.0 ^ ^ -V:-''^^'^ * \ • ^ » o /^ V-. . ^ ■ '^ 'I ^ V . ■^.v. < ■x"^ i.V ^'\ x^--^ ^. . //'-^ ^ >*^ "- '^;,. ^■i- ,>' ■'■:. '.'^^.- ■'^ %.<^ ^?y.-. -sP^' '" ■0-' '\ ^ s- ^^- . ^ 0^ ^<'\^'^" - -^oV o o^ ^-<- f ?'^ 0- .x^''%. ^ -^^ ■>bv^ -^-0^ ^.' ■'-t.. .V. „-^ °x ^>rtr:^^v '., v-r^r^* s#' , .„.^. . .<=^ °-"c/co-.:^b'-^^^ ^'\ '.^^' '^^ ^o V ^ /■■ ■N^^'V =..¥l|w^ ,;f^ -^ "^^ d*^' ■ .0- 4* % '-. .^ <^n - ^^= -7- /.^:::^^% ^j^m^ V V!- ^ - " /■ O "b > . <:r. a\ - r^ ^- -^..^^^ 8 . -^. ^0 / _.^^ : %4^ ^ .s> ^^. ■Jj, ^ ^h^iiy^ -% .. ^ .^"% ^ v'-^ -O^^ • »., ,-^ .^0•' /'. ,/.^ ^* o.^' 0\oO x^-/.. •" ,-^ ^ '*-'"s as a whole may be too transverse or too obhque upon one side. This is chiefly found in pathological curves of the spine, but still such conditions may exist where there are severely contracted muscles, The Peactice of Osteopathy 49 especially in some cases of paralysis. Thus the contour of the ribs must be taken into consideration by comparing one side with the other. In examining the first rib an examination somewhat different from the other ribs should be given. It is best to have the patient assume a sitting posture; then place the middle fingers of each hand upon the first ribs near their centers and compare one with the other. Also note the difference of the spaces between the ribs and clavicles. Generally the first rib is dislocated upward, rarely downward. Besides finding an abnormal prominence or depression of the rib at its center considerable tenderness will be noticed. Examinations of this region are every day experiences with the osteopath. When diagnosing the position of the floating ribs it is best to have the patient lie flat upon the back with the thighs flexed upon the abdo- men, so that the tissues about the lower ribs may be entirely relaxed. Then by placing the flat of the fingers carefully over the ribs the outline and position of them can be easily discerned. The floating ribs are often- times found deranged and are the source of a great deal of suffering through the iliac regions. These ribs may become dislocated from the vertebral ends and drop down obliquely toward the iliac crest, or else the free end may become locked beneath the rib above. Occasionally both ends of the rib drop down quite perceptibly and consequently is the cause of considerable distress. In such instances the rib is depressed inward so that the normal contour of the lower thorax is lost. An examination of the clavicle should be carefully made. Always compare the clavicle with its fellow and examine thoroughly its articu- lation with the sternum as well as at the acromial prominence. Often the sternal end of the clavicle is slightly dislocated posteriorly to the sternum; although it may become completely luxated. The acromial end may be dislocated upward or downward. In examining the sternum special attention should be given the articulation of the manubrium and gladiolus. This is due to the crowd- ing anteriorly of the articulation of the sternal parts. Normally until wefl along in adult hfe there should be some movement here due to its membranous attachment. Occasionally the ensiform cartilage is turned inward, producing a tender point, but this rarely occurs. Also the ar- ticulation of the cartilages in the region of the eighth, ninth, and tenth ribs may be found considerably deranged, causing local tenderness and even stomach trouble. Dorsal and Lumbar Spinal Region. — With the patient sitting on the table abnormal deviations can be readily noted. There may be 50 The Practice of Osteopathy lateral swerves, from muscular weakness, or unilateral tension, involving the whole spine or less, or a reversal of natural curves, i. e., the spine depressed anteriorly between the shoulders and posteriorly in the lumbar making the straight spine. There may be, also, an exaggerated normal curve in the dorsal region producing a kyphosis with a compensatory lordosis in the lumbar region sufficiently great to change its relations with the pelvis. By the method previously given, now outline the spinal column for lateral and bilateral scohosis. These, frequently, are at their incipiency, and to the casual observer would pass unnoticed. It is well to make an outline of the spine before beginning treatment, and at times following, that progress may be observed. A simple method is lead tape which can be had from any plumber shop and can be molded to the deformity and traced on paper together with date of examination. H. F. Goetz has perfected an apphance for outhning and recording these deviations. Observe well the hgaments, as well as extent of joint movement, under deep palpation; from irritation they may become thickened and more or less fill the spaces about the spines and trans- verse processes, causing a rigid, smooth spine. To make a detailed examination the patient should be stretched out on one side upon a treating table, although the general examination may be sufficient. Then, standing in front of the patient and reaching over him, a most careful diagnosis can be made. Do not stand back of the patient as the flat of the fingers can not be used to advantage in outhning the different vertebrae. The various contracted muscles that may be found along the spinal column will be of valuable aid in locating de- rangements of the vertebrae and vertebral ends of the ribs. By using contracted muscles along the spinal column as a guide for locating lesions, reference to the large superficial muscles is not made, but to the small areas of contracted fibres of the deep muscles. It is the deep muscles that become more or less contracted, and even fibrotic, when lesions of the vertebrae and ribs exist. The superficial muscles are generally con- tracted by atmospheric changes, slumped postures, wrong habits, etc., and are not generally the result of disorders in the osseous system. The preceding points in regard to contracted muscles cannot be too carefully observed for there is a tendency among many osteopaths to treat the contracted deep muscles as primary lesions in nearly every case. Re- member that if they are not due to the motor nerve fibres of the muscles being irritated by the spinal lesion, or to a reflex stimulus, or to a com- pensatory change, that although the muscular tension may be the in- ception of the almost certain interosseous lesion, still the leverages se- The Practice of Osteopathy 51 cured through bony adjusting are very essential hot only in correcting the osseous malposition but in loosening and releasing fibrous muscles and thickened Ugaments. Thorax. — Examination of the thorax as a region has been largely gone over in speaking of the ribs and their sternal attachment, cartilages, sternum and the clavicles, but its appearance as a whole should be care- fully noted for it will be a valuable aid in diagnosis. Deviations from the normal, such as the emphysematous or barrel-shaped chest in asth- matic affections, or chronic cough, or accompanying kyphosis, the flat chest and its association with phthisis, the rachitic, etc., should be con- sidered. Spinal deformities are reflected in the thorax by marked chang- es in contour, such as elevations and depressions corresponding to the spinal changes. These result in marked interference with the thoracic organs and in young subjects are of particular interest. Rib changes are frequently the result of vertebral deviations. Abdomen. — The position for examination of the abdominal viscera is usually with the patient supine, head slightly elevated, knees drawn up partially and supported to reheve any muscular strain, and with the hands at the sides. In this position complete relaxation is obtained. Observe any enlargements from gas, fluid, or tumor, muscular changes, color, etc. The patient may, also, be placed upon the side, and in the knee-chest position for further verification of the diagnosis. Where the abdominal wall is much relaxed, or there is a pendulous ab- domen with enteroptosis, there will be found a change of relations of the viscera b}^ these different positions, allowing them to be palpated in another position. When there is marked tenderness it is often possible to go deeper with less discomfort with the patient in the knee-chest posi- tion. The Trendelenburg position may also be utiHzed. Where ascites is suspected palpation should be made with the patient in various posi- tions in order to note changes of location of the fluid. Frequently much can be learned by inspection with the patient standing. Clues to visceral disturbance can often be had by tracing the nerve connection from the spinal lesions to the suspected part. In examining the liver care must be taken that any gouging or se- vere bruising of the organ does not take place. The fiver can be out- lined by percussion and also by palpation of its lower and inner borders Congestions, atrophy, enlargement or hardening should be noted, also smy change in position. A rather complete examination can be given the biliary tract from the gall-bladder to the duodenal orifice of the biliary duct. 52 The Practice of Osteopathy By a careful inhibitory pressure over the duct the outhne of the tract can be discerned providing the patient is not too stout. When the tract is swollen considerable tenderness will be present. The patient will complain of a stabbing or piercing pain upon pressure and manipulation if the duct is inflamed. Usually the tenderness is greatest nearer the duodenal orlbce. The duodenal orifice is about one and one-half inches diagonally down- w^ard to the right from the umbihcus. In cases of impacted gall-stones the osteopath as a rule has very little trouble in locating the stone. The spleen may be percussed and when in a markedly enlarged condition its lower border can be palpated. Great care must be used in the latter condition as there is danger of rupture. In examining the stomach the usual methods of inspection, palpa- tion, percussion, analysis of the contents, etc., are employed. Palpation and manipulation over the intestines are practiced a great deal by the osteopath in various intestinal diseases. By his edu- cated sense of touch he is usually able to locate at once any impactions of fecal matter. Such impactions are generally found in the ilio-cecal and sigmoid regions. In the various acute obstructions from invagina- tion, tmnors, twists, adhesions, spasticity, knots, etc., many times one is able to readily locate the seat of the disturbance. There is one point to specially emphasize; that is, do not overlook prolapsed regions of the intestines; such occur frequently and are a source of considerable dis- tress, especially constipation. Simple manipulation will never do much good, neither will spinal treatment or injections, as a rule. A specific treatment must be given and, that is, after locating the exact point of prolapse, to reach carefully beneath the fold and replace it. In emaciated subjects the kidneys can be readily located, and in a few instances when they are diseased one can feel the contracted tissues about them. Be very careful not to injure the capsule about the kid- ney. Do not punch or gouge them in the least; but locate the Iddneys by a careful inhibitory palpation. Lumbar and Pelvis. — The intimate relation between the lumbar spine and pelvis make a consideration of them as a region necessary. Outside of ordinary curvatures involving both the dorsal and lumbar regions there are certain conditions which involve but one structure and require careful differential diagnosis to determine whether the lumbar or pelvis is at fault. In the former the fifth vertebra is a weak point and is most frequently at fault. The deviations are usually a sidebending and frequently accompanied with some rotation. Occasionally a mal- The Practice of Osteopathy 53 structure of the lower lumbar or pathologically relaxed Hgaments will approximate the spines and be misleading as to the real condition. A rotation or lateral tilting of the fifth lumbar may have the effect of ele- vating the crest of the iUum so that the innominatum would appear in- volved. There will be a difference in the length of the legs, angles of feet when patient is lying on the back, anterior spines out of hne and tenderness of the muscles attached near them. However, other diag- nostic points of innominate lesions, i. e., tenderness of symphysis and sacro-ihac articulation, and prominence of the posterior spine, will be lacking. Marked deviation of other lumbar vertebra? may produce practically the same effect, but the lesion will be so apparent that there will be no doubt as to the cause. To be able to diagnose accurately and intelHgently the pelvic region requires nearly as much skill as in examining the cervical region. The pelvic bones are Hable to many subdislocations, especially in the female. However, it should be remembered that many apparent innominate lesions are secondary or compensatory changes due to lumbar lesions. The pelvis as a whole may be tipped anteriorly or posteriorly upon the spinal column. It also may be twisted or rotated laterally upon the spinal column. The most common lesions are subluxations of an in- nominatum forward, backward, upward, or downward, or various com- binations of these displacements, such as a tipping forward and downward of an innominatum, or a tipping backward and upward, but these com- binations do not always exist in the manner given. As a rule when the ilium is anterior, the ischium posterior, then the innominatum as a whole is downward; when the ihum is posterior, the ischium anterior, then the innominatum as a whole is upward. This is only a rule, there are exceptions to it; for in some few cases when the ihum is anterior, the ischium posterior, the innominatum may be higher, and when the ihum is posterior and the ischium anterior the innominatum may be lower. To be able to diagnose such derangements will require skill and prac- tice; still there are symptoms and signs that are characteristic of such disorders. In examining the pelvic bones have the patient flat upon the back at first. Be sure he is flat upon the back for a very shght varia- tion may make considerable difference in the relation of the pelvic bones, one to the other, so far as the diagnostic points are concerned. Then go to the feet of the patient and grasp the ankles firmly, rotate laterally both legs, first to one side and then to the other, as well as pull and push both limbs shghtly, and then bring the heels together directly in the median line of the body and compare the length of the limbs at the heels. 54 The Practice of Osteopathy If there is any disorder whatever in one innominatum, and the thigh muscles have been relaxed thoroughly by the preceding movements and the heels are brought together in the median line of the body, a difference in the length of the limbs will readily be observed at the inner malleoli or the heels. For if the ihum is forward the ischium must be backward and as a rule the innominatum is thrown downward, thus causing an apparent lengthening of the limb which will be noticed by comparing the heels; if the ihum is backward the ischium must be forward and as a rule the innominatum is then upward, causing an apparent shortening of the limb on the affected side. A very slight variation in the pelvis will make considerable difference in an apparent lengthening or short- ening of the limbs. Such conditions are generally met with several times a day by osteopaths. The object of the lateral rotary movement and the pushing and pulHng of the limbs is to make sure that all the thigh muscles are thoroughly relaxed, for it is a very easy matter for contracted muscles in one thigh to produce an apparent shortening of the limb. Also be very careful in comparing the length of the two limbs at the heels where they come together that they are exactly in the median hne of the body, for if they should be to one side or the other, however shghtly, there would be an apparent lengthening of the outer limb as compared with the hmb near the median hne. While the patient re- mains flat upon the back it is a good plan to compare the anterior spines of the iUa. It may be readily noticed that one is higher or more depressed than the other, which will help to confirm the diagnosis. It is a good plan also to have the patient sit up squarely upon the table and compare the crests and posterior spines of the iHa; thus one may be seen to be higher than the other. Then, also, note the angles of the feet when pa- tient is supine; an everted foot usually means that the limb is shorter due to the tilted pelvis; the opposite is commonly true when the foot is inverted. However, this is not an absolute rule. Care should be taken in differential diagnosis of possible old fracture of leg, of infantile paraly- sis, of asymmetry, etc. There are three diagnostic points exclusive of all other signs that are quite conclusive when coupled with the preceding examination. If an innominatum is dislocated or subdislocated there will be tenderness over the symphysis pubis on the side affected, tenderness over the ilio- sacral articulation on the side affected, and tenderness along the crest of ilium where the abdominal muscles are attached. When tenderness is found at these three points it is quite conclusive that the innominatum is deranged, for at the symphysis pubis and iho-sacral articulation ten- The Practice of Osteopathy 55 derness must exist if the innominatum is disturbed, and by a change in the crest of the ihum the abdominal parietes will be affected, provided they are not too much debihtated. Marked tenderness of the external cutaneous nerve as it passes over the crest of the ilium below the anterior spine will be noticed on the unaffected side (Dr. Still). There will be, on rectal examination, marked tension of the tissues on the affected side. Possibly the patient may complain of pain exclusively in one side along the pelvis and hmb which will be a leading symptom telHng which side is affected. Additional diagnostic signs will be rigidity of muscles along the ilio-sacral articulation and abnormal prominence or depression of the ilium at its articulation with the sacrum, depending upon which way the innominatum has sHpped. Considerable deviation of the pubic bones may be noticed. The pubic bone on the side affected may be either thrown upward or downward. Radiographs have repeatedly revealed subluxations of the innomi- nate bones in many instances. This is certainly quite conclusive in con- firmation of the osteopathic ideas in regard to the pelvic bones becoming dislocated. Sacrum. — Examination of the sacrum is best made with the patient lying on the side, with the osteopath standing in front and with the hand palpate its posterior surface. In the sitting posture its relation with both innominates can be determined. It is displaced posteriorly but seldom, the most frequent being anterior, downward, and a combination of the two. In the anterior conditions tenderness at the sacro-iliac articu- lations is a good point, but it must not be confounded with an innominate lesion. The downward displacement is shown by comparison with the lower lumbar vertebrae. Observe the relation between the two, as a change in contour of the spine will also change the angle of the sacrum and vice versa. Coccyx. — With the patient and operator in same position as for the sacral examination outline the coccyx, as to first, contour; second, rigidity, third, sensitiveness. If abnormahties are detected go to the other side of the table and with a well lubricated index finger palpate its anterior surface. Changed contour, displacements, and old frac- tures can be readily determined. The most common deviation is an- terior at its union with the sacrum. The lateral form generally result- ing from muscular contraction is next, with posterior but seldom. "If the lower part of the sacrum is rotated backward, the sacro-coccygeal articulation or angle is affected or becomes more acute, since the tip of 56 The Practice of Osteopathy the cocc3^x is not displaced, but held in position by structures attached to it. If the sacrum is displaced downward the effect is about the same. Often this sort of sacral lesion is mistaken for an anterior luxation of the coccyx."^ Remember that normally there should be some move- ment of the coccjrx. It has a fibro-membranous articulation. Uterine, ovarian and rectal examinations are largely of the same natm-e as those given by other practitioners, although osteopaths find that oftentimes other practitioners are mistaken in regard to the etiology of many diseases to which these organs are subject. Arms and Legs. — There is comparatively little that is exclusively osteopathic in regard to the diagnosis of disorders of the arms and legs. One important feature that the osteopath finds in examining the arms and legs is that many of the disorders supposed to originate in the af- fected member are found to be caused from vertebral or rib dislocations. Innominate and lumbar lesions are particularly fruitful sources of trouble in the legs and feet. Always carefully examine the spine in the region of innervation to the arms and legs when they are affected. The shoul- der and hip joints, as well as all joints, are subject to partial dislocations. Many times when pain or other symptoms are presented in the arms or legs the trouble is at the shoulder or hip joint or in the spinal column. There are two regions that are very apt to be overlooked in the examina- tions of the arms and legs and they are the elbow joint and the fibula. The small bones of the ankle and wrist as well as of the foot and hand are subject to many dislocations which are easily discerned upon ex- amination and often overlooked. Special emphasis should be given in regard to many supposed diseases of the knee joints which are really caused by lesions in the spine or at the hip joint. Osteopathic Prognosis Everyone is of the opinion that to forecast the probable result of a disease is one of the most difficult problems the physician has to meet. To state the duration, course, and termination of an attack of disease as presented by its nature and sjanptoms implies an accurate knowledge of both disease processes and changes, and an insight into the individual's idiosyncrasies backed by ripe clinical experience. And after each of these factors has been carefully considered to balance one against the other, nothing short of superhuman knowledge may present a sufficient insight in order to render an accurate prognosis. A prognosis represents 1. Clark's Applied Anatom}', p. 331. The Practice of Osteopathy- 57 the culmination of one's learning, an understanding of disease charac- teristics, and an insight into temperament. C. M. T. Hulett^ says : " Only when we can know all the conditions, causative and sequential, with their possible comphcations and termina- tions, together with a full history of therapeutic results in a large number of similar cases, and carefully analyzing and weighing these variotis ele- ments, are we prepared to really make a prognosis. " Nettie H. Bolles^ writes as follows: "The prognosis depends upon the cause of the disease, the possibility of removing the cause, or the hkehhood of recurrence of causes, and the chances of avoiding such recurrence. The circumstances to modify the outlook are various and deserve careful consideration." It is not the purpose here to go into the many essential details, for that would mean an outline and forecast of all disease processes, and the effect of numerous extenuating circumstances. The medical profession have been gathering data for these three thousand years and prognosis with them is still inaccurate and incomplete. Osteopathic science will add just so much to the accuracy of prognosis as the sum total of the knowledge displayed in the fields of osteopathic etiology, diagnosis, path- ology and therapeutics. Suffice it to give here a few salient practical hints as noted in the osteopathic treating room and at the bedside. Osteopathically it may be said that prognosis depends, first, upon the true conception of osteopathy; second, upon the relative value of all factors pertaining to health and disease; and, third, upon the skill (tech- nique and native ability) of the osteopath. The first and second being granted, the third includes a remarkably practical and pregnant field, for in no school does the physician get into as close touch and understanding of the actual condition of the patient's disorder as in the osteopathic. Although the fundamentals and principles of the osteopathic concep- tion of diseases are really broad, Hberal, and all-inclusive, still owing to the fact that each individual (and thus each disease) is more or less a law unto himself should there not be absolute tables and prescriptions to be governed b}^; remember, however, this does not imply our fundament- als are not basic or our principles are not truths, but rather the appHca- tion and execution of the same are as varied as the individual's consti- tution, temperament, and disease. Herein rests the really difficult practical consideration of etiology, pathology, diagnosis, treatment, and prognosis. In other words, if the diagnosis and treatment are accurate the result rests entirely with the patient. 1. Prognosis — Journal of the American Osteopathic Association, Jan., 1906. 2. Prognosis— Journal of the American Osteopathic Association, Nov., 1902. 58 The Peactice of Osteopathy First, too much emphasis cannot be placed upon the fact that prog- nosis is dependent upon the osteopath — his education, training, abihty, experience, and technique. One's fitness is most important. And fitness and personahty complement each other. An osteopath may know theory and still not be practical; still one cannot be practical unless he knows theory. Second, osteopathic treatment frequently changes the usual course of acute disease. It is well known that many diseases have a certain regular course in their history. Many times the osteopath will be able to abort, lessen the severity, or cut short the ailment, thus changing the recognized symptoms and termination. Third, the knack of treatment, or knowing how to treat, not only one region of the body but all regions, not only one temperament but all temperaments. Fourth, the preparatory treatment before correcting the lesion. , Prevention, palliation, or cure, and thus prognosis, may be dependent upon a necessary preparatory treatment. Here is where a study of the patient's temperament is very essential. Fifth, a prolonged treatment may defeat one's purpose. As a rule a comparatively short, thoroughly indicated, specific treatment is best. Sixth, much, relative to prognosis, can be told by the tone of the vertebral ligaments. When a lesion corrects too easily or does not re- main well in place it shows a lack of tonicity on the part of the hgaments and muscles. Improvement is in direct ration to the increase of tonici- ty. Seventh, special care should be taken with the irritable spine. This spine commonly precedes the debilitated spine. Unless precaution is taken to apply inhibition before treating specifically a cure may be pre- vented or at least the disorder prolonged. Eighth, relaxation of muscles is not always essential, although the lack of it may prevent the correction of primary lesions. The relaxation should be carried out with care in order that all shock and irritation may be kept at a minimum. Ninth, needless stretching, traction, extending, rotation, and snap- ping of the neck is not only useless but may be positively dangerous. Rarely is it necessary to go through the above "movements" as many are accustomed to do. Tenth, it may be necessary, but not always, to give as additional treatment, after the anatomical defect has been specifically treated, a certain amount of stretching and moulding of the parts. The Practice of Osteopathy 59 Eleventh, owing to the close personal relations of physician and pa- tient, personaHty has a powerful influence on prognosis. Twelfth, too much emphasis cannot be placed upon the uselessness and injurious effects of over and misapplied treatment. All of the above have a positive bearing on prognosis. The osteo- path should study his technique well. He will find that it gradually changes and improves from year to year. In a word, as he gains in ex- perience he will become more skiUful by giving careful attention to the development of the sense of touch, by noting the resistance of the tis- sues, and a score of details that are very hard to describe but the sum total of which determines and indicates the successful osteopath. Another practical point that bears upon prognosis as well as upon the health of the osteopath is the manner of giving treatment. First, the height of the treating table should correspond to the height of the .practitioner. The table should be made for the practitioner and not the practitioner fitted and warped according to a certain table. Second, give part of the treatments on a treating stool. Here there is greater freedom of movement on the part of the patient, hence greater and more effective leverage can be obtained. Suit your treatment to the patient, not your patient to the treatment. Third, make your weight count for energy expended in the treatment. As soon as one set of muscles be- come tired substitute another set, e. g., the back muscles and the arms, the arms and the hands. Fourth, whenever possible substitute the weight of the patient for expended energy. Fifth, when lifting keep the spinal column straight; do the bending of the body at the knees. Hence a better treatment and a more favorable prognosis, and besides that new occupation-neurosis, the "osteopathic back," will be mater- ially lessened in both severity and frequency. 60 The Practice of Osteopathy OSTEOPATHIC TECHNIQUE The technique of treatment is, in a sense, a personal factor, for it is a well known fact no two osteopaths treat just alike. Nevertheless, the principles of technique are constant and universally appHcable, and he who apphes them with specificity manifest^ secures the best results, and exhibits a technique that is finished and characteristically osteo- pathic. General manipulations are not essentially osteopathic, although by employing them a few definite results may be obtained; still such technique should not be classed as distinctive osteopathic therap3^ Ev- ery case is a law unto itself and must be studied individually in order to be able to understand it perfectly. So much depends upon the abihty of the osteopath in the treating of a case, that in order to meet the indi- cations intelhgently he must have command of the various anatomical details of the body, not only in his mind but upon his finger tips.^ The sense of touch should be very acutely developed and this re- quires months of persistent, practical experience. A carefully educated sense of touch is the key-note to both osteopathic diagnosis and operative technique. From the very nature of the osteopathic conception — the physical body viewed as a mechanism whose disordered or diseased con- ditions demand anatomical readjustment — it is imperative that a deh- cate and educated sense of touch be acquired in order to logically and suc- cessfully appty its tenets. Proficiency means not only being able to note certain small physical irregularities, and various degrees and areas of muscular contractions, and variations in body temperature, but the extent and state of vital resistance, that is, tissue condition, and the teehng of organic resistance, e. g., the heart, lungs, liver. These are the special features wherein osteopathic fingers detect disease causes and traces. To know the difference between normal and abnormal structural deviations and distortions, as well as organic changes, re- quires an accurate, detailed knowledge of anatomy and pathology with a. systematic daih^ education of the sense of touch; but to realize, ap- preciate and know by tissue resistance feehng that nutritional condition is improving requires much more practical experience. Thus two very practical points should be taught to and thoroughly impressed upon every osteopathic student : First, the sense of resist- ance of the tissues. This gives us an absolute clue to the vitahty of the patient. As has been stated, there is a vast difference between the 1. See Ashmore's Osteopathic Mechanics. The Practice of Osteopathy 61 feel, the sense of resistance, of normal and abnormal tissues; for instance,, a normal muscle and a contractured muscle, a normal liver and a con- gested liver, a normal intestine and a prolapsed intestine and these dif- ferences comprise innumerable gradations. Second, the receptivity of the patient to treatment. This is dependent upon the vitality of the tissues. The sense of resistance to touch gives us an important diagnostic clue; the receptivity of the patient to treatment tells us much as to prognosis. After a few treat- ments the receptiveness will be positive or negative; that is, the patient is, or is not, responding to treatment. Consequently the receptivity of the patient usualty tells much as to the state of nutrition. Definite principles should be followed when applying the technique, for the osteopathic lesion is a "structural perversion," thus indicating, mechanical readjustment for its correction. The time is coming when the technique will be taught graphically and mathematically. This would not be a difficult thing to do, and it could not but prove inval- uable aid to the student. He can then the more readily and compre- hensively grasp the principles involved. To resolve and illustrate ma- nipulative readjustment to and by the principles of mechanics would add considerable to osteopathic development. For example, how nicely the correction of certain innominata maladjustments illustrates the prin- ciple of the wheel and axle. Vertebral and rib displacements when re- adjusted make appUcation of the principles of the simple machines. We are gradually approaching a more comprehensive understanding of the physiologic movements of the spine and of the etiologic role of muscle tension. This is part of the foundation work. Great care must be exercised in correlating this data with the individual case, for in therapy we are dealing with abnormahties — not alone normal physiologic chang- es. If our distinctive dynamics and therapeutics were taught in this manner the average osteopath would be more specific and comprehensive in his work and as a consequence more scientific. And consequently the principles involved in each and every case would stand out clearlj-. Hence diagnosis would be more exact, routine pommeling discarded, and better all around technique executed. Two general rules are apphcable to all dislocations, whether partial or complete: 1. Exaggerate or increase the dislocation. This is to relax the tissues about the dislocated articulation and to disengage the articular points that have become locked. 2. Reduce the dislocation by retracing the path along which the parts were dislocated. Hence to correct a lesion, for example, a vertebral lesion: (1) Exaggerate the 62 The Practice of Osteopathy lesion. (2) Place the fingers of the hand that are not employed in exag- gerating the lesion over the extended portion of the lesion. (3) Extend the region that is flexed when the lesion was exaggerated. (4) When the lesion is being extended produce traction and slight rotation of the region. (5) At the same time extension, traction and rotation is being produced push in upon the extended portion of the lesion. To this might be added for sake of clearness and greater assurance of success: (a) Be positive the focal point absolutely corresponds to the lesion, or else most if not all of your effort will be useless, (b) Just before reaching the maximum of exaggeration have your fingers correct^ placed for the readjustment, and at the very morfient of maximum exaggeration or just a fraction of a second prior begin to correct or readjust, or else you will lose the vantage gained and the operation will probably be a failure. (c) The general traction and rotation are to aid in unlocking the lesion, not to readjust as some may think. Inhibiting and releasing the soft tissues, such as spasms, contractions and contractures of muscles, and stretching thickened and adherent ligaments is very important prehm- inary work. Then, next to securing exact leverages an essential point is to maintain the release or exaggeration until the readjusting step is incepted. In other words, coordination of all factors is the desideratum. The lack of this is the cause of many failures. Hot fomentations fre- quently assist in relaxing irritable and spastic soft tissues. This, how- ever, is but a preliminary measure. AU rough handling, needless snap- ping of parts, and excessive rotation and stretching are not only apt to tighten the lesion more, shock the system and irritate the parts, but it may be absolutely dangerous. It should not be forgotten that the osteopath includes many meas- ures in his treatment of various diseases, as nursing, dieting, hygiene, sanitation, hydrotherapy, antidotes, antiseptics, etc., and does not de- pend upon readjustive manipulation alone, although correcting disor- dered anatomical structures and perversions are paramount in the treat- ment. The General Treatment. — A general treatment but accentuates the ignorance, in a majority of cases, of many so termed osteopaths. It is a deplorable fact that there is a tendency among some osteopaths to give general treatments in every case presented. The only explana- tion of such a procedure that one can think of is a lack of conception as to what osteopathy really is. To give a general treatment in every case is not only actually detrimental to the patient but it is the height of folly on the osteopath's part, for it gets him into a slovenly habit of procedure The Practice of Osteopathy 63 from both scientific and curative points of view, besides giving the out- side world an impression that osteopathy is but little different from mas- sage and Swedish movements instead of skillful, mechanical engineer- ing of the human body. But a "general treatment" is not to be con- fused with definite attention to be a series of more or less interrelated lesions. The essential point is to normahze the body when and where distinctly indicated and after a skillful manner. A general treatment, broadly speaking, should be given only under three conditions: (1) Constitutional diseases that are to be treated S5'Tiiptomatically. (2) Certain anemic cases. (3) When one is ignorant of the real cause of the disease. Each of these conditions is self-evident why a general treatment should be given. A fourth might be added, for those individuals who think they are not getting value received unless they are treated from head to foot. Such patients are usually ignorant of the philosophy of osteopathy and it is the osteopath's duty to teach them differently. The general treatment consists in stretching the spinal column from the atlas to the coccyx and relaxing all contracted muscles along both sides of the spinal column, besides giving special treatment to the cervical region, between the scapulae, the splanchnics and internal and external rotation of the legs. It is no wonder that fake osteopaths do cure a case occasionally. They are quite certain to correct some disorder by pulling and hauling a patient around in such a manner. Still on the other hand they are very likely to do injury to the patient. Those who claim that no injury can come from osteopathic treatment are mistaken. One can injure a person by treatment if he is not careful. It does not stand to reason that the most dehcately constructed mechanism should stand any amount of manipulation and misdirected force that may be given it. Positions of the Patient and Physician in Treating. — The position of the patient when a treatment is given depends altogether upon the affection to be treated. Probably about one-half of the cases can be treated to advantage upon a table, the remainder sitting on a stool. Many osteopaths treat nearly all their patients upon a table. It is much better to change back and forth, because to correct a certain disorder may be hard upon the table, but will be comparatively easy when the patient is on a stool, and vice versa. Besides, constantly chang- ing back and forth rests a physician greatly. Learn to treat in various positions, because it will be impossible to have all cases assume a certain position when being treated; and es- pecially in treating acute cases one is obliged to suit his treatment to 64 The Pkactice of Osteopathy the patient and not the patient to the treatment. There is also a ten- dency- for one to get into slovenly habits of treating when patients are all placed practically in one position, and certainly one cannot treat all cases in one position to equal advantage. Also learn to treat as well with one hand as the other. Many times one will be in such positions that equal use of either hand will be required. Carefully educate the sense of touch in both hands. Another point should receive consideration: learn to shift the strength exerted in treating from one set of muscles to others. For ex- ample, when one is standing for a long time he will continually shift his weight from one limb to the other. In the same manner in treating use the strength of the hands awhile, then the arms, then the muscles of the back, then the weight of the body, etc.; all in such a manner that there is a constant change by utilizing certain groups of muscles for the same work, as well as utiHzing the weight of the body of both physician and patient to advantage. It rests a physician greatly and thus allows him to perform a maximum amount of work with a minimum amount of strength and labor. It is frequently an advantage to the physician to treat upon the nude skin, thus preventing the fingers from becoming tender. Gowns can be easily made that open down the back so that the patient does not have to disrobe. The Neck and Head. — In the treatment of the neck the patient may assume the sitting posture or lie flat upon the back. The latter is preferable, as then one has complete control of the neck and head. Absolute control of a part is always necessary and when this is secured the dangers are reduced to a minimum, provided always that reasonable discretion as to the amount of strength, is used. Before correcting the various deviations of the cervical vertebrae it is usually best to thor- oughh" relax all the muscles, superficial and deep, about the field of op- eration. In relaxing muscles three methods may be employed. The muscle may be firmly grasped and manipulated until relaxed, or a firm pressure may be exerted upon the muscle and thus inhibit its nerve force until the muscle relaxes, or the muscle may be longitudinally stretched. The second method is comparatively slow and is usually given in acute cases where the patients are so weak and exhausted that they cannot stand any severe manipulation. This method, however, has certain advantages whan employed as a preparatory^ step in interosseous adjust- ments, though steady traction accompanied with slight rotation, if pre- cisely locaKzed, has many advocates. The Practice op Osteopathy 65 In relaxing muscles by manipulation, grasp firmly the belly of the muscle and draw outward on the muscle several times until it relaxes. If the patient is sitting, place one hand upon the head of the patient or about the chin in such a manner that complete control of the head is maintained throughout the procedure; then with the fingers of the other hand upon the contracted muscular fibres a manipulating or kneading of the muscle can be given. It is best to flex the neck and head to the side where the contracted muscles are, so that a better hold of the mus- cle may be maintained; then by a series of flexions and extensions with manipulation of the contracted muscles outward, results can be readily obtained. When the patient is lying on the back the physician may stand to one side of the patient's head and with one hand on the fore- head of the patient and the other hand around the opposite side of the neck, a rotary motion of the head and neck, which is equal to flexion and extension in the sitting posture, may be given by the hand on the frontal region while the other hand relaxes the muscles; or the osteopath may stand at the head of the patient and with either hand on the side of the head and neck of the patient a series of rotary movements of the head and neck may be given with manipulation of first one side of the neck and then the other; the hands and fingers being placed in such a manner that when the fingers of one hand are relaxing the muscles on its side the other hand is executing the movements of the head and neck, each hand continually alternating in the work. This latter method requires some practice in order to do the work readily and successfully, for quite a variety of movements are required. In the former method after one has worked on one side he is obliged to change to the other side and go through the same process. Move- ments may also be given to stretch the contracted muscles, thus over- coming the contraction and producing relaxation of the muscles. After having relaxed the muscles over the field of operation, correct- ing the vertebrse will generally be easier to accomplish. In readjusting an atlas it matters but little whether the patient is sitting up or lying down. A firm hold of the atlas can be gotten in either instance. In correcting the middle and lower cervical vertebrse it is best to place the patient upon the back. In correcting dislocations, as heretofore suggested, two general rules should be followed: (1) Exaggerate or increase the dislocation. This is to relax the tissues about the dislocated articulation and to disengage the articular points that have become locked. (2) Reduce the lesion by retracing the path along which the parts were dislocated. One can readi- 66 The Practice of Osteopathy ly see that a dislocated ball and socket joint could be reduced only by the dislocated bone retracing the path by which it left its socket, for the capsular Ugament would at once prevent its returning to the socket by any path other than that taken when dislocated. This applies to all dislocations to a greater or less extent. After locating the exact position of the abnormal vertebra the first rule is applied, i. e., exaggerating the lesion by flexing the head in the opposite direction to which the vertebra is dislocated. Then with one or two fingers placed firmty upon the side of the vertebra in the direction dislocated, so that when the proper time comes the vertebra may be pushed or slightly rotated back into its normal position, with the other hand produce flexion of the neck, so that the angle of flexion is exactly over the involved vertebra; next produce slight traction, so as to be sure that the articular points will be disengaged; and then with rotation and extension of the head to a normal or upright posture, at the same time pushing in on the disordered vertebra, are the movements to be executed in reducing a dislocated vertebra. It takes considerable practice to be able to correct a vertebra and to know when it is corrected. The amount of force appUed varies greatly in different cases. Cases of re- cent subdislocation require but Httle force unless there is marked spas- ticity of tissue, while in long standing cases many times the amount of force required is about all that one wishes to exert. As a rule in many chronic cases it is better to give a series of preparatory treatments in order to reduce muscle fibrosis and thickening of capsular hgament. Remember that often it is a sHght rotary movement or twist given that aids the most in executing rule second. No matter to what position a vertebra is rotated or side-bent the principles applied are the same in each case. Be very careful when flexing, extending or rotating the neck that too much strain is not brought to bear upon the ligaments. Some osteo- paths seem to take dehght in rotating and flexing the neck to a great degree. It is a dangerous procedure and moreover does not accomplish anything in particular. It should be kept in mind that osteopathic treatment is scientific and not a number of general movements of various regions of the body. Locate the lesions exactly and then a specific treat- ment can be given in every instance. To illustrate the treatment accord- ing to the preceding rules we wiU assume that a certain cervical verte- bra is anterior, say the fourth cervical. This means that there is an interosseous lesion between the fourth and fifth. The inferior articular processes and facets of the fourth have slipped upward and forward on The Practice of Osteopathy 67 the opposing facets of the fifth. First, hyper-extend the head in such a manner that the fulcrum comes exactly over the displaced articulating planes, thus throwing the fourth vertebra still more anterior, or in other words, exaggerating the lesion or increasing the space anteriorly between the fourth and fifth cervicals, so that when the head is flexed forward and pressure is exerted upon the anterior part of the vertebra (body or transverse process) the vertebra will have room and release enough to occupy its normal position. Second, when the head is hyper-extended place a finger anterior to the transverse process of the dislocated verte- bra and with the other hand around the head, that is producing the hyper- extension, throw the head forward with slight traction and rotation and at the same time push posteriorly quite strongly upon the dislocated vertebra. Follow out the same principles in all cases, no matter in which way the vertebrae are deranged. There are several methods of applying the underlying principles of adjustment. Relaxation and leverages may be secured in various ways. Preciseness, expeditiousness and skilKulness can be attained only by considerable personal experience. In cases where the lesion is between the skull and atlas have the pa- tient sit on a stool with the back part of his head against your chest, and reach around the head with one hand under the chin; then with the other hand around the transverse processes of three or four upper cervical vertebrae pull the spinal column toward the median line, while at the same time hfting up on the skull with the other hand and throwing the skull toward the median line. The object of lifting up on the skull is to relax and disengage the articulations, by inhibition, traction and ro- tation, between the occipital bone and atlas. This is one method ap- plicable to the various lesions of the occiput, which are of frequent occurrence. In treating the pharynx, tonsils and larynx, outside of correcting spinal lesions, an anterior treatment to these organs is very effective. Examine the deep muscles beneath the angle of the jaw when the pharynx and tonsils are involved ; and when the larynx is affected note the condi- tion of the muscles on either side of the larynx. After locating deeply seated contracted muscles in the region of the angle of the inferior max- illa place the fingers over the contracted tissues, and then by a down- ward, inward sweeping motion toward the median line the muscles may be readily relaxed. When treating the larynx relax the tissues on both sides by an upward, inward movement. These treatments are very effectual when apphed directly to the disordered tissues. 68 The Practice of Osteopathy Attention should also be given to the lymphatics. In simple in- fections treat the glands very hghtly but attempt to break down the surrounding edematous barrier. Release all the tissues down to and including clavicles, first ribs and pectoral and axillary regions. To treat slight lesions of the inferior maxillary articulation, stand at the head of the patient when he is lying down and hook the fingers about the jaw just in front of the angles, and with the thumbs over the bridge of the nose have the patient open the mouth while considerable force is exerted against his effort. This reduces any sUght dislocation of the inferior maxilla. When the jaw is completely dislocated place a piece of wood or hard substance between the molars and exert pressure upward and backward on the chin. If the dislocation is bilateral work on one side at a time. The object of treatment to the face is to stimulate or inhibit points of the fifth nerve that come near the surface (see neuralgia of fifth nerve) . While the patient is lying flat upon the back carefully stimulate these various points, especially the supra-orbital and nasal, with a downward and outward movement, or inhibit as indicated. In treating the scalp relax the muscles over the scalp thoroughly. This is secondary treatment to correcting the innervation to the scalp at the upper four or five cervical vertebrae. In cases of pharyngitis, tonsilUtis, croup, hay fever, etc., an effective local treatment may be given through the mouth upon the soft and hard palate. Introducing a finger into the mouth clear back upon the roof of the soft palate, and with a downward and backward sweeping move- ment from the median line on either side toward the tonsils, considerable relief can be given the patient. This treatment relaxes the tissues, re- Heves the congestion, and gives a stimulating treatment to the local nerves. A treatment of the same nature may be given over the hard palate to affect the palatine nerves, especially in hay fever, when the itching of the palate and sneezing are extreme. In cases of young chil- dren it is best to protect the finger by wrapping a piece of cloth around it. An osteopath should never give a manipulation or movement unless he understands wh3\ Just as soon as one gives general imitating move- ments, from that moment his work is not that of a scientific osteopath, but of a Swedish movement curist and masseur and a poor one at that. The osteopath's work is to locate the anatomical derangement and correct it, as a mechanic would adjust any disordered mechanism. General treatment amounts largely to naught, although in some few instances it is of benefit. The Practice of Osteopathy 69 To give a detailed description of the treatment of all lesions that may be found in the cervical vertebrae would be impossible in this sketch ; only a general survey of the work can be given. Each case calls for special treatment, but the same general principles are applicable in each case. If there is any one thing that should be ehminated from osteo- pathic treatment it is those mechanical routine movements of rotating, flexing, extending, and various Swedish-movement-massage-like manip- ulations that certain osteopaths give in each and every case. It shows that they are imitators and do not have a correct conception of osteo- pathic therapeutics. True it is, that routine movements will have stim- ulating and other effects upon the system. But does the body require such treatment? Is it lack of exercise on the part of the patient? If it is, then let the patient exercise himself. You do not want to lower your- seK to be a mere "engine wiper," or an exerciser. If it is not the lack of exercise and the system is in need of certain treatment, then seek the cause and apply a specific treatment. Do not hide behind generaUties. The Ribs. — In correcting dislocated ribs many methods may be employed, but all are subject to the same principles as given under the treatment of the neck and head. One of the best methods to correct typical ribs is to have the patient upon the side with the side of the affected ribs upward. Find out ex- actly the nature of the dislocation, i. e., what is the relation of the dis- located rib to the other tissues. Note whether the rib is upward, down- ward, inward or forward, locate exactly the dislocated rib. Then, while standing back of the patient, place your fingers upon both ends of the rib. Place your fingers in such a manner that when the proper time in the procedure arrives, all that will be necessary will be to push the ends of the rib into their articulations. For instance, if the rib is raised anter- iorly and lowered posteriorly, you will place the fingers on the sternal end, above the affected rib and the fingers on the vertebral end, below the rib, so that when the rib has been released from its abnormal position it may be slipped into normal position. After having placed the fingers in the exact position necessary, have an assistant take the arm and draw it obliquely across the face, while at the same time the patient takes a forced inhal'ation. The object of drawing the arm across the face and the deep inhalation is to exaggerate the lesion — to draw the ribs out of their locked position — so that the fingers upon either end of the rib may push the rib into normal position. Drawing upon the arm raises all the upper ribs as well as the dislocated typical rib, principally by the use of the serratus magnus; also inhalation has an effect to throw the rib out- 70 The Practice of Osteopathy ward and upward and thus away from its articulation. Thus after the lesion has been increased sufficiently to loosen the rib from its abnormal position, the arm is relaxed, the patient exhales, and the fingers upon the ends of the rib correct the dislocation. This treatment is used to the greatest advantage when there is a dislocation of a typical rib; it can be given while the patient is lying down or sitting up, although the former position is preferable. An excellent method, when the sternal end of the rib is dislocated is to have the patient sit upon a stool with his back toward the physi- cian; then by placing the knee in the back (while standing up, or easier still for the physician to sit upon an operating table back of the patient) over the vertebral end of the rib so that the rib may be held rigid poster- iorly, reach around with one hand over the dislocated end of the rib and place the fingers upon the rib in the direction dislocated ; so that when the rib is sufficiently released from its abnormal position it can be readily pushed into place; then with the other hand under the axilla of the arm on the affected side, pull up and back on the shoulder, so that the rib may be pulled away from its sternal articulation; and at the same time have the patient take a deep inhalation so as to aid in throwing the rib outward, upward and away from its sternal attachment; then when the end of the rib has been released sufficiently, relax the hold underneath the axilla, have the patient exhale, and sUp the rib into its normal posi- tion by the fuigers over the end of the rib. This is an excellent method. It is easy to give and does the work admirabh^ Practically the same procedure may be gone through when the vertebral end is dislocated, by changing 3'our position to the front of the patient, but there is danger- of the knee slipping off from the sternum during the operation and injuring the ribs. Several other treatments may be given to correct dislocations of the vertebral ends of the ribs. For example, while the patient remains sitting the osteopath stands in front of the patient and reaches around both sides upon the angle of the ribs; then with an outward and upw^ard movement of the fingers upon the angle of the ribs, they are pulled away from their locked position and allowed to slip into normal articulation. This treatment is applicable onl}' when the ribs are dislocated downward, but it is one of the best treatments for such cases. Another method oftentimes emploj^ed in correcting dislocations of the vertebral end of the ribs is to have the patient lie flat upon the side with the affected side upward; then b}^ flexing the arm on the forearm and placing the elbow against the chest or abdomen reach over the pa- The Peactice of Osteopathy 71 tient upon the angle of the dislocated rib and pull it away from the ver- tebra; when it is pulled away from the spinal column sufficiently, push upward or downward on the angle of the ribs, as the case may demand. The elbow placed against you gives complete control of the patient and aids, by your weight, in throwing the rib upward or downward. A treatment somewhat like the preceding one which is commonly employed, is to reach underneath the patient's upper arm, when he is lying upon his side, with the arm extended upward across the face; then by placing the fingers of the hand underneath the patient's arm over the angles of the affected rib or ribs and reinforcing the hand by the fingers of the other hand an upward, outward and rotary movement can be given the ribs, which pulls them out of their abnormal position and allows them to return to their normal articulations. An effectual treatment fco spread and raise the upper ribs is to have the patient flat upon the back, and with the fingers of one hand under- neath the angles of the ribs and the other hand upon the elbow of the patient's arm of the same side throw the patient's arm across the chest transversely and bear down upon the elbow, at the same time spring upward and outward on the angles of the ribs with the other hand. By throwing the arm across the chest and bearing down upon the elbow a strong leverage can be obtained upon the upper ribs, especially those between the scapulae. This treatment is very efficacious in certain lung and heart diseases. Still another method of adjxistfng ribs is to have the patient flat on his face upon an operating table with the arms hanging down on both sides of the table and a small pillow or folded blanket beneath the upper part of the chest; then standing beside the table, or better still, with one foot upon a low stool and the knee of the other limb upon the table in such a manner that one is directly over the patient's dorsal region one is then in a position to have full control of the vertebral end of the ribs. If the ends of the ribs are displaced downward, placing the thumbs over the angles of the ribs and pushing upward and outward on the angles, the ribs can be very readily crowded into position. If the ribs, especially between the scapulae, are dislocated in any direction, they may be quite readily corrected by placing the hand over the shoulder posteriorly and throwing it outward and upward and away from the spinal column in such a manner that the ribs are pulled away from the abnormal position; then upon relaxing the hold upon the shoulder with the one hand, the fingers of the unemployed hand may push upward or downward, as the occasion requires, on the angles of the affected side so that the ribs may be slipped into place. 72 The Practice of Osteopathy Many times one is obliged to treat the ribs of one side as a whole. In such instances the ribs are almost invariably thrown downward ex- cept on one side of scoliosis of the dorsal region. Several methods may be employed to raise the ribs. Probably the best method is to have the patient upon the side and with one hand upon the angles of the ribs and the other hand holding the wrist of the upper arm of the patient, an up- ward lifting movement is given both upon the angles of the ribs and upon the arm of the patient while the patient inhales. The work upon the angles of the ribs is to raise the ribs directly; the work upon the arm is to raise the ribs indLrectly, principally by the use of the serratus magnus. Another effective treatment is to have the patient upon the back and with one hand over the antsrior ends of the ribs and the other hand over the angles of the ribs an upward movement is given them by springing the ends of the ribs toward each other and by strong inhalation on the part of the patient. This treatment is most effective where the false ribs are at fault and especially in case of hemiplegia. While the patient is upon the back an assistant may take hold of the arm and draw it upward oxer the head of the patient, producing considerable additional upward ten- dency of the ribs, and the physician giving the same treatment of the ends of the ribs as before; or the physician may take an arm in one hand and raise it above the head of the patient and with liis other hand around the angles of the ribs, and the patient inhaling deeply, the ribs maj'^ be raised. A treatment used a great deal in raising the ribs as a whole is to have the patient sit upon a stool, and reaching around the patient from the front, place the fingers upon the angles of the ribs and raise them upward on both sides at the same time. This treatment can also be given by standing behind the patient and reaching around upon the anterior ends of the ribs and lifting upward while the patient aids you by deep inhala- tion. Remember that many times the ribs are drawn downward b}' con- traction of the muscles, due to atmospherical changes and slumped pos- tures. One should begin at the upper ribs in all treatments where the ribs are to be raised, as a whole, and work downward. To correct the first and the floating ribs a different treatment has to be given than the foregoing. An upward displacement is the most common lesion of the first rib. To correct such a dislocation, have the patient sit upon a stool and with one hand pull the head to the opposite side in order that the lesion may be exaggerated by traction of the lateral muscles of the neck (principally the scaleni) upon the rib; this disengages the rib from its The Practice of Osteopathy 73 abnormal position; then with the fingers of the other hand upon a point midway of the ends of the rib, exert a downward pressure at the mo- ment the extended head is relaxed describing a short are. But don't relax head until readjusting pressure is exerted upon rib. If the patient is unable to sit up, and it is not best to give the foregoing treatment, have the patient flat upon the back, with one hand take hold of the arm on the affected side and pull down and out upon the shoulder so that the rib may be somewhat drawn away from its articulation and released from its position; then with the fingers of the other hand upon the center of the rib, or its highest point, press downward when the hold upon the arm is being relaxed. Correction of an upper displacement of the first rib is an every day occurrence. Downward dislocation of the ftrst rib, is rare. To reduce this dislocation, place the thumb beneath the vertebral end of the rib, and with the other hand lift up strongly on the shoulder from beneath the axilla, at the same time exerting pressure upward with the thumb on the end of the rib. The floating ribs may be dislocated obliquely downward, or the free end of the rib may be caught underneath the end of the rib above. In either case, in order to correct the displacement, place the patient upon the back with the thigh on the affected side flexed upon the abdo- men so that the tissues about the field of operation are relaxed; then bear down carefully but firmly over the free end of the rib with the fingers until one finger can be hooked underneath the end of the rib; then with the other hand over the vertebral end of the rib, have the patient take a deep breath, at the same time springing the ends of the rib toward each other, thus relaxing the rib from its locked position; then have the pa- tient exhale quickly and at the same time spring the rib into its normal position. It oftentimes requires repeated trials, especially in stout per- sons, and quite often the operation is painful to the patient. It is neces- sary that one should understand this operation thoroughly, as it is one of the most common treatments in osteopathic practice. The floating ribs are very hable to dislocations and may be the cause of many pains in the side, disturbances of the vessels as they pass through the diaphragm and inflammation in the ihac region. A palliative treatment may be given the floating ribs by having the patient he flat either on the back or on the side; then place the hand near the vertebral end of the ribs and raise them upward while the patient takes a deep bi-eath. Treatment of lesions between the manubrium and gladiolus are best given by placing the patient with the face downward upon the operating table, and having the articulation of the manubrium and 74 The Practice of Osteopathy gladiolus just over the edge of the table. An assistant should hold the patient firmly upon the table while hyper-extension or flexion, as the case may require, with traction, is exerted upon the head, neck and shoulders, and manipulation of the articular points is given to reduce the dislocation. The same principles are emploj^ed here as in correcting lesions elsewhere. Correction of the cartilages along the sternum is very easily accompHshed by having the patient sit upon a stool and the osteopath standing behind the patient places a knee in the back; then reaching around with one hand over the cartilages and the other hand underneath the axilla, execute the same movement as given in correcting disloca- tions of the sternal ends of the ribs. A treatment sometimes used to release a depressed condition of the cartilages of the false ribs is to stand behind the patient while he site upon a stool and reach around him with fingers underneath the cartilages and raise them upward as he inhales. By having the patient take a deep breath and then exhale quickly while the fingers are over the cartilages a much better grasp of them can be obtained. This treatment should be carefully given, as there is danger of tearing the cartilages loose from the ribs. The Dorsal and Lumbar Spinal Regions. — Here, as in other regions of the body, before an attempt is made to correct the vertebrse the muscles should be thoroughly relaxed. One of the easiest methods to relax the muscles is to have the patient He upon the side, and then by standing in front of the patient and reaching over him with the finger? upon the contracted muscles an upward and outward rotary manipula- tion is given; or the patient may sit upon a stool while the physician stands in front with the arms around the patient and the fingers over the contracted muscles manipulating them upward and outward. Another ver}^ easy method is to stand behind the patient while he sits upon a stool and place a thumb over the contracted fibres, with the other hand under- neath the axilla lifting the shoulder upward and backward so as to favor a relaxation of the muscles, while the thumb manipulates them. In relaxing the muscles of the lumbar region have the patient on the side upon the table; then flex the thighs upon the abdomen with your weight against the knees so as to control all movements of the pa- tient ; reach over the patient with the fingers upon the contracted tissues and manipulate them outward and upward on either side until they are relaxed. A method sometimes employed to relax the muscles of the dorsal, lumbar and sacral regions is to place the patient flat on his face The Practice of Osteopathy 75 upon the table ; then by pushing up on the muscles from above downward with the flat of the hand they are easily relaxed. This treatment should be especially given when the patient's muscles are contracted by atmos- pherical changes and from standing in one position for a long time. When the muscles of the back are contracting they draw downward and many times draw the ribs with them, as well as tensing the tissues over the sacral foramina and obstructing or irritating the sacral nerves. By using the modern table longitudinally relaxing, or stretching, the lumbar and dorsal musculature saves considerable strength and effort of the physi- cian. To correct vertebral lesions of the dorsal region the same rules should be followed as in treating lesions of the cervical vertebrae. Treat- ments may be given with almost equal ease whether the patient is lying on the side or sitting up. To illustrate the treatment of the dorsal region when the patient is lying down, assume that there exists a lateral lesion, combined rotation and sidebending, between two vertebrae ; if the lesion is below the seventh dorsal use the legs as a lever, and if the lesion is above the seventh dorsal use the head and neck as the lever. Have the patient lie upon the side toward which the lesion is pronounced, either reach under the neck or around the limbs with one hand, and with the other hand upon the lesion bend the head and neck or the thighs in such a manner that the angle of the flexion is directly over the break in the spinal column; this is to ex- aggerate the lesion; then by lightly lifting up on the neck or limbs and with a sHght rotation of this lever the flexed parts should be extended, at the same time exerting pressure with the hand over the lesion in such a manner that the vertebra is pushed forward toward its normal position. , Practically, the same treatment is given when a patient is sitting up, with the exception, of course, that the hmbs cannot be used as levers. Lesions of the dorsal region or even the lumbar region can be corrected while the patient is sitting up. By this method considerable lifting is done away with. In fact, the weight of the patient can be used to great advantage by substituting it for one's strength. No matter in what direction the lesion is, the physician reaches around the patient's shoul- ders so that he just holds the weight of the patient from falhng to one side or the other; thus with one hand manipulating the lesion the other arm is around the patient guiding the weight of the body in flexion, rota- tion and extension. It is not always necessary to lift up on the patient but just let the weight of the patient act as strength applied to the power arm. Always make it a point when working upon dislocated vertebrase 76 The Practice of Osteopathy in any region that just as soon as one has obtained a sUght movement in the lesion do not attempt to correct it any more for the time being. A sUght movement toward the right direction may be all that is neces- sary to relieve the ill effects of the lesion. In fact it might be impossible to get the lesion anatomically correct as the shape of the vertebra may have conformed in a greater or less extent to its abnormal position. An excellent method to correct the various combinations of rota- tion and sidebending of the third to ninth dorsals is to have the patient sit up with the physician either sitting or standing, depending upon height of seat, back of the patient. Have the patient lean back until head is supported upon shoulder of physician, and the anterior and posterior mus- culature of torso, abdomen and pelvis are thoroughly relaxed. Reach around the patient's chest with one arm, the hand of which is placed beneath the axilla. The thenar eminence of the other hand is placed upon the posteriorly prominent transverse process of the lesioned seg- ment. Then with careful hyperextension, traction, and rotation and. sidebending of the torso, the anchorage is released, care being taken that localization is exact; this moment of coordination is accom- panied with a thrust of the thenar eminence upon the transverse pro- cess. Relaxation, leverages and thrust must be precise and thoroughly coordinated. To reduce vertebrae that are deviated anteriorly in the dorsal region, especially between the scapulae, is often a hard matter. A satisfactory method is to stand behind the patient, while he is sitting upon a stool, and reach around both sides of him upon the sternal ends of the ribs corresponding to the anterior vertebrae; then have the patient relax with the head upon the chest, and at the same time take a full inhalation while pressm-e is exerted posteriorly upon the sternal ends of the ribs. The object of this method is to pull back the rigid ribs (the lungs being filled with air) which are attached to the anterior surfaces of the transverse processes of the vertebrae, and thus upon the anterior vertebrae pushing them posteriorly; all of the muscles of the body being quite passive and the head rela^^ed on the body, a separation of the verte- brae is accomplished, thus favoring a crow^ling posteriorly of the sub-dis- locatecl vertebrae. To correct vertebrae of the lumbar region is on the whole much easier than in the dorsal region. Here the legs can be used as levers to great advantage. By the same method of flexion, rotation, and ex- tension, as employed in the dorsal region when the patient is lying on the side, the result can generally be obtained. The Practice of Osteopathy 77 Sidebending is the most common single lesion of the lumbar ver- tebrae, though there may be some rotation at the lumbo-sacral juncture. Occasionally malformation is found at the fifth. To correct the lum- bar lesions the following method is often used: place the patient upon the side of the rotation or sidebending with knees flexed, buttocks well back and entire spinal column straight. Next bring torso and head, with spine straight, well forward to edge of table. Then with hand upon ilium tilt it sHghtly forward, and with other hand upon shoulder rotate entire spine, including head, so that spine is locked and the point of locaHzation exactly corresponds to the lesions. This brings the spine back to nearly a straight position. Next, after a moment or two of tension-relaxation, either thrust back upon the shoulder or forward upon the iUum. Again exactly coordinating locahzation, relaxation and lev- erages is the key of the method. The Abdomen. — Direct treatment of the abdomen is given in many diseases of its organs. The patient should lie flat upon the back, the legs flexed upon the thighs and the thighs flexed upon the abdomen, so that the abdominal muscles will be thoroughly relaxed; and then the various organs of the abdomen can usually be manipulated with ease. Remember that in many diseases of the abdominal viscera the treatment of the splanchnics and vagi will be the primary treatment rather than direct abdominal treatments. In treating the liver directly, the ribs over the hver should be raised and separated, and the lower border of the hver manipulated directly, as considerable therapeutic results can be obtained, particularly when the liver is congested and enlarged. Manipulation of the bile ducts is very essential in many hver diseases. The treatment reheves congestion of the ducts and removes any collections of mucus in the ducts due to the congestion, as well as freeing obstructed flow of bile. The manip- ulation should be a deep, downward one, directly over the path of the ducts (from about the cartilage of the ninth rib to the duodenal orifice of the bihary tract, the latter being about one and one-half inches diag- onally downward and to the right of the umbihcus). Be very careful when first manipulating, and bear down lightly over the duct so that the structures superficial to it may be relaxed as the duct is deep below the surface of the abdomen. Usually the gall-gladder can be emptied by light pressure over the skin above the cartilages of the eighth, ninth and tenth ribs. The light manipulation acts, probably, by way of the spinal segment, as a stimulus to the dilators of the sphincters of the gall-bladder. Very likely through reciprocal innervation relaxing the sphincter of the bile duct will contract fibres of the gall bladder. 78 The Practice of Osteopathy Manipulation of the stomach has considerable effect in strength- ening its circular fibres and toaing up the coats in general. In cases of gas formation, the gas in some instances may by manipulating over the stomach, be forced through the cardiac or pyloric orifices. Direct treatment over the spleen by raising the eighth, ninth, tenth and eleventh ribs of the left side is effectual in congestion and enlarge- ment of the organ. In thin subjects the kidneys can be treated directly by pressing down carefully but deeply over the kidneys, and lightly crowding them upward and outward. This treatment also has some effect in reliev- ing contracted tissues about the renal vessels and Iddneys. Treatment to the intestines through the abdomen is an effective treatment. In the various obstructions to the intestines, constipation, etc., the direct work is essential. Treatment of the intestines is to cor- rect any abnormal position that they may have assumed, to relieve con- strictions of the gut caused by contracted tissues, to relieve impactions and adhesions, to increase peristalsis and to tone up the intestinal coats in general. The treatment consists in a manipulation of the intestines, especially in the right and left iliac fossse, and the pelvic colon, ascending colon and duodenum, as impactions and prolapses of the gut are more liable to occur at these points than in any other locality. In manipu- lating the intestines, work for a definite purpose and not give a general kneading treatment unless the walls of the abdomen and the coats of the intestines are weakened ; in the latter case the spinal treatment is the primary one. In treating over the iliac region, draw upward and in- ward on the folds of the gut. It is claimed by some authorities that nerves pass from the cutaneous surface of the abdomen directly to the intestine by way of the peritoneum; if such is the case, manipulation of the abdominal walls would have direct effect upon these nerve fibres. The abdomen may be treated when the patient is sitting up, but the treat- ment is not satisfactory. (See Prolapsed Organs) . The Pelvis. — The treatment of the pelvis is easy, but the difficult work is in making a diagnosis of the position of the pelvic bones. The pelvis is especially apt to become deranged by jars and falls. Seme of the most successful osteopathic results have been obtained in correcting the pelvic region. To relax the muscles over the pelvis, the patient should be on the side or upon the face ; then relax the muscles by manipulating them up- w"a»i'd, chiefly those over the sacral foramina. It is a good rule to adjust the lumbar first owing to release secured to the nerves supplying pelvic The Practice of Osteopathy 79 muscles and also to the fact that many pelvic distortions are secondary or compensatory to lumbar lesions. The easiest method to correct the innominata is to have the patient lie upon his side; then by standing in front of the patient slip one hand bteween the thighs and grasp around the tuberosity of the ischium, aad with the other hand upon the crest of the ihum, the innominatum can be moved upward or downward and forward or backward (wheel and axle principle). Simply pulling or pushing upon these two points in whatever direction necessary is all that is required providing the soft tissues are thoroughly relaxed. By hav- ing the patient flat upon the back practically the same treatment can be given, but not to so great an advantage. In cases where the ilium is posterior and the ischium anterior, the physician may stand back of the patient, while he is lying upon his side, and place one knee against the sacrum and with one hand upon the ilium, with the other take hold of the ankle of the affected side (the involved side being uppermost in all cases where the patient is Ijdng upon his side) ; pressure can be exerted upon the ilium and the limb pulled backward, thus correcting the de- rangement. This treatment should be avoided as much as possible, as there is considerable danger of pulling back too severely and injuring the patient; the lever is long and the amount of force exerted upon it cannot be judged precisely. Another method is, with the patient on the back, flex and evert the knee to the side so the side of the foot lies flat on the table. Grasp the ankle with one hand and with the other on the crest of the ihum of the opposite side then, by pushing down firmly on the knee the articulation is gaped and at the same time the operator pushes with his body against the knee with a sharp thrust. This may have to be repeated a few times before the articulation is released and if one is keen he will easily de- tect the slight concussion carried down the femur as the adjustment takes place. This will correct a forward and downward innominate. For an upward and backward one, place the patient in exactly the same position and go through the same motions except that the knee is pulled toward the operator. If the desired "chug" is not felt and adjustment is not definite, the leg may be pulled down rather smartly by the ankle to a parallel with the other. This is a technique that is easy, both for the patient and operator, and will correct any but the most stubborn. In the case of a greatly relaxed and atonic condition of the ligaments of the. pelvis much trouble is experienced, often, in making the adjust- ment permanent. Many suggestions have been made and most of them useless but, probably the use of a belt of non-elastic webbing about two 80 The Peactice of Osteopathy inches in width buckled tightly around the pelvis just below the anter- ior spines will do as much as anything and is a procedure well to follow in all such cases. Where there is a pendulous abdomen a support in the shape of a simple belt which should be so fitted as to act as a sling will transfer the weight of the abdominal viscera from the muscles, al- read}' stretched and atonic, to the belt and put the burden over the sa- crum. This prevents the pulling of the innominatum in lesion again. Overcorrection is suggested as a means on the ground that it sets up irritation and induces fibrous ankylosis and for the same reason W. W. Howard places his patient prone and with thumb works the ligaments associated with the joint until they are thoroughly inflamed. The pa- tient is then put in bed a few days and after the inflammation has cleared up the ligaments will be found to have shortened. To correct a rotary lesion between the pelvis and fifth lumbar the patient should be placed upon the side, and with the body held firmly, the pelvis can be forced backward or forward as the occasion demands. (See Coccyx). The Legs. — The origin of many symptoms manifested in the legs, as in the arms, are due to spinal lesions corresponding to the region of innervation to the affected tissues. The derangements of the pelvic bones are a frequent source of symptoms that are referred to the legs and feet. The osteopath finds that a shght dislocation of the hip may occur which is especially likely to affect the knee. This partial disloca- tion is apt to be an upward-posterior one; the head of the femur resting in the upper and posterior part of the acetabulum. Many diseases of the legs and feet are due to local displacement of the bones. The meth- od of treatment is the same as given in surgical works. (See Sprains). A general treatment of the legs and thighs is oftentimes necessary; it consists of flexing the thighs quite firmly upon the abdomen, and exe- cuting thorough external and internal rotary movements of the thighs and legs. In a few cases both limbs are flexed strongly at the same time upon the abdomen. After giving these movements manipulation over the saphenous opening and beneath the popliteal space is performed. This genaral treatment teads to increase the circulation of the entire limb and to relax thoroughly all contracted fibres. The Arms. — In treating the arms, care has to be taken that the affection is not due to spinal derangements; otherwise the arms are manip- ulated according to the disorder. Complete dislocations of the shoul- der comes under the province of surgery. Many times the osteopath locates slight or incomplete dislocations of the shoulder. Partial dis- locations of the shoulder are generally anterior. (See Sprains). The Practice of Osteopathy 81 In cases where pain exists in the shoulder or arm, outside of locat- ing the cause in the shoulder joint, the affection may be due to fibres contracting over the coracoid process, or a dislocation of the second or third rib, and in some instances the clavicle is deranged. Special care should be given to a possible bursitis and tendo-synovitis. Occasion- ally muscular fibres may shp out of the bicipital groove. Dislocations of the bones of the arm are treated according to surgical methods. The pains and various troublesome symptoms that may be manifested in the fingers or the hands are oftentimes caused by slight dislocations of the elbow, shoulder, ribs, or vertebrae, as low as the sixth to eighth dor- sals. The coccyx. — The coccyx, owing to its exposed position and rather unstable attachment, is subject to many injuries; more indeed than come to notice. Its injury results in many local and general disturbances owing to its close relation to the sympathetics. Successful treatment of deviations often bring startling results. They may be divided into fractures and displacements. In complete or partial fracture of the coccyx, as well as in dis- location, if the patient can be seen with reasonable promptness after the accident much can be done for relief of the pain and the prognosis is good for complete recovery. Examination should be made externally and internally and after the condition is diagnosed about the same procedure is indicated for any of the conditions. With the patient on the left side introduce the right index finger, well lubricated, into the rectum and carefully relax all tissue within reach of the tip. If there are spasms of the coccygeal muscles, inhibition of the anterior nerves will quiet them. When this has been done place the left index finger externally along the body of the coccj^x and holding it firmly both within and without release it lon- gitudinally and then adjust. After this has been done it is well to hold it there until all danger of returning spasm, which might displace it again, is over, when the finger can be withdrawn. The pain following will depend on the severity of the injury, but will keep up more or less constantly for several days. When severe, re- lief is often given by introducing the finger and relaxing contracted tissue which is pulhng it from its position. Hot water bags placed next to the part will be of benefit. The bowels should be kept confined for forty- eight hours if possible in cases of fracture. Watch carefully the progi-ess of union that the bones are in situ so there will not be deformity. In diagnosing the first injury be sure that there is no splitting of the 82 The Practice of Osteopathy first segment or splinters which may require surgical interference. In old cases of fracture where there is complete bony ankylosis it is not justi- fiable to attempt any change, but where there is motion and a fibrous union, after preparatory treatments about one week apart, it can usually be replaced. Look well to any muscular contractions which might in- terfere with it. Force must never be used nor any attempt to replace until it has been first released from its articular attachment. In the various forms of displacement the same technique applies as in frac- tures, or the finger and thumb of one hand may be used, the tip of the finger internally at the sacro-coccygeal articulation and the thumb ex- ternally at the same point. Complete control of the part is secured in this manner. Great care must always be used in treatment of any dis- placement of the coccyx. Contractions of. its muscular attachments will often cause deviations in contour. Removal of the irritation and re- laxation will allow it to assume its normal position. The sacrum. — Adjustments of the sacrum as distinguished from the ilium in strictly innominate lesions are not many. When posterior with tha patient on a stool the knee of the osteopath coveted by a pillow and placed against the sacrum and both hands grasping the anterior borders of the ilia, strong traction will move it into position. In a down- ward displacement with the aid of an assistant from behind holding the crests of the ilia firmly as the patient sits on the table, the osteopath in front clasping both arms about the patient and with a rocking motion from side disengages the sacrum and at the same time lifts it into posi- tion. For anterior displacements use the technique described in replacing upward and backward innominate dislocation first right side and then left, which will result in correcting the lesion. The preceding osteopathic technique includes a few of the treat- ments given by the osteopath. Although many osteopaths use methods not given here, those outlined are sufficient for illustrative purposes. A point which cannot be too thoroughly impressed upon the student is that osteopathic treatment is in reality constructive work, that is, re- adjustive, not only in detail, but in viewing the body structure as a whole. Detailed readjustment is an essential, still do not lose sight of the re- lation of the part to the whole. In our distinctive work anatomical con- struction is the basis of physiological function, although physiological stimulus is essential to anatomical development. How often to treat. — How often to treat a case depends entirely upon the nature of the disease from which the patient is suffering. Just The Practice of Osteopathy 83 as in giving drugs the frequency of treatment is entirely dependent upon the seat of the disease and its severity. Acute cases require a thorough'^ treatment at least once daily, and many times in severe cases the treat- ment has to be repeated several times daily. In subacute and chronic cases, as a rule, treatment should not be given as often as in acute cases; possibly once a day, but usually alternate days is better. In office prac- tice cases are commonly treated two or three times weekly. Still it is better not to treat some cases oftener than once a week. There is more danger in treating too often and too long than in not treating often enough. The distinctive work of an osteopath is to cor- rect disordered anatomical structures; and when a certain derangement has been corrected the tissues should have rest and plenty of time for repair. When treatments are given often, it simply keeps the tissues in an irritated state and nature does not have time to heal the diseased tis- sues. Always make it a point at each treatment to correct some definite lesion, and when the work is accomplished let the parts alone until the tissues have recovered as much as possible from the effects of the previous treatment before another treatment is attempted. The reason why some cases do not get cured under osteopathic treatment is simply be- cause the osteopath keeps the diseased tissues in an aggravated state by the constant treatment so that they do not have the least chance to heal; the physician is thus adding irritation to the disease. It is only by experience that one can tell how often to treat. Each case is a special study; what would be quite sufficient for a certain indi- vidual with a given disease would not be at all suitable for a second indi- vidual with the same disease. As in drugs what is suitable for one person would not be adapted to another, because the make-up of each individ- ual is entirely different; but here the parallelism diverges, for in drugs there is a foreign agent introduced into the system, while in osteopathic treatment the curative agent is entirely harmonious with the idiosyncra- sies of the individual. It is for this reason that experience in practice is so essential. Most cases should not be treated, as a rule, after a meal unless the patient is suffering from some digestive disturbance ; for treating other regions of the body outside of the digestive tract causes more or less stimulation of the parts treated and thereby draws blood away from the organs of digestion. Cases of disordered brain circulation, where the patient is unable to rest or sleep at night, should be treated at about their retiring time so that the circulation of the body may be equalized, thus giving the patient undisturbed rest. 84 The Practice of Osteopathy To show in a practical way the methods of experienced osteopaths ^in this matter G. J. Helmer^ is quoted: "I submit the following table to illustrate the frequency of treatment in one hundred cases taken from my practice : one case three times per week, sixty-three cases two times per week, twenty-two cases one time per week, nine cases once every two weeks, five cases once every four weeks. Comparing the present with the past, I find I am lengthening the time between treatments with much better results. " Another very practical side of the question and one which will be greatly appreciated by the patient, is the lessened cost for the same re- sult in the less frequent treatments, as well as the saving in time. With the loss in going to the office, rest after treatment, not to mention pos- sible wait while there, three times weekly represents more time than the average person can well spare and not infrequently will deter him from continuing. More especially is this true of those coming from a dis- tance. Length ol Treatment and Overtreatment. — Naturally the length of treatment depends upon the case at issue and nothing more. There is no reason why any two cases should be treated for the same length of time unless they present identical lesions and then the personal equation of the two might present such a wide difference of aspect as to forbid such a proceeding. The question of time has no place in the matter, save that it must not exceed physiological hmits and be sufficient for the needs of the case. The patient should understand at once that it is to accompHsh a spe- cific purpose that the treatment is given, just as definite as a surgical or dental operation, and when the work is done it is time to stop. He would hardly be attracted to the dentist who guaranteed to use forty- five minutes in extracting a tooth. Good judgment is required in this as in all matters pertaining to osteopathy. There is a generally ex- pressed opinion among the older osteopaths, based on experience, that: first, a short specific treatment is productive of best results and, second, treatments given under high tension when quick work is necessary are most satisfactory. Long treatments are debiUtating and over stimula- tion amounts to inhibition. Further, in a long treatment it is necessary to go over the whole body, thus dispersing the vital forces (which have been stimulated for heahng and upbuilding the pathological area) to parts not involved, thus defeating the very purposes intended. Dr. Still always advocated and gave the short, specific treatment. 1. Journal of the American Osteopathic Association, Dec, 1903. The Practice of Osteopathy 85 The point always to be considered is the individual characteristics of the patient, and effects of the first treatment should be carefully ob- served. After a patient has been under treatment for any considerable time it is well to give him a vacation from treatment, and it is remarkable what improvement will be shown at times by such a measure and how seldom he will lose ground. Dr. Still presented this subject vividly as follows: "To treat the spine more than once or twice a week and thereby irritate the spinal cord, will cause the vital assimila- tion to be perverted and become death producing by effecting an ab- sorption of the living molecules of life before they are fully matured and while they are in the cellular system, lying immediately under the lymphatics. If you will allow yourself to think for a moment of the possible irritation of the spinal cord and what effect it will have on the uterus, for example, you will reahze that I have told you a truth. Many of your patients are well six months before they are discharged. They continue treatment because they are weak, and they are weak because you keep them so by irritating the spinal cord. " It is not a rare exper- ience for a patient to leave apparently with httle or no improvement only to report a complete recovery a httle later. Misapplied Treatment. — Probably in spinal treatment more risks are taken than in any other region of the body. To us as a school it is by far the most important and interesting area we have to treat, conse- quently it is not surprising that various general treatments and meth- ods have been devised with the idea of getting quicker and easier results. Herein hes the danger outside of mistaken diagnosis, for short cut treat- ments can never take the place of time and skill. Technically speaking, if one thoroughly understands the philosophy of osteopathy and is con- versant with the underlying principles of its therapeutics, there is ab- solutely no danger of even the slightest injury. It is the one who takes chances by not properly diagnosing and by not being cautious enough with delicate persons when applying his treatments that is apt to over- strain some tissue or organ and otherwise do bodily harm. Of the treat- ments considered dangerous not one of them is without merit if judi- ciously applied, but unfortunately in many cases they are in general and indiscriminate use. It is well to remember that we are moving structures which have never been moved before and that time enough has not elapsed to observe what the ultimate result may be. Again, in adjusting a subluxation of the spine do not forget that the force necessary for that adjustment, if misappUed, is sufficient to produce a lesion, and there is no doubt that this has happened. Your patient's interests are 86 The Practice of Osteopathy above everything and must never be sacrificed for any reason what- ever, so if at any time there is uncertainty always give the patient the benefit of the doubt. On the other hand the osteopath must have the courage of his convictions and fortunately when these are coupled with good judgment the results are all that could be desired. The following should be used with great caution if used at all: First, Indiscriminate stretching of the spinal column with the aid of an assistant. It is not good osteopathy although there are some cases where it may be beneficial. While not specially dangerous, gen- erally, in deUcate patients, elderly people, arterio-sclerotic conditions, and in some stages of Pott's disease it is absolutely contra-indicated. Moreover in most spinal cases except impacted vertebrae and symmet- rical curvatures the stretching of the vertebral Hgaments locks the lesion firmer. Second, Extreme rotating of the cervical region. This cannot be considered good treatment in any case with the exception of the muscle stretching. On the contrary it is dangerous; first, it is not osteopathy for it is not specific; second, the nervous shock is severe, an important consideration in dehcate people; third, the cervical Hgaments become stretched and the vertebrae are easily displaced, while damage to a dis- eased vertebra, an aneurism or in arterio-sclerosis would be irreparable. No other region of the body should have greater care in treatment than the neck. Third, Hyper-extension of the spine with the patient on his face. This treatment is rarely indicated. In fact, it is barbarous and a rehc of an early day. Possibly more cases have been injured by this treat- ment than all others combined. Fourth, Rough separating of the vertebrae and ribs while the pa- tient is on his face. This is a most excellent treatment in many cases, but great judgment is necessary. Delicate patients, heart disease, and necrosed vertebrae and ribs should be carefully excluded. Fifth, Innominate adjustments such as placing the patient on the side and putting the knee against the sacrum while grasping the leg at the knee. Or, the placing of the patient face down with one hand on the sacrum and the other holding the knee. In both these there is a tremendous leverage and in the latter the strain is at the lumbar rather than where needed. There are other unnecessarily risky methods for this operation, while it is easy to perform in most cases and without danger. The Practice of Osteopathy 87 Sixth, Abdominal treatment gives wonderful results when in- telligently applied, but it may be productive of great harm in conditions of tumors, malignancy, and pus formations. Misapplied treatment is alwaj^s dangerous, no matter to what part of the body given, and it is proof of wrong diagnosis when given. As a rule treatment is given without proper diagnosis in such cases, so a mis- appKed treatment has two interpretations — first, ignorance; second, laziness. In the former lies the greater danger for ignorance coupled with force and lack of skill is an appalHng combination. Cases are frequently reported where tumors have passed from the vagina, rectum, nose, etc., the osteopath thinking it was the result of good treatment, without considering that it was simply the breaking of a long pedicle with great danger from hemorrhage. The greatest care should be exercised in treating cases where aneurism, osteomalacia, and arterio-sclerosis are present, also in the leg treatment of tabes dorsahs and in the weak, thin ribs of elderly people and those with a gouty or rheumatic diathesis. Imagine treating an abscess directly, yet it has been done, as have varicose veins with the terrible danger of rupture and embolism. Aneurisms have been ruptured in the same way. One could go on indefinitely with this subject, but to sum up: if the osteopath is not familiar with the feel of the living anatomy in its giving and resisting under treatment both in health and disease and does not know his osteopathy, nothing can prevent him doing harm. A suc- cessful practitioner means an understanding of pathology, then exper- ience plus common sense. The Practice of Osteopathy OSTEOPATHIC CENTERS "Osteopathic spinal centers" was a term commonly used in the early period of osteopathic development. From the facts, first, that a few centers have been actually determined in the cord, viz., genito-urinary, vaso-motor, etc.; second, that the innervation from the spinal segment to various thoracic, abdominal and pelvic viscera correspond with a considerable degree of accuracy to certain vertebral sections, and third, displacements of tissues of the spinal column affect viscus integrity, de- pending upon the locality of the structural perversion as to the organ involved and is a clinical observation of great import, arose the mis- nomer "osteopathic centers." For one to ask what "centers" should be "treated" in this or that disease shows a lack of the conception of os- teopathy as if he asked what "movements" to give when "treating" a certain disorder. It is as unosteopathic, as it is unscientific, broadly speaking, to suppose osteopathic technique implies the application of movements to certain nerve centers. Osteopathic Stimulation "Osteopathic stimulation" is another term loosely used without ex- tensive clinical experience to support it. Mechanical stimulation is fre- quently utilized in the physiological laboratory. But to employ it ex- tensively and comprehensively in the treating room or at the bedside the therapeutic potency of it will be found wanting; that is, to employ it to the exclusion of that most important basic treatment, readjustment, is a great mistake. Chnically, the pathologically slowed heart may be stimulated by a stimulus to the cervical sympathies, the gall-bladder emptied by a stim- ulus near the costal cartilages of the ninth and tenth ribs (this is probably via the spinal segments), etc. Normally, these organs and others may be temporarily stimulated. Experimentally, Burns^ of Los Angeles and Pearce" of San Francisco have shown the potency of osteopathic me- chanical stimulation. For example, stimulation (mechanical) in the middle and lower dorsal regions irritates and increases peristaltic action and vaso-constriction in the stomach and intestines. 1. Burns — Partial Report of Experiments upon Visceral Reflexes. The Os- teopathic World, Aug., 1905. 2. Pearce — Some Laboratory Demonstrations of Osteopatliic Principles. The Osteopathic Physician, Nov., 1905. The Practice of Osteopathy 89 Osteopathic Inhibition Likewise the term "osteopathic inhibition" has not always been scientifically employed. Mechanical inhibition is probably used less frequently than stimulation but still it is of more importance. Prob- ably the true interpretation of considerable of so-termed stimulatory and inhibitory efforts, is simply one of normahzation of tissues, physio logic equihbrium resulting from such changes. CHnically, to relax contracted muscles by inhibition, to relieve neu- ralgia by impinging nerve courses, to relax the cardiac orifice of the stomach by pressure at the ninth or tenth dorsal vertebra on the left side, etc., are excellent examples of the therapeutic value of inhibition. Experimentally Pearce and Burns produced the opposite results to that of stimulation. Inhibition in the middle and lower dorsal region caused relaxation of the muscles of both the stomach and intestines, decreased peristalsis, and caused dilatation of the blood vessels. The employment of stimulation and inhibition rounds out to a certain extent our therapeutics, that is, makes it more practical and spe- cific. We should not, however, over-rate the relative value of stimulatory and inhibitory treatment as compared with the readjustive treatment. Not but what the former is of considerable practical importance, but the point to be emphasized is that it gives a scientific demonstration of how pathological effects result, if long continued, from the various os- teopathic lesions: In a word, it shows the physiological process from cause to effect, or rather a step in the beginning pathological (perverted physiological) in many disturbances. Therapeutically, all will agree with Cherry^ that "stimulation and inhibition should be employed in all forms of acute disease as palliative measm-es until such time as the primary lesion may be removed." As a preparation for adjustment of any bony lesion there is no question but that simple inhibition for a brief time in the area will bring about relaxation of soft tissues in a much more satisfactory manner than the usual massage like method. McPherson, Montreal, has de- veloped a technique of sacral pressure which he uses exclusively in his practice. Without going into the merits of his theory there is no doubt that inhibition at the second and third sacral will bring about relaxa- tion of the muscles of the lower trunk in a most gratifying manner. An- other thing, if there is difficult}^ in introducing the finger in making either 1. Stimulation — Leslie E. Cherry, Journal of the American Osteopathic Asso- ciation, Feb., 1905. 90 The Practice of Osteopathy a vaginal or rectal examination, a minute's pressure at these points will, in most eases, cause the sphincter to relax so as to cause no discom- fort to the patient. This pressure will, also, have a great effect on the hypogastric plexus and the pelvic organs. Osteopathic Readjustment Readjustment or adjustment is many times particularly emphasized in this work as the key to osteopathic therapeutics. If the theory of readjustment can not stand the most searching tests of science osteopathy will have to be relegated to a most subservient place, on a par with massage, Swedish movements, and various medical gj^mnastics. Consequently the readjustment theory is again referred to, and especially so when the subjects of osteopathic centers, stimulation and inhibition are outlined. No doubt many stimulatory (so-called) and general treatments ex- ert their greatest influence by inadvertently readjusting tissues. Then how much more effective would the readjustment treatment be if applied intelligently. In certain acute disorders, e. g., "colds," immediate relief is often obtained by relaxing muscles through either stimulation or inhibition; in reahty the final result, as far as the muscle is concerned, is one of readjustment. Likewise in stretching and rotation of tissues and sections of the body the effect may either be stimulatory or inhibitory, and still it may be, also, readjustive. After all has been said the ultimate physiological effect of anj^ of these treatments, if of any therapeutic value, must be one of stimula- tion to a part or to the body generally. But there is a vast difference between physiological stimulation and the one method of obtaining the same termed mechanical stimulation. It is not the purpose here to enter into anything Hke an exhaustive survey of stimulation and inhibition but simply to outhne a few practical hints on the relative values. Every- one is aware that over-stimulation is equal to inhibition, and even apply- ing it to very deUcate subjects the therapeutic end we may wish to obtain may be lost and as a consequence the patient exhausted; whereas at the same time readjustment possibly could have been employed and real permanent effects secured. So we should whenever possible utihze the basic principle of our therapeutics, readjustment, for tliis represents in the majority of cases, first, permanent results; second, a saving of much time, and third, less exhaustion on the part of both patient and physician. The Practice of Osteopathy 91 McConnell^ has shown in his series of laboratory experiments on animals the reaUty and potency of the readjustment fundamental. The effect of malaHgned vertebrae and ribs upon contiguous vascular chan- nels and nervous tissues, not only affects immediate skeletal muscles by simple contractions but even produces interstitial myositis. Through narrowing of the intervertebral foramina and tension upon the fibrous tissue anchoring the spinal nerve in its exit, and through pressure and strain on the sympathetics in contact with the heads of the ribs, which are secured there by the parietal layer of the pleura, organs in corresponding cavities become diseased. Some of the diseases produced in the series of experiments were catarrhal and parenchymatous changes in the stom- ach and intestines, congestion of the liver and spleen, acute nephritis, goitre, inflammation of the lymphatics, edema of the cornea, and degen- erations of nervous tissues. Still too much emphasis should not be placed upon the narrowing of the foramen for certain pathologic changes are shown to be due to other conditions than Wallerian. The osteopath, as stated, may inadvertently correct osteopathic lesions. Vis medicatrix m(!.z^i^r«' near being entirely relieved, if not absolutely. Sm-gical measures are not always a success. Surgeons are not operating for this disorder so often as in past years. (See Movable Kidney — Diseases of the Kidney.) Liver Prolapse Thi? is commonly termed a floating liver. There is prolapse of the organ as well as its being abnormally movable. It is not of frequent occurrence; women suffer from it much oftener than men. Normally, the liver is partially held in place, in the concavity of the diaphragm, by a number of peritoneal folds. The attachment of these Ugaments is to the spine and the diaphragm; their principal function is to prevent extended lateral movements Of greater importance in supporting the liver in a normal position is the integrity of the abdom- inal walls, and the position of the stomach and intestines. If the abdom- inal walls are of normal tone the liver is very apt to be in correct position. And the rest of the abdominal organs, especially intestines and stomach, act as a cushion support. Often when the liver is displaced the remain- ing abdominal organs are, also, out of normal position and relation to each other; in fact, general prolapse of the abdominal viscera is a frequent cause of Uver prolapse. An additional support of the liver is a certain cohesion of the liver and diaphragm, and the elastic traction of the lungs. Foremost among the causes that predispose to inelastic and atonied abdominal walls are spinal irregularities, deviations, and cm'vatures, which impinge nerve force and obstruct blood supply. These same le- sions weaken ligamentous supports of the liver and lessen tonicity of the other abdominal organs, so that local or general displacements are readily forthcoming. Strains, injuries, frequent pregnancies, etc., also act as causes that weaken the supports of abdominal tissues and organs. In a word it is very often the pendulous abdomen that is the immediate cause of a floating liver. It is very rare to find the liver displaced to the lower region of the abdomen. The ptosis is usually somewhat slight. The organ generally rotates on descent, the right lobe being the lowest portion, owing to the attachment of a ligament, the ligamentum teres, to the umbihcus. Prob- "Bbly in some cases there is a congenital tendency to relaxation of the ligaments, and, thus violent exertions and atonic and flabby abdominal walls and diaphragm are secondary but important factors. The principal symptom of a floating liver is a tumor in the right The Peactice of Osteopathy 139 side, which may be low down. Palpation will usually determine this. Then the abdominal walls are flabby. Pain and bearing down of the right side are common. There is apt to be considerable indigestion. Various reflex symptoms are often present. The floating liver will seem larger than normal, as the liver is below the costal arch and much of it can be felt. Percussion will be of value in determining the extent of the disorder. Much can be accomplished by treatment, especially where the displacement is of a lesser degree. Correcting the spinal lesions, toning up the abdominal walls and diaphragm, and replacing the displaced or- gans will be extremely effectual. The abdominal bandage may be of service. • Certainly abdominal exercises will be beneficial. A point to remember is, stimulation over the abdomen beneath the right costal arch will cause the liver to contract and retract. This is of considerable osteopathic note. The liver will often recede at least a half an inch. This is a liver reflex (Abrams). Prolapsed Intestines Prolapse of the bowels, as a whole, or, more frequent still, of a part, is undoubtedly the most common form of organ prolapse. The intestines are so situated that they readily feel the effect of gravitative influences, of atonic and anemic states, and of weaknesses and disorders of other abdommal organs. Spinal irregularities come first as potent causes of bowel prolapse. The spinal nerves to the supports of the intestines, to the muscular coats of the intestines, and to the abdominal walls, are obstructed in their normal activity, and consequently those tissues to which these nerves are distributed are affected. Wasting diseases, as anemia, consump- tion, cancer and the like predispose to intestinal aton5^ The severe mechanical wrenches, strains, frequent pregnancies, tight lacing, heavy skirts, large abdominal tumors, obesity, cause more or less general or local weakness. The pendulous abdomen, from wrong or careless posture, and ex- clusive of other causes, is a common source of general bowel displace- ment. This form of disorder, besides being unsightly, favors abdominal stoutness. There are a number of instances where simply voluntarily holding or "sucking" the abdomen into place, until it becomes strong enough to support itself, has reduced one's weight by five, ten or fifteen pounds. These were cases where most of the adipose tissue was about the abdomen. Thus exercising and toning the abdominal organs by 140 The Practice of Osteopathy keeping them in normal position rectified a dormant blood and lymph circulation, which was followed by absorption of the abdominal stout- ness. Congenital weaknesses are to be considered in many cases. The muscular ligaments may not be developed, the mesenteric attachments may be too long, and various other abnormalities may result from con- genital disturbances. Of particular local interest to the osteopth, outside of the bowels dislocating as a whole, are: first, the hepatic flexure; second, the ileo- cecal region; third, the sigmoid flexure; fourth, the rectum; and fifth, hernias. Each of these sections are of separate interest and will be con- sidered presently. The symptoms are extremely variable. Constipation, a feeling of discomfort in the bowels, nervousness, depression, lassitude and anem- ia are frequent. CoHcky pains in the intestines, indigestion, hysteria at times, are also among the symptoms. In reality a great variety of symptoms may be present. The patient is likely to be emaciated. In some cases exhaustion is marked. Diagnosis, as a rule, is not a difficult matter. The various neuras- thenic symptoms in a lean patient with constipation, indigestion, and stomach and intestinal distress would lead one to suspect intestinal dis- placement. The outline or contour of the abdomen will often reveal the character of the trouble. The atonic, thin and relaxed walls of the abdomen may readily give view of the displaced organs. Then careful examination by palpation and percussion will help very materially in the diagnosis. Radiographic examination is a decidedly helpful diag- nostic method. The liepatic flexure is frequently prolapsed. The bowel (colon) ascends from below upward to beneath the costal arch and then angles sharply into the transverse colon, which extends directly across the ab- domen to the left side. The ligaments that support this flexure are apt to become weakened or stretched and allow a descent of this section of the bowel, which is followed by constipation, indigestion, etc. The ligament especiall}' involved is the colo-hepatic ligament. The duo- denum may require attention. This can be raised by getting beneath it where the organ descends alongside of the ascending colon. The effect of treatment is to release tension of the duodeno-hepatic ligament which is closely associated with the portal vein, hepatic artery and bile-duct. The ileo-cecal region is an area that readily becomes congested and catarrhally inflamed, especially from constipation or impaction The Practice op Osteopathy 141 at this point. The section often becomes atonic and prolapsed with resultant clogging of fecal matter. Owing to the close proximity of the vermiform appendix, appendicitis frequently results from the above condition. The osteopath can do much in these cases of appendicitis. Lesions are invariably found in the lumbar vertebrae or the floating ribs are depressed. The sigmoid flexure is also frequently prolapsed. The fecal mass often becomes impacted here, owing to a setthng or prolapse of this part. In some cases the prolapse is so marked that it extends to the rectum below and drags on the splenic flexure above. Lumbar and innominate lesions are the usual causes, although, it seems in a number of instances, that relaxed walls of the abdomen cause a "contraction of the diaphragm resulting in kidney displacement and followed by intestinal prolapse." The vertebral lesions, probably, first weaken the muscular coat of the bowel, then, second, the bowel sup- ports (other than its own inherent tonicity) and the abdominal walls. Prolapse of the rectum is of such separate importance that it will be but partly outhned here. As stated above, a source of rectal dis- placement arises from the section of the bowel above settling downward and ultimately causing invagination of one or more coats of the rectum. Dislocation of the coccyx is a potent cause of rectal disorders. Lumbar lesions, especially twists between the fourth and fifth, and fifth and sacrum are common causes of rectal weaknesses. Slips of the innominata are other causes of prolapse. Osteopathy has had marked success in these cases. Cures may re- sult from a single treatment to readjust the coccygeal displacement or temporarily reheve excessive physiological activity by dilating the rec- tal sphincter, or the treatment may demand a number of months' work in correcting general abdominal prolapse. Raising the sigmoid is ef- fectual. A hernia is "the protrusion of a loop or knuckle of an organ or tissue through an abdominal opening." Two of the common hernias of the intestines are inguinal and femoral. These conditions are most often acquired from severe straining, so that a loop of the bowel protrudes through a weakened and stretched area of the abdominal walls, though there is reason to suspect that congenital defects are often predisposing factors. Mention of the hernia is here made because, in a way, it is a form of bowel prolapse; that is, a limited form, and osteopathy contains certain possibilities for a successful treatment. Hernia has always been looked 142 The Peactice of Osteopathy upon as purely a surgical disorder; i. e., remediable by surgical measures only. Where a truss has failed to give relief surgery has been resorted to. This is true in most instances, but where the hernia is in the incip- iency careful abdominal exercises (this should be carried out with great care, for severe exercise may produce a hernia or increase one already existing), massage to the tissues about the hernia, attention to the bow- els, and spinal stimulation corresponding to the weakened tissue, and avoidance of strains may strengthen the tissues materially about the hernia. Occasionally a loop of the intestine will prolapse into the cul-de-sac back of the uterus. A heavy dragging pain low down in the center of the abdomen and constipation or complete obstruction are the pro- nounced symptoms. Careful lifting of the loop of bowel by pressure within the vagina and traction from above with a hand outside, with the patient, on her back, with buttocks elevated, gives speedy relief. The treatment of the prolapsed bowels represents those measures that will replace and keep in position the displaced organs. Naturally, the spinal and abdominal treatment comes first; this strengthens intes- tinal ligaments, tones intestinal muscles, and contracts the abdominal parietes, and at the same time the bowels are regulated, digestion and nutrition improved, and the general health built up. In some cases abdominal supporters will be of value. In a number of instances at- tention to chest mobility and diaphragm tonicity will be of value. Right living, which is represented by proper diet, sufficient outdoor exercise and regular habits, is invaluable. The really specific treatment is to correct spinal, rib and innominate deviations and abnormahties. But direct local work wiU be, in many instances, necessary. General abdominal manipulation is good, but this should be supplemented by careful local treatment. The hepatic flexure requires a direct stimulating and replacing treatment. The ileo-cecal section should be raised, stimulated and emptied of the fecal mass. Direct upward manipulation of the sigmoid flexure in the left ihac fossa and of the splenic flexure beneath the left costal arch is ex- tremely efficacious. Care must be taken not to bruise the parts. Get- ting beneath the prolapsed area and gently and intelligently raising the bowel so that it is emptied, toned up, and vascular congestion relieved, are the indications. This requires careful work and the necessity of gentleness can not be emphasized too much. Still in all of this treat- ment we should never forget the absolutely essential spinal readjust- ment. The Practice of Osteopathy 143 Rectal prolapse requires lacol internal treatment, external tissue correction, especially of the coccyx, an innominatum or the lumbar spine, and, of much importance, deep, careful and thorough work over the sigmoid section. Cases of bowel prolapse are every day experiences with the osteo- path. The osteopathic treatment is of great value in these and a suc- cessful issue is very often the result. Cases of pendulous abdomen, of ■obstinate constipation, of chronic indigestion, of many nutritional dis- orders, of feehng pain, weight or dragging, locally or generally, in the abdomen, are very apt to be in persons suffering from prolapsed intestines. A number of cases of bowel prolapse are associated with general prolapse of abdominal organs ; that is, displacement of the stomach, kid- neys, liver, spleen, etc. This general condition is termed enteroptosis or Glenard's disease. It usually requires several months to treat it successfully. These patients are neurasthenic, mal-nourished, and often bysteriacs. The symptoms from which they suffer are innumerable. Mechanical weaknesses, lowered vitaUty, poor innervation and blood supply, and auto-intoxication are causative factors. The Prolapsed Uterus Prolapse of the uterus is of common occurrence. The prolapse may be incomplete or complete; the latter when the organ is presented to the external world. Of special interest are those affections exclusive of surgical cases. Ptosis of the abdominal organs upon the pelvic organs is a common cause of uterine prolapse. The abdominal prolapse crowds uterine space, congests the uterus, weakens the ligaments, and drives the uterus downward as a wedge. Lumbar spinal curvatures are frequent causes of prolapse, as well as other displacements of the uterus. In this region vasomotor nerves to the pelvic organs make their exit, and, consequently congestions, in- flammations, and weaknesses of supports are results. Also, slips of the innominata disturb the pelvic circulatory balance. Weakness of the uterine support from below, the vaginal walls and perineum, most often arises from lacerations at child-birth. Still, the vaginal walls may be- <3ome relaxed through other causes. Tumors and extreme congestions are causes of prolapse. Heavy Ufting is quite a frequent source of uterine displacements. Osteopathy is very successful in uterine prolapses; that is, any displacement of the uterus not of a surgical character. Cor- rection of the external causes comes first. Then local treatment to re- place, tone, and relieve congestion, and break up adhesions is necessary. 144 The Practice of Osteopathy The external treatment is usually the primary treatment. Local work is not always necessary. Lacerations and other surgical indications, of course, require surgery. Ovarian Displacements The ovaries may be prolapsed, the left much oftener than the right. When prolapsed, it drops backward, downward and inward. Ovarian congestion, tumor, retroverted or retrofiexed uterus, tubal disease, and pregnancy are among the principal causes. Back of these congestions, tumors and uterine displacements, are the osteopathic causes, particularly spinal and rib lesions from the ninth dorsal downward. Specific lesions at the ninth and tenth dorsals and corresponding ribs, affecting directly ovarian tissues, and lumbar and innominate lesions and abdominal prolapse disturbing uterine and tubal tissues, are the most frequent osteopathic causes. A retroverted or retrofiexed uterus is often found. Uterine displacements bear down upon the ovary and cause its descent, and also disturb ovarian circulation. As has been stated, the left ovary is more apt to be displaced than the right. This is owing to the absence of a valve in the ovarian vein on the left side, and also, this vein opens at a right angle into the renal vein; this anatomical feature easily leads to passive congestion of the ovary, and thus to diseases of the organ. Then the rectum is on the left side and large fecal masses are apt to crowd against the ovary, which tends to its displacement. Thus it is readily seen that osteopathic treatment is very appUcable to ovarian displacement unless the indications are surgical. A more or less constant burning or sharp pain in the ovarian region, with probably some feeling of weight, profuse and painful menstruation, depression, irritability, etc., are diagnostic. However, a local examination will reveal the status of the ovarian position and congestion. The same treatment as in other organ prolapse is indicated; ton- ing weakened tissues, relieving congestions, replacing organ, with careful attention to the bowels and the general health. There are no tissue disorders of any part of the body wherein osteopath}^ is more thoroughly indicated and the results more generally satisfactory than in prolapse. And especially should it be remembered that in prolapse of various or- gans m.any vague intestinal and pelvic disorders and even ureteral and bladder disturbances may be traced to bowel dislocations and excessive kidney mol^ility in which osteopathic measures are often successful. Conclusion. — The purpose of this section on Prolapsed Organs has been to supplement the various articles on Dilatation of the Stomach, The Practice of Osteopaths 145 Movable Kidney, etc., with an outline that may include relaxation of a part or of the whole of the abdominal viscera. The physician is all too prone to simply note the most offending or conspicuously disturbed or- gan instead of carefully analyzing all the features, great and trivial, that may be either apparent or marked. A general relaxation of the abdom- inal and pelvic organs may be found, and a nearly complete restoration take place under treatment, but still a lacerated perineum may have to be repaired before a cure is completed. Or it may be in a general ab- dominal ptosis that a floating kidney will resist all measures for restora- tion, short of surgery, and before much improvement can be obtained the kidney will have to be stitched into place. An enlarged liver may crowd the kidney out of place or a transverse colon may prolapse and drag on contiguous tissues and still the annoying symptoms be referred elsewhere. Then the primal point of general relaxation may not be in one organ, but there may be a simultaneous displacement of several. The thorax itself may be distorted from various diseases so that the chest is narrowed, the diaphragm displaced with consequent descension of the abdominal organs, and from the latter a displacement of the pelvic. "Far down displacement, marked changes of form, and real dis- figurements of the stomach are found in some cases of kyphosis and scolio-kyphosis. "^ The osteopath will not only find this true in some cases, but in many cases, although he recognizes as causative factors injuries to the spine causing curvatures and postural defects as prolific sources of abdominal relaxation. "Glenard's whole theory of splanchnoptosia is based on the relaxa- tion of the suspensory ligaments of the intestines, especially that of the transverse colon; and Stiller, the discoverer of the floating tenth rib, says that splanchnoptosia is a descent of the atonic stomach, of the colon (especially the transverse portion), of the kidney (the right or both kidneys), exceptionally of the liver or the spleen. A descent which has been developed mostly in tender age, in consequence of general relaxa- tion, especially of the peritoneal suspensory ligaments in individuals with congenital general dyspeptic neurasthenia, tender muscles, lean habit, and slender bone structure, manifested in a higher degree by a floating tenth rib." Stiller observed that when there is a floating tenth rib there is a displaced stomach and a floating kidney, although it is not found in every case, but never missing if the case is pronounced. The tenth ribs in these cases have only a ligamentous fastening and are as freely movable as the eleventh and twelfth. 1. Rose and Kemp — Atonia Gastricia. 146 The Practice of Osteopathy That abdominal relaxation plays a very important part in many diseases of the abdominal and pelvic organs, in cardiac and pulmonary affections, disturbs the circulation in the legs, and is the source of many reflex affections no one can gainsay. The osteopath should always pay particular attention to tonic condition of the abdominal viscera, for re- laxation of the suspensory tissues and walls, and atony and sluggishness of the organs are frequently paramount etiological factors. And the osteopathic treatment is the remedy par excellence. The Peactice of Osteopathy 147 SKIN DISEASES Various skin diseases have been treated osteopathically with vary- ing success. So much depends upon the cause of the disturbance and its removal, in skin diseases, that the cure does not rest so much with the mere treatment, as with the necessary skill in locating the disturb- ing factor. One has to be continually on his guard to locate external irritations and disorders of the digestive and genito-urinary tracts. A great deal depends upon the avoidance of external influences; eating nutri- tious food and having an unobstructed circulation. The leading object of osteopathic treatment is to free the circulation and thus promote a healthy and unobstructed flow of blood; in no other class of diseases is this more essential than in skin diseases. After "the removal of cutaneous irrita- tions and the correction of internal disorders, the cure of the case de- pends upon the removal of constrictions to the cutaneous blood-vessels. The osteopath corrects the lesions found, relaxes the muscles thoroughly and stimulates the circulation to the parts involved, and promotes a healthy activity of all the excretory organs. When the upper part of the body is affected, lesions are generaUy found at the atlas and axis, and when the lower part of the body is affected, lesions at the fifth lum- bar are of common occurrence, although lesions may be located at var- ious points corresponding with the seat of disturbance. The constant use of hot baths will be found a helpful measure in many skin diseases. But use of soap must be considered as too much alkali will neutrahze the oil of the skin and cause undue dryness, but bran may be substituted to advantage. CleanHness is necessary but the result sought is, also, flushing the cutaneous vessels. There are many cases where a specific vertebral lesion will cause, through the peripheral nerves, a cutaneous irritation with intense itching and discomfort. This, in turn, produces an exudate with or without a crust and a condition results which is not amenable to any local or constitutional treatment but an adjustment of the lesion will in most cases bring immediate relief. Application of this principle will aid greatly in treatment of any skin disease. In no disturbance of health is it more necessary to find the cause than in skin disease and once found to apply specific treatment. Eczema is frequently met in osteopathic practice. It is the most common form of skin disease, comprising nearly one-third of all these disorders. For a differential diagnosis of the several varieties the student is referred to special texts. It is well to remember that the same under- lying causes may be basic to the various forms, for several varieties may 148 The Practice of Osteopathy occur at the same time or one variety pass into another, though commonly one form is more prevalent. The limbs, face and genitalia are the most common sites, though the eruption may occur on various parts of the body. Etiology includes a number of factors, constitutional and local. Dietetic errors, indigestion and faulty ehmination comprise the prin- cipal underlying causes, often manifested through absorption of toxins and leucomains. In fact any disorder of the abdominal viscera, organic or functional, may be a predisposing factor, likewise various disorders of the pelvis, tuberculosis, diabetes, anemia, etc. should be considered. So-called gouty and rheumatic tendencies may be the constitutional basis. The many osteopathic lesions plaj^ a very important role in lower- ing not only systemic resistance but of local tissue as well. This feature can not be over-emphasized. Then local irritants, mechanical, chemical and thermal, are not to be neglected. These are usually of secondary importance. Micro- organisms are probably a complicating factor after the lowered resist- ance has been estabhshed. Vasomotor neurosis, through constitutional defects, toxins and the very significant osteopathic lesion, is probably an essential part of the pathogenesis. Treatment is usually successful if the various etiologic factors are eradicated. Early treatment is very important. If the disorder is of more than local significance change the entire daily regimen of the patient. Diet, out-door exercise and sufficient sleep should be definitely regulated. A certain amount of general treatment to improve diges- tion, assimilation and ehmination is imperative. An unbalanced diet and over eating must be corrected. In certain moist types, eliminating fatty foods will be helpful, while in dry forms the starches and sugars should be reduced. If there is an underlying disease this should be remedied if possible. Particular attention should be paid to constipation. Common sense in diet, rest, change of environment and free elimi- nation, coupled with due attention to the osteopathic lesions, will cure the vast majority of cases. The greatest difficulty arises where there is some underlying disease. The parts should be protected against irri- tation such as dirt, cold, soap, and too much water. Meddlesome local treatment is to be guarded against. A simple application is boric acid, rice-flour or corn-starch, or where there is much itching add carbolic acid to the saturated solution of boric acid. Substitute bran for soap for cleansing purposes. The Practice of Osteopathy 149 Herpes Simplex, fever-blister, or ''cold sore" comprise two prin- cipal varieties: herpes facialis and herpes genitalis. The first occurs upon or near the lips, face, neck or ears. When the herpes is on the tongue or the mucous membrane within the mouth it is commonly termed " canker sores. " Herpes genitalis is located on the prepuce, glans penis or farther back upon the penis. In the female the labia majora and minora and vestibule are the usual locations. Lack of cleanhness, sexual excitement and adherent prepuce are causative factors, though predisposing factors such as faulty circulation and disturbed innervation are to be consid- ered. In "cold sores" there is often some gastro-intestinal disturbance, especially intestinal stasis, cold in the head and other infections that supply toxins which irritate the nerves. No doubt there are under- lying osteopathic lesions that lower the local nerve resistance or block the impulses such as vertebral and inferior maxillary lesions. The pre- disposing disturbance is probably due to the Gasserian ganghon. Cold winds and excessive exposure to the sun's rays will effect the tissues over the mental and infraorbital foramina, tensing the muscles and irritating the nerves at these points. On palpation they will be found sensitive. Frequent rotary motion by tip cf finger over foramina will open them and allow congestion to drain. Herpes Zoster, or shingles, is an acute inflammatory disease char- acterized by groups of small vesicles, usually along the course of the inter- costal nerves on one side of the body. Before the vesicles appear there is more or less severe neuralgia. The eruption is unilateral, very rarely bilateral. The nearby lymphatics are usually enlarged. Though the intercostal nerves are the ones most frequently involved, still the lumbar, thigh, trifacial and other cutaneous nerves may be affected. The most common lesion is an inflammation of the posterior spinal ganglion which usually involves the fibers of the entire nerve. Inflamma- tion of the nerve outside of the ganghon will cause the disorder. Toxins from various infectious sources are often exciting causes. Vertebral and rib lesions are always found; and where the Gasserian ganghon is involved lesions of the inferior maxilla and upper cervical vertebriB are predisposing factors. Thus osteopathic lesions from traumatism, cold and wet, and imbalance of muscular tension are important. Ex- udates, tumors, pleuritic and pulmonary affections are to be consid- ered as possible sources. 150 The Practice of Osteopathy Treatment. — Adjust vertebral lesions and carefully raise and separate ribs if intercostals are affected. Look after vertebral origin of any other nerve or nerves if otherwise. Local application of talcum or starch or boric acid will generally be sufficient. Urticaria, hives or nettle rash is a common affection often due to some derangement of the digestive tract. This may be a mechanical irritation or of a toxic nature. Every one is familiar with the various foods that are apt to cause the hives, shell fish, strawberries, cheese, pork, oatmeal, mushrooms, etc. The irritation may be a reflex one from the visceral disturbance; also, there may be irritation of the pelvic organs that would give rise to the trouble. It is well known that certain drugs will produce urticarial eruptions. There are cases where the irritation is simply local due to the nettle, mosquito bites and wasp stings. In chronic cases intestinal stasis, nervous exhaustion and nephritic diseases are important. No doubt osteopathic lesions frequently determine the location of the wheals. These lesions affect the innervation and thus estabfish a basis for the reflex vasomotor effect. This is in the nature of spasm of the cutaneous vessels quickly followed by dilatation with exudation of serum. The irritant probably acts on the walls of the blood vessels. Treatment consists of thoroughly emptying the bowels by warm water enema, correcting the diet, toning the viscera and adjusting the osteopathic lesions. Thorough attention to the patient's environment, daily habits and occupation are of value. Warm soda baths will relieve the itching. Acne is a common skin disorder that is characterized by an inflam- mation of the sebaceous glands of the nature of papules, tubercles or pustules. The face, shoulders, chest and back are the regions usually involved. It generally, appears about puberty. Blackheads is the starting point; these are accompanied with greasy sldn and dust, and influenced by micro-organisms and more or less intestinal disorder. The general or systemic health no doubt affects the local disorder, as in many skin diseases; for various intestinal derangements as indi- gestion, constipation, etc.; pelvic and menstrual irregularities; general ill health; anemia, etc. affect circulatory, glandular and nervous integ- rity. Any disturbance of normal elimination is important. The treatment consists of careful attention to the general health and to the local innervation of the face or region involved. Measures that tone the bodily organs such as outdoor fife, regular habits, plenty of sleep and correct diet are important. In some cases the X-ray is of value. The Practice of Osteopathy 151 ANIMAL PARASITES Tape Worms Varieties. — Taenia solium; taenia saginata; bothriocephalus latus. The larvae of tape worms are introduced into the intestinal canal by food and drink. The parasite reaches adult growth in the intestines. The larval forms are then found again in the muscles and solid organs. Taenia Solium. — This is derived from the hog, and is the most common form in this country. When mature it is from two to four yards in length. The head is small, about the size of a pin, and pro- vided with four cup-hke suckers surrounded by a double row of hook- lets, hence it is called the armed tape-worm. The head is fastened to the body by a thread-Hke neck, and following the neck, the body occurs in segments. The sexual organs, both male and female, occur in the center of the broad surface of the segment. The segments are about one milUmeter in length and seven or eight miUimeters in breadth. There are thousands of ova in each mature segment. The worm attams its growth in about twelve to fifteen weeks, after which time the segments are shed and passed. For further development the ova must gain en- trance to the stomach of a pig or of man, and passing from the stom- ach they may reach the muscles and organs and develop into larvae or cysticerci. Taenia Saginata. — This is derived from beef, and is much longer and larger than the taenia solium. It is from five to six yards in length; the head is over two millimeters in breadth, is square shaped, and has four large sucking discs, without booklets; hence it is called the unarmed tape-worm, in contradistinction to the hooked variety. The segments are thicker and the ova larger, and they are passed and ingested in the same manner as the taenia soHum. Bothriocephalus Latus.— This is found especially in Europe and is very long, measuring from eight to ten yards; it is derived from fish, is not provided with booklets, but has two lateral grooves. The segments are short and wide, the sexual organs being on the narrow side of the segment. Etiology. — Unhealthy condition of the stomach and intestines is the predisposing, and uncleanhness an important, factor in the occur- rence of tape-worm. Those eating imperfectly cooked beef, pork, fish or other meats, and those handling fresh meats, are liable to be affected with tape-worm. 152 The Practice of Osteopathy When the ovum is taken into the stomach the capsule is dissolved and the embryo passes into the small intestines, fastening itself into the mucous membrane, by its booklets and suckers and grooves. Symptoms.— Tape-worms occur in the human being at all ageS- Oftentimes s^-mptoms are absent, the expulsion of segments being noticed and thus the worms accidentally discovered. The tape-worm is seldom dangerous, but if a worm is known to exist it is always a source of con- siderable anxiety on the part of the patient. Severe anemia may re- sult and be wrongly diagnosed. There are dyspeptic symptoms, coUcky pains, nausea and occasion- ally diarrhea. The appetite is variable, sometimes ravenous. This condition is followed by loss of flesh and various reflex phenomena, as vertigo, headache, convulsions, palpitation, choreic movements, itching of the nose and anus, paralysis, and rarely, insanity. In addition to these symptoms there may be a wrinkled countenance, sensation of a cold stream winding itself toward the back immediately after a meal, pain in various parts of the body and ringing in the ears. The decisive diagnostic symptom is to find segments of the worm in the stools. Diagnosis. — Discovery of the ova or segments in the passages of the bowels is the only proof of the presence of a tape- worm. Prognosis. — Favorable in all cases. Treatment. — Prophylactic treatment is necessary. Meats should be thoroughly cooked so that the larvae will be destroyed; and all seg- ments of tape-worms passed in the stools should be burned — by no means should they be thrown outside or in the water-closet. The immediate expulsion of a tape-worm is not a necessity. First of all the mode of living, and then the general state of health should be corrected. Tape-worms invariably result from a general state of un- healthiness, and with improved health and corrected digestive processes the worms cannot exist, and in a short time will be expelled. Expulsion of the head is necessary before the case will be cured, for if the head is not expelled new segments will continue to grow. Stimulating the liver to increase the amount of bile, and increasing the activity of the digestive glands of the stomach and intestines, by a thorough treatment of the splanchnic region and direct treatment over the abdomen, will usually be sufficient for the cure of intestinal para- sites. The treatment will probably have to be repeated several times, in order that the intestines may regain a healthy tone, so that the para- site will not find favorable conditions for its existence within the intes- The Practice of Osteopathy 153 tmes, and that the bile may be secreted in sufficient quantities to dis- lodge the worm. Hahnemann claimed, "that during a period of comparative health tape-worms do not inhabit the intestines proper, but rather the remnants of food and fecal matter contained in the intestines, living quietly as in a world of their own without the least inconvenience to the patient and finding their sustenance in the contents of the bowels. During this state they do not come in contact with intestinal walls, and remain harmless. But when from any cause a person is attacked by an acute disease the contents of the bowels become offensive to the parasite, which in its writhing and distress touches and irritates the sensitive intestinal lining, thus increasing the complaints of the patient considerably by a peculiar kind of cramp-like colic. (In similar manner the human foetus in the womb becomes restless, twists its body and moves whenever the mother is sick, but floats quietly in the hquor amnii, without distressing . Tier while she is well.) " This but harmonizes with the osteopathic theory and practice with regard to tape-worm, that there is an unhealthy condition of the intestines which predisposes to the affection, and con- sequently the cure must be a correction of such a disordered state. During the treatment, if a light diet of milk and broths is given, it will favor an earher removal of the parasite, by helping to remove the mucus in which the head is embedded. If this fails extract of male fern is suggested. Ascaris Lumbricoides (Round Worm) This is the most common parasite, and is found principally in chil- dren; it is also found in cattle and hogs. It is of a yellowish brown color and in form resembles earth worms. The worm is cyhndrical, pointed at both ends; the female is from seven to twelve inches in length, and the male from four to eight inches. They are probably introduced into the stomach by food and drink. They occupy the upper part of the small intestine, and are usually one or two in number, though they may be numerous. Occasionally they migrate into the stomach and are ejected by vomiting, or into the trachea and produce suffocation, or into the larynx or Eustachian tube, or they may pass downward to the anus, or into the l)ilc ducts. Symptoms. — Oftentimes symptoms are absent. There may be dyspepsia, colicky pains, mucous stools, meteorism, vertigo, fretful- ness, voracious appetite, anemia, sallow complexion, headache, chorea and convulsions. Other symptoms may be present, as grinding of the 154 The Practice of Osteopathy teeth and itching of the nose and anus. Obstruction of the bowels has occurred. If a worm enters the bile duct obstructive jaundice occurs. A decisive diagnosis can be given only when the worm is seen. Treatment. — Particular attention should be paid the liver, for it is here that we must seek the natural remedy in the form of bile, in order to eject and cleanse the system from nematodes. Modes of improper living should be corrected ; cleanUness is essential, and there should be attention to the general health of the patient. Thor- ough correction of all defects of the spinal column in the region of the splanchnics, and careful direct treatment of the bowels is indicated. The child may be put to bed and fasted twenty-four hours, then the liver strongly stimulated to increase flow of bile. If the above treatment is not successful oil of wormwood may be employed. Oxyuris Vermicularls (Thread-worm ; Pin- worm) This small parasite, commonly seen in children, is from three to five millimeters long in the male and about twenty millimeters in the female, is blunt at one end and sharp at the other, and occupies the colon and rectum. They are probably introduced into the intestines in the ova, by uncooked fruits and vegetables, or by the dirty hands of mothers and nurses of the infants. They vary greatly in number; migrate to the rectum where they deposit their eggs, and are often discharged in the feces, where they appear like pieces of ordinary white thread. Symptoms. — Loss of appetite, anemia, restlessness and irritability are marked. The itching becomes intolerable when the worms come down in the rectum to the anus and within the folds about the anal orifice. In the female the worms maj^ wander into the vagina where they become particularly distressing, and thus may produce excessive sexual excitement and cause nymphomania and masturbation. Treatment. — Cleanhness of the most scrupulous kind should be demanded in every instance. Injections of cold salt water (repeated for at least ten days) and other agents within the rectum will destroy the eggs as soon as they are deposited, besides reheving the terrible itching. In obstinate cases use quassia decoction. Attention to the general health of the patient and great care of the intestines and other digestive organs are absolutely necessary. The spinal treatment to the intestines and other digestive organs, as well as thorough direct treatment over the abdomen, is indicated. The Practice of Osteopathy 155 Uncinariasis European hook-worm disease ; Miner's anemia; Ankylostomiasis; Hook- worm disease) This disease results from infection by the hook-worm of any of the various types. In Europe it is found in Italy, Belgium, Germany, France and Switzerland. In America it seems to be of Africo-Asiatic origin but was first discovered in the Southern states and abounds chiefly in Texas, Florida, Georgia, North and South Carolina as well as in the West Indies. Infection comes from unprotected feces that are allowed to be spread where the feet or hands may come in contact as it is without doubt that the contagion occurs through the skin. One au- thority states that hook-worm is rarely found except in cases where ground itch has occurred within a period of eight years. Negroes har- bor the parasite and transmit it but seem immune to its effects while the poorer whites are afflicted to a large degree. The worms are carried from some abrasion of the skin, by the blood to the heart and lungs, thence to the pharynx and swallowed, thence to the duodenum and jejunum where they attach themselves to the lining walls. Here they not only feed upon the blood but develop a toxin. The female worm is about twice the size of the male, 10 to 18 mm. as against 6 to 11 mm. and there is slight difference between the old and new world varieties. The head is provided with four hook shaped teeth which form the attachment to the intestine arid it is very secure. Diagnosis. — For years the languid, dull, expressionless, lack-luster of eye and general unambitious characteristics of the inhabitants of the great sand belt of the United States attracted attention and was at- tributed to laziness but the discovery of the hook-worm explained the cause. Children are stunted in mind and body and have a muddy, dirty white complexion. At the beginning there must be a very considerable colony of the parasites to cause symptoms but as the disease advances there is a dis- tention of the abdomen from enlargement of the spleen and liver and from flatulency. There is palpitation, shortness of breath, cardiac bruits from the severe anemia while edema of the feet and legs is rather common. The blood shows a severe secondary anemia with its coagu- lation time much increased. Leucocytosis is not common; hemoglobin is from one-tenth to one-half normal with erythrocytes about half nor- mal. Treatment. — The removal of the worms with the least possible 156 The Practice of Osteopathy harm to the body is indicated. Thymol is a poison which is not ab- sorbed by the body, when carefully given, and which is very toxic to the parasite. The dose varies from eight grains for a child under five years of age, to forty-five for an adult. Thymol is soluble in fats and in alcohol, so that for a day or so before the thymol is given, and from one to four days after, no fats or alcohol should be taken. The best way to avoid poisoning by thymol is to give the patient charcoal, then no fats or alcohol is permitted until the treatment is completed. When the stools become black, the thjanol is given on an empty stomach. A purgative is given a few hours later. Enemas should be used very freely in order to faciUtate the removal of the injured or poisoned worms. An- other dose of charcoal is given, and when the stools are black again, the patient ma}^ return to his ordinary diet. The denial of fats to. the per- son so thoroughly accustomed to bacon three times a day is a factor met with difficulty in dealing with patients of the ordinary class with the disease. (CHnical Osteopathy.) Prophylaxis. — After treatment it is imperative to prevent re- infection and to do that the most rigorous sanitary measures must be instituted. All feces must be disposed of and habits of cleanliness in defecation insisted upon while negroes, who harbor the worm without showing symptoms, must be looked after as well as the actual victims. Care of the feet is important and shoes should be worn in infected regions and all abrasions of the skin protected. Drinking water must be un- contaminated which presents a problem as wells and springs are usually unprotected. Absolute and persistent cleanhness is the answer to the question of prevention. Trichiniasis Trichiniasis is a name given to a disease produced by the embryos of the trichina spiralis. In the adult condition the trichina spiraUs lives in the small intestines. The embryos migrate into the muscles where they finally become encapsulated. Man is infected by eating insufficiently cooked pork containing the encapsulated worm, which is set free during the digestive process. About the third day they attain their full growth and become sexually mature. Each one discharges large numbers of embryos. As soon as born the young brood is carried away from the bowel and invade the muscles through various channels^ principally by means of the blood stream and along the connective-tissue routes. The female trichina may bring forth several broods of embryos in succession. In nine or ten days after infection the fiist brood reaches The Practice of Osteopathy 157 its destination. They attain to maturity in about two weeks after enter- ing the muscular tissue. In this process an interstitial myositis is ex- cited and a fibrous capsule is formed in four to six weeks. The capsule gradually becomes thicker and finally calcareous infiltration may take place. Thorough cooking destroys the parasite. The disease is most fre- quent among the Germans who eat raw ham and sausages. Symptoms. — These are sometimes absent, especially when only a few are eaten. If large numbers have been ingested, gastro-intestinal symptoms develop in the course of a few days. Vomiting, diarrhea, and pain in the abdomen may be present. In from one to two weeks muscular symptoms develop. There is fever, muscular pain, especially during motion, and the muscles are stiff, tense and sometimes swollen. When the respiratory muscles are involved dyspnea is produced, which may prove fatal. Eosinophilia is a helpful diagnostic point. Edema, especially of the face, is an important symp- tom. Profuse sweats, itching and tingling of the skin have been ob- served. Diagnosis. — Epidemics of this disease are more easily diagnosed than an isolated case. Among the Germans, if cases of apparent typhoid fever occur after a picnic or other feasting occasion, where raw ham or sausages have been indulged in, this disease should be suspected. Ex- amination of the stools and of the muscles will be of aid. The worms may be discovered in the pork, a portion of which has been eaten by the patient. Prognosis. — This depends upon the number of worms ingested. The prognosis should always be guarded. Early, marked diarrhea is favorable. Treatment. — Prophylactic treatment is of great importance in trichiniasis. Inspection of the meat supply, is doing much to prevent trichiniasis; although the most practical way to prevent the disease is to thoroughly cook all pork and sausages. The central portions of the meat should be well cooked. In the feeding of hogs care should be taken that they do not receive any offal, but only milk, grain, vegetables, etc. When a person is infected with trichiniasis, thorough and prompt evacuation of the bowels should be performed at once, so that the em- bryos will not have time to pass into the muscles, but will be ejected from the body. This should be followed by a thorough and persistent treatment for several days of the liver and intestines; treat both the 158 The Practice of Osteopathy liver and intestines directly and through the spine. The object of this treatment is to render all the digestive juices active, so that they may dis- lodge the animal parasite, and to prevent their passing into the muscles. Also keep the bowels active for several days. When the larval parasites have entered the muscles, a treatment cannot be apphed to affect them directly, but the health of the body should be maintained if possible, and the severer symptoms, as the mus- cular pains, weakness and insomnia combated. Thorough manipula- tion, massage and hot baths will be of special aid in relieving the stiff- ness and weakness of the muscles. Filaria (Filaria Sanguinis-Hominis) There are two varieties. One is a thread-hke worm with tapering, blunt ends, appearing in the blood at night, hence called nocturna, while the other is of shghtly different form, appearing in the blood only by day and is called diurna. The mosquito is the communicating host of the parasite. During the night, or should the patient sleep during the day, the nocturna appears in the peripheral circulation, while during the other interval they are probably in the other vessels, particularly the lungs. After the mosquito has taken blood from an affected patient it re- quires from six to seven days for the metamorphosis of the minute filaria which are then lodged in the probosis of the mosquito and introduced into the blood of the next victim. The adult parasite is from three to four inches long and the thickness of a coarse hair, with clear sexual distinction. Pathologically there are no distinct lesions, as the parent worm must establish one. Lymphatic engorgement may result from plugging of the thoracic duct or of a large lymphatic with consequent engorgement which may develop s5anptoms in the inguinal glands, pelvic and lumbar lymphatic trunks. As these varicosities develop rupture may occur; if into the genito-urinary tract chyluria or chylocele may result, or if in the abdominal cavity chylous ascites. Lymphangitis follows a lymph stasis, which later results in ele- phantiasis. (Barbadoes leg.) Symptoms. — Elephantiasis affects the legs, but the arms rarely; the labia of the female and scrotum of the male; occasionally the breasts and other parts of the body. Fever is present on account of the lym- phangitis, accompanied by rigors and delirium and there is marked local The Practice of Osteopathy 159 inflammation. The attack terminates in a pronounced sweat. In deeper parts there is deep seated pain and signs of sepsis, while abscesses may develop over the inflamed area. The varicose inguinal glands are doughy, soft and painless, with both sides affected aUke. The scrotum is affected by the extension, and at times the testes. Treatment is surgical, as the tumors must be removed. Unless the female worm is also removed this is, however, only palliative. Methylene blue is said to be destructive to the filaria and it is prac- tically harmless to the human body. The only treatment is one that will aid in building up the general health. 160 The Practice of Osteopathy HEMORRHAGES IVasal Hemorrhage (Nose bleed ; Epistaxis) Osteopathic Etiology and Pathology. — Traumatism, such as picking the nose, blows, and surgical operations; straining when coughing; nasal tumors and ulcerations; lesions of the atlas, or any lesion of the upper cervical vertebrae, that would interfere with the vasomotor dis- tribution to the nose and cause local congestion or weakness of the blood vessels ; obstructions to the general circulation ; irregularities or suppres- sion of the menstrual flow may result in nose bleed, as a vicarious men- struation; suppression of a habitual hemorrhoidal discharge. Pathologically the great frequency of nasal hemorrhage is due to the great vascularity of the nasal mucous membrane. Usually in cases of spontaneous origin, bleeding is from the region of the septal artery. Spontaneous bleeding may also occur from posterior hyper- trophies or adenoid vegetations. The blood flowing downward into the fauces, is expectorated in such cases, and may be mistaken for a hemorrhage from the lungs. Treatment. — The position of the individual is important. He should assume a sitting posture, or as nearly so as possible. Holding the nostrils tightly, or plugging them with a piece of cotton, will favor the formation and retention of a clot, so that the hemorrhage may be con- trolled. Pressure upon the carotid artery, or upon the facial artery at the angle of the inferior maxilla, will slow the blood current and favor the formation of a clot, also pressure on the sides of the bridge of the nose may influence it. Correcting any lesions that may exist in the superior cervical region, as derangement of the vertebrae or contracted muscles, wiH remove obstructions or irritations to the vasomotor system of the affected region, and thus equaUze the vascular system. Holding the arms above the head, and the application of ice to the nose are of aid in some cases. Also, injection of cold or hot water into the nostrils. In serious and obstinate cases, where other methods fail, a plugging of the anterior and posterior nares should be resorted to, using absorbent cotton or gauze. Broncho-pulmonary Hemorrhage (Hemoptysis) Osteopathic Etiology and Pathology. — Pulmonary congestion; croupous pneumonia; tuberculosis; hemorrhagic infarction; ulcers of The Practice of Osteopathy 161 the larynx, trachea or bronchi; gangrene of the lung; fibrinous bronchitis, carcinoma of the lung; lesions of the ribs or vertebrae from the second to the seventh dorsal inclusive, may cause diseases of the bronchial tubes or lungs, that result in hemoptysis, or the hemorrhage may be caused directly by extreme congestion resulting from the disordered vasomotor nerves; diseases of the heart, such as mitral disease, causing pulmonary congestion; aneurism of the branches of the pulmonary artery; vicarious menstruation from deranged menstrual functions; diseases of the vessel walls, or blood, as scurvy, anemia, hemophilia, etc. Pathologically in many cases, the lesions are microscopic, con- sisting of ruptured capillaries. In other cases larger vessels may be ruptured, or are the seat of erosion. Many other lesions may be ob- served. After death the bronchial mucosa is occasionally found inflamed and the lung tissues paler than normal. Diagnosis. — A differential diagnosis must be made between epis- taxis, hemoptysis and hematemesis. In epistaxis the blood may flow from the posterior nares into the pharynx; it causes coughing and a discharge of the blood may occur the same as in hemoptysis. A careful examination of the nasal region alone can determine the source of the bleeding. In hemoptysis the history of the case as to pulmonary or cardiac diseases is to be considered. There is a feeling of weight and of un- easiness in the chest. A salty taste and a tickling of the throat precedes the bleeding. The blood is ejected by coughing and is bright red, frothy, very Httle coagula, and is alkaline in reaction. In hematemesis the history would indicate disease of the stom- ach, spleen, liver or heart. Uneasiness, and occasionally nausea and faintness, precedes the bleeding. The blood is ejected by vomiting, and is dark, clotted or fluid, mixed with food, and is of acid reaction. In a few instances the blood due to hemoptysis may be swallowed, and vom- ited. Treatment. — In all these cases of hemoptysis the patient should be placed in bed and absolute rest demanded. An attempt should at once be made to correct any lesion that may be found influencing the cause of the bleeding. Correcting lesions to the vasomotor nerves of the lungs and bronchial tubes, and equahzing the disturbed vascular area, may be sufficient in a number of cases. These lesions will be found principally in the upper dorsal region. In some cases, perhaps, there is an impair- ment of the trophic nerves by the same lesions, thus interfering with the 162 The Practice of Osteopathy tone of the vessel-walls and pulmonary tissues. The diet should be light, nutritious and non-stimulating. The use of hot drinks is to be avoided. The rapidity of the heart's action should be reduced. This is best per- formed by thorough treatment of the dorsal spinal nerves of the left side over the heart, and by inhibition in the sub-occipital region. The ice- bag to the precordia is also helpful. Iced drinks and the eating of ice is of aid. Stimulation of the systemic circulation will be of value in help- ing to relieve the pulmonary congestion, although the two systems are somewhat independent of each other. Also, hot foot baths and the evacuation of the bowels may be of additional value. In cases due to or- ganic disease of the heart, the mind and body should receive absolute rest, so that the diseased areas may be strengthened as much as possible; besides a tonic treatment for the heart's action is necessary. After the hemorrhage has subsided care should be taken that bleed- ing does not occur again. All irritations of the respiratory tract should be avoided. A stimulating diet, tobacco and alcohol should be avoided. Nutritious food and a moderate amount of exercise is indicated. Hemorrhage of the Stomach (Hematemesis) Osteopathic Etiology. — Injuries to the stomach; local diseases, as congestion, ulcers and cancer; vicarious menstruation; a mechanical obstruction to the portal circulation; spinal lesions to the vasomotor nerves of the stomach; alterations in the blood; perforation of the stom- ach walls, involving a blood vessel; disease of some neighboring organ. Diagnosis. — A careful examination of the case and of the blood ejected will be necessary to determine the nature of the cause. The differential diagnosis as to the source of the blood, whether from the stomach or lungs, was given under hemoptysis. Treatment. — Correction of any lesions that may influence the blood pressure in the region of the stomach, is the first requisite. Treat- ment of the splanchnics has the greatest influence upon the vasomotor nerves to the stomach. Treatment of the vagi nerves and of the fourth and fifth dorsals, will quiet the violent movem nts of the stomach, and thus aid in controlling the hemorrhage. Stimulation of the cervical sympathetics and heat applied to the feet will tend to equalize the vas- cular system, and thus lessen the gastric congestion. The application of a broad flat ice-bag over the stomach will be of great value. Keep the patient quiet in bed. Surgical interference may be necessary. The Practice of Osteopathy 163 Intestinal Hemorrhage Osteopathic Etiology. — An obstructed circulation of the blood through the venaporta, as in diseases of the heart, lungs and liver; le- sions of the vertebree deranging spinal nerves to the intestinal blood sup- ply; injuries caused by corroding or cutting substances; mechanical in- juries to the intestines; degeneration or erosions of the blood-vessels from ulcers of the intestines, as from typhoid fever, typhus, dysentery, etc. ; disordered menstrual or hemorrhoidal discharges. Diagnosis. — The locality of the intestines affected can be approxi- mately determined by an examination of the discharged blood. When the blood comes from the upper part of the intestines, it is generally dark and mixed with the intestinal contents, which gives it a tarry ap- pearance. It is generally red and fluid when it comes from the lower portion of the bowels. If from the stomach, the blood is thoroughly mixed with fecal matter. Throwing the passage into water, the water is colored red when it contains blood, and if the contents contain bile the water is colored green or yellow. Also, noting the areas of contracted muscles, as in intestinal colic, will aid in the regional diagnosis. Treatment. — Absolute rest in all cases is necessary, the patient remaining as quiet as possible. Food, in severe cases, should not be given for ten or twelve hours. The bed-pan should be used in caring for the evacuations. Correction of the lesions along the spinal region, chiefly of the lower dorsal and lumbar regions, that are impeding the innervation to the intestines, should be attended to at once. This treat- ment tends to reUeve any hyperemic condition of the intestinal mucosa and influences the whole vasomotor area of the mesentery. Direct treatment of the abdomen in a few cases is of great value to reheve ob- structed and contracted vessels in the mesentery, but in certain patho- logical conditions, e. g., typhoid fever, leave the abdomen alone. Treat- ment (inhibition) along the spinal column from the sixth dorsal to the coccyx is helpful in all cases to quiet the peristalsis of the intestines. In severe cases cold drinks, eating of ice and an ice pack to the abdomen are of aid. In a few instances surgical measures will be necessary. Hematuria Osteopathic Etiology. — Congestion and acute inflammation of the kidneys, exacerbations of pyeUtis, renal calcuh, chronic nephritis, traumatism, tuberculosis, etc.; affections of the urinary tract, as calculi or lacerations of the ureter; calculi, cystitis, ulcerations, etc., of the blad- 164 The Practice of Osteopathy der; calculi, gonorrhoea, parasites, etc., of the urethra ; general diseases, chiefly the acute specific fevers and blood diseases; blows, wounds and traumatic influences, external to the kidneys; lesions of the renal splanch- nics. Diagnosis of the locality of the hemorrhage in the urinary tract: In hemorrhage from the kidney the blood is thoroughly mixed with the urine, giving a uniform color. Blood casts and leucocytes are present. In hemorrhage from the ureters the blood is usually molded in clots which conform to the shape of the ureter. The clots appear like small dark worms. In hemorrhage from the bladder the blood is not thor- oughly mixed with the urine and large clots form upon standing. In hemorrhage from the urethra the blood often discharges without mic- turition. When urine is passed the blood precedes the passage of urine. Treatment.— Rest is essential. A correction of the lesions to the renal splanchnics is necessary to control the congestion and inflamma- tion of the kidneys. When the ureters, bladder or urethra is involved, attention must be given to the condition of the spinal column below the renal splanchnics. In all cases the inhibitory treatment to the lower spinal column and ice to the loins are of value. If surgery is indicated, do not delay operation. Uterine Hemorrliage Most of the causes of uterine hemorrhage come under the subject of obstetrics; others under menorrhagia and metrorrhagia. Such will be found in obstetrical and gynecological works. Treatment. — The patient should assume the dorsal position with the buttocks raised. If any displacement of the uterus is present or if there is any foreign material in the uterus, usually such should be cor- rected or removed at once. Stimulation of the clitoris is a most effectual means to control uterine hemorrhage; it contracts the circular fibres of the uterus. Stimulation of the uterus directly through the vagina, and over the abdomen, and stimulation of the upper wall of the vagina, will aid in contracting the uterus. A quick, unexpected pull of the hair on the mons veneris wiU have the effect of closing the capillaries by shock to the nervous control (Dr. Still). Before closing the os, however, it is w^ell to know that there is no irritating foreign material within the body of the uterus. Correction of obstructions of the vasomotor nerves of the uterus through the splanchnic and lumbar region is important. Com- pression of the abdominal aorta, and vaginal injections of hot water may be of aid, as will also a hot water bag at the lumbar region and ice The Practice of Osteopathy 165 water bag over symphysis. In severe cases inversion of the body, if it can be done with safety, may be performed. Packing the vagina is a method resorted to occasionally in severe cases. Hiccoughs Occasionally there is a case of hiccoughs that has been continuous for hours or even days and that all efforts have failed to stop. They are caused by an irritation to the peripheral distribution of the phrenic nerve from some gastric disturbance or a local irritant acting upon the center in the medulla. It may follow fright or great emotion and be associated in persistant form in rheumatism, typhoid fever and other febrile diseases. It follows abdominal operations at times and is very distressing. When occurring in elderly people with pneumonia and in peritonitis with distention it usually marks the end. The same may be said in case of carcinoma of the stomach and bowels. Treatment. — Go first to the origin of the phrenic nerve at the third, fourth and fifth cervical and, if there is a lesion as there will prob- ably be, adjust it and note results. This will be sufficient in many cases. Faihng, bring direct pressure on the nerve just above the clavicle and anterior to the sterno-mastoid muscle and release the scaleni muscles. After this examine and treat at the fifth and twelfth dorsals. Cor- rect any lesions but best results will be had from inhibition at these points. Another method is to stand beside the patient and insert the fingers of both hands under the costal end of the ribs and lightly pull. Firm pressure over the solar plexus with flat of the hand is sometimes beneficial. In hysterical cases, drawing out the tongue will often be effective and it has been suggested that standing the patient on the head will stop them in short order. Tickling the nose to produce violent sneezing is an ancient remedy. Some one of these will cure the case, as osteopathy has never failed so far as recorded. The stomach should be emptied of all irritating matter to prevent recurrence. 166 The Practice of Osteopathy VARICOSE VEINS In varicose veins there is a dilatation of the calibre of the veins and their valves are insufficient. The walls are irregularly thinned, length- ened and tortuous. Osteopathic Etiology and Patliology. — The internal saphen- ous is the vein most frequently affected, although any vein throughout the body may become varicose. Commonly, varicose veins occur in the lower extremities and occasionally in the arms. The valvular insufbciency is caused by stretching of the wall of the vein, thus separating the thin, free edges and leaving an interspace that allows regurgitation of the blood. The valves becoming insuffi- cient, the column of blood in the veins has no support against gravity, and being interrupted in its course does not flow normally into collateral channels. The walls of the veins become thin, as does also the adjacent skin, thus increasing the danger of a rupture, either external or sub- cutaneous. Varicose veins are most frequently found in females, following uterine enlargements. The condition may be due to any obstruction or con- striction that prevents the free return of blood from the veins, such as dislocations of the hip, either slight or complete, dislocations of innomi- nata, contractions of adductor magnus muscle affecting femoral vein, prolapse of diaphragm obstructmg vena cava, tissue constrictions about the saphenous opening, garters, and, in fact, anything that might impede the free venous flow. The tendency to varicose veins increases as age advances, and many cases are found among people of middle life who have been accustomed to standing a great deal. Injuries to the pelvis, thigh or leg, lessening the nutrition to the leg, or injuries to the nerves, as vertebral dislocations in the lower dorsal or lumbar regions (the fourth lumbar especially) may be causes of varicose veins. Preg- nancy or tumors in the abdomen or pelvis, causing pressure upon the iliac veins, are occasionally causes. Distention of the sigmoid flexure, causing pressure upon the left iliac vein, or distention of the cecum; press- ing upon the right iliac vein, are fruitful sources, as are also diseases of the heart and lungs. Varicose veins of the upper extremities are due to occupations requiring overuse of the arms. Complications. — Varicocele, hemorrhoids, labial varix in the female, varix over pubes, ulceration and eczema due to disturbances of nutrition, edema and thrombus. Symptoms. — Lower Extremities. — Cramping pains in the hmbs The Practice op Osteopathy 167 ■upon rising. Fullness and heaviness of the limbs. Inspection may reveal superficial varicose veins near the saphenous opening, upon the external thigh, in the popHteal space, upon the external leg or behind the ankles. Edema and congestion of the foot and ankles occur in a few cases. Pain is quite a prominent symptom, due to pressure upon the nerve fibres. Eczema and itching are due to disturbed innervation and blood supply to the skin. Ulceration may occur, due to the burst- ing of a vein. Upper Extremities. — Before the varicosity appears there is usually pain or a feehng as of a sprain in the involved region of the arm. The pain is usually confined to a muscle or group of muscles. Treatment. — The majority of cases are due to disorders about the pelvis, hip or thigh, and the treatment resolves itself into the removal of these obstructions or constrictions. Occasionally cases are caused by partial dislocations of the hip joint, which can be easily overlooked during a hurried examination. The sHpping of an innominatum is an important factor. Rest in a recumbent position, attention to the general health, and especial attention to the bowels and hver, are essential in acute attacks. Occasionally the heart and lungs are at fault. Treatment twice per week should consist of removing any of the numerous causes of the condition, and spinal treatment as well; then the leg should re- ceive special attention. Remember, thrombi may form and the vein must, under no circumstances, be touched in the treatment. Be- gin by carefully rotating the leg to stretch contracted tissue about the saphenous opening, then separate the tendons of the popHteal space and follow the course of the vein to the abdomen and relax tissue about it. Keep patient off the feet as much as possible and elevate the leg when sitting. In rupture of varicose veins the hemorrhage can be arrested by ele- vating the Hmb and applying pressure with the fingers, above and below the wound, until a compress and bandage can be applied. The support of the varicose veins by elastic stockings will ease the pain and prevent edema in many cases, but, as a rule, it is a direct hindrance to the circu- lation on account of the necessity of having the stocking fit closely. Sur- gical operations are rarely indicated. Phlebitis (Phlegmasia alba dolcns; milk leg) An inflammation of a vein. In the condition described here it is a puerperal septic inflammation of the femoral vein. About the third 168 The Practice of Osteopathy week after confinement there is a swelling of the leg with or without redness. Great pain accompanies the condition and the temperature gradually rises to 102°-3°. As understood by osteopaths, this is the re- sult of a partial closing of the saphenous opening during parturition so that the venous flow is partly stopped. Treatment consists in carefully rotating the leg at the hip so that the fascia lata is spread, opening the lumen of the vein so the conges- tion will drain out. There will, also, probably be found innominate or lumbar lesions which must be adjusted with the result that almost im- mediate relief is given as a rule. Chronic Phlebitis The chronic form shows considerable inflammation along the line of the vein marked by tenderness, edema and thickening of tissue. The entire leg may be more or less involved through circulatory injury. In these cases will be found definite innominte lesions of a primary type or the distortion is superinduced by lumbar lesions. A few cases are quickly cleared up through adjustment that is readily secured. How- ever, in others, there being considerable thickening of the sacro-iliac articulating tissues, some time may be required to get complete ad- justment and consequent restoration of femoral circulation. In addi- tion to this, careful abduction, flexion, hyperextension and circum- duction is indicated. This last technique should be executed with great care and with due regard to pathology. If Dr. Still's emphatic com- mand were followed, that all maternity patients should have both legs rotated and innominates inspected, there would be no phlebitis cases, acute or chronic. The Practice of Osteopathy 169 THE RECTUM To treat the rectum intelligently and thoroughly, requires special knowledge on the part of the osteopath. A speculum should be used in many cases when making an examination, and all abnormal conditions carefully inspected with the eye; although much can usually be noted by the examination with the finger alone. The best position in which to give an examination and treatment is to have the patient on the side, with thighs flexed upon the abdomen. In a few cases the patient may lean over an operating table. The objects of rectal treatment are many — to reheve hemorrhoids, etc., of the mucouS membrane; to correct a dislocated coccyx; to treat an enlarged prostate gland; to replace a prolapsed rectum; to tone the lower bowel in cases of constipation; to give reflex stimuU to the heart and lungs, in cases of fainting, paroxysms, etc.; to relieve severe pains in the rectum at the time of the menstrual period, and to relieve congestion, inflammation, contracted tissues, etc., of local sources; to relax spasms in croup, and to remove tension to the nervous sj^stem in some forms of insomnia. In fact, so many diseases are affected by reflex irritations from the rectum that its examination is a necessity in many cases. The phrase "when in doubt treat the rectum" was coined by a progressive student and there is an element of truth in it. Surgical assistance to treatment will be considered under hemorrhoids. The principal need of osteopathic internal rectal treatment, is: (1) To relax all contracted and constricted fibres about the waUs of the rectum and between the sacrum and coccyx. (2) To correct a dislocated coccyx. (3) To dilate the sphincters thoroughly, in order to reheve irri- tations about the sphincters, and to stimulate the sympathetic nerves. Work through the rectum to treat an enlarged prostate gland, to correct a displaced uterus, and to make a more thorough examination of the uterine tissues, the Fallopian tubes and the ovaries, is a frequent occurrence. In giving local treatment, cleanse the fingers and oil the index finger; then, after introducing it into the rectum relax the contracted tissues by an upward sweeping motion on all sides. This treatment re- Heves all obstructions to vessels and nerves caused by contracted fibres, and tones the rectal walls. In prolapsed sigmoid, causing obstructive constipation, the finger can be used to separate the folds of mucous mem- brane and open the lumen of the bowel. Frequently there will be enough 170 The Practice of Osteopathy tone to the muscular coat so that the irritation will set up slight peris- talsis and cause the bowel to draw up to a considerable degree. In chil- dren where there is much straining at the stool, the sigmoid will often be found down and by using the httle finger the same results can be ac- compUshed and much rehef given. To dilate and stretch the sphincters thoroughly a speculum or dilator should be used under anesthesia; still, considerable can be done by one or two fingers. The sphincter should be thoroughly stretched in all directions, care being taken when an instrument is used that too much force is not appHed. Secure as much voluntary relaxation of the sphinc- ter as possible. Inhibition at 2d and 3d sacral will aid. This treat- ment is of aid in cases of hemorrhoids and prolapse of the rectum, in con- stipation due to the loss of tonicity of the lower bowels, in tightness of the sphincters, in pain of the rectum, and in stimulating the heart and lungs. In cases of a prolapsed rectum, due to irritation about the sphinc- ters, causing tenesmus, this treatment is of special value, as it gives the sphincter a phj^siological rest. Frequency of treatment per rectum must depend entirely on the patient and disease. It can be given daily in many cases and is frequently so indicated in acute hemorrhoids, pros- tatic troubles, etc. According to Quain, the sensory nerves to the rectum are from the second, third and fourth sacrals. Some of the motor fibres of the cir- cular muscles of the rectum are from the lower dorsal and upper two lum- bar nerves; these pass by the aortic plexus to the inferior mesenteric ganglion. Associated with these fibres, are the inhibitory fibres of the longitudinal muscles of the rectum. The sacral nerves contain motor fibres to the longitudinal muscles, and inhibitor}^ fibres to the circular muscles of the rectum. In all cases of rectal trouble, the lower dorsal and upper lumbar vertebrae may be found deranged, and thus interfere with the rectal nerves. Relaxation of the sacral muscles over the sacral foramina has a marked effect in reUeving tenesmus. In dysentery, where there is a constant desire to defecate, a thorough upward relaxation of the sacral muscles will give great relief. Proctitis or inflammation of the rectum is not an uncommon dis- order. The disease has been divided into acute, chronic, gonorrheal, dysenteric, and diphtheritic. Foreign bodies, impacted feces, cold, purgatives, prolapse of the sigmoid, and lumbar, coccygeal and innom- inate lesions are the most important causative factors. The acute form is more frequently found in older people. The symptoms are tenesmus, frequent evacuations of blood and mucus (possibly pus). The Peactice OF Osteopathy 171 prolapse of the mucous membrane, feeling of fullness, and radiating pains. The gonorrheal, diphtheritic and dysenteric forms are of rare occurrence, with the exception that the dysenteric may be somewhat frequent. The treatment is to remove all local irritations, cleanse the bowels, and put the patient in bed. AU irritating foods are to be prohibited. Use milk, soups, beef-juice, soft boiled eggs and similar foods. Correct all osteo- pathic lesions; especially will inhibition over the sacral foramina relieve the tenesmus. Cold water in the rectum and appUed to the anus will be beneficial. If abscesses occur, employ surgical measures. Prolapse of the rectum is another common rectal disorder. Acute cases are especially found in children, due to straining at stool. The sacrum is more straight, and thus violent straining, coughing, etc., the more readily produces prolapse. Prolapse of the mucous membrane is the most common, although all of the rectal coats may be involved. Prolapse of the upper part of the rectum into the lower or invagination is frequently met with by osteopaths. The sigmoid may prolapse and also affect the rectum. The treatment is to return the mass, using an anesthetic if necessary. If it is not retained, place straps across the buttocks. Then with attention to lesions that may be disturbing and weakening the rectal walls, and thorough local toning treatment, the prognosis should be favorable. In high rectal prolapse local attention is necessary as well as deep treatment through the abdominal walls to the sigmoid and upper rectum. The use of Cole's irrigator for high enema will replace and elevate both the upper rectum and sigmoid and greatly aid in a cure. Regularity of habits and proper food are essentials. Hemorrhoids • Definition. — A dilated or varicose condition of the plexus of veins lying in the sub-mucous tissue of the lower part of the rectum. The di- latation of these hemorrhoidal veins may extend into the adjoining sub- cutaneous tissues and mucous membrane, and the perirectal plexus and adjoining venous plexuses of the bladder, uterus, vagina and sacral canal may become involved. Osteopathic Etiology and Pathology. — The chief predisposing cause of piles is man's erect position and the absence of valves in the hemorrhoidal veins. Thus a retardation or stagnation of the portal vein would cause a backward movement of the entire cokram. It is evident that such a downward pressure of the blood in the portal system would dilate and extend the blood vessels, to the very capillaries in the rectal region. 172 The Practice of Osteopathy This retardation may arise from several causes: obstruction of the portal vein, from diseases of the liver; diseases of the heart; obstruc- tion or destruction of the capillaries of the lungs; pressure from a gravid uterus, tumor, etc. ; a general loss of tonicity of the abdominal walls, as in persons who take but little exercise ; the excessive use of wine, tea and coffee; injuries to the spinal column, especially in the lumbar, sacral and coccygeal regions; a dislocation of an innominate bone; lifting; consti- pation; straining at stool; carelessness of the calls of nature, etc. Ca- tarrh of the bowels may cause a congestion of the mucous membrane and consequently piles. Hereditary influence may be a factor in a few cases. Hemorrhoids are divided into two classes, external and internal. An external pile is one that arises from the margin of the anus outside of the external sphincter muscle. It differs from the internal pile from the fact that it is always composed either of skin or hypertropliied con- nective tissue, forming a mere cutaneous tag, or else it is composed of a small cutaneous vein enlarged by a clot of blood. The internal hemor- rhoids are composed mostly of enlarged veins and are connected by hy- pertrophied connective tissue. They have a free arterial supply and are covered by the mucous membrane of the rectum. They are due, usually, to an affection of the middle hemorrhoidal blood supply, thereby being a part of the visceral vascular system. Internal hemorrhoids, when pro- truding, can be returned within the rectum, while the external ones can- not. The venous turgescence varies in size from a pea to a walnut. They may be single or may surround the entire anal opening like a bunch of grapes. Repeated attacks of engorgement of the veins involved, will in time change the mucous membrane or the sub-mucous tissue, and cause ca- tarrhal swelling of the mucous membrane, or hyperplasia of the connec- tive tissue. At first the hemorrhoid is usually a blood tumor, but in chronic cases it is oftentimes made up largely of connective tissue. Ow- ing to pressure of the varicose veins, atrophy of the mucous and sub- mucous tissue may occur. The white or sKmy hemorrhoids occur when these roughened parts of the mucous membrane become inflamed and thickened, resulting in suppuration. Symptoms. — The symptoms are quite diagnostic and need not be mistaken. Besides the appearance of tumors, there may be consti- pation, pain during stools, indigestion, headache and pain in the back. Hemorrhages frequently occur, and if suddenly checked, as by cold^ other disturbances may occur, as congestion of the head, lungs, stom- ach, liver, kidneys, etc., which may result in hemorrhages from these or- The Practice of Osteopathy 173 gans. Fissures of the anus, contraction of the rectal sphincters and pro- lapse of the rectum may occur. Occasionally in old people there is a varicose state of the veins of the neck of the bladder, and in females, of the uterus and vagina, which causes hemorrhages of these organs. The communicating plexus of the spinal canal may be affected, causing weight, numbness and pain, so as to simulate a lesion of the cord. The patient may have a hypochondriacal disposition and be disinclined to work, especially at mental labor. Prognosis. — Depends upon the predisposing and immediate causes, but a large majority of cases can be cured. Treatment.— A thorough examination of the patient should be made, not only to ascertain the extent of the local trouble, but to under- stand thoroughly the general health of the sufferer, especiallj'- the state of the heart, lungs and liver. Many cases of hemorrhoids are caused by lesions in the lumbar and sacral regions, and especially dislocations of the coccyx (usually anterior) and the innominata. Correcting these lesions will oftentimes cure the hemorrhoidal disorder. Simple dilatation of the rectum once a week, in addition to other treatment, is of great aid in curing hemorrhoids, not a few of the cases being cured by dilatation alone. It relaxes the tis- sues about the tumefied vessels. Treatment is rarely necessary above the second lumbar, (unless there is more or less of a constitutional dis- order) as the superior hemorrhoidal blood-vessel of the inferior mesenteric is given off about opposite the second lumbar. In cases where the abdominal walls have become relaxed, a treat- ment should be given to strengthen the abdominal muscles and viscera. Particular attention should be given the liver. Treatment should be given over the abdominal muscles directly, and also to the spinal nerves of the same region. The diet should be strictly regulated and the bowels kept loose, and stimulants, indigestible food, full meals and too much meat should be avoided. Injection of cold water before stools is a good prophylactic, and appHcations of cold water to the protruding pile will be of some help in reheving the congestion. A squatting position dur- ing defecation will reheve considerable strain. Hemorrhoids in the acute state, within twelve or twenty-four hours from the engorgement, yield quickly to treatment. The local technique is to relax the tissues about the tumor, especially above and along the line of the vein, then with pressure at its base carefully force out the engorged blood. Follow this up by another treatment the next day and continue until normal. The vein wall, not being permanently 174 The Practice of Osteopathy stretched, will contract and if the irritating cause is found, there is little danger of return. Remember, in a case like this, the danger of embolism and be sure a clot has not formed. Cases of hemorrhage at stool, dur- ing or immediately following evacuation, when not from a bleeding pile, may be of considerable quantity and the source difficult to locate. It may be due to ulcerations or easily ruptured capillaries of the mucosa, but the cause will in many cases be found in the innominata and a re- duction of the lesion give rehef. Rectal conditions, associated with piles, and requiring surgery after treatment has failed, are: iiemorrhoids, which are of such long standing as to become organized tissue, (these will keep up continual ir- ritation and cannot be absorbed); saccules or pocket', formed by folds of mucous membrane catching and holding particles of feces, gradually enlarging and ending with considerable reflex symptoms ; fistulae, com- plete or incomplete, may frequently be healed by adjusting coccygeal or innominate lesions, but are apt to recur from the tract not being clean in the center or bottom; abscesses in or about the anus or rectum are usually traced to coccygeal, innominate, or local interference to circu- lation; fissure, complete dilatation under anesthesia to insure physio- logical rest of parts, is probably the best treatment. It is suggested that a fissure may be healed by making surgically clean, touching with iodine and coating with collodium. Papillae are small, hard black- capped papules in the lower rectum, each one involving a nerve terminal and causing much distress. All these conditions give rise to much dis- comfort and with surgical assistance can be cured without much trouble. It is not necessary to make them a major operation and do uncalled-for things. The less surgery about the rectal sphincter the better. Care of the anus and rectum after operation or successful treat- ment is a factor in preventing return. First, there should be soluble, non-irritating stools, which do not tend to bring about prolapse from straining. Diet and regularity contribute to this. Second, absolute cleanliness. This can only be obtained by following the stool with an enema of four or five ounces of cool water and immediately passing it. It will bring forth a considerable quantity of feces which would other- wise have been retained for another twenty-four hours. This procedure following, as it does, the stool does not in any way interfere with the normal function or create a habit. The anus should then be thoroughly washed in cool water and as thoroughly dried. Dusting with borated talcum powder, starch, etc., will prevent chafing. The Practice of Osteopathy 175 GENITO-URINARY The Prostate Gland This gland is subject to several painful and annoying diseases, con- trolling, as it does, the flow of urine and exerting such a profound influence over the sexual functions. The nerves to the prostate pass between the gland and the levator ani muscle, and the secretory branches are from the sacral nerves, while Quain gives the sensory as from the tenth, eleventh (twelfth) dorsal, first, second and third sacral and fifth lumbar. Lesions affecting the prostate are occasionally found at the tenth and eleventh dorsal and fifth lumbar, while the innominate lesions are common causes of trouble. These should be corrected, if present, and local treatment given to the gland. ''Massage of the prostate," says Lydston,^ "prop- erly performed, is one of the most valuable advances in genito-urinary therapeutics that has been developed in many years." Osteopathic technique is to place the patient on the side, knees flexed, and standing in front insert the index finger. Care must be used not to bruise the gland and it must be touched Hghtly when sensitive. Relax tissue about the gland, and, then, from the median fine with an outward movement, massage the surface of each lobe. This infiuences the blood and nerve supply, while the pressure will tend to reheve congestion. Length of treatment, as well as frequency, depends entirely upon conditions. Do not make the mistake of treating the perineum instead of the gland and do not gouge it with the finger. Remember it is sensitive tissue. Hypertrophy is most commonly met with in practice, as twenty per cent, of men past middle life are said to be afflicted. It is probablj'" not a sequence of old age, but due to chronic, congestive and inflammatory conditions. Anything which would produce these conditions— spinal lesions, excessive venery, masturbation, or other more innocent causes — would in time bring about enlargement. As the length of catheter life is estimated at six years it is of great importance that the condition be early recognized, for in advanced stages surgery is the last resort. In early stages the prognosis is good, either for a cure or to stop further enlargement, while many enlarged ones at the catheter stage have been greatly benefited or cured. Treatment of the gland once per week is usually enough, but in older cases can be given semi-weekly. Look well to nerve and blood supply. Acute Prostatitis is a serious and painful inflammation, causing 1. Twcntiolh Century Practice of Medicine, Vol. XXI. 176 The Practice of Osteopathy urinary retention usually. It results from trauma, horseback riding, over exertion, gonorrhea and its mal-treatment, etc. Lower dorsal and lumbar lesions are frequent. This condition must be closely watched. Inhibition of the sacral nerves will help control pain and stop any spasm of the sphincter. Cold apphcations to the gland externally at the peri- neum will aid in reducing inflammation. Local treatment should at first be given to the adjacent tissues as the gland will be very sensitive. Later direct massage will be of great benefit. Chronic Prostatitis may follow an acute attack or it may originate as a chronic or sub-acute affection. Frequent micturition and dull pain, referred to the perinemn and rectum, with the local examination, make diagnosis sure. The spinal lesions should be corrected and the gland massaged. This will induce absorption, by squeezing out the inflam- matory products and do much toward preventing future hypertrophy. "Massage is done by the finger. The patient is placed in the knee- elbow position and massage employed for four minutes daily. The value of massage in chronic prostatitis is very great, but should be employed with much caution and never in cases of suppuration."^ Prostatorrliea is often taken for spermatorrhea and any irritation of anterior sacral nerves would cause undue activity to the secretory nerves to the gland. This is easily determined. Tlie Seminal Vesicles can be reached just above the prostate, and if inflamed and tender or if engorged by inspissated seminal fluid, local treatment will be of benefit. Frequent massage, daily in some cases, to the gland and treatment to the sympathetic nerves above the trigone of the bladder, to the nerve fibres passing along the spermatic cord, and to the arteries directly, will be of the greatest aid in impotency. In Clironic Gonorrliea, where the gonococcus has found lodgement in and about the gland, it can be more readily dislodged by massage than by an}^ other form of treatment. Retention ol urine from nervous excitement or other minor causes, can often be overcome by local massage of the prostate. Spastic stricture can usually be cured by work about the prostate and its innervation . Varicocele A varicose enlargement'of the veins of the spermatic cord, epididymis and testicle. In varicocelefthe pampiniform plexus is usually enlarged, but all the veins of the cordfmaj^be involved. The swelhng gets smaller 1. C. Kriiger, Munch Med. Woch. The Practice of Osteopathy 177 under compression or in a horizontal position and enlarges again on stand- ing erect. It is almost invariably found on the left side, and the testicle on the affected side is generally smaller and softer than its fellow. The predisposing causes are a longer and tortuous spermatic vein on the left side; the absence of support of the veins from surrounding muscles; the imperfect valves; the entry of the left spermatic vein into the renal vein at a right angle, instead of at an acute angle hke the right vein; the more liabihty of compression of the left spermatic vein by ac- cumulation of feces in the sigmoid flexure; the lack of normal exercise of the sexual functions in young, immarried adults. Lesions in lower dor- sal and upper lumbar affect the condition; the eleventh dorsal particu- larly. A lesion at the second lumbar may cause neuralgia of the testicle with engorgement of the vein. The exciting causes are straining during stool, heavy lifting, ex- cessive sexual indulgence or anything that would determine more blood to the testicles. Varicocele is similar to the varicose state of the hemor- rhoidal veins and maj^ have Uke causes. The diagnosis is easily made. The feeUng of the veins between the fingers hke a convolution of earth worms; dull, aching, dragging sensation, and possibly prostration, weakness and dejectedness of spir- its, are characteristic symptom.s. "The condition is devoid of danger, except that it often begets morbid fears on the part' of the patient, us- ually the result of suggestion."^ The treatment consists of regulation of the bowels, removal of such predisposing and exciting causes as may be found, treatment of the vessels along the spermatic cord, and treatment to the lower dorsal and lumbar regions. In severe cases a suspensary bandage will give temporary relief. Surgical interference may be necessary in some cases in order to effect a cure. Impotency Results from treatment in these conditions are particularly grati- fying and offer a great field of activity in this day of sensational medical advertising. This condition can well be classed under four heads. Ex- haustive, Traumatic, Psychic and Organic. Exhaustive Impotency is the result of functional abuse, mastur- bation in early life, excessive venery, coupled with intemperate use of alcohol and improper diet without sufficient sleep. It can be symp- tomatic in neurasthenia. There is at first irritation of the spinal centers, 1. Deaver's Surgical Anatomy, Vol. II, p. 652. 178 The Practice of Osteopathy which causes exaggerated sexual activity, and later this is followed by complete or partial loss of function. The first step is for a radical reform in habits; regulation of the bowels, as they will likely be constipated; direction of the mind into wholesome channels, and then skillfully di- rected spinal treatment. Where there has been masturbation, look well for sources of irritation to the parts ; a long foreskin or adherent prepuce indicates surgical aid, or there may be a lesion at the sacrals involving the nervi erigentes or, of greater importance, the pudic nerve. The in- nominatum can be at fault in this. The lower dorsal, ribs and upper lum- bar are of importance. Kraft-Ebing says: "Conditions of absolute impotency are, however, rare, and are caused only by severe vertebral and nervous diseases." Nerve irritation undoubtedly is the cause of sexual perversion (outside of heredity and malformation) so their relief is as necessary to bring about reform of habits as to effect a cure. Where the general health is affected constitutional treatment should follow. Motschutkovsky uses suspension in treating these cases with good re- sults. The effect is to separate the vertebrae, freeing spinal nerve and blood channels. The prostate will probably be found in an irritated, sensitive condition, as well as the seminal vesicles. Treat as outlined under the prostate gland. Ligation of the dorsal vein of the penis is recommended by some authorities as tending to aid turgescence of the organ. Prognosis is so dependent on how well the patient follows di- rections, age, environment and general condition that it is hard to give, but as a rule is rather favorable. Traumatic Impotency is a strictly osteopathic classification, for the reason that sexual weakness is often traced to lesions resulting from remote injuries. These injuries may be to the spine, ribs or sacrum. The lower spine may be impacted from a fall or the result of long con- tinued riding on rough streets or the railway. This inhibits the nerve supply to the extent of often seriously impairing the sexual functions. If the cord is injured to any extent the results are more serious. Treat- ment in these cases has given uniformly good results. It will always be due to a specific lesion, so the examination must be thorough. Psychic Impotency is the form most frequently met with and gen- erally the most difficult to cure, yet it should not be if the patient's con- fidence can be secured, for in many cases sexual power is but sUghtly impaired, but owing to the suggestions given by the medical advertisers the victim diagnoses his own case as hopeless. "It is not uncommon that virility returns with the peace of mind. "^ Observe all the procedure 1. Vecki, Sexual Impotence. The Practice of Osteopathy 179 given and then inspire hope where it can be honestly given, and if the patient is progressing favorably, other things being equal, advise early marriage under strict rules of conduct. If already married, conjugal re- lations should be most carefully investigated and the wife taken into your confidence. Her co-operation in correcting very possible errors in sex- ual matters, as well as sympathetic aid in easing the patient's anxiety and chagrin, will be invaluable. Nothing but the frankest understand- ing between all parties is permissible and the osteopath must be in ab- solute control. Organic Impotency is the result of a cortical injury or disease. The latter is the most common, as it follows tabes dorsalis, paralysis affecting the lumbar cord, some cases of diabetes, etc. Also, any con- genital malformations or absence of all or part of the organs. Prog- nosis in these cases is bad, as cure is seldom possible. In no other class of cases will honesty, tact and good judgment count for sO much or the rewards be greater. 180 The Practice of Osteopathy HEAT STROKE (Heat Exhaustion: Sunstroke) An affection produced by exposure to excessive heat. Two varieties are recognized; heat exhaustion and thermic fever. Heat Exhaustion. — This is caused by prolonged exposure to high temperatures, combined with physical exertion. Fatigue, over-eating, alcohoHc drinking, and poor sanitation predispose. This may occur without exposure to the direct rays of the sun, the heat being artificial, or in mid-summer, in close, confined rooms the same result will be pro- duced. There is vasomotor paralysis, the surface of the body is usually cool, the temperature may be as low as 95 degrees F., while the pulse is small and rapid. Sunstroke or Thermic Fever. — This is usually caused by pro- longed work under the direct rays of the sun in a humid, very hot and sultry atmosphere. This is caused by the action of the heat upon the heart centers producing a paralysis of those centers. Pathologically, rigor mortis develops early and is marked. Putre- factive changes appear early, owing to the high temperature of the ca- daver. The various organs are deeply congested, the venous engorge- ment is extreme in the cerebrum. There is rigid contraction of the left ventricle; while the right is dilated and filled with blood. The blood is fluid and dark. Parenchymatous changes take place in the liver and kidneys. In heat exhaustion with lowered temperature there is a paralysis of the vasomotor center in the medulla, and the heat is dissipated more rapidly than it is produced. In thermic fever the heat regulating centers become paralyzed by the action of the excessive temperature and more heat is produced^ and less dissipated than normal. Symptoms.— Heat Exhaustion.— This may occur gradually or suddenly with a severe attack of faintness, pallor, dizziness, headache, cold perspiration and sometimes bhndness as the first symptoms. Con- sciousness is rarely entirely lost. In severe cases there is more permanent collapse. The pulse is rapid and feeble and there is great restlessness and dehrium. Under prompt treatment mild cases may recover in a few hours, while in extreme cases death may occur almost at once from heart failure. Thermic Fever. — In some cases the patient is struck down, be- comes quickly unconscious, and may die within an hour, or death may The Practice of Osteopathy 181 be almost instantaneous. In other cases there is pain in the head, op- pression, dizziness, nausea, vomiting and sometimes diarrhea or frequent micturition. Soon unconsciousness sets in, the face is flushed, the eyes injected, the breatliing labored and there is a temperature of from 105° to 110° F. The pulse is full and rapid, the skin hot and dry and the pupils are contracted. There is usually complete relaxation of the muscles, and in some cases there is twitching and jactitation. Epileptiform con- vulsions are rare. In fatal cases the coma deepens, the pulse becomes feeble, rapid and irregular, the breathing hurried and shallow and death occurs in a few hours. Favorable cases are indicated by a fall in the temperature and by the return of consciousness. In these cases recov- ery may be complete. In some cases the patient may never be able to stand even moderate degrees of temperature, which often produce excite- ment, headache and pain in the cervical region. Failure of the memory, and the loss of power to concentrate the mind are sometimes sequelae. Meningitis, epilepsy and insanity are also sequelae. Diagnosis. — This presents little difficulty. The history and cir- cumstances preceding the attack are very important in making the diag- nosis. The diagnosis between heat exhaustion and sunstroke fever is readily made. In heat exhaustion the temperature is lowered, the pulse is feeble, consciousness is rarely completely lost; in sunstroke fever the temperature is extremely high, there is usually complete unconscious- ness, and the pulse is full and rapid. Prognosis.- — This should be guarded, depending upon the severity of the case. Treatment. — ^In cases of heat exhaustion remove the patient to a shad}^ place and apply water to the face, chest and spine. Thoroughly treat the upper cervical region, in order to control the impaired vasomotor centers and nerves. If the temperature is below normal a hot bath should be given. Keep the heart and lungs stimulated. In sunstroke, place the patient in a recumbent position and loosen all constricted clothing, and stimulate the heart's action. The high fever is to be met promptly. Place the patient in a bath of water, to which add ice freely. The patient may also be rubbed with ice, and ice water enemata may be employed. The muscles of the neck will be found contracted, probably due to cerebral hyperemia. A thorough relaxation of these muscles will be of gi-eat aid in equalizing the vascular system. It is a good plan to thoroughly relax all the muscles along the spinal colunm for the same purpose. When the temperature nears normal the baths should be stopped. After the temperature has been reduced place the 182 The Practice of Osteopathy patient upon a cot with ice to the head. The cervical treatment should be repeated as often as necessary. The diet of the patient should be liquid for a few days. Plenty of water and stimulation of the kidnej^s and bowels will be found beneficial. The sequelae are to be treated ac- cording to the condition. Much can be done for the sequelae of heat ex- haustion and sunstroke. Lesions will be found corresponding to the regions involved. Deep contracted muscles are common. The Practice of Osteopathy 183 DEPARTMENT OF OPHTHALMOLOGY By C. C. Reid It is the desii-e to make this discussion on the eye the most useful possible to the whole profession. Let it be plainly understood that there is no effort to cover every phase of eye pathology but to elaborate eye diseases and therapeutics strictly from the standpoint of osteopathy. There are many very elaborate and extensive text-books and even ency- clopedise written on the eye by the medical profession. The world of ophthalmic literatm-e is extensive and profound. Just so are the elab- orations on the' general field of medicine. Such things as hereditary in- fluences, congenital deformities, amblyopias, albinism, coloboma and the field of ophthalmic surgery does not concern us at the present time in an osteopathic text-book. This department is dedicated to a scien- tific development of ophthalmic therapeutics along osteopathic lines of thought. Some things in the therapeutics of the eye concern all schools alike. For instance, proper cleanliness and antiseptic precautions in regard to the eye, dietetics, hygiene and the care of the general health. The same anatomy and many of the same methods of examination and diagnosis obtain ui all schools. It is the intention to go into the opthhal- mic therapeutic field in these discussions where osteopathy has a differ- ent outlook with a definite distinct reform to offer in the viewpoint of the anatomy, methods of diagnosis and the system of treatment. How to Examine an Eye It has been said that one should be a good general man in order tc be a competent specialist. This is especially true in regard to ophthalmic therapeutics. Many systemic diseases have eye symptoms and path- ology. The same blood and lymph that nourishes and bathes different parts of the body, also circulates in the structures of the eye. In the examination of the eye, heredity, occupation and envnonment are to be taken into consideration. Osteopathic lesions may exist from falls, strains, twists, blows, colds and exposure and impair the mtegrity of the metabolic processes of the eye through the nerve connections and blood supply and lay the foundation for a great variety of eye diseases. With these lesions existing about the neck and upper dorsal, it is only required to have some insignificant local irritant to start symptoms and cause pathology apparently out of all proportion to the etiology. It is im- portant then that one understand the nerve centers and reflexes and the 184 The Practice of Osteopathy osteopathic logic underlying these conditions or else he must frequently work without a satisfactory explanation of the etiology and consequently be more or less unscientific in his treatment. The eye examination should consist of the case history, the family history, inspection, osteopathic examination, especially from the fourth dorsal vertebra to the occiput and especial exiimination of the eye by inspection and other methods. 1. The Case History. Thoroughness of the doctor, or the lack of it, will be readily displayed at this point. Every little thing, as far as oossible, that has a bearing on the case should be observed and uncov- sred in the case history. The physician should want to know every fact that helps him to better understand his case. Patience in hearing the history will often be of great assistance. It gives light on the physical and mental condition of the patient. Much can be gained by being careful and attentive. Notice carefully what he emphasizes and what he thinks is the most important. Inquire in regard to headaches, ner- vous symptoms, previous eye trouble and past illnesses. Get a venereal history if present, as many eye diseases are complicated or caused by syphilis or gonorrhea. 2. The Family History. — Inquire as to blindness in the family and about the age it occurred, if any. Get a venereal history if possible. 3. Inspection. — Much inspection can go on while the history is being taken. Observe the countenance, whether there is strabismus or frowning due to eye strain, photophobia as suggested by the effort to avoid the light; note symmetry. Look closel}' at the lashes, lids, con- junctiva, cornea and iris. Note any scales or crusts on the lids at the root of the lashes. Turn the lids for further inspection. Note the size and relation of the eyes. Exophthalmos may be due to an enlarged globe in high myopia, to Graves' disease, orbital tumor and paralysis of the extrinsic muscles, or staphyloma. In blepharospasm there may be a corneal ulcer or a rupture of the eye-ball. An exact examination must be made at the first visit in order for a diagnosis to institute the best treatment possible. Study the conjunctival sac for congestions, hypertrophy, swelling, tumors, foreign bodies, trachoma bodies and secretions. In all forms of conjunctivitis the congestion is most marked in the fornix and decreases toward the sclerocorneal junction. In iritis and cyclitis there is a circumcorneal injection, a pink or red color radiat- ing from the cornea. Note any corneal pathology in the way of ulcers or abrasions and foreign bodies. Compare the tension of the eyes. 4. The Osteopathic Examination of the Eye. — This heading is The Practice of Osteopathy 185 put here in order to show what osteopathy has to offer that is distinct as belonging to our system and not practiced by any other school. Osteo- pathic research so far has shown that osteopathic science has much to offer on etiology and diagnosis and treatment in eye diseases. The case history, family history and inspection should require but a few minutes but they are essential to a proper examination and may aid us in what to expect osteopathically. Weak nerves will cause asthenopia. A broken arch, an innominate lesion or a slipped axis may cause weak nerves. The osteopathic eye examination then should consider the whole mechanism of the body. In case glasses are being worn for asthe- nopia they may readily be made unnecessary by osteopathic treatment in the correction of the lesions and building up the system. Some time ago some parents sent their daughter to me to have her eyes fitted for glasses. They stated that she had been to different doctors and opticians and no one had ever given satisfaction. They said she was all right every other way if her eyes were properly fitted with glasses. They did not want her examined or treated otherwise because she would be well every other way with correct glasses. Her vision was right eye 5-20, left eye 5-15 or about one-fom^th vision in each eye. A plus .87 diopter sphere combined with a plus 3 diopter cylinder in axis 90 gave her perfectly normal 5-5 vision in each eye. This gave her perfect satisfaction until she started to school in September, a couple of months later. Before the end of the first month she was having trouble with her eyes and was again sent to me by her parents. Her v^ision was reduced to 6-15 in each €ye with her glasses on. She wondered and no doubt the parents did, if it was not another case of a misfit in glasses similar to all her previous experiences. This time I insisted upon a thorough physical examina- tion against all protest. The following lesions were discovered: the left innominate was up and back or tilted posteriorly, first lumbar anter- ior and to the right, sixth and first dorsals to the right. The case was not refracted again. I took particular care the first time and I was quite sure the refractive error was corrected. It was all explained to the parents and regular osteopathic treatment was begun. In less than a month practically every lesion was corrected, her vision returned to normal and she also was cured of an annoying backache with which she had been bothered for years. Her nerves were depleted a great deal. She got benefit in ways that she had not dreamed of. This approach to the eye is not considered by physicians in general, even the oculists. I have had about ten special courses in medical colleges and hospitals on the eye, ear, nose and throat, and I have never heard anything mentioned 186 The Practice of Osteopathy that would indicate any ideas of the logic involved in this case. Surely osteopathy has much to offer in eye troubles that is new and unique. The osteopathic examination of the eye then should begin with the feet, goins then to the innominates, lumbar, dorsal, ribs and cervical regions. Ocu- lists are too prone to rely upon crutches (glasses) in the treatment of asthenopia. It is easy for the osteopath to conceive how lesions of the upper dorsal and cerAdcal regions may occur and disturb the nerve and blood supply to the eye. This is why asthenopia appears so frequently with ordinary use of the eyes, even without abuse or refractive errors. The Lumbar Region The lumbar region should bs rarefuUy examined, especially for any curvature which might cause a disturbance of the equilibrium above. Compensatory curv^ss or individual lesions would be the result with a consequent interference with the integi'ity of the nervous reflexes to the eye. The Dorsal Region The same may be said of the dorsal region as of the lumbar in re- gard to curvatures. There is one individual lesion in this region that very frequently exists with eye troubles, i. e., the 2nd dorsal vertebra lateral. Any of the upper four dorsals in lesion maybe a causative factor in predisposing to disease of the eye but it has been my observation that the 2nd is involved most often. In severe headaches due to eye strain from refractive error, a good diagnostic symptom is tenderness and con- traction at the 2nd dorsal even when there is no subluxation. The Cervical Region This region should have particular care in search for individual lesions. It is quite easy to pass over some small cervical lesion that may be causing serious disturbance, especially if the neck happens to be fleshy. I have corrected cervical lesions and stopped twitching of the eyelids (orbicularis palpebrarum) and other muscles about the face. The first case I ever saw was twenty-two years ago when I was a junior at Kirksville. Dr. F. P. Millard, now of Toronto, was a room mate of mine. He was constantly annoyed by a twitchmg of an eyelid. I did not find any lesion for it. We went one day to see Dr. Still at his home and told him of our difficulty. He said without examination that the 3rd cervical was in lesion. There was a senior student present whom the "Old Doctor" directed how to use the proper technique. There was The Practice of Osteopathy 187 a sharp pop, the vertebra evidently went into right relation, the twitch- ing stopped. I understand the patient has had very little trouble since. Injuries, exposure and strains to the spine may have antedated an innominate lesion and caused weak joints, muscular and ligamentous tension, local inflammations and partial immobilization of joints. All this would have its modifying effects upon the manifestation of secondary lesions from the innominate abnormality. This makes the study of the bony relations very complex and the effect upon the numerous blood vessels, nerves and other soft tissues still more complicated. The Ciliospinal Center Following osteopathic examination and giving proper importance to lesions below the fourth dorsal vertebra, we must remember a special significance to be attached to lesions of the upper dorsal in relation to the eye. Almost any author on nervous diseases or diagnosis will discuss this center. Many of us have it not sufficiently impressed, hence I repeat some known relations. The ciliospinal center consists of a nuclear group of cells in the lateral horn of the last cervical and two upper dorsal segments of the spinal cord. From this nucleus fibers pass to the anter- ior division of the eighth cervical and first and second dorsal nerves and become the white rami communicantes which are efferent in their func- tion. These fibers pass to the inferior cervical sympathetic ganglion, thence upward with the sympathetic trunk through the middle and superior cervical sympathetic ganglia, along the carotid plexus to the vessels of the face and eye, to the glands of that region, to the un- striped muscular fibers of the levator palpebrse superioris and to the dilator pupillae muscle. Any strong feeling or emotion (which of course is perceived and in- terpreted by the brain cortex) will cause a dilatation of the pupil of the eye. The cervical sympathetic being cut, dilatation does not take place. The rami of the cervical, first and second dorsal cut, the phenomenon stops. It is evident the ciliospinal center is under the influence of a center or centers in the brain. Bing says "There is even an idiomotor mydriasis, which may be brought about by a ver3^ vivid mental concep- tion of darkness. " It has been noted that paralyzing lesions of the cervical sympathetic, of the last cervical and two upper dorsal segments of the cord, and of the anterior roots and rami communicantes of the same, will result in myosis. 188 The Practice of Osteopathy The efferent rami are also vasomotor, secretory and trophic. It must necessarily follow that congestive and inflammatory conditions, secretory perversion of the lachrymal, Meibomian, Zeissian and perspira- tory glands, and disturbance of the normal nutrition of any of the orbital tissues may result from lesions of the lower cervical and upper dorsal vertebrae. Osteopathically we know that such a lesion may not be sufficient to be paralytic in its effect, but stimulatory. In this case we may note a pupil habitually too wide and more or less photophobia from a super- abundance of light. The unstriped muscle fibers in the levator palpebrse superioris may be unduly contracted making an appearance of a slightly bulging eyeball when it is only a wide open eye. One who has eye strain from a refractive error, overuse of the eyes, or unbalanced muscles will as a rule have tenderness at some spot in the region of the ciliospinal center. A mechanical lesion at that part of the spine may or may not exist in such conditions, but I believe the soreness is there every time. This is one of the diagnostic points in differentiating headache of eye strain from other conditions. White rami are only in the dorsal region and to the second lumbar and from the second, third and fourth sacral. It has been noted that lesions of the cervical vertebrae do not have as profound an effect upon the eyes as do lesions of the first three dorsal vertebrae. The plausible explanation of that is that the cervical vertebrae have no white rami from their corresponding nerves in the bulbo-spino-sympathetic-ciliary arc as have the upper dorsal. From all the foregoing statements one can readily contemplate the intricate complexity of our osteopathic problems in relation to the eye. Combine this logic of the lesions outlined and the ramifications of the structures with their normal and perverted functions and combine it with contributing causes, such as infection, exposure, irritants, etc., and amidst the great diversity we reduce much miscellaneous, unclassified material to a degree of simpHcity. Many otherwise unexplainable con- ditions become reasonably clear. Dr. Louisa Burns under "The Experimental Demonstration of Osteopathic Centers" has this to say: '^Somatic Reflexes" "In the first series of experiments, the electrodes were placed upon the nasal mucous membrane of animals under anesthesia. The muscles near the third thoracic vertebra were at once strongly contracted The Practice of Osteopathy 189 "The electrodes were then placed upon the conjunctivae. The muscles near the second vertebra were then contracted. There were also slight and inconstant contractions of the cervical muscles "The electrodes were placed upon the eye ball. The muscular con- tractions were sometimes noted near the second thoracic vertebra, but the reaction was not constant. The cervical muscles were scarcely contracted at all. "The electrodes were placed upon the outer surface of the eye lids. The facial muscles were contracted very quickly and forcibly, but no contraction of the muscles of the upper dorsal region were noted "The superior cervical ganglion was exposed to view, and the electrodes placed upon it. The pupils became greatly dilated, the con- junctivae beoime hghter in color, and the mucous membranes of the nose and throat were also lightened "The Gasserian ganglion was exposed to view. The ganglion was stimulated directly. The upper thoracic muscles were very strongly contracted, and the blood vessels in the area of the distribution of the fifth nerve were immediately and strongly contracted. Some of the sjrmpathetic fibers are carried by way of the fifth nerve. In order to ex- clude the effect of the direct stimulation of these fibers, the fifth nerve was cut, and the central end was stimulated by the electrodes. The muscles of the upper thoracic region were contracted, as before. The vessels in the area of distribution of the fifth nerve were contracted after latent period of a minute or so "The stimulation of the central end of the cut fifth nerve caused strong muscular contractions in the upper thoracic region, and also constriction of the vessels in the area of distribution of the fifth. Direct stimulation of the superior cervical ganglion produced effects identical with those produced before the mutilation. "The spinal cord was cut above and below the superior cervical ganglion. This cut was made from behind, and the sympathetic chain was uninjured. The effects noted after both operations were the same, and can be described as one. "The stimulation of any cranial structure failed to cause reflex contraction of the muscles in the upper dorsal or the cervical region. "Stimulation of the cranial structures did not produce any vascular changes except those which might be referred to the direct effects of the electricity upon the vessel walls. 190 The Practice of Osteopathy "Direct stimulation of the superior cervical ganglion produced the effects noted before mutilation. "Therefore the cervical portion of the spinal cord is an essential element of the reflex arc by way of which sensory impulses from the cranial structures are able to affect the condition of the upper dorsal muscles, and also in the path by which these impulses are able to affect the size of the blood vessels of the cranial structures themselves "Mechanical stimulation of the tissues near the second thoracic spine was followed by a contraction of the blood vessels of the cranial mucous membranes and the conjunctivae, by a dilatation of the pupils, and an increased secretion of saUva. These effects were practically in- variable "The superior cervical ganglion was subjected to mechanical stim- ulation by the manipulation of the tissues over it. In animals, this maneuver was followed by dilatation of the pupils and by a contraction of the cranial vessels, which was soon followed, if the stimulation con- tinued, by a dilatation which was rather persistent. "After the extirpation of the Gasserian ganglion without the injury of the sympathetic nerves, the mechanical stimulation of the tissues near the second and third thoracic vertebrae caused the same vaso- constriction and pupilo-dilation as was observed in the animal before mutilation. "After the destruction of the cervical portion of the sympathetic chain, and after the extirpation of the Gasserian ganglion in most ani- mals, the mechanical stimulation of the tissues in the upper dorsal region did not produce any perceptible effects "Mechanical stimulation of the tissues near the second and third thoracic spines caused dilatation of the pupils and contraction of the vessels of the cranial mucous membranes. "Inhibition, or the maintenance of an artificial lesion, caused dila- tation of the vessels of the nasal mucous membranes and of the con- junctivffi. The eye ball was also somewhat congested. The pupils were dilated in tliis case also." The Nose and Throat in Eye Trouble An examination of the eye would not be complete without a careful inspection of the nose and throat. The same nerve and blood supply that go to the eye is tied up so definitely with the nose and throat that when there are lesions of the nose and throat the eye is often affected The Practice op Osteopathy 191 secondarily. Just recently a case of dacryocystitis came into my office. After I had carefully examined her eye, spine, nose and throat, she informed me that she had been to three eye speciaHsts before and not one of them had ever looked at her nose and throat, not to mention the spine. She had cervical and dorsal lesions, and diseased tonsils. The inferior turbinate on the side of the dacryocystitis was curled out so that it lay against the external wall of the nose almost if not altogether blocking the entrance of the lacrymal duct to the inferior meatus. This was evidently the predisposing cause of her dacryocystitis. In neuralgia of the eye, blepharitis, obscure pain, conjunc- tivitis and often deeper troubles you will find a bad condition of the nasopharynx, such as adenoids, vegetations, pus pockets, adhesions in the fossa of Rosenmuller, contraction of the soft palate, disturbed re- lations of the septum and turbinates, sinus trouble, poor drainage, ex- ostoses and polyps. In eye disease all these things should be discovered if they are present, in order to get best results and in order to make a careful diagnosis. Examination of the Eye by Special Methods The first thing after the family history, personal history, inspection of the eye and the osteopathic examination, is to find out how well the patient can see. To test the acuteness of vision certain test letters are used. Snellen's Test Letters are good. The normal eye can read 3-8 inch letters at twenty feet. The test letters on the cards usually range in size to be read at 10, 15, 20, 30, 40, 50, 70, 100 and 200 feet. The most desirable distance is 20 feet. If at the distance of twenty feet he reads the 3-8 inch letters his acuteness of vision would be marked 20-20 or normal. Always use the distance between patient and chart as the numerator of the fraction and the number above the letters which he reads as the denominator. If he is twenty feet away, the numerator re- mains twenty and the denominator changes according to the line of letters seen on the test cards thus: 20-15, 20-30, 20-70, or 20-200 may express the vision. If the patient could not see the 200 feet letters at 20 feet he must be brought nearer, say 10 feet, for him to see the large letters; his vision would be 10-200. These fractions representing the acuteness of vision may be expressed in meters. Some charts have letters numbered that way. If the vision is good enough for small objects to be clear, the near point should be taken. This would show the amount of accommodation of the eye. This is expressed in diopters. 192 The Practice of Osteopathy A diopter is the unit of measurement of the refractive power of lenses. Leases are numbered by their refractive power in diopters. A lens that ha^ a curvature that will refract parallel rays of light and bring them to a focus at one meter distance is said to be a one diopter lens. This unit of measurement for the refractive power of lenses was proposed by Nagel in 1866. It soon became quite generally used. The focal distance of a lens decreases as the strength of a lens in- creases. One diopter lens (written ID) has a focus of one meter (1 M) or 100 cm distance. A 2 D lens has a focal distance of 1-2 M or 50 cm. A 4 D lens has 25 cm focal distance and a 1-2 D lens has 100 cm-f- | = 200 cm distance or 2 M. Trial cases have in them lenses varying in strength from .12 D or .25 D to 20 D of the spheric form. We will not discuss the trial case here. Accommodation in the Eye Accommodation in the eye is the ability of the eye to vary its focal point. Wlien the normal eye (emmetropic) is at rest its focal point is at infinity so far as parallel rays are concerned. This is called the far- point or the "punctum remotum** (P. R.), When the eye looks at letters twenty feet away it scarcely accom- modates at all to get a focus, or so Httle that it may be disregarded in ordinary practice. Now if one brings fine print close to the eye he will find a point so close that it becomes indistinct. This point is the near- point of focus or the "punctum proximum" (P. P.). The range of accommodation is the difference between the refractive power of the eye when it is at rest and whan the accommodation is exerted to the utmost, the difference between the P. R. and the P. P. If one must accommodate one diopter to get a focus at one meter or forty inches distance, at thirteen inches or reading distance one must accommodate at least 3 D in order to see the letters clearly. If 3 D were the total of his accommodation he could not read at that distance but a few minutes; because the accommodation could not be held at its maxi- mum for long at a time. Eye strain with its train of symptoms would result. Hence it is quite important to find the near-pomt or punctum proximum in order to judge in regard to eye strain in an emmetropic eye. If there is a refractive error, allowance for it must be made accordingly. As a person gets older the accommodation in the eye becomes less and less until at 45 years of age he can only use 4 to 5 D of accommoda- tion. This is so close to the amount required for reading that he has some eye strain. He begins to hold his paper farther away from him so The Practice of Osteopathy 193 he requires less accommodation. This condition we call "old sight" or presbyopia. An emmetropic eye at forty-five to fifty years of age re- quires a plus glass to make up for some accommodation in reading. Frequently there are latent disturbances of equihbrium of the ex- trinsic muscles of the eye. This is heterophoria. If it is a latent con- vergence it is esophoria; if a latent divergence it is exophoria. The latter is more frequent. Hyper- and hypophoria are used for upward or downward tendencies. Normal muscular balance is orthophoria. Cause the patient to fix on an object about thirteen inches away with both eyes; push a sheet of paper in front of one eye and watch be- hind the paper, the eye thus covered. If heterophoria exists the eye will move sUghtly from its point of fixation since it no longer sees the object. In orthophoria it will remain fixed as long as the other eye sees the ob ect ; the innervation to the different muscles is properly distributed. A Maddox rod found in any complete trial case may be placed before one eye. Have the patient fix on a candle flame, say twenty feet away. The flame appears drawn out into a luminous line. This line can not be fused with the candle flame as the other eye sees it if there is hetero- phoria. The amount and kind of disturbance is somewhat indicated by the distance and direction of the luminous line and the flame. The ex- act amount can be measured by the use of a prism that will cause them to fuse. Next the patient should be taken to the dark room and a careful inspection of the anterior segment of the eye should be made with oblique iUumination. First use the unaided eye, then use a lens that magnifies. The 20 D plus lens from your trial case will suffice for the magnification. Note the transparency or lack of it in the cornea and crystalline lens; the depth of the anterior chamber and the appearance of the pupil and iris. Now we are ready for the ophthalmoscopic examination. The Ophthalmoscope. — This is an instrument that commands great respect. Any one who is interested in eye troubles must have and use the ophthalmoscope if he expects to be efficient in diagnosis, upon which, of course, intelKgent treatment must forever depend. One must try and try again in order to become proicient in the use of the oph- thalmoscope. A Schematic Eye is of great assistance to a beginner who does not have clinics or patients on whom to practice. Such an eye with full di- rections can be obtained at almost any optical goods store. It will make the study of ophthalmoscopy easy and interesting. The pupil can 194 The Practice of Osteopathy be regulated to any size and the eye can be made short (hyperopic), long (myopic) or normal (emmetropic) for study. The efficient use of the ophthalmoscope makes the diagnosis of in- ternal diseases of the eye as easy as the diagnosis of external diseases of the eye. Only some rare conditions will puzzle, and that is true of any part of the anatomy. The ophthalmoscope is a simple instrument; its chief function is to illuminate the interior of the eye. The value of ophthalmoscopic findings depends on their correct interpretation by the examiner. The ophthalmoscope has a mirror to reflect the light into the eye. It has two discs on which are mounted convex (plus) and concave (min- us) lenses. The larger disc has seven plus and eight minus lenses. To these may be added the lenses in the smaller disc making many com- binations. A drop of a 2% solution of cocaine or homatropine may be used as a mydriatic where one can not otherwise see clearly the fundus. If no mydriatic is used a somewhat weak illumination should be employed in order not to arouse the accommodation to much activity and make the pupil small. If there is any opacity in the media a strong illumination should be used. The room should be dark; the darker the better. There are two methods of using the ophthalmoscope. The in- direct and the direct methods. One is more useful at one time and the other at another time. By the indirect method we view the whole field of the fundus more readily but less in detail. With the ophthalmoscope before his eye the examiner's face is twelve to fifteen inches from that of the patient. When the '**red reflex" of the eye is seen a plus 13 or 16 D lens is interposed near the patient's eye. This magnifies the field. The image is inverted. As a rule it is best seen with a +4 D lens in the aperture of the ophthalmoscope. This method is especially more satisfactory in high degrees of my- opia and astigmatism. The optic disc is the objective point. One may see a retinal vessel first; this should be followed to its emergence from the disc. From this point view all parts of the fundus by having the patient look in different directions. This is better by the indirect method than for the examiner to vaiy his position. The direct method of ophthahnoscopy is better for detail work and in all cases except high degrees of myopia and astigmatism. It is also better in determining errors of refraction. The patient looks straight across the room. For a beginner it may be essential to dilate the pupil, hence the schematic eye as suggested. The Practice of Osteopathy 195 If the examiner has a refractive error, he should wear his own glasses or correct by throwing in front of his eye proper lenses in the ophthal- moscope. Face the patient and sit on the side of the eye to be examined. Use left eye to examine the patiet's left eye and right eye for the pa- tient's right. Examiner and patient keep both eyes open. The ex- aminer may not be able to suppress the image of his other eye and may have to close it part of the time. Catch the ''red reflex" some 15 to 18 inches away and move close to the patient's eye. The "red reflex" color varies with the error of refraction, the transparency of the media, the degree of pigmentation and the size of the pupil. A blood clot will make it redder, some exudates will make it gray or yellow. The examiner may approach as close as half an inch from the eye to be examined. Find the optic disc and examine all points of the fun- dus from it. Rotate in glasses to correct the patient's refractive error if he has any. The strongest plus glass with which the fine retinal vessels can be clearly seen will represent the hyperopia of the eye. This is true only if the examiner's accommodation is at rest. The weakest minus glass with which the fine retinal vessels can be clearly seen repre- sents the myopia. A Normal Fundus. — The color of the fundus is due to the blood vessels of the retina and choroid and the connective tissue of the chor- roid and sclera. Variation is due to the pigment. In the albino it is Kght pink. In the negro it is dark reddish. There are all gradations between the two. The optic disc is the end of the optic nerve as it comes into the eye; it is circular in shape, pink in color, and sharply defined. It is about l-16th of an inch in diameter; about 15° to the nasal side of the pole of the eye and slightly above the horizontal. There may be a dark choroidal ring around the disc or part way around. There may also be a white ring caused by the sclera. As a rule there is a depression in the center of the disc out of which the retinal vessels emerge and spread out over the fundus. The fovea centralis or point of clearest vision is located two and a half disc diameters to the temporal side of the disc. Around this is a circular area of Hght yellow, the macula lutea. The subject of ophthalmoscopy has been touched upon somewhat in detail because of its great importance to the general practitioner. Every osteopathic physician should know the ophthalmoscope well enough to recognize the ordinary lesions inside the eye. When we take up pathological conditions of the eye we will have occasion frequently 196 The Practice of Osteopathy to refer to the ophthalmoscopic appearance. Without the use of this instrument aU of our cUnical field research on internal diseases of the eye is valueless. Many have told me they have cured cataract with osteopathic treatment, some say they have cured specific neuroretinitis with no sequelae, others testify to opacities and bhndness from various causes. Invariably we ask if they used the ophthahnoscope in their diagnosis and with it watched the progress of the case. Abiiost invari- ably the answer is "no, it looked hke it," "the s>Tnptoms indicated it," or "Dr. so and so, an ocuhst diagnosed it as such." Fellow Osteopaths! we can not base our claims on this kind of data. With a little study and practice the ophthalmoscope can be mastered. Not till then can we get reHable statistics on internal diseases of the eye in our case reports. Os- teopathy has much to reveal to us in this field and for the sake of the science and our patients we appeal to every one to do the work here set forth. Diseases of the Eye Osteopathic Manipulation for Eye Diseases A general correction of lesions should be made in order to give per- fect aligmnent and equilibrium. Lesions that affect the nerve and blood suppl}^ will be found from the fourth thoracic to the occiput ; more often at the occiput, atlas and axis in the cervical region and the second and third thoracic in the dorsal region including the ribs. Correction of these lesions must have specific attention in every case of eye disease that shows any tendency to chronicity or in repeated eye disease and exacerbations. A thorough upper spinal treatment to insure good mobility of all joints and establish freedom of fluids and forces is recommended. The nose, throat and sinuses should be examined for pathology. If the tonsils and pharynx are not normal the cotted index finger should be introduced into the mouth until the anterior pillar of the fauces is reached. A mouth gag may or may not be used. Massage the tonsil through the anterior pillar then move to the top and press down on the tonsil with a pumping motion. Repeat this from below the tonsil and posteriorly. Slip the finger under the soft palate and stretch it thor- oughly. Clean out any adhesions and vegetations in the vault of the nasopharynx and fossa of RosenmuUer. Stretch the pillars of the fauces by pressing down on each side at the root of the tongue. If the sinuses are diseased they should be drained. If the nose is dis- eased and has abundance of secretion, first use irrigation for cleanhness. The Pkactice of Osteopathy 197 Manipulation in the nose will be of great benefit in some eye dis- eases as pa,thology there frequently has an important bearing on diseases of the eye. The nose is often too narrow and contracted. The first inch of the nose is muscular and cartilaginous; it is of even more importance to dilate the nose in contractured conditions than it is the sphincters at the lower end of the rectum. The great benefit derived from rectal dila- tation has been recognized for years. In dilating the contracted nose a wide blade nasal speculum may be used. The cotted and oiled httle finger may be used where it is properly adapted in size. The dilating can be done with practically no pain and no damage to membranes or other tissues. It should not be extended beyond the cartilaginous and muscular part. Manipulation of the turbinates and tissue further back may be done if needed, by the use of instruments. The Edwards turbinate adjuster instrumefnt (Aloe Co., St. Louis) or the Ruddy Nasal Third Finger (Sharp and Smith, Chi- cago) are the best instruments so far devised for this operation. A thorough stretching of the eyelids, manipulation of the eye ball and the points of the fifth nerve are indicated in many diseases. The hds may be stretched by pulling them from side to side. The cotted forefinger well oiled (sterile vaseline) may be slipped into the conjunctival sac back of either lid and with the thumb on the outside the hd may be massaged or stretched in any direction. The points of the fifth nerve may readily be infiuenced at their respective exits about the orbit. The eye ball and deeper contents of the orbit can be pro- foundly treated by pressing the finger into the orbit above, below and at the sides of the bulb and pushing it in all directions as far as possible. The Ruddy eye finger instrument was devised for this deep manipula- tion of the orbital and bulbar structures. It is of high value. One finger may be laid on the closed eye and with a tapping motion with the other hand a vibration or oscillation of the orbital structures may be had. This is a useful treatment. The wise selection and skillful use of these various methods of treat- ment for the eye will solve most of our difficulties. This short survey of osteopathic methods will aid us in the more specific discussions to follow. Neuralgia A convsiderablc number of people seem to be subject to attacks of pain in one or both eyes. These attacks of pain come at varying inter- vals; in some cases several times a day, in others as far apart as one or two weeks. The pain will suddenly start almost without warning and 198 The Practice of Osteopathy with very little provocation, and last from one to twenty-four hours. It is very severe and the patient frequently thinks something terrible is wrong. Something terrible is wrong so far as his comfort is concerned. But in these cases to which I am referring there is no organic trouble with the eye. The patient does not need glasses. There is no sign of in- flammation. Vision is not disturbed. Local examination of the eye with the ophthalmoscope reveals that the fundus of the eye is normal. There is no S3anptom connected with the eye except pain, occasionally accompanied by a slight redness. I have had several cases in my own practice and my attention has been directed to cases of other physicians. These cases differ from tic douloureux in that there is no muscular spasm. In fact, motor nerves do not seem to be involved. The involve- ment seems to be largely in the fifth cranial nerve, usually the supra- orbital, or other smaller branches of the ophthalmic division of the fifth cranial. Sometimes we note shght dilatation of the pupil with more or less congestion. This would indicate an involvement of the sympa- thetic branch to the eye. The lesions discovered in these cases have been a subluxation of the occiput upon the atlas or an upper cervical lesion and frequently some involvement at the second dorsal. There has been noted also trouble in the nasopharynx such as contractures of the muscles of the soft pal- ate and adhesions in the fossa of Rosenmuller. Misplacements of the uterus have also been found in some cases. Treatment Nearly all these cases are curable with from one week to six weeks treatment. Of course the treatment must be inteUigently directed after a correct diagnosis as to the cause. The cause can usually be re- moved. One case to which my attention has been directed was that of a woman about forty years of age who had very severe pains. With all the local treatment of the eye and otherwise she got practically no results until she had replacement of the uterus, which brought immed- iate relief. Other cases have no trouble on that kind but have lesions of the cervical region and on correction of these lesions the neuralgia dis- appears. Other cases have had the nasopharynx cleaned out by the finger operation and this stretching of the soft palate which relieved the neuralgia immediately or in a few days. Numbers of cases have been to medical physicians and had various eye remedies administered locally with no permanent benefit. Of course the treatment was administered at the wrong place. The Practice of Osteopathy 199 The ramifications of the sympathetic and fifth cranial nerves are so complex and far-reaching that we must keep in mind that one or more of many causes for the trouble may exist and be quite remote from the seat of the pain. Diseases of the Eyelids Occasional factors are bee stings or insect bites, which completely occlude the palpebral fissure. We may have some palpebral edema from Hd abscesses, chalazion, hordeolum, dacryocystitis, panophthalmia and so forth. In hemorrhagia subdermalis there is so much spongy tissue beneath the skin about the eye that the blood extends easily and far. The red tint will soon change to a reddish blue and then become dark, what is known as a black eye (ecchymosis). This frequently results from a blow. The skin is sharply attached around the orbital margin by tense connective tissue so the area of the hemorrhage is limited to the region of the orbit. There may be spontaneous rupture of some of the vessels by hard sneezing or coughing, especially in young children. In older people it may indicate a fragile condition of the vessels, arterio- sclerosis or some trouble with the kidneys. The diagnosis of the eye condition is not difficult but the cause of the hemorrhage in that region might be investigated further. Local treatment is of some value in these conditions. They may be soothed by cold compresses. In bee stings and insect bites use an alkahne compress. Manipulation about the eye and osteopathic treatment of the neck with a view to directing a better circulation to that region will aid much. Herpes Zoster Ophthalmia This affection of the supraorbital branch of the fifth cranial nerve may extend to the eyelids. It may not go beyond the stage of blistering and redness with some edema. However, it is possible for it to become gangrenous and even extend to the conjunctiva and cornea. I had one case of herpes zoster gangrenosa of this region. There were several gangrenous spots as large as a dime on the forehead and extending down in the region of the eyelid. The process extended to some extent on the cornea and in heahng left a condition of irregular astigmatism. Treatment. — The prognosis in herpes zoster is always favorable under osteopathic treatment. Lesions of the cervical region will almost invariably be found interfering with the sympathetic connections of the fifth cranial nerve causing the trophic disturbance to the region. Osteopathic treatment applied to these conditions will always hasten normahzation. The affected part might be kept covered with some sooth- ing lotion to keep the skin soft. 200 The Practice of Osteopathy Hordeolum This is commonly known as a sty. It is due to suppuration of the glands of Zeiss. It is a harmless affection but causes pain and in- convenience. Diagnosis. — Swelling and pain with a small inflammed nodule in the palpebral margin is quite diagnostic. Treatment. — The circulation is obstructed in this region. The effort should be made to open the circulation before pus has formed. This can frequently be done and the hordeolum aborted by carefully picking up the eyelid and rolling the nodule between the fingers. This will cause some pain but if it is kept up for a moment or two about every hour through the day with an occasional thorough treatment of the neek the sty will usually be aborted. If pus forms it should be opened as soon as it points and then the squeezing and rolhng process may be em- ployed again, wliich will aid rapidly in the freeing of the circulation. Chalazion This is a Meibomian cyst in the eyelid. It shows as a circum- scribed swelling on the inner side of the hd. It frequently becomes large enough to produce some deformity of the lid. A chalazion is mov- able on the tarsal cartilage. It is a chronic condition and the cyst may become as large as a bean. There may be more than one in the same lid. Treatment. — When a chalazion is small and not of long standing it can frequently be cured by osteopathic treatment. Introduce the finger into the conjunctival sac under the Hd, and with the thumb ex- ternally, grasp the chalazion between the finger and thumb; roll it thor- oughly. Squeeze and massage it two or three times a week for awhile. This, combined with a thorough treatment of the neck, will result in a cure. If at the end of six weeks the condition has not disappeared sur- gery should be resorted to. Blepharitis This is an inflammation of the eyehd. It is either acute or chronic according to the cause. Acute blepharitis may be due to heat or injury. Chronic blepharitis affects the glands of the lid causing a perversion of the secretions. There is usually the formation of crusts and scales. This, condition is known as blepharitis sicca. In some cases infection will form httle pustules at the roots of the ciha. There is soreness and aching. There may be photophobia. The nasal region may be in- The Peactice of Osteopathy 201 volved. Osseous lesions of the cervical region are usually present. Re- fractive errors frequently exist in these cases. Occupation or envir- onment may expose to dust or wind sufficient to keep up the irritation. Treatment. — Change environment. See that there is thorough cleanliness of the hd. Rub or pick away all scales. Use a bland oint- ment. Correct any cervical or upper dorsal lesions. Ptosis This is congenital or acquired. In congenital ptosis operation seems to be the only treatment. Acquired ptosis is amenable to treat- ment frequently. The cause is some lesion interfering with the passage of proper nerve force to the levator muscle of the hd. The lesion may be at the origin of the third nerve, at the cortical nucleus in the sigmoid gyrus or in the trunk of the third nerve, or a lesion of the muscle itself. Tumor, trauma, syphihs, sclerosis, hemorrhage, gout or rheumatism, or anything that will produce a peripheral neuritis are causative factors. Lesions of the cervical and upper dorsal by reflecting back upon the nerve centers may produce a ptosis. Treatment.— Remedial measures according to indications. Cases due to osteopathic lesions as indicated will usually yield readily to treat- ment. Where there are other factors treatment must be varied accord- ingly. Trichiasis This is a condition in which part or all of the eye lashes turn in- ward and touch the eye ball, due to cicatricial contractions in the con- junctiva and tarsus. Many of the ciha are so small in these conditions that it is very difficult to see them. A loupe or a magnifying glass must be used in order to discover them. Dystrichiasis is a condition where the ciha come in irregularly growing in all directions, some of them turning in toward the eye ball and causing irritation. Treatment. — Anepilatory should be used to extract all of the wild hairs. Care should be taken to get out the finest ones as they will fre- quently cause irritation if not removed. Entropion and Ectropion Entropion is a turning in of the eyelid and ectropion is a turning out. These conditions may be spasmodic and temporary. Entropion is more often due to cicatricial contraction in old blepharitis or trachoma conditions. In some cases the condition may be corrected by the use of 202 The Practice of Osteopathy strips of adhesive plaster. In cicatricial conditions operation is the rule. Spasmodic ectropion may be corrected sometimes by curing the con- junctivitis. Bandaging may be resorted to. In paralytic ectropion os- teopathic treatment may serve to produce a complete cm*e. Operative procedm-e should he a last resort. Diseases of the Lachrymal Apparatus Dacryocystitis Dacryocystitis is an inflammation of the .lacrj^inal sac. It is due to some lesion in the nose, malposition of the inferior turbinate or a poor blood and nerve supply to the lacrymal region as determined by cervical lesions. The sac becomes infected and we have a dacryocystoblen- norrhea. Pus and tears are regurgitated into the eye through the puncta. There is irritation and the conjunctiva may become infected at any time, also the cornea. It is a dangerous and annoying affection. Treatment. — Osteopathic measures have something to offer along this line. The medical idea seems to be completely surgical in recent years. The first and only thing to be done surgically is to obhterate the sac or dissect it out and currette the nasal duct, completely destroying the apparatus. Lancing does not affect a cure. By treating for a good nerve and blood supply to that region, the irrigation of the nose and a thorough squeezing of the sac each time with a view to forcing the solu- tion in the sac down through the nasal duct into the nose, a cure may be effected in many cases. If these cases can be gotten before infection has taken place, in the state of epiphora or the backing up of the tears into the eye, thorough treatment along the lines just indicated will in nearl}^ all cases result in a cure. Boric acid solution should be used to wash out the sac when pus is present. The attempt should be made to force it into the nose. Prob- ing properly done is of value in many cases. These cases should be followed up with great care. Treat the neck thoroughly and spring the inferior maxilla. Diseases of the Conjunctiva Conjunctivitis The conjunctiva is a mucous membrane that coats the posterior surface of the eyelids and the anterior surface of the eye-ball. It forms a sac, which is slit open in front in the Une of the palpebral fissure. The conjunctiva consists of three parts (1) the conjunctiva tarsi, the part on the hds; (2) the conjunctiva bulbi, the part on the eyeball, The Practice of Osteopathy 203 and (3) the conjunctiva fornicis, the part connecting the first and sec- ond ; it is the retrotarsal fold or the region of transition, often called the fornix. The first part can be seen by everting the lids. It is adherent to the tarsus. It is covered with a laminated cylindrical epithelium. The membrane contains an abundance of lymphocytes similar to ade- noid tissue. This increases with every inflammation of the conjunctiva. This is why chronic conjusactivitis often results in thickened lids. The blood supply of the conjunctiva of the lids is from the muscu- lar branches of the ophthalmic artery. The nerve supply is from the ophthalmic division of the 5th cranial and the sympathetic. The bulbar conjunctiva continues over the cornea. It is covered with layers of pavement epithehum. Its blood supply comes from the posterior conjunctival vessels about the retrotarsal fold, and the anterior cihary arteries which accompany the tendons of recti muscles; these two systems anastomose in the conjunctiva. Conjunctival injection or con- gestion shows a superficial net work of larger or smaller vessels that move with the conjunctiva. The color is scarlet or brick red. Ciliary injec- tion occurs as a rose red or pale violet zone around the cornea, spoken of as peri- or circum-corneal injection. It does not move with the con- juctiva and occurs more with diseases of the cornea, iris and cihary body. In the etiology of conjunctivitis a great variety of germs are con- sidered by different writers. CoUins and Mayo give a report of "germs found in normal conjunctiva. " Bacillus Xerosus in 94% of normal conjunctivae ; Staphylococcus Albus in 79%; Pneumococcus in 9%; Diplobacillus in 6%; Staphylo- coccus Aureus in 6%; Streptococcus in 5%. If this be true, and I do not doubt their statement, we are prac- tically compelled to say that these germs at least are only secondary in the etiology of conjunctivitis. Just at this point osteopathy comes with its flood of Ught and makes it easily explainable why some conjunctivae become inflamed while others do not, when all have germs present. The lesion disturbing the integrity of blood supply and nerve force to the eye is the primary cause while the presence of germs may be the aggravating cause. The lesion prepares the soil in which the germs thrive sufficiently to become an irritant. There are aU gradations of this soil preparation. The more fertile the field (i. e. the more profound the effect of the lesion) the more virulent germ life may become; the resistance is proportion- ately less. Conjunctivitis is classifiecl for convenience in study, diagnosis and treatment as follows: 204 The Practice of Osteopathy (1) Catarrhal, (a) acute, (b) chronic, (c) folUcular; (2) gonorrhoeal; (3) ophthaknia neonatorum; (4) trachoma; (5) diphtheritic; (6) eczema- tosa (phlyctenulosa) ; (7) vernahs; (8) tubercular; (9) traumatic. This is the clinical classification after Fuch. Treatment of Conjunctivitis In order to give the best care in these cases it is quite essential that both the primary and secondary causes be given attention. Some good germicide or antiseptic is to be used with intelligence. This is in harmon}^ with the great principles of antisepsis and cleanliness taught by osteopathy from its inception. The use of the microscope in the bac- teriology of conjunctivitis aids in more definite diagnosis and the selec- tion of a proper germicide. For the Koch-Weeks bacillus, the pneumo- coccus and the influenza bacillus silver nitrate 1% or a 25% solution of argyrol is used; for the diplo bacillus (Morax-Axenfeld) zinc sulphate 1 gr. to the ounce is ahnost a specific. A good way to prepare the zinc prescription would be : Boracic acid and water oz. 1. Zinc sulphate gr. 1. The boric acid and water of course being a saturated solution. Apply one drop to each eye about four times a day. If one can not have the use of the microscope to make specific the diagnosis, the zinc solution may be alternated with the argyrol as the germicide. Ice cold applications are good in many of these cases. Catarrhal Conjunctivitis Acute — mostly affects the conjunctiva of the lids in the Ught form. If severe it invades the bulbar conjunctiva. There is redness and swell- ing and increased secretion which dries at night upon the edges of the lids and glues them together. The eyes are better in the morning and worse toward evening. Corneal ulcers and iritis may arise as compli- cations. Chronic inflammation may result. Etiology. — Textbooks on the eye give bacteria as the chief cause; some scarcely mention anything else. After discussing how the bacteria get there and multiply, they usually bring in some statement to indicate that in many cases no bacteria can be found in the secretions from the conjunctiva. These latter are unaccounted for in the etiolog3^ Catarrhal conjunctivitis is non-specific in its origin. The great science of osteopathy will fill in the missing Unks to works otherwise very exhaustive on the eye. The Practice of Osteopathy 205 If the cause is due only to a passing irritant as dust, smoke, pollen or wind the disturbance may vary from hyperemia only, to a severe attack of conjunctivitis. Fuch says the majority of cases are produced by bac- teria, but THAT IN NOT A FEW CASES OF CONJUNCTIVAL CATARRH THE EXAMINATION OF THE SECRETIONS FOR BACTERIA PROVES NEGATIVE. He also says that the usual course of the disease is from eight to fourteen days, but not infrequently there remains a condition of chronic CATARRH PROTRACTED OVER A LONG TIME ; THAT NOT INFREQUENTLY THE NORMAL CONJUNCTIVAL SAC CONTAINS PATHOGENIC GERMS. Some authors divide the etiology into (1) specific, (2) non-specific. The first they account for by irritants due to dust, heat, smoke, metal, pollen, cold, wind, glare of Kght, eye-strain from overwork of the eyes, ametropia and chronic alcohohsm. The second they account for by germ life, most often the Morax-Axenfeld diplobacillus or the Koch- Weeks bacillus, the latter germ being found in the so-called ''pink-eye." It is contagious. This is one condition for which the zinc sulphate (^% to 2% solution) is almost a specific. No doubt the irritants and the bacteria mentioned, with others, do cause much of our catarrhal conjunctivitis and that one who fails to consider properly the local conditions in practice wiU be sadly lacking in best results. On the other hand many cases, treated for local conditions only by very competent men who used the best antiseptics and germicides, have very indifferent results. The acute condition would continue and grad- ually become chronic. From observation, study and experience there are causes aside from local irritants, ametropia, bacteria, syphihs, rheuma- tism or measles. There is some disturbance to the integrity of the spino- ciliary sympathetic arc. In many cases of eye disease note lesion and tenderness at the upper dorsal, the removal of which will cause improve- ment of the eyes. Many cases of eye strain can be relieved by correction of the first, second or third dorsal, and the use of glasses made unnecessary. Irritation of the eye wiU cause more or less tension of the muscles at the second and third dorsal, and stimulation of the tissues near the second and third dorsal spines will cause dilatation of the pupils and contraction of vessels of the cranial mucous membranes; which means vasomotor, secretory and trophic disturl^ances. It follows then that an osteopathic lesion at the second or third dorsal will cause or tend to cause disease of the eye. There may be all gradations in the effect produced, the lighter being mere tendency, while again it may be enough to set up profound vasomotor, secretory and 206 The Practice of Osteopathy trophic changes in and about the eye. The first effect of the lesion may be stimulatory, and later, inhibitory. The normal resistance of the eye would be lowered and naturally, local irritants, bacteria and ametropia would have a more profound effect. This will explain how one can devel- op conjunctivitis in the absence of a local irritant with no bacteria pres- ent, and no eye strain. All of these causes, or any number of them, may be acting together, and each more virulent because of the influence of the other. Lesions of the occipito-atlantal joint or any of the cervical ar- ticulations may cause eye disturbance. There are no efferent rami-com- municantes in that region and the course of the physical disturbance must be greater in proportion to the eye trouble produced, than at the upper dorsal. It is important however to make a close examination of the entire cervical region in eye trouble. What has been said on the osteopathic causes of acute catarrhal conjunctivitis applies with equal force to chronic and follicular con- catarrhal conjunctivitis. What has been said on the osteopathic causes of acute catarrhal conjunctivitis apphes with even greater force to the chronic from. The great variety of local irritants may account for acute conjunctivitis, and does in most instances; but in chronic conjunctivitis local irritants are more often secondary or incidental while the osteopathic lesion with its effect upon the bulbo-spino-sympathetic ciliary arc is the funda- mental cause. Of course some continuous local irritant, e. g., an un- corrected refractive error, excessive Hght, heat, dust or germ Hfe in the environment may cause a chronic conjunctivitis. Other causes may be retracted hds (lagophthalmus) leaving the eyeballs too prominently ex- posed; turning in of the ciUa (entropion, trichiasis or dystrichiasis) which impinge upon and irritate the bulbar conjimctiva. Chronic blephar- itis may spread to the palpebral conjunctiva and then the bulbar. For- eign bodies in the eye, or infarction of Meibomian glands may be causes. The diplobacillus (Morax-Axenfeld) is the most common germ in chronic catarrhal conjunctivitis. Symptoms and Course. — In mild cases the redness is only mod- erate. The conjunctiva is smooth and not swollen. Old cases have hypertrophy with thickening. There was a small girl who came into the office recently who had the conjunctiva of the hds decidedly swollen with some hypertrophy. Her eyes were glued shut with pus every morn- ing. Pus pockets were forming along the folhcles of the cilia and on the direct edge of the fid. Her troubles started a year ago and got gradually The Practice of Osteopathy 207 worse. A few osteopathic treatments were given during three months (she was irregular in coming) and argyrol, 20%, used locally. All pus and debris were cleared off the lids and conjunctiva each time. The swelling all left and the thickening became inconsiderable; the eyes looked almost clear. On pressure there was tenderness at the right side of the second dorsal. No mechanical lesion was apparent there but in treat- ment that region was thoroughly loosened. The subjective symptoms are usually worse at night; pain, heavi- ness of the lids; feeling of a foreign body in the eye; burning; itching and dryness in many cases. This condition is one of the most frequent of eye diseases in adults; may be senile catarrh in advanced age. It is frequently complicated with blepharitis, ectropion, epiphora and ulcerations of the cornea. Treatment. — The osteopathic treatment depends on the findings in the osteopathic examination. No case of chronic catarrhal conjunc- tivitis should be treated without a thorough examination of the whole spinal, rib and innominate mechanism. Careful and detailed adjustment should be made of any lesions that might disturb the ciHary arc, the other nerve connections, the blood supply or the body equiHbrium. This does not mean that local treatment of the eye should be neg- lected in any way. Any measure that will aid in getting rid of local pathology as quickly as possible should be ours. Where there is abun- dant secretion, silver nitrate 1% to 2% solution put on the conjunctiva with a brush when the lids are turned, or argyrol 20% to 25% dropped into the eye are among the best antiseptics for local use. If the diplo- bacillus is present zinc sulphate |% solution is indicated. The nose, nasopharynx and pharynx should never be overlooked in this disease. Follicular Conjunctivitis Follicular conjunctivitis is of catarrhal origin. It is charac- terized by the presence of follicles. There may be only a few or a great many. If numerous they are often in rows on the palpebral conjunc- tiva. Microscopically they show as circumscribed masses of adenoid tissue. In this they resemble the granules of trachoma. Sometimes cases persist for years with little or no inflammatory symptoms. On account of the follicles this disease is frequently confused with trachoma. We have heard numbers of well meaning conscientious osteopathic physicians testify to curing cases of trachoma with a short course of osteopathic treatment with no pathology remaining. We are absolute 208 The Practice of Osteopathy believers in the effectiveness of osteopathic treatment and want, to give it full credit for doing all it will; but here we want to enter a plea to the profession that we need more discrimination and definiteness in our diag- nosis. Technique is being emphasized and we say Amen! It is proper for us to be thoroughly competent in technique but diagnosis should be made just as emphatic because scientific technique depends upon diag- nosis for each individual case. Difierentiation of follicular conjunctivitis from trachoma. Follicular conjunctivitis occurs (1) chiefly in the young; (2) the folhcles are smaller, more sharply limited, project more above the conjunctiva, are often in rows, and oval in shape; (3) the disease clears up with no bad after effects often without any treatment and the ten- dency is to ultimately get well; (4) it never leads to shrinking of the con- junctiva, to pannus or other destructive sequelae ; (5) it can arise without contagion and is not considered contagious although, hke trachoma, it does attack large numbers of people who are confined in a small place. Trachoma. — (1) It seldom occurs in cliildren; (2) the folhcles are larger, do not have sharp outlines, are less prominent under the con- junctiva, are round in shape and never in rows; (3) tends to lead to more or less pathology and seldom recovers spontaneously; (4) scar tissue becomes a product of the inflammation in the conjunctiva and leads to shrinking of the conjunctiva, causing in turn entropion and trichiasis. Pannus is the sure result of unarrested cases as there is a tendency to infection of the cornea from the infected conjunctiva moving over it and remaining in contact; (5) trachoma has been proved to be contag- ious. Trachoma bodies which are considered the infective agent have been isolated. The use of atropine in some instances will cause a follicular catarrh which clears up on stopping the use of the poison. Parinauds "Infectious conjunctivitis" has granulations but almost always occurs in only one eye and is accompanied with constitutional sjmaptoms. Treatment of Follicular Conjunctivitis. — The treatment should be directed against the inflammation. The trophicity of the nerve terminals to the conjunctiva may be altered by osteopathic lesions. Suggestions under chronic catarrhal conjunctivitis apply here. If there is no inflammation the folhcles tend to disappear, leaving no trace of patholog}^, hence a few osteopathic treatments of the Uds and the cervical region will hasten normahzation. The Peactice of Osteopathy 209 Gonorrheal Conjunctivitis This disease is sometimes called purulent ophthalmia or acute blennorrhea. It is caused from an infection of the conjunctival sac with the gonococcus of Neisser. Contact with soiled fingers or linen may transfer the germ. Symptoms. — Within 12-48 hours after inoculation the first symp- toms of redness and irritation occur. This is soon followed by much swelling and tension of the Hds and chemosis of the conjunctiva. There is much pain and a copious discharge of pus coming from beneath the lids. At first the pus is yellow or yellowish green. Later the symptoms begin to subside; there is less tenseness and heat; the lids can be more readily everted and the discharge ceases after 6 or 8 weeks. The puckered conjunctiva becomes rough and granular. In these cases the prognosis is always grave; more so than in oph- thalmia neonatorum. The eye is almost always marred in some way. One of the great dangers is involvement and destruction of the cornea. If the cornea becomes hazy soon after symptoms begin it is not a good omen. Ulcers will Hkely form and then there is a tendency to punc- ture the cornea. In mild cases the cornea may escape without injury. In severe cases it is likely to ulcerate. If it perforates, the anterior chamber is emptied and the iris prolapses into the perforation; adhesions take place and there is heaHng with reformation partially of the anterior chamber. An adherent leukoma is the result with practical loss of vis- ion. There may be a bulging of the cornea known as anterior staphyl- oma. The iris and ciHary body may become involved, causing iritis and cycHtis, or the whole inner structures may be affected making a pan-ophthalmitis with atrophy of the eyeball. The cornea is affected by the infective material direct or the nutrient vessels to the cornea at the limbus may be obstructed by the extreme swelling and pressure. Complications of arthritis, rhinitis, septicemia and endocarditis may arise. If there is none of these, at least there is a general debilitated condition which needs attention. Treatment. — The treatment should be local and constitutional. The diagnosis should be made quickly from the history, symptoms mi- croscopically, and local cleansing begun at once and followed diligently. Excessive discharge should be wiped away with cotton. The conjunc- tival sac should be thoroughly irrigated every hour or oftener if necessary to keep it clean. This is to be done day and night. A saturated solu- 210 The Practice of Osteopathy tion of boric acid may be used, or corrosive sublimate one grain to the pint, or permanganate of potassium solution 1-5000. The irrigation should be followed by the free use of argyrol 25%. This procedure will keep the eye clean and be the means often of saving the cornea from de- struction and the eye from bhndness. If there should be ulceration of the cornea a drop of atropine |% should be used in the eye often enough to keep the pupil dilated and the ciliary body at rest. Osteopathic physicians no less than other physicians should not neglect this local, careful, persistent, antiseptic cleansing of the eye in such cases. Theosteopathist can do more. He is not limited to antisepsis even in this kind of work, however important it might be. The unaf- fected eye should be carefully protected. Buller's shield should be used. The osteopath should give thorough treatments to the neck and the fifth nerve. Supporting treatment to the system according to indications should be given e. g., bowels, kidneys, nerves, muscles, joints as in constipation, nephritis, neurosis, rhemnatism, arthritis, endocarditis, septicemia, rhinitis etc. Ophthalmia Neonatorum This is an acute purulent conjunctivitis in the new born. Neona- torum comes from a junction of the Greek word Neos — new, to the Latin word natus — born; new-born. This disease is the bugbear to the ob- stetrician. He must always be on the lookout for it and act promptly in order to save sight. Every general practician should make a careful study of this disease if he expects to treat children. Sixty to seventy percent of conjunctivitis neonatorum is due to the infection with the gonococcus of Neisser. It usually comes from a gonorrheal discharge from the genitals of the mother. The nurse or anyone who handles the baby might be the agent in the transmission of the infection. The disease is not always of gonorrheal origin. Some cases are due to the pneumococcus, streptococcus, diplobacillus or one variety of staph- ylococci. Thus there are two varieties or types of ophthalmia neonatorum; a severe type which is gonorrheal or specific and a mild type which is non- specific. In some states there is a law which requires the use of silver ni- trate in the eyes of all babies at birth. Every baby's eyes should be The Peactice of Osteopathy 211 thoroughly washed at birth, with boric acid and where there is the least suspicion of gonorrhea silver nitrate 1% or argyrol 25% should be used. A routine use of one of the silver salts would be good practice. Symptoms. — Gonorrheal cases begin usually the third day after birth, non-gonorrheal, on the fifth or sixth day. Both eyes are usually involved, one worse than the other. The lids swell much. There is chemosis of the conjunctiva which may put the cornea in a pit. The dis- charge is abundant. It is yellow or greenish yellow. The disease gradually declines and the discharge ceases in six to eight weeks. The conjunctiva is thickened and looks granular. May be some cicatricial changes. The chief danger is to the cornea, more so if it becomes hazy the first two days. Corneal lesions seldom occur in non-specific forms. If the cornea is involved perforation is likely, with a general in- flammation of the eyeball (panophthahnitis) followed by atrophy (phthis- is bulbi). CompHcations such as rhinitis, meningitis, endocarditis and general septicemia may occur. Diagnosis is made from the onset, character, symptoms and course with the use of the microscope. Prognosis. — Delayed or improper treatment in these cases will likely be fatal to sight as sloughing of the cornea will occur. With prompt and proper care the prognosis is favorable. Treatment. — Mild cases (non-specific) are treated in the same manner as simple conjunctivitis. In severe cases (specific) clean the eye carefully and apply cold compresses of gauze 15 to 20 minutes at a time every hour or two. Keep the gauze on a block of ice and change every few minutes. If the cornea is involved heat may prove more satisfactory. There must be constant removal of the discharge. Wipe away the ex- cess and irrigate freely with boric acid at least every hour day and night and more often if necessary. After each washing use a solution of ar- gyrol 25%. Once a day silver nitrate 1% solution may be used and washed out with a salt solution. If the cornea should ulcerate the treatment need not be altered. The attendants should be carefully instructed as to the importance of the care and the contagious nature of the pus. Antisepsis and cleanhness here is more essential, effective and ex- clusive than in any other disease of the eye. Wisdom in the use of anti- septics is a strong point in the armamentarium of every progressive os- teopath. 212 The Practice of Osteopathy Trachoma Tliis disease is known as granular lids or granular conjunctivitis. Although the germ has not been discovered, we know this is an infectious disease. A roughness and hypertrophy of the conjunctiva develops. There is development of follicles or granulations. Later these products are absorbed and cicatrization of the tissues follows. Cause. — Trachoma is found most common in Egypt and Arabia. It spreads easily in crowded institutions. It is in many instances a mixed infection with the Morax-Axenfeld bacillus, Koch-Weeks bacillus and the gonococcus. "Trachoma bodies" have been discovered which are claimed by some to be a causative factor in the disease. These small bodies are not found in all cases however. Spinal lesions of the cervical and upper four thoracic vertebrae will disturb the blood and nerve supply to the eye which will predispose to the disease should some of the virus or germs of trachoma be present. In practically all these cases there is tenderness if not an actual twist at the second and third thoracic. Symptoms.— A small boy came to our cUnics complaining that his left eye was smaller than the right. No inflammation or swelling was prominent. The eye looked normal except slightly smaller than the right. On turning the Hd granules in the fornix of that eye were readilj^ noticed. Trachoma had a good start. The tissues were so hyper- trophied in that region that the eye could not be opened quite as wide as the other one, hence the impression that that eye-ball was smaller. The granulation often develops so insidiously that the victim may have the disease for months before he realizes he has a bad eye. When symp- toms appear there may be photophobia, lachrymation, gluing of the hds from a scanty secretion, pain, and blurring of vision. The granules are gray, translucent and roundish under the conjunctiva. Hypertrophy increases to a certain height when cicatrization and contraction begin. The duration may be years. The more the hyper- trophy the longer the duration and the greater the contraction. (Note here that treatment should be directed toward combatting the hyper- trophy by establishing circulation). Sequelae. I merely mention the sequelae here: pannus, ulceration of the cornea, trichiasis, dystrichiasis, entropion, ectropion, symble- pharon, xerosis, corneal opacities. For the explanation, pathology and The Practice of Osteopathy 213 treatment of these sequelae not covered in this treatise, see any good works on diseases of the eye as Weeks, Fuchs or De Schweinitz. Treatment of Trachoma. — -In reporting cases of trachoma treated and cured by osteopathy we should be sure of our diagnosis. The treatment is antiseptic, hydrotherapeutical, osteopathic and operative. A saturated solution of boric acid should be used. Argyrol 20% is good if there is much secretion. Nitrate of silver 2% and copper sulphate are still used in some cases to advantage as claimed by some physicians. The osteopath should count on careful cleanliness. Hot compresses over the eyes are often very agreeable. Operations are often performed for trachoma. The granules are rolled out with Knapp's roller forceps, and other methods. Grattage is practiced with some wonderful results. It is done as follows: Get some fine sand paper and cut it in strips about one-half inch wide by three or four inches long. Put it in alcohol in a vessel for ten to fifteen minutes. Pour off all the alcohol except a few drops that will cling to the vessel by capillary attraction. Touch a match to the residue. This will burn just enough to make the sand paper absolutely sterile without burning the latter. Put the patient under somnoform. Use a small artery forceps to grasp the edge of the eyeHd, roll the lid back over the artery forceps to expose all granulations clear to the fornix. Use a protector to the eyeball. Now with the sandpaper quickly scrape or curette away all of the trachoma bodies and granulations. Re- peat the process on the other eye if it is involved. Wash out well with a saturated solution of boric acid and bandage the eyes for a few hours. This will cause considerable swelling and inflammation. Use cold appli- cations and keep the eyes disinfected. I have seen some very good re- sults from this method. Osteopathic. — Following the sand paper operation a thorough treatment of the cervical and upper dorsal region would add consider- ably to the rapidity of the patient's recovery and sense of well being. General tonic treatment is of special benefit in nearly all trachoma cases as they are subnormal in their general health. One form of technique which has been used by myself and others to advantage in these cases is as follows: SteriHze the fingers carefully, lubricate with vaseline or K. Y. the forefinger of the right hand. With the left hand raise the upper lid and introduce the forefinger of the right hand with the thumb above. Catching the lid between the thumb and finger squeeze and massage the whole structure clear to the fornix as tho]'Oughly as possible. Repeat the process on the other eye. 214 The Peactice of Osteopathy A technique used by Dr. Edwards of St. Louis is as follows: After sterilizing and lubricating the forefinger hft the hd and introduce the finger as far as possible into the orbit pushing the fornix back into the orbit. This stretches all the tissues around the fornix, opening up a better conjunctival and palpebral circulation. The ciliary vessels and nerves are stretched and stimulated. It is rather surprising to one who has not tried it, how far the finger can be introduced into the orbit. One set of nerves that should be especially studied and considered in trachomatous conditions is the cere-brobulbo-spino-sympathetic-cil- iary arc. This has already been elaborated. All spinal lesions should be carefully diagnosed and corrected. Dr. T. J. Rudd3''s third finger eye instrument is very useful in these conditions in restoring normal circulation about the orbit. See that the nose and throat are normal. Phlyctenular Conjunctivitis By some this disease is considered an eczema of the conjunctiva. This will at least enable us to get an idea of the conjunctival pathology. What is said of phlyctenular conjunctivitis applies largely to its cor- responding disease of the cornea-phlyctenular lTnptoms are headache — frontal, fronto-temporal or fronto- occipital. It may extend into the neck between the shoulders. Eye balls may be tender, diplopia at times, may be photophobia, lachryma- tion, congestion of the eye, itching and burning of the Hds. Accommodative Astlienopia. — In this form the cihary muscle is fatigued. The cause is usually over-use of the eye when hyperopia and astigmatism exist; sometimes in myopia or presbyopia. Treatment. — In this form the treatment is the proper fitting of glasses and improvement of the general health. Muscular Astlienopia is due to tiring of the extraocular muscles, usually the internal rectus. This may result in a phoria or a non-para- lytic squint. Ametropia may exist but asthenopia may come even in emmetropia due to over-use of the eye. Treatment. — Correct ametropia if present, with glasses. Exer- cise the weakened muscle. Correct the nerve supply to the weak muscle. Treat cervical and upper dorsal. Manipulate tissues of the orbit. Spring the jaw. Correct any nose and throat pathology. Nervous, Neurasthenic or Reflex Asthenopia — The cause is supposed to be some functional disorder, more often found in females. May be due to too dim or too bright light, over-use of the eyes. Hysteria may follow ametropia. Treatment. — Often the treatment is troublesome and the case is very obstinate according to old school methods. Rest, hygiene, general health and habits are looked after. The cause must be found or the treatment cannot be specific. These are the different forms of eye strain as ordinarily classified. Now as we stud}^ the reflex symptoms from these and attempt to trace The Practice of Osteopathy 233 out the reflexes from an osteopathic point of view, we may find some more definite causes of these conditions and consequently some methods of treatment not found in standard text books might naturally suggest themselves. Reflex symptoms that have been traced to eye strain by ophthal- mologists are as follows : Constipation, indigestion, heart-burn, nausea, vomiting, nervous attacks, fear of impending calamity, irritabihty, despondency, insomnia, restless sleep, epilepsy, nervous twitchings and eneuresis. All these symptoms have been seen to disappear after eye strain was corrected. There is no absolute way of proving that all these symptoms have existed because of eye strain. The existence and disappearance of some of them at the time of treatment for eye strain may be a coincidence. It is evident that eye strain in varying degrees may produce a train of symptoms sim- ilar to many above mentioned. A patient, nervous, anxious, uneasy, and despondent, constipated, and having some indigestion, showed on examination contractures and tenderness at the third dorsal. It was found he was suffering from eye strain from over-use of glasses that were too strong for him. The eyes were refitted. He was wearing a (R)+4.50 D. S. = +.50 cyl. Ax. 180. (L) +4.50 D. S. = + .50 cyl. Ax. 90 for close work and a (R)+2.00 D. S. = +.50 cyl. Ax. 180 (L)+2.50 D. S. = +.25 cyl. Ax. 90 for distance. The new glasses were — Reading — (R)+3.00 D. S. = +.25 cyl. Ax. 180 (L)+3.00 D. S. = +.25 cyl. Ax. 180 Distance : (R) + 1.50 D. S. = +.25 cyl. Ax. 180 (L) + 1.50 D. S. = -l-.25 cyl. Ax. 130 He was fitted two years previously. At that time the stronger glasses were correct. Eyes change more or less constantly, especially between the ages thirty-five to fifty-five years. When glasses are fitted, a weak ciliary muscle after a rest may become stronger and allow weaker glasses to be worn. If a young person is fitted for myopia, in a few years he may dis- card his glasses as presbyopia develops. A person fitted correctly, who has a strong ciliary muscle may not be able for awhile to see as well with the glasses as without them. After they are worn awhile the ciliary nmscle will cease its efforts to accommodate so much and the glasses 234 The Practice of Osteopathy give the desired effect. In some cases the doctor's reputation to fit glasses proper!}^ may suffer at the hands of such people who sometimes refuse to take glasses, or after getting them refuse to wear them. In the case of the man just mentioned a refitting quieted the nervous symptoms — he became more cheerful and ceased to worry. Indigestion and constipation improved. The soreness and contractures were over- come in a few treatments. Now let us ask the question, why is it that eye strain will cause nausea and vomiting? Also why will indigestion affect the ej^es by causing "spools" in the vision'^ A little osteopathic logic, based as it always is or should be, upon anatomy and physiology, may throw some light on this subject. No doubt every one of us has demonstrated many times clinically that indigestion from over-eating will cause soreness and contractures at the third and fourth dorsal, the nerve center in the spine for the stomach. The reflexes between the viscera and the eye are complex and diffi- cult to follow. In giving the probable course of the nerve reflexes from the optic nerve to the third nerve Dr. Louisa Burns suggests the follow- ing: "The nerve elements of the retina start the impulse; it passes over that portion of the optic nerves which enter the anterior quadrigeminates, the cells of the quadrigeminates where the impulses are coordinated, then by axons of these cells to the lateral or viscero-motor nucleus of the third nerve, thence to the ceUs of the ciliary ganglion, and by the non-medulated (sympathetic) fibers of these, the short ciliary nerves to the non-striated muscles concerned, viz: the ciliary muscle, some fibers of the levator palpebrse and the spliincter of the iris. " The third nerve arises in the floor of the aqueduct of Sylvius from two nuclei; a lateral nucleus which is a viscero-motor group of nerve cells, and a central nucleus or a somato-motor group of cells. The som- ato-motor nucleus supplies all the extrinsic muscles of the eye except the external rectus and superior oblique which are supplied by the sixth and fourth respectively. The nasal branch of the ophthalmic division of the 5th sends fibers to the ciliary muscle. Association fibers connect the nuclei of the 3rd, 4th, 6th and 7th. The evidence is in favor of the 10th or pneumogastric having such association fibers. We noted four places in the brain to which the optic tracts go before the radiations reached the center of sight in the occipital lobe. If we cannot follow all the reflexes through the brain and cord at least with the facts we have it is not difficult to imagine abnormal impulses coming over the third nerve from a straining of the ciliary nucleus, thence over The Practice of Osteopathy 235 viscero-motor fibers in the lateral horn of the cord, over the white rami- communicantes, through the sympathetic ganglia, over the splanchnics to the stomach, producing abnormal peristalsis, nausea and vomiting. In turn we would have the somato-motor nerves to the muscles affected as before described, contraction and congestion of muscles of the spine. When we have patients consult us and describe a train of symptoms like nausea, vomiting, nervousness, frontal and occipital headache, we should have eye strain in mind and inquire for lachrymation, photo- phobia, itching and burning Hds and congestion of the eye. Any of these things should make us think of testing for ametropia in its various refractive errors, as well as a careful spinal and a nose and throat examina- tion. General physical and laboratory diagnosis should not be neglected. References Fuchs's Text Book of Ophthalmology, Duane. Headaches and Eye Disorders of Nasal Origin, Sluder. External Diseases of the Eye, Greeff . Vol. Ill Practical Medicine Series: The Eye, Ear, Nose and Throat by Casey A. Wood, Albert H. Andrews, Geo. E. Shambaugh. Diseases of the Eye, Weeks. Diseases of the Eye, Ear, Nose and Throat, Posy and Wright. Diseases of the Eye, De Schweinitz. Diseases of the Eye, May. Text Book of Ophthalmology, Roemer and Foster. Diseases of the Eye, Jackson. Ophthalmic Surgery, Meller. 236 The Practice of Osteopathy DISEASES OF THE EAR, NOSE AND THROAT By J. Deason Diseases of the Ear Methods and Technic of Examination. — The external ear may be examined by direct inspection with or without the aid of artificial light. The external auditory meatus may be examined by means of a simple conical ear speculum and reflected light from a head mirror. This method requii'es considerable practice but efficiency can and should be attained because it can be used under all conditions and therefore is a reliable method. The Holmes electric am-oscope which we use and recommend fo^ examining the meatus and ear drum, is very efficient but like other elec- trical equipment is not always dependable. There are many electrical equipments for examining the ear, but so far I have found none other than the one above mentioned that is worth space in an instrument cabinet. To examine the meatus, grasp the pinna and draw it firmly upward and backward. This tends to straighten the canal so that the aural speculum may be inserted well into the external canal. It must be re- membered that the auditory canal is always sensitive and while there is really httle danger of doing any harm by exercising ordinary care, the pa- tient is always afraid of being hurt and one can accomphsh better results by practicing careful technic. If the electric auroscope is used, the e3^e should be placed very close to the lens and every part of the canal, waUs and drum membrane care- f uUj^ examined. The Holmes auroscope has a small tube and bulb, pres- sure upon which will vary the air pressure in the meatus and cause the drum to move. This must be done very carefully because in very thin, atrophic membranes there is soma danger of ruptiu'ing the drum. Diseases of the Auditory Meatus Inspissated Cerumen, or hardened ear wax is one of the most common affections of the meatus. The cause in some cases can be traced to lesions of the mandible, but in many cases the cause is unknown. Treatment. — Protect the clothing l^y means of a towel or rubber neck piece. By means of a soft rubber ear syi'inge, wash the canal thor- oughly by forcing warm soap solution into it. I prefer concentrated The Peactice of Osteopathy 237 liquid castile soap (any good soap will do) diluted about one to four in water as warm as the patient can bear it. The soap solutioxi is con- tained in a pus bowl held tightly against the neck under the ear. There is little danger of using too much force with the soft rubber syringe. In most cases the hardened cerumen will be dislodged by the syring- ing only. If this cannot be done, it may be well to discontinue the treat- ment until the following day. The solvent action of the soap solution wiU further reduce the hardened mass and it usually can be removed by syringing the following day. This method is preferable in many cases because patients disHke the pain which usually accompanies the use of a curet. The dull loop cm-et is the most efficient and safest instrument for re- moving hardened cerumen that the syringe may fail to dislodge. This in- strument must be used with great care because the membranes, long protected by the covering of cerumen are hypersensitive and bleed easily. After removing the cerumen, the canal should be thorouglily dried and lubricated with some non-irritating lubricant. It is also well to place a small pledget of absorbent cotton into the external opening to protect the sensitive membranes from the cold, an- and dust. In drying the canal I prefer to use a small aluminum applicator, twisting a smaU piece of absorbent cotton on the end in such a way as to cover the tip well, thus making any injury from its use impossible. Atrophic Meatus Sensitive or itching ears as the patient commonly describes it, is a very common disease caused by any atrophic condition of the membranes of the auditory meati and frequently found in common with auditory or other cranial nerve deficiency or degeneration. The du'ect cause of the UTitation is the collection of particles of dry cerumen. Treatment. — The local treatment consists of syringing with warm (118° to 120°F) soap solution until all of the scaly cerumen has been removed. The canal is then dried and lubricated as described above. Several such treatments may be required after which I prefer the use of the continuous irrigating ear cup, using salt mixture instead of the soap. The same salt mixture as is recommended for nose and thr jat irrigation is satisfactory. After such irrigations the application of phenol-glycerine (10% phenol in glycerine) seems to be an efficient treatment. The local treatment must, of course, be accompanied by corrective treatment to the mandible and upper cervicals. 238 The Peactice of Osteopathy Furunculosis There are three acute affections of the ear which may usually be diagnosed from their points of tenderness or pain. Pain upon moving the lobe or pinna indicates furunculosis. Pain on pressure posterior to the angle of the jaw or externally in front of the ear indicates middle ear infection and pain on pressure ov^er the mastoid region suggests mastoiditis. Probably the most common of the painful diseases of the external meatus is fm'unculosis, which is a sub-cutaneous infection of the lining membrane of the meatus. The point of swelling may usually be seen but in some cases the entire canal is closed. Treatment. — In all cases of occluded pus, drainage must be ob- tained, but in the early stages of furunculosis, it is not always possible to determine the place of " pointing" or the most desirable point to lance. As soon as the place of "pointing" can be located it is advisable to lance deeply by means of a curved paracentesis knife. The parts are thor- oughly cleansed and anesthetized by applying phenol and neutralizing with alcohol. The external parts are first painted with alcohol to prevent "burning" from any phenol which may be dropped upon them. A small cotton apphcator is used, applying the concentrated solution of phenol or the crystals (using only a small amount of phenol) to the af- fected parts and immediately neutralizing with alcohol. Care must be observed not to apply any phenol to the drum membrane and the operator must be sure that the action of the carbolic acid is completely neutralized by a Hberal application of alcohol. The knife blade is placed beyond the furuncle, its curved point turn- ed outward and quickly drawn forward through the furuncle, cutting deeply. The canal is then packed with a pledget of cotton dipped into phenol-glycerine. If the place of pointing cannot be seen, palliative treatment may be appUed by thoroughly cleaning the meatus, drying and applying a phenol- glycerine pack. Heat may be apphed by means of a therapeutic lamp. Any electric light bulb or the dry electric pack will do. The external parts are well lubricated with paraffin oil and the heat applied contin- usously or intermittently until the pain is relieved. Infection of the Meatus Infections of the meatus are frequently secondary to, or accompanied by furunculosis. The treatment, therefore, is similar to that of furuncu- losis. The Practice of Osteopathy 239 Always try to locate the point of infection, lance or curet, apply phenol or other chemical germicide, neutralize, dry and pack with phenol- glycerine. After the point of infection has been thoroughly drained, cleanliness and protection from dust or further infection is all that is necessary. In all cases of infection of the external meatus, suspect middle ear abscess as a cause. There may be a pin-point opening through the drum, from which the infection has originated and is being maintained. Otomycosis or fungus infection of the auditory meatus is rare. It usually resembles other infections symptomafcically, but often without pus. A microscopic examination will serve to diagnose the condition. The treatment consists of thorough cleansing, drying and the free apphcation of alcohol. Alcohol is dropped into the ear until the canal is full and a pledget of cotton applied to retain it. Usually two or three applications are sufficient to effect a cure. Eczema of the auricle and meatus is of two types, the squamous or scaly form and the sclerotic form. Both forms are chronic and may be readily diagnosed by the appearance. Treatment. — Some cases are very difficult to cure but we have had excellent results with the following treatment: Careful adjustment of cervical and mandibular lesions; thorough treatment of any local in- fections of head or neck; direct application of phenol-glycerine, local cleanhness and protection from irritation. Diseases of the Middle Ear Clinically the middle ear consists of the tympanic cavity and its contents, the eustachian tube and the mastoid cells. Acute Suppurative Otitis Media Acute infections of the middle ear result from acute naso-pharyngeal affections such as colds, influenza, measles, mumps, whooping cough, etc. Bathing in contaminated water often results in infection to the middle ear through the eustachian tube. Diagnosis. — Earache, pain on pressure under the angle of the jaw and sudden deafness are the symptoms. (There are also the common febrile symptoms.) The chief physical signs are: redness and bulging of drum membrane, and contraction and tenderness of upper cervical muscles. Treatment. — If the patient is seen before the drum has ruptured it is seldom necessary to lance the drum if the proper treatment is given promptl3^ 240 The Practice of Osteopathy Drainage must be obtained and maintained by catheter aspiration through the tube irrigation of the naso-pharyngeal cavity, irrigation of the meatus by means of the continuous ear irrigator and apphcation of dry heat over the affected part. Heat is best apphed by means of a therapeutic lamp. (Any lamp with reflector that will furnish proper heat is efficient as there is no virtue in colored light.) The skin surface over the ear, side of face and mastoid region is first well lubricated with some mineral oil to prevent blistering and the heat is applied either con- stantly or intermittently. A pledget of absorbent cotton dipped into phenol-glycerine is placed in the meatus and forced loosely against the drum. This should be removed every few hours and a fresh pledget put in. The neck and upper dorsal muscles should be kept relaxed and ad- ju stive treatment given frequently. Under this treatment the pain should be relieved and the bulging of the drum should disappear in from two to twelve hours. If this is not accomplished or if the condition grows worse, the drum should be lanced. See some text on otology for technique. In my experience, very few cases have required paracentesis. It must be remembered that treatment should be continued regu- larly and for some time after the pain and other symptoms have been relieved or a recurrence is probable. Patients should have daily treat- ment until the physician is sure that no comphcation or recurrence is likely to result. If the patient is not seen until after the drum has ruptured, the same treatment may be applied except. the irrigation or syringing of the meatus. This, in case of ruptured drum, may force pus into the mastoid cells resulting in mastoiditis. Instead of syringing, the auditory meatus is cleaned by means of a cotton appHcator or by aspirating with a cath- eter. At all times drainage through the meatus must be maintained un- til the drum begins to heal. Acute Mastoiditis Acute mastoiditis results from acute or chronic otitis media. In some cases the otitis media may have been only a mild attack. Diagnosis. — There is no one symptom that is positively diagnostic but a numl^er of signs and sjTiiptoms must be considered as follows : 1. Always suspect mastoid complications in acute otitis media and watch for this comphcation daily. Most cases have some mastoid inflammation. The Practice of Osteopathy 241 2. Pain or swelling over mastoid. Pain may not be present, but usually is, sonletimes radiating over temples and eye on affected side. 3. Tenderness on pressure not always present. May be very mark- ed. Tenderness extending to tip or above ear means extension of infec- tion. If persistent tenderness over tips with marked swelling and dis- coloration — operation is indicated. 4. Swelling, not always present, but sometimes very marked. If extreme swelling and bluish discoloration— usually means operation. 5. Temperature varies from normal to 104° or 105° F. Temperature of more than one or two degrees means systemic absorption and suggests surgical drainage. Streptococcus or staphylococcus infections cause higher temperatures and require drainage earlier than other infections. 6. Transillumination not positive, but of some value. Like X-ray, usually shows dark, because of inflammation, but must rely upon symp- toms, as above. 7. Microscopic. — Stain for pus, bacteria and bone debris. Hema- toxylin stain shows dark bone particles if there is bone disintegration. 8. Blood Count. — If absorption, there will be some variation in proportions of leucocytes. Any high leucocytosis shows systemic ab- sorption and the natural attempt to overcome the infection. Non-Surgical Treatment. — 1. Drainage must be maintained from middle ear through tube or drum or both. Catheter aspiration through tube. Sometimes gentle inflation to clear the tube, followed by aspiration is effective. 2. If drum is ruptured, aspirate middle ear by catheter or by Moore's method or both. This is very important. If no aspirating machine, use syringe and pump meatus and tube persistently. Dry meatus and keep well open. 3. Patient should be kept in bed if symptoms are marked, with Ught diet and bowels well open. 4. Heat. — Apply oil or other lubricant over whole side of face and head and apply heat by means of 'therapeutic" lamp intermittent- ly. Thirty minutes light on and fiifteen minutes light off. The light- heat (any electric lamp with reflecting shade will do) is much better than hot water bottle or electric pad or sand bag. The heat must be kept going day and night if symptoms are marked until the pain has entirely subsided. Heat is most efficient in the early stages. After symptoms are well marked, the ice pack is more desirable. 5. If drum is not ruptured, heat may be applied by means of Dca- 242 The Practice of Osteopathy son's continuous irrigating cup. Start at 116° F. and gradually increase to 123° F. if patient can bear it. Surgical. — If drum has not ruptured and symptoms continue, it is best to make free incision of drum, — keep open and apply (2) above. Indications for Mastoid Operation. — There are no definite signs, symptoms or tests that will determine positively when operation should be done. If the ^bove non-surgical methods are practiced, few cases will require operation, but many will develop into chronic mastoiditis and so it is very difficult to decide whether a mastoid operation should or should not be done. It is best to explain thoroughly the possible com- plications to the patient and relatives and request them to assume re- sponsibility. INIastoid operations are attended by very httle danger when properly done. Signs and Symptoms Suggesting Operation. — Acute otitis media with mastoiditis. (1) Persistent pain and swelUng not relieved by non-surgical treat- ment. (2) Marked protruding of posterior wall or meatus. (3) Marked tenderness, swelling and discoloration above ear or over tip of mastoid. These with temperature of more than.. 102° usually are enough to demand immediate drainage. (4) Any evidence of extension of pus under skin of neck below tip. A positive indication for drainage. (5) Any indications of brain or meningeal involvement such as very marked and persistent headache, partial or total loss of consciousness, etc. (6) Indications of labyrinthine involvement such as marked vertigo, etc. (7) Sudden cessation of discharge means obstructed drainage from middle ear or from mastoid into middle ear and if drainage cannot be re- stored by aspiration, this means operation. (8) The whole chnical picture must be carefully considered at aU times. Take no chances. Advise operation before someone else finds it too late. Chronic Mastoiditis Cause.— Always from unsuccessfully treated acute form or from chronic sujopurative otitis media. Non-surgical treatment. — See chronic suppurative otitis media. We have had a few cases that were seemingly permanently cured by non- surgical treatment, but beheve thej^ are rare. The Practice of Osteopathy 243 Indications for Operation. — 1. Recurrent exacerbation of acute or chronic otitis media. 2. Constant discharge which resists treatment for chronic suppura- tive otitis media. 3. Continued pain or recurrent pain and swelling following acute otitis media. 4. Open sinus into mastoid either external or through meatus. 5. Cholesteatoma. 6. Symptoms of labyrinthine or brain involvement following acute otitis media. 7. Definite evidence of bone disintegration in mastoid. As stated above, none of these are definite indications. The whole group of signs and symptoms are to be considered. Chronic Suppurative Otitis Media Etiology. — Chronic suppurative otitis media usually results from an unsuccessfully treated acute otitis media. If in acute otitis media there has been bone erosion or extensive destruction of the mucous mem- brane by a virulent infection, chronic suppuration is hkely to result. A persistent mastoid infection following otitis media is hkely to result in chronic otitis media and this is strong argument for early mastoid operation. 1. Otitis media resulting from some virulent infection such as the recent influenza pandemic or scarlet fever is always more likely to result in mastoiditis and chronic suppuration of the middle ear. 2. Such infectious agents as streptococcus, staphylococcus, long- chain pneumococcus or bacillus influenzae are Hkely to result in chronic suppurations. 3. Lowered vitality from any cause. 4. Inefiicient drainage from failure to aspirate the Eustachian tube, delayed perforation or failure to lance drum sufficiently early. 5. Mastoid necrosis, which maintains drainage into the tympanic cavity. 6. Abnormal granulations,. polypi, etc. in tympanic cavity. 7. Chronic inflammation with suppuration of the epipharynx or Eustachian tubes. 8. Cholesteatoma resulting fi-om perforated drum and growths of epithelium (extending into the middle ear cavity. Diagnosis. — The diagnosis is easy because nearly every case of discharging car without pain is chronic suppurative otitis media. The 244 The Practice of Osteopathy determination of the exact nature of the condition present is not onlj^ very important but very difficult. Differential diagnosis consists in determining the nature of the infecting organism and the nature and extent of the pathology. 1. Direct examination of the external meatus after drying with cot- ton applicator usually determines the location and extent of perforation of the drum and the general nature of the discharge, whether purulent or mucopurulent. Very rarely one finds a serious discharge which means a very slight infection or discharge from non-infective inflammation. The presence of whitish or greyish pus, mucoid and stringy, usually means pneumococcus infection. Greyish, purulent non-mucoid discharge us- ually indicates streptococcus or bacillus influenzae infection. Yellow, purulent discharge suggests staphylococcus infection. The general ap- pearance of the discharge, however, cannot be considered of important diagnostic value because most chronic suppurations are mixed infec- tions, because of long exposure to external contamination. 2. After cleaning the meatus, several smears should be made di- rectly from the opening in the drum. By staining with methylin blue or gentian violet, the nature of the bacterial infection can be determined and this is very important. By staining another smear with hematoxylin and washing in water, any dark irregular particles, bone debris, may be found, which means bone disintegration. This too, is very important. 3. Transillumination is sometimes of value. The mastoid may be transilluminated by placing a good rubber covered transilluminating lamp over the mastoid and observing the external meatus through an aural speculum. If the mastoid is free from infection the light will pass through and illuminate the meatus. 4. The X-ray plate is, of course, the best means of determining the nature and extent of mastoid involvement. Treatment. — This is certainly one of the most difficult diseases of the ear that one is ever called upon to treat and the physician should be cautioned against offering a favorable prognosis. Perhaps the most difficult thing about its treatment that the doctor has to learn is that practically none of the so-called antiseptic washes do any good, but on the other hand they often do harm. Certain general principles are im- portant and the treatment must depend upon the nature and extent of the infection and pathology present in each case. The constitutional treatment consists of everything that will in- crease the patient's general resistance and certainly all lesions of the cer- The Practice of Osteopathy 245 vical, upper dorsal and mandibles must be properly adjusted, but this is not enough. All spinal lesions that may exert an influence on metab- ohsm and ehmination are of important consideration. The diet, habits and environment of the patient must be considered. A careful examination of the naso-pharyngeal tract may reveal some other focal infection, such as chronic tonsilhtis, pharyngitis or sinuitis, which is maintaining the infection through the Eustachian tube. There may be a focal or general infection of some other part of the body, which is reducing resistance or causing a hematogenous infection of the tym- panic cavity or mastoid cells. Drainage must be maintained in all cases, both through the Eus- tachian tube by catheter aspiration and through the drum by aspirat- ing and drying. If the perforation in the drum is small or in the middle or upper part, it should be opened down to the floor so that the con- tents may be more easily removed and better drainage estabUshed. It is well first to thoroughly cleanse the meatus and tympanic cavity by syringing with salt mixture (salt 3 parts, borax 2 parts and soda 1 part, a teaspoonful to a half pus bowl of water) at from 116° to 118° F. After syringing, the meatus is carefully dried, and the middle ear cavity as- pirated through the tube and drum opening. The advantage of this simple treatment is thorough cleanliness and drainage with the mini- mum of irritation. This treatment given daily or thrice weekly wifl often cure the case. Staphylococcus and streptococcus infections usually respond to the following treatment: After thoroughly cleansing as above, the meatus and tympanic cavity is syringed with a one to four or one to five dilution of Dakin-Carrel solution (Hyclorite may be used instead) followed by aspiration, the fluid being drawn through the tube, thus preventing rein- fection from that source. Pneumococcus infections do not respond to either of these methods of treatment. The pneumococcus, because of its capsule, is not affected by antiseptics, but on the other hand the irritation of the tissues caused by their use, only gives the infective agent a better opportunity for growth. In pneumococcus infections we have found the following method efficient : Thoroughly cleanse the meatus and middle ear cavity by salt mixture syringing, aspiration and drying. The meatus and tympanic cavity is then filled with a neutral mineral oil. The oil is also pumped through the Eustachian tube. It is the purpose to fill the entire cavity and its openings so thoroughly that no air can enter. In some cases 246 The Practice of Osteopathy we have used bismuth paste after the oiHng with excellent results. The pneumococcus is aerobic and if all air can be kept away for a consider- able time, it furnishes an unfavorable culture environment with Uttle irritation to the membranes. Surgical treatment. — The presence of bone debris indicates bone disintegration in the tympanic cavity or mastoid cells. If the mastoid cells are thus involved there is httle chance for direct treatment. If such cases do not respond in a short time to any of the above methods of local treatment, ossiculectomy or mastoid operation may be necessary. Some specialist surgeons claim from 80% to 90% favorable results from mastoid operation in such cases. Non-Suppurative Otitis Media — Catarrhal Deafness Deafness is any impairment of normal hearing and is that symptom next to pain and chronic discharge that causes the patient to visit the doctor. If acute diseases of the ear, nose and throat could always be successfully treated, there would be httle trouble from the symptoms of chronic pathology. It must be understood that catarrhal deafness is a symptom of chronic otitis media and is, therefore, seldom of recent ori- gin. Etiology. — Chronic otitis media is nearly always the result of the extension of infection through the Eustachian tube and has come from some acute or chronic nasopharyngeal infection. Chronic colds, pharyn- gitis, tonsilhtis, sinuitis, etc., resulting in acute or chronic otitis media either with or without suppuration, constitutes the beginning of catarrhal deafness. Symptoms. — There is seldom any pain with this disease. Some cases have an occasional acute attack with pain and other symptoms of acute otitis media. Deafness, var5dng with the progress of the pathologic changes, is always present. The patient in the early stages will seldom admit that he suffers from deafness and often he is honest because he may not rea- lize that he cannot hear normally until his otitis media has progressed to the second or third stage. Most patients, in fact, do not become alarmed about their hearing until it is too late to restore normal hear- ing. For this reason, physicians should be on the look-out for such conditions and should advise special treatment early. The human species in its present environment, depends much less upon the organs of special sensation than do the animals of the wild, and The Practice of Osteopathy 247 they may therefore be very deficient in sight, hearing, smell, etc. with- out actually reahzing this loss. In addition to deafness there are other symptoms such as occasional or constant fullness or feehng of "stuffiness" as the patients express it, due to partial or complete occlusion of the Eustachian tubes. Tinnitus aurium or head noises is very common and often the most annoying symptom. Autophony, or the loud sound of the patient's voice to him- self, which often causes him to speak low and indistinctly, occurs in the later stages. Presbyacusia, or the inability to adjust the hearing appa- ratus to variations in pitch, commonly occurs in the second stage and is evidenced by the fact that the patient does not hear when more than one person is talking. Paracousis or perverted phenomena of hearing, such as the better hearing of some persons in a noisy environment, is a symp- tom of the third stage of otitis media and often means an unfavorable prognosis, so far as marked improvement in hearing is concerned. Pathologic Stages. — For convenience of discussion we may con- sider chronic otitis media in three stages. The First Stage. — The active pathology is limited to the pharyn- geal portion of the Eustachian tube with some inflammation of the mem- branes of the tjmipanic cavity. Closure of the tube followed by absorp- tion of the oxygen causes a decreased pressure in the tympanic cavity and thus a retraction of the drum, decreased movement of the ossicles and a general decrease in function of all tympanic structures. Deafness in this stage may be very marked, especially if the Eustachian occlusion has occurred from some nasopharyngeal acute inflammation. There may be pain but there is always a characteristic "fullness" and some- times dizziness. Deafness in these cases varies with weather changes. If proper treatment is had in time, the progress of the pathology can be stopped and every case can be restored to normal hearing. The Second Stage. — The active pathology has extended through- out the Eustachian tube causing marked occlusion and some stenosis. There is further inflammation of the tympanic structures with an in- crease in the symptoms of the first stage. The drum membrane is less movable but there is no fixation of the ossicles. Pressure upon the bulb of the auroscope causes movement of that part of the drum to which the malleus is attached. The drum is thicker, more retracted, and less movable than in the first stage. Presbyacusia is common and often mark- ed, but there is no paracousis. More than 90% of these cases can be materially improved and many can be made to hear normally if proper treatment is given in due time. 248 The Practice of Osteopathy The Third Stage. — The active pathology in the third stage consists of an involvement of the entire mucous membrane lining the Eustachian tube and tympanic cavity. These membranes are all chronically hy- pertropliied. The Eustachian tube, however, is sometimes fairly well open, but the ossicular attachments are more or less fixed by hyper- trophicd tissue and adhesions and the drum is markedly retracted, thick- ened and usually very immovable. The deafness is usually quite marked, head noises are commonly present and often ver}^ annoying. Patients usually do not notice a variation in their hearing from weather changes. Presbyacusia is present in 80% of cases and their hearing for low tones is much reduced. Unless there is a complicating nerve affection these cases hear well by telephone, which means that they can also use an electric hearing in- strument to advantage. These cases can never be restored to normal hearing, but many of them (30% of my cases) can have some improve- ment and in most cases I believe the progress of the pathology can be stopped, and this is always well worth while because their hearing is likelj^ to be entii-ely lost if something is not done. Psychologic Stages. — There are three rather distinct psychologic stages in catarrhal deafness. The first, the period in which most pa- tients refuse absolutely to admit that they are deaf even to the aurist upon whom they call for treatment. They insist that they hear perfectly if people would only speak distinctly. This is partially true, because up to the third stage of deafness the voice can be fairly well heard if people would only articulate clearly. In the second stage patients admit that they don't hear well, but insist that they are going to recover normal hearing and often resort to various kinds of injurious treatment. In the third stage they give up all hope of ever regaining their hearing, become morose, and avoid company. These psychic stages do not al- ways correspond with the pathologic stages given above. Diagnosis. — The external auditory meatus, drum membrane and ossicular chain, constitute the apparatus whose function is that of con- duction of sound waves to the perception apparatus of the inner ear. The function of the conduction apparatus varies inversely with the pro- gress of pathologic change in these structures. The perception appa- ratus, the structures of the inner ear, are not necessarily affected by mid- dle ear pathology, but on the other hand, sounds transmitted by bone conduction not only seem louder but they last longer because the "es- cape of the excess" of sound thus transmitted is hindered by deficient The Practice of Osteopathy 249 conductive mechanism. This explains why such persons hear well by telephone and why the tuning fork, whose base is held to the mastoid (provided there is no nerve affection) may be heard for a greater time than normal. Likewise the prong of the vibrating tuning fork when held near the concha is heard for a shorter time than normal, because of the deficient function of the conduction mechanism. Tuning forks are known by their number of vibrations per second, such as 16, 32, 64, 128, etc. Three or more forks are required to make an accurate measurement of the conduction and perception functions — a low fork about a 32, for the low tones, 128 or a 512 for the medium tones and a 2048 for the high tones. A good set of forks should be selected and standardized, i. e., the normal bone and air conduction of each fork determined by testing it on a number of persons whose hearing is known to be normal. For the general practitioner who cares only to get a general idea of the extent of the pathology, one fork of medium pitch such as a 128 or 512 will be sufficient. To measure the function of .hearing, the fork is set into maximum vibration, its base held against the mastoid and the patient is asked to state when he no longer hears it. This length of time in seconds is re- corded as "bone conduction." The fork is then held near the concha and the patient again states when he does not hear it. This length of time in seconds is recorded as air conduction. Normal Hearing Tuning Fork Test. — The normal time rate in seconds set of forks is as follows : Fork 32 64 128 512 2048 4096 B. C 25 30 30 20 10 A. C tone 70 90 90 40 20 The tuning fork test, carefully made, is the only known method of measuring the functions of the various structures concerned in audition. Tlie Wliisper Test is made by producing a clear whisper from re- sidual air only, which should be heard about twenty feet by a normal ear. Tlie Watch Test is made by using some loud ticking watch (I pre- fer an Ingcrsoll), holding it first near the ear until the patient recognizes the tone, and then taking it beyond the hearing distance and approach- ing the car until it is heard. I prefer also to move away from the ear until the limit is reached and strike an average of this with the above results. 250 The Practice of Osteopathy The average eighteen size Ingersoll watch can be heard for from 100 to 150 inches by the normal ear. The practical test for the patient is his hearing from the spoken voice, and is the most reliable so far as permanent results are concerned. Low Tone Limit. — The lowest Hmit of hearing is about sixteen double vibrations per second, but the lowest practical limit is about thirty-two. There are few people with normal hearing and with musical- ly trained ears who can recognize a definite tone lower than this, so I consider the thirty-two fork sufficiently low for all practical tests. Conduction Deafness. — Low tones are lost in tympanic involve- ment or conduction deafness, and are diagnostic in such cases, but are of no particular value in nerve deafness except when that is compUcated by catarrhal deafness. Practical Hearing Limits. — The human voice varies from about 60 to 150 double vibrations per second, and most sounds that we really need to hear are less than 700 vibrations per second. This is the reason for using the low forks, 64, 128 and 512. Measurement of Nerve Force. — To measure auditory nerve force, the fork (say the 128, whose normal B. C. is 30 seconds) is set into vibration and held gently and with even pressure against the mastoid and the patient is asked to tell or signal the doctor when he ceases to hear the tone. Two or more tests may be made to determine the pa- tient's personal equation, but the use of control forks (the 64 and 512) will show any such error. Granting that there is no complicating path- ology, tympanic or labyrinthine, the number of seconds of hearing over 30 will be the patient's auditory nerve force. For example, if he hears the fork 30 seconds his hearing will be thirty-thirtieths or normal. If his hearing is 25, 20, 15 or 10 seconds, his auditory nerve force will be re- spectively 25-30, 20-30, 15-30 or 10-30. By means of this method an accurate measurement of the functions of hearing can be made and a definite prognosis can be given. I never use any of the various named qualitative fork tests for hearing, because they have no value to one who employs this system. Foot Note — In the chart T is used, meaning that tone is heard, while S indi- cates sound but no tone. Foot Note — It is not the purpose to give any detailed or differential methods of diagnosis because if one cares to treat these diseases he will of course, study a special text on this subject. The methods here given are only for the generl practician who wishes a general idea of the condition present. The Practice of Osteopathy 251 Summary of Diagnosis of Different Stages of Catarrlial Deafness First Stage 1. Fork 32 128 2048 B. C. 35 20 A. C. T 70 40 2. The drum is only slightly retracted but freely movable. 3. Whisper heard from five to twenty feet. 4. Ingersoll watch heard from 30 to 150 inches. Second Stage. 1. Fork 32 128 2048 B. C. 40 20 A. C. T 60 40 Note that the tone of the 32 fork is heard, the 128 fork has increased in bone conduction and reduced in air conduction but that the bone-air ratio is direct, that is the patient hears longer by air than by bone con- duction. Note also that the high fork is stiU normal. 2. The drum wiU be found retracted but that part to which the malleus is attached is still movable when tested with the auroscope. 3. The whisper is heard from two to ten feet. 4. The IngersoU watch is heard from six to sixty inches. 5. Presbyacusia but not paracousia, is present. Tliird Stage. 1. Fork 32 128 2048 B .C. 45 15 A. C. S 20 30 The typical diagnostic points in third stage catarrhal deafness are: 1. Tone for the 32 fork is lost. 2. There is an inverted bone-air ratio for the medium fork. The drum is retracted and the malleus fixed. 4. The whisper may be heard at less than one foot or not at all. 5. The Ingersoll watch is heard less than six inches from the mastoid. 6. Para- cousis Willisiani is present. For the general practician this is important because he can make a rather definite prognosis. Treatment. — The treatment will be given briefly because space would not permit ofl engthy discussions of details of methods and technic. A careful examination should be made for some source of focal in- fection about the nasopharyngeal tract. Chronic or subacute tonsil- FooT Note — Note that the patient hears the tone of the low fork, that the 128 fork has its bone conduction slightly increased (30 to .35) that the air conduction is slightly decreased (90 to 70) and that the high fork remains normal. 252 The Practice of Osteopathy litis, phar>Tigitis or sinuitis or root abscess are often a cause, and not much will be accomplished in improving the otitis media until these focal infections are found and properly treated. The original cause of these focal infections may have been some bony lesion, but to successfully correct such lesion now does not mean that the source of infection will be removed. Auto-intoxication from gastrointestinal disease is common. In my cases, 80% of the third stage have chronic constipation or other chronic gastro-intestinal affection. In many severe acute affections of the naso-pharynx the inflamma- tory process has left the Eustachian tube occluded or stenosed and the pharyngeal fossa filled with adhesive bands. It is not uncommon to find the epipharynx and pharyngeal fossa filled with partially atrophied adenoid tissue or if the curet method has been used for removing ade- noids, there is often connective tissue adhesions and any or all of these may prevent the normal ventilation of the tympanic cavity by way of the Eustachian tube. In such cases sm-gical removal of these obstructions and dilation of the tube is necessary. My practice has been to give a general anes- thetic (nitrous oxide or somnoform will be sufficient in many cases) and by means of an adenotome (La Force or Gradle, I never use a curet) re- move all adenoid tissue. Then by means of the finger I carefully remove any adenoid tissue in the posterior nares and pharyngeal fossae that the adenotome may have failed to get and also dilate the pharyngeal portion of the tube by inserting the finger. This operation if carefully and thoroughly done and if preceeded and followed by the proper surgical cleanliness and supportive treatment, will when indicated, accompKsh excellent results. The after treatment is even more important because if this is not well done, no results or even unfavorable results may occur. The after treatment consists of daily irrigations of the nasopharynx, thorough attention to upper thoracic, cervical and mandibular lesions, aspiration of the Eustachian tubes and other local treatment to the nasopharyngeal membranes. After the operation has been done it is best to do no digital manipulation of the pharynx for from three to six days. After this time digital treatment, gentle dilation of the Eustachian orifice to maintain its patency, stretch- ing of the soft palate to re-establish proper nerve function and the appU- cation of deep pressure in the pharyngeal fossae to stimulate the otic ganghon is important. This treatment is not massage in any sense but definite, purposeful, manipulation and if carefully done will be followed by excellent results. The Practice of Osteopathy 253 Since the origin of this method of treatment, there has been much comment on its value and many have tried or at least they thought they tried it with unfavorable results. The causes of failure are, attempting treatment in cases impossible of cure, or poor diagnosis, improper tech- nic of operator or incomplete operative procedure and inefficient suppor- tive treatment. It must be understood that not all cases of otitis media even in the beginning stages require the above method of treatment or will be bene- fited by it. Those cases which have resulted from other causes than acute pharyngitis seldom require such radical methods of treatment. In every case, the cause must be found and consistent treatment given. In my experience, the radical method of treatment has not been found necessary in more than twenty per cent of cases of chronic otitis media. In the other cases the treatment consists of removing sources of focal infection (about forty per cent) and normalizing nasopharyn- geal reflexes by osteopathic and local treatment (about forty per cent). In aU cases, the treatment must be complete. To remove thoroughly aU obstruction from the epipharynx and leave a source of focal infection in the tonsils will accompHsh Httle, or to remove carefully all pharyngeal obstruction and all sources of focal infection will not restore normal functions of the middle ear structures if the osteopathic lesions and gas- tro-intestinal perversions are neglected. Surgery in itself, even though carefully and thoroughly done, is not efficient treatment and this is why the medical specialists fail in this disease. After the necessary surgery has been done, then normal tone must be restored to the various tissues involved. Normal reflex mechanisms must be re-estabUshed and this can be done by thorough and efficient osteopathic corrective work and the proper local treatment directly to the structures affected. Meniere's Symptom Complex This is a form of catarrhal deafness with all the characteristic path- ology of the first or second stage, but in which, due probably to sudden tubal occlusion, there results a marked variation in the intralabyrinthine pressure and there are, therefore, the symptoms of conduction deafness combined with labyrinthine involvement somewhat resembhng Men- niere's disease. There is dizziness or even vertigo, with head noises, but not the marked prostration and nausea which characterizes Meniere's disease. Treatment. — The treatment is the same as in the first stages of catarrhal deafness and the prognosis is always good. The labyrinthine 254 The Practice of Osteopathy symptoms are usually completely relieved as soon as the middle ear is ventilated. Diseases of the Inner Ear. Acute Suppurations. — Acute suppurative diseases of the laby- rinth occasionally result I'rom the extension of infection from the tympan- mn but they are certainly very rare. Such conditions may result from acute suppurative otitis media in which there has been an excessive col- lection of pus without rupture of the drum or drainage through the tube but this very rarely occurs and after drainage has been estal)lished, laby- rinthine infection is hardly possible. Diagnosis. — Labyrinthitis is of several forms but in gerneral, there are the symptoms of labyrinthine involvement such as : nystagmus, vertigo, nausea, vomiting, headache, earache, deafness and febrile symp- toms. When labyrinthitis is suspected, an aurist of much experience should be called into consultation at once. Treatment. — Suppurative labyrinthitis is not in itself a fatal disease but dangerous compHcations may result because of the close proximity to so many delicate structures. Threatened meningeal infec- tion requires surgical drainage, but unless meningeal infection is immi- nent, surgery is contraindicated. Since the mortahty, considering dangers of compHcations, is not high (about 10%) and since such operations are very compHcated and require great surgical skill, we may conclude that surgery is generally contraindicated. Nonsurgical treatment consists of keeping the patient quiet in bed, Uquid diet, and good eUmination. Drainage through the middle ear or Eustachian tube must be maintained. Deep manipulation of the cervical structures will help to main- tain lymphatic drainage but any treatment which necessitates much movement of the head should be avoided until the symptoms of vestibu- lar irritation have ceased. Non-Suppuratlve Labyrinthine Diseases. Meniere's Disease. — This disease is caused by hemorrhage into the labyrinth with the following symptoms: There is sudden and intense vestibular irritation such as vertigo, marked tinnitus, nausea, vomiting and complete deafness on the affected side. There may also be cere- bral disturbances and loss of consciousness. The Prognosis depends upon the extent and severity of the path- ology. It is probal)le that those cases in which recovery occurs quickly are not true cases of Meniere's disease but have some causes other than The Practice op Osteopathy 255 labjrrinthine hemorrhage. Such cases are perhaps Meniere's Symptom Complex. The Treatment consists of complete rest in bed, Hght diet, and good elimination until the marked irritation has passed. It has been my prac- tice to carry out further treatment similar to that of the treatment of nerve deafness to be given later. Many of these cases will make com- plete recovery. Nerve Deafness. The term "nerve deafness" is generally used very carelessly to apply to any chronic or non-suppurative process of the labyrinthine structures other than those mentioned above, which cause impaired hearing. Nerve deafness is not an uncommon disease. In my cases of deaf- ness there has been some involvement of the labyrinthine structures or auditory nerve in 27% of the cases examined. I think the reason for most authors putting the percentage of nerve deafness much lower than this is because of inexact methods of diagnosis. The above percentage is based upon the actual measurement of nerve force. See measurement of nerve force under non-suppurative otitis media above. A careful study of eases by the method of actual measurement of nerve force, shows that there are two distinct forms of nerve deafness. In one there is only a deficient function of the structures of the labyrinth, due perhaps to some perverted physiologic function, and this form we may call auditory nerve deficiency. The other form of nerve deafness, due probably to an actual degeneration of the nerve or its end organs in the labyrinth, may be properly known as auditory nerve degen- eration. Auditory Nerve Deficiency. — A study of our case reports shows that in 64% of the cases in which the nerve force was 16-30 or high- er (more than half) favorable results were obtained, provided that there was no complicating labyrinthine affection. These cases have been classed as "nerve deficiency" and the pathology as functional. A fa- vorable prognosis (64%) may be offered. Example of tuning fork findings : Fork 32 64 128 512 2048 4096 B. C 18 20 20 20 10 A. C T 50 60 60 '40 20 In addition to the tuning fork findings the voice and watch test will be reduced to from one-tenth to two-thirds normal. The patient often complains of itching meati and dry nares. There are usually no signs or symptoms of labyrinthine affection. 256 The Practice of Osteopathy Treatment. — The treatment consists of local treatment to the nasopharynx, tubes and meati as described under the treatment of chronic otitis media. Everything should be done to build up the patient's general health and improve the local nutrition. It is highly essential to search the entire system for sources of focal and general infection. Autointoxication from chronic gastrointestinal disease was found in 90% of our cases. Any treatment therefore that will restore normal gastro- intestinal function is indicated. Recently we have had some excellent results from colonic irrigation and the proper adjustment of diet in such cases. Any source of focal infection must of course receive proper atten- tion. The osteopathic corrective treatment consists largely of careful at- tention to lesions of the splanchnic area because of the importance of nor- mal digestion, metabolism and elimination. This is certainly a most im- portant part of the treatment and should never be neglected. Upper cervical and mandibular lesions have much to do with the local nutrition to the ear structures and these must not be neglected. The fact that we almost constantly find evidence of deficient nutrition to the meati and drums in this disease together with lesions of the mandible, suggests a local osteopathic cause. Auditory Nerve Degeneration. — In those cases in which there is a measureable deficiency of nerve function of less than half the normal we have found that very few respond to treatment. (See table above.) The cause has therefore been attributed to a structm-al pathology and the condition called auditory degeneration. Example Table: Fork 32 64 128 512 2048 4096 B. C 10 12 8 5 2 A. C S 20 25 15 7 5 There is usually very marked impairment of hearing for voice and all other sounds. The Ingersoll watch may be heard five or ten inches, but usually not at all, and the whispered voice heard only a few inches or not at all. There are nearly always signs and symptoms of labyrinthine deaf- ness and evidence of tone islands. The deafness in these cases is usually progressive regardless of any treatment. In this disease there is nearly always an associated affection of the labyrinth as shown by the high forks. The fractions represented by the high forks will agree in proportion provided there is no labyrinthine involvement. The Practice of Osteopathy 257 Our results in auditory nerve degeneration have been measurable improvement in only 2% of the cases treated. The prognosis is there- fore very poor and I believe we should always tell our patients frankly that there is almost no chance for improving their hearing in such cases. The treatment is the same as that given for nerve deficiency and because of the general good that may be had from treatment, that is, the im- provement of the general resistance, it is often well for the patient to have such treatment to stop the progress of further special sensory degenera- tion. It should always be our purpose to treat the patient rather than to treat some particular organ only and if this method is followed, our gen- eral results will surely be much higher. Diseases of the Nose Method of Examination. — For use in nasal examinations and treatment, a suitable chair with adjustable head rest is of much value be- cause if the patient is not comfortable and in a convenient position, the work is very difficult. A few instruments, such as the following, are very essential: A sterilizer for instruments, head mirror and reflecting lamp, nasal speculum, tongue depressor, tonsil pillar-retractor, a nasal pack- ing forceps and a few aluminum cotton applicators. These instruments are few and comparatively inexpensive, but are of more practical value than a Hfetime collection of electrical apparatus. Any physician can readily learn the use of these instruments and the methods of examina- tion by attending the clinical sessions of our conventions. Methods and technic of treatment, however, require much practice and exper- ience to develop efficiency. Acute Rhinitis This disease, commonly known as a "cold in the head" is one of the most common, and because of the complications which so commonly re- sult, a disease which really requires careful consideration. Etiology. — The predisposing cause is reduced resistance and indi- vidual susceptibility to air borne irritants and infective organisms. Direct exposure of some insufficiently protected part of the body such as the feet in cold, damp weather, exposure of some unprotected part of the body to draughts or exposure of the whole body to slightly reduced temperature for a considerable time, are the common causes. In cold weather, it is very important that the proper indoor humidity be main- tained, because the drying of the mucous membranes renders them sus- 258 The Practice of Osteopathy ceptible to infection. This disease is not only contagious at times but may even become endemic from some specific and virulent organism. The comphcations which may and often do follow such infections are laryngitis, bronchitis, pneumonia, etc. and any one or more of the focal infections, such as sinuitis, tonsilhtis, or middle ear infection. A focal infection thus caused may become chronic and render the patient con- stantly susceptible to head colds. In fact in those persons who suffer from chronic head colds, there may nearly always be found some focal infec- tion, such as the above named, and it is often impossible to get permanent rehef until such sources of focal infection have been properly treated. The influence of gross structural lesions, osteopathic lesions of the cer\dcal and upper thoracic region, vertebrae and ribs must not be over- looked because they exert a powerful influence upon the blood supply, particularly the venous and lymphatic drainage and upon the autonomic nervous mechanism, which regulates the physiologic control of such func- tions. Gross structural abnormalities of the intranasal chambers, such as deflected septum, enlarged turbinates or cellular turbinates, which cause deficient or abnormal breathing space, may cause and maintain head colds. Diagnosis. — The diagnosis is usually easy. Nasal congestion with the usual '' stuffy" feeling of the head, sneezing, headache, etc. are well known symptoms. On direct examination the nares are congested, there is a watery discharge and all of the membranes of the nasopharyn- geal tract are congested. Treatment. — If there is ever a demand for good, thorough and specific osteopathic work, certainly it is demanded in such cases. I am an advocate of thorough, deep relaxing treatment followed by spe- cific adjustment in such cases. Complete rest in bed with hght diet and careful attention to the ehm- ination are verj^ essential. Perhaps the most difficult problem is to con- vince the patient that a head cold is really a serious disease and demands thorough and prompt treatment. Every ear, nose and throat speciahst has had ample opportunity to know that most of the really serious com- plications of the head and neck result from the lack of prompt and proper attention to head colds. The local treatm.ent consists of irrigation of the nasopharynx fol- lowed by oil spray to protect from further irritation and the mainten- ance of proper drainage from the sinuses and middle ears. I am not an advocate of the so-called "antiseptic sprays" because they neither destroy bacteria sufficiently to be effective nor do they maintain drainage. The Practice of Osteopathy 259 In all cases, the physician should be ever watchful for the complica- tions and should not hesitate to call consultation of a specialist when such symptoms develop. Purulent Rhinitis Persistent inflammations of the nasal membranes are usually of a purulent nature or at least have had such a cause in the beginning. Etiology. — Purulent rhinitis may be a result of an unsuccessfully treated infection of the nose or throat following some disease of child- hood or early life. It may be due to infection at birth. Commonly there is a subacute or chronic sinus infection that maintains the infection of the nasal mucosa. Polyps, enlarged or cellular turbinates, adenoids or adhesions in the epipharynx, often retain the secretions and cause chronic rhinitis. In many cases I have found that osteopathic lesions of the cer- vical or upper thoracic region are effective causes of chronic rhinitis. The Pathology consists of hyperemia, hypertrophy and exfoliation of the cellular membrane. The turbinates and all membranes become enlarged and thickened and the breathing space is usually greatly de- creased. The Symptoms are nasal obstruction, and mucous or mucopuru- lent discharge with usually hypersensitiveness, which causes sneezing and other symptoms common to "head colds." Treatment. — The same treatment as given above for acute rhinitis applies here. A thorough examination should be made for all of the various causes given above and the proper corrective treatment given for any or all such causes. Chronic Hypertrophic Rhinitis Etiology. — Chronic rhinitis is usually a result of an infective rhi- nitis and has for its cause any one or more of the various causes given above under purulent rhinitis. Pathology. — The pathology in chronic rhinitis varies with the cause, but is usually characterized by a series of changes beginning with infec- tion and hyperemia and followed by an actual and usually marked hyper- trophy of the interstitial tissue. The posterior ends of thei nferior or, less often, the middle turbinates are usually enlarged and extend back- ward into the pharynx. The Symptoms aie much the same as in purulent rhinitis, except that the purulent discharge is often not present. These cases usually suffer from chronic head colds, headaches and persistent nasal 260 The Practice of Osteopathy obstruction. The-senses of smell and taste are usually impaired and there is a nasal twang to the voice. Treatment. — In these cases, it is common to find osteopathic causes which prevent proper drainage from the head and neck and this is im- portant because, if all the local causes are properly corrected, this is not sufficient to effect a cure. Surgical treatment for the removal of polyps, sj^nechia, adenoids, adhesions, correction of septum, or hypertrophied or cellular middle tm-- binates is often essential and certainly infected sinuses must be properly drained. We have had cases in which root abscesses seemed to be ac- tive causes, but it must not be thought that surgery and sm-gery alone is hkely to cure chronic rhinitis, and I want to caution against the whole- sale removal of turbinates for such conditions. The mere fact that the turbinates are enlarged is not sufficient reason for their removal. There has been a cause for this enlargement and turbinotomy or turbinectomy does not remove this cause. Cautery is worse, because it seldom ac- comphshes more than very temporary results and often leaves the mem- branes worse than before. Cautery destroys mucous membrane, leaving a dry and easily irritated surface which is often impossible to normahze. The proper surgery, carefully done, followed by efficient osteopathic corrective work and thorough irrigation of the nasopharyngeal tract with the necessary oil spray protection after irrigation, will constitute efficient treatment. Treatment, thorough and long continued, will in due time restore nutrition, drainage and normal reflex nerve control to the tissues. Treatment after surgery is essential. Intranasal Treatment. — Many cases are caused by the retention of secretions under the turbinates and in the superior vault. In all cases, therefore, it is essential to thoroughly free all possible retention cavities by means of a small cotton-wound probe before irrigation. The intranasal membranes are adrenahzed and anesthetized and a thorough examination >is made using a good reflecting lamp, nasal speculum and cotton tipped probe. Every part of the intranasal re- gion is inspected for sources of purulent discharge, mucus collections, synechia and for hypersensitive areas. The probe is curved at the end and passed under each turbinate and drawn forward and backward with considerable pressure to insure that any collection of foreign matter is thoroughly lemoved. Every part of. the intranasal region should be thoroughly treated in this way. The hiatus semilunaris must be kept well open to permit free antrum drainage and all other sinus openings should be kept free from any obstruction that may block the drainage. The Peactice of Osteopathy 261 This particular technic requires great care and practice, but it is very effective and so commonly we have found that this work thoroughly done will reduce much and in some cases all of the turbinate hypertro- phy rendering surgery unnecessary. Atrophic Rhinitis As the term suggests, this disease is just the opposite from hyper- trophic rhinitis in that the membranes are shrunken, the nares are wide open and usually the membranes are coated with a mucopurulent dis- charge, accompanied by a bad ordor. It is a chronic disease and progres- sive in nature. Etiology. — Deficient nutrition, systemic or local, or some degener- ative infective process constitutes the cause. Some cases may be traced to syphiHs, but this is certainly not always the cause. Chronic sinuitis, the cause of which is some virulent infection, is often the cause. Too much or incorrect surgery and cautery is certainly a cause in many cases. Pathology. — The marked atrophic appearance, the retracted tur- binates, the excessive purulent or mucopurulent foul discharge are characteristic and diagnostic. The tissues underlying the mucous membranes are shrunken, and at- rophic and this tissue has usually been replaced, sometimes almost com- pletely, by connective tissue, and thus the blood supply is markedly deficient. Treatment. — In chronic cases, those in which the atrophy is well progressed, there is no hope of restoration to normal conditions, but I l^elieve that the progress of practically every case can be stopped and that, in most cases, a permanent cure can be effected under proper treatment. Every ijossible source of focal infection, such as sinuitis, pharyn- gitis, tonsillitis, etc. should receive proper attention promptly. After this has been done and sufficient time allowed for normalization, a blood count may reveal some other source of focal or general infection, which may be reducing the general resistance. Auto-intoxication from some gastro-intestinal affection is commonly a cause and must receive proper attention. The general health of the pa- tient must be restored and maintained. Thorough osteopathic treatment must be given for any cause of low- ered nutrition, local or general. The failure, I believe, in medical practice (They admit failure in this disease) is due to the lack of attention to the restoration of normal nutrition. Why drain a sinus and leave an atlas or upper thoracic lesion which decreases the local nutrition and leaves these membranes susceptible to further infection? 262 The Practice of Osteopathy Before and after surgical drainage, irrigation of the nasopharjTi- geal tract. Thorough irrigation to cleanse every part. Hot irrigation (one gallon of salt mixture solution, salt 3 parts, borax 2 parts, and soda 1 part, a tablespoonful to the gallon at 118°F. to 123^F.) to cleanse, to free all parts from infection and to restore blood supply to the affected parts. Frequent irrigation, daily for a sufficient time to thoroughly sterihze and restore circulation. After each irrigation, an oil spray (any non-irritating petroleum oil) is applied freely to protect the membranes from irritation and further infection. Before each irrigation a thorough probe treatment, as described under hypertrophic rhinitis, should be given that the membranes may be thoroughly freed from all retained secretions. After the membranes are once clean, the sinuses free from infection and the blood supply reestablished, the treatment may be reduced in fre- quency to three times weekly, but the treatment must be continued for months or even years to effect a permanent cure. The patient can be taught to do his own irrigation after the disease is well under control. All irritating sprays, chemical cauteries, etc. must be avoided. The so- called "antiseptic sprays" do harm by irritating the membranes and cer- tainly do no good, because they do not cleanse the parts. They only serve to deodorize, but actually accompHsh nothing in the way of cure. It has been my experience that iodine and the silver salts in any of their various preparations are not efficient but that they actually do harm. My experience indicates that practically every case can be cured if the proper treat aent is given for sufficient ti ae. Pharmacodynamics If I may be pardoned for discussing things pharmacological in a text on practice, I want to urge that chemicals as such, are usually a failure in treatment. My results from various series of experimental work both laboratory and chnical, show quite conclusively that there are very few, if any, chemical substances that have actual value by virtue of their chemical properties alone. There are, however, cases in which chemical agents may be used to advantage to obtain desirable physical results and physiologic reactions. The salt mixture mentioned above increases the solvent power of the water for mucus, pus, and other collected material and it also renders the water less irritating to the mucous membranes. Other than this, it has no value so far as I know. This solution is certainly not antiseptic or germicidal, further than that cleanliness may be considered an antisep- tic procedure. The Practice of Osteopathy 263 The phenol-glycerine (10% phenol and 90% glycerine) which we have recommended, is somewhat germicidal, non-irritating, except to the nasal mucosa, is a protectant to inflamed membranes in some instances and is also somewhat hygroscopic. These virtues to the Umited extent that they may be of advantage, depend chiefly upon physical quahties. Adrenalin in high dilutions (1 to 5000 to 1 to 10,000) is of value in retracting the erectile tissues of the nares for puproses of examination and for obtaining better drainage, etc. It also constricts the small blood vessels and thus reduces the chances for hemorrhage or absorp- tion of narcotic drugs which may necessarily be used as local anesthetics. The effects of adrenaHn are very temporary and it is, therefore, of Httle value in treatment. Following irrigation I have used the petroleum oils (Hquid petrola- tum) to advantage as a protection to the mucous membrane. One half gram each of menthol and camphor and two or three drops of cinnamon oil to the pint of this oil, is readily dissolved and produces a pleasant, soothing effect to inflamed membranes, but further than this, the add- ed substances have no particular value. The above named chemical agents constitute, except in rare instances, my stock of "drugs" for treatment purposes. Hyperesthetic Rhinitis — Hay Fever There is perhaps no disease in which there has been more speculation concerning the etiology than in hay fever, and while osteopathy has ac- complished a wonderful advance in the treatment of this disease, I am not sure that the cause or causes are yet thoroughly understood. Etiology. — The theoretic causes of this disease may be expressed in the various names which have been given to it as follows: The term Hay Fever suggests that it is a febrile condition caused by hay pollen irritation. Peach cold. Rose cold. Rose fever. Rose catarrh. Rye fever and Ragweed fever suggest similar specific causes. Idiosyncratic coryza means nothing and this probably expresses what the theorists know about its cause better than any other name. Hysteric rhinitis suggests a prob- able psychic cause, which certainly does exist in some cases. If I may be pardoned, and I know I never will be, let me suggest just one more name — "Respiratory Reflex Ineflaciency. " Intoxications. — Autointoxication from focal infections or from gastro-intestinal perversions certainly have an important influence either directly or as predisposing factors and should always be carefully considered in treatment. 264 The Practice of Osteopathy Osteopathic Lesions. — Osteopathic lesions, such as interosseous, muscular and Hgamentous, seem to function as predisposing causes by their general effects upon the sj^stem. It seems probable that their ef- fects upon the organs of metaboHsm and elimination are of greater impor- tance than any direct or specific effect in causing the immediate symptoms. In practically all cases lesions of the upper thoracic vertebrae and ribs and of the cervical region are present. It is my opinion that such lesions are more often secondary than primary. Respiratory Reflex Inefficiency. — Measurement of nerve force in these cases shows that none are really possessed with "an excess of nerve force, " but that practically all vary from two-thirds to four-fifths normal, showing that probably all cases are deficient in nerve force. This instabiUty of the nervous system can be explained, I believe, in the theory of peripheral reflex insufficiency. As evidence of this the following facts may be cited: 1. It is known that peripheral irritation of almost any nature, to the mucous membranes of the nasopharyngeal tract, will excite an attack in susceptible individuals. 2. That any treatment which tends to increase the resistance of these membranes will prevent or reheve an attack. 3. That peripheral inhibition to these surfaces will temporarily relieve an attack. 4. That complete normahzation of these membranes will make the patient resistive to the so-called specific irritants, such as pollen, dust, etc. 5. That the mucous membranes of the entire respiratory and gas- tro-intestinal tract react to irritants to bring about "the hay fever state" and that any treatment which tends to normalize these membranes, ren- ders the patient more resistive to hay fever attacks. Exciting Causes. — There is no doubt that various air-borne irri- tants, such as pollen, dust, chemical fumes, emanations from animals, etc., act as exciting causes of acute attacks, and j^et there are cases that develop acute attacks out of season or at a time when it seems that there could be no air-borne irritation. From evidence which will be offered later (see prognosis) I am led to beUeve that probably all susceptible cases can be made entirely resistive to the air-borne irritants. Patliology Functional Patliology. — Certainly in this disease there is ample evidence of marked perversions of function or functional pathology. The Practice of Osteopathy 265 Kyle believes that in many cases the cause of local irritation lies in "some chemical change in the constituents of the mucus-secreting glands, " and "it is a well known fact that in many cases of hay fever the irritation is not hmited to the nasal mucous membrane. The eyes and mucous membrane of the stomach and bladder, and even the intestines may be markedly irritated." These chemical changes in the secretion of the mucous membranes, together with the excess of uric acid would seem to point either to a general perversion of the secretory mechanism or to a deficient elimination, or to both. The periodic occurrence may be accounted for by assuming that the systemic strain is sufficient to initiate the symptoms. The fact that the attack is actually delayed or hastened in susceptible in- dividuals by the late or early beginning of hot weather, and that these cases get rehef by going to a more moderate chmate is further evidence of this. Again we are reminded of Dr. Still's teaching, that the body main- tains its own chemical laboratory which adjusts or tends to adjust its work to the needs of that body, but under abnormal strain this adjustive mechanism may fail to meet all of the demands of function. It seems here that the osteopathic concept may easily include all environmental causes as well as internal causes in the predisposition to deficient func- tion or disease. Structural Pathology. — During the attack there is a general catar- rhal inflammation of all nasopharyngeal membranes, accompanied by a watery discharge and marked swelling of the turbinates. Sensitive areas may be found on the middle turbinate and opposite wall of the septum. Probably it is this hypersusceptibility to irritation that causes the attack from the air-borne irritants. The pseudo-membrane which may be found covering a part or all of the mucous membranes of the nares probably results from this irrita- tion and is formed for the purpose of protection. Clinical Types. — CHnically, three rather indefinite types of hay fever may be recognized, viz.: Vernal, those cases which have their at- tack sometime during May, June or July; Autumnal, in which the attack occurs in August or September and usually lasts until the beginning of cold weather, and an indefinite or pseudo form occurring at any time of the year, with no characteristic attack, as in the other forms, but with indefinite s^^mptoms resembhng hay fever. Symptoms and Diagnosis. — Patients usually go to the physician self diagnosed. The characteristic sneezing, the watery discharge from 266 The Practice of Osteopathy the nose, and the irritation of all membranes of the naso-pharynx and conjunctiva will serve to make a diagnosis in most cases. Direct exam- ination will reveal the nasal congestion and other characteristic pathology as described above. Termination. — Most cases of the autumnal form, unless successful- ly treated, continue with equal or increased severity until after the first or second frost, when they usually terminate in asthma, bronchitis or sinuitis, which lasts for several weeks or months. Each year the at- tack lasts longer and is nore severe and the asthma occurs earlier and is more severe. Treatment Intranasal Surgery. — Intranasal abnormalities, such as deflected septum, spurs on the septum, hypertrophied turbinates, polypi, etc., which materially reduce the breathing space, usually demand surgery. Nasal surgery, carefully and properly done, is always a great aid and often absolutely essential to the successful treatment of hay fever and asthma, but nasal surgery carelessly done frequently does more harm than good. The correction of a deflected septum or the removal of a spur on the septum by submucous operation often aids materially in the prevention of pressure irritation, increases the breathing space and normalizes drain- age from the sinuses. Surgery is therefore very essential in many cases of hay fever, but surgery is never the all essential part of the treatment, because if the proper after treatment is not given, the surgery alone will seldom result in either temporary relief or cure. Focal Infection. — The importance of focal infection of the sinuses, tonsils, teeth and occasionally other parts, such as the nasal cavities, epipharynx, middle ear and mastoid cavities cannot be overestimated. Such conditions may be effective in causing hay fever, by causing direct infection of the membranes of the naso-pharyngeal tract or by auto- intoxication. Digital Surgery, for the removal of adhesions in the posterior nares and pharynx, is in my opinion, very essential, and this work should be done thoroughly. Massage of the soft palate or pharyngeal walls is of no particular value. All adhesions and adenoid tissue must be removed because this removes an effective source of constant irritation and focal infection and tends to normalize the direct and reflex nerve mechanism. The practice of the radical intranasal technique as originated by The Practice of Osteopathy 267 J. D. Edwards, D. 0., is indicated, I beKeve, in some cases in which the crushing of cellular middle turbinates, or the breaking of adhesions is indicated, but I am not yet ready to accept this theory of "curetting" the mucous membrane by radical digital technique. The fracture of the turbinates is not necessarily a bad technique provided they are prop- erly readjusted as Dr. Edwards does it, but to fracture and not readjust is a dangerous practice. The efficiency and safety of any method depends upon the operator's definite knowledge of what needs to be accompHshed and how it is to be done. There are contraindications to digital, as well as any other kind of nasopharjmgeal surgery, such as: (1) Acute infection of any part of the nasopharyngeal tract; (2) evidence of sinus involvement; (3) septal deflections, spurs and hypertropKied turbinates, which would not permit such work without undue trauma. There are certain other precautions such as thorough cleanhness of the parts to be treated; aspiration of the sinuses before and afterward, and the use of a finger of sufficient size which will not produce undue trau- ma. In my opinion very few doctors have such fingers. Failure in accomplishing results is due to three things, viz., (1) In- sufficient knowledge of diagnosis and prognosis; (2) insufficient knowl- edge of what should be accompHshed and the technique of doing it, and (3) the necessary additional or supportive treatment. It is a great mistake to think that the removal of adhesions in the pharynx or nares is sufficient, because if this is not followed by the proper supportive treatment, no results or even bad results will frequently occur. This treatment is not a massage in any sense, but a definite operative procedure and requires as much care and skill as the removal of adenoids or tonsils. Space will not permit an explanation of the digital technique and the radical treatment should not be attempted without some definite knowl- edge of the methods and technique. Intranasal Treatment. — The intranasal method of treatment as explained above under hypertrophic rhinitis is very effective and if care- fully and thoroughly done is in most cases just as efficient as intranasal digital surgery. This treatment followed by irrigation and oil spray and nasal pacldng will be found effective in most cases if the treatment is properly don(>. Nasal Packing. — Thorough packing of the nasal cavities after all sources of focal infection have been removed and after thorough cleans- 268 The Practice of Osteopathy ing has been done, by means of long strips of absorbent cotton is effective in reducing the swelling and iriitation. The Radical Packing Method. — This method can be done best in a hospital. The nares are prepared as for surgical operation, by com- plete retraction of all erectile tissue, thorough cleansing by irrigation and the apphcation of a local anesthetic. Anesthesia need not be complete. A careful examination is then made for any sjmechia, or focal infections. Packing should never be done until the doctor is sure there is no sinus involvement. The entire nasal cavity is then packed very firmly with sterile gauze. This is best done by means of a special packing instru- ment or long nasal packing forceps, using narrow gauze contained in tubes. In some cases the nasal ca\aty is lubricated before packing. The packing should be done early in the morning and removed just before bed-time, so that the patient may sleep. This treatment is re- peated daily until all signs and sjTuptoms of nasal irritation are gone and then replaced by irrigation and oil spray. If tliis treatment is properly done, there will be a complete sloughing of the pseudo-membrane followed by a restoration of normal and resis- tive tissue. The results of our two years' experience (we have tried this on only a few patients each year) are very encouraging. Relief fi;om the sj^Tiptoms are very prompt and seemingly more permanent than from other methods. Treatment of Auto-lntoxication. — All sources of focal infection are thoroughly treated. Sinus infection is very common and must re- ceive proper attention before any other treatment can be effective. Our experience shows that many cases have auto-intoxication of gastro-intestinal origin. The hospital care of such cases makes possible the thorough cleansing of the colon by irrigation and the reestabhshment of an acid producing flora which seems to prevent fermentation. Osteopathic Corrective Worl<. — Thoroughness of treatment for the removal of all causes is the secret of success. To successfully remove the immediate sources of auto-intoxication by treating a sinus infection or by thoroughly freeing the colon from fermentation products means only temporary results if the underlying causes are not corrected. A thorough osteopathic examination is necessary to determine such causes and certainly such treatment should not be neglected. Correction of all cervical and upper thoracic lesions and particularly the clavicles and ribs is important. These lesions seem to be the result rather than the cause, but normal respiratory functions seemingly cannot be maintained unless such treatment is done. The Practice of Osteopathy 269 Sinuitis I Acute or chronic inflammatory disease of the nasal accessory si- nuses with or without suppuration is more common, I believe, and is re- sponsible for more complications and chronic affections of the nose and throat than is generally known. Etiology. — The cause in most cases hes in unsuccessfully treated acute infections involving the nose and throat. Abnormalities of the nasal respiratory passages such as deflected septum, enlarged or cellular turbinates, adhesions resulting from cautery or careless surgery, causing deficient drainage, constitute the local causes. Underlying some of these direct causes, lesions of the cervical region which impair the nutrition to and drainage from the head are to be considered. Symptoms and Diagnosis. — Acute or chronic headaches and neu- ralgic pains of the head are common symptoms. Acute sinuitis of the frontal sinuses is accompanied by marked and persistent frontal headache and pain in the eyes. In infections of the maxillary sinus there is usually pain over the affected part, but there is often referred pain to other parts of the head. Sphenoidal sinuitis usually causes general headache with no definite location. By direct examination of the nasal cavities a purulent or mucopur- ulent discharge may be seen and the source determined. In many cases, however, the pus may be retained or insufficient in amount to detect by direct examination. Transillumination in a dark room by means of a good transillum- inator will usually show a darkened area over the affected part. The average battery equipments commonly sold for this purpose are of httle value. The X-ray plate when properly done, is more dependable than the transilluminator. In some cases, all of these methods fail to locate the affected sinus and the cause can be found only by opening into the sinuses, aspirating with a catheter and making microscopic examination of the aspirated material. The microscope is indispensible for this work. Every sus- picious discharge should be stained until pus is found and except in wel 1 defined cases, this is the only practical method of positive diagnosis. Treatment. — Local treatment of the nasal cavities by retracting the turbinates and irrigation will be successful in many cases, but unless there is a large normal opening the pus will not drain sufficiently and probe treatment is required. In acute cases in which the pain is marked, osteopathic treatment of the cervical region, deep relaxation of the sub- 270 The Practice of Osteopathy maxillary structures and the application of heat over the affected part, together with the local nasal treatment should be given, but if this does not relieve the pain within twenty-four hours, the sinus should be opened and thoroughly drained. If efficient drainage is not established early the symptoms will usually increase until the pain is almost unbearable and serious complications may result. In practically every case of acute sinuitis, I beheve it is best to make a good, free opening into the affected sinus first and secure complete drain- age by catheter aspiration. If this is properly done every case will recover much more quickly and without comphcations or danger of chronic infection. Non-Suppurative Sinuitis Cases of non-suppurative sinus involvement are not at all uncommon. The so-called "Vacuum sinuitis" which results from a closure of the normal opening, resulting in inflammation without pus formation, is re- sponsible for many of the complicated cases of referred pain, which are so often improperly diagnosed. Chronic headaches and the various symptoms of fifth nerve affections, the neuralgias of the head, are fre- quently caused by non-suppurative sinus involvement. Treatment. — The treatment consists of estabhshing good drainage and proper ventilation of the affected sinus or sinuses followed by thor- ough intranasal treatment as explained above. The osteopathic correc- tive work must not be neglected. Sypliilis of the Nose In osteopathic practice syphilis is not a common disease. The oc- currence of syphilis of the nose is still more rare but certainly should be recognized. Diagnosis. — The local lesions of the nose are of two types, those of acquired syphihs and of congenital syphilis. There are three characteristic manifestations of acquired sypliihs as follows. The primary lesion or hard chancre is a firm, indurated ulcer- ated mass with only slight discharge. Chancre of the nose is exceedingly rare. In secondary syphilis there is the mucous patch, the result of mu- cous membrane necrosis. In tertiary syphihs the local lesion is the gum- ma or more commonly, the ulceration left from necrosis of the gum- ma. These lesions may appear from a few to many years after the ini- tial infection, but they never follow immediately. The lesions may ap- pear on almost any part of the intranasal structures. They resemble The Practice of Osteopathy 271 the lesions of atrophic rhinitis but in atrophic rhinitis there is never the extent of destruction that so frequently results from tertiary syphihs. Treatment. — It has been my practice to refer all suspected cases to Dr. F. J. Stewart for differential diagnosis and treatment and his method of the use of salvarsan has proven efficient. Epistaxis — Nose Bleed The causes of nose bleed may be divided into two general groups, local and constitutional. The first group consists of trauma directly to the nose either external or internal, from nasal operations and other caus- es. The presence of a cluster of thin-walled veins on the anterior part of the septum wliich readily rupture from shght cause, constitutes per- haps the most common cause of nose bleed. The ulcers of atrophic rhi- nitis or syphihs occasionally cause bleeding. Mahgnant growths of the nose may cause frequent and profuse hemorrhage. The constitutional causes of epistaxis are, the acute fevers, cardiac and arterial diseases, which cause excessive tension; and cases of altered composition of the blood such as the anemias, malaria, purpura, chlorosis, hemophiUa, etc. Diagnosis. — Direct examination of the nose will usually reveal the cause. If there are no signs of trauma or rupture of the anterior group of vessels and the bleeding does not respond quickly to packing of the affected side, there is either a rupture of a large vessel; which requires long continued pacldng, or it belongs to the class of constitutional disease. If there is evidence of some necrotic disease of the nose or if there are areas of exposed bone or cartilage from careless surgery, these may usually be seen and the point of bleeding located. Treatment. — Cold appfications, irrigation of the nares with cold normal salt solution and the application of an absorbent cotton or gauze pack is usually sufficient to stop the average case of epistaxis from any cause. The direct application of cold to the lower cervical region will cause capillary restriction. There are many cases in which the membranes of the nose have lost their tone due to various irritants or from deficient nutrition to the parts. These are cases of a wholly different type from that of the well known necrotic diseases such as atrophic rhinitis and syphilis. Hay fever is a result of such a cause. The treatment in such cases consists of removing any local causes or osteopathic lesions and then normalizing the resis- tance of the membranes by the methods described under the treatment for hay fever. 272 The Practice of Osteopathy The treatment for those cases of epistaxis due to constitutional dis- ease depends wholly upon the causative factors and the proper treat- ment of these. Any local treatment in such cases will be expected to produce only temporary results. Diseases of the Nasopharynx The nasopharynx may be the location of acute or chronic inflamma- tions, neoplasms, malignant or nonmalignant, processes of atrophy or hypertrophy, adhesions, etc. It is important to remember that the naso- pharynx admits the Eustachian tubes and supports four superficially located gangha of the fifth nerve. Acute Nasopharyngitis.— Acute inflammatory pi'ocesses of this region may result from rhinitis, infections of the lower pharynx, focal in- fections of these parts or from direct involvement of its own structures. The symptoms are post nasal tenderness and mucus dropping. Some patients experience the sensation of a foreign body in that location. The thick, adherent collections of mucus are difficult to dislodge and some- times are so persistent that they cause nausea. There is usually occlu- sion of the Eustachian tubes, resulting in partial deafness, tinnitus and often dizziness. The Treatment consists of thorough cleanliness by irrigation and osteopathic corrective work to the cervical region. It is also es- sential to keep the anterior neck structures particularly those of the submaxillary region, thoroughly relaxed to maintain efficient drainage. Chronic- Nasopharyngitis This is one of most common diseases of the nasopharyngeal tract, causative of many complications and yet perhaps the least recognized in proportion to its significance. The frequent occurrence of adhesions of the pharyngeal fossae, hypertrophied membranes, enlarged spongy extensions of the inferior and middle turbinates (the posterior turbinate bodies) occlusion of the orifice of the Eustachian tubes and chronic, ex- cessive secretion of thick mucus all show that this disease has either gone unrecognized or at least has not received proper treatment. Treatment. — Complete surgical removal of all abnormal growths, adhesions, etc. as described under the treatment of chronic non-suppur- ative otitis media and this followed by thorough irrigation and other meth- ods of local treatment described above are efficient. The successful treat- ment of this disease requires time. There has been a partial or, in some cases, almost a complete loss of the normal fuctions of the nerve reflex The Practice of Osteopathy 273 mechanism of these parts, peripheral reflex inefficiency and this must be restored. Efficient and long continued treatment of the lesions commonly found in the cervical and upper thoracic regions will do much to restore these normal functions, but this alone without the surgical treatment ill never effect a permanent cure. Neither will the surgery and local treatment alone effect a cure. The whole treatment is required. Adenoids Adenoids are the hypertrophied lymphoid tissue of the nasopharynx. They occur commonly in children, as a result of acute inflammations. Possibly the suckling process of the child produces a partial vacuum of the epipharynx and thus causes excessive blood supply to the part and therefore excessive growth of these soft tissues. Adenoids, however, are not confined to children but frequently occur in adults. In all cases they are a source of much annoyance and often the cause of acute and chronic disease. Symptoms and Diagnosis. — Mouth breathing, head colds, partial deafness, etc. are the common symptoms. The flattened nose, the high arch of the hard palate and the stupid appearance of the face are diagnos- tic. By direct palpation to the nasopharynx the nature and extent of the adenoid mass can be determined and this is the best method of diag- nosis. Treatment. — Many methods of non-surgical treatment have been employed, but there is nothing as satisfactory as complete surgical re- moval. Adenoid tissue has no known function different from that of other lymphoid tissue and there is always sufficient to perform any neces- sary function without excess of adenoid growth. The excessive adenoid growth is in every case a detriment to normal development, because it impairs nasal respiration and usually causes chronic nasopharyngitis and thus reduces resistance against all diseases of childhood. There is therefore, no excuse, much less a reason, why excessive adenoid growths should not be removed surgically, provided it is properly and thorough- ly done. The operation for removing adenoids requires in cliildren, a general anesthetic. In adults, a local anesthetic is used by some operators. I have found it best to first break the adenoid aass away from the side walls of the pharynx digitally. A LaForce or Gradle adenotome is then used to remove the adenoid mass. If either of these instruments is properly used it will always remove the greater part of the adenoid mass without undue trauma or injury to any of the pharyngeal structures. 274 The Practice of Osteopathy Cnrets should never be used because they ahnost never remove the aden- oid mass properly, but they usually do injure the pharynx. Many cases of pharjmgeal adhesions. Eustachian tube occlusion and naso- pharyngitis result from direct injury caused by curets. After the adenoid mass has been removed the finger is inserted into the pharynx and any adenoid growths in the posterior naresare removed. The pharyngeal fossae are also thoroughly freed from adenoid tissue and adhesions and the orifices of the pharyngeal portions of the tubes are gently dilated. This method insm-es complete removal of all excessive adenoid tissue, and normal functions of the nasopharynx. Adenoids thus removed do not return. After the surgical work has been completed the nasopharjTigeal tract should be thoroughly irrigated with hot salt mixture solution. This thoroughly cleanses the membranes, hastens healing, prevents hem- orrhage and avoids post-operative infection. Irrigation of the naso- pharynx should be continued for some days or until all evidences of in- flammation have ceased. The pharynx should then be examined to be sure that no adhesions have developed from inflammation, but if the operation is carefully done, complications will never result. Diseases of the Oropharynx Acute Pharyngitis Acute inflammations of the pharynx alone or in common with in- flammations of other parts of the nasopharyngeal tract are common. This disease is most common as a result of the acute infections affecting the nose and throat. Etiology. — The predisposing causes are focal infections of the nasopharynx, such as tonsilhtis, sim,itis, etc. Deficient nutrition or anemia of the pharynx or systemic anemia are common causes. Lesions of the cervical, upper thoracic and hyoid are common predisposing causes. Undue exposm*e of the neck in susceptible persons or too much or too tight clothing about the neck ma}^ also predispose to inflammations of the pharynx. The exciting causes are the acute infections, colds and focal infec- tions. Perhaps the most common exciting cause is tonsillitis, acute or chronic. Symptoms and Diagnosis. — The characteristic dr\Tiess of the pharj^nx, pain and persistent coughing are diagnostic. Upon direct examination, the reddened, swollen appearance of the pharynx and pos- terior pillars can be seen. I The Peactice of Osteopathy 275 Treatment. — The treatment should be general and local and should be determined by the causes and conditions present. This dis- ease is usually an acute infection and Kke other acute infections, the usual systemic treatment should be applied. The local treatment consists of throrough cleansing of the naso- pharynx (by irrigation if the patient can permit) and the frequent (or occasional as required) use of some gargle until the inflammation has sub- sided. Any cleansing nonirritative solution may be used for a gargle. Equal parts of peroxide, alcohol and glycerine, a tablespoonful to a half glass of very warm water or ten to fifteen drops of phenol-glycerine to a half glass of warm water will make a good cleansing gargle. The osteopathic treatment consists of corrective work to the cer- vical, upper thoracic and hyoid and thorough relaxation of the submaxil- lary musculature to obtain good venous and Ijnnphatic drainage. If sufficient care be taken to avoid trauma, digital stretching of the soft palate and pharvngeal muscles by the use of the finger internally, is very efficacious. Chronic Pharyngitis Chronic pharyngitis may be hypertrophic, atrophic or granular. In hypertrophic pharyngitis the pathologic changes have passed beyond the stage of hyperemia and there is always hypertrophy or hyperplasia, usually the latter, of the pharyngeal membranes. These changes in most cases, have extended to and involved all of the nasopharyngeal mem- branes. Chronic granular pharyngitis, or so-called clergyman's sore throat, has a similar pathology to that described above, but with swollen and inflamed lymph follicles. This condition seems to be a result of exces- sive use of the voice. Chronic atrophic pharyngitis has a similar etiology and the diagnos- tic signs are also similar to atrophic nasopharyngitis with which it is us- ually associated. Etiology. — The causative factors are similar or the sa^ne as those of nasopharyngitis. Lesions of the cervical and upper thoracic and chronic focal infections such as tonsillitis, sinuitis, etc. are the common causes. Treatment. — The nature of the treatment should be determined ])y the causes found. The nature of the pathology requires long contin- ued treatment and careful attention to all causes. Thorough osteopathic corrective work, the removal of all sources of focal infection, proper at- 276 The Practice of Osteopathy tention to any gastro-intestinal perversions which may be causing auto- intoxication and thorough cleanhness of the parts by gargling with some cleansing, nonirritating solution and by irrigation. In most cases there is a considerable collection of adhesions in the nasopharynx or posterior nares or in both. Enlarged "posterior tur- binate bodies" and the extension of the inferior turbinates into the pharynx are also common results of the hypertrophic process. Complete surgical removal of this excess tissue and the after treatment as described above under chi'onic nasopharyngitis are frequently required to obtain com- plete and permanent results. These cases can be successfully treated if the proper attention is given to aU possible causes in each individual case. It is the individual- ization, the specific and detailed attention to the cause or causes, and such treatment continued for sufficient time, that will obtain results. In atrophic pharyngitis, normal nutrition to the parts and usually to the entire system must be restored. Many such cases are secondary to systemic anemia or to rheumatic intoxication. A careful examination should be made for evidence of systemic causes. In many cases, I be- heve that thorough osteopathic corrective work applied to the mid and lower spine is the most essential part of the treatment. Other than this the local treatment as described under atrophic rliinitis appUes here. Tonsillitis There is perhaps no other organ of the body, diseases of which have caused a greater variance of opinion relative to treatment than the ton- sils. There are those who beheve that every hypertrophied, atrophied, or infected tonsil together with its fellow of the opposite side should be removed. There are also those who believe that no tonsils, regardless of their pathology, should ever be removed. These are the radicals and their views are not at all in keeping with present day facts. Those physicians and surgeons who have tried to arrive at some safe conclusion on this subject, beheve that there are certain methods of non- surgical treatment which are effective in aany cases and they also beheve that in other cases, tonsillectomy is imperative. Functions of tlie Tonsils. — Many and varied functions for the tonsils have been held by various theorists such as: the absorption of the products of salivary digestion; the secretion of an amylolytic ferment; tl at they are atavistic structures and therefore have no function; that they ehminate systemic toxins ; that they serve as culture tubes for the production of vaccines; that they protect the deeper cervical tissues from The Practice of Osteopathy 277 bacterial invasion; the theory of internal secretion and a score of other theories which so far, have never been substantiated by either clinical or experimental evidence, The hematopoietic theory or the theory of blood formation has a rather definite basis because such a function would be possible from the histologic structure. The formation of small lymphocytes has been at- tributed to tonsil tissue (Flemming) and this view has been generally accepted. Some of the lymphocytes however, find their way through the epithelial walls into the crypts and are discharged as ''mucous plugs", while others are carried by the efferent lymphatics into the cir- culatory system. In this respect, the tonsils, l^ke other lymphoid tissue, produce l^maphocytes which are essential constituents of the blood. This function is particularly marked during the growing period, but this function is also highly developed in all lymph nodules during this period, and in the growing child there is an abundance of such tissue and thus it seems that the tonsils, while important to the growing child, would not be at all indispensable structures. Some physicians claim to have observed deficiencies in growth and development of children whose tonsils had been removed during the first ten or fifteen years of hfe, but this is not commonly accepted. The tonsils have their greatest cellular activity during the growing period and unless chronically hypertrophied they atrophy during adult hfe, Tonsillectomy We may safely conclude from this evidence, that in the growing child, it may be well to retain the tonsils providing they are not directly affected in such a way as to endanger the general health of the child, but that there is Httle, if any, danger in their early removal. In adults, there seems to be no reason why they should not be removed in cases in which there is evidence of involvement beyond restoration by treatment or those cases in which there is evidence of toxic absorption. When surgical removal of the tonsils is indicated, the complete re- moval or tonsillectomy should always be done. A careful and complete enucleation of the tonsils when properly done will never be followed by any untoward results other than the temporary surgical sore throat. There is never any excuse, much less a reason, for partial removal of the tonsils or tonsillotomy, because such operations never accomplish the desired result and they nearly always require tonsillectomy later. In association with a reputable vocal teacher I have studied the re- sults of tonsillectom}^ on the voice. In none of the twenty cases studied 278 The Practice of Osteopathy was there any impairment following the operation, but on the other hand sixty per cent were improved either in range of pitch, quality or endur- ance, in addition to their being more free from laryngitis, pharyngitis, etc. for which the operation was done. Doctors Ruddy, Edwards and Reid of our profession have told me of similar experiences, so I am certain that tonsillectomy properly done will in selected cases, improve the voice. Acute Tonsillitis Acute tonsiUitis is an acute infectious and often a contagious disease characterized pathologically by inflammation of the tonsils. Some authors differentiate between follicular tonsillitis in which the crypts or lacunae are involved, and parenchjmiatous tonsiUitis in which the paren- chyma is involved. Etiology. — The predisposing and exciting causes are the same as in other acute infections of the upper air passages except that there is usually a chronic tonsiUitis as a result of some previous attack. Symptoms and Diagnosis. — The symptoms also are similar to other acute infections of the nasopharyngeal tract, with sore throat, variable temperature, headache, etc. By direct examination of the phar- ynx, the protruding masses with white or yeUow patches are readily seen. Treatment-- — Infection, drainage and eUmination are three words inseparable in the therapeutics. The local treatment (I doubt if many will agree) in either acute or chronic tonsilUtis is essentially the same — radical aspiration drainage. In all cases, except young children who will not permit it, I place a vacuum cup directly over the tonsil and apply as much vacuum as can be obtained. This treatment will, when properly done, empty the crypts of all pus. This accompUshed, each crypt is probed with a cotton appUcator dipped into phenol-glycerine. Cervical and upper thoracic treatment and deep relaxation of the sub-tonsil tissues to increase the normal blood supply and to decrease congestion by drainage eUmination are essential. The lower thoracic and lumbar should receive due attention for the purpose of increasing general elimination. The diet and other treatment are no different from that in other infectious fevers. Peritonsillar Abscess (Quinsy Sore Throat.) Peritonsillar abscess results from the collection of pyogenic bacteria and pus formation between the tonsil and the pillars of the fauces. It is perhaps a result of the closing of an infected crypt causing deep pene- tration of the pus. I The Practice of Osteopathy 279 Diagnosis. — The symptoms are those of acute tonsillitis but us- ually more marked and with one tonsil decidedly more protruding than the other. In some cases the location of the abscess can be seen and it is comparatively easy to open with a knife or probe, but in many cases the abscess is so situated that it cannot be located except by exploratory probing. Treatment. — Drainage by direct incision of the abscess pocket is indicated as early as a definite diagnosis can be made. There is no defi- nite technic to be followed except to observe certain general principles. If the ''pointing" of the abscess can be located, it is comparatively easy to make a good, free, direct incision and accomplish complete drainage. In many cases the only way to locate the pocket is to employ a probe or small, long, scalpel and explore between the pillar and tonsil until the pus pocket is found. As soon as this is located the pus pours out around the probe and this gives the location. Free drainage by means of a Kberal incision should then be made. Aspiration of the pus pocket and fihing with phenol-glycerine is effective after drainage has been obtained, but a hberal drainage must be maintained. The non-surgical treatment as described under acute tonsillitis is to be applied here. Chronic TonslSlltIs Chronic tonsillitis usually is the result of one or many attacks of acute infections of the tonsils. Occasionally cases of marked chronic tonsillitis occur in which the patient denies ever having had an acute attack. The pathology consists of hypertrophy of the lymphoid tissue and connective tissue. Diagnosis. — The purpose in diagnosis is not to determine whether the tonsil is hypertrophied but to determine whether the tonsil is causing any local or general physiological perversions and if so, whether local treatment or surgery should be applied. The direct examination should be made very carefully, because otherwise a bad tonsil may be readily overlooked. The mere fact that a tonsil is large or has open crypts from which a whitish mass may be ex- pressed does not mean that such a tonsil is directly responsible for local or systemic physiologic perversions. The examination should be made by means of a tongue depressor, tonsil retractor and a good head mirror and reflecting lamp. Every part of the tonsil and surrounding pillars should be carefully examined. Firm pressure applied against the tonsil from in front and behind will 280 The Practice of Osteopathy often force material from the crypts or out around the capsular margin. Any such material thus expressed should be examined microscopically. By probing the crypts with a small pointed cotton-wound probe and staining the material obtained, the condition of the deep parts of the tonsil can be determined. The sj-mptoms in every case, are to be considered with the micro- scopic findings, but there are cases in which either of these, together with appearance on direct examination, is sufficient to determine the advisa- bility of tonsillectomy. In general, we may say that the following factors would indicate tonsillectomy. 1 . Chronic, recurrent tonsillitis with or without compHcations, which does not respond to non-surgical treatment. 2. Positive evidence of arthritis of any form with microscopic evi- dence of some virulent organism, such as staphylococcus, streptococcus or long-chain pneumococcus, present deep in the tonsillar tissue. 3. Any persistent discharge of pus from the tonsil in which the microscope shows the presence of virulent bacteria and which will not be relieved by treatment. 4. Markedly hypertrophied tonsils which directly interfere with the voice, deglutition or respiration and which do not respond to treatment. 5. Persistent focal infections of the middle ears, ur sinuses or root abscesses which do not respond to treatment and in which case there is a virulent infection of the deep parts of the tonsil, shown by microscopic examination. The above are only general conditions and there are probably many other indications or groups of sjmiptoms that would indicate tonsillec- tomy. In most cases, unless the findings show positiveh^ that tonsillec- tomy should not be delayed, we advise treatment. If treatment does not restore to normal, it will probably reduce the time of the surgical sore throat following the operation. Non-surgical treatment. — The local direct treatment, as we practice it, consists of: 1. Direct aspiration by means of the tonsil cup, applying from fifteen to twenty inches of vacuum. 2. AppHca- tion of phenol-glycerine by means of cotton apphcator to the full depth of each crypt. H. Irrigation of the crypts by means of a catheter and hot salt mixture solution. 4. Syringing of the crypts by means of the cathet(?r and phenol 10%, alcohol 20% and glycerine 70%. The digital treatment of the tonsil consists of: 1 . Applying pressure against the anterior pillar thus forcing the contents out of the tonsil, The Practice of Osteopathy 281 the Ruddy method. 2, By the bidigital technic, the front finger of one hand inside, posterior and inferior to the tonsil and the fingers of the other hand outside exerting deep pressure and opposing the finger in- side. In this way the tonsil can be lifted forward and upward and its contents expressed. The digital treatment is not as effective as that described above. The osteopathic corrective treatment consists of adjustment of the atlas and axis and the mandibular articulation and the obtaining of free movement of the hyoid and the relaxation of the submaxillary muscu- lature and other deep structures. This treatment, if followed persistently, will relieve the local symp- toms of a very high percentage of cases of chronic tonsillitis, and in many cases even the systemic compHcations will be relieved. Whether in cases of systemic absorption this is the preferable treatment I am not sure, because, once the local condition is improved the patient will usually refuse operation and even if the physician finds definite evidence of toxic absorption he cannot convince the patient that his tonsils require sur- :gery. J 282 The Practice of Osteopathy MENTAL DISEASES BY L. Van H. Gerdine and A. G. Hildreth. INTRODUCTION The subjects herewith presented, while including certain of the most important sections of mental disease, make no claim to complete- ness either in the subject matter presented or in the attempt to cover the entire field of the psychoses. They cover those portions, however, with which we have come in closest touch at the Still-Hildreth Sanator- ium, and in which we have the most complete records. I have been aided in the compilation of the essential facts and statistics by the able staff of the institution and wish to acknowledge especially the valuable cooperation of Dr. C. M. VanDuzer in the Dementia Praecox group, Dr. H. P. Hoyle in the Manic Depressive group. Dr. B. L. Jemmette in the group entitled Delirium, Confusion and Stupor, Dr. J. C. Snyder in the Senile Dementia group and Dr. G. S. Elkins in the Involutional group. The opinions concerning each type held by Dr. A. G. Hildreth are appended under its appropriate heading. I wish to state emphatical- ly that the sole treatment carried out in the Macon Institution is specific corrective work upon spinal lesions, and it is upon this treatment that the statistics are based which are to be found throughout the text. These records cover more than 700 cases, including complete histories of the patients with the physical and mental findings on examination; these represent, therefore, by far the largest body of statistics ever accumulated in the study of osteopathic results in mental disorders. While the re- sults naturally vary in different types of mental disease the grand to- tal shows that more than one-half of all patients admitted recovered. Details for each group will be mentioned under its appropriate head- ing. WHiile adjuncts such as diet and hydrotherapy have been utilized; we certainly cannot attribute any curative value to their influence. It should be further emphasized that in no case whatsoever has medicine been used as a curative agent. And the same may be said of surgery. It has indeed been conclusively proved even in the medical world that medicines and surgical procedures are absolutely ineffective ; from the osteopathic viewpoint this of course is perfectly reasonable since the theory calls for definite lesions as causative factors and these lesions can hardly be reached other than by the osteopathic method of The Pkactice of Osteopathy 283 correction. The results obtained, therefore, could only be attributed to the genuine osteopathic principle enunciated by Dr. A. T. Still who kept in close touch with the work and gave it his approval up to the time of his death. He had always maintained that the osteopathic prin- ciple could accomplish remarkable results in this field and considering the previous inefficiency of any other method his confidence has been fully justified. Dementia Praecox This condition refers to mental disorders arising usually during the period of puberty or adolescence, therefore, between the ages of fourteen and twenty-five for the most part, although apparently similar cases may arise in later years. The term dementia refers to mental de- terioration and enfeeblement, while "praecox" signifies adolescence, though some writers infer that the term praecox may be used to indi- cate the early or precocious development of the mental enfeeblement. Certain it is that in most cases deterioration, with its resulting symp- toms of mental enfeeblement giving rise to the term dementia, usually occurs in time, though by no means always early. It is a chronic pro- gressive disease which may terminate in a complete loss of mentahty; in other cases it may become arrested in any stage and remain so perma- nently; in still others it may recover, though this is rare. By reason of the variability of the symptoms, three groups are generally recog- nized, first suggested by Kraepehn. Each is differentiated by more or less characteristic symptoms and referred to under the head of the Hebe- phrenic, Catatonic and Paranoid types, although all have certain symp- toms in common and there are mixed types. Etiology. — According to the authorities some form of hereditary factor can be found in some fifty per cent or more of all cases; this is supposed to create a predisposition, a natural weakness of the nervous system, which renders it unable to bear the ordinary storm and stress of fife, so that the, mechanism becomes according to the French expres- sion, "wrecked upon the rock of puberty or adolescence;" in other words, a premature giving way of the nervous system, being inherently un- able to stand the strain of life. Another suggestion is that it represents the outcome of abnormal types or reactions of the individual to the environment, with a failure of proper adjustment to surroundings and the formation consequently of mental problems which to the patient are incapable of solution. This may be called the psychological theory. The most commonly accepted idea, however, is the physical causation. 284 The Practice of Osteopathy According to this the disease results from autointoxication, the intoxi- cant arising from the disturbances of the glands with internal secretions, more particularly the sexual glands. This endocrine theory is supposed to be supported by the fact of the appearance of this disease most com- monlj^ at the time of puberty and shortly thereafter. The osteopathic conception fits in very well with this latter view, inasmuch as the spinal lesions are quite capable of explaining not only a disturbance of innervation to the glands with the resultant interfer- ence in their normal secretion, but also could produce disorder of the circulation and nutrition to the brain. Symptomatology. — Although each variety of Dementia Praecox has special symptoms characteristic of the type there are certain symp- toms common to all forms, and these will be first considered. All the functions of the mind in the course of time tend to become disturbed and to be weakened, but in the earUer stages we find marked differences as regards the disturbance of different functions, thus memory and ori- entation in most cases seem good; on the contrary, attention and associ- ation of ideas somewhat poor. Emotional life is almost alwaj^s marked- ly affected, even in the beginning. Very commonly at first there is de- pression to be followed later by expansive feelings and then by apathy in general. The will power is altered early and the conduct is apt to be peculiar. The judgment becomes impaired. All of these symptoms mentioned are deviations from the normal in the patient and therefore presuppose that the patient was formerly normal. This should sharply differentiate the praecox group from cases of defective development (imbecility or idiocy). In this latter group there is an arrest of devel- opment of the mind, whereas in praecox there is a loss in a developed intellect. We see a young patient, for example, who has lost interest in things about him, neglects his work at school or at home, remains alone for long periods of time and seems unwilling to mingle with other peo- ple. He gives the impression of one depressed and worried about some- thing he is trying to solve, perhaps he mutters to himself or gives way to unprovoked laughter, he may refuse to eat, or to talk unless questioned and may even then not answer. When he does talk it will be discovered that he knows perfectly well where he is, and knows people around him and understands everything that is going on; his memory will be found good, he can usually recall past incidents and tell what he has been do- ing recently. As the condition progresses, however, while the patient may still for a long time retain fair orientation and memory for past events, his accumulation of recent ideas will be found poor, so that he The Peactice of Osteopathy 285 will recall them with difficulty. We notice that it is difficult to get the patient's attention and concentration seems to be impossible, he may answer a direct question, but immediately seems to be occupied with other thoughts and it takes some little effort to gain his attention again. If he continues to talk it is plain that the association of ideas is poor, giving rise to disconnected phrases which usually come forth sluggishlj^ and without show of emotion. Dissociation of ideas occurs; that is, different ideas expressed may practically contradict themselves. For example, the patient may say he is a king and yet when asked to sweep the floor will do it perhaps without hesitation, not considering that is hardly the kind of work a king would do. The dissociation is also marked in the contradiction found between the content of the thought and its associated emotional idea, for example, the patient may speak of a near relative as dying recently, yet with no show of emotion, even with a meaningless laugh. This dissociation may ultimately result in complete incoherence, in which no sense can be found whatsoever in his speech. Emotional indifference is noticeable early and sluggishness of reactions to stimuli, even failure of such reactions ; the patient will neglect himself, stay away from meals, express no desires and make no complaints. In the earlier stages, however, the patient who may have been for some little time apathetic, suddenly without apparent cause becomes angry, noisy, and possibly violent and destructive, again gradually relapsing into his quiet, apathetic state. The thought content is commonly associated with delusions, that is obviously false ideas, but which the patient is unable to perceive are false. Delusions of persecution are most common, the pa- tient feeling in a dim way that everything is not right ; and in attempting to explain to himself the reason, often attributes causes to people or forces outside of himself, and on account of the feehng of bodily discomfort, also by reason of the depression, he explains the external forces as un- friendly to himself. Hallucinations may be present and furnish the material around which the delusions form; on the other hand halluci- nations may result from the delusions. By hallucination is meant a false sense perception, as the patient may state he sees someone before him who is not there, or that he hears voices from individuals who are not around him ; he may also complain of receiving electrical shocks, or wire- less messages, which he usually states come from his persecutors. Symp- toms of this nature form a good example of the so-called split personality, or "schizophrenia," wherein certain idea complexes are split off from the main personality and address themselves to the main portion, the patient attributing these noises (voices), sensations (visceral and tactile), 286 The Practice of Osteopathy tastes and smells to an objective rather than a subjective source and subsequently forming delusions. However, unless we are dealing with the paranoid form the delusions are fragmentary, transient and absurd. Hebephrenia. — This is a progressing mental enfeeblement, ter- minating usually in deterioration, and without showing marked pecul- iarities in thought or action aside from the progressing deficiency. The patient appears in general inactive, lacking in energy and ambition, indifferent, depressed, incapable of much concentration and hence the efficiency becomes progressively impaired until he is unable to accom- phsh anything. From time to time there may be periods of confusion, depression, passivity, at other times periods of excitement. Catatonia. — In this form the general symptoms are similar to those of the simple type above described with the addition of the special symptoms referred to as catatonic excitement and catatonic stupor. The excitement period is manifested by an unrest and monotonous ac- tivity, stereotyped actions and speech, the patient constantly repeating some act, such as moving the hand, foot or head over and over again in the same way, or repeating the same word or phrase indefinitely. This occurs apparently involuntarily, the actions being automatic in character. The patient who has been in a semistuporous state may pick up a glass or chair and without show of emotion break it against the wall. In catatonic stupor the patient may show in the lighter degrees a simple loss of interest and feeling with sluggish reaction to stimuh, or a profound inactivity and stupor in which state he cannot apparently be reached by any stimuli; nevertheless, he apparently retains conscious- ness. In this type we observe the interesting symptom of negativism in which the patient always does the opposite of what he is requested, or refuses outright to obey any command. There may be a refusal of food so that the patient has to be fed by a tube, mutism may be present, the patient may go for weeks or months without saying a word; stereo- type of attitude results in cataleptic poses and rigidity, in which the patient may maintain any particular pose for a prolonged period of time, and if placed in some other attitude may similarly retain the new attitude for a long time. This constitutes the so-called wax like rigidity, the patient reminding one of a wax figure. Pathologic suggestibility occurs in which the patient imitates movements, or repeats words and phrases that are spoken or performed before him. Paranoiac Form. — In this type delusions predominate and are characterized by variability, inconsistency, illogicahty and transitori- ness on the one hand, with many gradations to the opposite extreme The Practice of Osteopathy 287 where they become more or less fixed, and often dovetail into each other forming apparently a systematic whole. They tend to be usually of a persecutory and hypochondriacal character and in later stages when the mind is distinctly weakened are often of a grandiose type. Sometimes the patients have some kind of explanations for them and at other times none whatsoever, and they are often curiously dissociated from the emotional accompaniment. The patient may state there is poison in his food, in an indifferent tone of voice or even with a laugh; he may claim that his teeth are all set in wrong and offer no explanations to these obviously false ideas. The patient commonly thinks that some- body "has it in for him," someone will do him mischief, will kill him, that people are talking about him and criticizing him, everything that he hears or reads he thinks has some bearing on himself, so-called "de- lusions of reference. " Hallucinations may be present, the patient hear- ing voices, or receiving impressions or ideas which he claims come from without. These external impressions he misinterprets as voices or forces which are accusing, threatening and slandering him. Later on, the patient tends to change from the depressed persecutory stage to an expansive one, when he claims he is some celebrated person, king or president, or pope. The impairment of the judgment is clearly dem- onstrated in these cases since the patient who may claim to be the king of England may beg the attendant to change his place at the table or for a postage stamp. Pathologic Anatomy. — This is obscure. Since a certain pro- portion of cases recover, there can evidently be no degenerative changes at the outset, though some cases deteriorate fairly early, others only after several years. In some chronic cases there have been observed de- generative changes in the cortical cells. Diagnosis. — First, the common age of onset during puberty and adolescence, fourteen to twenty-four in the vast majority of cases, this being the only common mental disease occurring during this age period. Second, the progressive character terminating in mental enfeeblement or deterioration, that is "dementia" proper. Third, the evidence of defect or deficiency symptoms indicating that the patient's mind has allered in the sense of deterioration from its former normal condition, whereas, in imbeciles or idiots the mind has failed to develop in the first place. Fourth, in the earher stages particularly the marked dissociation of the brain powers, some being well maintained as memory and orienta- tion (that is knowledge of time and space), others being weakened, such as judgment, power of attention and the like. Fifth, the early appearance 288 The Practice of Osteopathy of the emotional defect, a remarkable indifference and apathy of the patient to people and surroundings, the patient being unsocial and tak- ing no interest in anything. Sixth, all the peculiar motor reactions, which are mentioned above under the catatonic head, and which very rarel}" occur in any other mental disorder. Seventh, the delusional content nearly always refers to the patinet's exterior, forces outside of him, people or things which are exerting an unfavorable influence upon him, delusions of persecution and reference. The patient practi- cally never accuses himself, as is the rule in cases of true melancholia, never blames himself, but always the other party or the other force out- side of him. Eighth, the delusions of grandeur are usually indicative of a stage of deterioration. Prognosis. — Some authorities are inclined to doubt if any case ever completely recovers, claiming that in apparent recovery it may have been a question of mistaken diagnosis, or that the recovery is more apparent than real, that the patient is not truly ell, or ill have a re- lapse, so that a permanent cure will be impossible. Other authorities admit the possibiUt}^ of recovery though in a very small minority of cases. The statistics of the Still-Hildreth Sanatorium, covering more than two-hundred fifty cases show total recoveries of at least one- third. This includes all types and all stages of progress, many being advanced on entrance. Of the less advanced cases and those of not more than two or three years' standing there have been some fifty per cent recov- ery. Many cases make improvement or become stationary in greatly improved condition, but are not included in the thirty per cent. Of the three types, the catatonic offers the best prognosis, the hebeprhenic the poorest, while the paranoiac occupies an intermediate position. Treatment. — Of the etiologic factors above mentioned, that of autointoxication, resulting possibly from endocrine disturbances or other sources, is most generally accepted in the medical world and agrees excellently with the osteopathic point of view. Spinal lesions are regu- larly found more particularly in the dorsal region, which are quite capa- ble of disturbing the innervation to the glands; therefore, their nutrition and activity. A correction of these before the disturbance has continued too long, and hence before detrioroation has set in, should theoretically normahze the glandular condition and therefore prevent deterioration and enable the patient to recover. Such is the probable explanation of the results, and in many cases the recoveries were obtained in patients previously considered hopeless. The Practice of Osteopathy 289 Remarks by Dr. Hildreth In a great majority of the cases the cause Hes in the interference between tKe fourth dorsal vertebra and the eighth, which analyzed means a disturbance of the great splanchnic nerves, through whose interference would be caused the toxic condition and even the sexual disturbance described in so many cases from standard authorities. The same lesion, if deep seated enough, could produce an interference with the vasomotors and reflexly interfere with the circulation to the brain. In many we also find a first, second or third cervical lesion. The effects of these lesions on the equiUbrium of the circulation to the brain are easily traced through the superior cervical sympathetic ganglia. These lesions, namely, the mid-dorsal and upper cervical, especially when corrected in the earlier stages, have thus far proven to produce successful results. In a lesser number of cases we find the cause to be from the first to the fourth dor- sal vertebrae; our reasoning here being that the interference or the phy- sical disturbance must be so deep that it reaches and interferes with the deeper nerve currents, both downward and upward, thus disturbing the equilibrium of the circulation to the brain. We have found this class to be the hardest to respond to treatment ; however, that may be due to the fact that the physical defects at that point are harder to correct. Osteopathic treatment applied to the lesions above described without question offers therapeutics of intrinsic value to this class of patients. Delirium, Confusion and Stupor This clinical group has become well estabhshed, not only in its recog- nition from the dominant symptoms as indicated above, but also from rather definite causes. The immediate cause seems to be an abnormal blood state, or so-called toxemia, which may result from infectious dis- eases, or states of exhaustion, or autointoxications, or foreign poisons; the poison acts as an irritant to the brain. In states of exhaustion so- called "fatigue bodies" are formed and are apparently toxic in character. The autointoxicants may have various sources, such as chronic kidney disease, or diabetes, and the like. The most important of the foreign poisons are alcohol and morphine. This morl^id group is further charac- terized not only ])y a toxic cause and dominant symptom complex of de- lirium, or confusion, or stupor, but by a similar onset and course. The onset is usually acute and the course somewhat wave like, gradually reach- ing a climax and subsiding, or resulting in death or becoming chronic. To emphasize the clinical symptoms of confusion which is so important 290 The Practice of Osteopathy the term "acute confusional insantiy" has often been used, or "amentia/' according to the common German terminology. Hallucinations also play a prominent part, particularly those of vision; hence, another com- mon appellation, "acute hallucinatory confusion." Heredity is men- tioned at most as creating a predisposition, though often the personal and family histories show no such evidence whatsoever. Intellectually there is a definite lack of orientation, the patient is unable to identify himself or his surroundings in time and space. He cannot clearly under- stand what goes on around him, that is, consciousness is " clouded ;"^ the clouding may be of such extreme degree the patient's mind becomes blank, due to complete psychic inhibition. This is referred to as stupor. The emotional life plays a secondary role subordinate to the intellectual content. The patient may be greatly excited for example, resulting from a frightful hallucination. The hallucinations are mainly of the visual type and are almost always present. The patient hves in a perpetual state of sense deception as if he were constantly dreaming; the hallu- cinations for the most part are of distressing, disagreeable or even fright- ful character. These may give rise to delusions, which are manifold, often fantastic and usually transitory. Physical changes are always found associated with the disturbed mental status. If it arises during the active stage of an infectious process there is of course the high temperature and all other physical signs of fever. In a certain number of cases with temperature no definite signs can be found indicative of any of the well known fevers, hence has been called by various names, such as "Bell's Delirium," "Acute Mania Gravis," or "Acute Febrile Delirium. " This ordinarily runs an acute rapid course with very high temperature, very marked delirium, followed by stupor and usually death from exhaustion. Even though no temperature be present the physical condition reminds one very much of that found in fever diseases. There is the lost appetite, resulting emaciation and malnutrition, insomnia, exhaustion, etc. Osteopathic Theory.— While it may be admitted that the var- ious factors mentioned above may take part as exciting or predisposing causes, it is obvious that in numerous instances mental disorders do not arise whatsoever, even when the patient is subjected to these factors. There must necessarily be other elements essential to produce the psycho- sis. The osteopathic theory comes in at this point to fill in and com- plete the chain of causes and to initiate the onset by the introduction of the idea of nutritional and circulatory disturbances resulting from the spinal lesions. The Practice of Osteopathy 291 The records of the Still-Hildreth Institution show 18 of the toxic type, in which the poison is derived from without, who were treated, with 17 recoveries. There were 25 cases connected with the infection and exhaustion group, with 20 revoveries. Remarks by Dr. Hildreth In this group we have to do with blood disorders, resulting from the infections, conditions producing exhaustion, and the various tox- ins, or poisons, whether originating within the body or derived from with- out. These disorders are largely functional in character, resulting from brain irritation due to the toxemia or disturbance to the centers of nu- trition. The main object of the osteopathic treatment, therefore, is to aid ehmination and regulate and build up the nutrition. In most of the patients the physical lesions are found in the mid dorsal area, chiefly from the 4th to the 7th, and in the cervical region, the 1st to the 3d. In aiding the kidneys in ehmination the 10th and 11th dorsal ver- tebrae must be looked after. These conditions commonly respond very rapidly to the treatment and represent one of our most successful groups so far as results are concerned. Manic Depressive Psyclioses The psychoses which are brought together under this classification include mental disorders which at first glance would appear to be of very wide variation, namely, conditions of maniacal excitement and those of depression. Further consideration, however, reveals the very evident reasons why they should be united as sub groups under the one head. The fact that these two mental states of seemingly opposite character- istics often appear alternately in the same individual, that in certain cas- es of each type there is a wave like feature in the nature of the attack and the frequency with which they tend to recur, together with other points of similarity in respect to duration, prognosis, etc., tend to point to their very close relationship. Kraepelin was the first to draw at- tention to these facts and advocate the present convenient and widely accepted classification of these disorders. The outstanding feature is the disturbed emotional state which dominates and overshadows all other symptoms and is fundamentally the same whether expressed through the excitement of mania or the de- pression of melancholia. Etiology. — Heredity is considered an important factor. Various authorities claim to have demonstrated direct hereditary influences in 292 The Practice of Osteopathy as many as eighty per cent and more of cases. Individual predisposi- tion resolves itseK into a matter of constitution and temperament in which there seems to be a greater tendency among those who are subject to the emotional extremes. Early adult hfe is by far its most frequent period of onset, though it may arise also somewhat later. In certain cases the beginning of the disorder dates from some psychic or emotional shock. Just what impor- tance these factors have as causes is little known since other cases devel- op in which the constitutional element alone seems responsible and no immediate exciting cause can be demonstrated. The osteopathic view:^oint emphasizes the all important influence of spinal lesions as exciting factors. In individuals who have a tenden- cy to this reaction their presence disturbing the cerebral circulation and nutrition may act as the direct causative factor. Manic Phase. — The manifestation of this condition is brought about by the release of the inhibiting influences which normally govern all psychic function. Various terms as hypomania, acute mania, deUr- ious mania, etc., have been used to differentiate the different degrees in which the symptoms appear. In the milder types we find the following symptoms present. There is a marked feeling of well being. The patient, having lost sight of his personal limitations, feels a consequent exalted opinion of himself. His conduct is often rather boisterous, he talks a great deal, often swearing and using obscene language. He is inconsiderate of others and tries to impose his will upon those about him. There goes with this a certain unstabihty of the emotional tone as manifested by the quickly changing feeling of good humor, irritability and anger. There is a rapid flow of ideas with a marked loss in the ability to concentrate and direct thought. The ideas which pass through the mind do not coordinate themselves toward a definite goal, but deviate from the course of consecutive think- ing by any passing association. Again there is a restlessness and activity beyond all normal bounds. The individual feels strong physically and mentally. The appetite is unusually good and if activity is not too extreme there may be a gain in weight. The period of sleep is dimin- ished and the feeling of fatigue is reduced. In the more exaggerated cases the flight of ideas becomes more marked, the associations are more rapid and supei-ficial and the atten- tion is focused but momentarily. Illusions and delusions may be present due to the imperfect preceptions from inability to concentrate attention and from abnormal associations. Rhyming speech, disconnection of The Practice of Osteopathy 293 phrases and even apparent incoherence are often present. The state of mind may be such that the patient tears his clothing, breaks up furni- ture, jumps, dances and shouts and often will not take time to eat. The most extreme cases which refuse food over some period of time progress rapidly to exhaustion and measures to conserve strength become im- perative. Depressive Phase. — In this phase of the disorder are encountered manifestations which are in direct contrast to those presented in the manic phase. In place of the exalted emotional state there is a depression. There is a tendency to worry over trivial matters of the daily routine and of instances in past life. Introspection is the predominant mental attitude and the whole outer world is colored by the inner feehng of worry and uncertainty. Replacing the rapidity of thought in the manic phase there is a distinct slowing of mental processes in the depressive phase. Thinking is more dihcult and labored, questions are answered slowly and with an apparent effort and there is usually a tendency to avoid social life. Again replacing the excessive activity in mania the depressions show a retarded action. There is disinclination or disabihty toward any effort either motor or mental. The patient feels weak and incapable of effort, the body assumes a bent attitude and the facial expression is one of despondency. The appetite is usually impaired with resultant loss of weight, the bowels are sluggish, the period of sleep reduced. In the more exaggerated cases the retardation may be complete. Introspection is carried to the degree where the patient tries to take unto himself the responsibihty for all the sin in the world. He himself is the arch sinner and he feels himself the subject of punishment by di- vine wrath in a manner in which no other individual was ever punished. Also the introspection tends to produce various hypochondriacal ideas. The patient may feel that he has contracted some incurable disease and that certain bodily functions have ceased operating. Mental processes become not only retarded and difficult, but actual- ly painful, a symptom which has been termed psychalgia. Suicidal tendencies are also quite frequently present. In extreme conditions the patient may become so retarded in thought and activity that he apparently receives no stimulus from the outer world. He lives in a more or less stuporous state, even requiring that food be administered by tube. Circular Insanity and Mixed Forms- — In addition to the condi- tions in which siiiipl}' mania or inclaiicholia are manifest there are cer- 294 The Practice of Osteopathy tain cases which show variations and combinations of these forms. A common type is that in which there is an alternation of the manic and depressed conditions. The patient may pass directly from one state into the other, or there may be an intervening period of lucidity. The term circular insanity has been applied to this type. Other variations are those in which there are recurrences of the manic or depressive at- tacks often at more or less regualr intervals, each recurrence being a prac- tical repetition of the preceding. There is also possible a considerable interminghng of the character- istics of the two types. In the manias may occur difficulty of thinking, passing feelings of depression and even almost stuporous conditions. In depressions there can exist a marked degree of restlessness and activity and a rapidity in the flow of ideas. Prognosis. — The outlook for recovery from the individual attack is good. The attack may last from a period of days to one of a number of months and recovery comes with rarely any evidence of mental deteri- oration. There is a tendencj^ to recurrence of the trouble. In fact recurrence is the rule rather than the exception. In the osteopathic handling of these cases it has been the endeavor to demonstrate that the correction of lesions had a tendency to lessen the duration of the in- dividual attack and reduce the tendency to recurrence. Judging from the experience thus far gained in the observation of cases under treatment during the attack and the comparative few recurrences reported both of these aims have been attained. Treatment. — The osteopathic measures are aimed at the cor- rection of the spinal lesions, especially those located in the upper dor- sal and the cervical regions. Some reflex effects from lesions in more re- mote areas may have their influence so that it is wise to look to the cor- rection of any other structural variations when present. Remarks by Dr. Hildreth The mental disorders of this type are purely functional and maj^ cover a broad scope as to causes; however, from the osteopathic view- point a great majority of them seem to have as their specific exciting cause, lesions in the upper dorsal and upper cervical regions. The treat- ment should be appHed specifically to the cause which may range any- where from the 1st to the 8th dorsal, or from the 1st to the 3d cervical, covering the nutritional and circulatory centers and thus controlling the nutrition and circulation to the brain. There can be no question but what the osteopathic theory of adjustment of physical defects forms the The Practice of Osteopathy 295 basis of permanent cure, since many of our recoveries had been previously under other methods of treatment without results. Our records cover over 200 cases with recovery in more than two-thirds, and very few recurrences up to the present. Involutional Psychosis In the mid years of life, between forty and sixty, a decline begins, which in the older years results in decay; it is especially true at this per- iod of the sexual hfe and the organs underlying it. While these organs undergo a very definite change constituting the so-called climacteric period in women, it is not at first sight so evident in men; however, the evidence is that a somewhat similar process, though much slower, tends to occur in the male. Associated with the decay of the sexual organs is a disturbance presumably of the internal secretions; if this latter dis- turbance takes place slowly and evenly the body may not notice any marked changes; on the other hand, if it takes place more quickly, or unevenly, it may give rise to distinct symptoms which indicate a distur- bance of the nervous system in general and often even of the mentahty. Hence, the significance of the term. Involutional Psychosis. In a large majority of cases the mental disorder is marked by the dominance of de- pression and is frequently referred to as melanchoha. For a long time it was considered that this represented a special mental disorder having little or nothing in common with other psychoses. In recent times Dumas has studied this group very carefully and shown that it in reality has very much in common with the depressed phases of the Manic Depressive Group of psychoses. Kraepelin himself, who was the first to demonstrate the unity of the Manic Depressive Group, has accepted the conclusions of Dumas and incorporated the Involutional Depressions as a sub type of his Manic Depressive Psychosis. Among etiologic factors have been mentioned hereditary elements, which have been claimed to have been found in at least fifty per cent of all cases, forming presumably a predis- position ; it is also stated that a predisposition may be acquired through various debilitating causes. Exciting factors are claimed to be present, such as mental shock, grief, worry and the Uke. The disease would then seem to occur when wc have a combination of exciting factors and pre- disposition. Careful consideration will show, however, that no such mental disturbance occurs at this age in many people who show evidences of such predisposition and of exciting factors, therefore it would seem that still other causes were necessary; if we consider the suggestion above mentioned that there are atrophic processes taking place in the sexual 296 The Practice of Osteopathy glands leading to a loss of the internal secretions and if we further consid- er that this may take place unevenly and in an unbalanced way, thus aid- ing in giving rise to the symptoms, we will find a definite point of contact for the osteopathic conception. Osteopathically considered, we may say that the spinal lesions lead to a disturbance of innervation and nutrition to the ductless glands, and therefore produce disordered secretions in those patients developing the disease, whereas such a condition may not be present in others who^at the same age period do not develop the psy- chosis. Symptomatology The emotional tone of depression dominates the picture. Asso- ciated symptoms are anxiety, fears, particulary of impending danger, the loss of interest in the external world, with a concentration of atten- tion upon self; psychic distress is usually present, often to an extreme degree, leading apparently to real mental pain, so-called psychalgia. Delusions are usually present and manifold in variety; they mainly re- fer to the patient liimself and are of a self -accusatory nature; they fre- quently refer to notions of sins having been committed, also unworthiness of the patient, of poverty, nihihstic ideas, either about his own body or external things. He may claim for example that he has no stomach or kidney, or heart, that the external world is unreal and the hke. His motor reactions become retarded, or even in the more extreme cases inhibited, producing a form of stupor. The inefficiency which results along with the psychic pain and distress may determine suicidal tenden- cies which are very frequent. Orientation is usually good, the patient remaining aware of his own identity and that of his surroundings; the judgment of course is impaired so that the patient is unable to appreciate the unreality of his delusions ; as a result he sees no hope in the future and on account of present sufferings prefers death to life. The patient may remain in a perfectly passive mood, giving the appearance of extreme depression, paying no attention to the surroundings, possibly mute, giving no regard to the necessity of the toilet, paying no attention to his clothing and the like. This may continue for hours or days. Food often has to be forced on him, possibly even by the tube; the result is usually more or less emaciation and may result in marked malnutrition; similarly the sleep may be seriously interfered with, even though the patient is quiet. The resulting loss of sleep and malnutrition sometimes lead to the death of the patient. On the other hand, the patient may moan and wring his hands in anguish, walking up and down, crying The Practice of Osteopathy 297 out that he is a sinner and that he wants to die and the hke. This is the so-called melancholia agitata. The physical symptoms of importance are sleep disturbances, poor appetite, with emaciation, cyanosis, often a subnormal temperature, low blood pressure, slowed heart action and weakened circulation. The hair may become gray, the skin dry and harsh and indeed any of the signs of senile decay may appear. Diagnosis and Prognosis. — These depend partly upon the men- tal symptoms, partly upon the physical. On the mental side is to be em- phasized marked depression, with the relatively clear orientation, re- sembling the depressed phase of Manic epressive insanity; also the dominance of the self-accusatory delusions. On the physical side the age period, and the evidence of previous attacks, even though very slight. The prognosis from the study of the mental symptoms depends on the prefience or absence of signs of defect, or deterioration, as for example foolish and silly delusions. On the physical side the presence or absence of conditions like Iddney or arterial disease; in general, it may be said if the physical findings are negative and the mental symptoms show no deterioration there should be a good outlook, particularly if the condition has not become too chronic. A favorable outlook is always possible if the disease is treated early and the lesions disturbing the activities of the glands and of nutrition and the circulation are corrected and if the other physical findings are negative and signs of deterioration absent. Since this is probably only a sub-group of the Manic Depressive Psychoses, as has been mentioned above, the results obtained under osteopathic treatment are noted under the Manic Depressive group. Remarks by Dr. Hildreth Our experience with this class of cases invariably lead us to the nerve centers which regulate and control the process of nutrition and circulation; it is a matter of keeping up normal equilibrium of all organ- ic life and especially the circulation to the brain. The basis of the treat- ment therefore is to be found in the nutritive centers, as well as those centers which control the circulation to the brain, the ductless glands, etc. Senile Dementia Senile Dementia may be defined as an al^normal weakening of the mind arising in old age. As the word dementia implies, the intellectual change is quantitative rather than qualitative, the prime characteristic of the disease being mental loss rather than mental perversion. 298 The Practice of Osteopathy It is commonly stated that a most important cause of the disease is the general malnutrition incident to age. Since only a small propor- tion of the aged develop dementia, this is probably only a cooperating factor. Other causes mentioned are overwork, emotional strain, trauma- tisms, intoxications (especiall.y alcohohsm), cerebral arteriosclerosis and perhaps heredity. Pathologic Anatomy. — The disease is organic, the brain exhibit- ing definite pathological tissue changes. There is an atrophy of many nerve cells and a proliferation of neuroglia fibers, so that the cerebrum becomes shrunken and hard, with thickened meninges and thinned cor- tex, and shows a loss of weight. The cerebral arteries may or may not exhibit sclerosis, thrombosis, or miliary aneurisms, with resultant areas of softening. The cells show pigmentary degeneration and many of the association fibers have disappeared. Onset. — The onset of this dementia is usually very gradual, the condition not being recognized until rather marked. It occurs mainly in the seventies and later and in the late sixties, being rare before sixty. It often follows financial reverses, emotional shock, or various diseases. The earUest symptoms are a change in the person's disposition, shght disorders of memory, and trivial lapses of various sorts. As the disease progresses the symptoms become more marked and fundamental, involving not only the intellectual but also the emotional and volitional phases of consciousness. Interest in the outside world begins to flag, attention to wander, perception to be incomplete and inaccurate, association of ideas to be slow, memory to weaken and judg- ment to be impaired. Memory of the most recent incidents is the first to be lost, of recent years next, and then of middle age so that the pa- tient may not recognize his own children or know, for example, that his wife is dead; finally the memory even of 3-outh is lost and the patient is to all intents and purposes a child, liis condition being an exaggeration and aggravation of that commonly known as "second childhood." Several forms of Senile Dementia exist, of which the most common is probably the simple or non-delusional type. Other forms are funda- mentally the same as the simple, but with certain superimposed symp- toms. Fairly early in this type it becomes unsafe for the patient to continue in business. Due to impairment of memory and judgment he is apt to lose his property. Soon his work is poorly done or neglected entirely. He becomes garrulous and annoys his associates with tiresome repetitions of childish reminiscences, continually wandering from one subject to another. His speech becomes incoherent and his sentences The Practice of Osteopathy 299 fragmentary. He grows untidy and indifferent to the ordinary niceties and conventions of life. His appetite is either poor or voracious; in the latter case the weight may keep up fairly well. He may be either apathet- ic or turbulent. If the former, he seems stupid, indifferent, and sleepy. He is credulous, docile, and very suggestible. Patients of the turbu- lent type are restless and always moving about, either depressed or elated, giving unreasonable orders and then contradicting them. Sleep- ing poorly, they are apt to get up and wander about the house at night. In men, prostatic disease may cause a recrudescence of sexual feehng. Patients of either type eventually become filthy, soiling their clothing, etc. Even in well advanced cases, however, senile dements are often able to perform well certain habitual activities, such as signing their names, or playing certain games, such as checkers or dominoes. Conf usional Type. — Another form of Senile Dementia, which may in severe cases usher in the attack, but which usually, when present, is sequent to the simple form, of which it is a more severe grade, is the confusional. The additional symptoms of this type are probably due to defective ehmination and the consequent toxicity. Usually unsys- tematized delusions, and sometimes hallucinations are present. Ex- cept for a possible occasional period of remission the confusion is con- tinuous. It varies greatly in degree, now being mild and passive and again active, perhaps developing into delirium. Orientation as to both time and place may be lacking. Such patients may ask for dinner a few minutes after a meal, go to bed at noon, be unable to find their own room, or to recognize their own children. They are apt to be obstinate and peevish. Delusions vary in type but both these and the hallucinations are usually painful and, being referred to the patient's associates, give rise to the thought that they are trying to kill or otherwise harm him. Delusional Type. — A third type of Senile Dementia is the par- anoid form. Dements of this type, owing to delusions of persecution and auditory hallucinations are sensitive and suspicious. Such cases may sometimes show good orientation, apparently unclouded minds, and little evidence of senility, requiring careful study to differentiate the condition from true paranoia. A patient may, on account of hallu- cinations of taste and smell, refuse food in the behef that it is poisoned. Members of his family who are devotedly caring for him are suspected of designs on his money, and this suspicious attitude frequently leads to unjust wills. The delusions and suspicions may be entirely concealed from the family. Wealthy paranoid dements are peculiarly apt to be- come the prey of scheming adventuresses, particularly in case of the 300 The Practice of Osteopathy above mentioned sexual recrudescence, and marry them. Opposition of the family is regarded as part of their general persecution or as due merelj^ to their desire to get the estate. Some patients merely appear odd, suspicious, untidy, peevish, and childish. Some have expansive delu- sions and exhibit the euphoria so frequently found in syphihtic dements. Senile Delirium. — A fourth type has been described by some psycliiatrists under the title of senile dehrium. This may appear as the initial form of the disease or as an acute attack in one of the above forms. It is characterized by great incoherence and restlessness, en- tire absence of orientation, and numerous rapidly changing delusions and hallucinations, the condition resembhng dehrium tremens. It is probably due to some somatic cause, such as nephritis, pneumonia, or cystitis, which is often fatal. Complications may arise in Senile Dementia, such as apoplectic strokes, hemiplegia, epileptiform seizures and aphasias. Prognosis. — It is evident from the pathology of the conditions that the prognosis is not at all good when the disease is well advanced. It is a chronic disease and usually progressive until death, which is due to one of the complications, malnutrition, or especially pneumonia. How- ever, many cases have shown improvement, and in incipient stages re- covery. A cure of advanced cases being impossible, the important consideration is prevention or arrest in its incipiency. It is evident that this can be done only by preventing, or removing as far as possible, the predisposing causes. A glance at the list of these shows that much depends upon the cooperation of the patient by regulat- ing his habits of Ufe. Physical and mental overstrain must be avoided, deleterious habits, such as the use of intoxicants or narcotics given up. Much can be done by osteopathy to eliminate the effects of these upon the organism. Cardiovascular and renal symptoms are very important and should be watched for in order that early treatment may check the process initiated. To this end the patient's habits and diet must be reg- ulated and treatment instituted to relieve toxicity and promote ehmina- tion. Lesions must be corrected, special attention being given to the lower dorsal that affect the kidneys, the upper dorsal that affect blood pressure, and both the upper cervical and upper dorsal that affect the blood supply and nutrition of the brain. Arteriosclerotic Dementia. — This is a mental enfeeblement arising sometimes in the fourth, but chiefly in the fifth, decade of hfe, and associated with symptoms of arterial hardening. The cause is arteriosclerosis, which may be second aiy to some form The Practice of Osteopathy 301 of nephritis. The arterial hardening may be general or may be con- fined to the arteries of the cerebrum. It is hkely that the arterioles supplying the cortical cells are especially involved in an atheromatous condition. The disease is organic, chronic and progressive. Hemor- rhage, embohsm, or thrombosis may occur, producing focal lesions and areas of softening, with hemiplegia, aphasia, etc. The earhest symptoms may be headaches and dizziness. The blood pressure is usually found to be high but not invariably. An athero- matosis may be present in some one of the palpable peripheral arteries, such as the radials. Further symptoms on the physical side are quick fatigue, loss of energy, numbness and paresthesias of the extremities, and somnolence in the daytime or perhaps insomnia at night. Strokes may occur, usually sKght and temporary, probably due to spasm in a degenerating artery or perhaps to serous effusion. Toxic symptoms ap- pear, due to disorder in kidneys, Kver, and other organs. Epileptiform seizures are possible. Mentally the patient shows impairment of mem- ory, and perhaps some confusion and hallucinations. Rarely stupor occurs. He may be agitated and irritable or melancholy and depressed. Suspicious and persecutory ideas of the paranoid type may appear; also hypochondriacal ideas. Osteopathic Theory. — In these psychoses of the older years of life the termination is usually dementia, which means mental enfeeble- ment, and which results from degenerative changes in the brain substance. As has been shown it is largely a nutritional question and the nutritional condition varies tremendously in different elderly people ; it is well known that many old people preserve their brain powers fairly well to the end; on the other hand others fail relatively early, some even in the fifties; these cases of earlier failure are referred to as the ''presenile type. " The osteopathic conception would be to find out the source productive of the nutritional disorder and correct it at the very outset, therefore making it quite possible to prevent the disease process from taking place. The prognosis then in the earher stages is very good. Remarks by Dr. Hildreth While many cooperating factors may be found in the causation of the mental disorder of elderly people, our experience shows there is always very definite disturbance of nutrition and the nutritional cen- ters. We find chief physical interference between the 3d and 8th dor- sal vertebrae, most definite as a rule at the 4th, 5th and 6th; with the corresponding ribs on the right side. Contributing causes may be found 302 The Practice of Osteopathy in other areas, associated with the disturbances of the heart and circu- lation and of the kidney. In the cardio circulatory disorders we find ab- normal spinal conditions in the upper dorsal region and especialty the 5th rib on the left side. In the kidney disorders we find the lesions usu- ally at the 10th, 11th and 12th dorsal. The above mentioned areas in general represent the centers of control of the splanchnic nerves and therefore the important processes of digestion, metabolism and assimila- tion. Specific treatment applied to these points is verj^ helpful and re- sults in marked improvement and indeed in relieving the patient's symp- toms completely when in the earlier stages of the disease. The Practice of Osteopathy 303 DEFECTIVE CHILDREN By Raymond W. Bailey It is our purpose here to impress on osteopaths the almost unlim- ited possibiHties in the study and treatment of mental conditions of chil- dren, which heretofore have been considered hopeless. Osteopathy has demonstrated that it has much to offer to this class of defectives but the profession has not thoroughly appreciated its great possibiHties. It has been the custom to send these children to institutions where they have received care with some attempt toward education but with absolutely no effort being made through physical treatment to overcome their debiht3^ We shall show that the osteopathic lesion is of prime import- ance in these cases, and that we have been slow to reahze the efficacy of osteopathic treatment for such seemingly hopeless children. We can- not emphasize too strongly the importance of accepting and treating these cases wherever possible. The mental diseases are considered under two general heads: (1) Inherited, and (2) Acquired Tendencies. 1. Inherited Tendencies. — In this class are those cases arising from poor endowment of the protoplasmic structure through lowered vitality of the parents or other progenitors. These taints may come from either parent, or both, and may exist in the offspring from some preceding generation. Such diseases are constitutional and are amen- able to supporting treatment in direct proportion to the amount of endowed energy inherent in any given organism. Of the inherited tendencies, we have two kinds: 1. Congenital Diseases, (a) From any influence of an inherited nature not directly acting on the environment of the parent while the fetus is in utero, and (b) From any influence which directly affects the development of the ovum through imperfect fertilization coming through either parent or both. 2. General Impairment. — This condition exists (a) Where a similar defect has existed in foregoing generations and is strictly hered- itary; (b) Where general vitality is diminished from such causes as neuro- pathic parents, or where there have existed constitutional defects, such as tuberculosis, syphilis, epileps}^, alcoholism, abuse, overwork, strain, 304 The Practice of Osteopathy acute inflammatory diseases, and poor health of the mother during ges- tation ; also consanguinity. (c) Premature birth tends to impairment physically and mentally of growth of organism and frequently leaves its manifestations of ma- rasmus, rachitis and other nutritional disturbances. (d) Prolonged labor may leave its mark on the child where more or less asphyxia has occurred resulting in obstruction to cerebral cir- culation. Causes acting after birth to the already impaired germ cell and re- sulting in many of the afflictions of early life, both mentally and phys- ically, are 1. Traumatism. 2. Convulsions. 3. Rachitis. 4. Infectious fevers. 5. Meningitis. All of these seriously affect the metabolism within the newly-born, a process which is begun, doubtless with difficulty, and susceptible to easy derangement, and the same effect magnified with growth into its subsequent mental and physical deformity. 2. The Acquired Tendency. — In this the second great class are those conditions arising subsequent to conception where germ plasm is healthy but growth is arrested by some external factor either intra- or extra-uterine. Thus the acquired tendency may be given to the fetus in utero and not be considered congenital as in case of injury affect- ing health and growth of otherwise healthy conception. In short, the acquired has its beginning at conception or subsequent to it while the congenital is previous to conception or already inherent in the germ plasm leading to conception. Any influence which retards the 1. Inherent capacity of cell for growth or, 2. Adequate blood supply either in quantity or quality results in enfeebled offspring and these causes are enhanced by (a) Traumatism or Injury (b) Drink or Abuse (c) Dirt or Unhygienic surroundings (d) Depravity or Ignorance Factors entering into acquired tendencies affecting offspring direct are divided into three classes, those: The Practice of Osteopathy 3C5 I. Before birth such as (a) Abnormal condition of mother's health during preg- nancy as in disease of any nature, mental or physical or (b) Injury to fetus direct by blow, fall of parent, oi instrument. 1 1 . During Birth from : (a) Abnormal labor from any cause. (b) Primogeniture. (c) Premature birth. III. After Birth. (a) Traumatism. (b) Toxic causes such as scarlet fever, whooping cough, meningitis, measles, mumps and exanthemata. (c) Convulsions. (d) Nutritional disturbances. Consanguinity or intermarrjdng of blood relations, or in-breeding results in : 1. InstabiKty of the nervous system. 2. Intensifying of constitutional defects. 3. Decrease in size of offspring. 4. Predisposition to disease through lowered vitality. 5. Impairment of reproductive function. Immediate consanguinous offspring may manifest a high degree of intellectual or physical attainment but successive processes tend to neurotic types and are prone to physical weaknesses and insanity. This practice is found among Quakers and Jewish peoples, inhabitants of the Islands north of Scotland, in isolated rural localities, and among African tribes. Mental Deficiency in Children Synonyms. — Amentia ; f eeble-mindedness. There are three grades of amentia: 1. Morons: those whose mental age corresponds closely to their chronological age or is nearly normal. 2. Imbeciles: those in whom there is a wide disparity between the mental age; and the chronological age. 3. Idiots: the lowest form of arrested mentality or those whom it is impossible to teach. Definition. — Mental deficiency is a pathological stage in which the mind has failed to attain normal development. 306 The Practice of Osteopathy Various degrees of intelligence or mental capacity in man lie betweeen: (1) Genius such as Bacon, Newton, Plato, Galileo, Shakespeare. (2) Lesser Ability but still conspicuous in development such as our great leaders in science, literature, reform and the arts and medicine, furthering, each their respective causes. These merge easily into (3) Average mass of mankind. (4) Dullards or those of inferior intelUgence. (5) Feeble minded, merging imperceptibly into (6) Imbeciles and by insensible gradation into (7) Idiots and gross idiots. The mentally defective is wholly incapable at maturity of adapting himself to his environment or local conditions in order to maintain ex- istence independent of any external support. Dementia is a disease of the mind or that which was once possessed, and by some neuronic disturbance is lost totally or partially. Insanity is a disturbance of neuronic function which may or may not end in degeneration of brain tissue. Physiology. — The normal brain begins its development shortly after fertiUzation of the germ cell, by the expansion of the anterior end of the rudimentary spinal cord into four primary cerebral vesicles. These develop into a series of elaborate infoldings, each with multiple cells around them. At or about the sixth month of fetal Hfe this embryonic brain assumes the shape of the adult brain, minus the secondary fissures and convolutions which are characteristic of full development. At birth there are sometimes many convolutions and the brain weighs from 280 to 330 grams. Growth is then rapid and at six months it weighs from 560 to 680 grams; At one year, 750 grams. It continues to increase until At 12 to 14 years it weighs 1150 grams in the female, and 1300 in the male ; At 20 to 21 years the weight is 1244 grams in the female and 1374 in the male. Growth is slow from this time until at 25 to 35 years the average weight of the brain is 1269 grams (45 oz.) in the female, 1421 grams (50 oz.) in the male. This growth of the brain is due, first to the rapid multiplication of nerve cells and, secondly, to the individual enlargement of each nerve cell. These cells arise from the floor of the four primary vesicles and are each similar to its fellow. They finally show differences in feature and The Practice of Osteopathy 307 become characteristic in size and shape which process continues through- out Hfe. This process of differentiation of nerve cells results in the pe- culiar laminated appearance of the brain cortex. At the period of lam- ination, the nerve cells throw out delicate processes which pursue definite directions throughout the brain mass constituting a system of associa- tion fibers which link together in a most complicated manner all parts of the brain, and are called the association fibers of Flechsig. Projec- tions from these cells form the various pathways by which the brain is connected to the various parts of the body. Nerve cells in the different parts of the brain mature at different periods, those areas which have to do with the highest intellectual func- tions, viz., the frontal and parietal regions, maturing last. At the seventh month of intra-uterine life the brain cell is a small round type of neuroblast, undifferentiated, lying in a matrix. The cells increase in size until about the second week (extra-uterine) of life, tiny processes begin to develop. At the third to fifth year these cells are mature and possess axons, dendrons and geminules. These communi- cate, forming the above-named association system conveying impulses to and from all parts of the cerebrospinal system. They multiply and elaborate after puberty into a compHcated system up into middle hfe after which growth ceases and they slowly diminish. Greatest Growth is between the first appearance of the primitive brain and the end of the sixth month of Hfe (extra-uterine) , hence it is during this period that any adverse conditions relative to development of nerve cells may cause the greatest damage. Mind and Brain. — Whatever may be the connection between these two, we know that the former develops with the growth of brain cells and fails with their decay. Amentia is associated with the incomplete development of brain cells and Dementia is coincident with their de- generation and death. Patliology — Brain. — Structural abnormahty of the brain tissue may exist without variation of mentality or defect. Early observers gave these gross defects as a cause for amentia. However, it has been demonstrated beyond doubt by microscopic examination of cerebral neurosis that cellular changes occur and that imperfect and arrested development exists and is an essential basis of amentia. Histology — Blood Cells. — Cortical blood cells in the ament are 1. Xuinciiciilly fewer. 2. Irregular in arrangement. 3. Imperfectly developed. 308 The Practice of Osteopathy 4. Microscope reveals changes proportionate to the deficiency dur- ing Hfe. Blood-vessels in Amentia show no marked changes from those of the normal brain. Hyahne degeneration may be present; also pig- mentation. These conditions are not constant in amentia hence cannot be considered causal. Neuroglia in Amentia. — Sclerosis and hj^pertrophy occur in a large proportion of cases. This is diffuse throughout the brain, with here and there certain circumscribed areas forming nodules. Nerve Fibres of Cortex in Amentia. — Association system fibres are always diminished in number and not sO comphcated. Clinical Varieties of Amentia. — There are two varieties of amen- tia and conventionally^ for sake of study we must arrange them into those from (1) Congenital causes and (2) acquired causes. Among those which arise from congenital causes we have the micro- cephalous and MongoHan types. In both cases there exist constitutional taints through successive or immediately forgoing generations of such diseases as syphihs, tuberculosis, epilepsy, and acute alcohohsm affecting proper collaboration of germ cells previous to fertihzation and hence impaired germinal endowment through a weakened nervous system. Those arising from acquired causes are from injury to mother or fetus. Microceplialus. — A person whose skull measures less than seven- teen inches in its greatest circumference. This class comprises less than 10% of all aments. Cause. — The type is neither a freak reversion of the species to a lower grade of development nor accidental, but due to an inherited blight on the nervous system arising from constitutional disease, alcoholic and sexual excesses, consanguinous unions and too numerous latter-life preg- nancies in undermined health states. They come entirely from neuro- pathic stock and their brothers and sisters are degenerates. Many dwarfs exhibit this type. Cliaracteristics of Microceplialy. — (1) Circumference of skull diminished; (2) Brain smaller; (3) Stature small (5 feet); (4) Rarely live to advanced age; (5) Die of tuberculosis; (6) Mostly imbeciles and idiots (few morons). They have their sensory impressions intact and are generally vi- vacious and muscularly active, even restless. They have good sight and hearing and are highly initiative but have not the ability to any sus- The Practice of Osteopathy 309 tained effort. They are actively observant and the majority are affec- tionate and well behaved. Some are unsteady in walking, others are helpless, and about one-half are subject to epileptic fits. Mongolian Amentia (Mongolism). — This type (Kalunk or Tartar variety) received its name from Dr. J. Langdon Down from their facial resemblance to members of the MongoHan race. They number about 5% of all aments including the semi-mongols who have only a few of the characteristics of this type. Cause. — Eleven out of twenty-five are from syphilitic origin. Gland- ular or nutritional defects are suggested as a cause. They will show negative Wassermann test and positive tubercuHn tests. Uterine ex- haustion and ill-health of mother during gestation are factors suspected of entering into this condition. The latter-born of large famihes are frequently affected. Pathology of Mongolian Idiocy. — The brain of the Mongolian anient is considerably under-sized and has less convolutions and is more shallow. The pons, medulla, and cerebellum are about half the size of ordinary feeble minded types. The cells by microscopic examination show an immature condition. This lack of brain development results in deficient expansion of base of skull, hence the characteristic physiog- nomy. There is no glandular abnormality. Description of the Mongol Type. — This type is distinguished by characteristics of skull, eyes and tongue and is usually observed at birth 1. The skull (Brachycephalous) is rounded and diminished in size particularly through the antero-posterior diameter. The face is flat- tened, there being no recession of frontal and supra-occipital regions. Eyes. — The palpebral fissures are narrow and slope obHquely down- ward and inward. Lids inflamed. Tongue protrudes, is large and marked by large papillae and scored by transverse fissures due probably to tongue sucking, predis- posing to inflammation of the mucous membranes. Ears are small and round and have poorly developed and irregular lobules. Nose is short and flat and has triangular nostrils. Teeth are soft and ill formed and tend to decay. Hair is usually scanty and wiry and very dry. Cheeks arc flushed. Palate is high and narrow and mouth is open, and lips are cracked. Adenoids exist in all cases. 310 The Practice of Osteopathy Hands and Feet are broad and clumsy. Flat foot and knock- I noes are common. Skin is rough, coarse and dry. Abdomen is large and mushy. UmbiUcal hernia often present Circulation is rarely good, causing blueness and coldness of ex- tremities, with sores and chilblains. Heart lesions are frequent. Les- ions of a chronic inflammatory nature in respirator}'- and digestive tracts exist. Nasal and bronchial catarrh and diarrhea are common. Mon- gols die early (about 14 years) usually of phthisis. Available statistics show the various types and variations of these conditions in great detail; however, the above will enable the reader to classify and properly diagnose in given cases. It is not the writer's intention to portray here what is easily a treatise bj^ itself. Osteopatliic Consideration of Amentia. — During a period of five years, observation of the various types has led me to believe that much can be done to correct circulation to cerebral structure with con- sequent development of brain tissue and function, where discoverable trauma exists. From all available sources there is traumatic interfer- ence in from 15 to 45% of these cases, according to different authors. Where history involves constitutional findings (syphilis, tubercular, glandular and chronic alcohoUsm) I have treated them with the intent of relieving only until the next phase of the condition would appear. Where trauma alone exists and the family history is good, I know the case is in the field of osteopathy alone, and can be developed to a degree limited only by the intelhgent care of those having the case in charge. Especial attention should be given to disciphne, housing, sanitation, personal hygiene and general environment. Lesions. — Atlas, generally rotated. Rarely posterior but fre- quently resting beneath a posterior occiput. Lateral mass on the pos- teriorly resting portion of misplaced atlas will become interlocked with transverse process of axis in a few instances, combining the amentia with a progressive inflammatory tendency to the middle ear which by suc- cessive abscesses ultimately destroys structure and function; possibly traumatic epilepsy, and surely catarrhal inflammations in all mucous membranes of the head. Many bony and ligamentous irregularities exist in the various types of mental defective where the cause is inherited weakness, nutritional diseases or kindred sources. Spinal luxations exist singly and in series, causing various palsies, spastic muscles, and deformit}'. Postural de- fects, particularly of ribs and costal cartilages cause functional disturb- ance throughout the thorax and abdomen. The Practice of Osteopathy 311 Treatment. — Invariably the care of aments entails wisdom of procedure. Reconstruction is the prime object in every instance, hence time and number of treatments must not be considered. Treat to cor- rect structure; teach as far as possible; train always. Deft and intelKgently applied technique are certainly required in the correction of these cervical lesions. Treatment should be given thrice weekly (never less than twice for progress) with definitely established mental tests before, to discern the mental level, and at succeeding per- iods of three months each, noting progress, if any. The Binet-Simon scale or some other available mental test should always be made and record carefully kept of each case for your own benefit as well as the patient's. After six months, if no appreciable gain is shown treatment is discontinuted and the case must be cared for in another manner as be- yond your special field of effort. Usually it is apparent by the end of the third month if anything can be done to improve the mentality. The physical advantages, in some cases wa'rrant continued treatment where there is no appreciable mental gain. Institutional care of these types is the only practical means of handling them properly from an osteopathic standpoint, as it requires some one properly equipped to make your tests and keep your record; — it is sufficient for the doctor to do the work de- manded. They can thus be classified and progress systematically shown. The higher grades must be taught and though self dependence may never be attained they can in many cases by training be capable of useful pur- suits and quite frequently remunerative work. It makes for happi- ness at least to keep them busy and forestalls the mischief that would otherwise result. Even imbeciles can help in routine work of an insti- tution or home, and idiots may, by training, gain some power of self help and cleanHness. Training depends on the individual capacity for such in each case — his habits, and general character of his propensities. Pre- vention of their marriage should be positive and for prevention of their propagation this and their sterihzation by operation are the only two measures at hand. Sterilization, however, is repugnant to some elements of society and could be abused, hence the segregation of aments would appear to be our only solution at present. The ultimate intention of treating any case is to use any measure tending to stabiHze the nervous system. Corrective effort alone is not sufficient but these osteopathic endeavors in conjunction with proper discipline, good food, regular rest and personal hygiene both mental and physical and a scrutinizing re- striction tending to any kind of excess is rendering the osteopathic pro- cedure in such cases rapidly indispensable for the treatment of amentia. 312 The Practice of Osteopathy POST-OPERATIVE TREATMENT By George A. Still At the convention of the American Osteopathic Association held in BovSton in 1918, I gave a short talk on the above subject, and during the day after I had given the lecture, two women and one man, graduate osteopaths, asked me if I really meant to convey the impression that we actually gave osteopathic treatments to recent surgical cases. I do not know whether I convinced them or not, but I do know that they con- vinced me that there are people practicing osteopathy who have abso- lutely no concept of its merits and underlying principles. To my surprise I have found that a great many osteopaths who con- sider themselves absolutely "pure" are just a bit startled at the thought of handhng post-operative compUcations by treatment. These are in- variably fellows who have had most of their experience in office work, and who do not come in contact with acute cases. Still it is difficult to conceive how a man can believe that osteopathy is specific for certain diseased conditions and not for others. As a matter of fact osteopathic treatment has not proved itself more satisfactory in any field of thera- peutics than it has in post-operative conditions. The common post-operative conditions are pneumonia, pleurisy, backache and headache, nephritis, vomiting, neuritis, phlebitis. Taking up these subjects and discussing the least serious first we would of necessity discuss pneumonia last, as it is the most serious, and is less influenced by other conditions. It will also serve to illustrate many of the details in treatment. We will therefore briefly take up the other conditions and then dis- juss pneumonia more fully. Vomiting We believe there is no question that a good part of the prevention of anesthetic vomiting is in the preparation of the patient, including a good cleaning out of the bowels without debihtating cathartics. In other words, the vomiting is increased if the alimentary tract is loaded, or if on the other hand it has been irritated to the extent of losing its tone. Combining a careful preparation with a straight ether anesthesia and osteopathic treatment to the neck and splanchnics we have been able to eliminate any serious post-operative nausea. I do not recall a case in the last few years that vomited on the following day unless the con- The Practice of Osteopathy 313 dition for which they were operated was one that essentially in itself would cause vomiting; for instance if the patient had peritonitis and had been vomiting due to the toxic ileus. They might even vomit after the abdomen had been opened. This could hardly be called "post-op- erative" vomiting. The improvement in our records in post-operative vomiting is in proportion to our increased faith and use of the osteopathic treatment. Time and again patients have told us that they had taken anesthetics before and were sick from three to five days and even a week. Invar- iably we have been able to surprise these patients by the fact that they were sick less than a day. The usual treatment with bismuth sub-nitrate, cerium oxylate, sour wine and the other usual remedies were not used in any case or in any amount. No drugs whatever were employed. Backache and Headache There is practically no difference in the post-operative headache ■and the office headache. There is of course the usual multipHcity of causes, and as a matter of fact in this condition treatment can more nearly approach the ordinary office treatment, and the results are about the same. As for backache, we find that speed of operating and not keeping the patient under the ether too long has a marked influence. Also we have a four inch Seely mattress on the operating table which helps some. Treatment does the rest and does it effectively. For this compHcation even the ordinary nurse knows enough to give a treatment of some sort. Neuritis Nine times out of ten the post-operative neuritis is really a local osseous lesion, a shpped innominate, rib, vertebra, clavicle, biceps ten- don or something of the sort, and responds quickly to a specific treat- ment. Phlebitis This compHcation usually comes on quite late after an operation and at first it is sometimes hard to differentiate it from a neuritis. Ab- solute rest of the involved part with lower spinal treatment gives relief, but under no circumstances should the affected part be freely moved while there is active inflammation. The reason for treatment of the lower spinal area is that practically always one of the saphenous veins is involved. 314 The Practice of Osteopathy Nephritis This complication is to a very big extent eliminated by a careful' urinalysis prior to the operation, and careful preliminary treatment in indicated cases, and in other cases the postponement or if necessary com- pletely elimination of the operation where it is not a case of life and death. Where the condition does appear we have found it the hardest of the post-operative complications to control. Indeed it is the only one that we have not found very easy to manage. We do not vary the treatment for a post-operative nephritis from what we would use in any ordinary case of nephritis. We have observed treatment of this condition in many cases under medical management, and wliile we are satisfied with the osteopathic treatment compara- tively we are not yet satisfied that we have it developed to its greatest efficiency. Pleurisy This condition in nearly every instance can be corrected with one or two treatments of a twisted rib unless it is the pleurisy of a beginning pneumonia. As far as the pain is concerned the simpler type hurts as much as the one that is going to develop a real complication. For this reason relief obtained by a single treatment often seems Httle short of miraculous to the patient. Pneumonia When I took charge of the surgical work at Kirksville, osteopathy was not used in post-surgical treatment. Post-operative vomiting was treated medically, as were other post-operative conditions, including pneumonia. Cases of a real major surgical nature rarely got an osteo- pathic treatment. The idea seemed to be that osteopathic post-operative treatment had to be along the same fines as it would be for such an illness as lumbago, brachial neuritis, or ordinary pneumonia, and other non-surgical con- ditions where the patient could be placed for giving a treatment in a position that was not permissible following an operation, as it would work great harm to the wound. It seemed to me that if osteopathy was effective in a case of ordi- nary non-surgical pneumonia, it should certainly be good for a case df pneumonia that was post-operative and that all we had to do to handle the condition was to apply a new technique of treatment that could be used on a patient who had a surgical wound. All we had to do was to so The Practice of Osteopathy 315 manipulate the spine that we would get the results locally, and yet handle it in such a manner as not to affect the wound. Many laymen, and even some physicians of our own school, express surprise at the suggestion that we do much osteopathic work in the after care of surgical patients. But the fact is we have worked it out so that now, except for pain, during the immediate after effects of the op- eration drugs are absolutely not used in our hospital for any of the post- operative complications. The opiate immediately following the opera- tion, is really a follow up of the anesthetic, and we use that as rarely as possible. Needless to say, there are cases such as un-united fractures, extensive adhesions, etc., where the emergency conditions positively call for some relief of the pain for a short while, but that is the only condition that we cannot control with mechanical treatment. I am very glad that I had the confidence to give this an early trial ^nd a thorough trial, without being afraid to leave off the drugs. The big field, however, where osteopathic treatment has won the most im- pressive success and proved itself a most absolute specific, is in the field of post-operative pneumonia with which I am proud to announce a one hundred per cent, success for combined osteopathic treatment in my fourteen years continuous surgical work. Not to have lost a single case is partly due to luck. In other words, with any series of serious cases, it is impossible but that there be some fatality finally. Post-operative cases have one advantage along with their disad- vantage. While they have the shock of the operation to contend with, and the weakened condition from the disease for which they were op- erated, still except in extreme emergency they would not have been op- . erated on unless they had a good heart and good kidneys and a good blood pressure, so that in cases in which we are most concerned in com- batting pneumonia, we usually start with a patient who has those or- gans in a healthy condition. First Post-operative Pneumonia Cases Treated Osteopath- Ically. — At the Chicago Convention in 1911, I reported the first post- operative pneumonia cases that had been treated osteopathically. I believe at that time that there had been only three cases. At that meeting I mentioned the fact that some of the doctors and some of the internes who treated those cases felt sure that they were not treating them properly because they could not get away from the idea that pneu- monia needed strychnin and other drugs. One of these cases got well in three days from the developed lobar pneumonia symptoms. The results were so miraculous that the young man treating it began to doubt 316 The Practice of Osteopathy whether it could have been pneumonia. He could not understand how he, a senior student, could overcome this dreaded disease by merely- working on the spine. He could not believe that osteopathy, a science that he had been able to learn himself, so easily could cure a condition that he had thought must be almost necessarily fatal. One of the weaknesses of osteopathy is the fact that there is no mysticism about it. It is so simple that any person with ordinar}^ in- telligence can learn to use it, and yet it is so simple that it takes an un- usual intelligence to be able to grasp the fact that it is the therapeutic discovery of the age. Many, many times I have had young internes and students cure genuine lobar pneumonia and do it with such obvious ease that it caused them to wonder, in a way, if it really could be pneu- monia. It is bred in our very tissues to look for some mysticism, some- thing impossible to understand, something supernatural, something connected with the Unknown associated with the treatment of disease and accordingly it is just human nature to find it difficult to believe, even when we see it, that a simple method of treatment can actually effect a cure. Real pneumonia, as we understand it, is a consohdation of the lung tissues characterized by fibrosanguinous exudate into the pulmonary tissues and spaces, associated with one or more particular germs as ex- citing factors and proved by the physical tests and the character of the expectoration. How many cases have been cured that had not entered consolidation I do not know because up until the time of actual consolida- tion there may be a question as to whether or not they would have had pneumonia. I know that many cases with marked symptoms of pneu- monia have failed to develop under treatment or the case has been aborted . Pneumonia lacks a great deal of being a seK limited disease. The number of cases with beginning s5Tiiptoms that fail to develop is too great to be ascribed to coincidence. Of course I know that some of these might have been only pleuritis, some only neuritis, etc. How- ever, in giving the statistics of pneumonia cures we will give only those in which pneumonia developed and showed a hardening or consohda- tion of the lung tissue. In these cases there can be no argument as to whether there was pneumonia. When we have an acute condition associated with the sjanptoms of consolidation, we can hardly be confused as to the diagnosis. We may make a mistake in our physical findings, but hardly after a Httle ex- perience, and certainly when we are sure of the physical findings there will be no trouble in naming the disease. The Peactice of Osteopathy 317 The Clinical Findings. — Post-operative pneumonia is a Kttle different from the common pneumonia. It always comes on a little more insidiously. One has to watch for post-operative pneumonia more close- ly than he would for the attack that we may meet in ordinary practice. A patient may have considerable pain from his wound, may have some pain in the back from the position he is in; there may be headache, and an upset feeUng from ether; and the pain comes in the chest. All these symptoms are forerunners of pneumonia, but the pain in the chest is not noticed until it gets quite severe. In other words,there are other things to annoy the patient as well as the attendant, and at first, this condition does not cause complaint. A strong and healthy individual who feels a pain in his pleura, which is the forerunner of pneumonia, knows it at once, because that is the only distress he has. His entire attention is attracted and he asks for a physician's help. But in the post- operative case, the physician has to keep a look out in order to prevent a case from getting well under way before it is recognized. As an example of this I had a case of a man who was with a party driving an automobile and they tried to cross the railraod track in front of a train. This patient I speak of was one of the survivors. He had a fracture of the femur, fracture of the skull, fracture of three ribs, and otherwise more or less bruised up. Naturally the preliminary work con- sisted in getting the ribs and legs attended to as well as possible and looking out for cerebral hemorrhage or meningitis. This patient developed consolidation in both lungs in spite of regu- lar treatment, and it precipitated on him very rapidly, partly masked by the disturbed breathing from other sources of irritation. We put him on hourly treatment, but after a few hours his condition from the in- juries and the pneumonia was such that his wife asked us not to treat him any more. She put it this way, that she knew he would die in spite of all that could be done and as long as he was going to die he might as well die easy. Every time he was treated it had the effect of bring- ing him out of his stupor, and he would complain, and she thought it would be a kind act to let him slide off into the next world uncomplaining. Pneumonia in a case of this sort cannot be handled with kid gloves if we wish to save the patient. We must give firm, strong treatment. Light treatment in this condition will do no good. Indeed Hght treat- ments in any sort of pneumonia are of httle avail. Many times I have changed internes in a pneumonic case that was not responding and the results were immediate. That is, the turn for the better was obvious from the beginning of the good strong treatment. 318 The Practice of Osteopathy The case above mentioned was treated a good part of each hour for twelve hours. He had no strychnin, no oxygen, nothing but treat- ments, but he got well and is now living, and aside from a limp has no evidence of either his injury or his illness. Some cases, in private practice, may get well on a treatment a day, but I would hate to handle the kind of cases we get in that manner. I have had severe cases, especially hemorrhagic cases, where the treat- ment was almost continuous for hours preceding the crisis. Of course, after the crisis we can ease up. On the other hand, it is not infrequent that a few good strong early treatments, given at the beginning of a case absolutely stop it. I have seen cases where a consoHdation area of the apex of the lower right lobe as large as the palm was easily outUned, and this together with the chnical symptoms would be cleared up in two or three days. There is no possible medical method by which this can be done. Medical authorities agree that under their treatment pneumonia runs an unshortened course; in other words, a course in the individual case that has not been affected by the medication. Medically, even where the crisis occurs early, the consolidation persists for some time, but I have seen it cleared up time and again under osteopathic treatment in the length of time that could have been brought about only by osteopathic treatment. I have previously called attention to the fact that many of the medical text books on physical diagnosis mention a point that is a very practical and very plain demonstration of the efiiciencj^ of osteopathy in puhnonary conditions. These books only mention this fact without pointing any moral or drawing any conclusions. The point is this: that frequently when a professor is having a class or a section of a class examining a case of pneumonia, they will outhne the size of the consoHda- tion at the beginning, the instructor marking it off when he makes the first examination; then after the students have examined it, by per- cussion, palpation, etc., possibly a dozen or twenty of them, the later students will find that the area has shrunken perhaps an inch. This fact has been frequently noted. It is said, indeed, that if careful ex- amination is made it will alwaj^s be noted. How Manipulative Treatment Benefits Doubtless this proved that accidental manipulations of the ribs helps clear up the congestion about the real consohdation and reduces some of the dull area. Very likely this explains some of the cases of The Practice op Osteopathy 319 partial or real results from spondylotherapy. Naturally, scientific os- teopathic treatment would necessarily magnify such results very much. It is a great wonder with the obvious failure of medical treatment in pneumonia, that at least some crude from of manipulative treatment has not been devised by those practitioners. We have already men- tioned that the treatment of post-operative cases varies mainly in the manner of applying it. In other words, when we raise the ribs we keep the patient on his back, in treating the spinal centers we treat with pa- tient on his back, and the physician who has no grip in his hands will not be able to treat a post-operative pneumonia to any advantage. In these cases one has to get at the patient's back by reaching under and the weight of the patient helps to give the treatment, but a strong grip is necessary. It is much safer for the wound to handle the patient in this way but not infrequently beginners wear their knuckles pretty nearly off before they get the finer technique; after which it is easy. In raising the ribs there is no more difficulty in treating in this position than there is with a patient who can sit up or turn from side to side and in some cases a patient can, of course, be partially turned. Theory is all right but in these cases practice has been added to it in something over three hundred cases treated in this manner, and in this manner only. I have had no case die. None of my cases had oxygen and none of them had strychnin or alcohol unless it was a person who had used alcohol constantly or daily and in these cases I consider that the system has become sufficiently used to it that it is practically a food and that sudden withdrawal is apt to bring on delirium. It is not neces- sary in those cases that indulge deeply now and then, but it is advisable in those that take a small amount regularly, just as they take food. These patients are used to a constant heart stimulant and its withdrawal is also apt to be reflected in the heart action. These are the only cases in which I have ever authorized anything in the way of a chemical stimu- lant of the heart during pneumonia. You will undoubtedly recall that in reading the newspaper accounts of men who are big enough and prominent enough to have bulletins in the newspapers when they are dying, that almost universally the next to the last bulletin was that oxygen is being administered. The last bul- letin announces the time of death. You will also note that in case the patient lives that oxygen then is not mentioned, and a few days later the patient is all right. My observation is that the use of oxygen may attract the attention of the family, it may attract the attention of the patient, but as for any actual benefit on the patient I do not beheve it 320 The Practice of Osteopathy is in the least helpful, and that the only treatment for pneumonia is os- teopathic. I am so convinced of it that I am using only that method. As to strychnin, some say strychnin must be given. Some say it must be given at the crisis, and others say it must be given from the inception of the disease. I do not believe the majority of cases will do as well under strychnin. I know they will not do as well under strych- nin as under osteopathic treatment. I will not say they will not do as well as if under no treatment. It is possible that there would be an oc- casion for its use at the crisis, and I have seen such cases, and I have used it while studying medicine. I used it at the crisis, and I used it in cases where I am convinced that it helped them over the crisis, but I am also convinced now that by osteopathic treatment they would have done still better and the crisis would not have been so acute. In other words what strychnin does in favorable cases, osteopathic treatment does better in all cases. In our post-operative cases study the charts and you will see that they do not have the acutel}^ violent crisis that usually occurs under other treatment. They are under better control and if we can get them near the beginning, as we usually do, we can keep up the resistance so that where they would otherwise have a hard crisis they have an easy one. Instead of having a temperature of 105, pulse 165, respiration 70, or such a condition, they are more apt to run a temperature of 102, pulse 120, respiration 35 or 40 and they go through it without that suddenness and acuteness that is common under other methods of treatment. In several instances, as an example of showing how this resistance is kept up, I had letters from boys in the camps. One letter told of a wide epidemic of severe tonsilHtis. In one group of soldiers there were three osteopaths who treated all the men and this was the only group that was not sent to quarantine. This group developed sore throat and was treated osteopathically and the sore throats checked so that quaran- tine was unnecessary. Among the detailed reports in the A. M. A. Journal there will be nothing about this, nor about many other instances where osteopathic treatment, given by men forced to remain in the ranks, has done things that medicine cannot do. These examples are too frequent to be co- incidents. If I had had three cases of post-operative pneumonia and they had all got well, it would not be surprising. If I had ten cases and they all got well, there are medical hospitals that have been this lucky. But there are no medical hospitals in the world that can report one hun- dred cases or two hundred cases or three hundred with developed pneu- The Practice of Osteopathy 321 monia and all lived. The percentage of pneumonia eases that die now in medical hospitals, is much less than formerly. But the cause of this is not vaccine, antitoxin or drugs. It is due to the fact that pneumonia cases now, hke typhoid, are given very Httle medicine and are turned over to general nursing treatment; that is, in the best medical hospitals. The mortahty is in inverse ratio to the drugs given. The advance medical teaching is against so much drugs in pneumonia, though of course the hick doctors use it because they are practicing medicine of the by-gone age, before Andrew Taylor Still forced on the world the idea partly started by homeopathy, that the less drugs the better. Home- opathy failed in not quite discarding drugs and in not having a substi- tute that reproved drugs. As a matter of interest I wish to mention that while in medical col- lege I had the advantage of being taught surgery by the greatest sur- geon that ever lived, John B. Murphy. I only wish that circumstances could have permitted me to have shown him what osteopathy could do in post-operative conditions, because Murphy was a broad minded man and no man living ever thought less of orthodox medicine and old fash- ioned drug treatment than Murphy. He and the Old Doctor would have been great friends had they ever met. Murphy, whom I considered a most wonderful surgeon, and whose skill! never hope to approach, stated to me many times while a student that he lost more cases from post-operative pneumonia than any other condition and that in upper abdominal conditions like gall bladder, stomach, and similar operations, post-operative pneumonia constituted the most of his mortahty. This great man was afraid of post-operative pneumonia, while I, a much less skilled surgeon, am no more afraid of post-operative pneu- monia than I am of something occurring in a distant state because with osteopathic treatment, v/e have ehminated post-operative pneumonia as a fatal condition. PART SECOND The Practice of Osteopathy 325 INFECTIOUS DISEASES Fever Fever is due to various causes, so that a definite statement cannot always be given as to the cause of fever in every disease. Each fever case, Hke all other disorders, is a law unto itself; different causes are found in different cases. Moreover, often only theories, and not abso- lute facts, can be given. Fever may be present when a local disease assumes a constitutional character or when the constitutional character is manifested from the beginning of the disease. Fever may be a systemic disorder or a symp- tom of disease, and is characterized by an increase of body temperature. Other symptoms are usually present, as an accelerated pulse, disturb- ances of distribution of the blood, increased catabolism, and disordered secretions. Etiology. — In infectious diseases fever is due chiefly to the action of various toxic or harmful agents, produced by the disease, upon the fluids of the body and upon the nervous system. Disturbances of the thermogenic centers and nerves of the brain or cord by harmful agents, or by lesions of the anatomical structures affecting these nerves, are sources of fever. Also disturbances of the vasomotor centers (in the medulla and auxiliary centers along the cord) and nerves are causes of fever in many instances. A disturbed or lessened function of the nerves controlling sweating is an important factor. The multiplication of mi- cro-organisms in the body, acting directly on the tissues or by producing toxic substances which affect the nervous system, is a fruitful source of fever. A few cases may be caused by direct affection of the nervous system, as is shown by appearance of fever in epileptic attacks, or by the passage of a catheter into the bladder. In a large number of all cases a demonstrable cause can be found upon careful examination, whether the fever be due to a necrosed mass of tissue, the introduction into the system of decomposed food, infectious diseases, a lesion of some ana- tomical structure affecting a thermogenic, vasomotor or sweat center, a lesion to the innervation to the heart (vagi and cervical sympathetic) causing a rapid heart, or a lesion to the lymphatic system. Treatment. — The treatment of fevers in a general way consists principally of thorough inhibition to the posterior spinal nerves of the upper cervical region in order that the center of the vasomotor system in the medulla may be affected, probably by the way of the superior ccr- 326 The Practice of Osteopathy vical ganglion of the sympathetic. Thus the entire vascular system is equalized, for there is always a disturbance in the distribution of the blood in fever and if the center controUing the nerves that govern the lumen of the blood-vessels can be brought under control, there will result an equalization of the vascular system; if such occu^-s, health must ensue. Besides the vasomotor nerves to the blood-vessels being affected by this treatment, the nerves governing the lymphatics and the sweat glands will also be controlled. The sweat glands as a rule are rendered active by affecting directly the innervation of the glands, also the glands are controlled indirectly by the blood supply; this aids materially in lessening the temperature of the body. Treatment for a few minutes to the upper posterior cervical region would also affect the thermogenic centers and nerves of the brain reflexly in the same manner as the vasomotor and sweat centers and nerves are affected, thus tending to equalize the mech- anism of the thermogenic system. Besides this action on the vaso- motor, sweat, and the thermogenic nerves, there is produced an increased exhalation of moisture from the lungs, on account of an increase of vas- cular area in the lungs through vasomotor action. Also the large vas- cular area in the abdomen, under control of the splanchnic nerves, be- comes constricted. Thus there is brought about a lessening tempera- ture by evaporation, heat radiation, and perspiration; and an increased action of the general nervous system, a stronger cardiac force, an equali- zation of the vascular system, and a more perfect elimination of toxic properties by the skin, kidneys and lungs; consequently a reduction of the fever. The foregoing treatment is successful to a limited extent, onlj^ in such cases where causative factors of the fever are involving the pre- dominating centers controlling the heat production or dispersion and the vasomotor system directly; for if the lesion that is causing the disorder should be affecting an auxiliary center along the spinal cord instead of the predominating center, as is oftentimes the case, treatment of the predominating center would be useless as far as any permanent benefit is considered; although a temporary effect will be gained by lessening the fever at that point. Consequently, in many cases, the lesion hes within the jurisdiction of auxiliary centers which are situated at various points along the spinal cord. When such is the case, it will be of little benefit to give the cervical treatment. In such instances the lesion to the auxiliary center would have to be removed in order to cure. One cannot depend upon a set rule to reduce a fever; determine the cause, as in any other disease or symptom, and remove it. The Practice of Osteopathy 327 In addition to the treatment to the cervical region and along the spinal column, as are indicated upon an examination, attention should be given to the heart's action. The equihbrium between the accelerator and inhibitory nerves (cervical sympathetic and vagi) should be main- tained. The interchange of gases in the lungs should be rendered as nearly normal as possible; this is best accompUshed by raising and spread- ing of the ribs from the second to the seventh dorsals, particularly in the region of the fifth and sixth. Also stimulation of the vagi will aid by in- creasing the motor power of the lungs. The kidneys and bowels should be kept active so as to favor a rapid elimination of various toxic proper- ties; besides they have control over large vascular areas. Treatment over the ureters will prevent any clogging that might occur in them from a condensation of the urine. Attention, also, should be given the tissues at the fifth lumbar and over the ihac vessels to influence the cir- culation in the pelvis. The food of the patient should be Hquid — milk, soup, broths, etc., and almost any quantity of water allowed if called for, given httle at a time and at frequent intervals. The room should be well hghted, venti- lated, clean and kept at an even temperature. Two points should always be remembered relative to fever: First — That there are many causes of fever; and in order to reduce the fever the cause must be determined and removed, the same as in any disorder. A definite fever treatment cannot be given any more than a definite constipation treatment; the case must be seen in order to determine the cause. Second — The reduction of fever is not necessary; the fever should be treated only as a symptom of disease when it exists as such. In fact, fever is beneficial, for it is one of nature's methods to relieve an over- burdened system from harmful agents, unless the temperature is ex- cessive and continuous and is Hkely to cause more harm than the pri- mary trouble. Absolute rest in bed always is of decided benefit in lessening the temperature. Hydrotherapy is of immense value in reducing a fever. It is an agent that has been greatly used, and if applied intelhgently cannot but be of aid. There is much ignorance in regard to the principles and prac- tice of hydrotherapy, not only among all classes of people, but among well informed practitioners in medicine. The most important func- tion of the skin is as a heat regulator. Knowing this fact, the osteopath treats the vasomotor nerves that control the cutaneous circulation and 328 The Practice of Osteopathy the nerves that control the excretion of the skin; the nerve supply being from the cerebrospinal and sympathetic nerves. In many difficult and obstinate cases hydrotherapeutic measures should be used to aid the skin in regulating the temperature, as well as to enhance system func- tions for the same reason that osteopathic manipulations are given. Maintaining an equilibrium in heat production and heat dispersion is necessary in order that the standard of the body temperature may be kept; and the amount of the arterial blood circulating within a tissue determines its temperature. The principal effect of water as a thermic agent when applied ex- ternally is due to the influence of the action of the water upon the cu- taneous circulation. Lesser effects would be the mere extraction of heat from the body by evaporation and the equalization of tempera- tures of two bodies coming into contact. As the bod}^ is endowed with compensatory powers, tliis latter means would apply only to a Hmited extent. The temperature of the water used is important, as the colder the bath the less effective would its power be in reducing internal tem- perature. When a cold bath is used there is a driving of the blood away from the surface on account of the contraction of the peripheral vessels; consequently increasing the cutaneous circulation and cooUng by radia- tion is prevented and less heat is lost. A collateral hyperemia occurs in the underMng parts which acts as a protection to the deeper tissues. The cold also inhibits the vasomotor nerves controlling the abdominal splanchnics, and thus a larger amount of blood passes to tliis immense vascular area. On the other hand, when a warmer bath is used the effect is opposite, and a lowering of the temperature is the result. The cutaneous vessels being dilated, the superficial blood is rapidly replaced by blood from the deeper vessels, thus allowing a cooling of the body to a large degree. In the various fevers where hydrotherapeutic measures are em- ployed, the object to be gained by such methods is not primarily an anti- thermic one but an anti-febrile reaction; consequently the use of cold water is employed. In mere heat reduction the warmer water would be more effective; but by the aid of the colder water the cause of the increased temperature, as in infectious fevers, is lessened; besides a re- freshing and stimulating effect upon the entire system is gained. Thus the aim of the cold bath and friction, is not primarily to subdue the temperature by heat radiation or evaporation, but to correct disturb- ances governing the formation and the dissipation of heat caused bj^ infectious fevers, and, moreover, to stimulate the nervous sj'stem, pre- The Practice of Osteopathy 329 vent heart failure, increase the eliminating power of thefskin, kidneys and lungs, and to influence the corpuscular and chemical constituents of the blood to a more normal condition. The full cold bath and friction (Brand Method) is commonly em- ployed in infectious fevers. The half bath, wet pack, or sponging may be used. The modus operandi of each is given under the hydrothera- peutic treatment of typhoid fever. Typhoid Fever (Enteric Fever) In writing of these acute diseases which are self-hmiting, it is under- stood that osteopathy aborts, overcomes symptoms and otherwise changes conditions frequently. When this occurs the case is not typical and it is a typical case which is here described. Deftnition.— An acute, infectious disease caused by the bacillus typhosus. It is characterized anatomically by hyperplasia and definite lesions of Peyer's patches and mesenteric glands, and enlargement of the spleen, and chnically by its slow onset, often diarrhea, abdominal tenderness, tympanites, fever, headache, and rose colored spots on the abdomen. Osteopathic Etiology and Pathology. — Lesions to the lower dorsal and lumbar regions are always found, which impair the innerva- tion and vascular supply of the intestines and cause defective nutrition. This is the most important predisposing cause, although general low- ered vitality from over-work, improper food, unhygienic environment, and insanitary surroundings, are also of great importance. It is possible that one's vitaHty may be so lowered that the bacillus of Eberth, if of sufficient numbers or virulency, wiU find a suitable medium wherein to multiply and grow, and thus the spinal lesions found in these cases are the result of reflex irritation. But the most probable underlying cause is the spinal lesion, and given two individuals with equal Hkelihood to infection, one with the spinal lesions and the other not, the former within all probabihty will be the more likely to suffer an attack. The severity and extent of the osteopathic lesion undoubtedly bears a direct ratio to the probability of attack from an infectious disease. Typhoid fever usually occurs between the ages of fifteen and thirty years. Some fam- ilies are more susceptible than others. The autumn months, especially after a dry, hot summer, favor the disease. One may be reasonably certain that whenever there is a case of typhoid the individual has not been careful as to diet, or drinking water, or some rule of health, and 330 The Practice of Osteopathy wherever there is an epidemic it can always be traced to insanitary sur- roundings, the water supply, contaminated garden truck or other food, sewage, etc.; although tliis does not preclude the probability that the osteopathic lesion or lowered vitahty of Peyer's patches and mesenteric glands from other causes are important and many times primal etio- logical factors. The specific poison may be so virulent that practically no one escapes and again those of lowered vitality only will succumb to an attack. The exciting cause is a special micro-organism, the bacillus of Eberth. The contagion may be carried through the air from one person to another, but this is rarely the case. Though the water is the most common mode of conveyance, the bacillus has been found during epi- demics in both water and milk. The water may be contaminated by the intestinal discharges which have not been properly disinfected. Ex- treme cold does not destroy the typhoid germs. Millv may be infected from the milk-can being washed with the contaminated water or the unclean hands of the milker. In fresh millv the germs multiply rapidly. Salads, celery, ice and fruits may be contaminated. Oysters have be- comed infected while being fattened or freshened. It is thought by some that the poison is not eliminated from the sick in a condition capable of transferring disease to a healthy person, but must undergo changes in the soil before it is able to cause the disease in another. Typhoid fever may be caused, however, by direct contact with the stools. Filth, sew- ers, or cesspools do not directly cause the disease, but they form a suit- able medium for the preservation of the typhoid germs. Pathologically, the characteristic lesions in typhoid fever consist of changes in the lymphoid elements of the bowels. These changes are most striking in the solitary glands and Peyer's patches. The altera- tions which occur may be divided into four well defined stages: (1) Infiltration — the glands are enlarged from infiltration and there is marked cell proUferation, particularly Peyer's glands in the jejunum and ileum and to a lesser extent those in the large intestine. The glands be- come pale and prominent. Occasionally the soUtary glands, which are usually deeply imbedded in the submucosa, become prominent ho Microscopically, the capillary blood-vessels are at first consider- ably dilated, but later become more or less contracted, giving an anemic appearance to the folHcles. The adjacent mucosa and muscularis may become infiltrated. The cells have the character of lymph corpuscles, some of which are larger, epithelioid in character, containing several nuclei. From the eighth to the tenth day this medullary infiltration reaches its height and then undergoes either resolution or necrosis. The Practice of Osteopathy 331 (1) Resolution takes place by a granular or fatty infiltration of the cells. This produces pitting of the swollen follicles, which may cause small hemorrhages. (2) Necrosis. — With all the severe cases of cell infiltration, hy- perplasia of lymph follicles reaches a stage where resolution is impossible and necrosis occurs. The necrosis is partly due to the choking of the blood-vessels and partly to the direct action of the bacilli. The necrosis may involve only the superficial layers of the mucosa or it may extend deep into the muscular coat and even perforate the outer or serous coat. Usually, however, this does not extend below the submucosa, mucosa, or muscularis. Not all of the patches necessarily slough, but as a rule it is always more intense toward the iliocecal valve. (3) Ulceration. — The extent and depth of the ulcers depend upon the amount of the necrosis.- Large ulcers are sometimes formed, es- pecially in the lower end of the bowel, by the union of several. The edges are swollen and undermined. The base is usually smooth and formed of submucosa. Perforation of the bowel occurs in a small percentage of cases; more commonly the ulcers heal. The perforations may be multiple, but rarely exceed two in number. (4j Healing.— Cicatrization begins about the fourth week. This granulation tissue covers the floor. It is sometimes formed with con- nective tissue and a new growth of epithehum results. The gland is ul- timately replaced by a depressed scar with a smooth, pigmented sur- face. The majority of deaths occur before this stage is reached. The gland structure is never regenerated. The mesenteric glands show intense hyperemia and later become enlarged and softened, but rarely ruptured. The glands at the lower end of the ileum are markedly involved. The spleen is enlarged, softened, and diffluent. Occasionally rupture occurs. Infarction is not a rare occurrence. The liver shows parenchymatous and granular degeneration, and the cells are found to contain much fat. Infarction abscesses and acute yellow atrophy occur in rare instances. Diphtheritic inflammation of the gall-bladder sometimes occurs and the bile is thinner and paler than normal. The kidneys also show parenchymatous degeneration. They are pale in appearance, with shght cloudy sweUing. Microscopicallj'-, there are seen granular and fatty infiltration of the cells of the convoluted tubules. Rarely, there is acute nephritis which may be hemorrhagic. There may be miliary abscesses in which typhoid bacilH have been found 332 The Practice of Osteopathy by some observers. Diphtheritic, but more frequently catarrhal, in- flammation of the pelvis of the kidney may occur. Catarrh of the blad- der is not infrequent and even sometimes diphtheritic inflammation is present. Rarely orchitis is encountered. Hypostatic congestion of the lungs is not uncommon. Gangrene and hemorrhagic infarction are sometimes present. Lobar pneumonia may be a compUcation. In the larynx ulceration is sometimes met with; bacilli, however, have not yet been found in these ulcers. Diphtheritis of the pharynx and larjTix may occur. Catarrhal or croupous pharyngitis may oc- cur; while swelling of the follicles of the pharynx and base of the tongue is frequently noticed.- Peritonitis is always present in fatal cases in wliich perforation of the bowel has taken place. The perforation insiy occur in ulcers from which the sloughs have already separated, or it may be caused by a ne- crosis of all the coats. Extensive peritonitis may occur without perfora- tion, and is probably due to extension of the inflammation to the peri- toneum. The heart may be affected. Endocarditis is rare, while peri- carditis is much more frequent. Myocarditis is frequently met with, the cardiac muscles presenting parenchymatous and rarely hj^ahne de- generation. The arteries are frequently found to be involved. These conditions (obHterating arteritis and partial arteritis) may affect the smaller vessels, especiallj^ those of the heart, but more commonly affect the arteries of the lower extremities. Thrombosis of the veins, especially of the femoral, and more rarely of the cerebral veins and sinuses, occurs. Granular and hyaUne changes in the voluntary muscles may occur. This degeneration does not affect the whole muscle but involves only certain fibres. Regeneration takes place during convalescence. With the nervous system meningitis is rare. The peripheral nerves are frequently the seat of parenchymatous changes. The ganglia of the trunks of the vagi present an inflammatory change. The blood presents little change. During the first two weeks the red corpuscles gradually decrease in number until the first week of con- valescence, after which they gradually increase in number. There is often a marked decrease in the number of leucocytes. Leucocytosis is absent. The hemoglobin is always reduced. Symptoms and Course. — The incubation period varies from a few days to two weeks or longer. During this time the patient may feel in his usual health, but more often there is a feehng of languor and The Practice of Osteopathy 333 indisposition to exertion, loss of appetite, slight coating of the tongue, nausea, headache, chilUness, but seldom a decided rigor, pains in the back or legs and nose-bleeding. Any of these symptoms may be present and last usually from a few days to a week or more. These symptoms increase in severity and the patient takes to his bed. The invasion as a rule is gradual. The first week dates from the onset of the fever which generally (but by no means in all cases) rises steadily during the first week a de- gree or a degree and one-half each day, reaching 103 or 104 degrees F. The pulse is quickened to 90 to 110 per minute and is full, of low tension and sometimes dicrotic. There is great thirst, also a coated tongue. The skin is hot and dry and there is rather intense headache. Unless the fever is high there is no dehrium. The sleep is disturbed and there may be mental confusion and wandering. Cough with some thoracic op- pression is not uncommon at the onset. The abdomen is slightly dis- tended and tender. There may be either constipation or diarrhea. The spleen is somewhat swollen and a rose colored rash appears on the skin of the abdomen and chest. During the second week the fever remains high and exhibits the continued type, the morning remission being sUght. The pulse is ac- celerated. The headache disappears, but there is marked mental dull- ness and slowness and there may be a mild delirium at night. The tongue is coated and the hps are dry. The abdomen is tympanitic and tender. Diarrhea replaces constipation. The case may prove fatal during this week from the result of nervous or pulmonary symptoms, hemorrhage, or perforation. The fever changes in the third week from a continuous to a re- mittent type. The pulse ranges from 110 to 130. The patient is very weak. CompMcations may arise, as pulmonary symptoms, feebleness of heart, intestinal hemorrhage, perforation, and peritonitis. In favorable cases during the fourth week the fever begins to dechne and the general and local symptoms gradually disappear. In protracted cases the fourth and fifth weeks may present the symptoms of the third week. Frequently the following aggravated symptoms are added: stupor, dehrium, increased weakness, rapid, feeble pulse, and distended abdomen. Heart failure and inflammatory complica- tions increase the danger. During the fifth and sixth weeks a few cases will show irregular lever. Great care should be taken that comphcations do not occur. The fever is the most important and characteristic symptom and 334 The Practice of Osteopathy from the temperature alone a diagnosis may be made. During these stages of development, which is the first four or five days, the tempera- ture rises steadily; the evening temperature being about a degree or a degree and one-half higher than the morning remissions, reaching 104 or 105 degrees F. at the end of the first week. When the fastigium is reached the fever persists with slight morning remissions.. At the end of the second and throughout the third week the temperature becomes more remittent and there may be a difference of three or four degrees between the morning and evening temperature. During the last stage the fever falls by lysis, forming a more or less regular step-like fine of descent. The stage lasts from one week to ten days. When the disease sets in with a severe rigor the fever frequently rises at once to 103 or 104 degrees F. In the hghtest forms the fastig- ium may be almost absent; defervescence setting in upon the first day of the fastigium and in many cases defervescence occurs at the end of the second week and the temperature may fall rapidly, becoming normal in ten or twenty hours. This fall in the temperature may take place without any apparent cause or it may follow an intestinal hemorrhage. The temperature often falls many hours before the blood appears in the evacuations. The occurrence of peritonitis is also marked by a sudden fall in the temperature. Hyperpyrexia in typhoid fever is not very common except just before death. After the temperature has been normal for several days there may be a sudden rise of the temperature to 102 or 103 degrees F. This may persist for a couple of days and then return rapidly to the normal. These recrudescences, as they are called, are quite common and are caused most frequently by errors in the diet, constipation, excitement or mental emotion. These elevations in the temperature are found most frequently in children and persons of a nervous temperament. Afebrile Typlioid is of very rare occurrence. The patient has all the characteristic symptoms of typhoid fever with the exception of a fever. The rasli is highly characteristic. It appears about the eighth or tenth day, usually upon the skin of the abdomen or chest, rarely found elsewhere on the body. It consists of a variable number of rose colored spots distinctly elevated, and disappear on pressure. These spots last three or four days and appear in successive crops. Vivid red erythemat- ous eruptions upon the chest and abdomen are commonly seen during the first week of typhoid fever. Urticaria is rarely seen. The Practice of Osteopathy 335 Sweating characterizes some cases of typhoid fever, but generally the skin is dry. This may occur with or without chilly sensations or actual rigors. In some cases there may be recurring paroxysms of chills, fever, and sweats and they may be mistaken for intermittent fever. Edema of the skin may occur and is usually due to anemia or cachexia and sometimes to nephritis. Local edema may occur as the result of vascular obstruction, particularly thrombosis of the femoral vein. There is a pecuKar musty odor exhaled from the skin in typhoid fever, particu- larly if the skin has been neglected. In all protracted cases bed-sores are Ukely to develop. The hair is apt to fall out but is generally re- newed. The nails also suffer and ridges can usually be observed upon them. Intestinal symptoms are very inconstant. Usually there is constipation at the onset and this may persist throughout the disease although a moderate diarrhea may occur throughout the disease. The severity of the diarrhea is due most probably to the degree of the ca- tarrh rather than to the extent of the ulcers. It is probable that the discharges are more frequent when the catarrh involves the large in- testine. The number of discharges average, as a rule, from two to four or more daily. The stools are either fluid or of the consistency of jelly, of a grayish-yellow color, alkaline in reaction 'and are very offensive. Hemorrhage is a serious symptom, but by no means always fatal. This usually occurs in cases of considerable severity and it generally oc- curs at the time of the separation of the sloughs during the third week. When it occurs quite early in the disease it is generally the result of hypereiTiia. It may be so slight as not to be noticed by the eye or it may be from one to three pints. Intestinal hemorrhage, however shght, is always a grave sjanptom. There may be symptoms of collapse and fall of temperature, or it may occur without any symptoms. Meteorism is an almost constant symptom, and when excessive adds to the seriousness of the case and corresponds generallj^ with the extent of local lesions. Abdominal tenderness and gurghng upon pres- sure in the right iliac fossa may be present ; pain is generally absent, and when present is usually slight. Perforation almost invariably causes fatal diffuse peritonitis and is the most serious compHcation. It may occur at any time but is most common between the second and fourth weeks. It is usually indicated by sudden acute pains in the abdomen and symptoms of collapse. As a rule symptoms of peritonitis appear at once; distension of the abdomen, great tenderness, and rigid abdominal walls. Vomiting, pinched fca- 336 The Practice of steopathy tures, and rapid, small pulse shows general collapse of the circulatory system. Bronchitis is almost invariably present as an initial symptom. It is indicated by the existence of sibilant rales. The cough is generally sHght. Hypostatic congestion of the lungs and edema, due to enfeeble- ment of the cardio-pulmonary circulation, in the latter part of the disease are not infrequent. The pulse as a rule is not very frequent and is generally not in pro- portion to the fever until late in the disease; 90 to 120 is the usual range. During the first week it is about 100, full, and frequently dicrotic; later it becomes more rapid, feeble and small. In severe cases during the ex- treme debility of the third week the pulse may reach 150 or more (the so-called running pulse). During convalescence the pulse occasionally becomes subnormal and bradycardia is met with more frequently than after any other acute fever. The blood presents definite changes, some of which are important. In cases where there is profuse sweating or copious diarrhea, the red corpuscles may be relatively increased; this is due to the loss of water. In most cases there is httle change until the end of the second week. During the third week there is generally a decrease in the number of cor- puscles and of the hemoglobin, which is always reduced. Leucocytosis is always absent. The white corpuscles are slightly diminished espec- ially toward the end of convalescence. During the first week there is generally persistent headache, some- times neuralgia. There are a few cases in which the effects of the ty- phoid bacilli or their poison is manifested in the nervous system from the very onset. There are violent headaches, retraction of the head, rigidity, photophobia, twitching of the muscles, rarely convulsions, all indicating meningitis as which it is occasionally diagnosed. It must be remembered however, that aU nervous symptoms may occur independ- ently of a lesion of the nervous system. Delirium may exist from the onset, but it usually is not present until the second or third week and only in the severer cases. As a rule it is most marked at night. It is generally of the low, muttering type, very seldom maniacal. When the patient picks at the bed clothes or grasps at imaginary objects there is indication of danger, as it is a serious symptom. Convulsions are rare. The urine is diminished in quantity, high specific gravity, and of dark hue Both urea and uric acid are increased and the chlorids are. The Peactice of Osteopathy 337 diminished during the first stages. About the stage of decHne the urine becomes hght in color and greater in quantity than normal. The spe- cific gravity is lowered, urea and uric acid are diminished, and the chlor- ids are increased. Febrile albuminuria is verj^ common but of no special significance. Acute nephritis may develop as a complication. Pyuria is not an uncommon complication and post-typhoid pyehtis may also develop. Malarial fever may be associated with typhoid, especially in ma- larial districts. Persons with tuberculosis, epilepsy, chorea, and other forms of chronic nervous diseases are liable to typhoid fever. In epi- lepsy and chorea the movements and fits usually cease during the at- tack of typhoid fever. Varieties of Typhoid are numerous and are named with reference to the degree of severity which varies from extreme mildness to extreme severity. The mild or abortive form is of frequent occurrence. The onset is usually sudden. The symptoms are similar to those of a typical case but much milder and appear earher than in the usual type. This form runs its course in about two weeks. The fever usually reaches 104 de- grees F. In the severe or grave form there is high fever and the nervous symptoms show a profound intoxication of the system. The grave types are those associated with serious compHcations or those cases which set in with pneumonia, Bright's disease, or cerebrospinal symptoms. In the latent or ambulatory form (walking typhoid) the symp- toms are very slight, the patient being hardly sick enough to go to bed. The symptoms may be of this character throughout the attack, and the patient may be able to be up and about. In other cases the first symp- toms are very mild, but later they may develop symptoms of the sever- est type. The Afebrile form is rare. Hemorrhagic typhoid is a very fatal but rare form. In this type there are cutaneous and mucous hemorrhages. Diagnosis. — As a general rule typhoid fever is easily recognized. The Widal test should be made. At times the diagnosis may have to be delayed until the distinctive signs appear, especially in those cases which come on with severe headache, dehrium, twitching of the muscles, and retraction of the head. In these cases the diagnosis of cerebro- spinal meningitis is invariably made, until the appearance of the colored spots on the abdomen, which must decide the diagnosis; Cerebrospinal meningitis being a rare disease and typhoid fever with severe nervous 338 The Practice of Osteopathy symptoms quite frequent, it is more probable that it is typhoid. At least one-half of the cases termed brain fever belong to this class of ner- vous typhoid. Prognosis. — A positive prognosis can not be made, as even the mildest cases are Uable to have severe compHcations develop at any stage of the disease. Under osteopathic treatment the prognosis is undoubtedly more favorable than with the treatment of the older schools. If the osteopath can see the case early, the first week, there is always a chance to abort the attack. In all cases there is the probability that the attack will be shortened; this is a common experience. Price of Mississippi, has treated many cases, and invariabty when the patient is seen early the attack has been shortened to thirteen or fourteen days, whereas under other treatment the disease runs the usual course. Adsit of Kentucky, White of New York, and the staff of the American School of Osteopathy (Kirksville), as well as many others, have had the same experience. And if the attack cannot be aborted or shortened there is the further probabiUty that the severity will be lessened and complica- tions prevented. The prognosis is always more favorable in winter than in summer, and especially favorable in children. More women die than men, and fat persons stand the disease badly. Treatment. — Typhoid fever is one of the diseases that practi- tioners of all the schools are agreed that drug therapeutics avail but little in its treatment. The treatment of the older schools consists of prophylaxis, good nursing, attention to hygienic principles, dieting, and hydrotherapy. All of these have their places and are recognized by the osteopathic school. But the above methods are of the defensive only — allowing the disease to run its usual course and reducing the like- lihood of compHcations. On the other hand the above treatment coupled with osteopathy, not onty attacks the ravages of the disease defensively, but of more importance, the disorder is attacked offensively. Herein is where attacks are aborted, or shortened, or severity lessened, or com- plications prevented. The efficacy of osteopathy is due to the abilitj^ of the osteopath to treat disease, not only prophylactically and palli- atively, but of more consequence, aggressively. The correction of the spinal lesions in typhoid fever is of first im- portance. This treatment effects a tendency toward equahzed circula- tion of the intestines. The vasomotor nerves are disturbed by the above lesions which in turn produces stasis in Peyer's patches and the mesen- teric glands. Reversely some of the spinal lesions may be due to reflex stimuli, for "Kirk , . . states that muscular contractions produced The Practice of Osteopathy 339 by reflex activity are often more sustained than those produced by di- rect stimulation of the motor nerves themselves."^ Prophylactic treatment is very essential, for typhoid fever as a rule is a preventable affection. Modern hygienic and sanitary resources enable a community to reduce the number of cases to a minimum. The number of cases in a locality depends almost directly upon the condi- tion of the water supply and drainage. Care should always be taken in regard to the source of drinking water and milk. During an epidemic the water should be boiled for half an hour before being used. The pa- tient should be isolated. In hospitals they should have special wards; in families a special apartment should be given them. Hygienic prin- ciples should be followed as in other infectious diseases. The methods of disinfection must be rigid to prevent the spread of an infection. The excreta (stools, urine, vomitus, and sputum) are to be received into a bed-pan or any appropriate receptacle containing half a pint of carbolic acid (one to twenty). Three or four pints of the carbohc acid (one to twenty) should then be added to the bed-pan and the contents mixed carefully before emptying. All utensils used in handHng the excreta are to be carefully disinfected by the same material, and dried. After every stool the nates of the patient should be cleansed by a cloth compress, wet with a solution of carboHc acid (one to forty) and the cloth burned. The sick room should be thoroughly ventilated each day. All utensils used about the patient in feeding should be boiled in water immediately after using. The bed and body Hnen is to be changed as soon as soiled and these, with all changed bath towels, blank- ets and rubber sheets, should be received in a sheet rinsed in carbohc acid (one to forty) and placed where they may be soaked in the solution for four or five hours. The clothes are to be boiled for half an hour. The rubber blanket is to be washed in the solution, dried and aired. The General Management, careful nursing and a regulated diet, is of paramount importance in the treatment of typhoid fever. The pa- tient should be placed in bed as soon as the disease is determined and there remain until the end of the attack. The room should be well ventilated and have a sunny exposure if possible. The single woven wire bed with soft hair mattress and two folds of blankets is best. A rub- ber cloth should be placed smoothly under the sheet. When a good nurse cannot be had, the attending osteopath should write out directions regarding diet, bed hnen, and utensils, and the disinfection of the ex- creta. 1. Ilinckle— The Scientific Basis of Osteopathy. 340 The Practice of Osteopathy A liquid diet should be administered. Milk is most commonly used; care being taken that it is thoroghly digested. If milk is not borne well by the patient, other foods, as whey, sour milk, buttermilk, and broths may be substituted. Give food that is easily digested and which leaves but httle residue. When milk is used alone, three pints at least may be given to an adult in the course of twenty-four hours; and it should always be diluted, preferably with plain water. Beef juice, mutton or chicken broth may also be used when milk is not agreeable. Albumin water, prepared by straining the white of eggs through a cloth and adding an equal amount of water, is an excellent food. Well strained, thin barley gruel is considered by many an excellent food for typhoid fever patients. Cases not able to take nourishment into the stomach, on account of vomiting and other causes, should be fed rectally to support life. Do not force feeding to an unwarranted degree. Recently a number of new diets have received commendation. These include the "high calory" diet, which includes three pints of milk with one of cream, two to eight ounces of milk sugar, eggs, butter; some- times cereals, toast, potato, and other soft foods are given. A full sugar diet, as of candy alone, is based upon the immediate absorption of sugar, its value as a source of energy, and the fact that a plentiful carbohydrate supply lessens the danger of acidosis.^ The best drink for fever patients is pure, cold water and they should be encouraged to drink freely of it. Barley water, ice tea, lemonade, or even moderate quantities of coffee or cocoa, may be given. By Osteopathic Treatment many cases of typhoid fever may be aborted, if treated correctly, during the first week. If the stage of necrosis of Beyer's patches has set in, one can either lessen the severit}" of the attack or, at least, shorten the usual course. During the stage of infiltration, treatment to the intestinal splanchnics (chiefly from the ninth to twelfth dorsal, the innervation to the jejunum and ileum) and careful treatment over the abdomen is indicated. This treatment will tend to lessen the intestinal catarrh and diminish the infiltration and cell proliferation of the lymphoid elements of the inteatines, and thus produce unfavorable the conditions for the bacillus of Eberth. In other words, increase the tone and activity of the intestines so that the micro-organisms of typhoid fever will not find the proper tissue-soil in order to grow and multiply. All cases of tj'^phoid fever present lesions in the dorsal or lumbar spine and this is really the great predisposing cause of typhoid fever. 2. Clinical Osteopathy. The Pkactice of Osteopathy 341 Correcting these lesions is absolutely necessary in order to abort the disease. Some patients may have such a lowered vitahty to begin with that the recuperative powers of the body cannot be rendered forceful enough in a short time to combat the effects of the micro-organism. Carefully raising the cecum is very effective (A. T. Still), but this must be done with the greatest of caution and judgment. Dr. Still considers a posterior condition of the third, fourth and fifth lumbars as typical in typhoid and that it inhibits the lymphatics to the intestines. R. L. Price has had excellent success in shortening the usual typhoid course. His first treatment is to thoroughly empty the bowels by ene- mata. This is followed by spinal, liver and splenic treatment, and i liquid diet. E. C. White has also treated a large number of typhoid cases with marked success. He prefers to employ the Brand method (and it must be properly used) from the start. He is, also, a thorough advocate of the spinal treatment. In cases of constipation give a very light treat- ment over the left iliac fossa. With all patients observe careful dieting. White believes that many lesions of the spine arise from reflex irritations during acute attacks. Careful, frequent attention to the spine is de- manded. Hildreth, relative to abdominal and spinal treatment, writes as fol- lows: "In the abdominal treatment of typhoid fever, too much care cannot be exercised; or in the spinal treatment, too much judgment used in giving just the right kind of manipulation. There can be no ques- tion relative to the seat of the disease, and consequently there should be no trouble in knowing where or how to affect the nerves to control the same. That Peyer's patches or the right iliac region is always involved, we all know. The spinal treatment should be appHed from the eighth dorsal to the first lumbar inclusive; this affects all the lesser splanchnics and thus controls the circulation of the entire bowel. And this treatment should be given, according to the symptoms indicated, in each and everj^ case. If the patient is constipated, then the treatment should be more of a stimulative character, but if diarrhea is present, as is commonly the case, the treatment should be an inhibitory one. In the above I always finish with a very careful treatment of the floating ribs on the left side; this affects the lesser splanchnic nerves. In all cases I always carefully treat the lower two or three lumbar vertebrae, which directly affects the hypogastric plexus of nerves, and thus controls the circulation to the lower bowel. "In all cases I always treat the bowels directly, more or less, but 342 The Practice of Osteopathy this treatment must be given with the veiy greatest care and the best judgment, always governed by the condition of the bowel. By no means manipulate the bowel, but just lay your hands flat on the abdomen, and with the most gentle pressure inhibit the peripheral nerves, thus either quieting an excited peristalsis or equahzing a disturbed circula- tion. And with this treatment remember that the two specific points in typhoid fever are the lower dorsal and lower lumbar nerves. "The above treatment is used, of course, in connection with all the other necessary treatments, such as dieting, nursing, sponging, reheving the headaches, etc. I am unalterably opposed to ice-packs for the bowels in typhoid, for the reason it is too much of a shock. Cold cloths are good and much better than ice, and should always be used instead of ice." After the disease has become thoroughly established always make it a point during each visit to examine the entire length of the spinal column carefully and readjust any tissue, whether it be vertebra, rib, or muscle, that may be found disordered. The bowels are to be watched carefull}^ and if constipated, they should be moved with a hght enema. Great care must be taken not to treat the abdomen roughly, if at all, after the first week. The treatment might be very injurious to the structures diseased. A Ught treatment over the liver and kidneys each time is a wise precaution. The heart's action, should be watched care- fully. In addition to the hydrotherapeutic treatment, the general fever treatment should be employed. The patient should usually be seen twice a day. Abdominal pain is best reheved by Ught treatment over the ab- domen and by thorough treatment of the lower dorsal or lumbar region. Apphcations of hot water will be helpful. Meteorism can be reheved by raising the lower ribs and by direct treatment to the abdomen. A change of diet may be beneficial. When gas is in the large bowel an enema may be given to remove it. Diarrhea and constipation are best controlled by the usual treat- ment given the spine in such cases, and over the abdomen and the hver. Light enemata may be given for constipation. The stools should be ex- amined when diarrhea occurs, as the presence of curds may cause the aggravation. Hemorrliage from the bowels demands absolute rest. It is prob- ably better to have the patient use the draw sheet for the evacuation. Immediate and thorough treatment must be given to the spinal column in the region of the intestinal nerves to the diseased area, so that existing lesions may be corrected and the vascular area of the mesenterj^ equal- The Practice op Osteopathy 343 ized. Ice should be given freely and an ice-pack placed over the abdo- men. Food should be restricted for ten or twelve hours. If the peris- talsis of the intestines is increased, an effort should be made to control it through the vagi and splanchnic nerves. In perforation hot applications, rest and thorough treatment of the innervation to the peritoneum are of value, but immediate operation is usually advisable. Insomnia is best reheved by attention to the cervical region. Re- laxation of the muscles in this region and a quieting treatment to the posterior occipital nerves, coupled with cold sponge baths, will usually induce sleep. In delirium attention to the circulation of the brain, by careful treatment of the vasomotor system, and the Brand method of baths will reheve this distressing symptom. During convalescence the patient should be restricted from any mental or physical exercise for a week or ten days and then should move about with care. Sohd food should not be given for ten days or two weeks. If the temperature has been normal for ten days, it is then safe to allow such food as eggs, milk puddings, and milk toast. If diarrhea should persist, being due to ulceration, the diet should be restricted and the patient confined to the bed. If constipation is troublesome relieve it by enemata. There are several beneficial effects obtained by hydrotherapeutic measures that should receive careful consideration. Probably it is of the least significance to lower the temperature ; other beneficial effects being of greater importance. When the baths are systematically car- ried out, (1) there is obtained a general improvement of the nervous system, the mind is rendered clear, muscular twitchings are lessened, sleep is induced and the heart's action strengthened; (2) the respiration is stimulated, thus diminishing the liabiUty of lung compncations;(3) the activity of the renal function is increased, consequently allowing more rapid elimination of toxic matter; (4) reduction of the temperature, and overcoming ill effects of high fever. A cold water bath, or what is generally termed the Brand method, is commonly employed. The following plan is usually followed. When the temperature is above 102.5 degrees F., rectally, a bath of 70 degrees F. is wheeled to the patient's bedside and he is placed into it for ten or fifteen minutes. The patient should be lowered into the bath by means of a sheet. Enough water is used to cover the bodj^ and neck of the patient. The head is sponged and the limbs and trunk are rubbed thor- 344 The Practice of Osteopathy oughly dining the entire procedure. When the patient is taken out he is wrapped in a dry sheet and covered with a blanket. This procedure is gone through with every three hours if the case is severe, otherwise once every seven or eight hours will be sufficient. The luke-warm bath is occasionally used in private practice when one is unable to use the Brand method. A bath of 90 degrees F. is em- ployed, which is gradually cooled ten or twelve degrees, after the patient has been placed in it, by pouring cold water on the patient. This bath is found very helpful. Also in private practice the cold pack is found satisfactory. The patient is wrapped in a sheet wrung out of water at 65 degrees F. and cold water is sprinkled over him. Whenever there is objection to any of these methods the body may be sponged off with tepid or cold water when the temperature rises above 102.5 degrees F., rectally. One Hmb should be taken at a time and then the trunk, occu- pjdng altogether some twenty or thirty minutes. The Great War brought the subject of typhoid vaccination before the world with emphasis but its results are not, as yet, in shape so an unbiased opinion can be formed. The army medical department will tell us that it was an unquahfied success but we do know that there were serious outbreaks among inoculated troops who were hving under most hygienic surroundings in America. There were, also, outbreaks among protected troops in France to the extent that the medical authorities felt called upon to warn all medical officers that vaccination should not be considered as protecting against unsanitary surroundings and that great precaution must be observed, the same as under non-vaccination condi- tions. This does not imply imphcit confidence. It is, also, a historical fact that the Japanese arm}', during the Russo- Japanese war had as low a rate of typhoid without vaccination as can, probably, be shown with it in this war. At that time they depended en- tirely upon pure water and sanitation. See reports of typhoid fever in A. O. A. Case Eeports as follows: C. M. T. Hulett, Series I, p. 7, J. H. Wilson, Series III, p. 3, F. E. and H. P. Moore, and F. A. and E. S. Cave, Series IV, pp. 4 and 5. In paratyphoid fever, an acute infectious disease caused by the paratyphoid bacilhis, the treatment is the same as for typhoid fever. It is milder and similar to typhoid fever. Typhus Fever Definition. — An acute, infectious disease; characterized by sud- den invasion, high fever, marked nervous symptoms, a pecuhar macu- The Practice of Osteopathy 345 lated and petechial eruption and a termination by crisis about the four- teenth day. Etiology and Pathology. — Typhus fever is becoming less fre- quent than formerly and is rarely seen in this country. It was very destructive during the Great War, particularly in the Balkan states. Filth, over-crowding, famine, intemperance and bad food are the pre- disposing causes. Typhus fever is highly contagious and is transmitted by the pediculus corporis (cootie) as was first discovered by the American Red Cross workers in Serbia. Probably infection may come by contact and fomites. The specific organism is the bacillus typhi exanthematici (Platz). Pathologically, there are no constant lesions. There is a general hyperplasia of the lymph follicles, but no ulceration. The blood is dark, thin and lessened in fibrin. Hypostatic congestion of the lungs and bronchial catarrh are frequently met with. The hver, kidneys and spleen are found to be somewhat enlarged and softened. The petechial rash remains after death. Symptoms. — The incubation period is about twelve days. The onset is usually sudden, ushered in by chills. The temperature quickly rises to 104 or 105 degrees F. There is headache, pains in the muscles, especially of the back, and early, profound prostration. The pulse is at first full and strong, 100 to 140, but soon becomes weak and frequent. There may be distressing vomiting. The face is flushed, the eyes in- jected, the expression stupid, and there is generally low, muttering de- lirium. The tongue is furred and white, soon becoming dry. The bow- els are constipated and the urine is usually scanty and of high specific gravity. There is great thirst. Conjunctiva injected; pupils con- tracted ; early prostration. The eruption appears about the fifth or seventh day. It first makes its appearance upon the abdomen and chest. It rapidly extends all over the body with the exception of the face. The eruption is of two kinds — rose spots, which disappear upon pressure, and those which be- come hemorrhagic (petechial) ; pressure has no effect upon them. Dur- ing the second week the symptoms are increased. The tongue is dry, brown and fissured, and sordes appear on the teeth. Retention of the urine, due to paralysis of the bladder, is common. The breathing becomes more rapid and the heart's action more feeble; the patient may die from exhaustion. This ushers in the typhoid state with low, muttering de- lirium, ataxic symptoms, subsultus, tremors, and maybe bronchial symptms. In favorable cases the crisis occurs at the end of the second week. Patient sinks into a sound sleep, the temperature falls rapidly, 346 The Practice of Osteopathy there is profuse sweating and a critical diarrhea but the patient now gains rapidly. Convalescence is usually rapid; relapses rarely occur. The urine is scanty, high colored and frequently albuminous. Bed sores are com- mon. The temperature continues high, reaching 106 degrees F., or more, with slight nocturnal remissions. In fatal cases the fever often rises to 108 or 109 degrees F. just before death. Diagnosis. — The sudden onset, frequent chills, early profound prostration, character of the rash, historj'- of exposure to the poison and unhygienic surroundings decide the diagnosis. During an epidemic there is usually no doubt, but in sporadic cases the diagnosis is some- times extremely difficult. Prognosis. — This is usually grave, but the mortaUty rate is being greatly reduced in consequence of the better sanitary arrangements. Treatment. — Typhus fever is highly contagious and great care should be taken in controlling the disease. Isolation, disinfection and extermination is imperative. So far as known none of the osteopaths have had experience in the treating of typhus fever osteopathically, but there is no reason why the disease should not be treated with the same success as is met with by osteopathic treatment in other diseases. It is claimed that the disease should be treated in the open air, in tents, as the recovery of the patient and the safety of the attendants are greatly favored. For high temperature, besides the treatment given to remove any disorder that may be found, the general fever treatment is indicated, and hydrotherapy would also be of aid — sponging the surface of the body, or the use of the bath. Asthenia is wherein the greatest danger Hes, and a stimulating treatment along the spine and to the heart should be given ; although correction of the primary trouble may be sufl&cient. Hj'dro- therapeutic measures, the systematic use of the cold bath, would be of service the same as in typhoid fever. Headache and dehrium which are apt to arise, caused by too much blood in the head, may be relieved by treatment of the cervical spine. Also cold applied to the head will aid. Th'e bowels should be watched carefully; treat the splanchnics thoroughly and the intestines and hver directly. Nourish the patient as in typhoid fever by nutritious hquids — milk, broths, etc. Although typhus is now a comparatively rare disease, an outHne has been given to emphasize what correction of unhygienic conditions and insanitary surroundings will accomphsh. It is particularly a dis- ease of filth. The Practice of Osteopathy 347 Malarial Fever (Ague) Definition. — An infectious disease caused by the hemocytozoon of Laveran. "It is characterized by paroxysms of intermittent fever of the quotidian, tertian or quartan type, a continued fever with marked re- missions, a pernicious or rapidly fatal form, and a chronic cachexia with anemia and enlarged spleen." (Halbert). The varieties of malarial fever are: intermittent fever; pernicious intermittent; remittent fever; malarial cachexia; masked intermittent; malarial hematuria. Osteopathic Etiology and Pathology. — Malarial fevers are caused by a parasite known as the hematozoon of Laveran. Three varieties of the parasite have been separated, corresponding with the three leading forms of the affection. The parasite of tertian fever is about as large as a normal red blood corpuscle, beginning as a small hyahne ameba in the red blood corpuscles. The parasite of quartan fever is very similar in its appearance to the tertian parasite but smaller; its ameboid move- ments are slower and the red blood-corpuscle embracing it shrinks about the parasite, assuming a deeper greenish color. The parasite of the es- tivo-autumnal fevers is still smaller. "If only one group of parasites exists the paroxysms— quartan intermittent — will occur every fourth day. Double quartan infection will result in paroxysms on two suc- cessive days with an intermission of one day. Infection by three groups of parasites will create daily paroxysms — the quotidian intermittent. Infection by more than three groups is rare." (Anders). Only in the earlier stages of development, small hyahne bodies are to be found in the peripheral circulation; being, in the later stages, in the blood of cer- tain internal viscera, spleen, and bone marrow, particularly. It is an accepted fact among medical observers that to the mos- quito, anopheles, is due the spread of malaria and it has been the sub- ject of much investigation in all parts of the world. The mosquito be- comes infected from biting an individual whose blood contains the malar- ial parasite, this is then developed in the mosquito to maturity and later is transmitted to the next subject bitten. This explanation would show why certain locahties favorable for the breeding of mosquitoes are par- ticularly given to malarial outbreaks. Low, marshy grounds, banks of rivers, small ponds, etc., as well as warm weather, are needed to produce the conditions for the development of the anop heles As the country has developed the intensity and extent of malaria has diminished until it is now confined largely to the southern states. It is practically un- 348 The Practice of Osteopathy known in the northwest and in the St. Lawrence basin. Regions which have never had cases, however, have developed them when the anox)heles has appeared. Whiting notes cases in Southern Cahfornia, the result of the insect being brought in by ships from Mexican or Central Amer- ican ports. In certain regions the anopheles is present but has not ap- parently come in contact with a malarial victim, so is incapable of spread- ing the disease. Also in colder climates this species is harmless. By draining the lands and preventing the breeding places, the num- ber of the pests is reduced, while the screening of houses and care against exposure to the bites make it possible to Hve in malarial sections and not become infected. Naturally the resisting power of a patient is called into account when bitten by the mosquito. Where it is epidemic the inhabitants will be found, generally, poorly nourished or debilitated from climatic or other conditions. This renders infection easy, for immunity must come from the ability of the blood to combat the invading parasite. The osteopathic predisposing causes for malaria are usually interference with the vasomotor nerves to the spleen and liver, as these two organs are so concerned in maintaining the stability of the blood tissue. Ligon, of Alabama, notes that most cases have lesions between the ninth and twelfth dorsal on the right side. The chief morbid changes are due to the direct effect of the ma- larial parasite upon the blood. There are also changes in the liver, kid- neys, and spleen, which changes usually vary with the duration and in- tensity of the disease. The disintegration of the red blood-corpuscles, accumulation of the pigment thus formed, and the toxin engendered by the malarial parasite are responsible for the morbid lesions of the dis- ease. In pernicious malaria the blood is more or less hydremic, and the discs are seen in all stages of destruction. The spleen is enlarged and soft and the pulp dark from the accumulation of the pigment, and spontan- eous rupture has occurred in a numl^er of cases. The Hver is swollen and turbid; pigmentation occurs, but is generally only visible by means of the microscope. By the aid of the microscope all the tissues of the body, even the brain, may be found to be pigmented. The spleen in chronic malaria is greatly enlarged, firm, pigmented and the capsule thickened. The liver is enlarged, the color varying from a slight gray to a deep slate gray, according to the amount of pig- ment. The kidneys may be enlarged and deeply pigmented, as is also the mucous membrane of the stomach and intestines. The Practice of Osteopathy 349 R, W. Connor observes that the kidneys and liver are most notice- ably involved, vasomotor obstructions the rule, the spleen in the majority of cases shows engorgement and that special attention to these centers will give the best results. He invariably finds spinal lesions from the seventh dorsal to the first and second lumbar, most frequently the eighth, ninth and tenth dorsals. A lowered vitality predisposes to infection from the bite of the mosquito. Symptoms. — Intermittent Fever. — This form is what is known as fever and ague, in which chills, fever and sweat follow each other. The period of incubation varies from six to fifteen days, but it may be months after exposure before the first paroxysms set in. The paroxysm is usually preceded by a feeling of uneasiness and discomfort, sometimes by nausea or headache. The paroxysm consists of three stages, cold, heat and sweating. In the cold stage the chill usually begins gradually; it is generally intense, the teeth chatter and the body shakes violently. The skin is cool and pale, the lips are blue, the face is pinched and the patient looks very cold. During the chill the temperature rises rapidly. Nausea, vomiting and headache are common. The pulse is frequent, small and hard. The urine is increased in quantity and of low specific gravity. The chill lasts from a few minutes to a couple of hours. The hot stage succeeds the chill. The skin gradually loses its coldness and becomes hot. The face is flushed, there is great thirst, the mouth is dry, and the tongue is coated. Usually at the termination of the chill the temperature has reached its maximum level, from 104 to 106 degrees F. The pulse is full, and there may be a throbbing headache. The duration of this stage is from half an hour to three or four hours. During the sweating stage drops of perspiration appear upon the face; the perspiration soon becomes profuse, extending all over the body. The temperature soon falls, the headache disappears and in a couple of hours the paroxysm is over. The entire duration of the paroxysm is from eight to twelve hours; the patient usually feehng perfectly well between the paroxysms. The spleen is enlarged. If the paroxysms of fever occur daily at the same hour they are called quotidian intermittent fever; if every other day they are known as tertian intermittent; and if every third day they are called quartan intermittent. If there are two parosyxms in the same day the term double quotidian is used; if the paroxysms occur a couple of hours later each successive day they are called "retarding;" if a couple of hours earlier they are named "anticipating." 350 The Practice of Osteopathy Remittent Fever. — (Estivo-Autumnal Fever). — This is charac- terized by a continued fever with parox3^smal exacerbations and re- missions. It occurs especially in warm and tropical climates. In tem- perate climates it usually occurs in the late summer and fall. It is also termed bilious remittent fever on account of the intensity of the gastro- intestinal manifestation. The estivo-autumnal parasite is the exciting cause. It is very often preceded by malaise, headache, nausea and vomit- ing. The onset is usually gradual and the chill may be wholly absent. As a rule, however, a chill generally occurs at the onset, but it is less severe than that of intermittent fever. After the chill the temperature rises rapidly to 102 or 104 degrees F. or even higher. The pulse is full, rising to 100 or 120. There is violent headache, flushed face, pains in the Umbs and loins, nausea and vomiting, and dehrium when the temper- ature is very high. The urine is scanty or even suppressed, slightly albuminous, sometimes bloody, high colored, and deposits a sediment of urates. Jaundice is not infrequent; the spleen is enlarged and herpes labialis is quite common. After six to twenty-four hours the symptoms abate and slight sweating occurs. The temperature usually drops to 100 degrees F., the headache disappears and vomiting ceases; this is fol- lowed bj^ a new exacerbation of fever at the end of about twelve hours, generally without the chill; and this hot stage is in turn again followed bj^ the remission. These attacks may last three or four weeks. Pernicious Malarial Fever.— This is rare in temperate cUmates and is always associated with the estivo-autumnal parasite. The prin- cipal types are the cerebral and algid. The cerebral type usually begins with a severe chill; sometimes, however, the chill is absent. The patient is violently seized with grave cerebral symptoms, as acute delirium or sudden coma. The coma- tose condition lasts from twelve to twenty-four hours when consciou- ness usually returns, the primary paroxysm rarely proving fatal; it is, however, often followed in a short time by fatal relapse. The Algid variety is characterized by intense prostration and ex- treme coolness of the surface with the internal temperature high. The gastric symptoms are extreme nausea and vomiting. The pulse is feeble ; the breathing frequent and shallow. There is intense thirst. The voice is feeble and indistinct. The mind is clear. The urine is suppressed. In this type the parasites gain entrance to the gastro-intestinal mucosa, sometimes forming distinct thromboses of the smaller vessels. This form may be confused with yellow fever. The Practice of Osteopathy 351 Malarial Cachexia. — This is a chronic condition which often occurs in cases that have not been properly treated or in persons that hve in malarial districts and are constantly exposed to the infection. The two most striking symptoms of this condition are anemia and an enlarged spleen or "ague cake." There is fever at intervals, but chills rarely occur. The skin is of a dirty yellow color. The spleen is greatly enlarged and the blood is profoundly anemic. There is debihty, and frequent sweating, and the hands and feet are cold. The digestion may be deranged and there may be sUght jaundice. Sometimes there is edema of the feet and even dropsy occurs. Hemorrhages of the various mucous surfaces are common. Paraplegia and orchitis are rare symptoms. These cases usually do well under proper treatment, and if the patient can be moved from the malarial district. Masked Intermittent. — Malarial neuralgia most frequently in- volves the supraorbital branch of the trigeminus; also the occipital, the intercostals, sciatic and brachial nerves may be affected. Such forms of malaria are called "masked malaria." In this form there is no fever and as a rule it is very hard to diagnose. A blood analysis should be made to confirm the diagnosis. In some cases one or more stages in the paroxysm of intermittent fever is omitted; this is especially true with the chiU, in which case it is termed "dumb ague. " Malarial cachexia is also sometimes called "dumb ague" and both are found among the older in- habitants of malarial districts. Persons living in malarial districts are sometimes affected with constipation, headache, loss of appetite, nausea, vomiting and a languid feeUng; this is called "latent intermittent fever." Frequently "bihous attacks" are of a malarial origin. Malarial Hematuria. — Hemorrhages may occur from the mucous membrane in all severe and persistent types of malarial infection. It is a frequent symptom of the pernicious variety. The parasites destroy the red blood corpuscles; this is the cause of the hemoglobinuria. Pros- tration and anemia are marked. In blackwater fever, a tropical dis- order, acute hemolysis, is the cause of the hemoglobinuria. Diagnosis. — This is usually easy. The characteristic stages of the paroxysms, the periodicity, residence in malarial districts and the alter- ations in the blood will usually remove every doubt as to the diagnosis. Typhoid Fever may simulate malarial fever, but a careful analysis of symptoms and blood examination will differentiate. Prognosis. — This is almost always favorable under early and per- sistent treatment. The unfavorable symptoms are uremia, hemorrhage and marked jaundice. 352 The Practice of Osteopathy Treatment. — Attention should first be given to prophylactic measures. Environment, isolation of the patient, and destruction of the mosquito are important considerations. Cases of malarial fever present distinct lesions in the vertebrae and ribs corresponding to the vasomotor nerve supply of the spleen and liver. The most common lesion found is a marked lateral deviation between the ninth and tenth dorsal vertebrae and a consequent downward displacement of the tenth ribs. A disturbance will always be found in the region of the eighth to the eleventh dorsal vertebra, inclusive, or in the corresponding ribs on either side. These lesions undoubtedly derange the vasomotor nerves to the spleen and liver; thus permitting a weakness or lowered resistance of the system, especially of the blood. The blood resisting powers are lessened, probably on account of the spleen being affected, as it is an elab- orating gland of the blood; and the liver's action is somewhat dependent upon the action of the spleen; besides, the Uver is a secretory and excre- tory organ. The principal osteopathic treatment given in cases of malarial fever is correction of these subdislocations, and thorough treatment to the hver and spleen directly. Ligon observes that when the case does not respond quickty to treatment it is very Hable to be of considerable duration, although in the majority of cases the disease is controlled from the third to seventh day; the most constant lesions found are from the eighth to tenth dorsal and also the fourth lumbar. During the chilly stage thorough treatment of the vasomotor nerves in the upper cervical, the upper dorsal, the lower dorsal and the lumbar regions is indicated; tliis treatment is given to equalize the vascular sys- tem. During the hot stage the same treatment as in the chilly stage should be given to control the vascular system; besides a thorough treat- ment of the spleen and liver is necessary. Sponging the body with water will be of some aid in reducing the temperature. During the sweat stage thorough inhibition at the superior cervical gangUon to control the sweat center of the medulla, and treatment at the upper dorsal and first lumbar to control auxiHary sweat centers are in- dicated. The bowels should be kept active. When in a comatose form and when internal temperature is high, place the patient in a bath. In chron- ic cases, change of climate with thorough systematic treatment will usually result in recovery. The Practice of Osteopathy 353 Tete\ of Louisiana, makes the following interesting statement: ''A specific osteopathic treatment given within an hour before the expected chill is a specific cure for malaria." He follows this up by treating on the third, fifth, seventh, fourteenth, and twenty-first days, on account of the tendency of the return of an attack on those days. His observa- tion of the value of treatment just before the attack is borne out by a report by Teall^ where the case was cured in one treatment, but the lesion was as high as the fourth dorsal. N. Chapman confirms this as being her experience in many cases. The spleen has been observed by Bandel to become engorged and upon emptying there would follow a rise of temperature of one fourth to half a degree. This has also been spoken of by Tucker as the ''splenic wave." Ligon makes the state- ment that where the osteopathic lesion (the predisposing cause) has been of long standing prior to the attack, and as a consequence hard to correct, it is difficult to shorten the malarial attack. This would emphasize the point that the essential treatment must be a thoroughly readjustive one, and that stimulatory and inhibitory work can only palliate. This is borne out by several practitioners who have had considerable experience. Very satisfactory results follow adjustment of the seventh to tenth dorsals. Quinine has been accepted by medical authorities as a specific for malaria. It is supposed to act directly upon the intracorpuscular hema- tozoa. That it is not infalHble is shown by the numerous cases which come to the osteopath, suffering from both the disease and the quinine. And even drug authorities state that other treatment is also required. It has remained for Dr. Still to demonstrate that excellent results follow osteopathic treatment in malaria. Frequently a single treatment has been sufficient to free and regulate the body fluids and forces so that the parasite was rendered inert, and this treatment was directed chiefly to the fourth and twelfth dorsals. Whereas the osteopath recog- nizes and appreciates the importance of micro-organisms as exciting and determining factors in many diseases, still he values them as secondary factors only and relies primarily upon removing the predisposing and true etiologic factors, so that nature's forces may not be obstructed and thus predominate. Osteopathic etiology and pathology has shown so conclusively, in a large number of cases, that the existence of micro- organisms is dependent upon devitalized tissue, whether the tissue is a local one or a circulating one, as the blood; and just so soon as the ana- 1. Journal of Osteopathy— Prize Article July, 1906. 2. A. O. A. Case Reports— Series I. 354 The Practice of Osteopathy tomical is adjusted the physiological will function and antitoxic and antimicrobic substances are secreted. "When the patient has the quartan parasite, as soon as the tempera- ture begins to fall I give him from two to six ounces of red meat juice, extracted from rare beefsteak, sometimes as much as five pounds in the first twenty-four hours following the chill. In almost all cases of quar- tan malaria the blood is built up sufficient!}^ by the time they reach the second cycle to pass without the paroxysm, or chill. By the time for the third cycle, which is the seventh day, I always have built up the pa- tient's resistance so as to enable him to pass by this cycle without any symptoms of malaria whatever. In cases of double or triple I find the same treatment causes about the same results. I do not give any other diet, except dry toast if they eat the beef instead of taking the juice. If they can take the steak I prefer their taking it, but almost all cases prefer the juice. * * * The treatment for the tertian type of malaria is practically the same as the treatment for the quartan. "The estivo-autumnal type of malaria differs from the quartan and tertian types; first, in that the paroxysms are, as a rule, much more irregular; second, they are much longer in duration; third, the chiUs are more frequently absent; fourth, the fever is often irregular, intermit- tent, remittent, or continuous in character. This type very often takes the form of blackwater or hemoglobinuric type with hemorrhagic sjmip- toms, with hemorrhage from nose, gums, and bowels. The first thing to do in a case of hemorrhagic malaria is to put an ice bag on the abdomen, which will tend to control the hemorrhage from the kidneys. Give the patient all the red beef juice you can get him to take, provided he has not developed a very sick stomach; if so, give him high sahne enemas and in one-half hoiu- give him four ounces red beef juice per rectum. Re- peat the feeding per rectum in four hom'S. As soon as he can retain anything on stomach give him aU the juice he can take comfortably. Treat the Hver thoroughly — at least three times in the first twenty-four hours. At the end of thirty-six hours the yellow cast will be very much fighter, which is a sure sign that the patient is getting better. Watch the urine closely. The third day there may occur a suppression. If so, give strong stimulation to the renal plexus through the abdomen, and be sure there is a thorough relaxation of the dorsal and lumbar muscles. "It is an estabhshed fact that people in the malarial districts eat very fittle beef. I find that ninety-nine per cent of the cases of malaria never eat it, or when they on rare occasion do, it has been so overcooked that all the blood-building substances have been destroyed. The beef The Practice of Osteopathy 355 raw would be better in my opinion; although, the possible chance of getting a tapeworm or animal parasite is so considerable that I would advise that the beef should be heated to 250 degrees." — E. C. Arm- strong, Clinical Osteopathy. Septicemia This term is applied to any toxic condition caused by the invasion of the blood by pathogenic micro-organisms, with or without any visible site of infection . Etiologically, the micrococci, streptococci, pneumococci, or staph- ylococci, as to frequency, in order named, are the cause. The infection is usually introduced by a wound, of any degree of severity. The uterus is a frequent seat following miscarriage, parturition or operation. The virus may be absorbed by the mucous membrane. It may also arise from infection of the deeper tissues. Pathologically, the changes are not marked, but consist in brownish color of the muscles, ecchymotic spots in the pia mater and dark appearance of the blood, which is also less coagulable. Spleen, Hver and lymphatics are enlarged with some changes in the other organs. Symptoms. — The incubation period is from four to six days and the onset is gradual, though often announced by a distinctive chill, fol- lowed by a profuse sweat. The most common type is the continuous form of fever, which may, in morning remissions, become subnormal. Pulse is rapid at the beginning, but as cardiac failure comes on, it be- comes weaker. In the earlier stages there may be vomiting with diarrhea later. There are punctiform hemorrhages of the skin and possibly other eruptions. Blood examination will settle any doubt as to diagnosis. Prognosis is good in large percent of cases and depends upon the general health of the patient. Treatment. — "Incise and drain the infected part; if possible, apply hot boracic acid compresses or keep part suspended in hot boracic acid solution. Osteopathic treatment will aid materially in stimulating and strengthening the patient. Bowels, kidnej^s and skin must be kept active. Normal salt solution, hypodermically or per rectum is of value. Diet should be liquid, fruit juices, broths, soups until temperature has remained normal twenty-four hours then milk, eggs etc., in gradually in- creasing amounts until general diet is restored. Amputation of the part may be necessary. " — L. E. Browne. 356 The Practice of Osteopathy Pyemia A febrile disease arising from an invasion of the blood by pathogenic bacteria, wherein sepsis and multiple abscesses occur from absorption and metastasis. Etiologically, the cause may be traced to various specific organisms which enter the blood stream and produce thrombophlebitis. From these points and from other bacteria, new foci are estabhshed. Oc- casionally the lymphatics carry the germs. The disease maj^ also start from ulcerative endocarditis or when the appendix is infected. Pathologically, thrombosis of the vein may take place in any region. Abscesses may form in the lungs, Hver, spleen or other internal organs. The small abscesses may unite and form a large one. The skin presents eruptions and hemorrhagic extravasations, while there may be ulcers of the mucous membrane, also the serous surfaces may be purulently inflamed. The muscles, subcutaneous and osseous tissue occasionally have abscesses. Ulcerative and suppurative heart lesions occur. Symptoms. — The incubation period is short. There may be slight fever, but commonly a chill is the first symptom, which may re- occur for some time. The fever is either remittent or intermittent and when the temperature is low, sweating is a feature. The pulse becomes rapid and weak, when the disease is severe; breathing becomes difficult. Skin symptoms, such as eruptions and pustules, generally occur. In a word, there is a general intoxication. There is a lessened number of red blood corpuscles and leucocytosis is a characteristic. In grave cases, delirium and coma are present. Diagnosis.^The history of the case and symptoms will usually render diagnosis easy, although care is necessary to determine from septicemia. Malaria, typhoid and acute tuberculosis must be excluded. Prognosis. — Much depends on asepsis and surgery but on the whole it is unfavorable. Treatment. — Surgical interference and treatment as outhned under septicemia is the only hope. Dengue (Breakbone Fever) Definition. — An acute infectious disease; characterized by a double febrile paroxysm, severe pains in the muscles and joints and sometimes a skin eruption. The Practice of Osteopathy 357 Etiology. — It is a disease of tropical and subtropical regions. Un- hygienic conditions predispose to an attack. During an epidemic a single attack is the rule. The disease spreads from place to place along the lines of travel, attacking both sexes, and all ages. It occurs in epi- demics, practically affecting every one. The specific germ has never been isolated as it is probably ultra-microscopic but there is no doubt but that it is carried by the mosquito Culex fatigans. Symptoms.— The incubation period lasts about four days. The onset is abrupt with a slight chill, headache, and extreme pain in the joints and muscles, of a boring or breaking character. The joints be- come red, swollen and painful. The fever rises gradually to 103 or 106 degrees F., or over. The pulse is rapid and full and the respirations are much quickened. The face is flushed, the tongue coated, the appetite is lost, and slight nausea occurs. "Black vomit," similar to that of yellow fever, has been observed in this disease. Hemorrhages from various organs may occur and the IjTiiphatic glands are swollen. The urine is scanty and the bowels constipated. Febrile albuminuria and delirium are rare. At the end of three or four days the temperature falls and there is a period of remission; the patient is free from pain, but profoundly prostrated. During this time the eruption generally appears, but is never constant in character. After a remission of two or three days, the symptoms reappear and a second febrile paroxysm sets in. This is usually milder and shorter than the first, lasting two or three days, when convalescence begins. The duration is, according to medical writers, from seven to ten days, and convalescence slow. Death seldom occurs, so practically no pathological changes have been recorded. By osteo- pathic treatment, E. B. Ligon has been able to confine the attack to four or five days duration; this is confirmed by the experience of N. Chap- man. Diagnosis. — During an epidemic the disease attacks all classes alike, and the distinct remission renders the diagnosis comparatively easy. An occasional case might be mistaken for acute rheumatism, but the absence of any glandular swelling or eruption, while the pain is more closely limited to the joints, will aid in the diagnosis. Care has to be taken that yellow fever is not mistaken for dengue. Treatment. — The indications of the treatment arc to maintain the patient's strength and to treat the leading symptoms as they arise. The s(!verity of an attack can probably be lessened at the start by strong and thorough treatment of the sub-occipital, upper dorsal, lower dorsal 358 The Practice of Osteopathy and lower lumbar regions, respectively, so as to control the large vascular areas by means of the vasomotor nerves of the cranial region, of the lungs, of the splanchnic region, and of the lower hmbs, thus equahzing the entire vascular sj^stem. Ehmination should be pushed and the excre- tory organs stimulated. Ligon has observed that the cervical and lum- bar regions are especiallj^ tender on the second day and the lower dorsal region on the tliird day. The most severe symptoms disappeared within a few hours after treatment and the attack was markedly shortened. The high fever may be treated by the usual methods and by the external application of cold water. The pain is to be controlled, accord- ing to the region affected, by a correction of parts impinging upon the nerve tissues and by strong inhibition. The entire spinal region should be kept constantly in a relaxed condition, as far as muscular contractions are concerned. Particularly should the treatment be extensive along the spine during prostration. N. Chapman, in addition to the osteo- pathic treatment, has the patient drink considerable hot water; also employs the hot bath. The treatment frequently shortened the attack. During the entire attack of the disease, the patient should be kept in bed and a carefull}^ regulated diet administered. Relapses are not infrequent. A suitable change of air may hasten convalescence. Cerebrospinal Meningitis Debnition. — A specific, infectious disease caused by the diplococcus intracellularis meningitidis, occurring sporadically and in epidemics. It is characterized by inflammation of the membranes of the brain and spinal cord and an irregular course. Osteopathic Etiology and Pathology. — The specific exciting cause of the cerebi-ospinal meningitis is due to the diplococcus intra- cellularis meningitidis of Weichselbaum. Lesions are found in the vertebra? corresponding to the cervical and dorsal enlargement of the cord, as well as in corresponding deep muscles; also, as is well known, the mus- cles of the entire back are severely contracted, especially of the cervical, upper and lower dorsal regions. IVIore commonly it attacks the young, although it may occur at any age. Overexertion, exposure, overcrowded and illy-ventilaied buildings, barracks and tenements, and depressing mental influences are predisposing causes. Manj^ times the disease occurs among the poorer classes. Sometimes the disease prevails in the country rather than in the city. In cases that prove speedily fatal there may be no characteristic changes; simply marked congestion. Other cases in which death occurs The Practice of Osteopathy 359 after the disease has been fully developed, there is found every degree of inflammation from slight hyperemia to suppurative changes. There can be no doubt that the osteopathic lesion, as vertebral and rib lesions and deep muscular contractions, affects the circulation of the meninges of the brain and cord and thus favors the invasion of the specific micro- organism. The arteries, veins and sinuses are greatly engorged. The walls of the ventricles soften and the ventricles contain serous exudate. The brain matter may be congested and softened in spots. In the spinal membranes similar changes take place and at times there is extravasation of blood. The changes are more marked on the posterior than the anterior surface of the cord. Abscesses sometimes form. The exudate may follow the lymph sheaths of the cranial nerves, especially the audi- tory and optic. In long standing cases the membranes become thick and adherent and areas of softening or atrophy of the cortex develop. The thickening and adhesions of the membranes may cause various symptoms for months or even years after recovery from the acute dis- order. The spleen may be normal in size, but when the fever has been intense, it is apt to be slightly enlarged. Bronchitis, pneumonia, endo- carditis and pleurisy may occur. The liver may become hyperemic and the kidneys congested. Symptoms. — The prodromes vary, although the onset is apt to be sudden with a decided chill; headache; vomiting, and pain in the neck and back, which is usually severe, but may be so slight as not to be noticed by the patient. The temperature rises to 101 to 102 degrees F., in most cases. However, it may rise to 105 degrees or 106 degrees and even to 108 degrees in fatal cases, and the pulse is full. Hyperesthesia, photo- phobia, and dread of noise are apt to be prominent symptoms. The muscles of the neck and back become rigid, and there are pains in the limbs. Orthotonos occurs more frequently than opisthotonos. Con- vulsions are common in children. There may be paralysis, especially of the muscles of the face and eyes. Delirium usually appears early; it may be mild, but it is often maniacal. The bowels are usually confined, though there may be diarrhea. There is moderate and constant leuco- cytosis and jaundice has been met with. The urine is sometimes albuminous, and sugar has been noted in rare cases. The urine may be increased, but more often it is lessened as in other infectious diseases. Herpes faciaUs occurs shortly after the onset in more than half the cases. The contents of the vesicles may be purulent and one or two may 360 The Practice of Osteopathy coalesce. The petechial eruptions are occasionally numerous and cover the entire skin; they do not disappear upon pressure and the number of spots varies greatly. Other eruptions as sudamina, ecthyma, pemphi- gus, urticaria, erysipelas, rose colored spots, and gangrene of the skin (rarely) have been met with. In cases that are rapidly fatal, the onset is sudden, usually with violent chills, headache, depression, and in a few hours coma and col- lapse, which are soon followed by a fatal termination. The tempera- ture may rise slightly, but it is often subnormal. The pulse is feeble; breathing is labored. These cases occur more frequently at the beginning of an epidemic. They occasionally occur sporadically. The abortive form terminates abruptly after the development of one or more pronounced, characteristic symptoms. The mild form can only be recognized during the prevalence of an epidemic. The symptoms are very mild; slight vomiting, little or no fever, headache and slight pain in the back and limbs. The intermittent form is characterized by increase in the fever every day or second day. The strict periodicity seen in malaria is not observed; the fever resembles that of pyemia. In the chronic form the condition may persist for weeks or months. Complications. — Pneumonia (lobar and lobular) is a frequent com- plication. Pleurisy, pericarditis, parotitis, arthritis, enteritis, optic neuritis and otitis media may be other complications. Sequelae. — Blindness, deafness, keratitis (rai'ely), persistent head- ache, chi-onic hydrocephalus, abscess of the brain, mental feebleness, defective articulation, aphasia, and paralysis of certain cranial nerves or of the lower extremities have occurred. Diagnosis. — Typhoid fever begins slowly and is unaccompanied by vomiting, muscular spasms or rigidity, or hyperesthesia. In ty-, phoid the fever is higher and there is a characteristic temperature curve. Widal's test will confirm. Tubercular meningitis is not epidemic and has no characteristic eruption. It is usually less sudden in its development and is invariably fatal. Retraction of the neck, muscular spasms of the legs and arms are not so marked as in spinal meningitis. Pneumonia may be comphcated with meningitis, especially when the meningitis is confined to the cerebrum. If the case is not seen early, it is almost impossible to say which is the primary affection, as pneumonia may have meningeal complications or cerebrospinal meningitis may be associated with pneumonia. There will be motor spasms and tremors, The Practice of Osteopathy 361 but the head is rarely retracted, and there is less myalgiac pain than in cerebrospinal meningitis. Prognosis. — This varies according to the severity of the type. It is a grave disease. Cases have been treated successfully by several osteopaths. The duration is very variable — from two or three days to weeks or even months, but probably in all cases this time can be ma- materially shortened by judicious osteopathic treatment. Convales- cence is very slow and relapses are prone to occur. Treatment. — The osteopathic treatment of cerebrospinal menin- gitis requires most thorough, but very careful, work along the spinal column, especially the cervical region and the region of the dorsal en- largement of the spinal cord, in relaxing and keeping relaxed the deep mus- cles on either side of the spine and correcting the derangements of the vertebrae, particularly in the upper cervical spine. Such treatment has a marked effect on the circulation of the spinal cord and brain. Prob- ably, a large amount of the work along the spine, in all cases where mus- cles are relaxed, has a direct effect upon the circulation of the spinal cord. This treatment constitutes the, primary osteopathic work in cerebrospinal fever and should be frequently apphed until a cure is ob- tained. Even in chronic cases where limbs have been greatly affected by pressure upon the nerve centers, due to a thickened membrane, contin- ued osteopathic treatment along the spine has had a marked effect in absorbing the pathological condition and restoring strength. The preceding spinal treatment is also a very great safeguard in keeping the various viscera healthy and thus preventing complications. In all constitutional diseases of an acute nature, it is a wise precaution to thoroughly examine the entire length of the spinal column at each visit; and if such precaution is taken many serious complications will never occur that might otherwise have taken place. The patient should be isolated in a somewhat darkened room, and care taken that the disease is not allowed to spread. Keep the patient upon his sides as much as possible. The diet should be a nutritious one of milk and broths. They should drink freely of water. Cold to the head and spine will be of service in controlling the inflammation; it should be apphed with an ice-cap and a spinal ice-bag. Sponging the bod}^ should be employed if the temperature is above 102° F. The gen- eral bath, as in typhoid fever, may be employed if practicable. Direct treatment to the bowels, kidneys, hver and spleen should be given at each treatment. Lum])ar puncture and the Flexner-Jobling serum are considered of value by those who have had an extensive experience. 362 The Practice of Osteopathy Diphtheria Definition. — An acute, infectious disease, caused by the Klebs- Loeffler bacillus, and characterized by a membranous exudation on the mucous membrane of the fauces, larynx or nose, and by constitutional s^Tuptoms. The presence of the Klebs-Loeffler bacillus distinguishes tme diphtheria from any other form of membranous inflammation. The term diphtheroid is applied to all such forms as are not due to the Klebs-Loeflier bacillus. Osteopathic Etiology and Pathology. — The exciting cause is the Klebs-Loeffler bacillus. The predisposing cause is obstruction to the circulation of the pharjaix and tonsils by sub-dislocations of upper cervical vertebrae, and even the lower cervical and upper dorsal, and severely contracted deep muscles of the neck. The stasis of blood favors the growth of the bacillus. Link^ says: "The cause of nasal, pharyngeal or laryngeal diph- theria is obstruction of the blood and lymph through the neck and the obstruction occurs as a result of lesions in the cervical region, affecting the cervical sympathetics, or lesions in the upper thoracic region whence the vasomotor fibers arise. A derangement of the veretbral articulation of the first rib is usually found. .(This affects the stellate gangUon and fibers of the sympathetic chain). These lesions cause a condition of lowered vitaUty of the mucosa of the nose and throat; the abnormal secretion favoring the rapid multiplication of the Klebs-Loeffler bacillus — the exciting cause of the disease. " Dr. Still believed that, among other lesions, contracting of tissues involving the scaleni and disturbing the relations of the first rib with the clavicle and vertebra are causative factors. The constitutional symptoms are produced by the toxins generated by the bacillus and absorbed from the diseased spots by the lymphatics and blood-vessels. The bacillus is non-motile and does not usually penetrate the mucosa, but remains very near the site of the local changes although there are in- stances where it may enter the blood and other tissues. The bacillus is very resistent and can maintain an existence for months outside of the body. There is great variation in the virulence of the Klebs-Loeffler bacillus; it has been found in healthy throats, and sometimes the bacillus may exist in the throat after an attack of diphtheria for months after all the membrane has disappeared. It has also been found in cases of simple catarrhal angina without membrane, and in simple tonsilUtis 1. E. Link, Diptheria— The Bulletin, 1905. The Practice of Osteopathy 363 Of the bacteria associated with the bacillus of diphtheria, the strepto- coccus pyogenes is the most common and probably the most active. The staphylococcus, micrococcus lanceolatus and bacillus coli communis are also found. The contagion is communicated, as a rule, through the air, by means of fomites from the membranous exudate or discharges from the diph- theritic patients, or during convalescence, from secretions of the nose and throat. Infected milk may cause the disease. Most cases occur in childhood, between the second and seventh year. The disease is most prevalent in the cold autumn and spring months. It is most fre- quently met with in temperate and cold climates. Defective drainage, catarrhal conditions of the throat, enlarged tonsils, general weakness, and feeble resisting power are predisposing factors. One attack does not confer immunity from another, but rather predisposes to a second. The false membrane is usually found on the tonsils, the pillars of the fauces and the pharynx, and in fatal cases it may be extensive and involve the uvula, the soft palate and the posterior nares, and even the trachea and bronchi. At first this membrane is yellowish white, but later may become gray; it is more or less adherent and when torn off leaves a raw surface. The diphtheritic poison coming in contact with the throat leads to, first, a necrosis or death of the epithelial cells, es- pecially the more superficial, and the leucocytes. The second change is the hyahne transformation, and simultaneously coagulation; hence the term coagulation-necrosis. The irritation produced by the bacilK causes a migration of leucocytes and these are destroyed and undergo hyahne transformation. This process proceeds from without inward and is. usually superficial, and the necrosis may be extensive, involving the deeper tissues, causing ulceration and a gangrenous condition of the parts. The erosion of the tonsils may be so severe as to attack the carotid artery. The lymphatic glands are considerably swollen. The spleen is commonly enlarged. The kidneys show parenchymatous changes. The blood is dark and fluid. Fatty degeneration of the heart is not infrequent. Sometimes fibrinous coagula are found in the heart. Capillary bronchitis, catarrhal pneumonia and areas of coUapse are almost constantly found on examination of the lungs in fatal cases. The urine is typically febrile with early albumin and often tube casts and renal epithelium. Th(! blood shows an excess of red blood cells which may reach 7,500,000. Hemoglobin is slightty reduced. There is con- siderable anemia during convalescence depending upon severity of tox- emia. 364 The Practice of Osteopathy Symptoms. — The incubation period varies from one to ten days, usually two or three days. According to the location, diphtheria may be divided into pharyngeal, laryngeal and nasal forms. In Pharyngeal Diphtheria, which is most common, there is first a slight chill or chilliness, followed by fever and sore throat, both of which increase rapidly. The throat is swollen and red and the patient complains of difficult swallowing. The membrane begins on the tonsils in the form of grayish- white patches; it then spreads from the tonsils to the soft palate, sometimes covering the uvula. The cervical glands are swollen and tender. The neck muscles are contracted and somewhat difficult to relax. The temperature rises to 102 or 104 degrees F. The pulse is rapid and feeble, ranging from 120 to 140. There is loss of appetite. There is more or less prostration depending upon the gravity of the con- stitutional symptoms. The average duration is from one to two weeks. Laryngeal Diphtheria (Membranous Croup) may be secondary to extension from the fauces or it may be primary. At first there is slight hoarseness and a harsh, metallic, ringing cough. These symptoms may persist for a day or two, when the child suddenly becomes worse; there is marked dyspnea and the hps and finger tips become fivid. The child soon becomes very restless. The temperature may be sfightly above normal and the pulse increased in frequency. In favorable cases the dyspnea is not very marked and the child probably will have only one or two paroxysms, when it will fall asleep and wake in the morning feeling very comfortable. The next night, however, the attack may be more pronounced. In extreme cases death may result from suffocation. In some cases the suffocation is slower and results from extension of the membrane downward into the bronchi. Dr. Still found same conditions as in diphtheria, but also the hyoid is involved with the superior laryn- geal nerve. The sacral and lumbar nerves are also involved. He always emphasized chilHng of gluteal region as a cause for croup and that heat should be applied at the inception of the disease. Nasal Diphtheria is generally secondary, but it may be a primary affection. In many cases no membrane is found; in others there may be a pseudo-membrane formed in the nose, but there is absence of any sys- temic disturbance. The Klebs-Loeffler bacillus is sometimes present in these membranes. Nasal diphtheria may be a very grave disease — the constitutional symptoms being great prostration, high fever, marked glandular swelling, irritating and offensive discharges from the nose, and epistaxis. Inflammation occasionally extends through the tear duct to the conjunctiva. The Peactice of Osteopathy 365 A diphtheritic membrane may grow where the skin has been cut or bruised, but the bacillus cannot live on normal skin. It flourishes on a raw, moist surface and membranes have grown on the lips, tongue, vulva, glans penis, and on ulcerative surfaces and wounds. Diphtheria occurs occasionally in the conjunctiva and the external auditory meatus. It should be remembered that there are many atypical forms of diph- theria. Bacteriological examination should always be made in suspicious and puzzling cases. The complications of diphtheria are nephritis, hemorrhages, rashes, capillary bronchitis, pulmonary collapse, catarrhal pneumonia, myo- carditis, arthritis, otitis media, and paralysis. Diagnosis. — The presence of the Klebs-Loeffler bacillus will at once decide the diagnosis of diphtheria. Prognosis. — The prognosis should always be guarded. The nasal and laryngeal forms are always grave. The causes of death are involve- ment of the larynx, septic infection, heart failure, bronchopneumonia during convalescence, and rarely, uremia. Treatment.— Hygienic and prophylactic measures are important. A room should be selected that is ventilated and exposed to the sun- light. All unnecessary articles of furniture should be removed. Great care must be taken against the spread of the disease. Always isolate the patient and disinfect everything that has come in contact with him. The greatest danger Hes in the spread of the disease during convalescence and in the ambulatory form, when patients are about and coming in contact with individuals, especially children with catarrhal conditions of the nose and throat. The physician should be careful about disin- fecting himself. In view of the fact that many osteopaths have treated successully numerous cases of diphtheria and that the osteopathic treatment is peculiarly indicated and effective, the probable requirement of anti- toxin (the use of which we do not feel called upon to discuss) would be. lessened. Relative to the antitoxin Osier says: "The principle of ac- tion depends on the circumstance that the blood-serum of an animal rendered immune, when introduced into another animal, protects it from infection with the diphtheria bacilH, and has also an important curative influence upon diphtheria, whether artificially given to animals, or spon- taneously acquhed by man." "The treatment of diphtheria by osteopathic methods is often a pleasure rather than a trial because of the success which rewards us for our efforts. There has been considerable discussion by the members oi 366 The Practice of Osteopathy our profession regarding the methods to be employed in successful!}^ overcoming this disease, and many have expressed the view that since antitoxic serum is a physiological remedy, which naturally belongs to all schools of heahng, it should be employed by the osteopathic physician in cases of diphtheria. I have no objections to the use of the serum ther- apy by members of the profession who conscientiously feel that they need it in their practice to secure the highest success. However, I feel, on the other hand, that if they were well acquainted with the technique of the methods * * * they would not feel it to their advantage, from the standpoint of success, to use injections in a single case." — R. D. Emery, CHnical Osteopathy. The local treatment should be carefully, but vigorously, given. By proper treatment of the throat the extension of the disease may be prevented. The muscles about the thi'oat, especially the deep ones, should be thoroughly relaxed and the cervical vertebra) corrected if dis- placed. The vasomotor nerves to the blood vessels of the affected region require careful treatment at the superior cervical ganghon, and the cer- vical lymphatics from the atlas to the first rib should be closely watched. The nerves to control are the vagi, glosso-pharyngeal, spinal accessory, and sympathetic nerves to the pharyngeal plexus, and in cases of nasal diphtheria the fifth nerve has to be carefully treated. An external treat- ment to the pharynx will have the greatest effect on these nerves. An in- ternal treatment to the nerves of the soft palate will be of considerable service. The parts diseased should be disinfected and kept as clean as possible. Bichloride of mercury (1:4000) used as a spray will be found satisfactory, although there are several other disinfectants and germicides that may be used. Pellets of ice in the mouth will be a comfort to the patient. Cold appKed externally will be found best for the adult; heat externally is better for the child. Every possible means should be used to prevent the disease from spreading. One of the chief dangers of diphtheria is the spread of the disease to the larynx, trachea and bronchi. When the disease has ex- tended to these parts it presents all the sjrmptoms of true croup. The deep cervical muscles should be thoroughly relaxed to aid in reHeving the passive hyperemia and with a view of disorganizing the exudate. Attention should be given to the upper ribs, as interferences with the vasomot^or nerves of the mucous membrane of the trachea and bronchial tubes usually occur. Direct treatment over the larynx and local treat- ment through the mouth upon the soft palate will be of aid. A thor- ough relaxation of all the dorsal muscles, even as low as the tenth dor- The Practice of Osteopathy 367 sal, should be given. Inhalations of slaked, freshly burnt Kme may be useful in loosening the exudation. In desperate cases tracheotomy or intubation of the larjmx should be performed. Willard^ says, relative to membranous croup: ''It matters not whether or not the laryngeal inflammation was immediately caused by a germ; it would not, nor could not, have been produced by such had there not been an unnatural con- dition of the circulation of and about the larynx. " A constitutional treatment should always be given with a view of preventing the spread of the disease from one organ to another and to prevent complications. The heart's action should be carefully watched throughout the entire course of the disease. Treatment of the spinal cord will guard against paralysis that sometimes follows the venous hyperemia of the vascular Hnings and substance of the brain and spinal cord. Pay particular attention to the upper dorsal region to prevent possible heart involvement. Post-diphtheritic paralysis seldom if ever occurs in cases that are treated osteopathically. This is a common sequela and is present in from 10 percent to 30 per cent of cases, appear- ing within three weeks of apparent recovery. Sometimes it is the only result to show diphtheria was present. It seems to follow use of anti- toxin rather frequently. Attention to the splanchnics and to the ab- domen directly will tend to keep the stomach, hver, kidneys, and intes- tines in a healthy state. The diet of the patient should consist of liquid food — milk, broths, meat juice, raw eggs and barley water. Let the pa- tient drink freely of water. Treatment of the rectum may be employed with benefit when the pharynx is greatly disturbed. Various sequelae and complications are best reheved or prevented, according to Link, as follows: "First, Umiting the production of toxins by a most thorough relaxation of the muscles of the neck, thereby favor- ing the unobstructed circulation of the blood and lymph; second, by the correction of lesions which affect the vasomotor of the head and neck; third, by spinal treatment affecting the vasomotor to the areas involved ; fourth, by increasing the activity of the excretory organs, by treatment in the splanchnic and lumbar areas, that the toxins may be more rapidly eliminated. In cases where laryngeal stenosis is marked and suffocation is imminent, intubation should not be delayed." Post-diphtheritic paralysis usually yields to osteopathic treatment. Apply treatment according to location. 1. A. M. Willard, Membraneous Croup — Journal of Osteopathy, March, 1904 368 The Practice of Osteopathy Dysentery (Bloody Flux). Dysentery is an infectious disease wherein the large intestine is in- flamed, with ulceration of the mucous membrane; is characterized, clinically, by frequent stools containing blood and mucus; fever and ex- haustion. Osteopathic lesions of an osseous character and deep mus- cular contractions of the lumbar region are always present. These in- volve the vasomotor nerves to bloodvessels and lymph channels. Catarrh of the intestinal tract is an important predisposing cause. The dis- ease usually occurs in the summer and autumn, and is more common i n hot, malarial regions, although it is found in various chmates. Unhygien- ic conditions are also important predisposing factors. In no disease more than dysentery does specific correction of the osseous lesion effect quick and satisfactory results. Acute Ileocolitis (Bacillary Dysentery) This is the variety most frequently found in temperate chmates. It occurs either sporadically or endemically. The Flexner bacillus is frequently found, as well as pus microorganisms. There are various strains of the bacillus. There is a catarrhal inflammation of part or the whole of the large bowel. Other forms may occur, as ulcerative and membranous. Osteopathic Etiology and Pathology. — Sudden atmospheric changes and simple irritants, such as unripe and indigestible food, are usually the immediate causes. The predisposing cause of acute catar- rhal dysentery is always found by the osteopath to be due to spinal de- rangements in the lumbar region. The lesion is generally a slight lateral deviation of a vertebra. It is generally found at the second or third lum- bar; still, the trouble may be found at any point in the lumbar section. The lesion involves vasomotor nerves to the intestinal mucous mem- brane, thus causing the inflammation. The drinking of impure water in itself may not be the cause of the disease, but is a favorable medium for the development of the organisms which may excite it. Dyspep- tic conditions and constipation seem to predispose to the disease. The mucous membrane is injected and swollen and often covered with bloody mucus. The folHcles of Lieberkuhn are enlarged from reten- tion of their contents, the result of the swelKng; the foUicles are often ruptured and the mucous membrane sloughs off in patches, forming ul- The Practice of Osteopathy 369 cers. These may extend along the whole colon and frequently into the ileum. Symptoms. — Diarrhea is the most common initial symptom; the stools being copious and painless. The stools soon become small and frequent, covered with mucus and streaked with blood. These are passed with straining and tenesmus, accompanied by colicky abdom- inal pains of a griping character. Chills are rare. The tongue is furred and moist; later it becomes dry. Nausea and vomiting may be present, but not as a rule. There is fever and often excessive thirst. Later the stools become green in color, due to the bile which causes a burning sensation in the rectum. On examination there are found red blood-corpuscles and leucocytes, and large, round and oval epithelioid cells containing fat drops and vac- uoles. In mild cases, the course is about eight days ; severe cases subside within four weeks, but if the osteopatislc treatment is careful and spe- cific, the usual duration can generally be reduced one-half. Pi-ognosls. — The prognosis is generally favorable in the catarrhal form when the disease is treated properly. The previous general health, hygienic conditions, and sanitary surroundings are of great importance. When there is ulceration or membranes the prognosis should be guarded. The condition may become chronic. Treatment. — The bowel should be thoroughly washed out by warm water enema, several times, if necessary, to remove irritating material. Invariably a lesion of the spinal column is found at the third and fourth lumbars or near by. It is generally a subluxation, of a lateral nature, between these vertebrae : rarely is the lesion above or below this point. The treatment should be applied immediate^ and directly to this region. Time is valuable in these cases and one should go to work at once to correct the irritation. An attempt should be made at each treatment to correct the disorder. This should not be delayed by wast- ing time in relaxing muscles and inhibiting, for unsually this gives only temporary relief. When a sHght movement has been accomplished between disordered vertebrae, treatment should be stopped and results watched, because the adjustment may have released all obstructions or irritations causing the disease. In many cases, to get an anatomically correct spine is an impossibility, from the fact that the displacements may be of long standing and naturally the subluxated vertebrae have conformed themselves to some extent to their unnatural position. In other words, what has been lost in the position and relation of a vertebra may have been compensated by reducing the effect of the lesion to a 370 The Practice of Osteopathy minimum. A lesion of this nature at the third lumbar impairs the in- nervation to the colon and consequentlj^ produces a stasis of blood in the mesenteric circulation, followed by inflammation, bloody discharges, cramps, etc. A single treatment is usually quite sufficient in milder cases. Other cases require treatment every few hours or thereabouts, until recovery. Treatment directly over the abdomen through the mesenteric cir- culation and glands is an effective treatment in most cases and especiall}^ when the attack is severe. It relaxes the tissues about the mesentery, thereby reUeving the stasis and freeing the circulation. The greatest care, however should be exercised in giving this treatment. The constant desire to defecate, that is common to many cases, is a very annoying S3miptom. Strong, thorough treatment over the sacral region, by inhibition over the sacral foraminae and by relaxing the tense muscles of the sacrum, will reheve this condition. In relaxing these muscles, place the whole hand against the muscles and push upward to- ward the occiput. This treatment inhibits the nerves to the rectum and lessens the tenesmus. Attention should be paid to the liver to keep it active. Washing out the large bowel with tepid water produces a sootliing effect, besides having a tendency to allay inflammation. The blandest of liquid foods, as peptonized or boiled milk, broths, beef juice, barley and rice, should be given. The patient should remain in bed until completely cured. Amebic or Tropical Dysentery This form prevails in the tropical and subtropical countries for the most part, and is caused by an animal parasite, the ameha dysenteriae. This is constantly found in the stools, the tissue of the intestine and also in the pus of the liver abscesses, which are secondary to dysentery. Amebae are sometimes found in the stools of healthy men, having prob- ably entered the system through the drinking water or uncooked food. Patliologically, the mucous membrane of part or whole of the large intestine is swollen. Round or irregular ulcers which undermine the mu- cous membrane, especially of cecum, ascending and pelvic colon, are found. In later stages there is infiltration of the connective tissue fol- lowed by necrosis. In some cases false membranes and sloughs are formed. Symptoms. — The onset may be either sudden or gradual, with a very irregular diarrhea, moderate fever, and copious, liquid stools, abounding with the amebae coli. The straining may be less severe and The Practice of Osteopathy 371 persistent than in catarrhal dysentery and may be absent. Sometimes there is nausea and vomiting. Abscess of the Hver is the most common comphcation, which may be single or multiple. When single it usually involves the right lobe. Mul- tiple abscesses are small. The more recent abscess walls are necrotic; the older have whitish, smooth, fibrous walls. These abscesses do not contain pure pus, but a fatty and granular debris containing the amebae and a few cellular elements. Sometimes they extend into the lung. Diagnosis. — This depends upon severity of attack and general condition of the patient. Relapses often occur and the case may become chronic. Cases have been treated osteopathically with success. Treatment. — In this form of dysentery the treatment is largely the same as in acute ileocolitis. The spinal lesions affect the innervation to the intestine, thus producing a stasis in the circulation; this condition favoring, and in fact, inviting the retention of the ameba coK in the sys- tem at this point. The diet is the same as in other forms of dysentery. Rectal in- jections and hot apphcations to the abdomen are useful. In all cases where strong treatment has been given to the spinal column, a quieting treatment to the nervous system and an inhibitory treatment to the heart will be gratefully received by the sufferer. Both of these effects can be accompHshed at the same time by simple inhibition to the occipital nerves. The stools should be taken care of immediately and disinfected. Ice water enemas given frequently are reported as giving good results. For the tenesmus, inhibit strongly at 3d, and 4th, sacrals. Chronic Dysentery This is generally resultant from an acute attack, though the amebic form may be sub-acute from the onset. PathoIogically,the coats are generally thickened, especially the submucosa and the muscular coats being hypertrophied. Ulcers are usually present, although there are cases in which there are no ulcers. Cicatricial contractions sometimes follow and the cahbre of the bowels is reduced, strictures being rare. Symptoms. — There is a progressive loss of flesh and strength, little or no tenesmus, slight, colicky pain and extreme anemia. The stools contain mucus, at times blood, and the bowels move from two to twelve times a day. Diagnosis. — The history of the initial symptoms will estabhsh the diagnosis. It is not always possible to distinguish between chronic dys- 372 The Practice of Osteopathy entery and chronic diarrhea. The duration is from a few months to several years, although osteopathic treatment has proven very eflEicient in many instances. Treatment. — Rest and a liquid diet are most essential. Foods that are easily assimilable and nourishing, with a minimum amount of residue, are required. Beef juice, beef peptonoids and peptonized milk are the types of food. Change of air, hygienic measures and environment are important. In cases that become chronic, the spinal column oftentimes exhib- its lesions above and below the lumbar region. Undoubtedly they are lesions of secondary importance in comparison to the lumbar lesions, but it is important that they be corrected. The treatment requires thor- ough, careful work of the disordered spinal column and lower ribs. Oc- casionally a slight kj^phosis is present in the dorso-lumbar region that demands persistent work in order to correct it. An occasional rectal in- jection is beneficial, especially in cases that have shght ulceration of the sigmoid flexure or rectum causing coKcky pains and a few loose stools in the morning, the patient being fairly comfortable during the rest of the day. Erysipelas. Definition. — An acute, infectious, specific disease, characterized by a pecuhar inflammation of the skin, due to the streptococcus erysip- elatis, with a tendency to spread. Osteopathic Etiology and Patliology. — Osteopathically, lesions are found to the vasomotor nerves and lymphatics of the affected area. Dr. Still gives lesions of the "inferior maxilla, the cervical vertebrae, the clavicles or the upper ribs" as specially important factors. These lead to congestion and predispose to infection. It occurs in epidemic form, especially in the late winter and spring. One attack predisposes to a second. Family predisposition exercises a slight influence. Abrasions, lacerated wounds, especially of the scalp, may be the starting point of an attack. Persons having skin diseases and wounds, and women who have been recently dehvered are Hable to be affected. Chronic Bright's disease, chronic alcohohsm, syphiUs, debility, phthisis, organic heart disease and unhygienic surroundings are predisposing causes. The specific virus is the streptococcus erysipelatis, which acts as a local irritant producing the dermatitis. These are found in the Ij-mph vessels and cutaneous connective tissue. The fever and constitutional symptoms are due to toxic agents. The Practice of Osteopathy 373 It is an inflammation of the skin, and if uncomplicated, no other structures are involved. Subcutaneous and mucous tissues may be involved, but rarely; if so, there is apt to be suppuration. Visceral com- plications are of a septic character. Endocarditis, pericarditis, pleuritis- pneumonia, and nephritis are possible compHcations. Symptoms. — The incubation period varies from two to seven days. The onset is generally sudden with chill, followed by fever, 104 or 105 degrees F. There may be nausea, headache, and pain in the back and Hmbs. The local inflammation of the skin follows, usually on cheeks and bridge of nose, or at site of an abraded surface. The area is red, smooth, and edematous. It spreads rapidly, the patch be- ing elevated above the surrounding tissue and tense. The swelUng may be so great as to close the eyes and distort the features. The cer- vical glands are swollen. The temperature continues high for four or five days and falls by crisis. The eruption begins to subside and a moder- ate desquamation occurs. If the disease takes a fresh start the fever again rises and continues as long as the disease spreads. There is usu- ally headache and sometimes delirium. The tongue is furred, and bow- els constipated and the urine scanty. As a result of intense infiltration the part may become gangrenous. Suppuration frequently occurs in facial erysipelas. The inflammation may extend to the mucous mem- brane of the throat and mouth. Diagnosis. — This is not difficult. The fever, the acuteness of the disease, the rapidily spreading eruption, and the constitutional dis- turbances will serve to distinguish it from all others. Prognosis. — This is usually favorable; healthy persons rarely die. Convalescence may be slow. Treatment. — Isolate the patient for the disease is contagious, and a third person may convey the virus. The poison may cling to clothing, furniture, etc. The physician should not take care of confinement cases.. A number of cases of erysipelas have been cured by correcting dis- orders in the region of the second, third, fourth and fifth dorsals. The lesions are principally subluxations of the ribs and severely contracted muscles. The disorder at the points named interferes with the vaso- motor nerves to the face, thus predisposing to an attack of erysipelas by allowing the micro-organism congenial tissue for its devastations. In many other cases derangements have been found higher than the upper dorsal, principally through the middle and upper cel-vical vertebrae. Lesions in these regions would also interfere with vasomotor fibres, es- pecially through the fifth nerve directly. 374 The Practice of Osteopathy The treatments on the whole are to examine for lesions to the in- nervation of the affected region and remove them, besides giving special attention to the bowels, a nutritious diet, and absolute rest. In cases where there is much restlessness and insomnia, treat the upper cervical region, especially the deep posterior muscles . Locally, use cold water applications; adhesive strips applied near the inflamed area or tincture of iodine, may prevent the disease spreading. Yellow Fever Definition. — An acute, infectious disease, characterized by a febrile paroxysm followed by short remission and then relapse, jaundice, toxemia, suppression of the urine, and gastric hemorrhage. Osteopathic Etiology and Pathology. — While a specific germ is the cause of yellow fever, it has not as yet been isolated. Extended tests by United States Army surgeons in Cuba show conclusively that the in- fection is alone carried by the stegomyia fasciata^ but ''It remains some- what uncertain whether the mosquito is the sole means of transmission." (Anders). Season is the chief predisposing cause as the outbreak is us- ually in summer and a frost ends its spread. Immunity is generally con- ferred by one attack. Tucker" noted that all cases examined had liver lesions and that most of the patients were of the malarial or bihous type. Spinal lesions were -not marked in some cases, but when present were in the liver and renal areas. Tete^ believes it to be a virus secreted in the human organism under certain atmospheric and other conditions in certain types, i. e. people subject to hepatic and renal disturbances. He also says the vagus is an important factor. Pathologically, there is more or less jaundice and hemorrhagic extravasations under the skin. The blood serum is red-tinted, owing to the destruction of the red cells. The liver is pale and presents exten- sive fatty degeneration, with necrotic masses in and between the cells. The gastro-intestinal mucous membrane is swollen, congested and pre- sents numerous minute hemorrhages. The kidneys show parenchyma- tous inflammation. The spleen is not enlarged. The heart sometimes shows fatty degeneration. The stomach contains more or less of the "black vomit," which is a mixture of transuded serum and transformed blood pigment. 1. See Dr. Still — Philosophy and Me'chanical Principles of Osteopathy. 2. Journal of Osteopathy, October 1G05. ■ 3. Journal of Osteopathy, October 1905. The Practice of Osteopathy 375 Symptoms. — The incubation period varies from one to five days. The attack generally begins with a chill, fever, 102 to 105 degrees, head- ache and pains in the loins and legs. The pulse is accelerated, the face is flushed, the tongue is coated, the throat sore, the bowels constipated and the urine scanty and albuminous. Recent observers state that bile is present in most cases before the albumin is noted. Nausea and vom- iting may be present at the onset, but become more severe about the second or third day when the black vomit appears. The febrile stage or stage of invasion, lasts from a few hours to several days and is fol- lowed by a decline in the fever when the severity of the other s^Tnptoms abates. This is called the stage of remission and in favorable cases convalescence sets in or the patient may pass into the second febrile paroxysm. The temperature rises again, jaundice appears rapidly, nausea and vomiting return. The tongue becomes dry and coated. The stools are black and offensive, the urine is albuminous, scanty and may be suppressed; there may also be hematuria. Death may occur from exhaustion or from uremia. Recovery may follow the gravest symptoms, even when there has been black vomit. The duration of the entire attack covers about one week. Relapses sometimes occur. Price says there is a point in differential diagnosis in yellow fever and it is a symptom not met with in any other febrile affection. It is the progressive fall of the pulse rate during the congestive stage of the first sixty or seventy hours, i. e., a variation of from five to ten beats less each morning and evening. He adds, "As long as the kidneys are active there is but little to fear. " Diagnosis. — Remittent fever has not the deep jaundice, the clear mind, the black vomit, or the albuminuria of yellow fever. The en- larged spleen and the presence of the organism of Laveran in the blood in remittent fever will decide the diagnosis. Dengue is sometimes con- fused with yellow fever. Prognosis. — This is always a grave disease, and in its severe forms ver3^ fatal. Recovery, however, may occur after the severest symptoms have been manifested. Black vomit is not always a fatal sign. Enough cases have been treated osteopathically to state that osteopathy is particularly effective. Improved sanitation is doing much to reduce moi'tality. Treatment. — Pi-ophylactic treatment should be carefully carried out. All patients should be quarantined and carefully screened so they cannot be bitten by the mosquito and the disease spread further. Peo- ple that are not acclimated should keep away from infected districts. 376 The Practice of Osteopathy All pools, cisterns and other places which can breed mosquitoes should be drained or screened. A systematic warfare should be waged against them. The patient must be put to bed at once and plentifully supphed with fresh air. Everything must be scrupulously clean — body and bed hnen. Use a tube for nourishment and a bed-pan for excretions as the patient must not make the shghtest exertion. Spinal lesions may or may not be found. They have been observed in the cervical, eighth dorsal and second lumbar. The treatment on the whole is s\anptomatic. The chills and fever of the first stage should be controlled by thorough work at the upper cer- vical, upper dorsal, lower dorsal and lower lumbar regions. Treat- ment at these points controls the superficial and deep vascular areas of the bod}' through the vasomotor nerves. The irritable stomach, dehr- ium and severe neuralgic pains of the head, back, epigastrium and Umbs are to be treated according to the conditions and severity of the symptoms. The kidneys and bowels should be watched carefully, and at the onset should be freely opened and control of the kidneys never lost. Let the patient drink freely of tater, which will aid. Hydrotherapeutic measures, as a cold bath or sponging, may be employed to aid in con- trolling the fever, the nervous symptoms, and the ehminative power of the excretory organs. Discontinue the use of hydrotherapy when a spon- taneous fall of temperature occurs. At the beginning of the first stage and during the stage of remission are the periods that the osteopath should do very effectual work by pay- ing particular attention to the four large vascular areas of the body, viz. : head, lungs, abdomen and legs. Treat the vasomotor nerves to these regions, thoroughly, as given in the treatment of the first stage. Dur- ing the third stage everything should be done that is possible to support the system. Ice slowly dissolved in the mouth will be of aid to an ir- ritable stomach. Hemorrhages and the various s\aiiptoms are to be treated as they arise. Good nursing, dieting, ventilation and keeping the skin, kidnej's and bowels active are the primary points to consider. During the per- iod of depression, the heart must be closely watched. The diet should be a Hght, Hquid one, of the nature of peptonized milk or fight broths. No food is recommended by some at the onset nor until the crisis is passed. Others feed during the stage of remission and give stimulants. Dur- ing the last stage rectal feeding is suggested if gastric irritabihty is pro- nounced. The Peactice of Osteopathy 377 Tetanus (Lockjaw) Definition. — An infectious disease, caused by Nicolaier's tetanus bacillus, characterized by persistent, tonic spasms of the muscles with violent exacerbations. Etiology and Pathology. — The exciting cause of tetanus is a spe- cific bacillus which usually gains access to the system through some wound. The site of infection is the only place the germs are found. The disease is much more prevalent in some locaUties than in others. It is found in hot countries, as in India and the West Indies, far more com- monly than in temperate regions. Esposure to damp cold is one of the recognized causes, also those localities where there are rapid changes from cold. Such regions seem to produce conditions favorable to the existence and growth of the bacilli. Earth mould, particularly where putrefaction is taking place, as in soil that has been manured, is especially favorable to the existence of the bacillus. It is frequently found in the intestinal tract of the horse, so that the soil about stables is apt to contain the germs. The highh^ fer- tiUzed soil of France and Belgium rendered it a special menace to the wounded of the Great War. Antitetanic serum, according to all reports, was particularly efficacious. Wounds and abrasions of various kinds, particularly contused and punctured wounds of the hands and feet, favor the excitation of tetanus. When an open wound is present, the term traumatic tetanus is given to the disease; idiopathic tetanus when no wound is discoverable; tetanus neonatorum when it attacks infants — this form is usually due to insanitary conditions, especially the improper care of the umbilical cord; lock-jaw or trismus when the jaw alone is affected; cephalic tetanus when the throat and face is involved. Characteristic lesions have not been found in the cord or the brain. The bacilli develop at the site of the wound where the toxin is manufac- tured. The bacilli do not invade the blood and organs. The toxalbumin is one of the most virulent poisons known. Congestion occurs in various organs, due to obstruction of the move- ment of the blood during a spasm. The brain, cord, lungs and muscles are congested. The nerves are often found swollen. Symptoms. — The period of incubation is from one to twenty days. This is time required for the poison "to be absorbed by the end plates in the muscles and to pass up the motor nerves to the spinal cord." In 378 The Practice of Osteopathy most cases the incubation is from five to ten days. A chill precedes other symptoms in a few cases. The onset is quite sudden, with stiffness in the neck, jaw and tongue. There are headache, stomach disturbance and languor. Opening the mouth is difficult, but is not painful. Deg- lutition is difficult. The stiffness increases and extends to the spinal muscles, abdomen and legs which are held in a firm spasm. Thus, the trunk and legs are inflexible. These syinptoms vary in degree of severity, dependent upon the extent of involvement. The jaws may be firmly locked or they may yield to forced extension — "lock-jaw." The muscles of the face may be involved, the angle of the mouth drawn out, and the eye-brows raised — "risus sardonicus." The neck and trunk muscles affected produce opis- thotonos. Spasms of the pharynx and esophagus may occur, especially when there are injuries to the fifth nerve. Associated with these tonic convulsions is intense pain. The distress of the patient is extreme when the chest muscles are affected. All symp- toms are increased during the paroxysm. A foot fall, the slamming of a door, a draught of air or any slight sensory impression may excite a par- oxysm. The paroxysm may relax and during the interval the patient may walk about. The spasms vary in frequency from a few minutes to one in several hours. During spontaneous or induced sleep the spasm usually ceases. The febrile reaction is generally slight and apparently of ner- vous origin; in many cases 102 degrees F. In severe cases the tempera- ture may be considerably higher. Perspiration is excessive. The urine is scanty and high colored. The bowels are usually constipated. The mind remains clear throughout. Death is generally caused by exhaus- tion. Chronic tetanus presents similar symptoms, but less marked, and it develops slowly. Diagnosis. — The history of a wound followed by the characteris- tic symptoms would rarely occasion an error. Strychnine poisoning differs from tetanus in the history, in the more rapid development of the symptoms, no trismus at the beginning, marked involvement of the extremities, and absence of rigidity between the paroxysms. In tetany the extremities are chiefly affected by the spasms, the muscles are relaxed during intervals, and trismus is a late or very rare condition. In hydro- phobia trismus does not occur and the respiratory spasm is caused by attempts at swallowing. The mental symptoms increase. Prognosis. — The prognosis is unfavorable. Eighty per cent of traumatic and fifty per cent of the idiopathic cases prove fatal. Cases that are fatal usually die within six days. Cases where there is slight The Peactice of Osteopathy 379 elevation of temperature, and where the spasm is locaHzed to the muscles of the face, neck and jaw, or where muscle stiffness is late in appearing, are more likely to recover. Treatment. — Free incision and thorough disinfection with hydro- gen peroxide and cauterization with pure carbolic acid, of the wound are necessary. The patient should be put in a dark room and there remain as quietly as possible. Avoid all sources of peripheral irritation. Liquid food is to be given, and if the jaws are firmly set, rectal feeding may be employed or food may be passed through the nose with a catheter. For the spasms, strong inhibition of the nerve centers controlling the affected muscles may be of use. Probably the most effectual treat- ment for the paroxysms would be strong, thorough treatment of the up- per cervical region. Hot baths give relief to the spasms. All the ex- cretory organs should be greatly stimulated, particularly the kidneys, lungs and bowels. Other symptoms are to be treated as they arise. Tetanus antitoxin is highly commended by surgeons who used it dur- ing the Great War. As death is at a two to one ratio any method of treat- ment is justified. A few cases have been treated osteopathically with fair success, following antiseptic measures. Simple Continued Fever Definition. — An acute, febrile disease, mild in character, of short duration, not excited by any special organism and depending on a variety of irritating causes. Osteopathic Etiology. — The most frequent cause of this form of fever is probably gastro-intestinal disturbance. In children it may be due to gastro-intestinal derangement, or to the eating of decomposing food or to exposure to wet and cold. It may be caused by exposure to the sun or great heat, or mental or physical fatigue. It may be the re- sult of exposure to cold sufficient to produce a shght bronchitis, tonsillitis or other affection producing an unnoticed locaHzed inflammation. It may follow a prolonged exposure to noxious odors or gas. Lesions, osseous or muscular, are always present, corresponding to the tissues and organs disturbed. Muscular lesions, especially, are prominent. Symptoms. — The onset is usually sudden with a feehng of lassitude, weariness, chilliness, and headache. The temperature rises quickly to 102 or 103 degrees F. or over, and is usually apt to terminate suddenly by crisis on the third or fourth day. The pulse is frequent and the face is flushed. The child is often irritable. Mild delirium may occur. An- orexia is present, and the bowels arc constipated. Convalescence is rapid. 380 The Practice of Osteopathy Diagnosis. — This depends upon excluding other probable diseases. If the fever cannot be attributed to some of the causes already referred to, there may be a doubt as to its character for the first twenty-four hours, but, if after a careful examination, one finds no other cause and no symp- toms develop of any of the recognized diseases, acute continued fever can hardly be mistaken for any other disease. Prognosis. — Always favorable, recovery without sequelae being the rule. Treatment. — It is necessary to find out the irritative cause in order for one to be able to treat intelligently. Rest in bed with treatment of the disturbing factor of the disease, whatever that may be, is the principal treatment to be given. Careful examination of all the organs, with due consideration of the symptoms, will generally leave no doubt as to the cause, and treatment appHed accordingly will be sufficient. If there is any gastro-intestinal disorder, thorough treatment of the splanchnics, anterior treatment to the abdomen and thorough evacuation of the bowels are indicated. Use an enema if necessary. Besides the usual fever treatment, sponging the body with tepid water at the time of day when the fever is highest will aid in lessening the temperature and render the patient more comfortable. In cases where nervous symptoms are prom- inent, care should be taken against any excitement and, if insomnia results, a quieting treatment in the cervical region is usually sufficient. Use plenty of water internally, which is not only necessary for the tis- sues on account of the fever, but is of great aid in keeping the skin and kidneys active, and thus a great help in the ehmination of waste mater- ial. A Hquid, nutritious diet is best. Milk, broths and soups will be enough. The demands on the digestive tract are not great when a fight diet is administered, besides not exciting the nervous and vascular S5^s- tems unduly. Tuberculosis Definition. — A general or local infectious disease caused by the bacillus tuberculosis of Koch. The bacillus produces specific lesions of the form of nodular bodies called tubercles that undergo caseous ne- crosis with a tendency to involve neighboring tissue. There maj^ be a diffusion of the infection by way of the lymph and blood vessels to var- ious tissues and organs. Osteopathic Etiology and Pathology. — Tuberculosis exists in all countries. It generally prevails more extensively in warm than in cold cUmates, and is of more frequent occurrence in the city than in the coun- The Practice of Osteopathy 381 try. Altitude, however, exerts more influence than latitude. The dis- ease rarely occurs in mountainous countries, owing to the puritj^ of the atmosphere. The disease is very prevalent in the West Indies and the South Sea Islands. Tuberculosis is frequently met with in Canada among the French Canadians and the EngHsh. All races are subject to tuberculosis, but the Indians of this continent, the South Sea Islanders and the colored race are very susceptible to the disease. It is estimated that from seven to ten percent of the present death rate in the United States is due to tuberculosis. The tubercle bacillus was discovered by Koch in 1881. It is a short, straight or sHghtly bent, rod. This bacillus has an exceedingly tenacious hold on life and is found in greater or less numbers in all tuber- culous lesions. It can live almost indefinitely outside the body. The bacilli are found in great numbers in the sputum, which dries and flies in the atmos- phere in the form of dust. The organism is thus widely spread in regions frequented by phthisical patients. The bacillus gains entrance into the body by way of the respiratory tract in the vast majority of cases. Milk from tuberculous cows wiU produce the disease, especially in children, causing intestinal and mesenteric tuberculosis. The meat of tubercu- lous animals is not necessarily infectious, although there is a possibility of infection by this means. Tuberculosis may be transmitted by direct inoculation; this does not often occur in man, but when it does, the dis- ease usually remains local, although general infection may occur. Per- sons who follow certain occupations, as butchers, dissectors of dead bod- ies, and handlers of hides, are more or less subject to local tubercles of the skin. The virus may enter the body through any fissure or excoria- tion on the skin; thus by Washing the clothes or bed hnen of phthisical patients, by the bite of a consumptive, or by a cut from a broken sputum glass of a consumptive, one may become infected. It is stated that there may be hereditary transmission. In some cases the virus may be transmitted and the disease ma3^ not appear for many years. Predisposing Causes. — Hereditary predisposition, which renders the person more liable to accidental infection ; delicate constitution ; scrof- ulous tendency; previous infectious diseases, as influenza, whooping cough, measles, typhoid fever; diabetes melhUis, etc. In young children menin- geal, mesenteric and lymphatic forms of tuberculosis are the most fre- quent. Pulmonary tuberculosis is usually met with in adults, espec- ially between twenty and thirty years or age. The development of tuberculosis is favored by damp localities; by improper and insufficient 382 The Practice of Osteopathy- food; constant inhalation of impure air; injuries to the chest, with or without laceration of the lungs, and various osteopathic lesions that weaken the tissue through faulty nutrition. Corresponding to the in- nervation of the organ or tissue diseased will always be found anatomical derangements. "Every case has a defective spine and thorax." (Hay- den'). Bronchial catarrh, tonsiUitis, diseases of the stomach and intestines, especially enterocoUtis, tubercular pneumonia, pleurisy (rarely), intra- thoracic tumors and congenital or acquired contraction of the orifice of the pulmonary artery increase the susceptibhHty to infection. Les- sened vitality of the tissues, whether inherited or acquired, is necessary before the germ can become implanted and proliferate, producing tuber- • culosis of the tissues and organs. In nearly every instance, when the lungs are involved, lesions are found at the second, tliird, or fourth ribs. These lesions undoubtedly predispose to the tubercular infection, by lessening the vitahty of the lung tissues through interference with the innervation or vascular supplJ^ Possibly a lesion at the second rib or second dorsal vertebra would interfere directly with the vasomotor nerves of the upper thoracic ganglia. The condition of the middle and lower cervical vertebrae should be carefully examined, for lesions at that point would involve the lymphatics of the lungs. The lowered vitality caused by the lesion is the predisposing cause and the tubercular bacillus is the exciting cause which determine the character of the affection. C. A. Whiting in Clinical Osteopathy says: **The spinal outline characteristic of tuberculosis and of the pre- tubercular stages presents the following peculiarities : The cervical spine presents various abnormalities, usually lesions involving single vertebrae and associated with irregular muscular tensions. The upper thoracic spine is anterior, the ribs drooping and rather more freely movable than normal; the vertebral articulations are less movable than normal; the tissues in the neighborhood of the upper two or three dorsal spines are abnormally sensitive and the muscles innervated from these segments are contracted irregularly when the disease involves the apices. The lower interscapular region is found sensitive and these muscles are con- tracted when the lower lobes of the lung are involved, and the location of these sensitive areas may be employed in the locahzation of the lung area infected. "In every case recorded in this clinic, lesions involving the area of the origin of the upper and middle splanchnic nerves have been 1. Journal of the American Osteopathic Association, March 1906. The Practice of Osteopathy 383 found. The typical tuberculosis spine must include lesions of the lower dorsal area. Probably these lesions are predisposing factors in tubercu- losis, partly because of the effects produced upon nutrition thereby, but doubtless the lack of the normal mobility of this part of the spine pre- vents the normal stimulation of the liver, the spleen, perhaps the pancreas, thus the normal opsonic index is lost, and immunity broken. The treat- ment of tubercular cases should include careful attention to the splanch- nic area, the maintenance of the normal mobihty and structural rela- tionship of the entire spinal column, and such stimulating movements to the ninth and tenth thoracic neighborhood as is indicated in each indi- vidual case. " Pathology. — In adults the most common site of tubercles is the lungs; in children it is the lymphatic glands, joints and bones. No organ is exempt ; the saKvary glands and pancreas are the least frequently involved. The mihtary tubercle is the beginning of tubercular deposits. This may develop in any tissue where the tubercle bacillus is found and it is only distinguished by the presence of a tubercle bacillus, as similar conditions are produced by the aspergillus glaucus and actinomyces. In the development of a tubercle there is proHferation of the fixed tissue cells, particularly those of the connective tissue and the endothe- lium of the capillaries, due to the irritation of the bacillus, producing the epithelioid cells and in some instances the giant cells, in both of which ba- cilli may be found. The epithehoid cells vary in shape. The giant cells are formed by enlargements of the epithelioid cells and a repeated divis- ion of their nuclei or possibly by fusion of several cells. On account of the inflammation produced by the bacillus, there is migration of leuco- cytes from the adjacent vessels and lymphoid cells. The leucocytes are largely polynuclear and are rapidly destroyed, but later mononuclear leucocytes appear, which are able to resist the action of the bacilli so that they are not so readily destroyed. A reticulum of connective tissue is formed around the various cells. The tubercles are non-vascular and when once formed undergo caseation and sclerosis. Caseation is a process of coagulation necrosis or destructive change, beginning at the central part of the growth, due to the action of the bacilli. The primarily transparent tubercular tissue may become a gray gelatinous body containing bacilU. Frequently the caseation is followed by softening; less frequently, calcification, or it may be surrounded by fibrous tissue. During the time the cell destruction is going on at the center of the tuliorele, hyaline and fibrous changes may render the tissues sclerotic. 384 The Practice of Osteopathy These changes, caseation, the destruction of forces, which are danger- ous to the patient, or sclerosis, which is a healing process, depend upon the power of the body to produce an antitoxin to overcome the effects of the special toxin produced by the bacilh. There may be a widespread tuberculous involvement. This is the result of fusion of the new foci of infection or of mihary tubercles. The lungs are the usual site of infection, varying from a small area, to a lobe or a still greater area. The irritation of the bacilli is capable of producing associated inflammatory processes in its own neighborhood. There may be an overgrowth of interstitial tissue. In other instances, changes to catar- rhal or croupous pneumonia may occur. Suppuration is associated with tuberculosis, especially of the lungs, and is due to a mixed infection or the presence of pus organisms. Some authorities claim that the tu- bercle bacilli alone are able to produce suppuration; it is, however, more probable that suppuration is due to a mixed infection. The constitu- tional features in tuberculosis are more dependent upon this secondary infection, especially by the streptococci, than upon the primary infection. Tuberculosis of the Lymph Glands (Scrofula) Scrofula is a true tuberculosis of the lymphatic glands. The virus is less virulent than that from other sources, which accounts for the slow development and milder course of tuberculosis of the glandular system. Tuberculous Adenitis may occur at all ages, but is most common in children and young adults. It is rarely congenital. Catarrhal in- flammation of the mucous tissues weakens the resisting power of the lymph tissue, thus allowing the bacilh to develop, and is an important predisposing cause. The glands most frequently affected are those of the neck; more rarely there is involvement of all the lymphatic glands of the body. Invariably lesions of the upper and middle cervical verte- brae and upper dorsals and corresponding ribs are found, as well as le- sions to the lymphatics at various points along the spinal column and ribs. These lesions affect the innervation to the lymph glands, as well as mucous membranes, and thus predispose to the disease. In all cases anatomical derangements are found in the region of the innervation to the involved gland. In general tuberculous adenitis all the lymph glands of the body are more or less involved, while the other organs and tissues are The Practice of Osteopathy 385 rarely affected. All the visible glands are found to be swollen, tender and painful. There is more or less protracted fever, with wasting and debility. This is a rare affection. In local adenitis the glands of the neck are most frequently affect- ed and this is especially the case with children. Negroes are more fre- quently affected than whites. It is seen especially among those living in an unsanitary environment. Measles, whooping cough and an hered- itary tendency are predisposing factors. The submaxillary glands are usually the first affected. At first they are swollen to various degrees and are tender; later they suppurate and rupture if one is not able to cure them. There may be fever. The skin over the glands is usually freely movable; it may, however, be adherent. The glands above the clavicle, those in the posterior cervical tri- angle, and the axillary glands may all be affected. In such cases it is likely that the bronchial glands are also involved and may infect the Hving tis- sue. Lesions of the upper and middle cervicals and deep muscles are al- ways found and undoubtedly are the underlying causes. Lesions of the lower cervical, upper dorsal, ribs and clavicle, are of frequent occur- rence. Infection may gain entrance by way of the pharynx and tonsils. The affection often runs a slow course. The bronchial glands may be affected primarily, but usually second- arily to infection of the lungs. The primary form is seen most common- ly in children and is apt to be associated with suppuration. Lesions of the upper and middle dorsals and of the cervicals will be found. Catarrh of the bronchial tubes is a predisposing cause. The X-ray is of great value in the diagnosis . ■ The most noticeable symptoms are those due to pressure or irri- tation. Systemic infection may follow rupture into a vessel. Local infection of the lung may occur and the pericardium become infected. Mesenteric cases occur among children and may be primary or secondary. The primary form is rare. Swallowed sputum is a frequent cause. The trunk and hmbs are puny. The child is anemic, and often the abdomen is tympanitic. Diarrhea is marked and there is pain and indigestion. Fever is almost constantly present and of an intermittent type. The disease is most frequently met with among poor children in unhygienic, poorly ventilated houses. There may be an associated tuberculosis of the peritoneum. 386 The Practice of Osteopathy Acute Tuberculosis This shows best the truly infectious nature of tuberculosis. In it mihary tubercles develop in many and various parts of the body. In some cases these growths seem to be uniformly distiibuted throughout all the viscera. In other instances they are locahzed in the lungs or in the meninges of the brain. In nearly every instance it is an auto- infection, arising from an old tuberculous focus, which may be latent and quite unsuspected. General infection, in most instances, arises from the rupture of a nodule into a vein, from tuberculous lymph glands, tuber- culosis of the bones, joints, or even the skin. General Miliary Tuberculosis or Typhoid Form. — This is sim- ilar to a general infection of the body and resembles, to a marked degree, the symptoms of typhoid fever. The onset is rarely rapid. In most cases there is a period of incubation, during which the health fails, the appetite is lost, headache occurs, and the patient soon becomes feverish, with increased debility. The temperature rises and the pulse is rapid and feeble. The tongue is dry. The respirations are increased. Dehrium may be present. In rare cases, there may be Uttle or no fever. The temperature ranges from 101 to 103 or even 105 degrees F. It is ir- regular and marked by evening exacerbations and morning remissions. Occasionally there is an inverse type of temperature in which it rises in the morning and falls in the evening. In some cases the pulmonarj^ symp- toms are marked, while in others the meningeal symptoms are more prom- inent. Tubercle bacilH are rarely found in the sputum. The spleen is usually enlarged. Constipation is present, as a rule, but there may be diarrhea, and hemorrhage from the bowels may occur. The ui'ine may contain traces of albumin. There may be excessive sweat- ing, and herpes is often present. Choroid tuberculosis is frequently met with. In doubtful cases the blood should be examined for tubercle bacilli, although they are not always present. The duration is from two to four weeks, the disease usually terminating unfavorabty. Diagnosis. — It is often very hard to differentiate between this form of tuberculosis and typhoid fever. In typhoid fever epistaxis is a common, early symptom. The temperature curve of the continued type is quite diagnostic. The Widal test should be made. The respirations are mod- erately hurried and the pulse is often dicrotic. Diarrhea is frequent. Typhoid rash is diagnostic. No tubercles are found on the choroid. No tubercle bacilli are found in the blood. Hemorrhages from the bowels are common. The Practice of Osteopathy 387 Pulmonary Form. — When the lungs are chiefly affected the pul- monary symptoms are marked from the onset. It may develop sud- denly or there may be a long period during which the general health fails markedly. In children the disease may follow measles or whoop- ing cough. There is dyspnea, cough and the expectoration is muco- purulent. There is broncho-vesicular breathing with sibilant and sub- crepitant rales. The temperature is high, ranging from 103 to 105 de- grees F., or higher. Respiration and pulse are rapid. The disease may last from several weeks to months, or, on the other hand, it may prove fatal within a few days. As the end draws near the signs of suffocation become intensified. Diagnosis. — The history and general symptoms, together with the dyspnea and cyanosis, will generally decide the diagnosis. The blood should be examined for malarial parasites. The Widal test will differ- entiate typhoid. Cerebral or Meningeal (Tuberculous Meningitis). — This form which is sometimes called acute hydrocephalus, occurs quite frequently and is an infection of the pia mater of the brain or cord. It occurs most frequently in the first two years of life, although it may occur later. It is usually tuberculous in some other region, especial- ly in the bronchial glands. Rarely does the disease involve the menin- ges primarily. The meninges at the base of the cerebrum is the principal involve- ment. There is more or less inflammation, with fibrous purulent exuda- tion. There are tubercles along the blood vessels. The ventricles may be distended. Symptoms. — The onset is slow, lasting one or more weeks. Head- ache, constipation, vomiting and chills, followed by a fever, are the ini- tial symptoms. When the onset is sudden, the disease is generally usher- ed in with a convulsion. The fever rarely rises above 102 or 103 degrees F. The pain is often severe, causing the child to give a sudden cry — the hydrocephahc cry. During sleep the child is restless and there are slight muscular twitchings. The irritative symptoms now abate. The child becomes quiet and is dull and apathetic. Constipation still persists. The abdomen is boat-shaped, and the neck may be retracted. The pupils are dilated. Convulsions and other cerebral symptoms may occur. The tempera- ture ranges from 100 to 103 degrees F. The respiration is irregular and sighing. Following this, tlie mental faculties are lost and coma occurs. Con- 388 The Practice of Osteopathy vulsions or spasmodic contractions of the muscles of the neck, back and limbs may occur. The pupils are dilated and do not respond to light. The pulse is frequent, irregular and small. The temperature rises to 103 to 105 degrees F., or it may be subnormal. The duration is from two to five weeks; chronic cases may last for a number of months. Prognosis. — Generally very unfavorable. Acute Pneumonic Phthisis The infection of the lungs is rapid and may be primary or secondary. This form is met with most frequently in children and young adults, but may occur at any age. The Pneumonic form is more rare than the bronchopneumonic form and may be very rapid in its course. The attack sets in abruptly with a chill and the temperature rises rapidly. There is pain in the side ; cough; dyspnea and mucous and rusty sputum, which may contain tuber- cle bacilli. There is impairment of resonance, increased fremitus, and bronchial breathing. The whole or part of the lung may show signs of consolidation and dullness, all the symptoms of pneumonia being present. The patient rapidly loses flesh. This attack may come on a person in good health after exposure to cold ; but there may have been a debihtated condition, or a predisposition to phthisis. Death may occur in the second or third week or the case may continue from three to four months. One or both lungs may be involved. The lung is heavy and airless, sinking quickly in water. There is destruction of lung tissue and upon section, cavities are found. The cavities are generally small and are sur- rounded by tubercles. Older caseous areas of a yellowish white color may be visible. Miharj^ tubercles are found upon careful examination. The bronchopneumonic form is the most common and occurs most frequently in children. It often follows the infectious diseases, especially measles and whooping cough. The child may be taken ill suddenly with what seems to be an ordinary bronchitis, the temperature rises, the cough is severe, and there may be consolidation with submu- cous and sub crepitant rales. Rapid respiration and sweating are often marked. The course of the disease varies. There is rapid loss of flesh, and in many cases the disease develops into chronic phthisis. In other instances death occurs in from three to eight weeks. The disease may attack the adult whose resistance is impaired. Chills, fever, pain in the chest, hemorrhages, wasting are most noticeable ms; these are the various signs of bronchopneumonia. Tubercle The Practice of Osteopathy 389 bacilli are often found in the sputum. The course is usually from three to eight weeks, while a number pass into a chronic stage. Areas of caseous tubercles are found, which later suppurate, break down and form cavities. The bronchial lymph nodes are found enlarged, and usually there is acute tuberculous pleurisy. Diagnosis. — In the pneumonic form it may be impossible to make a diagnosis early in the disease. Tuberculosis may be suspected if the patient has been in bad health, has a predisposition to phthisis, or has had any pulmonary disorder. Pneumonia will present the typical symptoms, but if fever continues, tuberculosis will be suspected. Ex- amination of the sputum will probably decide. In the bronchopneumonic form it is very difficult, in the early stages, to distinguish it from simple bronchitis and bronchopneumonia. The irregular fever and rapid loss of flesh are important signs. The sputum will show elastic tissue and tubercle bacilh early in the disease and should be carefully examined. Chronic Pulmonary Tuberculosis The chronic form of the disease is more common than the acute. It seems probable that many cases of pulmonary tuberculosis are due to inhalation of the tubercle bacillus, though no doubt, particularly in chil- dren the bacillus frequently gains entrance to the system through the in- testinal tract from infected milk and food. Deformities of the chest, especially where there is constriction and rigidness of the upper part, with more or less immobility of the first, second and third ribs and the junction of the manubrium and gladiolus, associated with weak muscles and a stooped posture are definite predisposing factors. This condition may be congenital or acquired. The local innervation, blood supply and lymphatic drainage is involved, so that the individual is less resistant and consequently susceptible to infection. The bronchi are thus weakened, favoring the infectious process so that the disease may advance and in- volve the neighboring tissues, or if infection has gained entrance to the lymph or blood stream elsewhere, the susceptible pulmonary organs may become diseased. Owing to the above predisposing factors the primary lesion of the lungs is often in the bronchus a little below the apex near to the posterior and external borders. A lower lobe may be involved, or several lesions may occur at the same time, involving one or both lungs. Frequently the other lung is infected from the lesion or lesions of the first. In the acute cases the exudative process involves the lung tissue, 390 The Practice of Osteopathy becomes caseous and softened, and later necrotic with cavity formation. In the chronic type the exudative process is slower, with thickening of the walls of the air vesicles and increase of fibrous tissue. Cavities, the result of caseation, are of various size, ragged, often coalesce and open in- to the bronchus. Fibrous tissue forms about them and frequently arrest the process. In the necrotic involvement blood vessels are often injured causing hemorrhages. Pleurisy, empyema, catarrhal bronchitis, and bronchiectasis are often associated involvements. In addition to the tubercle bacillus, other microorganisms, strepto- coccus and staphylococcus pyogenes, influenza bacillus, and diplococcus pneumoniae, are often found, and no doubt are important exciting factors. The bronchial glands are swollen, and contain tubercles. They may undergo purulent disintegration. Tuberculosis of the larynx is common. In. severe cases there may be amyloid changes of liver, iiidneys, spleen, and mucous membrane of the intestines. Tubercu- lous lesions are found in the intestines, spleen, kidnej^s, and brain in near- h' equal proportions; then come the liver and pericardium. Symptoms. — The onset of the disease is either abrupt or gradual. Frequent!}' it succeeds influenza, measles, or bronchitis. There is a cough, expectoration, loss of weight, afternoon temperature and probably night sweats. The disease is hkely to develop slowly. In other cases gastro-intestinal disorders are the first symptoms, especially with weak- ness and debihty. Again, the disease may follow pleurisy. When the attack is abrupt, pneumonia is simulated. However, the apex of the lung, instead of the middle or lower lobe, is involved; expectoration is considerable and the fever is not so high and pronounced. Hemoptysis frequently occurs. The local symptoms are important. Pain is an early either mod- erate or severe, sjniiptom, although there are cases where it is absent. When associated with pleurisy, it is severe. The pain is usually situated at the base, anteriorly or laterally, of the scapulae, but may be between them. Cough is present, in the majority of cases, throughout the entire course. It usually grows worse, and is dry and hacking at the beginning but looser and paroxysmal and accompanied by a mucopurulent expecto- ration later on. The expectoration, at first, is slight and there may be more or less blood mixed with it, or even hemorrhage may occur. With the formation of cavities, the expectoration increases and is of a greenish- gray or greenish-yellow color. In some instance the sputum is more or less fetid. The expectoration is composed of pus cells, blood, elastic tissue, fat glol^ulcs and tubercle bacilli. Hemoptysis is present in a The Peactice of Osteopathy 391 majority of cases. Early hemorrhages are usually sMght, due to rupture of weakened vessels. When there is softening or cavity formation, ero- sion of vessels may be pronounced and hemorrhage considerable. Dysp- nea is a variable symptom, but is characteristic of lung changes. Fever is a characteristic symptom. It is probably always present at the beginning and the afternoon increase of temperature is common. Where there is softening and formation of cavities, a remittent or inter- mittent type is present. The pulse is frequent, regular and compressible. Sweats may occur at any time, but especially during sleep. They in- dicate fever activity, and are increased during cavity formation. Ema- ciation is a prominent symptom. This is due to gastro-intestinal dis- orders and prolonged fever. Loss of weight is gradual, especially if the disease is advancing. Where the lung is considerably diseased, heart disturbances are comm.on. Other disorders, as of the gastro-intestinal tract, genito-urinary, cutaneous, and nervous sj^stems, are frequent, especially in long stand- ing cases. The gastro-intestinal disturbances are gastric catarrh, vomiting, loss of appetite, coated tongue, constipation, and later on, diarrhea. Among genito-urinary symptoms, albuminuria is frequent. The kidney involvement may be either of an acute or chronic character. Pyehtis and cystitis are present in some cases, and amyloid degenerations are not uncommon. With the cutaneous symptoms, the skin is fre- quently dry and scaly, and the hair of the head dry. The hectic flush is common. Upon the chest and back there may be pigmentary stains. The nervous symptoms vary according to the involvement. Tuber- culous meningitis is rare. The mind usually is clear and even in advanced stages the patient is always hopeful. Physical Signs. — Inspection reveals that the shape of the chest is often characteristic. A phthisical thorax is flat, especially the thoracic opening with wide intercostal spaces, prominent costal cartilages, and depressed sternum. Sometimes the lower sternum forms a deep concav- it}^ (funnel breast). Another type of thorax is long and narrow, with very oblique ribs, and Httle expansion. In other instances the chest is of apparently normal build. Defective expansion is observed early, es- pecially at the apex of the affected side. The clavicle of the ajffected side often stands out more prominently. Palpation shows there is decreased expansion and increased frem- itus. Normally, the fremitus is stronger at the right than at the left apex. If the pleura is thickened, the fremitus is decreased, l^ut increased in lung involvement. 392 The Practice of Osteopathy On percussion, if the diseased areas are minute, the percussion note may not be changed. Always compare the two sides of the chest. Dulhiess is first noted, as a rule, above, on or below the clavicle. As the disease progresses, the dull sound increases. The size of the cavitj' , its walls and the amount of secretion modify the note. Large, thin- walled cavities elicit the "cracked-pot" sound. Consolidation, thicken- ed pleura, large amount of material in a cavity and a connecting bron- chus impair resonance. On auscultation the breathing is harsh and the expiration is pro- longed and high-pitched (bronchial). Early in the disease crackling rales may be heard. After consoUdation takes place there is bronchial breath- ing and crepitant rales. When softening occurs they become moist, loud- er and sometimes bubbling. These may be heard upon inspiration and expiration. Pleuritic friction sounds, as in case of pleurisy, may be heard at any stage. Vocal resonance is increased. The signs of cavity are: Percussion. — There is more or less de- fective resonance or tympany. Over large cavities a "cracked-pot" resonance is obtained. This is best obtained when the patient has his mouth open. There may be normal resonance if the cavities are covered with a considerable thickness of unaffected air cells. Ausculation may detect cavernous or amphoric breathing, pec- toriloquy and coarse, bubbling rales. Metallic tinkling may be heard over large cavities. Vocal resonance is increased. Complications. — The larynx and trachea frequently undergo tu- bercular inflammation, due to invasion from the lung tissue. Pneumonia is of common occurrence. Gangrene, pleurisy and endocarditis are other complications. Diagnosis. — Bacilli may be found in the sputum before the physical signs are well developed. It may be necessary to examine the sputum several times before the tubercle baciUi are detected. The presence of bacilli will set the diagnosis at rest, provided clinical symptoms are pres- ent. Fever, hemoptysis, cough, emaciation and a continuous, local induration arc diagnostic. The X-ray should be employed as an aid in diagnosis. Prognosis. — The prognosis of pulmonary tuberculosis varies greatly in different cases. Undoubtedly a number of cases have been cured; many arrested; even spontaneous cures have occurred. A great deal can be done to prolong life and to make the patient comfortable. The aver- age duration is about three years, although by careful treatment this time is probably being increased. The Practice of Osteopathy 393 Fibroid Phthisis This term is applied to a form in which there is induration, followed by contraction of the affected lung tissue, due to an overgrowth of fibroid tissue. The greater number of cases are primarilj^ tubercular, but have run a fibroid course. Other cases are primarily fibroid, followed by tuber- culous infections. It may begin as an ordinary ulcerative phthisis, or it may begin as an inhalation bronchitis. In other instances it may fol- low a chronic tuberculous bronchial pneumonia or pleurisj^ The onset is extremely insidious. There is persistent cough, often paroxysmal in character. Dyspnea is marked, especially on exertion, but little or no fever is present. The expectoration is profuse and muco- purulent. There is slight loss of weight. In the later stages edema is marked. It is a disease of long duration, lasting from ten to twenty years. The patient is often able to pursue some occupation and may have fair health. There is marked dullness over the affected side, which is commonly much depressed. There is distinct bronchial breathing at the base, while at the apex there may be cavernous sounds. The heart is frequently dis- placed and the right ventricle hypertrophied. The bronchi are dilated. The chnical history is identical with that of simple cirrhosis of the lung from which it is often separated with difficulty. Both lungs may become the seat of tuberculous disease. Prolonged suppuration results in amyl- oid changes in the Hver, spleen, kidneys and intestines. X-ray plates are of value in diagnosis. Tuberculosis of Other Tissues The alimentary tract is frequently the seat of tubercular inflam- mation. The intestines may be involved primarily or else secondarily from the lungs or peritoneum. The primary form is most common in children. There is slight fever, pains of a colicky nature, irregular and persistent diarrhea. The disorder is commonly unrecognized, being mis- taken for appendicitis or other intestinal disorders, until emaciation, sweats, the continued fever or lung involvement are manifested. The stomach, esophagus, pharynx, tonsils, palate, tongue and lips may be the seat of a tubercular lesion. The serous membranes are usually secondarily involved. The peritoneum is generally invaded from contiguous organs, especially the intestines, although the pleurae may be the starting point (and in the female the generative tract is a source) . The disease may be either acute or chronic. In the former it starts abruptly with vomiting, pain in the 394 The Practice of Osteopathy abdomen, fever, and possibly diarrhea. In the chronic form there are fever, pains, emaciation, weakness and the abdomen is distended. The enlarged glands may be felt through the walls. There may be ascites, or the walls of the peritoneum are adherent, or the tubercles may ulcerate. The endocardium is occasionally the seat of acute or chronic tubercu- losis. It is usually secondary. Likewise the pleurae are sometimes in- volved. The chronic form is more common. The genito-urinary system is subject to tuberculosis. The blad- der, ureters and pelvis of the kidney are attacked, and from these the kidney; or possibly the kidney involvement is part of a general tubercu- losis. (See pyeUtis). The ovaries, Fallopian tubes and uterus are also subject to tubercular invasion. The diagnosis depends upon finding the bacilH, the symptoms indicating, oftentimes, an inflammation only. Also the prostate, testicles and seminal vesicles are attacked. Tuberculosis of the mammary glands is rare. In miliary tubercu- losis the liver is commonly affected, often secondary to other tissues, es- pecially the peritoneum, lymphatics and lungs. The blood-vessels and heart are sometimes involved from nearby organs or from miliary tuberculosis. The brain and cord are also at times invaded. This has been described under meningeal tuberculosis. Diagnosis and Prognosis of Tuberculosis. — The osteopath .should be familiar with the various forms of the disease. An understanding of the pathology and chnical symptoms is essential. The finding of the l^acillus, provided there are symptoms of inflammation, is diagnostic. Much depends upon the patient's constitution, hygiene, sanitation, food, fresh air and general management. The osteopathic lesion is decidedly an important factor, but the treatment must be balanced from both the distinctive osteopathic view and that of general management. Then the patient's part is as necessary as the osteopath's. Under proper care and treatment, unless the disease has progressed to a marked degree, there is always a tendency toward recovery, but, to emphasize again, the os- teopathic treatment, the environment and general hj^giene should be thoroughly understood and appreciated, for at best, the disease is treach- erous. Even after an apparent recovery is made, the patient should be under observation; there is always danger of recurrence. Tuberculosis can '■often be treated successful!}^, or arrested, provided the disease has not progressed to a late stage; although many times, in the later stages, hfe can be considerably prolonged by careful treatment. Treatment of Tuberculosis. — The prophylactic treatment of tuberculosis should receive first consideration. The sputum should The Practice of Osteopathy 395 be thoroughly disinfected and care taken that the patient does not spit about carelesslj^ A spit-cup should be provided and the sputum collect- ed and destroyed by burning and the cup steriHzed. The patient should be well taken care of and given a separate apartment, so that the danger of conveying the disease to others is reduced to a minimum. He should occupy a single bed. All unnecessary furnishings of the room should be removed and the objects that remain in the room should be frequently aired and disinfected. The general and sanitary environment of the patient should be as favorable as possible to hygienic living. Many times a change of residence is of great benefit. When possible the patient should be out of doors and light exercise taken. The body should be well protected by flannels, the year around. Keene^ would carry prophylaxis to careful examination of the preg- nant woman to avert a sudden development of tuberculosis after par- turition; also of the child, after birth, to remove any predisposing lesions. The mother with a tubercular tendency should, under no circumstance, nurse the child and should be instructed to observe any disposition on the part of the child to acquire malpositions in sitting, standing or walking. Another important consideration in the prophylactic treatment is the inspection of dairies and slaughter houses. The disease may be transmitted by infected milk. There is less danger of infection through meat; although all animals that present distinct lesions should be con- fiscated. Sanatoria and other special arrangements for the care of pa- tients should be encouraged. The Treatment of the disease consists primarilj^ in locating the cause of the devitalized condition of the cellular tissue. This is the vital point to be considered and requires a thorough examination of anatomical structures in the region involved. There is a reason why the tissues are in a depraved state and it is our work to examine thoroughly the structures that might become deranged anatomically and cause an obstructed innervation or vascular supply. The disease is not primarily due to the bacilli; the bacilli would not have infected the system had it been in a healthy state. Hence, the object of the treatment in tubercu- losis is to favor a building up of normal, well-nourished tissues so that it is impossible for the bacilH to infect the region. Of course, destruction of the bacilli is important, but we cannot expect to do much by the use of a parasiticide, for we are not then influencing or affecting the real cause of the disease. If we can improve the arterial circulation to the diseased tissues, we will be striking at the root of the disease and the healthy blood 1. Journal American Osteopathic Association, December 1904. 396 The Practice of Osteopathy will be the only parasiticide necessary. This is where the osteopathic theory of the cause of disease differs from that of other schools of medi- cine. At the local points of infection there is a decided malnutrition of the tissues, due to a lack of proper blood to the parts, thus favoring the lodging of micro-organisms; by re-estabhshing normal nutrition nature will repair the tissues if the condition is curable. Hence, it can be seen at once that if the case is curable osteopathic treatment will meet the demands scientifically. The preceding is the key-note of osteopathic therapeutics; not only in the treatment of tuberculosis, hut in all diseases where micro-organisms play an important part. In tuberculosis of any part of the body, it is the duty of the osteopath to carefully examine the structures that may become anatomically deranged, from any cause, affecting the nerve, blood and lymphatic supply to the tissues or organs diseased. Cor- rection of anatomically deranged tissues and attention to the hygiene, diet and general health of the patient constitute the treatment. On the subject of Pulmonarj^ Tuberculosis, W. Banks Meacham says: "In cases of pulmonary tuberculosis it should be remembered that the pathological lesion in the lung is a result of a general systemic interference — an interference so great that the body as a whole loses its stored-up heat in excessive temperature, loses its reserve nutrition, as manifested by early and continuous loss of weight. "Therefore the causative osteopathic lesion should not be sought alone over the site of the pathological lung lesion but rather in that area where general nutrition is osteopathically affected. "A few general considerations of osteopathic mechanics involved in nutrition should be ever present with the searcher for the cause of pulmonary tuberculosis. For instance we know that ingested fat is acted upon by the pancreatic enzymes; that the invertin of the intestine is an endocrine secretion. In diet we seek to administer an excess of fats to take the place of fat-loss in this disease, often losing sight of the fact that some mechanical maladjustment prevents fat-spUtting into a form suitable for tissue assimilation. "It is common osteopathic knowledge that lesions of the upper dorsal area have a profound influence on general nutrition. Consequent- ly it is to this area that we must look for the causative osteopathic les- ion in this disease. The influence of thiss area is due to the fact that the nervous mechanism of the secretory glands gets its most direct disturb- ance in this area where the nerves leave the spinal cord to become distinct innervation to these organs. The Practice of Osteopathy 397 "Apart from the nutritive and general circulatory influence of upper dorsal lesions we must consider the germicidal action of the endocrinous secretions in devitalizing the specific bacterial agent in tuberculosis. Undoubtedly these internal secretions have marked effect in agglutinat- ing the bacilH, thus enabling the phagocytes to perform a larger duty. "The correction of upper dorsal lesions, with due regard for the pathological condition within the thoracic cavity gives a scientific physio- logical and bacteriological therapeutic action in tuberculosis. **Other lesions may and do demand attention and correction when possible. But we must not lose sight of the fact that our specific action comes from a corrected relation of the upper dorsals. In the cloud of unproved theories and guesses in the Kterature of pulmonary tubercu- losis nothing seems nearer an established truth than that it is a disease contracted in infancy, that it develops, later, in those persons who retain the infantile type of chest — thorax of large antero-posterior diameter in contrast with the lateral diameter. "In the progress of the disease we do get a costal malformation giving the 'horse-collar' thorax, with an apparent lesion of the os- seous walls of the thoracic cavity. But these lesions are the result of nutritive changes brought on by the active infection already present; and are not in any true sense, causative factors in the estabhshment of pathological areas within the lung. "The osteopathic treatment, then, of this disease is, manifestly, a correction of a plastic posterior upper dorsal lesion. And where the pathological lesion of the lung contraindicates forceful correction, mo- bihty of the area should be sought. "The general care of the case should look to the normal func- tioning of all organs, with emphasis on ease to the patient. The diet should be what the patient can assimilate properly even though it be much less than the amount a normally active person should ingest. Al- titude has a favorable effect in selected cases only. It is remarkable that many cases recover in the extremes of the Rockies and the coasts of California and Florida. "No violent exercise should be undertaken on account of the possi- ble embarrassment of an already overworked heart and in considera- tion of the possibly engorged pulmonary vessels. For these reasons, too, rest in bed is advisable with temperature above 99° F. and pulse above 85." In scrofula, lesions will be found to the lymphatic glands, impair- ing their innervation and function. The treatment is not to be applied 398 The Practice of Osteopathy over the glands directly. First, it is necessary to locate the lesions of the bones, hgaments and muscles or such tissues that would cause dis- turbances to the glands, then readjust the parts. The object of the treatment is to modify the soil conditions on which the bacilU multiplj', by correcting the local derangement of the tissues. The entire body is not in such a depraved state that the bacilH will grow and multiply wherever they happen to come in contact with the body; tissues of any organ favor a receptivity for the bacillus only when these local tissues are in a morbid condition. It is then our work to aid nature in relieving obstructed forces that are causing such an effect. There are general measures which influence the tuberculai- pro- cess. The diet of the patient should be nutritious. A diet of milk, l^uttermilk, egg albumen and meat juice will probably be found best, although many -will be able to take ordinary food. The patient should be out of doors as much as possible. Meacham^ says "Fresh, pure air, wherever found, is essential; elevation is an individual requirement, an even temperature is not necessary and sunshine is important only as it allows the patient to be out of doors. Exercise should not be taken when the patient has a temperature above 99 degrees." The dry, even cli- mate of the Southwest certainly tempts the patient to be out of doors more than one with opposite conditions. Even when the patient is greatly debihtated and weakened, insist upon his taking outdoor exer- cises or rides. Gymnastic and methodical breatliing exercises are essen- tial in widening and strengthening the chest. Bolles" believes that the appetite should control the diet and forced feeding be not insisted upon. Fasting, to test the sense of food desires, has points well worth looking into, as gastric disturbances with a loss of strength follow over-feeding. He also recommends deep breathing and physical culture to elevate the ribs and increase thoracic expansion. Outdoor sanatoria are being es- tablished over the country, in many cases by state appropriation as, "the treatment of tuberculosis itself has not been a satisfactory proced- ure except by climatic changes or the outdoor treatment persistently applied." (Halbert). The fresh air treatment may be taken at home by sleeping in the open air or by apphances fitted to the window of the room so only the head is exposed to the air. The only factor is to get the air. The skin, as well as the excretory organs, should be kept active. Always make it as comfortable for the patient as possible. The fever is indicative of the activity of the disease, so that treat- 1. .Journal American Osteopathic Association, May, 1905. 2. Journal American Osteopathic Association, May, 190.5. The Practice of Osteopathy 399 ment to influence the process and to promote elimination is best. Spong- ing with either cold or tepid water will be helpful. The cough is a troublesome symptom. Attention to the underlying irritation is de- manded, although one cannot hope to influence, to any great extent, the cough dependent on cavity formation. Catarrhal processes in the res- piratory tract can be lessened. Lesions that are acting as a cause of irritation, will frequently be found in subluxated ribs or vertebrae. The seventh and eighth dorsals are frequent sources of cough. The tissues about the pharynx and larynx, and the hyoid bone, disturbing the vagus and other nerves, should be carefully watched, also possible reflex irri- tation from the abdomen and pelvis. Night sweats are due to tuber- cular processes weakening the system and particularly lessening ner- vous control. These will subside as the body is strengthened. Spong- ing will be of service. Disorders of the stomach and intestines, such as nausea, vomiting and diarrhea, require treatment of the splanchnic area and regulation of diet. Considerable can be done to relieve tu- bercular laryngitis by careful treatment of the larynx and contig- uous tissues. Hemorrhage is Hkely to be self-Hmiting. Attention to the upper dorsal vertebrae and ribs and muscles will tend to equalize the circulation. Rest and use of ice upon the chest, as well as inter- nally, will be beneficial. Mclntyre, in an article on "Fat Food in Consumption," sums up the treatment for tuberculosis in the following words: "The treatment, then, for consumption should include rich, stimulating diet, proportioned to the digestive power of the patient, containing an excess of fats in most digestible form, of which sweet cream, fresh butter and well-cured bacon are the best examples, and the free use of pure drinking water, coupled with the promotion of blood flow, respiration and elimination of waste by osteopathic means." Surgical measures may be necessary where glandular or other tissue has broken down and is a menace to recovery. Spanish or Epidemic Influenza"^ By George M. McCole The epidemic of influenza which swept over the world and reached the United States in August 1918, starting in at the Atlantic sea-board cities, developed rapidly there and passed westward over the country. It reappeared the following winter. ♦Rewritten from article in Osteopathic Physician, .June 1919. 400 The Practice of Osteopathy Epidemiology. — In the United States it was called Spanish influ- enza, as it was at its worst in Spain at the time it broke out here and was thought to have been brought from that country. In Europe it was called the Uki-ainian influenza and in southern Russia it was said to have emanated from the Orient. No country in the world was exempt. It was at one time thought to be a type of the pneumonic plague and while plague is the severest toxemia known many cases of Spanish influenza were equally as prostrating and fatal as the ordinary type of pneumonic plague. The bacillus pestis was never proved to be the cause of this pandemic of influenza but the cHnical analog}^ was very evident. A study of European conditions of health and hygiene shows how- reasonable it is to beheve that some disease would develop and sweep a world lowered in vitality and immunity by the abnormal conditions of war. Every known communicable disease was raging in Europe and Asia where milHons of people existed under exceedingly poor hygienic conditions. The period of incubation of influenza was extremely short, averaging about two days. All ages were attacked, although persons over 60 rarely. Those between 25 and 35 seemed to be the most susceptible but it was, perhaps, because they were in active hfe and more exposed. There is considerable evidence that the disease was not air-borne but conveyed bj^ contact with active cases. The secretions of the mouth, nose and eyes were considered the active carriers. Masks, made of several layers of gauze fastened over the face, have been worn by many people but ex- perience taught that their use did not avail against infection. Mortality. — The mortahty under drug medication as shown in a statement bj^ Henry S. Bunting was as follows: "New York City 9.8%; Chicago 14.5%; Boston 27%. Osteopathy's influenza salvage repre- sents the difference between these figures and the low score of one fourth of 1%." He gives the following statistics on pneumonia following influenza under drug medication. "Reports from 148 health commis- sioners show an estimate (called conservative) of 33% of fatahties in epidemic pneumonia under medical care. In some large centers it ran as high as 68% to 73%. As officially compiled to date, the fatalitites in epidemic pneumonia in our army and navy cantonment hospitals amounted to 34^%. Osteopathy's fatahties were only 10% which in- cluded all those eleventh-hour appeals to Osteopathy. "The Chicago and New York departments of health figures, each show total death losses of 18% in all of their epidemic cases. Osteopa- The Peactice of Osteopathy 401 thy's remarkable salvage of life is best measured from this point of com- parison. Its total death rate from both influenza and pneumonia has been actually less than one percent. " And this is based on 110,000 cases reported to the American Osteopathic Association. Pathology. — The pathology of Spanish influenza is practically a study of lung involvement. There we find an exudative pneumonia of a rapidly confluent type, a transudate of blood serum and red cells ap- pearing in the lower lobes of both lungs and rapidly flooding the entire space. Air bubbles were scattered through the serum soaked lungs, giv- ing a frothy appearance to some parts. At times some parts of the lungs showed drops of hquid pus. Where pneumonia did not develop there was no typical pathology. The toxins left an irritated bronchial tube, intestine or kidney just as in any other severe toxemia. Broncliial and the old type of lobar pneumonia also appeared as a comphcation of Spanish influenza, making three types of pneumonia which were to be guarded against. Symptoms. — The attack is usualty ushered in by a chill or prolong- ed chilly sensations, sometimes lasting for two or three hours; fever 103° to 105° F. ; if it does not fall in three days or if it comes up after once falhng, pneumonia is to be suspected; pulse, full and bounding with a varjdng rate ; headache usually general in type and in severity from sHght discomfort to a most violent type; intense pain in the back and legs; tenderness the whole length of the spine but especially distressing in the upper dorsal, lower lumbar and sometimes the upper cervical; a dysp- nea which is best described as being a constricted feehng of the chest with airhunger; often the bronchial tubes are raw and dry, the patient feeling as if the breathed-in air were hot to the bronchial tubes, an active exudative bronchitis developing; sometimes there is an active bronchitis with distressing cough; nose bleed is a frequent symptom (and is often a sign of threatening pneumonia) ; most cases sweat more or less, some have drenching sweats; sleeplessness; albuminuria frequent. When the temperature breaks it practically always falls below nor- mal during the course of that day. A typical case of severe character often presents all of the above symptoms; the hghter cases perhaps only two or three of them, of which the chilly sensations, fever and bounding pulse are the most common encountered. A severe case is impossible to differentiate from the first symptoms of smallpox. Where a case of this type is encountered, it is always ad- visable to get history of vaccination or smallpox. 402 The Practice of Osteopathy Examination. — The successful treatment of disease calls for atten- tion to little things. Some little thing properly cared for very often gives us our margin over adverse conditions and spells success in the care of our patient. During the epidemic I found a few cases which ran a temperature much below normal, sometimes as much as three or four degrees, and still with enough symptoms to be easily diagnosed as influenza. Pulse was taken at the time the thermometer was in the mouth. Pulse was practically always bounding and hard. Its rate varied widely, being influenced by many other conditions. I often, early in the attack and where other sjmiptoms were indefinite, made a diagnosis principally from the pulse. Respiration was taken while holding the watch and with the finger on the pulse so that patient would not know that breathing was being watched. Many patients complained of a sensation of weight on the chest and difficult breathing — hardly what one would term true dyspnea yet a real air hunger and sensation of constriction in the chest. The breath was often tainted with the odor of acetone, indicating a high de- gree of acidosis and giving an important diagnostic point. The heart was then examined, both by auscultation and percussion. The examination was then extended over the lungs and pleural rub hstened for. Patient was questioned as to having had a chill, general health, oc- cupation, undue exposure, fatigue, what physic if any, had been taken or other drugs used, bowel movements and bloody stools, food taken, sleep the night before, and dreams, headache and backache. The full examination could not be given at each call and not all of it to each patient, as time would not permit during the height of the epidemic. Throat was always examined. This is an important point. The urine was examined in a great many cases and often albumin and sometimes casts were found. Treatment. — I consider it advisable to give a strong deep treat- ment if the patient is seen before the attack has gained full headway; after that I give short fight treatments. If the disease has not developed much at the time of the first visit vigorous treatment with adjustment of the deep-lying and tightened-up hgaments over the spinal cord is indicated. Subsequent treatments are given to overcome the invariable and recurring contractions along the The Practice of Osteopathy 403 spinal cord. The spine is gently sprung and the muscles pulled away from the intervertebral foramina so that arteries, veins and nerves of the spinal cord are free to function. I might note here that I consider Spanish Influenza does its damage through the attack of its peculiar and virulent toxin and the accompany- ing acidosis, on the body's reservoir of energy- — the spinal cord and re- lated structures, the vegetative glands and nerves. If the patient is in a serious condition he is often treated in the posi- tion in which found, so as not to disturb him. Care is particularly taken to keep a patient who is moist with sweat from taking cold or being ex- posed. An extra covering is thrown across the neck and shoulders, and pulled down as the bed covers are moved to get to the area to be treated. The musculature of the upper dorsal and cervical region is given special attention, the region of the first and second cervical and the first to sixth dorsal being special seats of trouble. The region between the spine and scapula on the left side, first to sixth ribs left, and the re- gion of the suprascapular notch on the left side are given specific treatment to free them of contractions. The tissues of the suprascapular notch are in direct connection with the nerve supply of the heart muscle and treatment here is astonishingly effective. This treatment for the heart is best given with the patient lying on the right side, leaning a little forward, with his left forearm against the chest, hand at neck or chin. Stand then at the patient's head and with the thumbs give all the region on the left side at the base of the neck and around the suprascapular notch thorough muscular adjustment for circulation and removal of contractions which disturb the heart's vital- ity. Treat first to sixth dorsal region. I consider this treatment specific for the heart debihty of infiuenza and many other heart conchtions, as well. I have found it especially effective in the weakened and nervous states following infiuenza and in so-called ''run down conditions" generally. Vibration with the tips of the fingers on the anterior chest wall is often used. Tender and contracted tissues are often found along the anterior ends of the ribs which are involved at their spinal ends. These are gently treated. Children are often given vibration, holding their chests with my hands under their arms. If the patient is stout and not easy to treat I have him sit up in bed and give the upper dorsal thorough percussion with the side of the hand\ 1. This treatment was described by Henry M. Stovel, in The Osteopathic Phy- sician of January 1917. 404 The Practice of Osteopathy About 100 strokes at each treatment are usually given. I remember one very fat patient in the eighth month of pregnancy to whom I could give hardly any other treatment. It was especially valuable here and we saved the mother after a hard fight, though the child was still-born. When nature is meeting the emergency and holding her own in the battle against infection we have a moderate fever — a benign fever. When the body is overworked with other duties and irritations the fever may rise dangerously high. Here it is that the physician must give further aid. Here it is that osteopathic treatment further aids by giving rest to the patient, easing pain and promoting general circulation (this in itself often quickly reduces fever). Here it is that the attention we give to clothing, diet, ventilation, quietness, good nursing, etc., comes in. The body is relieved of all duties but the one. Its functions are all turned to one end — the destruction of the invading infection. The osteopathic physician adjusts. Nature cures. It is all a matter of adjustment. For labored breathing, an effective treatment is to have the patient with hands clasped and arms raised above the head, patient being in bed, face up. Stand directly at head of patient. Reach over patient's arms and under the upper dorsal and lift up against the heads of the ribs with your fingers, thus raising the chest, beginning as far down the spine as you can and working up as you treat. Relax the muscles at the same time. Frequency and Amount of Treatment. — Frequency and extent of treatment depend upon the condition of the patient. In influenza the patient is approached with the idea of a dailj' visit. If then there is any doubt about his being entirely safe for 24 hours he is seen in 12 hours or as often as the condition indicates. Patients are usually seen more than once a day. The average time which the patients are confined to the bed is about five days. Some are free from fever in three days; some not for six or seven days. According to conditions they are then kept in bed from one to three days longer. As to the amount and length of treatment, I agree with James M. Fraser, who says adjustment of the soft tissues should be made and made with as Uttle disturbance to the patient as possible. He says^: "The ill effects of too long-drawn-out general treatments, or in short, over-treatment, I consider one of the most important questions for osteo- paths because I incHne to the behef that in many acute infections more harm may be done by such fatiguing over-treating than if the patient 1. O. P. June 1919. The Practice of Osteopathy 405 were really not treated at all. A "flu" or pneumonia patient should never be treated over fifteen minutes at the longest in one treatment. It is much better to treat often and not treat so long, as over-treatment may result from a desire to be thorough. If we always would stop and think what we are doing and just what we are trying to prevent we would be more careful when we treat these infectious cases. A patient's re- sistance may really be lowered, his bowels inhibited, his heart overstimu- lated, his muscles fatigued and his nerve force depleted by treating over- time. When the reaction begins, stop. " Congestions and contractions should be removed wherever they are found, be it in the region of the throat, spine, ribs, Hver or spleen. I order a daily enema and give positive instructions — after having had one or two almost fatal cases from this cause — to use no physics. Purg- ing killed more people here than any one other thing. If a heavy physic be given two or three times and the patient comes to a crisis, so much vitahty has been taken out of the blood that he does not have enough strength to carry him over and he dies. If the patient comes to pneumonia I find it good and effective to use the "constipation treatment." It is best to let the bowel take care of itself. Nature can do many things, and caring for the bowel in a crisis is one of them, providing the correct diet has been given the patient. If the patient is getting nothing but fruit juices there may be a natural bowel movement and even if he has been getting other food it is better to leave the bowel alone until after the crisis and then give the enema. A patient with a frank pneumonia following influenza has but little chance of Kving if his strength is being drained from the blood stream through the bowel every few hours. I see to it that no draft blows on the patient's bed. In a windy location a cold draft can appear suddenly and do great damage in a short time. The patient should not breathe cold air. Fresh air is all right but it must not be cold air. I order extra covering for the neck, arms, shoul- ders, back and chest. I Hke a wool workshirt best but use pneumonia jackets, extra undershirts, sweaters, etc., when the wool shirt is not to be had. In fact continued warmth seems to be an almost necessary condition to the proper handling of influenza. It is because heat, even the heat of the fever itself seems to aid the nervous system in building up antitoxins. The patient is instructed that if a sweat comes on, either from a hot bath, hot drink or as a result of the disease, to he and take it, for throwing off the covers is a sure way of taking cold and inviting pneumonia. 406 The Practice of Osteopathy If the house is cold or the patient weak or very sick the urinal and bed pan are used. In fact I prefer their use even when those conditions are not present, as the less the exposure the less chance of pneumonia and the quicker recovery. Rest lying in bed is absolutely necessary to a satisfactory course and quick recovery. For lung congestions and bronchial irritation, in addition to osteo- pathic treatment along the spinal cord, raising the ribs and chest, and vibration of the chest wall, I sometimes use the old fashioned mustard plaster (made with one teaspoon each of flour and mustard, mixed with olive oil or with water and white of egg), keeping it on about ten to thirty minutes or until a good, red reaction is brought about. The feet must be kept warm with hot water jugs. A hot mustard foot bath is excellent when the feet persist in staying cold. At first I did not use the hot tub-bath. I am now ordering it if I see the patient early in the attack and where there is no contra-indica- tion, such as a dangerous heart condition. I do not use it unless it can be given properly and without undue exposure to the patient. I never give it late in the disease. A good method is to get the patient into the tub, lay two canes or sticks across the tub, and cover all with a blanket or rug. Place a bath towel for the head to rest on and pull the blanket around the neck. The patient can then take a good hot sweat in comfort. His arms and shoulders, his knees and legs will not be exposed to chill. When he gets up the blanket can be drawn about him if desired. He then goes back to bed for a good rest and sweat. A cold towel is placed on the head and water given to drink. Every patient should have a good sweat early in the attack. An- other good method is to cover with a blanket and place outside fruit jars or jugs filled with hot water, cold towel to the head and several glasses of water or lemonade to drink. The use of cold compresses on the chest I do not favor. They are used by some osteopathic physicians, but I believe the result is better with other methods. Apphed in a hospital where the technique is well in hand they might be successful, but personally I fear them. I am even careful about putting an ice bag on the heart. Cold packs are some- times used in my practice but only on the head for pain or dehrium. Chill must be avoided. Warmth must be conserved, even the fever is benign. Neither do I favor "rul>on" of camphor, turpentine or onions when they irritate the patient. If the patient has been used to them or The Practice of Osteopathy 407 has faith in them and wants them I order them. I also order something of the kind where ''something must be done". When a family calls a doctor they "want something done," and it is best to do something; ever keeping in mind, however, that our patient's strength must be con- served. I do favor "rub-ons" in that I think it is well to keep the skin soft with some oil. It helps to keep an even temperature and the skin active. The skin should be wiped dry often, however, to remove the skin secre- tions which if left on become stale. I remember being called to see one Httle girl who could not get her breath, and found she was holding her nose with the bed clothes. She told me that the smell and stickiness of the lard and turpentine and the onions made her so sick and uncomfortable that she felt she could stand it no longer. When she was cleaned up, and clothed in nice clean white cotton she showed a wonderful improvement, and it was real as well as apparent. As to baths in influenza, I instruct the nurse to bathe the patient only as necessary for cleanHness and his comfort. DabbHng around in water is not a safe procedure in a disease where pneumonia is so easily contracted. I do not use alcohol rubs where the patient is in anything like a ser- ious condition, as alcohol closes the pores and dries out the skin. A rubbing or massage by the nurse is good for a restless, nervous patient, but it had better be done with oHve oil or some other good oil. In in- fluenza we do not want the pores closed. We need eHmination, and all we can get. A small saving of vitality or a little eHmination of toxins may be the margin that saves a patient for us. I do not favor the use of turpentine, for if it is absorbed it irritates an already sick kidney; if it is not absorbed it is useless. Why disturb the patient? For the bronchial irritation, in addition to osteopathic treatment, and the accessory mustard plasters, inhalation of steam is often used. A pan of boiling water is set by the bed and the patient leans over the edge of the bed with a bed-sheet or paper over the head and steam vessel, breathing the steam as long as it lasts. For the throat most any cleansing gargle can be used but I prefer the use of the connuon baking soda gargle. I have about one-half teas- poonful of soda placed in a glass and boiling hot water poured over it. As soon as this is cool enough to use I have the patient gargle thoroughly. The idea is to get the mouth, pharynx and tonsillar area clean and free from accumulations. Lemon-water gargle is often gratefully accepted. 408 The Practice of Osteopathy If a very sick patient breathes through a dirty and dried-out mouth, all the stage is set for him to draw into the devitahzed lung large quanti- ties of infectious material. For this reason if not for the comfort of the patient it is necessary that the mouth be kept clean and also moist. It is not possible to kill this germ life with any antiseptic. The field must be made and kept clean. The nasal passage also should be looked after, to keep it clean as possible and also to allow the patient to breathe through the nose. For the nasal passage any good non-irritating oil is effective but I like best 2|% iodine in oil. It is a good lubricant and as far as possible we do get the germicical action of the iodine. Patients asking me what to do to avoid influenza are advised to keep the mouth clean and closed and to use the oily solution of iodine in the- nasal passages. And when treating the respiratory tract we must keep in mind the fact that all healing comes from the blood side of a membrane. No healing ever comes to a membrane from its exposed surface. Local treatment to a membrane must be a treatment which removes irritation, not one which adds more. Healing must come from within. "The rule of the artery is supreme. " Diet. — The diet used is Hquid, so that the digestive functions will be taxed as little as possible, for they are weak at this time. Fruit and vegeta]:)le juices only are used. The influenza germ propagates largely in the intestine and if the in- testine has in it the products of a full diet the bacterial growth soon overpowers the patient. Germ hfe cannot develop on fruit and vegetable juices. Another reason for using the liquid and fruit diet is that influenza is a disease running a short course and feeding is not necessary. If it were a disease such as typhoid, running a fever for several weeks, we would then give a more liberal diet, but the patient's strength will not be lost on a liquid and fruit-juice diet in three or even eight days. The frequency with which the urine contains albumin in this dis- ease shows us what a heavy load the kidneys are carrying. This makes a salt-free diet advisable and again brings fruit juice to our favorable attention. To activate the kidneys and thus reheve the headache we give always plenty of water and often hot lemonade. Orange juice and lemonade are used frequently as are blackberry, raspberry, pineapple, loganberry and grape juices. When the acid juices are not well borne we use non- The Practice of Osteopathy 409 acid juices, such as pear and raspberry juice. A ripe, cooked pear mashed with a fork and mixed with one or two different fruit juices makes a satis- fying dish. Bottled sweet cider is also a most valuable food and a good bever- age. We use it in almost every case and find it the most acceptable to the patient of any food offered. I am of the opinion that apple cider has been neglected as an article of diet, both in disease and health, but espec- cially in fevers. It contains considerable iron for the blood, as well as having considerable food value. It has the added virtue of being pleas- ing to the patient. In addition to these juices we often use spinach juice. I have the nurse get a can of the best grade spinach and serve the juice hot, as a broth, with a httle salt and pepper and perhaps celery salt and a piece of bacon in it to flavor it and to appeal to the patient. Spinach juice con- tains much iron and iodine in a form readily absorbable by the blood. It also is useful in maintaining the alkalinity of the blood and body fluids, thus counteracting the acidosis of the disease. It renders the urine alkahne and thus relieves the kidneys of the irritation of acidosis and of an acid urine. Where the kidneys are or are Hkely to be involved the spinach juice must be served without salt. All the mentioned fruit juices tend to counteract acidosis and pro- duce alkahnitj^, but are not so effective as the spinach juice. They have the advantage, however, of being used in larger quantities. The spinach juice has considerable food value and has the added value of appealing to the patient's reason, when the iron and iodine content is explained to him. It is especially useful when treating those patients who are wondering if they should not be getting some sort of "tonic." The juice taken from ground fresh lettuce is also valuable. It con- tains more iron, iodine and phosphates than the spinach but it is not so easy to prepare. I have used it in the cases of several anemic and quite sick babies and consider it well worth all the expense and effort it took to secure it. Tlic breaking down of the alkahne reserve of the body and the con- sequent acidosis, comes early in the disease and is disastrous, and all I lie attention given to the diet is amply repaid in results. Careful at- tention to the diet is the only way the acidosis can be overcome. Raw fruit and vegetable juices also supply that most valuable ele- ment, vitamines. For this one thing alone is the raw fruit juice most valuable. I do not believe too much attention can be given to securing 410 The Practice of Osteopathy a Kberal suppty of vitamines for the bod.y, especially during an attack of fever. Some especially interesting points are brought out by contributors to the Journal of the American Osteopathic Association in the March, 1919 number. I wish here to add a discussion of these points. The contributors are physicians and good representatives of our profession and they report uniform and excellent success in handhng the recent epidemic. It seems to be the consensus of opinion that the treatment should be specific and light to avoid fatigue, with the possible exception of the first treatment, which often should be general and vigorous. All are agreed that the patient should be kept in bed, not even leav- ing it to go to the bath room. The patient must be protected in every way from fatigue and exposure. The enema was used by all. A num- ber of writers state plainly their opposition to the use of physics and laxatives. A hot tub-bath is recommended by several, but there is op- position to much bathing. Practically all the writers used the fruit-juice diet. However, a few gave a heavier diet and were successful with their patients, which is one more proof that the osteopathic treatment is the deciding factor in bringing about a cure. J. R. Thornton wrote after having had about 100 cases. He speaks especially of his cases of pneumonia. They resolved by crisis. There were no deaths. He says: "All cases were, preceding the first treat- ment, given a generous plain water enema. Orders were left for two enemas per day until told to discontinue, and in most cases the patient got the enema. A few cases, with the highest fever, the stationary fever, were given tap-water enemas, one each hour until the temperature drop- ped two or three degrees. "Sponge baths were given to reduce fever in every case. Diet was Hquid until the temperature was normal. "The osteopathic treatment of the usual spinal work, paying special attention to cervical and dorsal areas, and strong inhibition. "Pneumonia cases were treated three to five times a day and had as much time as they required at each visit. They required action. Heating compresses were used on each case, except the ice bag to the heart when rapid. One case of deUrium was treated with ice caps to the head and neck. Normal salt solution per rectum. Murphj' drip was given in each case. Diet, liquid consisting of egg-nog, milk, strained soup and broth. " The Practice of Osteopathy 411 Maiy Alexander Patton: "Treatment should be quick, every motion significant so as not to tire the patient, for exhaustion is always present. Each patient was treated two or three times a day until temper- ature became normal. The nasal douche was given twice a day followed by K-Y jelly. Hot soap bath followed by soap enema and enteroclysis when fever persisted. " W. Curtis Brigham ordered "Hot packs the full length of the spine twenty to thirty minutes, three times a day. This will produce profuse sweating and often put the patient to sleep." I have used this same treatment, especially in nervous cases, and hold it in high esteem. I have the patient put a bath robe on backwards so that the arms and legs are well protected but the spine easily accessible. The hot packs can then be used and covered over and the patient not exposed. R. H. Nuckles maintains that lung and ear trouble will not follow influenza where osteopathic treatment has been given to adjust the cervical and upper dorsal circulation. H. A. Price: "We have kept particularly in mind, first, the nerve, blood and lympathic supply to the lungs; second, the circulation to the spine (meaning spinal cord); third, the internal secretory functions and to the general excretion." Ralph M. Crane says: "A great deal of my work is among the ItaKans. It was necessary to give quick specific treatment that I might do as much good as possible to the greatest number. I did not treat them as often as I would like to, and because of this fact I learned that osteopathy got control of the 'flu' immediately, the first treatment suffic- ing to start them on the road to recoverj^; in fact, many of them got no more than one treatment." 412 The Practice of Osteopathy ACUTE ERUPTIVE FEVERS, MUMPS AND WHOOPING COUGH By Edgar S. Comstock GENERAL CONSIDERATION In the consideration of these diseases, it is well to bear in mind that lowered resistance is the primary condition that has made the in- fections possible, and that lowered resistance implies an imbalance of or obstruction to the vital fluids and forces of the body, thereby inter- fering with the functional activity of the body's normal protective mech- anism. The imbalance of or the obstruction to these vital fluids and forces, which is structural in nature, is produced by many conditions, as fatigue, exposure, sudden changes of heat and cold, emotions, dietetic errors, physical force or violence, etc. These conditions, because of the re- sponse of the tissues of the body to environmental changes, produce con- tractures of the elastic tissues, such as muscle, fascia, etc., which dis- turbs the structural integrity of the body and thus produces obstructions, irritations or intei-ference with the media of exchange of these vital flu- ids (blood and lymph) and forces (nervous energy) of the body. It is evident, then, that the most potent curative factor in the treat- ment of these diseases, as in all others, is the removal, whenever possible, of the obstructions and interferences that pervert the activity of these protective forces. It is necessary, therefore, to remove the exciting causes (fatigue, dietetic error, etc.) and by such physiological means as may seem necessary to readjust the structures of the body so as to re- move the above mentioned obstructions and interferences. The structural lesions most frequently found in the infectious dis- eases are of the muscular and fascial type and are very evident to the careful observer. The interosseous lesions are probably often the pre- disposing factors to the susceptibiHty of the softer tissues to reaction to environmental changes, but it has been the experience of the writer that the adjustment of the softer tissues was of greater primary importance in the acute stages of these diseases. The interosseous lesions may be easily adjusted in the very early stages of these diseases, that is before the severe symptoms have appeared, but after the more severe condi- tions have appeared it has been our experience that the soft tissue work was sufficient unless the interosseous lesions were very easily adjusted. It is the writer's desire to impress upon the reader the necessity of The Practice of Osteopathy 413 careful attention to the structural lesions that are always constant in these diseases, using whatever physiological means seem necessary to adjust these lesions and keep them adjusted, and to insist upon carefully restricted diet; continuous, thorough ehmination of the waste products of the body; hygienic surroundings and well regulated environments both mental and physical. Then Nature, which has given the body its own protective mechanism, may have full control of the situation and all of the normal protective chemicals and forces in the body organism are utihzed in the battle with the invading infective forces: the glands secrete the chemicals of protection; the antibodies are rapidly de- veloped and thrown into the battle area; metabolism begins to return to normal; elimination becomes increased because of the stimulating action of foreign substances in the body structures; and the work of repair and recuperation begins. If rehance is placed upon the inherent protective forces of the body, the knowledge of the special type or character of the invading organism is of little importance from the standpoint of the treatment of the dis- ease after it has become established. The value of the knowledge of the specific organisms is in preventive medicine, in seeking out the habitat and breeding ground of the organism and its mode of transmigration. Knowing these, effective measures may be adopted to prevent their propagation and spread. Examples of this are Yellow Fever and Ma- laria. Variola (Smallpox) Definition. — Variola is an acute, specific, highly infectious and contagious, epidemic disease. Its beginning is sudden with a chill, vomiting, severe headache and lumbo-sacral pains. It has a typical fever curve and a typical eruption on the skin and mucosse of macules, papules, pustules and crusts successively. History. — Prevailed in China and India at least 1000 years before the Christian era. Epidemics occurred in the sixth century and during the crusades. Its first clinical description was given in Arabia during the ninth century. It was brought into Mexico about 1520 by the Span- iards and between three and four million people contracted the disease. In 1718 preventive inoculation was introduced into England and in 1796 Jcnner discovered vaccination. Etiology. — The specific agent which is the cause of this disease is unknown, Init the virulence of the agents is retained for a long period 414 The Practice of Osteopathy and is the most virulent found in all diseases. There is no period from the initial fever to the final desquamation that the disease is not con- tagious, although the stage of suppuration is the most violent. Although the disease is so highly contagious and the entrance of this particular poison into the system produces this disease, still no one has yet been able to discover a germ nor what the nature of the infective agent is. To contract the disease it is not necessary to touch an individual already afflicted, not to even approach the sick room. It may be only necessary to touch a garment that has once been in contact with a smallpox pa- tient, or which has simply hung in his vicinity. The blood is infectious at a very early stage. As smallpox is con- tagious without eruption it seems that the secretions and excretions convey the virus. The dried pustules seem to have the greatest infec- tiousness. Cadavers of smallpox (Variola) victims are very dangerous and relatives of them should be carefully warned. The disease often persists in infected communities for years. The disease is evidently spread by fomites, contact with the pustular contents, and crusts or scales of the desquamating skin. It attacks all classes, ages and con- ditions of people, which is unUke other erythematous diseases. A previous attack usually confers immunity. Vaccination is claimed to confer immunity but apparently in not all instances, for there are records of "successfully vaccinated" individuals having severe attacks of the disease. The susceptibihty to smallpox, as to all other infectious diseases, varies in different individuals, in different races, and under the influ- ence of conditions as yet unknown. Some persons are not susceptible to the disease, nor are they to vaccination, and yet others have been known to have had the disease as much as three times. The [egro and Indian races seem to be more susceptible than the Caucasian. Then again at intervals of a few years, the general susceptibility of the people seems to be increased so that cases of smallpox become far more numer- ous than usual. A point of considerable interest is the fact that the child, while in the mother's womb, may experience the disease along with the mother and thereby acquire, before birth, the usual immunity conferred by one at- tack of the disease. In most cases of smallpox in pregnant women, abortion or miscarriage occurs, yet a sufficient number of instances are on record in which healthy children have been born, exhibiting the char- acteristic pitting of smallpox, and possessing no susceptibility to vaccina- tion. Again there are other cases in which pregnant women have small- The Practice of Osteopathy 415 pox and the babes in the wombs have escaped entirely; while the most singular fact is that while the fetus may experience the disease, the mother through whom the exposure was effected, escapes, either because of a previous attack or possibly because of vaccination. While there seems to be no reason for believing that an attack of smallpox can be, or ever has been, aborted by artificial means, yet there is a prevalent behef that this process occurred during certain epidemics of smallpox, cases having been known in which individuals presented all the symptoms indicating the invasion of smallpox, and yet no erup- tion occurred, and yet such individuals were thereafter insusceptible to smallpox or vaccination. The mortality of smallpox varies like the susceptibility of it — with the age of the patient and with some unknown conditions of the atmo- sphere or soil which favor the occurrence of the epidemics. The average in scattered cases — sporadic — is probably not greater than one in nine or ten. A fatal result occurs more frequently in the second week of the disease than at any other time. Pathology. — Granular and fatty degeneration occurs in the liver, spleen, kidneys and heart. Infiltration is found in the adrenal glands and testicles. During the papular stage, there is local hyperemia of the papillffi, with interstitial exudation and colhquative necrosis of rete cells, so that a vesicle is formed, peculiar in that it is traversed by delicate bands of epithelial cells. This, with the fact that coagulation-necrosis occurs mainly in the center, gives it the umbihcated, or depressed ap- pearance. The contents of the vesicle are plasma, fibrin and cell detritus. Leucocytic invasion converts vesicles into pustules. This has a more globular, elevated appearance than the umbihcated vesicle. Pyogenic organisms are found in the pus. When the inflammation injures the corium, scars are apt to result; this occurs when the skin is scratched. The actinic hght rays increase the danger. Diagnosis. — Mistakes in the diagnosis of the first cases of small- pox in an epidemic are almost inevitable. Hemorrhagic scarlatina or measles sometimes cause confusion; in the hemorrhagic scarlatina the mucous membrane hemorrhages are less frequent than in smallpox. The prodromal eruptions plus purpura arc very suggestive. The in- vasion stage lasts about three days. Smallpox is characterized by sudden onset with violent chill and shivering; agonizing pain in the back and legs; intense headache, mostly frontal; temperature rapidly reaching 102 to 104 degrees F.; full, strong, rapid pulse, going to 100 to 140; uncontrollable vomiting; pharyngitis; 416 The Practice of Osteopathy red face, bright eyes, coated tongue; anorexia; constipation; sleepless- ness; delirium; often copious perspiration and extreme prostration. An "initial exanthem, " clearing within 24 to 48 hours, appears. It is either hemorrhagic or erythematous. About the third day the true eruption appears, first upon the forehead and in the scalp, then the rest of the face, the backs of the wrists, trunk, arms, and lastly the legs, most abundant upon the parts exposed to the atmosphere. With the appearance of the eruption, all symptoms abate, the temperature falls, and the patient may feel quite comfortable. The eruption consists of coarse, red spots upon the body, like flea-bites, rapidly becoming, within 24 hours, slightly raised red papules, feehng hard and shotty to the touch, and each surrounded by a broad red inflammatory band, the areola. Usually by the sixth day the papules become converted into umbilicated ^'esicles, at first clear, then turbid. They are hard and indurated to the touch, and on the eighth or ninth day the}^ become pustular. The areola becomes much darker, the temperature rises to 103 to 105 degrees F., and the pulse to 110 to 120. The other symptoms all reappear, with saUvation and delirium. Marked edema of the skin renders the skin unrecognizable. The pustules are painful, especially in places where the skin is thickened. The maturation lasts about three days, when the fever falls by lysis. If fatal, death usually takes place about the tenth day, preceded by feeble and more rapid pulse, marked dehrium, subsultus and sometimes diarrhea. About the eleventh day, desiccation begins, the pustules begin to dry, forming tight scabs which are closely adher- ent. The fever and other s}^nptoms subside but itching becomes an- no jdng. The odor from the pustular stage on is a pecuHar greasy one. After the rupture of large pustules the centers frequently dry and sink in, often in the shape of the Maltese cross. This is most typically seen on the backs of the hands and is pathognomonic. Toward the end of the third week the scabs faU, leaving red ghstening pits which disappear or change into deep white striated scars. The hair falls but may grow again. The diagnosis is not certain until the eruption is seen. In the smallpox without eruption the diagnosis must be made from the history of exposure, the presence of an epidemic, fever, lumbar and head pains, delirium, and possibly the initial rash. Mistakes in diagnosis may be made even by smallpox experts, but attention to the history, somatic findings and the course of the disease, rather than to the eruption, will prevent disastrous results. Always iso- late any and all suspected patients. The Practice of Osteopathy 417 Varicella Compared with Variola Vaccination and smallpox never Smallpox may closely resemble prevent cliicken pox; especially mild cases. Age — usiiall}^ before puberty, may Usually after puberty (many ex- occur in adults, ceptions.) Initial stage practically absent. Temperature, — no remission on onset of rash. White cells normal or decreased. Prodromal rash very exceptional. Vesicles in crops. Vesicles rarely shotty. Rash Evolution, — Very rapid, vesicles on first or second day. Eruption is universal, successive crops, most abundant on back, begins on body, less on face, scalp, hands and feet. Vesicle is superficial and fluid trans- parent. Initial stage severe, even in mild cases. Typical remission and secondary fever. Leukocytosis. Prodromal rash quite frequent. Vesicles never in crops. Vesicles, following macules, are hard and shott5\ Rash Evolution, — Much slovv'er, vesicles on seventh day. Development progresses down- ward, face first, then wrists, trunk, arms and lastly legs. Less on trunk. Fluid pearl-colored and not trans- parent. Thicker covering. Halo (areola) usually absent. Involution is quite rapid. Areola is marked. Involution is slow. The Secondary Toxic or Septic Rash appears during the stage of decrustation, sometimes with a mild fever. It may be either scarlatini- forin, morljilUform, or hemorrhagic. The skin immediately surround- ing the drying pocks is often exempt leaving an anemic halo. The rash lasts about three days and fades or desquamates. With the develop- ment of the skin eruption, an exanthem appears upon the mucous mem- l)ranes of the body cavities, developing into ulcers. This may develop l)of()ro the dermal rash and be of diagnostic importance. 418 The Practice of Osteopathy Forms or Varieties ^ ^^ . , ^, (a. Discrete. I. variola Vera < , /■. n ( b. Confluent. I c. Purpura variolosa 11. Variola Hemorrhag- S (black smallpox) ica. ( d. Variola hemorrhagica pus- tulosa. III. Varioloid. e. Smallpox modified by vac- cination or partial immunity. Discrete Variola Vera. — Incubation symptomless and averages 12 days. Prodromal stage, from first symptom to eruption. Averages three days. The longer the stage the more severe the infection. Intensity bears Mttle if any relation to prognosis; however, if onset is mild, disease will not be confluent or hemorrhagic. Invasion begins with severe chill, often repeated. Initial fever rises suddenly to 103° or 104°, and reaches maximum on second or third day. Pulse is rapid and full. Skin is red, hot and dry. There may be sweating in the discrete form and in the favorable cases. The headache appears with the chill and is usually frontal. When severe and accom- panied with neckache and vomiting it may suggest meningitis. The backache appears with the chill and lasts about two days. It is a lumbar pain, ^'eiy hke lumbago; it occurs slightly less frequently than the head- ache and vomiting. This pain is rare in other fevers hkely to be con- fused with smallpox. Vomiting is constant in children and usual in adults. The initial eruptions, which are present in about 10 to 12 per cent, are of considerable diagnostic importance. They are usually lim- ited to the lower abdomen, inner side of the thighs, axillae, and some- times on the extensor surfaces of the knees and elbows. Tlie Eruptive stage consists of the following sub-stages: macules and papules; vesicles, and pustules. The macules and pa]iules occur on the fourth day and progress for about three days. They begin on the forehead, near the hair, with itch- ing and burning and resemble flea-bites. These soon become papules, which are reddish, elevated, circular, hard or shotty and discrete. On second day of this stage they appear on the body, and on the next day on the extensor surfaces of the extremities. If the eruption appears on the second day the confluent type may be anticipated; if on the third day of the disease, the discrete type. The Practice of Osteopathy 419 The vesicles which occur on about the seventh day of the disease, contain lymph. UmbiUcation occurs in the centers of many of the ves- icles, and it is suggestive of smallpox. The suppurative stage begins about the ninth day with clouding of the vesicles and inflammation around them. This continues for three days. The pustules become opaque, then yellow, and a thick pus oblit- erates the umbihcation. The inflammatorj^ "halo" becomes more vivid and edema may follow around these haloes. This edema causes in- creased tension and deformity, particularly of the face, and produces great tenderness and pain. The pustulation follows in the order of eruption, from the face downward, and are the thickest on the extremi- ties and head. The pustules evacuate spontaneously, or may dry up without rupture. The skin gives off a peculiar, offensiye odor. Bed- sores are now most Hkely to develop. The eruptions also may occur in the mucous membranes, particu- larly in the mouth and nasopharynx. These pass through the successive stages as do those of the skin, but less typically. With the pustulation there is usually a gradually rising secondary fever. In the discrete type the secondary fever does not remain high more than twenty-four to thirty-six hours, with morning remissions. A marked leukocytosis occurs with the secondary fever and its extent depends upon the sever- ity of the infection Dilirium, albuminuria, acute exhaustion and heart paralysis are to be guarded against during this stage. The state of involution, or decrustation, begins about the twelfth day. It follows the order of eruption, and is accompanied with a de- crease in edema, redness and pain, but is attended with intolerable itch- ing. Crusts form, the hair falls out and by the end of the second week the temperature returns to normal. If fever persists during this stage it indicates some complications. Scars occur when the true skin is in- volved and lasts three or four weeks. Complete convalescence follows the disappearance of the last crust. Confluent Variola Vera. — This is a mahgnant type and used to be more prevalent than now. The initial stage is violent, and the headache and backache very agonizing. The fever remission is very shght or absent, and attended with hardly any improvement in symptoms. The earUer the exanthem occurs in variola the more likely it will be of the confluent type. The confluent eruptions occur especially upon the face and head, sometimes on the hands and feet. It is largely discrete on the body and extremities. Great edema appears with the fusion of the eruption, with the swelling and erosion of the mucous membrane, the 420 The Practice of Osteopathy eyes close and the nostrils become obstructed. The fever is high,, pulse high and rapid (often irregular), dilirium, albuminuria, persistent nausea and vomiting, great thirst, husky voice, enlarged cervical glands, saliva- tion in adults and diarrhea in children are symptoms present. Death occurs from acute toxemia, usually within a week, but may last a little longer. Recovery from confluent variola is very infrequent. Purpura Variolosa. — This is "Black Smallpox." That is, small- pox with primary hemorrhage in the initial stages. It is the worst type and results almost invariably in death. It is very important be- cause it is so difficult to diagnose. Its incubation period is short (6 to 8 days), invasion very severe, lumbar pains almost unbearable, pros- tration great, pulse soft, small and rapid and respiration unusually high. The initial pains and vomiting ma^^ last until death. On the first or second day a plum colored eruption appears, with brick-red, purple or inky ecchymoses particularly about the eyes. The condition is desperate. Hemorrhages may occur from any cavity of the body, sometimes accompanied by gangrene of the pharynx. The dis- ease does not usually reach the period of real eruption, because death usually occurs within four or five days. The diagnosis of this condition is by history of exposure to smallpox and the characteristic prodromes. Variola Hemorrliagica Pustulosa. — This is the type with the secondary hemorrhage, or the hemorrhage after the eruption appears, and is more common than primary hemorrhage. It occurs in weakly and alcoholic subjects. The initial stage is severe, and the hemorrhages occur into the vesicles or pustules. There may be epistaxis, hematuria and metrorrhagia. The outcome is almost always fatal, though the hemor- rhage at the vesicular stage may be followed by rapid abortion of the rash and recovery. Varioloid. — This is modified or mitigated smallpox; also known as variola benigna. Persons exposed to smallpox sometimes suffer from varioloid, and persons who have had smallpox may suffer from varioloid at subsequent exposure to smallpox. Vaccination appears to initiate an attack in persons pecuharly susceptible, or as a result of im- properly performed vaccination. The lesions remain in the epidermis, the course of the eruption is shorter, the papules vesicate by the fifth day, the process of suppuration is abridged, decrustation occurs rapidly with little or no scarring, and all symptoms are milder. There are many modifications. Other varieties are (1) Variola sine exanthemate, which has the usual symptoms without the eruption; (2) Variola verrucosa, which has The Peactice of Osteopathy 421 large, solid, conical papules with small vesicles at their apices, which rapidly desicate and form crusts, and finally disappear without scars; (3) Variola cornea (horn pox) which is known by the large mahogany crusts. Complications and Sequelae. — Variola is often accompanied by many complications and sequalse which are an early severe toxemia and a later secondary infection. During the secondary fever, there may be bronchopneumonia, pleurisy, dysentery, hemorrhages of all kinds, ul- cerative eye, ear or laryngeal conditions, purulent arthritis, orchitis, gangrene when the swelhng is great and subcutaneous abscesses form, often attacking the penis and scrotum, erysipelas attacking the face, and rarely nephritis. During convalescence, carbuncles, boils and other subcutaneous abscesses are very common. Disturbances of the peripheral nervous system as neuritis, paralyses especially of the palatal muscles, neuro- retinitis, and otitis media are less common. The sequalse most common are boils, abscesses, deep pitting, otitis media, blindness and permanent baldness. The urine has the usual febrile changes. White islood cells reach 10,000 to 20,000 or more. Lymphocytosis occurs during pustulation; polymorphonuclear cells are decreased to 40%, sometimes to 12%; myelocytes and irritation forms are found. During the febrile stage there is a polycythemia followed by an anemia to 3,000,000 or less during the pustular stage. Regeneration is slow, lasting about fourteen days. Normoblasts are rare except in hemorrhagic forms. Exudate taken from the pustules show streptococci, staphylococci, and psuedodiphtheria bacilli. Treatment. — The imperative demands of treatment are isolation, ventilation, cleanliness and disinfection. If symptoms are suspicious of smallpox, notify the proper author- ities at once and isolate patient. When diagnosis is made, cut hair and beard very short. 1. Isolate patient in room free from draperies, rugs, carpets, cur- tains, pictures, etc. 2. Disinfect all vessels used in room of the patient in carbolic acid solution or in bichloride of mercury solution. 3. Family of patient should be isolated for from sixteen to twenty days. 4. Room should be well ventilated, with windows screened and slightly darkened with red curtains to exclude the ultra-violet rays of 422 The Practice of Osteopathy light. Temperature should be maintained at 65 degrees. Door- way- may be protected by a sheet dampened with a 1 :60 carbohc solution. 5. Nurse must be robust, perfectly immune and not afraid. If male nurse, hair must be very short and must have no beard; if female, hair must be short and must wear close fitting cap. 6. Absolute cleanUness is secured by plenty of baths, clean bed and personal linen, and careful nursing. Phj^sician must put on special suit with cap and gloves which are kept in the house, but not in the sickroom. The first sjinptoms being the headache, nausea and vomiting and the lumbar pains, the first points of attack in the treatment would be the relief of these pains in the head and back by thorough relaxation of the spinal muscles, paying particular attention to the suboccipital, mid- dorsal and lumbar areas. The headache may be partially relieved by steady pressure between the frontal and occipital regions. No inter- osseous adjustments requiring painful or difficult technique should be given after the more severe symptoms have appeared. Patient should be visited from one to three times per day, and the reflex contractures of the muscles must be relieved as often as they occur. Dysentery and diarrhea are controlled by strong inhibitory pressure in the sacral and lumbar regions. Give vasomotor treatment to the superior cervical ganghon. Stimulate the anterior aspect of the solar plexus to stir up its acid function, the blood being alkaline in smallpox. During all the stages up to the stage of pustulation, the patient re- sponds very readily and successfully to osteopathic treatment. The headache, the backache and the aching joints respond to treatment as readily as, if not more readily than, the headache and backache of in- fluenza do to osteopathic care. The constipation is usually quite readily relieved. It has been the experience of those who have handled small- pox cases, that the tendency to the confluent type is greatly reduced by this treatment and that the response of the patient to osteopathic treat- ment is very gratifying. Indeed, those of experience have less fear of the outcome of their smallpox cases than do they have of scarlet fever or pneumonia. After the pustules have formed, each pustule is treated with iodine painted on the pustule with a camel's hair brush. During the pustular stage it is not necessary to give manipulative treatment, and indeed it is sometimes impractical because of the tenderness of the skin. However, about all that is needed during this period is good hygienic treatment and good nursing. During convalescence constitutional treatment should be given. The Peactice of Osteopathy 423 Diet. — During period of vomiting, pellets of ice in the mouth are comforting. During periods of fever give plenty of water with, prefer- ably, lemon juice. As the fever declines begin with barley and oatmeal water with lemon juice; then follow with easily digested and nutritious diet of milk, eggs, broths, beef juice and gruels. Feed every three hours during that period but not large quantities. During convalenscence a full, well-regulated, nutiitious diet should be ordered. Hygienic Care. — Keep nose cleansed with glycerine, cold cream or ohve oil, which keeps the crusts soft. The mouth and nasopharynx may be cleansed with any mild antiseptic. The eyes are washed with warm boric acid solution. Cold compresses applied over the eyelids assist in reducing the edema. A daily tepid sponge bath is necessary. Bath may be given with bichloride of mercury solution (1 :20,000) or creolin (1:500). Headache. — Deep, steady digital pressure in the suboccipital fossa and at eighth thoracic spine; ice bag to the head; or a mustard plaster at the back of the neck may relieve. Vomiting. — Thorough relaxation and adjustment of the great splanchnic and cervical areas, with deep, steady digital pressure in the occipital triangles, and at the fourth and fifth dorsal vertebra on the right side will usually control the condition. Fever. — Relaxation of the upper dorsal area, relaxation of the cervical area, and deep, steady pressure in the suboccipital region often reduce temperature. Warm sponging in lower grades of fever, bath at 70° F., and cold pack may be needed. If temperature goes very high give a continuous cool colonic irrigation. Pitting. — Cold wet dressings of lint soaked in anj^ comfortable mildly antiseptic solution, or of ice water and glycerine, are to be used on the hands and face to prevent pitting. Hot water dressings are more comfortable to some patients. It is well to protect the skin from the light, especially from the ultra-violet rays. This, however, must not lead to any lack of ventilation. When crusts are forming keep them moist with vaseline, oil, glycerine, or carbolic acid in lanolin or vaseline. Odor. — Baths, the daily toilet and the use of dusting powder or o% iodoform powder, an open bottle of smelHng salts or of weak ammonia are good. Plenty of fresh air is best of all. Cardiac Weakness. — If pulse is feeble and frequent, a general quieting treatment should be given, including relaxation of the cervical area and of the fourth and fifth dorsal segments. An ice bag in flannel 424 The Practice of Osteopathy directly over the heart is often very useful. Gentle, careful spinal ex- tension is very restful and eases the spinal circulation. Delirium is usually reheved, or prevented, by spinal extension, the prolonged warm bath or the cold pack, if given when signs of nervousness appear. Morphia or chloroform may be necessarj'^ in violent and sui- cidal cases. Laryngeal Obstruction. — Usually caused by edema and may re- quire tracheotoni}'. Bed-sores. — These and abscesses may occur even under the best of care. Place patient upon a water-bed or in a continued warm bath. Convalescence is not complete until the skin is entirely free from crusts and is perfectly smooth. Prognosis. — Prognosis depends upon age of patient; comphca- tions; and environment from which patient comes, as well as upon the nursing. In varioloid the prognosis is recovery; in the discrete variety, good; in the confluent type over 50% are fatal; in the mahgnant types practically all die. In patients under five years old and over forty years old the prognosis is very grave. A filthy environment predisposes to complications. Recurrences seldom occur; second attacks are usually varioloid. Prophylaxis. — Usual rules of health authorities are: rigid quar- antine or isolation, vaccination, disinfection of the skin and all fomites, and final fumigation. Quarantine of a suspected individual is sixteen days after exposure. Isolation continued until every trace of eruption has disappeared. The dead body is very dangerous and a public funeral is not permitted. The clothes used by the patient must be steamed and other articles must be washed with bichloride of mercury and fumi- gated with formaldehyde vapor. Disinfection of the hands, face, beard and hair of attendants with bichloride solution is imperative. Vaccination (Vaccinia ; Cow^-pox) Definition. — Vaccinia is an eruptive disease of the cow, com- municable only by inoculation and causing, when transmitted to the human being, local reaction in the form of a pock and constitutional disturbances which are followed by a more or less lasting immunity against small-pox. Vaccination is the artificial inoculation of vaccine virus for the purpose of producing an immunity against small-pox. Arm to arm vaccination was formerly very generally practiced but has been practically discontinued because of the possibihty of mfection I The Practice of Osteopathy 425 from syphilis and other infections. When it is necessary to use the human l3Tiiph it should be taken upon the eighth day from a typical unbroken vesicle in a perfectly healthy child at least three months old. The vesi- cle must be pricked at several points, care being taken not to draw blood. The bovine vaccine l>Tnph is now in general use because it practically ehminates the possibiHty of syphiHs and other infections. Also because it is more easily traiisported. It is thought best by many authorities to vaccinate in infancy after the sixth month, at the seventh and eighth year, at puberty, and there- after at intervals of about seven years, but depending considerably on the prevalence of small pox. The virus is prepared under sterile condi- tions from carefully selected and tested calves. It is put up under asep- tic conditions in hermetically sealed capillary tubes or, in the old style, on ivorj^ points. There is a great variety of opinions as to the efficacy of vaccination in producing immunity against small pox, this variety of opinion being very prevalent among representatives of the medical schools. Dr. F. P. Millard of Toronto says the lymphatic system is the keynote, and that vaccine virus poisoning spreads through the lymphatics, causing diph- theria and allied throat affections. Dr. A. T. Still said, "We are opposed to vaccination." He repeatedly emphasized the fact that "Nature furnishes within the body all the remedies necessary to cure disease." In the recent Canadian epidemic (1919-1920) the medical authorities have met with a most strenuous opposition. The Homeopathic profes- sion, almost to a man, went on record as opposed to compulsory vac- cination. The Illinois Supreme Court has ruled that compulsory vac- cination is unconstitutional. Technic. — The area usually selected is the left arm at a point above the insertion of the deltoid muscle. Some prefer the leg over the junction of the two heads of the gastrocnemius muscle, because it is more easily cared for, and, because of the style of wearing short sleeves among women, it does not expose the scar which results from the vaccination. The surface must be washed, dried, with a soft towel, and then stcrihzed with alcohol. With a sterilized needle or lance scratch an area about a quarter of an inch in diameter, being careful not to produce bleeding but merely an oozing of pinkish lymph. A drop of the virus should be deposited upon the abraded surface, rubbed in with the side of the needle and let dry. A thin layer of sterilized gauze should be lightly applied and held by means of adhesive plaster, not encircling the limb. This should ])e occasionally removed and redressed. The 426 The Practice of Osteopathy pock should be kept dry and clean, and may be lightly dusted with starch or toilet powder. "Persons exposed to the contagion of small pox should be immediateh' revaccinated. The immunity conferred diminishes with time." It is the writer's personal opinion that, with the amount of complications that so frequently follow vaccination and with the fact that "it is necessary to revaccinate during an epidemic or after exposure, " it were better to defer vaccination, if parties are favorably incHned to the practice, until such time as the presence of small pox in the commu- nity make it apparently necessary. Typical Vaccination. — The period of incubation varies from three to five days. At the end of this time local reaction shows itself in the form of reddish papules at the point of inoculation. In about five days these develop into compound vesicles, which at first have clear and then later opaque contents. About the eighth day the vesicle is fully developed and is round or oval with prominent and well defined edges and a depressed center. An erythematous areola usually appears about the tenth day and the contents are purulent. The surrounding skin is swollen and tender, and a scab now begins to form in the center of the pock and rapidly extends toward its edges. About the end of the second week the areola fades, and the pock is changed into a thick brown- ish crust which becomes dry and hard, and comes off between the twen- tieth and twenty-fifth da3'S after vaccination. A dusky red scar is left and this gradually becomes white and pitted. During the evolution of the pock the glands through which lymphatic drainage takes place become shghtly enlarged and tender. The constitutional reactions are usually moderate fever, restless-, ness at night, irritabihty and loss of appetite. These symptoms usually appear about the fourth day and continue about three to five days. At an}^ time during the vaccinia erythema, roseola or urticaria may appear. The constitutional reaction in revaccination is sometimes very severe. There are many atypical symptoms following vaccination as var- iation in the number of the pocks, in the size, in the severity of the con- stitutional symptoms, in the contents of the pock, in the healing and for- mation of the scar and in the transmission of specific diseases as sj^philis, tuberculosis, leprosy, cancer and tetanus. Complications. — All cases are not benign, as due to impurity of vaccine, carelessness in technic, improper care in dressing, handling of the wound by the patient himself, scratching it with the finger nails, and other accidents of like nature, infections may set in and very serious The Peactice of Osteopathy 427 complications arise. These result in abscesses, erysipelas, tetanus and various eruptions. Otitis media may leave deafness. The writer knows personaU}^ of a young man in the Army during the World War who was vaccinated while in the Army and two abscesses developed which ate entirely through the arm, one abscess passing through the arm just anterior to the humerus and the other just poster- ior to it. It was many, many months in heahng, and nearly caused loss of the arm. There are many cases of record where vaccination was followed, di- rectly or indirectly, by paralysis, deformities, and chronic constitutional diseases. It is usually claimed these conditions were due to accidents following the vaccination and not due to the vaccination itself. How- ever, it can not be denied that the vaccination was at least the indirect cause of these deplorable conditions. General Vaccinia. — (Vaccinal eruptive fever; Vaccinola). This consists of a vaccine rash, developing usually from the fourth to the tenth day following vaccination, and appearing in various parts of the body, particularly about the wrists and on the back. The secondary pocks usually develop about the eighth or tenth day after vaccination and are usually more abundant on the vaccinated limb than on any other part of the body. As the pocks appear in successive groups, all stages of the disease may be seen at one time, and the condition may last for many weeks. Fever may be absent or present, but is usually proportionate to the extent of the eruption and the associated com- phcations. Treatment. — After vaccination, the patient should be told to return in seven days, when the dressings should be removed, and if the vaccination has been successful, a pearl-like vesicle will be present. If the vesicle has been broken by accident or by rubbing of the gauze, the free portions of the dressing should be cut away and the adherent part left undisturbed. A new gauze should be applied in any case, and in five or six dsbjs more, the dressing should be again changed, and this changing continued at intervals until the crust falls, which is usually during the third or fourth week. If no vesicle forms by the tenth or twelfth day, the vaccination has not been successful. It is suggested by the vaccination advocates that another attempt should be immediately made. Prognosis. — Uneventful recovery is to be usually expected. Pit- ting from generahzed vaccinia; various constitutional diseases; paraly- ses and other maiming disabihties sometimes occur. While it is not us- 428 The Practice of Osteopathy ually considered dangerous to life, there are nevertheless many cases of record where death has resulted. It is not wholly unattended with danger. The best of care should always be taken following vaccination to prevent the possibility of comphcations, though even then they do occur. Scarlet Fever (Scarlatina) Definition. — Scarlet fever is an acute, specific, contagious, infec- tive disease of unknown origin, characterized by very sudden onset, fever, vomiting, sore throat and diffuse exanthem. History. — It was first recognized in the sixteenth century, but first fully described and differentiated from measles bj^ Sj^denham in 1660. It was introduced into America about 1735. Etiology. — The causative organism or agent is unknown. The virus of scarlet fever produces severe necrosis, but no suppuration. The streptococcus is the most important factor in the production of compli- cations and in their mortahty. It is claimed to be the cause of the ma- lignancy of the disease but not of the disease itself. Susceptibihty to the disease is by no means universal as only 38% of children and but 5% of adults exposed to the infection acquire the disease. Over 90% of the cases occur under ten years of age, and rarely during the first year of Kfe. "Scarlet fever is a toxic superficial expression of internal malnutri- tive conditions of the blood as a tissue. The cause of the toxicitj' is usually over-feeding, or the feeding beyond the demands of the proxi- m.ate principles of the body, or the over-feeding under unhygienic con- ditions. " — J. Martin Little john", "It was once held that the virus was disseminated during des- quamation, but oral, nasal and otitic discharges probably perpetuate the infection, perhaps months after scaHng is complete. In no other disease is the virus so tenacious. It may persist ten years on clothes, furniture, etc. " — A. R. Edw^ards. The light forms are as contagious as the severe ones, and inocula- tions have occurred from the hving subjects as weU as from autopsy cuts. In degree of infectiousness smallpox ranks first, measles second and scarlet fever third. The infection may be spread b}^ any third per- son or by articles coming in contact with the patient, and often the mode is obscure. Sporadic cases apparently frequentty appear. The reason for the sporadic cases may easily be explained by the theory of J. Martin Littlejohn, given above. One attack usually confers immunity, but not The Practice of Osteopathy 429 always. This disease occurs more often in the autumn and winter, and is more prevalent in cities than in the country. (Measles is more preva- lent in the country.) Scarlatina sometimes occurs with other infec- tions, such as diphtheria or measles, and more rarely with varicella, per- tussis, etc. Predisposing Factors. — Age, one to ten years; lowered resistance from over-feeding, unhygienic environments, exposure to sudden tempera- ture changes; lesions, both muscular and interosseous which interfere with the distribution of the fluids and vital forces of the body; season of the year (autumn and winter); puerperal women, and wounds. Pathology. — No specific lesions are found. No trace of the rash shows after death except in the hemorrhagic form. The anatomical changes in cases coming to autopsy are those of simple inflammation, follicular tonsillitis, or diphtheroid angina. Streptococci are abun- dantl}^ found in the glands and foci of suppuration. Symptomatology. — Scarlet fever is divided into four stages: (1) Incubation, (2) Invasion, (3) Exanthem, (4) Desquamation. Incubation Stage. — Has no noticeable symptoms and lasts from two to four days. Some authors claim as high as ten to fourteen days. Invasion. — The invasion lasts one day. The onset is very sudden beginning with a chill which is followed by a characteristic vomiting, oc- curring in 75% of the cases, which is more frequent than in any other disease of childhood except pneumonia. The vomiting is followed by headache and the beginning evidence of sore throat, which usually soon develops into a tonsilHtis. The severity of the sore throat is indicative of the severity of the scarlet fever that follows. The temperature suddenly rises to 103° or more, the pulse becomes unduly rapid for the temperature, 120 to 160 per minute, and the respiration is increased. The skin begins to burn, there is dysphagia and intumescence of the cervical glands. The muscles of the back become hypersensitive to touch and to extremes of heat and cold; and particu- larly sensitive spots are found over the transverse processes of the first to 4th cervical vertebrae, the 4th and 5th dorsal and the 11th and 12th dorsal vertel^ra). At these points will be found intensel}^ contractured tissues which must be kept relaxed. Exanthem. — The eruption appears at the end of the first day or early the second day, showing first over the clavicles and on the neck, then over the upper trunk, next the lower trunk and Hmbs. The eruption on the extremities appears particularly over the flexor surfaces of the joints. By the end of the second day the eruption has^covcred practically the 430 The Practice of Osteopathy entire body, leaving a white circle about the eyes and mouth. The erup- tion pales, or disappears on pressure, quickly returning to the scarlet color on the removal of the pressure. Frequently, the skin itches and is very uncomfortable. A punctiform eruption in the arm-pits, over the groins, or on the roof of the mouth is considered positive proof of scarlet fever. The eruption at first consists of small red spots which fuse as the skin swells and results in an intense lobster-colored erythema. This lasts four to six days. The tongue, at first, is red at the tip and margins with a greyish-yellow or whitish fur in the center through which is often seen the swollen red papillae, the "strawberry tongue." The "fur" des- quamates on the third or fourth day, leaving a surface intensely red with marked raised, swollen papiUa?, the "raspberry or cat tongue," which lasts nearly a week. The breath has a heavy, sweet odor. The pharynx, u\aila and tonsils become swollen, and often creamy-white patches cover the mouths of the tonsillar folhcles. Between the second and third day the eruption reaches its height, when it has a vivid scarlet hue unUke any other eruption, and becomes darker each day until it ma}^ be a bluish-red, when it gradually fades and desquamation begins. By the seventh or eighth day the rash has dis- appeared, together with the fever. Desquamation. — Scahng begins on the face first, from the sixth to the ninth day and lasts several weeks. The skin looks somewhat stained, is a little rough hke "goose-flesh" and gradually the upper layer begins to separate, and the scaling begins in large lamellae or flakes. Casts of the fingers or toes may be shed. The swelhng of the glands dis- appears, and the fever falls by lysis, and convalescence begins, unless complications intervene. Diagnosis. — In typical cases diagnosis is easy, especially during epidemics or when the eruption is accompanied by other criteria. 1. Sudden onset, with nausea and vomiting, sore throat, quick appearance of fever and rapid development. 2. Punctate spots in the throat, swelling and dysphagia are usually present. The severe sore throat symptoms with the above are always very suspicious. 3. Strawberry tongue is constant. 4. Eruption, typical in character, appearing on second day, first showing on the neck above the clavicles, intense on the body and prac- tically absent around the mouth. Eruption confluent, with no inter- vening free areas of the skin, followed by desquamation. The Practice ^of Osteopathy 431 5. Lymphadenitis much more pronounced in the inguinal and other glands than in the cervical. 6. Desquamation, tender joints and albuminuria will force the conclusion of scarlet fever, if former symptoms have been indefinite. In the atypical cases we may have very light attacks with all the symptoms present but very poorly developed ; or some symptoms absent as in cases with no temperature, or others with no rash. Some cases are so atypical as to be impossible of diagnosis. The writer has very recently had the experience of one case when there were absolutely no typical symptoms present after being called on the case, but four days after the invasion of the disease in the patient a sister of the child developed typical scarlet fever, and not until the sixth day did any eruption or sore- throat appear, and then the eruption was more characteristically measles than scarlet fever. Consultants with the writer agreed with him that the case was one of an atypical, non-eruptive scarlet fever. Differentiation. — Scarlet fever is not always easily differentiated from other diseases, such as a septic rash, drug rashes, diphtheria, measles and German measles. A. R. Edwards gives this differentiation between scarlet fever and septic rash. Scarlet Fever Sepsis. Bright red erythema, with small A very deep purple-red rash, some- red papules, times spreading over the entire body. The eruption is much the same in both diseases, the same places being exempt. Miliaria are rare. Miliaria are frequent. Rather typical desquamation. JDesquamation observed less fre- quently. Criteria: angina, tongue, onset. Etiology, chills, sweats, fever ir- glands, etc. regularity, polymorphous exan- thems, etc. Diphtheria. — Often difficult to differentiate. The simple erythema is sometimes observed in diphtheria, but is darker, more on the trunk, and more transitory than in scarlet fever.Jgj Drug Rashes. — These rashes are caused by belladonna, iodoform, quinine, iodide, chloral, copaiba or aspirin. They may be easily dif- ferentiated if the cardinal symptoms of scarlet fever are considered in- 432 The Practice of Osteopathy stead of the rash alone. At the present time, perhaps the most fre- quent drug rash that we meet is that produced by aspirin. It is some- times hard to diagnose because the aspirin has been taken for a sore throat or tonsilUtis. which so resemble the early symptoms of scarlet fever. Measles and German Measles.— The symptoms of the invasion stage of these diseases is sometimes quite similar, and even the rash may be quite similar: the differentiation will be discussed under measles (q.v.). Types and Forms.— (a) Mild and abortive form (scarlatina sine eruptione). In this the rash may be scarcely perceptible, while the fever, sore throat and straw-berry tongue are present. Desquamation may be present and it may be followed with a severe nephritis. (b) Mahgnant forms, (1) Atactic variety, violent intoxication, onset of great seA-erity, fever very high (107° to 108°), extreme headache, delirium, and often convulsions. Initial dehrium gives place to coma; dyspnea may be urgent; pulse very rapid and feeble; and death occurs before eruption appears. (2) Hemorrhagic variety: there are hemor- rhages into the skin, beginning with scattered petechiae, becoming more extensive and ultimately involving the whole skin. It is characterized by severe fever and brain s:yTxiptoms at the onset; incomplete exanthem, necrosing angina, marked glandular and splenic sweUing; subcutaneous, serous and mucous membrane hemorrhages with ulceration. Death may take place on the second or third day. This is more common in enfeebled children, although it may attack adults in apparently full health. (c) Anginose form (Scarlatina anginosa.) This form resembles septic diphtheria, with marked toxemia, necrosis and adenitis. The throat symptoms appear early and progress rapidly. Temperature high, cyanosis, diarrhea, rapid weak irregular pulse, and stupor occur. The fauces and tonsils are covered with a thick membranous exudate which may extend to the posterior wall of the pharynx, forward into the mouth, upward into the nasal chambers, and may occasionally reach the trachea and bronchi. The Eustachian tubes and middle ear are usually involved.. The glands of the neck rapidly enlarge and become the seat of brawny induration, and the inflammation extends beyond their hmits. Necrosis occurs in the tissues of the throat, fetor is extreme, the consti- tutional symptoms are great and the child dies of toxemia. If he does not die, extensive abscess formation in the tissues of the neck takes place with sloughing and danger of hemorrhage from the opening of a large artery. The Practice of Osteopathy 433 Blood Pressure. — ^Rises at first, thereafter it follows the pulse and temperature. After the seventh or eighth day it may be below normal. Cases of albuminuria show hyperextension and slowing of heart action. With the subsidence of the kidney irritation the pulse rate is increased and the blood pressure returns to normal. Urine. — Shows ordinary febrile character, being scanty and high colored. Slight albuminuria is rather common after the stage of eruption, even a few tube casts may be present without any serious irritation of the kidneys. Urinalysis should be made daily. Blood. — The red cells are moderately reduced to 3,000,000 or 4,000,000 per c. mm. during convalescence. There may be some poikilo- cytosis, and normoblasts are occasionally seen. Leucocytosis is early, 15,000 to 30,000 per c. mm., faUing with the decUne of the fever usually by the fourteeneth day, but may persist for weeks after the temperature is normal. The count runs roughly parallel to the temperature. Over 40,000 leucocytes per c. mm. are of bad prognostic omen. Polymorpho- nuclear cells are increased to 80% or 90%; early returning to normal in favorable cases. Eosinophiha is present in all but malignant cases. It reaches its maximum two or three days after the rash appears and returns to normal after the leucocytosis has disappeared. The early presence of eosino- phiha excludes septic conditions. When these cells are absent in scarlet fever, myelocytes are to be found. Treatment. — Chnically scarlet fever represents, from the osteo- pathic viewpoint, (a) a toxic condition due to internal malnutrition and a decrease of the detoxinating function of the thyroid gland; (b) secondarily associated with the sore throat is a type of toxic tonsillitis, but it is due to the toxic elements in the blood; (c) in the lesion field it is associated with extreme stiffness and muscular tension in the upper cervical area and also in the entire dorsal area, overlapping the upper lumbar. The eruption is a superficial expression of the attempt of the body to ehminate the toxins, and this ehmination should be aided by enhancing the activity of all the other ehminative functions. Cases are on record where pa- tients have been exposed to scarlet fever, have gone the usual incubation period and developed the invasion symptoms, and by thorough, oft- repeated osteopathic treatments, with the aid of enemata and copious hot water drinking, have not gone beyond the invasion period and the disease apparently aborted within two or three days. It is therefore well to give thorough, oft-repeated attention to these cases during the very early stages. 434 The Practice of Osteopathy (1) In all cases where the first symptoms indicate the possibiUty of a contagious disease, the patient should be immediately isolated and kept isolated until all danger of contagion is past. In scarlet fever casess get a competent nurse. Keep room light, quiet and thoroughly venti- lated with a constant temperature of as nearly 70° as is possible. (It were better to have two rooms if possible, one for day and one for night: have room or rooms on upper floor if in a house). Arrange suitable means for thorough disinfection of all articles used in the sickroom. These are very essential. (2) Patient should be clothed in usual night wearing apparel. The bed clothing should be warm, but not heavy. The physician should wear an operating gown or a sheet which thoroughly covers his clothing, also a cap. He should carefully wash his face and hands immediately after leaving the sickroom. The quarantine should be maintained for the legally required period, and even after if there continue discharges from the nose, nasopharynx or the ear. Bichloride wrappings should be placed about the body of the dead, and funeral must be private. (3) Have enema given immediately to cleanse the lower bowel. Follow this with frequent draughts of hot water, or better hot lemonade for the first day. Place hot water bottles at feet. If eruption is slow in coming out, it may be aided by a hot bath, followed by wrapping the patient in warm blankets to prevent chilling. (4) Thorough osteopathic treatment should be given along the entire spinal area from the atlas to the sacrum, inclusive, to keep the muscles well relaxed, giving special attention to the relationship of the vertebrae and the tension of the muscles from the occiput to the fourth cervical; the third to the sixth dorsal; and the tenth to the twelfth dor- sal areas. Also give special attention to the deep cervical muscles, particularly those at the angle of the inferior maxilla, and at the articu- lation of the inferior and superior maxillae. Remember the tendency of the kidneys to complication in scarlet fever, therefore do not neglect the renal splanchnics, for here you not only control the renal functions but also regulate the adrenal functions and their internal secretions. Keep the clavicles properly adjusted and articulate them by bringing them well forward to relieve any irritation that may have started in that area. Careful direct treatment to the abdomen should usually be given at each visit besides the work in the splanchnic area to keep the bowels, kidneys and Hver active. Diet. — Water must be given freely. If fever is very high, pellets of ice held in the mouth will give comfort. During the height of the The Practice of Osteopathy 435 fever it is preferable to withhold all nourishment, but if in a particular case it seems to be indicated, confine the nourishment to fruit juices, especially oranges. Never force feeding during the fever. For infants cut down their feeding to at least 'half, making the milk very thin with water or gruel. After defervescence, carefully increase to a hght diet using sparingly of nitrogenous foods except milk. After four weeks in the usual case, gradually return to the ordinary diet. This is a good time to make corrections in the ordinary diet if any are needed. The bowels must be kept regulated. An enema is usually indicated after the onset of the disease. During the time that food is permitted it should be of a laxative character. During the fever stage the enema should be given daily to help keep the bowel cleansed and to help reduce the temperature. If bowels are persistently sluggish and the fever is constantly high the abdominal heatmg compress (so-called "cold com- press") will give much relief. The nose and throat should be constantly looked after. The nose may be cleansed by instillation by means of a medicine dropper, using normal salt solution. If the throat symptoms are mild, a gargle of warm normal salt solution is enough for cleanliness of the membrane. If the throat symptoms are too severe to permit the use of the gargle, or if the patient is too small to be taught the use of the gargle or to \ ash the throat, irrigation may be employed. The use of raw lemon juice, or of raw pineapple juice, on a cotton swab is of great value in cleaDsiijg the tonsils and throat. The swabbing should be repeated several times per day. The teeth should be carefully and thoroughly cleansed twice per day. The skin must be constantly cared for. During the fever it is well to cover the skin with linen or soft cotton. Daily sponge baths of car- boHzed water (1:40) of tepid temperature followed by applications of cocoa-butter will give much comfort. Use only good toilet soap and do not use the so-called antiseptic soaps because, authorities claim, there is a chance of renal injury. During the period of desquamation the use of the cocoa-butter will assist in limiting the source of infection by pre- venting the diffusion of the dry scales which are considered infectious by many physicians. A. R. Edwards says: "During desquamation, oil- rubs were once employed to decrease the dissemination of dry scales, but they decrease the function of the skin, which is of great importance when the kidneys are involved; also, infection is carried by means of throat secretions. Soap and water serve equally well." Some authori- 436 The Practice of Osteopathy ties suggest that during the desquamation, after bathing the patient, the skin should be thoroughly rubbed and then the oih" application used, using cocoa-butter, unmedicated cold cream, hquid albolene or the like. Olive oil and vasehne are usually irritating. The writer inchnes to the opinion that the soap and water bathing is sufficient, except perhaps the use of cocoa-butter over the areas that are desquamating severely. The temperature can usually be controlled by the usual osteo- pathic methods; steady deep pressure apphed in the sub-occipital region for a few minutes, followed by relaxing the muscles of the back from the first to the eighth dorsal, by raising and spreading the ribs in the mid-dor- sal area, and by light inhibition over the solar plexus. The tepid enema will assist in lowering the temperature. If temperature is high and pa- tient is delirius and has other nervous sjanptoms the cold pack is useful. The ice cap may be used almost constantly in high fever. If glands are swollen treat by crowding the tissues toward the gland but never work upon the gland itself. If pain is felt in the ear immediate attention must be given it. Cor- rect any deviations of the atlas or other upper ceri-ical vertebrae, relax the deep muscles at the angle of the jaw, and relieve any impingements in the lower cer\dcal and upper dorsal regions. The ear should also be treated with copious boric solution irrigations, as hot as can be borne and at low pressure. The condition of the ear drum membrane must be watched daily and if there is bulging and congestion it is safer to punc- ture the drum under cocaine than to await spontaneous rupture. Use small amount of boric powder after rupturing. The heart must be examined daily. Vigorous treatment through the thoracic region is indicated, if cardiac symptoms appear, and the patient must be kept quiet and in bed. If heart seems feeble it may be well supported by the cold packs directly over the heart. Nephritis is most common in the second and third weeks of the illness, but may develop later. In all cases where any symptoms of ne- phritis appear, light or severe, the patient must be confined to bed for at least four weeks, and kept on a milk diet. All irritants must be absolutely avoided. Hot baths should be given twice daily to increase the sweat and the urinary functions, the bath lasting half an hour and the patient kept afterward between blankets. Treat thoroughly, daily, the splanchnic and renal areas, paying particular attention to the tissue conditions in the lower dorsal region. In the milder cases, the urine contains albumin and a few tube casts, very rarely blood, and edema is shght or transient. Though the patient The Practice of Osteopathy 437 improves, he remains pale and there is a shght trace of albumin in the urine for months. If recovery does not take place, then chronic ne- phritis becomes established. In the more severe cases there may be a puffy appearance of the eye-lids, sHght edema of the feet, urine diminished in quantity, smoky, containing albumin and tube casts. The kidney symptoms dominate, dropsy persists and there may be effusion into the serous sacs. The condition may become chronic, the patient may succumb to uremia, but in the majority of cases recovery takes place. The nephritis may be hemorrhagic, in which the urine is suppressed or there may be a very small amount of bloody fluid laden with albumin and casts; constant vomiting and convulsions follow and the patient dies with symptoms of acute uremia. Other complications are arthritis, mahgnant endocarditis, severe toxic myocarditis and acute phlegmonous inflammation, the last three of which are usually fatal. Chorea is a fairly frequent nervous complica- tion. The mental symptoms are mania and melancholia. Progressive paralysis of the limbs with wasting, may simulate infantile paraylsis. The fever may persist after the eruption disappears and the child remain in a septic state (scarlatinal typhoid). Relapses are rare. Scarlatina may coexist with almost any other acute infection. It lowers the resistance of the body to disease and is often followed by other acute infections or by tuberculosis. Therefore the necessity of care during the entire convalescent stage. Measles (Rubeola; Morbilli) Definition. — Measles is an acute infectious, congatious, erythe- matous disease, occurring in epidemics, characterized by an initial coryza, bronchial catarrh and an eruption of a general maculo-papular type ; also by the presence of Koplik's buccal spots. Etiology. — Predisposing Influences: The chief predisposing factor in measles, as in all other contagious diseases, is a lowered resistance in which some structural or functional change has taken place that re- duces the functional activity of the body's inherent protective agencies. These predisposing factors may be classed under three heads, namely; (a) structural, (b) environmental, (c) dietetic. Under the first we find structural disturbances in the upper cervical area affecting the functional control of the nose, throat and head, as well affecting the thyroid and its internal secretions: structural disturbances in the upper and mid-dorsal 438 The Practice of Osteopathy areas affecting the vasomotor control to the head, neck, and chest, there- by perverting nutrition to all these structures and rendering them more susceptible to the infective organisms; also the dorsal lesions disturb the functional integrety of the lungs and heart, with the result of disturbed respiration and circulation, both of which are vital factors in body re- sistance: we also find structural lesions in the lower dorsal region, affect- ing the function of the kidneys and their elimination and the function of the adrenals and their internal secretions. Under the second or en- vironmental, we have unsanitary and unhygienic conditions, exposure to sudden changes of temperature, wet clothing, fatigue, etc., all of which produce secondary structural lesions and the effects above mentioned. Under the third or dietetic classification, we have the errors of diet so common in children and adults as well; such as too much candies and other sugars, also too much starches, as well as over eating and unbal- anced diet. Measles prevails in all climates and attacks all races, the Negroes appealing to suffer more severely than the whites and to be more subject to complications. Outbreaks are more common in winter and spring, but occur at all seasons. The disease is particularly a children's dis- ease but adults may contract it if not protected by an attack in early Hfe, and with adults the disease frequently manifests the more aggra- vated forms. It is more common after puberty than scarlet fever. Exciting Cause. — While the disease is probably produced by a micro-organism, it has not yet been demonstrated. Inoculation experi- ments upon human beings have shown the presence of the infecting prin- ciple in the blood, in the tears, in the secretions of the nasal, pharyngeal and bronchial mucous membranes, and in the contents of vesicles occas- ionally present. Inoculation with the epitheHal scales thrown off at the end of the disease has been unsuccessful. Ordinarily the transmission of the disease takes place through the breath or the nasal and bronchial secretions. The disease may be carried by a third person or by fomites. The infecting principle is intensely active, but not so tenacious nor per- sistent as scarlet fever. Measles is communicable throughout its entire course from the earhest appearance of the coryza. The individual pre- disposition toward measles is apparently so general that few, upon expos- sure, escape it, though we have observed cases where children have been directly exposed and who were immediately thereafter put under osteo- pathic care and did not develope the disease. Second, or even third, at- tacks may occur at intervals of some years, but these are unusual. Spor- The Practice of Osteopathy 439 adic cases do occur and are often the starting points for epidemics. Ex- tensive outbreaks occur at intervals of five or six years. The incubation period is from seven to eighteen days, usually about ten days. Symptoms. — Prodromes are common, usually consisting of loss of appetite, restless sleep, fretfulness, and often feverishness. There are three stages, (a) Invasion, (b) Eruption, (c) Desquamation. (a) Stage of Invasion. The prodromal symptoms are intensified. There is often chilHness but seldom distinct chills. The temperature rises, often reaching 102 to 104 degrees, upon the first and second day. It then falls one degree or more to rise again upon the appearance of the eruption. Nausea, vomiting and headache are often present. The tongue is furred. With these symptoms coryza has developed and is sometimes intense, often simulating severe influenza. Irritation and smarting of the eyehds, lachrymation, photophobia, persistent sneezing, running of the nose, sore thi'oat, discomfort in swallowing, hoarseness, and cough, at first of a croupy character, appear in rapid succession and with varying intensity. These initial catarrhal symptoms are character- istic and occur in the mildest cases in which chilliness, fever and the as- sociated signs of the reaction of the organism to general infection are not observed. The vessels of the conjunctivae are injected, the eye- lids swollen, the nasal mucosa tumid and reddened. The mucous mem- brane of the mouth and throat is erythematous, while upon the soft pal- ate and the roof of the mouth, and particularly upon the buccal mucous membrane, are to be seen pin head or spht-pea sized, circumscribed, round or irregularly shaped reddish blotches slightly or scarcely at all raised above the surrounding tissues, usually discrete, but sometimes con- fluent. This eruption also shows itself in the larynx and is undoubtedly the cause of the croupy cough and other throat sjTiiptoms. In a strong light there may be seen upon some of the spots on the mucous membrane of the cheeks and hps minute bright whitish, or bluish-white flecks which are called Koplik's Spots. These spots appear early and soon disap- pear, and as they are not found in any other disease they are of value in the early diagnosis of measles. The duration of this stage is usually three or four days; rarely it is shorter or it may be as long as a week. (b) Stage of Eruption. On about the fourth day the temperature again rises, increasing as the rash develops, often to 104 or 105 degrees and reaching its maximum about the sixth day when it usually falls by crisis; followed on the seventh or eighth day by normal temperature. The pulse rate increases with the fever, often reaching 140 or higher. 440 The Practice of Osteopathy The eruption iisualty appears on the fourth day, and shows first about the hair line on the forehead, spreading to the face, chest, trunk and the arms and legs. The eruption is attended by itching and burning, and completely develops in from twelve to thirty-six hours, the catarrhal symptoms persisting during this time. During this time, in the more severe cases, delirium or stupor may be present, and the patient com- plains of sore throat and general discomfort, and is restless and wakeful. Usually upon the second or third day of the eruption, great and rapid amelioration of all these symptoms takes place and the fever falls to normal or sub-normal. When the eruption is fully developed the indi- vidual spots are irregularly circular or oval, and diiffer greatly in size, averaging about the size of a split pea. The eruption is unevenly set, but usually close together and sometimes confluent, especially on the face, buttocks, hands and feet. Frequently they take on a crescentic arrangement and the spots are circumscribed, the intervening skin being normal or slightly hyperemic. About the ninth day the rash begins to disappear, on the face first, then the neck and the rest of the body iu about the same order as the eruption appeared. The skin takes on a yellowish discoloration and the rash disappears in a bran-like desquamation which lasts several days to a week. In the beginning of the stage of eruption, and in many cases throughout its course, the skin is moist and often bathed in free per- spiration. At the height of the eruption the superficial lymphnodes of the neck, and elsewhere, are often slightly swollen and tender. (c) Stage of Desquamation. The fine branny scales of desquama- tion are often so fine as to be easily overlooked. This process occupies about a week. The catarrhal symptoms in uncompHcated cases gradu- ally disappear, so that, by the end of the second week from the initial coryza, convalescence is fully established. The cough frequently per- sists and is of a bronchial nature. Epitaxis is common at the height of the attack. Relapses of measles are extremely rare. Diarrhea is apt to occur at some time during the attack, without any particular signifi- cance. Varieties. — Atypical cases may occur but are not common. Thej^ are as follows: (1) Morbilli Papulosi, development of distinct papules, hard to the touch but not extending deeply into the skin. (2) M. Vesicular; a vesicular form. (3) M. Sine Exanthema, cases in which the eruption does not appear, but general symptoms and coryza are present. (4) M. Sine Exanthema, in which the mucous membranes are not involved. The Practice of Osteopathy 441 Variations in constitutional symptoms. — (1) M. Afebriles, rare cases in which there is no rise of temperature. (2) M. Hemorrha- gica. This is the malignant form and in it the organism is unable to withstand the intensity of the infection and death takes place in the course of two or three days after sustained hyperpyrexia, profound adynamia, or hemorrhages into the skin and mucous membranes. These malig- nant forms are very rare in private practice, but they occasionally occur in asylums and in the fierce epidemics of camps, and were common in the first outbreaks among the natives of the Fiji Islands, where measles prevailed as a scourge. Death may occur before the rash appears or a few papules may show themselves upon the forehead and wrists. This is also known as black measles, and it is characterized by convulsions, delirium and coma, petechiae, bleeding from the mucous surfaces and profound constitutional depression. The patient is rapidly exhausted, the pulse frequent and thready, the skin pale and cold, and death oc- curs. (3) Adynamic measles is a serious type in which the symptoms are grave from the onset but without hemorrhages and a t3^phoid status is early present. Complications. — In the absence of complications, measles is com- paratively a benign disease, but these complications are frequently enough present to place measles among the more serious diseases of childhood. The ordinarj^ complications are due to the extension or intensification of the catarrhal processes peculiar to the disease. (1) Otitis media is quite common, and msiy result in perforation of the tympanic membrane and permanent impairment of the hearing; or lead to sinus thrombosis, meningitis, or abscess of the brain. (2) Bronchopneumonia is the most common complication. (3) Purulent conjunctivitis may occur and in neglected cases infiltration and ulcera- tion of the cornea. (4) Catarrhal laryngitis is a frequent complication. (5) Pseudo-membranous type is very uncommon but very dangerous. (6) Edema of the glottis is not common but does occur. (7) Diphtheria is much less common in measles than in scarlet fever. The high death rate of measles is due to the bronchopneumonia compUcation in which the lesions become extensive, the symptoms become urgent and a large proportion of these cases die. (8) Acute enterocolitis is a frequent and s(M'ious complication. (9) Gangrenous stomatitis occurs in young and debilitated children, and in girls gangrene of the pudenda occur during convalescence with greater frequenc}^ than in other infectiouss diseases. Sequelae. — The more common sequelae are chronic local infiam- I 442 The Practice of Osteopathy mations, conjunctivitis, otitis, nasal catarrh, laryngitis, and bronchitis. Tuberculosis is a common sequel. Diagnosis. — During an epidemic, coryza, persistent sneezing and fever are suspicious. The appearance of the eruption on the third or fourth day upon the mucous membrane of the mouth and throat, and Koplik's spots are positive. Measles is often confused with 1. Rubella or German measles, 2. Variola, 3. Typhus Fever and 4. Scarlet Fever, which see. Oc- casionally drug exanttiems are confused with measles. These may be caused by salicylates, antipyrin, quinine, turpentine or copaiba. These rashes are not accompanied by fever or throat symptoms unless they have been given to allay these very conditions. Treatment. — Measles is so often a serious disease that it should not be attended with carelessness as it so often is, but the best of care and attention given. Parents should be informed of the danger of com- phcations and of the absolute necessity of proper care and attention. As soon as a susceptible individual is exposed to the measles, he should be immediately isolated, watched and corrections made of any dietetic errors, unsanitary conditions or structural lesions that may exist. He should be protected from sudden atmospheric changes and carefully watched for the first symptoms of the prodromal coryza. On the appearance of the prodromal, or invasion symptoms the patient should be put to bed in an isolated, well-ventilated room of as nearly constant temperature as is possible, from which all hangings, rugs and unnecessary funiture have been removed. The windows must be shaded to protect the eyes from direct or strong light, and any artificial lights in the room must also be well shaded. The cases can usually be easily handled by careful, well-directed osteopathic treatments. In the manipulative treatment we must pay especial attention to the muscular and other soft tissue conditions in the suboccipital region, over the transverse processes of the upper four or five cervical vertebrae, under the angle of the lower maxilla and the lateral cervical tissues to remove any obstructions to the circulation and nerve control of the head and throat; see that the muscles in the lower cervical and upper dorsal areas are kept well relaxed, and articulation of these vertebrae, the upper three ribs and the clavicles are kept free; remove all lesions in the mid dorsal area, whether muscular or otherwise, to prevent involvement of the lungs or heart, and' to keep up function of the respiratory and circulatory systems ; treat and keep normal the tis- sues and the articulations at the kidney and adrenal center, 11th and 12th The Practice of Osteopathy 443 dorsal; raise the ribs and keep them freely movable, this especially for the bronchial cough. Painful manipulations should be avoided and are not necessary. Dr. Still said, "The arms must be raised and the axillary region freed and kept so." During the acute stage two or three treat- ments per day are advisable. Do not treat severely or to cause discom- fort to the patient. Best results are obtained in the gentle, but thor- ough, treatments. In the beginning of the case have the bowels cleansed with an enema, and then careful attention must be constantly given to the bowels and kidneys. The bowels can be kept open by manipulations and diet. The diet should be light and easily digested; during the fever it is best to withhold all food but give plenty of water. Follow fast with fruit juices and then the Kght diet. The temperature is usually controlled by treatment, but if it remains high for some time and if the physician cannot reach the patient, the nurse should be directed to give a tepid sponge bath of ten to twenty minutes duration, and repeated at intervals of two or three hours. Also the tepid enema will often reduce the temperature. For the itching of the skin, a tepid bath with water at 100 degrees given twice daily should be used, the patient dried carefully, and an appH- cation of oHve oil, cold cream, liquid albolene, or a two per cent menthol salve, rubbed over the entire body will give rehef . The cough is best reUeved by thorough treatment of the anterior thoracic regions and the correction of any upper rib or clavicular lesions. Keeping the air of the room moist with vapor is agreeable to the mucous membranes. The dropping of a few drops of eucalyptus oil in the boihng water produces a very soothing vapor. If the eyes are much involved, they should be bathed every hour or two with a three per cent solution of boric acid, using cotton which is immediately destroyed after use. Dark glasses in a well ventilated room is better than an unaired darkened room. The nose and mouth should be carefully cleansed at regular inter- vals and the cloths burned. The throat should be carefully examined daily at first, and at least every other day later, until the case is discharg- ed. The conditions of the lungs must be observed by daily examinations, and the lung and bronchial areas should be daily treated to prevent the possibility of respiratory involvement. If rash is slow in appearing and the temperature is high, a hot l)ath (105 to 110 degrees) for three to five minutes will often bring out the rash and relieve the more serious symptoms. During convalescence the 444 The Practice of Osteopathy patient must be protected against cold. Recovery is hastened by the continuation of treatment during convalescence and treatment given should be indicated by the symptoms present. Prognosis. — Practically all uncompHcated cases recover. In the hemorrhagic and adj^namic types, the majority succumb. One attack usually confers immunity. Sequelae are frequent under the "old school" treatment, but are infrequent under careful, conscientious osteopathic treatment and careful nursing. "In and of itself measles is usually not particularly serious, but the after-effects are so far-reaching and so serious that students of the his- tory of medicine rank measles third among infectious diseases for causing death. During recovery from measles the patient stands in special danger from pneumonia, and pneumonia following measles is more dan- gerous than uncomplicated pneumonia. There is a considerable length of time during which he is particularly susceptible to tubercular infection. This is so often insidious, and its evidences are so obscure, that by the" time the disease has fully developed, one may have forgotten the mild attack of measles which really paved the way for the serious malady. " — C. A. Whiting. Rubella (German Measles; Rubeola notha; Rotheln; Epidemic Roseola) Definition. — A specific acute, contagious, infectious, eruptive dis- ease, characterized by a diffuse maculopapular eruption and swelKng of the superficial Ijmiphatic glands. It is attended by a mild fever, suffused eyes, mild cough, slight sore throat but no catarrh, a macular rose-red eruption of the throat accompanied by the swelHng of the cervical Ijonph glands and by a rose-red eruption of irregular size and shape appearing on the fii'st day of the disease. Rubella, in some ways, resembles scarlet fever and also measles and was at one time considered a hybrid of the two. It is now known to be an independent disease. Etiology. — The exciting cause, or the infective principle, has not yet been discovered. The disease is probably carried by fomites, is read- ily transmissable, attacks children especially, and usually occurs in epi- demics, though sporadic cases are frequently found. The epidemics usually occur at intervals with several years intervening, during which time there are comparatively few cases. Persons of all ages are suscepti- ble unless having acquired an immunity through an attack of the disease at some former time. Rubella does not confer immunity against any The Peactice of Osteopathy 445 other disease, as scarlet fever or measles, nor do these diseases confer im- munity against rubella. One attack of rubella confers immunity against any succeeding attacks. The incubation period is from five to twenty-one days and is without symptoms. The predisposing factors are the same as in measles or other infec- tious or contagious diseases. Symptoms. — Invasion Period. This stage is usually of very short duration, lasting from a few hours to perhaps two days. The initial symptoms are usually mild, being a sudden chilliness, but not chills; mild fever of about 100 degrees; a shght headache; mild sore throat; swollen cervical and post auricular lymphatic glands; Mttle or no coryza; sometimes shght pains in the back and legs; and the macular rose-red eruption in the throat which is constantly present. Often the initial symptoms are so mild that the presence of a disease is not recognized until the eruption appears, which usually occurs on the first day and rare- ly not until the fourth day. Eruption Period. — The rash, which consists of round or oval reddish spots about the size of a split pea, mostly discrete, but sometimes confluent, and surrounded by areas of hyperemic skin, usually shows first upon the face and follows a wavehke progression over the bodj^ and Hmbs. The rash usually begins to fade upon the face before it has ap- peared upon the last affected areas, and usually remains in one region from a few hours to a half day. It extends over the entire body in from twenty- four to thirty hours. Occasionally the skin is so hyperemic in exten- sive tracts that the rash more resembles scarlet fever rather than measles. The crescentic arrangement of the papules usually seen in measles can not be made out in rubella. In the course of two or th]-ee days the rash disappears with very fine desquamation, leaving a faint pigmentation, which remains for a short time. Shght etching usually accompanies the rash. Relapses are rare and comphcations infrequent. There are no special sequelae, but albuminuria, bronchitis and pneumonia have been noted. Although one attack usually confers immunity, second attacks have been reported, which may have been real second attacks or the first attack may have been an error in diagnosis. Diagnosis. — Early or sporadic cases may present great difficulty in diagnosis, but when an epidemic is present diagnosis becomes much easier. The direct diagnosis of the disease rests upon the very mild na- ture of the disease, its short initial onset, the character of the eruptions 446 . The Practice of Osteopathy and the early enlargement of the glands with the absence of severe throat symptoms and coryza. Rubella is frequently mistaken for mild cases of measles or scarlet fever. Unlike measles, it does not have the prominent catarrhal symp- toms, the higher fever, the crescentic grouping of the eruption and Koplik's sign. In measles the adenitis is not so severe as in rubella, and especially are the sub-occipital and post-auricular glands involved in rubella. Scarlet fever has a very sudden onset with severe symptoms, a very sore throat, the characteristic tongue and the pecuHar rash, all of which are decidedly different from rubella. In the latter stages the character of the desquamation is also a distinguishing feature. Treatment. — Patient should be kept in a properly heated and well ventilated room, being careful that no draughts chill the patient, and should remain in bed for at least two days. Patient should be iso- lated. Treatment should be directed to the upper cervical, mid-dorsal and lower dorsal areas to keep normal the function of the internal secret- ing mechanism, and to normalize and keep normal the respiratory and circulatory systems. Treat carefully to upper lymphatics, working around the enlarged glands and not directly over them. Watch the excretory functions and keep them active by judicious measures. If annoying itching occurs, the hot bath followed by being wrapped in a soft warm blanket will usually relieve. Daily tepid sponging should be given and if hot bath does not relieve itching an application of olive oil or cold cream will often relieve. Diet should be reduced and regulated ac- cording to age of patient and severity of the case. Usually the above is all that is indicated, but if more severe symptoms present themselves vary your treatment according to the symptoms present. Prognosis. — Recovery is the general rule. Relapses sometimes occur, and are usually much more severe than the initial attack. The symptoms are often more severe in adults than in children. Like measles, this disease seems to lower resistance to other infections, and therefore especial care should be taken to protect the patient from exposure to other diseases for some time after recovery from rubella. See that the pa- tient is built ap constitutionally after recovery by plenty of fresh air, suitable exercises and good food. Varicella (Chicken Pox) Definition. — ^Chicken pox is an acute, specific, contagious, slightly febrile, eruptive disease, usually of childhood, affecting the whole or- The Practice of Osteopathy 447 ganism through the blood. It is an epidemic disease that spreads rapid- ly, is highly contagious but not inoculable, and confers immunity. History. — Varicella was first recognized about 1553 and was dis- tinguished from smallpox by Trousseau. Etiology. — The agent that causes the disease is not known; the dis- ease usually affects children under ten years of age, but does occasion- ally attack adults. It bears no relation to variola, except the very shghtly similar eruption. It is transferred by direct personal contact, by the air or by a third person. It is infective from the first symptoms until all the crusts have disappeared. Although the disease usually oc- curs in epidemics, frequently we see sporadic cases. As in all other contagious or infectious diseases the predisposing causative factors are those conditions which lower the resistive powers of the body, such as fatigue, improper diet, exposure to sudden tempera- ture changes and imperfect ehmination of the bodj^ wastes. The struc- tural lesions found as predisposing factors are contractured muscles of the neck and behind the jaw, and muscular and interosseous lesions of the upper cervical, mid-dorsal and dorso-lumbar areas, also of the clav- icle and upper ribs. Symptoms and Diagnosis. — There are three stages to the disease: (1) Incubation, (2) Prodromal, (3) Eruptive. 1. Incubation Period. — This period lasts about fourteen days though it may vary from seven to seventeen days. During this period there is practically no symptomatology except perhaps the last two or three days, when the child shows evidence of a little excitabihty and irri- tabihty. Often on the day before the first noticeable symptoms the child appears even more active than usual. 2. Prodromal Stage. — Prodromal symptoms are not common and usually last but about twenty-four hours. The first noticeable symptom is the irritabiHty of the patient, which is followed by a temperature, usually 99° to 101°, which temperature persists during the course of the disease. There are sometimes thirst, anorexia, constipation, seldom vomiting, and a furred tongue. Some cases have been observed to have the following as prodromal symptoms, but these we beheve are usually due to concurrent conditions that exist at the time of the infection: delirium, convulsions, angina, conjunctivitis, dysphagia, bloody vomit- ing and stools, and an initial erythema, usually scarlatiniform. 3. Eruptive Stage. — The eruption comes within twenty-four hours and is often the first symptom that is noticed. It appears first as hyper- cmic macules and then rose-colored papular spots, somewhat compar- 448 The Practice of Osteopathy able to the typhoid roseobie and not hard. These papules rapidly be- come raised, flattened, ovoid, pin-head to pea-sized vesicles containing a fluid at first watery and then pearly. They disappear on pressure. The vesicles mature within twenty-four hours, are very superficial, and leave a shght areola about them, which is not inflammatory as in small- pox. The eruption appears first on the chest and then on the neck, face, scalp, and then trunk and Hmbs in the order named. The erup- tion is most abundant upon the back, and over the entire body they may number anywhere from eight to many hundred and are usually scattered. The vesicles are not umbilicated, but some may have slightly de- pressed centers, are discrete, and appear in successive crops which re- (juire from three to six days to complete. Pustulation and hemorrhage into the vesicle rarely occur. On the third or fourth day yellowish- brown crusts form and gradually disappear. Scars may result from scratching or infection. By the fifth day we may find all stages of the eruption because of the appearance of the successive crops. There may be an efflorescence upon the mucous membrane of the oral cavity and of the pharynx causing slight difficulty in deglutition. The itching may be more or less intense. As stratching may cause pitting it should be guarded against. The fever which is usually slight may persist during the entire eruptive stage, but if it is high and persists as high temperature it suggests compHcations. Muscular tension of the cervical muscles, especially those in front, and around the angle of the inferior maxilla are usually found, and often the clavicles are bound down, and relation of ribs is disturbed. Ulceration sometimes follows scratch- ing, and even gangrene may appear around the vesicles in debilitated children, especially those who are tubercular or congenitally syphil- itic. It is apt to be fatal in these cases. Complications of tubular nephritis, which occurs within two weeks; cardiac hypertrophy; uremia; otitis media; and bronchial affections, are sometimes met with. Treatment. — Isolate patient so as not to come in contact with other children. The younger children should be put to bed until the crusts have formed; older children may be allowed to be up around the room if their cases are light. Pay particular attention to the muscular lesions of the neck, lower maxilla, mid-dorsal and dorso-lumbar regions, keeping them relaxed by gentle relaxing treatments. A general systemic treatment is soothing and helps to prevent comphcations. "Be very careful and very thorough in your neck adjustments. Loosen the atlas and axis and draw forward the inferior maxilla from its pressure upon the vessels and nerves back of its angle. Draw the hyoid The Practice of Osteopathy 449 bone forward and secure good circulation of blood throughout the entire cervical area. " — A. T. Still. Give treatment at the 4th and 5th dorsals to stimulate the super- ficial circulation and thus increase elimination through the eruption as well as the sweat glands. Remember the eruption is the expression of the body's attempt to eliminate the toxins within. Keep the bowels active by splanchnic and abdominal manipula- tions and by laxative diet. . If bowels are persistently inactive use ene- mata. Diet should be bland and easily digested. During fever, diet should be liquid or better restricted, giving only water in abundance. During the eruptive stage do not use tub baths. Daily tepid sponges with either plain water or boric acid solution answers both as an anti- septic wash and bathing. After the daily sponging, and as often as necessary to control itching, anoint with a 10% boric acid ointment or with carboHzed vasehne. If scratching can not be controlled, the hands should be tied in musHn bags. As in smallpox the ultra-violet rays seem to irritate the eruptions and to increase the tendency to scarring, there- fore the windows and lights should be screened with a dull red material. Prognosis. — Invariably favorable unless compHcations set in, which is seldom. Recurrences are very rare. Prophylaxis. — The child should be kept in quarantine for three weeks or until the skin is entirely clean. Epidemic Parotitis (Mumps; Epidemic Parotiditis) Definition. — Mumps is an acute, infectious, contagious disease, occurring in limited epidemics, and characterized by inflammation of the salivary glands, particularly the parotid, swelling sHght fever and pain over the involved glands. There is special Habilitj^ to orchitis or to mastitis. Etiology. — Predisposing Factors: Mumps is peculiarly a disease of childhood and adolescence, not being common in infancy or after the twentieth year. It affects boys nearly t\yice as often as girls. Mandi- bular and upper cervical lesions, both of the interosseous and soft tissue types, are undoubtedly potent presisposing factors, as they obstruct and interfere with nerve and circulatory function to the glands affected. Also any condition which lowers the child's resistance to infections makes them more susceptible to this disease than to any other, these conditions being fatigue, exposure to dampness and sudden weather changes, dietetic errors, etc. The cases are more numerous in the spring and autumn 450 The Practice of Osteopathy seasons. Extensive epidemics are infrequent, but do occur in reforma- tory institutions and children's homes. It is much more wide-spread in large cities than in the country or villages. Exciting Cause; The specific cause has not been demonstrated. The disease is usually transmitted by direct contact, but there are in- stances where it has been transmitted by a third party or by fomites. There are two views as to the mode of infection ; the first being that the active principle travels along the course of the salivary ducts from the mouth to the glands, probably most often through the duct of Stenson to the parotid gland. This is the most generally accepted theory. The second is that the infection is a general one to which certain structures are more susceptible, principally the sahvarj^ glands, and the parotid in particular. Symptoms. — The period of incubation is from fourteen to twenty- one days. Prodromes are usually absent, though in the more severe cases constitutional disturbances, with chilhness, vomiting and mild fever may precede the local inflammation. In the milder cases the local swelling may be the first manifestation of the disease. The temperature is usually moderate but may rise to 103 or 104 degrees in the more severe cases. The left side is more often affected than the right. The disease is characterized by a feeHng of tension with soreness just below the ear. Soon a slight swelhng may be observed directly under the ear and in the course of forty-eight hours it reaches its maximum size. The parotid gland becomes greatly enlarged and the adjacent tissues of the neck and face become tense and edematous. The skin becomes hard and glossy and usually white in color because of the obstruction to the circulation from pressure. The swelling is between the angle of the jaw and the mastoid process, pushing the ear upward and its lobule is pushed sharply outward. In the majority of cases the other side becomes affected in two or three days, but sometimes the spread of the disease to the other side is delayed for several days, and occasionally the other side escapes the infection. Frequently the swelhng of the other side is so sUght that it is only recognized by the closest scrutiny. Infrequently the sub- maxillary glands become affected without involving the parotid glands, but these cases are rather rare. The patient is usually unable to open the mouth without considera- ble pain; acids, and rarely sweets, produce spasms of the jaw muscles; speech and even deglutition are difficult; the salivary secretions are usu- ally increased but quite frequently they are decreased. The breath is foul and the tongue is furred. The mucous membrane of the cheek and pharynx are reddened and there may be a slight angina. The Practice of Osteopathy 451 The spine shows subluxations of the upper cervical area, particularly of the atlas and axis, also upper rib lesions and upper dorsal lesions are frequently found. The lesions of the second and third dorsal, and their ribs, are most frequently found when the submaxillary gland is involved. The symptoms persist from six to fourteen days, when the swelKng disappears and the patient regains normal health. Orchitis occurs in about one-third of the cases after puberty. In infancy and childhood it is extremely rare. Usually one testicle is involved, and is characterized by weight, swelling and pain in the scrotum. The testicle may become greatly enlarged when the pain becomes intense. Atrophy may result and if both testicles are affected the loss of reproductive abihty may re- sult. In females, usually after puberty, the breasts may become enlarged and tender, pain and tenderness of one or both ovaries, hematoma of the labia, or a vulvovaginal discharge may occur. • However these com- plications are very rare. As a rule the patient is not very sick and relap- ses are very uncommon. The attack confers immunity which is practic- ally permanent. Diagnosis. — Under ordinary conditions, especially during an epi- demic, the diagnosis of mumps is very easy. The swelHng in front of and below the ear, with the displacement of the lobule outward is quite indicative of mumps. The relative rapidity with which the swelhng ap- pears, develops and subsides is characteristic of mumps. In acute cervical adenitis the swelUng is below the angle of the jaw and does not at any time correspond with the outhne of the parotid gland. In Hodg- kin's disease, which is a chronic affection of the lymphatic glands, the salivary glands are not involved. Treatment. — The patient should be kept away from other children, and should remain in a well lighted, well ventilated room of even tempera- ture, and if the temperature is high or moderately high he should be kept in bed. The correction of all interosseous lesions is indicated, especially of the upper cervical area, though the second and third dorsal should be given attention because of the influence of these dorsal nerves upon the submaxillary glands. Also correct upper rib lesions that may exist. As mumps is an infective disease the channels of ehmination should be watched and stimulated. Build up the body resistance by treatment at the mid dorsal area to affect circulation and respiration ; and lower dorsal area to affect kidney and adrenal function. Watch the bowels and keep this avenue of elimination functioning freely, using enemata if necessary. The diet should bo liquid, of fruit juices, thin gruels, milk and plenty 452 The Practice of Osteopathy of water. Tepid sponging allays the fever and restlessness. Relaxation of the deep muscles of the neck and shoulders will do much to make the patient comfortable, also the muscles under the angle of the jaw. A very gentle relaxing of the tissues ai'ound the gland itself, by crowding them toward the gland, assists in relieving the tension by securing a better venous and lymphatic drainage. Hot applications to the swollen glands will give a considerable rehef ; these may consist of hot fomentations, hot salt bag, electric heating pad, hot water bottle, etc. The mouth is kept in good condition by the use of a mild antiseptic mouth wash. Orchitis should not occur if the boy is kept warm and in bed. If it does occur the best treatment is relaxation of the lower dorsal and upper lumbar spinal muscles, rest in bed, support and protection of the scrotum with cotton wool, cold applications, correction of any bony lesions affect- ing the pelvic viscera. If mastitis occurs, rib lesions will be found and should be corrected, as they are probably the predisposing factor to this comphcation. Treat- ment would consist of correction of these lesions, if it can be done without irritating the inflamed glands. The manipulation of the surrounding tissues, with gentle crowding of the normal tissues toward the inflamed glands, without exerting any pressure on the gland itself, is helpful and comforting. Free tissues back to the axillary lymphatics. Prognosis. — The outcome is usually favorable. In the rare fatal cases, meningitis is the usual cause of death. Under osteopathic care the duration of the swelhng, fever and pain is usually greatly lessened. Quarantine of twenty-four days is necessary. Whooping Cougli (Pertussis; tussis convulsiva) Definition. — It is a specific, epidemic, infectious, contagious dis- ease affecting the respiratory organs, characterized by a cyclic course, a severe convulsive cough, paroxysmal, with the characteristic "whoop." Etiology. — It usually occurs in children, most frequently during the fourth year, and extremely seldom after the twentieth year. It ap- pears to be slightly more frequent among girls, and most cases occur in March and April. Pertussis is highly contagious, being carried by di- rect contact and by fomites. The Bordet and Gengou bacillus is the specific cause. This is found in the sputum most abundantly during the first week, the most infectious period, and becomes gradually less. One attack usually confers immunity. The Practice of Osteopathy 453 The incubation period is from seven to ten days. The patient may be considered non-infectious five weeks after the first whoop. Lesions of the cervical and upper dorsal vertebrae and of the first, second and third ribs, affecting the vagi, the phrenic, the sympathetic, the recurrent laryngeal or the vasomotor nerves predispose to the dis- ease. The bacteria were found by Mallory and Horner to be characteris- tically between the cilia of the trachea and the bronchi. They interfere, mechanically, with the movements of the cilia, preventing the normal removal of secretions. Symptoms. — The disease is divided into three stages: 1. The ca- tarrhal stage, which lasts one to two weeks; 2, the spasmodic stage, three to six weeks; 3, the dechning stage, three weeks. The Catarrhal Stage: Characterized by headache, photophobia, conjunctivitis, coryza and a cough which becomes drier and harder to- ward the end of this stage. Often the invasion is insidious and sometimes well marked with a temperature of 100° to 102°. Frequently this stage cannot be diiferentiated from a "hard cold," except toward the end of the stage when the cough becomes worse instead of better, and the child will seek some support to steady itself during the coughing paroxysm. Also the eyes will water freely during the coughing spell and the child will not be able to "get his breath" between coughs, but will have a number of coughs without inhahng. One to two weeks. The Spasmodic Stage: This stage dates from the "first whoop." The fever now usually ceases, unless there are complications. The cough becomes paroxysmal, consisting of a succession of fifteen or more short, rapid expiratory puffs with no intervening inspirations, immed- iately followed by a deep, loud inspiration, which is the characteristic " whoop, " and is due to the partial closure of the glottis. Each paroxysm is composed of three or more such spells, the last one often followed by the expectoration of a small plug of mucus or by vomiting. During the paroxysm the facies presents a swollen, dusky appearance, eyeballs pro- truding, eyes reddened, and puffy, pinkish lids. The child is well ex- cept for the paroxysm, which has an aura, tickhng in the larynx, thoracic constriction, a creeping sensation, when the child attempts to brace himself, or runs in terror for support. The "whoop" is a deep, singing or whisthng inspiration which is absolutely characteristic. During the cough the child's body is bent forward and he is perfectly helpless, often passing ui-ino and feces involuntarily. Cyanosis often occurs from the strain. 454 The Practice of Osteopathy After the attack patient regains control of himself, the respiration is fast, and there is fatigue, sweating and often pain in the abdomen from the strain of coughing. During the severe cough petechise of the fore- head, ecchymosis of the conjunctivae, epistaxis, bleeding of the external auditory meatus or from the frenum of the tongue may occur. Ulcer of the frenum of the tongue is quite common. The parosyxms vary from four to a great many per day, averaging about twenty. Three to six weeks, usually four weeks. The Terminal or Declining Stage: This stage is longer in pro- portion in the mild cases. The paroxysms occur at longer intervals, are of shorter duration and of less intensity, the catarrhal symptoms are more marked, the expectoration becomes thinner, fluid, mucopurulent, and looser. The "habit cough" may follow. It is during this stage that complications are most hkely to occur, therefore it is the most danger- ous. Complications. — Catarrhal inflammations are common in the ini- tial stage. Bronchopneumonia is the most frequent and severe complication. Lobar pneumonia, exudative pleurisy, endocarditis, pericarditis, meningitis and nephritis are infrequent complications. Spasms of the glottife in nervous or scrofulous children is largely noc- turnal, and may cause death from asphyxia even in the lightest cases. Hemorrhages may occur in the skin, conjunctivae, nose, throat, ears or cerebrum. The writer knows of one case where death was sudden from a cerebral hemorrhage in an apparently mild case. Other complica- tions are cardiac dilatation, emphysema, bronchiectasis, pneumothorax, aneurysm hernias, muscular ruptures, and visceral prolapses. Spasmodic cough from diseased l^ronchial glands very closely re- sembles whooping cough. Barthez and Sannee give the following differ- entiation: Whooping Cough vs Enlarged Glands 1. Contagious, epidemic. Isolated, not contagious. 2. Three periods, 2nd parosyxmal. No distinct periods. 3. Paroxysmal cough with whoop. Paroxysms without whoop, expec- vomiting, viscid expectoration. toration or vomiting. 4. Respiratory sounds normal. Signs of enlarged glands sometimes present. 5. Respiration normal in interval; Asthma in some cases, febrile move- apyrexia if simple. ments, sweats, wasting, etc. 6. Voice natural. Voice sometimes changed. 7. Acute. Chronic. The Practice of Osteopathy 455 Treatment. — Isolation of patient in well-ventilated, sunny room vhere there is plenty of fresh air day and night is essential. Children 3xposed to infection should be disinfected and isolated for three weeks, as the disease can not be diagnosed during the catarrhal stage. If case is at all severe, patient should be put to bed. Cases receiving early treatment are sometimes aborted. Treat- ment of the whole respiratory tract with correction of vertebral and rib lesions, and relaxation of the contracted muscles should be given. Treat- ments for the first few days should be at least twice per day. Pay es- pecial attention to the vagi and phrenic nerves. Lesions of the first and second ribs will affect the recurrent laryngeal nerves which will aggravate the cough. The muscles of the shoulder girdle are always very tense and should be kept well relaxed, as should the subscapular muscles. Frequently after treatment the child will have a coughing spasm and raise large quantities of mucus, after which there will be no more spasms for several hours. Children who play and live out of doors get along best. To sup- port the diaphragm and abdominal muscles from the strain of cough- ing a musHn bandage tightly pinned about the trunk is very valuable, a pad being placed over the stomach under the bandage. In a very young child instruct the nurse to strongly flex thighs on abdomen during the severe coughing. Inhalations of steam from water with a very few drops of eucalyptus oil in it often relieves the first tickling sensations. If cyanotic symptoms appear they may be relieved by raising the ribs, especially those over the heart; by relaxing the subscapular mus- cles; and by supporting the heart by application of cold cloth over the heart. Elevating the abdominal viscera and diaphragm is, also, of dis- tinct benefit. The diet should be nutritious and easily digested, restricted to liquids during the fever. The child should be warmly clad and pro- tected from drafts. The excretory systems should be kept active by plenty of water drinking and by diet. Treatment should be continued during the terminal stage to prevent the possible complications. Irri- tants, as beef-tea, stimulants, dry bread, cookies and overfeeding, pro- voke coughing and vomiting. Food should be given at frequent intervals in concentrated form — gruels, milk with lime water, zwieback in milk, eggs, inoat-juicc, etc. Older patients tolerate more solid food. Prognosis. — With the complications, this is the most fatal of the acute infections under five years of age. Infants and little children should receive special care. Ordinary uncomplicated cases are favor- 456 The Practice of Osteopathy able for recovery. The prognosis depends upon the age and strength of the patient, the severity and number of the paroxysms, and the pres- ence or absence of comphcations. No recurrence is to be. expected. Death is due to spasm of the glottis or to extensive subdural hemor- rhage, occurring chiefly in the children of the poor and in delicate in- fants. Prophylaxis consists of isolation, disinfection of sputum and final fumigation of the premises. Children should be protected from ex- posure to infection from whooping cough. It must be realized that it is a very serious disease. The Peactice of Osteopathy 457 CONSTITUTIONAL DISEASES Rheumatic Fever (Inflammatory Rheumatism) Definition. — An acute, febrile, non-contagious disease; it is in- fectious, although there is some controversy as to its exact nature; char- acterized by a multiple arthritis and a tendency to involve the heart. Osteopathic Etiology and Pathology. — The prevailing thought is that the disease is an infection due to a diplococcus. This micro- organism is called by others micrococcus rheumaticus and streptococcus rheumaticus. "Rheumatic fever occurs most frequently in the temperate zone, among people who Hve under conditions which are unhealthful and which especially induce focal infection. It is most prevalent in the young and in the more exposed male of all ages. The excess of lymphoid tissue in the pharynx and nose of the young explains the frequency of the inci- dence of the focal infection and the subsequent rheumatism. The fre- quent association of the onset of rheumatic fever with lowering of the body temperature by exposure to cold and a wetting is explained by the increased specific virulency of the bacterial cause acquired by a low temperature and the coincident lessened resistance of the patient due to the exposure. The frequent absence of evidence of acute focal infec- tion at the onset of the systemic disease is not an evidence that no focus exists. The latent chronic streptococcus infection of tonsilUtis, pyorrhea alveolaris, sinuitis, etc., may suddenly acquire increased virulence and specific pathogenic affinity with varying degrees of focal tissue reaction. This transmutation of type and pathogenicity certainly occurs in the focus of infection. The removal of the tonsils and other sites of focal infection has been followed by complete recovery of prolonged, sub- acute and chronic types of arthritis and has unquestionably prevented recurrent attacks of rheumatic fever to which the susceptibility is in- creased by one or more attacks. The occurrence of rheumatic fever after the removal of an apparent focus may be due to secondary systemic latent foci in lymph nodes proximal to joints, in the neck or elsewhere. The streptococci of these secondary foci may take on new virulence and specific pathogenicity, from the same causes which induced like changes in the pathogenic bacteria of the primary focus. ^" 1. Billings, Focal Infection. 458 The Practice of Osteopathy Osteopathic lesions play an important role, both in their relation- ship or bearing upon the tissues of a possible site for a focal infection and upon systemic conditions that derange general bodily tone. This has been definitely confirmed in those cases of rheumatism where cor- rection of the osteopathic lesions, with attention to hygienic measures, have resulted in recovery. This is a feature of osteopathic etiolog}^ and therapj^ that can hardly be over-emphasized, for an intact innervation, circulation and chemism of the organism is basic to both preventive and curative therapy. Rheumatism, like most diseases, is of local origin and if tissues and structures can be kept up to the normal, infectious or the other pathologic processes can rarely become active. . Pathologically, the sj^novial membrane is hyperemic. The mus- cles and ligaments are inflamed. The fluid is serous with more or less fibrin and leucocytes. In severe cases shght erosion of the cartilages is found. Acute rheumatism is rarely fatal; when death does occur it is generally due to the complications which arise. Symptoms. — The onset is usually sudden; although it may be pre- ceded by slight fever, aching in joints, chilliness, and sore throat. It generally involves the larger joints and is almost always multiple; it has a tendency to move from one joint to another. The pain in the joints usually develops rapidly with sHght chilKness and a rapid rise in the temperature from 102 to 104 degrees F. The pulse is frequent, often disproportionately to the fever. There are profuse acid sweats, often causing sudamina. There is loss of appetite and thirst is present. The urine is scanty, high colored, very acid, and deposits urates upon stand- ing. The tongue is coated and the bowels are constipated. The joints are reddened, swollen, extremely painful and tender to the touch. Every movement, jarring of the bed, or the pressure of the bed clothes is agonj'- to the patient. The blood is greatly deranged, anemia develops rapidly and there is well marked leucoc\i;osis. The duration varies from a few days to several weeks. Complications. — The temperatm-e may rise to 106 or 109 degrees F. ; this is often associated with delirium, great prostration and a feeble, frequent pulse. Endocarditis, pericarditis, myocarditis, pneumonia, pleurisy, iritis, chorea, convulsions and meningitis may occur. Coma may develop without preceding dehrium or convulsions; this is very ser- ious and may prove fatal. Subcutaneous fibrous nodules attached to tendons and fascia sometimes develop. They vary in size and are most cohimon in children and in young adults, occurring most frequently in the fingers, hands and wrists. They are also sometimes seen about the The Practice of Osteopathy 459 elbows, knees, scapulae and spines of the vertebrae. They usually last a few days, somethnes for months, and generally develop during the decHne of the fever. Cutaneous affections, such as urticaria, erythema, nodosis, purpura and sweat vesicles sometimes appear. Diagnosis. — This is seldom very difficult; there are, however, several affections which resemble acute articular rheumatism. In sep- tic arthritis its association with some other septic process and the tendency of the inflammation to end in suppuration with more or less destruction of the joints, will determine the diagnosis. Septic arthritis may develop during the course of pyemia, puerperal fever, or acute osteomyelitis. Gout is rarely mistaken for acute rheumatism. Gout occurs later in life and usually affects the greater toe; history and mode of onset will usually render the diagnosis easy. In gonorrheal rheuma- tism the history of recent infection, its obstinate character and being generally connected with a single joint from the start are diagnostic. It especially affects the knee. Heart complications are rare. Rheuma- toid arthritis begins in the small joints; then attacks them all, leaving permanent deformity. There is no fever or sweats and the heart is not affected. Acute arthritis of infants usually attacks the hip or knee. The effusion becomes purulent. Prognosis^ — Recovery is the rule, but the prognosis nevertheless, must be guarded. Relapses and recurrences are common. Subacute Rheumatism. — In this form both the local and gen- eral symptoms are of a milder type and are more prolonged than in the acute form. The temperature seldom rises above 101 degrees F. The inflammation of the joints is not so severe and fewer joints are involved. It may last for weeks or months, and then it may pass into the chronic form. Usually though, when the course is prolonged, the joints return to their normal state. Treatment. — Place the patient in a room that is well ventilated and maintain a temperature of about 70 degrees F. Avoid draughts of air. The bed should be soft and smooth and blankets should be used. The diet should consist largely of milk, and let the patient drink freely of water. Oatmeal, barley water, egg albumen and meat juices may also be used. Treatment should be given along the entire spine, especially if the rheumatism changes fi-om one joint to another; otherwise treat the in- nervation directly to the affected joint. Correct any derangements that may be found along the spinal column and carefully relax the deep back muscles. Particular attention should be given to the bowels and 460 The Peactice of Osteopathy kidneys. Also, treat the liver most thoroughly during each treatment. The liver is many times considerably enlarged and tender in rheumatism and a thorough treatment of it seems to favor a more rapid cure. Carefull}'^ treat the affected tissues. If 3'ou cannot treat over the joint, then manipulate the tissues above and below the joint; and usually after a few minutes' manipulation the swelling is somewhat reheved so that direct treatment of the joint can be given. It is best to wrap the inflamed joints in flannel if the pain is severe. Besides treatment of the innervation of the joint, hot appUcations will be helpful. Some claim that cold compresses are of aid to the inflamed joints. Complications are to be treated separately. Besides the ordinary fever treatment for the fever, the cold bath is very effectual. After convalescence has been estabhshed, the patient should be carefully protected for several days from cold and damp. For any stiffness that may persist, manipulation and hot baths will be quite sufficient. H. M. Still^ writes ''If the fever is not over 103 degrees I do not try to reduce it. . . After treatment in a majority of cases, the fever is re- duced within twenty-four hours unless complications have set in. These are usually of the heart, so no matter how mild the attack, keep this in mind. If the action is irregular and weak, stimulate it two or three times a day. If it is rapid and high fever, go to the vasomotor centers and reduce fever, then inhibit the heart action and keep the excretions active. If the joints are affected I always move them gently no matter how great the inflammation. As yet I have never had a case of rheumatism in which cardiac lesions or ankylosed joints were a sequela." If the tonsils are evidently badly diseased and osteopathic treatment does not clear them up do not hesitate to have them removed. Chronic Articular Rheumatism Osteopathic Etiology and Pathology. — This disorder should be studied in connection with arthritis deformans owing to similar sources of infection and various common factors. It usually develops slowly and follows an acute or subacute attack and is common among the poor, especially those exposed to damp and cold. Heredity, advanced j^ears, although the disease may appear at any age, and constant exposure to cold and wet are predisposing causes. Chronic lesions to the spinal column corresponding to the affected area are found. Too much stress from an osteopathic point of view cannot be placed upon the importance of lesions to both the digestive organs and to the joints especially in- 1. Massachusetts Journal of Osteopathy, Jan. 1906. The Practice of Osteopathy 461 volved. Then, in addition, particular attention should be given osteo- pathically or surgically, or both, to sites of focal infection. Pathologically, the capsules and hgaments of the joints are thick- ened also, the sheaths of the tendons around the joint, so that in long standing cases the movements are impaired. In severe cases the carti- lages ma}^ be eroded. Atrophy of the muscles covering the joints some- times occurs, especially when there is neuritis; thus producing marked deformity. This muscular atrophy is particularly marked when the shoulders or hips are involved. The atrophy is caused partly from dis- ease; in cases where the joint is distended with effusion, the wasting may be due to pressure upon the muscles or blood-vessels. Symptoms. — Several joints are usually affected; but it may be Mmited to one joint, particularly the knee, hip or shoulder. Pain and stiffness are the most common symptoms. The pain is increased upon motion, while the stiffness is often lessened by using the hmbs. The joints are slightly swollen, but seldom reddened and are usually tender upon pressure. All the symptoms are aggravated on the approach of stormy weather. There is fever but the general health is not greatly impaired. There may be distortion of the joints and ankylosis may oc- cur. Arterial degeneration and chronic endocarditis may develop as compKcations. Prognosis. — This should be guarded so far as a complete cure is concerned; although most cases are greatly benefited. Treatment. — The treatment of chronic articular rheumatism is largely correcting lesions of the spinal column, which affect the diseased tissues as well as the digestive organs, local treatment of the joints, and removal of focal infections. A certain percentage will respond to osteo- pathic measures alone, though surgery has a definite place in others. The joints and hmbs should be thoroughly treated so as to restore a better circulation and reheve the inflamed tissues. Wrapping the af- fected joint with cold cloths and then covering the cloths with flannel and oiled silk is often helpful. Due attention should be given the gen- eral health, such as nourishing food, free elimination and outdoor ex- ercise. Probably in some cases where the primary infection has been ehm- inated secondary foci are present and a general treatment will arouse sufficient reaction to cope with the condition. 462 The Practice of Osteopathy Arthritis Deformans (Rheumatoid Arthritis) Definition. — A chronic affection of the joints, characterized by progressive changes in the cartilages and synovial membranes, and by new osseous formations restricting the motion of the joint and causing deformit.y. Osteopatliic Etiology and Patliology. — It is due to lesions of the spinal column affecting the spinal and sympathetic nerves as well as dis- turbing the circulation to the cord. Lesions of the spinal column and ribs are found corresponding to the innervation of the diseased joints. The osteopath has been able in every case to demonstrate chnically im- portant osteopathic lesions. In addition the symmetry of joint involve- ment, muscular atrophy, sweating, etc., point to nervous lesions. Falli found upon autopsy that the anterior horns had undergone atrophic changes. Nervous lesions are probably of a predisposing character while some infection is the exciting cause. A thorough search of the entire body should be made for foci of infection. Malnutrition, trauma- tism, exposure to cold, and pelvic diseases are important causative factors. In all cases lesions will be found disturbing the organs of digestion. Fe- males are more frequently affected than males. The disease is fre- quently seen in women suffering from ovarian and uterine troubles, especially at the menopause. Hereditary influence may be a factor, also auto-intoxication. The disease is most common between the ages of twenty and thii-ty. Mental worry, anxiety, grief and injury are also predisposing factors. Patliologically, in one class of cases, the cells of the cartilages and of the synovial membrane proliferate. The cartilages undergo atrophy, or may become soft, degenerate, and are absorbed, leaving the ends of the bone bare. The bones naturally atrophy and become smooth. In another class the edges of the cartilages where the pressure is slight, thicken and form outgrowths which ossify and enlarge the heads of the bones, forming osteophytes which greatly impair the motion; true anky- losis is rare. The synovial membrane becomes thickened, also the cap- sule and ligaments, thus greatly restricting the movements of the joints. The muscles around the joints atrophy. In the spinal cord atrophic and degenerative lesions are found. In Still's disease there is an enlarged spleen and marked changes in the joint. Symptoms. — Pain and swelling of the joints and fever and enlarge- ment of the lymphatics near the joint are characteristic. The spleen The Practice of Osteopathy 463 is congested and later on there is gastro-intestinal disturbance. Multiple arthritis deformans, also known as Heberden's nodosites, is char- acterized by nodules developing at the sides of the distal phalanges. It occurs most frequently in women between the ages of thirty and forty, and gradually increases with age. At first the joints are swollen, tender and painful and then apparently become better. These attacks may ap- pear at different intervals while the nodules at the sides of the joints gradually increase in size. The larger joints are rarely affected. The progressive form may be either acute or chronic. The acute form at the onset may resemble articular rheumatism. It is more common in women between the ages of twenty and thirty, but may occur in children. Preg- nancy, recent delivery, lactation, the menopause, and rapid child bear- ing are common antecedents. There is swelling and tenderness of the joints and shght fever. Several joints are usually involved. The chron- ic form is most common. Symmetrical joints are usually involved. The affected joints slowly enlarge and are painful and red. Usually the hand is first affected; then the wrists, knees, toes, jaws and spine; in extreme cases every joint is affected. The vertebrae, spondylitis de- formans, may be attacked. The cervical spine may be alone involved, in which case the head cannot be moved up or down, although rotation usually remains. In some instances the entire spinal column is affected and may become perfectly rigid. In some cases there is hardly if any pain, while in others the pain is agonizing and is ahnost constant. The joints gradually become deformed, stiff and creak when moved; later they become completel.y ankylosed. This deformity is due partly to the thickening of the capsule, to the presence of osteophytes, and to the contraction of the muscles. These contractures flex the leg upon the thigh and the thigh upon the abdomen. Muscular atrophy increases the deformity. Numbness, tingling, pigmentation and glossiness of the skin, and local sweating may be present and are of trophic origin. The monoarthritic form affects old persons chiefly, and women more frequently than men. It affects particularly the hips, the knees, the shoulders, and the vertebral articulations. This is often caused by an injury. The muscles waste away and the knee-jerk is usually increased upon the affected side. Diagnosis. — Care has to be taken in not confusing it with rheu- matic fcvci- oi' gout. Radiographs should be made. Prognosis. — If treated early there is a fair chance for curing the disease. Advanced cases usually improve under treatment. The os- teopathic treatment should be persistent for at least sevoi-al months. Treatment. — Osteopathic treatment, if long continued in rliounia- 464 The PRAfxicE of Osteopathy toid arthritis, has given satisfactory results, although owing to the ex- tent of the deformity, a cure in advanced cases cannot be expected. An important cause of the disease is probably a trophic or vasomotor disturbance to the tissues of the joint. Osteopathically, there is never any difficulty to locate disorders in the spinal column corresponding to the innervation of the involved joints. The fact that many of the joints are affected symmetrically indicates that the lesion is a spinal one in- volving the nerve center. During the incipiency marked improvement is the rule. A thorough attempt should be made in every case to discover the source of infection and remove it, though this does not preclude the essential osteopathic adjustment. The treatment consists of attempts to correct the spinal derange- ment and careful manipulation of the diseased joints to restore vitality and motion in them. The preceding simple, but effective treatment, must be continued two or three times per week for months or even years in order to be of particular value. Coupled with the specific treatment should be a careful consideration of the general health. The emunctories should be kept active and the food of the patient be nutritious. The osteopath should require the patient to take considerable physical ex- ercise at regular intervals, warm baths and plenty of fresh air. Mas- sage and friction of the diseased joints will be of aid in absorbing ef- fusions and in restoring the tone of atrophied muscles. Hot compresses are a help. The baths at various hot springs are sometimes of benefit, and change of climate is invigorating. O. J. Snyder^ has this to say: "I must be very emphatic, however, to here advise exceptional caution in your manipulative procedure. * * * You cannot attempt to move the joint, for, if you do you will cause excruciating pain and do irreparable harm in that you will cause breaking down of the cartilage and cancellous bOne tissue. Your first endeavor should be to reduce inflammation and to mitigate pain. * * * Osteopathically much comfort and reduction of pain can be accomplished by inhibition in the proper spinal areas. A little friction and very gentle extention or traction of the joint can be attempted as soon as the condi- tion of the joint, by the foregoing treatment, has been made possible. At no time should rotation or side-bending, or any other manipulation that produces irritation of tissue be attempted." In stout adult women a villous arthritis of the knees may develop owing to faulty posture and poor elimination. These conditions are often amenable to treatment. 1. Journal of the American Osteopathic Association, November 1919. The Practice or Osteopathy 465 Muscular Rheumatism I Debnition. — A painful disease of the voluntary muscles and of their fascia and the periosteum. It is regarded by many as a neuralgia of these muscles. The pain is greatly increased by motion and pressure. Osteopafliic Etiology and Pathology. — Osteopathic experience with cases of muscular rheumatism shows that the nerves, as they pass to and from the spinal muscles, are affected. The lesion is caused, prin- cipally, by subdislocations of the vertebrae, ribs or pelvis, according to the region involved. A gouty or rheumatic diathesis, heredity, exposure to cold and wet and previous attacks are predisposing causes. Men are more often affected, owing to their more frequent exposure. The disease affects persons of all ages. It occurs in acute, sub-acute and chronic forms. In cases of frequent recurrence focal infections and intestinal toxins are often important factors. Vertebral and muscular lesions, septic foci, intestinal stasis, exposure to cold and drafts are principal causes. Pathologically, there is swelling of the muscles of the nature of myositis. In chronic cases there is often atrophy of the muscles, due to interference of the trophic nerves. Symptoms. — These are generally local and are never accompanied by marked constitutional disturbances. There is seldom fever, and the pulse is only sHghtly increased in frequency. Pain is the chief symptom ; it is increased by motion or pressure. Tenderness is generally present and there may be swelhng of the tissues. Rheumatic nodules have been found. The duration is usually three or four days, though it may last longer with frequent recurrences. Lumbago is a painful affection of the muscles of the lumbar area and their tendinous attachments. The onset is generally sudden. In severe cases it sometimes renders the patient helpless. In torticollis, or stiff neck, the muscles of the side and back of the neck are affected. It is usually confined to one side of the head. Any attempt to turn the head causes a sharp pain. In pleurodynia the intercostal muscles, and sometimes the pectorals and serratus magnus, are affected. It usually affects but one side, more frequently the left ; it is the most painful form of the disease, since the pain is aggravated by breathing. The respira- tory movements are consequently restricted on the affected side. The absence of fever and physical signs will distinguish it from pleurisy. In intercostal neuralgia the pain follows the distribution of the nerves and there are tender spots along their courses. Cephalodynia affects 466 The Practice of Osteopathy the muscles of the scalp. Scapulodynia, omodynia and dorsodynia affect the muscles of the shoulder and upper dorsal. Abdominal rheu- matism affects the muscles of the abdomen. Prognosis. — The prognosis is good. Favorable results are the general rule under careful treatmejit. Treatment. — Muscular rheumatism is usually an easy affection to cure. The cause of the disturbance is generally found in the region in- volved, and is due, in the majority of cases, to some dislocated tissue, usually osseous, that irritates the nerves to the muscles. In addition to correcting the lesions, removal of septic foci, free elimination, lessened diet, stretching of the muscles, application of heat, ironing and rest are beneficial. In lumbago there is invariably found a slight lateral deviation of some vertebrae along the lower dorsal or lumbar region. Occasionally deformity of the vertebrae, asymmetry, or arthritis are factors. The radiograph may be a diagnostic aid. Occasionally, a floating rib or an innominate becomes displaced. Stretching the loins by placing the pa- tient upon his side or back and flexing the thighs on the abdomen is very beneficial. Maintain the tension for three or four minutes. Hot fomentations and rest are helpful. Torticollis, or stiff neck, is generally due to a lesion of the middle cervical vertebra;. The lesion is usually between the third, fourth and fifth vertebrae, occasionally as low as the second dorsal. A reduction of the subdislocation will often relieve the attack. Stretching of the muscle and application of heat will also be of aid. In some cases of torticollis (chronic) there is a curvature of the cervical spine, and occasionally the nmscles are more or less fibrinous. Surgical measures may be instituted. In such instances a cure cannot always be accomplished. The tonsils, nose and teeth should be examined for sources of infection. A few cases of acute torticollis are caused by some of the deep mus- cular fibres becoming caught around a process of a vertebra. Severe contraction of the muscles by cold or extensive rotary flexions of the neck, may result in torticollis. Occasionally a case is found due to in- jury at birth. The cervical vertebrae should be carefully examined. The spinal accessory is the nerve generally involved. Lesions to the spinal accessory occur commonly at the third, fourth and fifth cervicals, or the atlas and axis. The muscles involved in torticollis are the sterno- cleido-mastoid, trapezius, splenius and scaleni. Operations should not be performed until a thorough course of treatment has failed to relieve. The Practice of Osteopathy 467 Pleurodynia is often a neuralgia of the pleural nerves. It is usually caused by subdislocations of the ribs exactly over the regions involved. Occasionally, a lesion may exist to the corresponding vertebra, but rarely. The rib is at times completely dislocated. AppHcations of heat and rest of the part are of aid. Strapping of the region will give considerable re- lief. In cephalodyina the muscles of the scalp are generally involved by lesions in the upper five cervical vertebrae. In scapulodynia, omo- dynia and dorsodynia the muscles of the shoulder are usually affected by displacements of the second and third ribs, although the lesion may be found sHghtly lower in the ribs, or in the corresponding vertebrae. The lower cervical vertebrae may also be at fault. In recurring and chronic cases carefully examine for infectious sources. Dislocations of the shoulder occur frequently; and muscular fibres may slip out of the bicipital groove (rarely) . In a few cases muscles may become contracted about the coracoid process, or the acromial end of the clavicle may be- come dislocated. Abdominal rheumatism is generally caused by lesions in the lower six dorsal vertebrae, which involve the innervation to the muscles. In some cases lesions of the lower ribs are found, and in a few instances a lesion may be discerned in the upper lumbar vertebrae. Myalgia of the upper extremity is caused by lesions of the cervi- cal or upper dorsal vertebrae or upper ribs. Occasionally some trouble may be found in the shoulder or elbow joints. In the lower extremity lesions may be found in the lower dorsal or lumbar vertebrae, or there may be derangements of the pelvic bones. Occasionally disorder is found at the hip and knee joints. Gout Definition. — A nutritional disorder in which there is an abnormal accumulation of uric acid and other purin bodies in the blood and tis- sues; and arthritis, deformity of joints and visceral derangements being the characteristic features. Osteopathic Etiology and Pathology. — Hereditary influences are the predisposing factors of about one-half of the cases of gout. Men are more frequently affected than women. It rarely develops before the age of thirty. Overeating, sedentary habits, drinking alcohol, es- pecially fermented drinks, and lead poisoning are predisposing factors. Emotional disturbances may excite an attack. Gout is not confined to the rich by any means; but there is also a "poor-man's gout," due to 468 The Practice of Osteopathy poor food, unhygienic surroundings, and to an excessive use of malt liquors. Uric acid seems to be a causative factor, but whether there is an increased formation or a diminished excretion of the uric acid has not yet been fully decided. The ultimate result is the same in either case; there is an accumulation of uric acid and other purin bodies in the blood, which is responsil)le for some of the effects of the disease. Osteopathic experience with cases of gout shows that lesions affecting the nervous system are important factors that control uric acid accumula- tion or excretion. The nerve centers controlhng the affected portions of the body are ahiiost invariably involved, as well as the nerve control to the digestive and excretory organs. A neurosis of these nerve centers probably occurs and is thus a predisposing cause of gout. Considerable can be accomplished in the treatment of gout by careful examination of the spinal column, in the region corresponding to the innervation of the affected area, for vertebral lesions, and correcting them. Usually, sUght dislocations of the bones of the foot are found, when that region of the body is involved. The most common subdislocations of the foot are in- volvements of the astragalus with its articulations and the metatarsals. Pathological changes are those of the joints principally. There is deposit of uric acid in cartilages, synovial membranes and ligaments. The joint of the great toe is most frequently affected, then the fingers, ankles, knees, hands and wrists. The exudates become hard and are then called tophi. In severe cases the cartilages of the ears, nose, eyelids and larynx are involved. Finally the joints become stiff, deformed and ankylosed, and sometimes there is ulceration. The kidneys are usually the seat of chronic interstitial inflammation with a deposit of urates. The heart and blood-vessels almost alwaj^s present changes. Arterial sclerosis is quite a constant lesion; the left ventricle of the heart is hypertrophied. Urate of sodium has been found deposited upon the valves. There is an excess of uric acid in the blood. Chronic bronchitis, emphj^sema and asthma are among the changes in the respiratory system. Symptoms. — In acute gout, before the attack, the patient maj^ complain of dyspeptic disorder, restlessness and twinges of pain in the small joints. He is apt to have irritabihty of temper and depression of spirits. The first symptom of the attack is great pain in the metatarso- phalangeal joint of the great toe, which usuall}' comes on suddenly at night with swelling, heat and discoloration of the joint. The tempera- ture rises to 102 and 103 degrees F. Towards morning the symptoms generally abate to recur again the next night. This lasts for several The Practice of Osteopathy 469 days, the symptoms graduallj^ abating. The urine is scanty, high col- ored, of high specific gravity and acid in reaction. It deposits urates and often contains a small quantity of albumin. There may be gastro-intes- tinal S3anptoms — pain, vomiting, diarrhea, faintness and a rapid, feeble pulse. Pharyngitis is an occasional symptom. The cardiac symptoms are pain, shortness of breath and irregular action of the heart. These attacks may appear with varying severity. In some cases there may be severe cerebral symptoms. Chronic gout follows repeated attacks of the acute form. The ar- ticular symptoms continue for a longer time and the condition extends to other joints. The chalk deposits slowly increase until the joint becomes swollen and deformed. The morbid changes already described are char- acteristic. The urine is increased in quantity, is of low specific gravity and may contain albumin and hyaHn and granular casts. Involve- ment of the heart and blood-vessels gradually occurs. Irregular gout or lithemia is seen in persons who have been gouty or have a hereditary predisposition. It includes a set of symptoms that are not alone distinctive, but when taken with this gouty tendency, all forms of irregular gout can be recognized. There are various gastro- intestinal disturbances; cutaneous eruptions; heart and blood-vessel changes; pains in the various muscles and joints; nervous symptoms, as headache, neuralgia and neuritis; urinary symptoms, and pulmonary and ocular disorders. Diagnosis. — Only the irregular form of gout should be difficult to diagnose. Differentiation is to be made from arthritis deformans and acute and chronic rheumatism. Treatment. — The hygienic treatment of gout is very essential. The patient should live a quiet life, avoiding mental and physical strains. Plenty of fresh air, exercise and regular hours should be insisted upon. AlcohoHc drinking should be avoided and the food taken in moderate quantities. Keeping the skin active by the use of cold baths, if the pa- tient is strong, and warm baths should he be weak, is a helpful measure. The dress of the patient should be warm and suitable for the chmate. A regulated diet of nutritious food, taken at regular hours, is neces- sary. Each patient should receive separate instructions as to diet. The food given may be small amounts of beef, mutton and chicken, with fresh vegetables; with the exception of strawberries, tomatoes and bananas, fruits may be used; fats, milk and stale bread are also suitable. The patient should avoid tea, coffee, pastry, hot breads, highly seasoned dishes, and such articles. The free use of water is beneficial. 470 The Practice of Osteopathy The osteopathic treatment consists of careful correction of the lesions of the spinal column in order to free the nerve force to the affected region. The spinal treatment in gout is the most essential treatment and is effective. A most thorough examination should be made of the tissues about the diseased area; in the foot the astragalus oftentimes is .^ubdislocated from its articulations, causing obstructions to the local vessels and nerves. The metatarsal bones should receive due attention, as occasionally one of the bones corresponding to the affected tissues is dislocated, usually downward. All the joints between the diseased tis- sues and the spinal nerve centers should be carefully manipulated so as to favor a better circulation. During a severe attack of gout, besides careful treatment of the blood supply to the diseased region, wrapping the joint in cotton wool and appl3'ing warmth and moisture to the joint may be helpful. The kidneys, liver and bowels are to be kept active. A Ught treat- ment to the kidneys and liver each time is verj^ helpful in aiding the or- gans to eliminate the waste material, and especially in controlling any inflammation that may exist in the kidne.y. The essential treatment in gout is to reUeve the disorder of the nerve centers, to increase the ac- (ivdties of the emunctories and to regulate the hygiene of the patient. Diabetes Mellitus Definition. — A nutritional disorder in which there is an abnormal amount of sugar in the blood, characterized b}^ an excessive urinary dis- charge, in which grape sugar is constantly present, and by a progressive loss of flesh and strength. Osteopatliic Etiology and Patliology. — Almost invariably there will be found a posterior dorso-lumbar curvature wherein the spinal col- umn tissues are much contractured. This condition probably involves the sympathetics (vasomotor and trophic) to the pancreas, liver and in- testines. Important lesions may also be found as high as the occiput. Tenderness and congestion over the abdomen, especially the liver, are frequent. It affects men more frequently than women and is a disease of adult hfe, ranging between the ages of thirty and sixty, though cases have occurred in the very young. It is more serious in the young, the very young seldom recovering. Hereditary influences are believed to be a predisposing cause. It affects the better classes principally and especially those of a neurotic temperament. The Hebrew race is specially predisposed. The colored race is seldom affected. The Practice of Osteopathy 471 Obesity, certain chronic diseases (malaria, gout, syphilis), occupa- tions taxing the mind, and pregnancy are predisposing influences. In- jury or disease of the spinal cord or brain frequently cause diabetes, especially anj^ irritation of Bernard's diabetic center in the medulla. Derangements of the endocrine system are important. Injuries to the spine, chiefly in the dorso-lumbar and sacral regions, and to the abdomen, and diseases of the pancreas or liver are, as has been stated, oftentimes causes. Lesions to the spine maj^ disturb the glycogenic function of the Hver, the glycolytic ferment of the pancreas, or produce an ahmentary glycosuria. Extirpation of the pancreas is immediately followed by dia- betes, but if a fragment of the pancreas is left it is not always followed by diabetes. The normal amount of sugar in the blood is 1-1000 while in diabetes the amount of sugar is 3 to 4-1000 up to 7 or 8-1000. The healthy kidney will not excrete sugar when it is at the normal ratio. Concerning the presence of acetone-bodies von Noorden^ says: "The excretion of acetone-bodies may serve, like glycosuria, as a measure of the intensity of the diabetic disease it will be at once understood that in no other disease do the acetone-bodies occupy so important a position as in diabetes." Irritation of the centers of the vasomotor nerves to the liver or direct stimulus to the liver cells is followed by glycosuria. Interference with the pneumogastric nerve also influences diabetes. Pathologically, the liver is enlarged, firmer and darker in color than normal. Often there is fatty degeneration of the organ. The pancreas is diseased in about one-half of the cases of diabetes, especially the islands of Langerhans. The lesions found are granular atrophy, occlusion of the pancreatic duct, atrophy from pressure, fat necrosis, and sometimes it is small, soft and anemic. The kidney changes are those of catarrhal nephritis. In the fatty degeneration hyalin changes take place. The heart is hypertrophied in a few cases. Arterial sclerosis is frequently met with. In the lungs bronchitis, pneumonia and tuberculosis occasion- ally develop. In the stomach and intestines catarrh is common. The blood presents an increase of sugar. In the nervous system are found many lesions, especially congestion, extravasation and sclerosis of the brain; disturbances of the posterior part of the cord, and congestion and sclerosis of the sympathetic gangha. The bony lesions, however, (al- most invaria})ly a posterior lower dorsal and lumbar) must involve the sympathetics, via the splanchnics, to the extent of profound metaljolic disturbance, for in no other way can llie results of osteopathy l)e explained. 1. Diabetes, p. 90. 472 The Practice of Osteopathy The importance of specific treatment at this point cannot be over estimated. Symptoms. — The onset is gradual; thirst and frequent micturi- tion being the first symptoms noticed. After an injiu-y or a sudden, severe nervous shock, diabetes may set in abruptly'. As the disease pro- gresses there will be marked thirst, polyuria, an abnormal appetite, wast- ing and debility. The tongue is dry, red and coated. There is con- stipation and the skin is dry and harsh. Temperature is often subnor- mal; pulse frequent with increased tension. In some cases the urine is not increased in quantity; usuallj^ how- ever, the amount varies from four to five pints to several quarts in twent}^- four hom*s. It is pale in color, of high specific gravity and acid reaction. Sugar is present in variable quantities from one or two per cent to five or ten per cent. Sugar in the urine must be constant in order that the affection is a true diabetic one. Albumin is often present; urea is in- creased and uric acid may be slightly lincreased. Acetone-bodies are often found and usually indicate a more serious condition. Diabetic Coma is the most important and gravest complication. There is either a sudden or gradual loss of consciousness. This may oc- cur after some form of exhausting exercise. There maj^ be previous head- ache or a feehng of intoxication. It may be preceded by nausea, vomit- ing, colicky pains or some local affections, such as pharyngitis or pulmon- ary compMcations. Peripheral nem-itis, neuralgia, numbness, are pos- sible symptoms. Impairment of hearing, cataracts, strabismus, diabe- tic retinitis and atrophy of the optic nerve may occur. The sexual function is lost early in the disease. Eczema, with burning and itching of the labia and vicinity, (and in men a balanitis), furuncles, boils and carbuncles are common. Gangrene and edema are not uncommon. Acute pneumonia, bronchitis and tuberculosis are possible complications. Progressive loss of flesli is a serious indication. Diagnosis. — The diagnosis is easy, as there is no other disease with which it can be confounded. Careful urinatysis should always be made. Examination for acetone, diacetic acid and oxybutyric acid is valuable. Prognosis. — Many cases have been cured by osteopathic measures while nearly all treated have been benefited. If the patient is put upon a diet free from carbohydrates, in mild cases the sugar wall disappear, while in severe cases it will still be present. Mild cases usually yield readily to treatment. In cases over forty years of age the outlook is quite favorable, The Practice of Osteopathy 473 but in cases under forty, and especially the young, the prognosis is not so favorable. In cases under puberty the results are apt to be fatal. Stout persons bear diabetes better than lean. All cases are liable to complica- tions, which render the prognosis more serious. It is a disease of long duration, although death has occurred in a few weeks. Treatment. — In nearly all cases of diabetes mellitus examined there have been found posterior conditions of the lower dorsal and lumbar regions. The posterior curve has always been fairly well marked and generally is a symmetrical curve. By that is meant a spinal curve that is not irregular and the relation of the various vertebrae, one to the other, is not seriously deranged. Correction of this condition of the spinal col- umn has almost invariably given satisfactory results and in the majority of cases the condition of the patient has improved remarkably, and many entirely cured. To get the best results the patient should be laid on his side on the operating table and the knees drawn up so that the thighs are flexed upon the abdomen. The osteopath standing in front of the patient throws his weight against the flexed thighs and reaching over upon the spinal column springs the entire weakened portion of the spine toward its normal position, stretching the spinal column to separate each vertebra from its neighbor so that the deranged nerves, as they pass through the intervertebral foramina, may be released. Meeker^ re- ports a case with a marked kyphosis which was treated two years before enough motion could be had between the vertebrae to produce any results, but after that they were favorable. Direct treatment to the abdominal organs to correct Hver congestion and stimulate the pancreas and increase activity of the intestines is essential. The nerves affected by the posterior pathological curve of the spine, mentioned above, and by separate lesions that may exist within the pathological curvature, are probably the vaso-motor nerves to the portal system, pancreas and the intestines. The vaso-motor nerves to the por- tal system branches are given off principally from the fifth to the ninth dorsal vertebrae, although fibres may escape from the cord as low as the first lumbar vertebra. The nerves to the intestines are given off princi- pally from about the ninth dorsal to the lower lumbar vertebrae. Pos- sil)]y there are nerve fibres direct to the hepatic cell protoplasm. How lesions in the dorso-lumbar region cause diabetes mellitus is an important question and is hard to answer. An unnatural acceleration of the portal circulation may cause an increased quantity of sugar to pass to the liver, resulting in part of the sugar not being changed into 1. Journal of the American Osteopathic Association, Oct., 1904. 474 The Practice of Osteopathy glycogen and thus passing into the circulation ; or a paralysis of the vaso- motor nerves to the liver causes congestion and slowness of the blood stream. Thus a disturbed circulation of the liver may cause accumulation of sugar in the liver, so that the blood ferment has time to act upon the glycogen and transform it into sugar; or there may be a saccharinit}^ of chjde or blood in the portal vein, due to an impeded conversion of sugar in the intestines into lactic acid; or there may be an accelerated absorp- tion of sugar due to an abnormal state of the intestines; or the nervous control to the pancreatic functions may be disturbed. Hence, one or many pathological changes may occur and influence a case of diabetes, due to a disordered dorso-lumbar region. The center for the hepatic vasomotor nerves, "diabetic center," is in the floor of the fourth ventricle at the level of the origin of the vagi nerves. A lesion of the "diabetic center" or an obstruction to the pneu- mogastric anywhere along its course may cause diabetic symptoms; hence, there may be lesions of the cervical region that would affect reflex- h' the diabetic center, or lesions of the pneumogastric may occur, partic- ularly at the atlao or axis, and cause diabetic symptoms, or, at least, these may influence the course of a case of diabetes melhtus. Or the upper cervical lesions may disturb the pituitary gland which is of importance in carbohydrate metabolism. There are nerves from the superior and inferior cervical ganglia of the sympathetic that have considerable influence upon the hver. These nerves do not pass down the cord to the splanchnics, but pass in the sym- pathetic to the ceUac and hepatic plexuses and then to the liver. Stim- ulation of these nerves causes the hepatic vessels at the periphery of the liver lobules to become contracted. Possibly in a very few cases, a stag- nation of blood in other vascular regions of the body may cause the blood ferment to accumulate in the blood to such an extent that diabetic symptoms occur. Dietetic treatment is essential, but is not so necessary as some medical authors would have us believe. A regulated diet should be insisted upon in all cases, but one should not go to extremes in dieting, A complete ehmination of the carbohydrates is no longer considered the ])est treatment, as it withdraws too important an element from the diet, producing weakness without any corresponding return for good. A patient's appetite is often inordinate and it will be necessary to regulate the quantity and character of foods. Proctor^ mentions a case which re- covered when carbohydrates were restored, as the patient was too starved 1. Journal of the American Osteepathic Association, Oct., 1904. The Practice of Osteopathy - 475 to build up. Under osteopathic treatment much more liberty can be allowed in selection of foods. Von Noorden^ reported a number of cases in which excretions of sugar continued upon the strict anti-diabetic diet, but which were sugar free when they received a large amount of oatmeal along with some vegetable proteid or white of egg and butter, other car- bohydrates being excluded. It is suggested by the editor of the Series that the oatmeal may be used alternately with diabetic diet, and reheve the monotony greatly. It can also be used as a test of the patient's digestive and sugar destroying powers. The following food may be in- cluded in the dietary: Animal Foods. — Meats of every variety, except Hvers; game, poultry, fish and eggs. Vegetables. — Cabbage, cauliflower, celery, lettuce, green string beans, the green ends of asparagus, tomatoes, spinach, mushrooms, cu- cumbers, watercress, young onions, or any other green vegetable. Bread and Cakes. — Made of gluten flour, bran flour or almond flour; griddle cakes, biscuits, porridges, etc., may be made of these flours. Beverages. — Skimmed milk, buttermilk, coffee and tea without sugar, and carbonated water. Relishes. — Pickles, cream cheese and nuts of all kinds except chestnuts. Fruits. — Oranges, lemons, cranberries, cherries, strawberries, all in moderate quantities. Other foods may be used, but each case requires a thorough studj^ in order to determine what is best to do. Various foods should be tested out and controlled by urinalysis. The point is to increase metabolism so that the body can store up con- siderable carbohydrates without the appearance of sugar in the urine. In severe cases Allen's fasting treatment to be followed by a low diet should be instituted. However, it should be remembered that the correction of dorsal and upper cervical lesions is invaluable. Mental excitement and worry should be avoided as much as possible. Frequent bathing and regulated exercise will be of considerable value. The diabetic patient should have a well ventilated room and plenty of rest and sleep; flannels are to be worn next to the skin the year around. Various symptoms and complications are liable to arise, which the competent osteopath is prepared to meet l)y following general rules. Keep the bowels open. And frequently examine for acetone and diacetic acid. If there are any symptoms of coma fast the patient, and neutralize the acid intoxication with bicarlwnate of soda until the urine is alkahne. 1. Practical Medical Scries, HK)."). 476 The Practice of Osteopathy Diabetes Insipidus (Polyuria). Definition. — A constitutional disorder in which there is a contin- ued excessive secretion of urine, free from albumin and sugar. There is constant thirst. Osteopatliic Etiology and Patliology. — This disease is more frequent in males than in females. It occurs most commonly between the ages of twenty and thirty. It is due to chronic disturbances of the nerves. The lesions usually found upon osteopathic examination are lateral derangements of the vertebrae in the renal splanchnic region, (ninth to twelfth dorsal inclusive) or a slight kyphosis in the same locality. Such lesions probably affect the central nervous system in the region of the sympathetic nerves to the kidneys, by a paralysis of the muscular coat of the renal vessels. The disease may be associated with other con- ditions, as injuries and diseases of the nervous system elsewhere; ex- posure to cold; prolonged debility and fatigue; cerebral diseases, as men- ingitis, paralysis of the sixth nerve, tumor of the brain, and blows on the head; injuries of the cervical region; sunstroke; cerebrospinal fever; malaria; syphilis; pregnancy; hysteria; hereditary influences, and drink- ing too freely of cold water. There are many diseases and conditions which may be associated with diabetes insipidus; and which act as irri- tants, directly or reflexly, upon the center in the medulla oblongata (which is just above the diabetic center), or upon the sympathetic ganglia in the abdominal region. Thus, there is a vasomotor neurosis, due either to central or reflex lesions. Second in importance to lesions of the renal splanchnics are le- sions of the upper cervical region. Irritations in the cervical region may act upon the center in the medulla or the lesions may affect some of the sympathetic fibres as they pass from the brain to the renal sym- pathetics. The pituitary gland may be disturbed. Probably axis and atlas lesions are factors. Lesions of the nerve centers and of the sjmipathetic ganglia have been found upon post-mortem examination, but they are not constant. Nervous lesions have been found in the region of the base of the brain. The kidneys are sometimes congested and enlarged. The tubules may be dilated. Symptoms. — Great thirst and an enormous secretion of urine of a pale, watery and slightly acid nature are the characteristic symptoms. The skin is usually dry and harsh, the bowels are constipated, and the The Practice of Osteopath i 477 appetite may be voracious. The health on the whole is quite perfect, although if the affection is not arrested, considerable loss of flesh and strength may result. There is a tendency for the disease to become chronic. The nervous lesion causing polyuria may be the outcome of a debil- itated condition of long standing or the symptoms may occur suddenly. Preceding the large flow of urine such symptoms as nervousness, irrita- bility, headache, sleeplessness, failure of memory, and inability to con- centrate the mind commonly occur. Other symptoms may be present in addition, as debihty, diarrhea, epigastric and lumbar pains, and im- paired sexual function. Diagnosis. — The diagnosis is not difficult. Thirst, polyuria and the absence of albumin and sugar characterize the disease. In diabetes melUtus, finding of grape sugar in the urine would at once exclude poly- uria. In paroxysmal diuresis, the increased amount of urine is not permanent. In interstitial nepliritis, there is albumin, casts, etc. Prognosis. — Depends upon the cause. The disease yields to treatment much quicker than diabetes mellitus and is without doubt much less serious. The disease, in a large majority of cases, can be cured. Under osteopathic treatment most cases will yield good re- sults or be cured in from a few weeks to six months. Treatment. — The treatment of the disease causing diabetes in- sipidus is of first consequence, but frequently such a disease is undiscover- able. There is often a tendency toward nem^asthenia; consequently, habits, environment, etc., should be carefully attended to. Examine for sexual, rectal and other reflex irritations. Correcting lesions of the renal splanchnics is important; in fact, in a fair number of cases treatment of this locaHty will entirely cure the dis- ease. A very effective treatment, in addition to the ordinary methods of treatment, is to have the patient lie flat upon the back while the osteo- path reaches around the patient on either side, placing the fingers firmly upon the transverse processes of the lower dorsal vertebrae and spring- ing the spine forward by lifting upward on the patient, enough even to raise the patient from the surface he is lying on. This treatment is especially effective in lessening the increased amount of urine. At- tention should be given to the false ribs on either side and to the condi- tion of the spine below and above the renal splanchnics. The cervical vertebrae should be examined carefully for disorders, and if any are found they should be removed at once, if possible. 478 The Practice of Osteopathy Hygienic treatment is of as much importance as in diabetes mellitus. The clothing should be warm, warm baths taken, and general friction and care of the skin utiHzed so that the circulation may be somewhat di- verted from the kidneys. Restriction of water is not always necessary, except in cases where excessive drinking has become a habit, as the thirst is caused by the diuresis and not the diuresis by the large ingestion of water. Regulate the diet and see that the bowels are acting normally. Rickets Rachitis De&nition. — A constitutional disease of children, characterized by impaired nutrition and changes in the growing bones, causing deformi- ties. The physical growth is disturbed and the bone deformity is due to an over growth of cartilages and delayed calcification. Etiology and Patliology. — Rickets may occur in the new-born, but it rarely begins before the child is six months old. It is a disease of the first and second years of Hfe. Heredity is probably not a factor but certain races, especially the Negro and Italian, have a tendency to be rickety. The disease is much more common in the large cities than in rural districts; also it is more common in Europe than America. The disease is most frequently met with among the ill-fed and badly housed poor of the large cities, though it is not rare to find it among the well-to- do. Lesions to the digestive organs predispose. Breast-fed children seldom have the disorder. Improper or insufficient food (a diet too low in fats and proteins) bad air, want of sunhght, prolonged lactation, expos- ure to cold and dampness are presisposing factors. Pathologically, the most marked changes are seen in the long bones and the ribs. The cartilage between the epiphysis and shaft is thickened and is soft and irregular in outline. Underneath the per- iosteum the tissue is spongy. Microscopic examination shows an increase of proKferation of the cartilage cells with scanty calcification. The bones are soft and there is a diminution in the calcareous salts. In a word ossification is delayed and the bones are not perfectly developed. In the cranium the frontal and parietal eminences are prominent, while the top of the head and the occiput are flattened, giving the head a square appearance. The fontanelles remain open until the second or third year of Hfe. The ribs become affected very early. At the point where the ribs join the costal cartilages, bulging occurs, forming the so-called "rachitic rosary." The normal shape of the chest walls is markedly changed. Just outside the junction of the ribs with the cartilages, the r The Practice of Osteopathy 479 ribs fall in, producing a shallow depression, while the sternum and car- tilages are pushed forward. The bones of the leg may be distorted. The normal curves of the spine are occasionally disturbed. The liver and spleen are often increased in size. Symptoms. — The onset is slow. In many cases digestive disturb- ances, with their usual effect upon the nutrition, precede the appearance of the characteristic lesions. The child is irritable and restless, and there is usually sHght fever and profuse sweats. The child is often languid, pale and feeble. The lymph gland are enlarged. The tissues are soft and flabby and skeletal changes begin to make their appearance. Among the first are changes in the ribs and head, already described under pathol- ogy. Changes sometimes occur in the bones of the face, particularly the maxillae. Dentition is delayed. The spinal column is frequently curved antero-posteriorly or laterally. The long bones are curved and their extremities become thickened. The pelvis is distorted and twisted and in women this may seriously compKcate labor. "Chicken breast" and "bow legs" are common, as well as muscular weakness, and the child walks late. The abdomen is large and prominent, due to flatulency and to the enlargement of the liver and spleen. Diagnosis and Prognosis. — By observing the symptoms, diagno- sis is not difficult. Prognosis should be guarded, owing to danger from other diseases; still, on the whole, prognosis is fairly favorable. Treatment. — Rickets being a disease of malnutrition due to weak- ness of the digestive organs, improper food, or to influences of disease, the treatment must be principally following hygienic rules and good dieting. The child under six months, if not nursed satisfactorily by the mother, should be given diluted cow's milk. Salts may be obtained from barley gruel and whole wheat. Diluting the milk, with barley water is highly recommended. Fresh meat juice and cream are invaluable. If curds are found in the stools, the digestion is not perfect and is usually due to overfeeding the child. The child should be out doors as much as possible. Fresh air is a necessity. The worst air outside is better than the best air of the house as far as purity is concerned. Protect the child carefully with warm clothes, and when sitting or walking the child should be supported. Baths will be found beneficial. In the older child, beef juice, light meats, yolks of eggs, green veg- etables and fruits may be given. Lessen the amount of carbohydrates. Careful osteopathic treatment of the various affected tissues of the child will aid a great deal in correcting deformities. Attention to the lesions found will also aid in increasing the nutrition to the involved tissues. 480 The Practice of Osteopathy as well as correcting digestive disturbances. This, also, is of distinct benefit in improving the assimilation of hme salts. Possibly treatment of the "nutritional" centers, (fourth dorsal and fourth lumbar) would be effectual. Carefully guard against comphcations of the nervous and respiratory systems. After ossification the deformities may be corrected by the orthopedic surgeon, though in the young child considerable can be accomphshed b}-- repeated attempts at straightening by bending and molding the long bones. All those conditions which predispose to rickets should receive attention; chief among these is the care of the nutrition of the mother during pregnancy. Nursing should be regulated, and possibh^ future pregnancies discouraged. Obesity Definition. — Obesity is essentially a nutritional disease and is an inconvenient accumulation of adipose tissue in the body, sometimes im- pairing the bodily function. With some individuals obesity is a normal condition. In others it means impaired health, especialty poor ehmina- tion. Etiology and Pathology.— Heredity, overeating, sedentary habits, hot, moist climates are predisposing causes. Exciting causes are especial- ly the eating of fat-making food, excessive use of alcohol and insufficient exercise. Obesity may follow the menopause or an infectious disease. Osteopathic lesions are frequently found in the upper and middle dorsal region. These probably are causes of a disturbed metabohsm. An excessive diet of starches and sugars will indirectly act as a fat producer. In young people the possibihty of hypopituitarism should be considered. Lesions of the upper cervical, in these cases, are frequent. Pathologically, adipose tissue is deposited throughout most of the tissues. Usually the abdomen is encumbered with a large amount. Passive congestion probably favors the deposition of fat, for in cases of pendulous abdomen, simply drawing the abdomen in and up and the pa- tient, through voluntary effort, keeping it up, will frequently cause ab- sorption of the fat in a few days or weeks. The fat is distributed under- neath the skin, throughout the viscera and about the heart. The tis- sues may suffer from fatty infiltration, especially the heart, arteries and veins; also the fiver, kidneys and stomach. There is an increase of specific gravity of the blood. Edema occurs from passive congestion, due to weak heart. Symptoms. — The round, fat face, double chin, hanging cheeks, large waist, the thick, prominent, sometimes pendulous abdomen, and the I The Practice of Osteopathy 481 bulky extremities form characteristic features. At first obesity presents no harmful symptoms. Usually the first troublesome symptom is in- creased frequency in the breathing, due to a weak and overworked heart, and to the fact that the motion of the lungs is hampered bj^ the heavy chest walls, and also by the interference with the descent of the diaphragm* on account of the enlarged liver. Dyspnea, passive congestion, anemia, poor digestion, uterine disorders, and mental inactivity are common. There is cardiac hypertrophy; later the heart is overlaid with fat. The pulse is usually frequent, but lasiy be irregular and slow. Treatment. — Obesity being a nutritional disease it seems but reasonable that alterations of the anatomical structures will produce a change in the proper balance of nutrition. Along osteopathic lines, de- rangement of tissues affecting the nerves to the digestive and lymphatic systems will produce obesity. In the majority of cases examined have been found disturbances at the sixth and seventh cervical, fourth and fifth dorsal and from the tenth dorsal to the second lumbar. Lesions at these points could readily interfere with the thoracic duct and the receptaculum chyH, as well as with the processes of digestion, assimila- tion and elimination. It is claimed that stimulation of the splanchnic nerves causes dilatation of the receptaculum chyli. Direct treatment to the abdomen and to areas of fatty deposit will aid very materially in absorption. The dietetic treatment is essential, the principle being to furnish less food to oxidize. Restrict fats, sugar and starches and limit the amount of water. Alcohol should be prohibited. Another important point in the treatment is exercise, which must be carried out in a sys- tematic way. Rules can be laid down only in individual cases and should be governed by the osteopath in charge. The principal effect of general mechanical treatment is to promote oxidation. Massage and baths are beneficial. The patient can do much for the abdomen by keeping it in and up, and walking erect. Scurvy Definition. — A constitutional disease, characterized by extreme general weakness, anemia, spongy condition of the gums, disintegration of tissue and a tendency to hemorrhages. Etiology and Patliology. — In comparison with former times scurvy is now a rare disease. Lack of fresh vegetables or their substitutes, over- crowding, dampness, bad hygienic surroundings, and prolonged fatigue under depressing influences are the predisposing causes. Arctic explor- ers have shown that fi-esh bear's meat and bear's blood are a preventative. 482 The Practice of Osteopathy There are extravasations of blood into the skin, muscles and mu- cous membranes. Hemorrhages may occur in the internal organs, es- pecially the kidneys and liver, and in the serous membranes. The gums are swollen and spongy. The teeth decay. The spleen is soft and en- larged. Parenchymatous degeneration of the heart, liver and kidney is fi-equent. Ulcers occasionally occur in the skin and bowels. The blood is thin but there is no leucocytosis. Symptoms.— The disease is usually slow in development. The general manifestations of anemia with debihty are among the first symptoms. The gums are swollen, soft and spongy, they bleed easily and in severe cases there is ulceration. Petechial spots appear upon the body. Subcutaneous ecch3rmosis occurs, first on the legs, then on the arms and trunk. The eyes and face are swollen; the patient appears as if he had been bruised. Hemmorrhages from the mucous membrane fre- quently occur. The temperature is usualty normal. The pulse is small, feeble and frequent; sometimes irregular and slow. The appetite is impaired and constipation is present at first, as a rule, although this may be followed by scorbutic dysentery. Diagnosis. — The disease is readily recognized when several cases occur together. It is somewhat hard to recognize in isolated cases, and to be able to distinguish it from certain forms of purpura. The etiology, the gingival changes and the hemorrhages usually decide the diagnosis. Prognosis. — Scurvy being a disease due to malnutrition, it is neces- sary to remedy such condition by attention and correction of the faults producing it. Hygienic surroundings and a wholesome diet will do more in curing the disease than anything else. An out-door life and good ven- tilation with anti-scorbutics, as fruit juices, especially lemons and oranges, fresh vegetables, (onions, potatoes, etc.) and fresh milk, are necessary. It is held by Garrod that scurvy is caused by an absence of potash, for a deficiency of potassium salts is found in the blood. The anti- scorbutics named above contain potash. A careful treatment along the splanchnics would help to improve the appetite and digestion. Treat the gums and ulcers according to surgical indications. Infantile Scurvy Scorbutus This form usually follows the prolonged use of condensed milk, sterilized milk or proprietary foods for children. The disease occurs during the first two years of life, Ijut it is most common from the seventh to the fourteenth month. The Practice of Osteopathy 483 It develops rapidly. Joint pains, anemia and irritability are early symptoms. The child is pale, has a muddy complexion and may show signs of rickets. The gmns may be soft and spongy. There is tenderness and pain on motion. There may be hemorrhages under the skin. The lower limbs are drawn up and motionless. The bones become thickened from sub-periosteal hemorrhage, and there is apt to be softening be- tween the shaft and epiphysis. The back and legs become very weak. The lesions are usually symmetrical. The temperature is variable. Treatment. — The treatment of scurvy in children consists in, first, omitting all proprietary foods and substituting fresh cow's milk, meat juice, strained gruel and a moderate quantity of fresh orange or lem- on juice. Under this treatment, cases that have not progressed too far will promptl}^ recover. Northrop says: ''It is a significant fact that the country which fur- nishes most of the Kterature on scorbutus in children is the same which is posted from end to end with advertisements of proprietary foods." Purpura Purpura is a symptom rather than a disease. It is characterized by extravasation of blood into the skin and bleeding from the mucous membranes, irrespective of direct injury. These extravasations do not disappear upon pressure and vary greatly in size. They may be small, (petechiae) or large (ecchymoses) . They are bright red and gradually become darker. Clotting of normal blood requires three to five minutes, purpuric blood, ten to fifteen minutes. It is a symptom of infectious diseases, as in pyemia, septicemia, mycotic endocarditis, typhus fever, smallpox, etc. Toxic, as produced by venomous snake bites and by certain medicines, as copaiba, mercury, quinine, iodides and others in overdoses. Cachectic purpura may be observed in cancer, tuberculosis, Bright's disease, scurvy, etc. In senile purpura the spots are generally confined to the extremities. Id certain nervous diseases, bleeding spots appear on the skin, as in tabes, myelitis and severe neuralgia. Mechanical purpura is seen in venous stasis; this is rare. Purpura simplex affects only the skin. It occasionally follows attacks of infectious diseases. The spots are found upon the legs, more rarely upon the trunk and arms. Articular pains may or may not occur. Fever is seldom present. I;0ss of appetite, diarrhea and slight anemia may be manifested. The duration is one to four weeks. Purpura rheumatica is a much more serious affection, character- ized by multiple arthritis of rheumatism. Seldom seen under five years. 484 The Practice of Osteopathy and lasts about two weeks. The joints are swollen and painful and the temperature rises to 101 and 103 degrees F. The amount of edema varies greatly and occasionally it is quite excessive. In addition to the pur- pura there is usually urticaria. Henoch's purpura is seen most fre- quently in children and is characterized by severe gastro-intestinal dis- turbances as pain, vomiting and diarrhea, hemorrhages from the mucous membranes and acute enlargement of the spleen, in addition to the symp- toms already named under the foregoing form. There is some danger of hemorrhage into the kidneys. The disorder of purpura hemorrhagica is usually associated with rheumatism, malaria and other infectious diseases. This is the most serious form of purpura. It is most commonly met with in delicate girls during early life; but it may occur at any age and in the most robust of either sex. Fever, weakness, vomiting and diarrhea are the early S3anptoms. After a couple of days of languor and weakness, purpuric spots appear upon the skin; and bleeding occurs from the mucous mem- branes and may cause profound anemia. Hemorrhages into the inter- nal organs occur. Favorable cases recover in ten days or two weeks. Others may end fatally. Care should be taken not to confuse the disease with scurvy. Treatment. — In the treatment of purpm-a the disease from which it develops should receive due attention. Occasionally there is danger of overlooking the primary disease and treating some symptoms of the disease, although it is true that sometimes an important symptom is nearty all that is manifested. Outside of treating the conditions under which purpura arises, general measures should be considered, as a nutri- tious diet, rest, fresh air, and general treatment of the patient so that normal circulation and strength may be restored. The treatment of the purpura locally should be such as to restore normal circulation of the part by removing any obstruction or irritation of the blood supply that may be found, by careful manipulation of the tissues. As stated the manage- ment of the disease under which it arises should be embraced in the treat- ment. In cases of hemorrhage from various organs see article under hemorrhage. Some cutaneous hemorrhages are best relieved by local manipulation. Hemophilia (Bleeder's Disease). Hemophiha is a hereditary condition manifested by a tendency to uncontrollable hemorrhage with or without injury. The usual mode The Practice of Osteopathy 485 of transmission is through the female line, rather than by the male. The mother does not necessarily have to be a bleeder, but the daughter of one, in order to transmit the disease to her offspring. Atavism through the female alone is almost the rule. Not all the children of a bleeding family are afHicted; the male children are more subject to the condition than the female children. The tendency usually appears within the first two years of hfe. The families of bleeders are often large and are commonly healthy looking and have fine soft skins. It is claimed blondes are most likely to be afflicted. Pathologically, an unusual thinness of the blood-vessels with a fatty degeneration of the intima has been noted. In many cases there is deficient coagulability of the blood and a lessened number of leucocytes. Hemorrhages have been found in and about the capsules of the joints, and in a few instances inflammation of the synovial surfaces. The arteries are situated superficially, but that does not explain anything. The real nature of the disease has not been determined. Emotional excitement is a factor, consequently vasomotor disturbances may be im- portant. The frailty of the blood-vessels and the peculiar constitution of the blood preventing thrombotic formation are the two facts of importance that have been recognized. Symptoms. — Hemorrhages occur from the most trifling injuries. Blowing the nose may cause severe epistaxis; the extraction of a tooth is a frequent cause of hemorrhage; the prick of a pin, a slight cut, a scratch, or a blow may result in profuse bleeding. The bleeding may occur spontaneously from the mucous membrane of the mouth, nose, lungs, intestines, etc. ; or it may occur directly from the fingers, toes, back of the hands, and lobes of the ears. The hemorrhages may last several hours. As soon as checked the patients rapidly resume natural appearance providing the bleeding is not often repeated, thereby causing a permanent anemia. There may be attacks of arthritis with fever, as with acquired hemorrhagic tendency, closely resembhng rheumatism. Diagnosis. — Hereditary tendency and persistent hemorrhage from shght injury. Prognosis. — In a few cases the tendency to bleed gradually dimin- ishes until at last it entirely ceases. The younger the subject the more is it liable to prove fatal. In the majority of cases death occurs between the first and eighth years. After maturity the chances of an attack are much lessened. Treatment. — Memljcrs of the bleeder's family, particularly the boys, should be guarded against traumatic influences, and operations 486 The Practice of Osteopathy of all kinds should be avoided. Out-door exercise, fresh air, bathing and plain nourishing food, in fact, the hj'gienic surroundings, and all food should be carefully watched so that the threatened subject may become strengthened and hardened. Marriage should be discouraged, especially with the daughters, as it is through them the tendency is propagated. Possibly, coupled with the foregoing prophylactic treatment, a stimula- tion of the glands of elaboration of the blood will be of service to build up the physical constitution of the patient. During attacks absolute rest and the required symptomatic treatment should be given. For resultant anemia the usual treatment is to be employed. In severe cases direct transfusion should be considered. I The Practice of Osteopathy 487 DISEASES OF THE DIGESTIVE SYSTEM Diseases of the Mouth Stomatitis Definition. — Inflammation of the mouth. Etiology.— Chemical, mechanical, thermal or parasitic irritations; secondary to disorders of the gastro-intestinal tract, scarlet fever, measles and variola; cachexia, due to such diseases as cancer and phthisis; den- tition; artificial feeding; hot weather and poor hygienic surroundings are the most common causes. Lesions to the innervation and vascular sup- ply of the mouth are found, principally, in the upper cervical vertebrae, occasionally in the upper dorsal vertebrae and corresponding ribs. Varieties. — Catarrhal, aphthous, ulcerative, parasitic, gangrenous. Catarrhal Stomatitis Etiology. — Most common in infants and children. Hot and ir- ritating substances; secondary to diseases of the stomach, to measles, scarlet fever and variola; difficult dentition; alcohohc or tobacco excesses. Hazzard says in all cases of stomatitis "there is generally lesion to the bony or other tissues in the cervical region (sometimes also in the up- per dorsal), which deranges vasomotor control of the tissues of the mouth and tongue, obstructs venous return, weakens the tissues and lays them liable to the effects of some particular irritant, local or in the system, but there is, generally, lesion affecting the gastro-intestinal tract which is the real underlying cause of the trouble." Symptoms. — Diffuse, red swelhng of the mucous membrane, heat and pain in the mouth, increased flow of saliva, fetor of breath, rest- lessness and languor. In children there is a disinclination to nurse and a slight fever may be present. The sense of taste is blunted and there is commonly a bitter taste in the mouth. The neck glands are enlarged. Treatment. — Removal of the exciting cause is the most improtant point in the treatment. Good hygienic conditions must be enforced. The mouth should be kept clean. Wipe it out at frequent intervals with a soft piece of absorbent cotton and cold water. A borax solution is frequently used. Attention should be paid to the diet and secretions. Light but thorough treatment of the upper cervical region is to be given, 488 The Practice of Osteopathy with careful attention to the tissues about and below the angles of the jaw, so that the innervation, blood and lymphatic supply may be equal- ized. Aphthous Stomatitis (Canker) This disease is characterized by little, painful, grayish-white spots upon the superficial layer of the mucous membrane. They consist, primarily, of an exudate of fibrin and wandered-out leucocytes. It is principally a disease of childhood. Among the common causes are diffi- cult dentition, disorders of digestion and uncleanhness of the mouth, such as neglect to cleanse the child's mouth after nursing. It may be a symptom of measles or of local diseases. Probabl}^ the innervation to the region of the Uttle grayish-white spots or canker is obstructed at some points by a disordered tissue. The lesion may be mechanical or it may arise from a disordered digestion. If one is able to locate such a lesion and remove it, a cure will be hastened. The seat of the infection is the internal surface of the cheeks, gums, roof of the mouth, tongue and Ups. Symptoms.— There is redness of the mucous membrane of the mouth, followed by the appearance of the vesicles with a red areola. Pain in the mouth and an increased flow of saliva occur. Mastication, deglutition, and even speaking, may be painful. This condition is followed by sleeplessness, [feverishness, diarrhea and fetor of the breath. Treatment. — Removal of the cause, as in other varieties of stoma- titis, is paramount. Give attention to the food. The milk should be sterilized. The disordered digestion should be corrected at once. All secretions must receive prompt attention. The child should be nursed at regular intervals. Locally, keep the parts clean and carefulty treat the innervation. Ulcerative Stomatitis This is a disease of children, although it may not be hmited to them, as it occasionally occurs in epidemics and affects all ages. It occurs chiefly in the families of the poor and in places where the hygienic sur- roundings are bad, the food poor and personal cleanliness lacking. It may begin as an aphthous stomatitis. Often sufferers from severe, acute diseases are subjects of attack. The Peactice of Osteopathy 489 Symptoms. — The gums of the lower jaw are chiefly affected. They are at first congested, swollen and bleed readily. Pain is increased by mastication and deglutition, the mouth is hot, the breath fetid, the saHva dribbles and the digestion and bowels are disordered. The ulcers may appear at various points upon the cheeks, lips and tongue; the deposit is yellowish-gray. In the more severe cases the gums are spongy and the teeth are loos- ened. In proportion to the constitutional disturbances, fever and en- largement and tenderness of the submaxillary glands occur. Even necrosis of the bone may follow. Parasitic Stomatitis (Thrush) The exciting cause is a fungus known as Laccharomyces albi- cans. It is claimed that a catarrhal stomatitis is the soil upon which the fungus develops. Parasitic stomatitis is chiefly a disease of nursing children and is promoted by unhygienic conditions. It is seldom seen after ten years of age, occurring in adults only in the last stages of con- sumption, cancer, and severe chronic diseases. Symptoms. — Upon inspection there are seen numerous milk-white elevations. These appear first about the angles of the mouth, soon ex^ tending to all parts of the mouth, and in a few cases, even to the pharynx and to the esophagus. When removed bleeding points are left. The general symptoms of stomatitis are present — pain upon mastication and swallowing; fetid, hot breath; increased sahva; increased temperature; restlessness; swollen lips and disordered digestion occur. Diagnosis. — The microscope will remove all doubt as to the nature of the affection. In aphthous stomatitis the ulcers are preceded by the formation of vesicles. Prognosis. — Is favorable in the majority of cases. Treatment. — Hygienic measures, absolute cleanliness, correction of the disorders of the gastro-intestinal tract and local treatment as in other forms of stomatitis, is the required treatment. A boric acid solu- tion will be found beneficial. 490 The Practice of Osteopathy SPINAL LESIONS AND THEIR RELATION TO DISEASES OF THE GASTRO-INTESTINAL TRACT Acute Gastritis, Chronic Gastritis, Gastric Neurosis, Gastric and Duodenal Ulcer. By Charles J. Muttart The instant relief that Osteopathy can give in acute indigestion is one of its outstanding achievements. It impresses the patient and his friends with a deep conviction of the superiority of osteopathic therapy. The results in these cases are not, in any sense, a matter of chance. They follow logically from the osteopathic viewpoint, teaching, reasoning, and practice. In deaHng with the manifestations of disease, such as heredity, onset, course, duration, subjective and objective symptoms, etc., and in the effort to differentiate cause from effect, and to reconstruct a mental picture of the sequence of cause, effect and sequelae, the osteopath has the advantage of binocular vision in that he recognizes two distinct pathologies co-operating to produce the symptom complex, syndrome or disease which he is called upon to treat. One pathology is to be found in one or more of the vertebral and rib articulations and the immed- iately adjacent or corresponding segments of the spinal cord. The other is in some one or more of the organs or tissues connected with the pathological segment or segments of the cord. The function of the joint is MOTION. — Unrestricted normal range of motion is essential for the normal function of all parts of the articulation as well as for the nutrition of the nerve mechanisms immed- iately adjacent. When a spinal articulation ceases to perform its func- tion all of its parts are more or less impaired, muscles atrophy, liga- ments lose their tone, and circulation to and from the spinal segment is interfered with because action is a large factor in promoting the flow of blood and lymph and maintaining normal stimulus. As a result of this spinal pathology, internal organs and tissues, sup- plied by nerves arising in the segment that is in lesion, will be variously disturbed in their function. Dr. Carl P. McConnell says: ''My observation of lesioned animals so far as the digestive organs are concerned is that the lesion affects the reflexes of and through spinal and sympathetic ganglia so that the vaso- motors arc involved with a consequent hyperemia of the submucous coat. This means involvement of the endothehal layer of the blood- vessels, diapedesis, derangement of the secretory function and dis- The Practice of Osteopathy 491 turbance of the motor mechanism, all of which lead to functional upset and disturbance." The dominant part played by the osteopathic lesion as a causative factor in acute and chronic diseases of the alimentary canal becomes in- creasingly evident as cHnical observation and laboratory research permit a more thorough appreciation of the anatomy and physiology of the parts involved. The abnormal stands out more clearly from the normal. Finally, the task of restoring normaUty is becoming a clear-cut problem to which the correction of the osteopathic lesions furnishes an almost complete solution. The normal ahmentary canal transports food, macerating it, mixing it, and treating it with various chemicals and enzymes on the way, break- ing it down physically and chemically, and absorbing from it such end- products as are needed to maintain metabohsm. The abnormal ali- mentary tract may be at fault in any of these functions. This dehn- quency is generally traceable to a mechanical origin. Correction of the mechanical deviation is followed by restoration of normal function except in cases where extensive tissue changes have occurred. Thorough mastication is essential to good digestion. Any dental defects or deficiencies should be corrected. The tentporo-mandibular articulation should be examined, and full free motion restored if lack- ing. The muscles on the affected side are softer than on the sound side. Tonic spasm rigidly closes the mouth. It may be due to tetanus, caries of the lower teeth, cutting of the lower wisdom tooth, or other irritations to the sensory branches of the inferior maxillary nerve. There is enough space back of the wisdom teeth to pass a catheter to administer food. The tongue assists in mastication and deglutition and is the seat of most of the nerves of taste. The hypoglossal nerve, which supplies it, leaves the skull through the anterior condyloid foramen and may be impinged there or lower in its course. Lesions of the occiput and upper cervical vertebrae and obstructions to the lymphatic drainage at the angle of the jaw may cause pressure on this nerve and cause dis- turbances in the movements of the tongue, atrophy, swelling, etc. Swell- ing may be due also to endocrine disturbance, constitutional diseases, anemia, glossitis, local irritants, injuries, etc. Pressure may be made on the hypoglossal nerve behind the angle of the jaw. The special sense of taste plays an important role in normal digestion. The hngual nerve supphes the anterior two-thirds of the tongue with taste. The sense of taste may be lost, impaired, perverted or otherwise abnormal. 492 The Practice of Osteopathy The sense of smell plays an important part in om- appreciation of flavors, and when it is impaired by colds, adenoids, or other affections of the nose or pharjmx, the sense of taste is measurably impaired. Nor- malization of nose and pharynx restores the sense of taste in such cases. Impairment or loss may also be due to lesions of the chorda tym- pani, or glosso-pharyngeal nerves. Lesions of the mandible, hyoid, occiput or upper cervical nerves, parotid disease or obstructed lymphatic drainage behind the angle of the jaw may cause pressure directly or in- directly on the glosso-pharyngeal and chorda tympani nerves. Per- version of taste occur in pregnancy, hysteria, epilepsy and insanity. Foul taste, fetororis in the mouth is frequent in pneumonia, ty- phoid fever, peritonitis, septicemia and other severe fevers; also after ingestion of pungent foods or strong drugs; in constitutional diseases; as a result of inattention to oral hygience, excessive smoking, mouth breath- ing at night, furred tongue, etc. It clears up on removing the cause. Furred tongue occurs in gastritis, fevers, and a variety of other con- ditions. The fur is composed of broken down epitheUum which would normally be removed by friction with solid food. When none is taken, the fur accumulates. When blood or hematin becomes mixed with the broken down epithelium, the fur is brown. Ordinarily it is white. A clean red tongue is frequently found in hyperacidity. It is probably due to vasodilatation due to hyperactivity of the autonomics or inhibi- tion of sympathetics. The sympathetic supply is from the superior cervical ganglion. It may be affected by lesions of the occiput, atlas, axis and third cervical vertebra, of the hyoid, by anterior cervical muscu- lar contractures, by obstruction to venous and lymphatic drainage and blood supply. Correction of the lesions named and normahzation of the other structm-es involved will usually restore the tongue to normal con- dition. The salivary glands have a two-fold innervation. The thin, full, watery, salty secretion is produced by activity of the cranial autonomic fibers; the sparse, viscous secretion containing the organic elements, ptyalin, etc., is produced by the sympathetics. The sympathetic nerve supply is from the middle and superior cervical ganglia and can be disturbed by lesions affecting them as mentioned above. The secre- tion of ptyahn may be disturbed by any lesion from the fifth dorsal up. It must not be forgotten that a posterior occiput draws the super- ior cervical ganghon back against the axis and third cervical with just as much pressure as is exerted by an anterior atlas or third cervical. This pressure or stretching tends to inhibit it, preventing vasoconstric- The Practice of Osteopathy 493 tion and permitting vasodilatation of the internal carotid artery and its branches and congestion of the parts suppUed, mid-brain, cerebrum, etc. If, for any reason, the venous drainage from the lateral sinus into the internal jugular vein, or the ebb and flow of the crebrospinal fluid between brain and cord, is reduced or hampered, an extra burden is thrown on the cerebral veins and sinuses, and the intra-cranial pressure is raised at each heart-beat, ultimately producing pressure on the menin- ges and causing violent headache over the fifth and tenth cranial nerves which supply the meninges with sensation. These nerves are inti- mately connected with the digestive system. Any increase of intra- cranial pressm'e causes increased irritabiHty and hyperactivity of the cranial nerves, many of which are concerned with various functions of the digestive system. Moreover, the nuclei of these nerves He on the floor of the fourth ventricle which is suppHed mainly by the vertebral arteries and the basilar artery. Lesions of the cervical vertebrae affect- ing the plexus on the vertebral artery or filaments to it from the upper parts of the cervical ganghated sympathetic cord, may impair the blood- flow through the vertebral arteries and cause similar increased irrita- biHty of the nerve-cells in the medulla, mid-brain and cerebellum. Such disturbance is reflected in awkward movement, hyperesthesia, and symp- toms due to increased irritabiHty of the autonomic nerves such as slow pulse and respiration, watering of the mouth, hypersecretion and hyper- motility of the gastro-intestinal tract, rapid digestion and poor assimila- tion, vasodilatation, impoverished blood, and so through a vicious cycle back to still greater impairment of nutrition to the nerve-cells within the cranium. Until the lesions are corrected, the condition becomes pro- gressively worse till exhaustion occurs. Ordinary medical hygiene can do little or nothing. The palHative remedies employed simply mask the symptoms, or actually accelerate the destructive process. Lesions that irritate the cervical sympathetics would cause vasoconstriction and give rise to opposite symptoms, name- ly, cerebral ischemia, decreased flow of saHva, atony of stomach, lack of digestive juices, sluggish intestinal peristalsis, rapid pulse and respira- tion, etc. Correction of the lesions and restoration of normal blood- supply and drainage to the brain and removal of anj^ lesions tending to inhibit the sympathetics from the fifth dorsal up, will usually in a short time restore the activity of the saHvary glands to normal. The otic and sphenopalatine gangHa can be disturbed by abnormal conditions within the pharynx. These must be corrected when found. 494 The Practice of Osteopathy Deglutition, or swallowing, is a very rapid, highh^ complex move- ment. It takes not more than a second for the food to cross the pharynx. The soft palate and larynx are raised to close off the air-way, making the food-way practicallj' continuous for the second needed to complete the transfer of the food across the air-way. The tongue is pressed against the roof of the mouth and the mylohyoid contracts vigorouslj^ and shoots the bolus of food across the pharynx. Bolting. the food leads to serious digestive disturbances, not the least of which is the loss of the normal reflex which prevents swallowing unprepared food. When lost, this reflex can be restored by thorough mastication for three or four months. The voluntary part of swallowing is performed by the motor por- tion of the fifth cranial and the hypoglossus. The involuntary part involves afferent impulses over the superior laryngeal and efferent im- pulses over the inferior laryngeal. The levator palati which raises the soft palate is probably supplied by the spinal accessory nerve through the pharyngeal plexus. This nerve can be affected by lesions of the occiput, atlas, mandible and hyoid, and by any obstruction to lymphatic drainage which increases pressure behind the angle of the jaw. In paraly- sis of the levator palati, as af terdiphtheria or other peripheral neuritis, fluids regurgitate through the nose during the act of swallowing. The rais- ing and closing of the larynx is accompHshed by the superior and recur- rent laryngeal nerves by way of the pharyngeal plexus. Pain in swal- lowing is generally due to some inflammation or infection of the tonsil or phar3^nx. This does not occur when everything is normal from the fifth dorsal up. The second and third stages of swallowing occur in the esophagus. The esophagus receives esophageal branches from the vagus, carrying autonomic fibers which contract its longitudinal muscles and dilate its arteries. It also receives sympathetic impulses from the plexus on the arteries which supply it. These sympathetic impulses convey vaso- constriction and constriction of the circular muscles of the esophagus. Anj^ lesion from seventh cervical to ninth dorsal might affect the esopha- gus; probably fifth dorsal is the most nearly specific, as the heartburn which results from regurgitation into the esophagus is usually locahzed there. Lesions of the upper six dorsal vertebrae interfere with digestion and nutrition in another vital way by reducing the activity of the lungs and consequent intake of oxygen into the system. If there is not sufficient oxygen to oxidize the pi-oteins to amino-acids there will be harmful pro- The Practice of Osteopathy 495 ducts left for the tissues to neutralize. Lesions of the third, fourth and fifth cervical affecting the phrenic may have a like effect. Sub-oxida- tion must be noted when present and treated by removing lesions affect- ing respiration, b}^ deep-breathing exercises, and by diet rich in the needed mineral salts, and properly balanced. An improperly balanced diet changes the structure of the tissues and amounts in effect to an osteo- pathic lesion which causes disturbed function. It must be searched for, found if present, accounted for, corrected and kept corrected to ob- tain maximum therapeutic results. The stomach, intestines and rectum are intimately related with the other abdominal viscera. It will therefore be readily seen that any disturbance of the hver, gall-bladder, pancreas, spleen, duodenum, pleura or peritoneum will disturb the function of the stomach, and that anj^ disturbance of any organ will disturb the function of the intestine. In fact, chnically, it would seem that the majority of cases can be accounted for by the lesions found, the stomach or intestinal disturbances which are regarded as reflex from some other organ, being in reaHtj^ caused by the same lesion as disturbed the organ which first manifested disturbance. Going more deeply into the nature of the mechanism whereby symp- toms of gastro-intestinal disturbance are produced, we find that the aU- mentary tract has an ingenious conveyer mechanism with a number of sphincters. These are operated by intrinsic sympathetic or myenteric nerves, called plexuses of Meissner and Auerbach. In conveying food, impulses are passed from one portion of the tract to the next over these myenteric arcs. Normally the peristaltic movement is always forward because the point of highest irritabihty is at the proximal end. There is an exception to this rule in the ascending colon, where antiperistalsis occurs normally. When the irritability of a distal point of the ali- mentary tract becomes greater than the more proximal points, an anti- peristaltic wave is set up causing vomiting. The myenteric activities are regulated by the autonomic impulses over the vagus, and by the sympathetic impulses over the splanchnic nerves. The autonomics contract the longitudinal muscles, dilating and shortening the tube. They also stimulate secretion of digestive juices and fluids and mucus and dilate the blood-vessels. The sympathetics contract the circular fibers and sphincters, narrowing and lengthening the tube, retarding the food, inhibiting the secretions and constricting the blood-vessels. The myenteric reflexes can continue after the vagi and splanchnics are cut. The vagi simply stimulate them and the splanchnics inhibit them. 496 The Practice of Osteopathy The pathways are from the coeliac plexus where the vagi and splanch- nics meet with various other plexuses on the arteries and following the courses of the arterial supply to the minutest parts of each organ. Each cell is surrounded by nerve fibers. Visceral-afferent fibers over both vagi and splanchnics convey impulses to the cord segments and me- dulla which modify the systemic blood-supply, drawing blood from the head and surface by constricting their arteries during digestion and filling the abdominal arteries. If opposite impulses should be received drawing blood away from the abdominal arteries, digestion would be interfered with. Any lesion or other condition causing hyperirritabihty or over- stimulation of the vagus will result in overstimulation of the myenteric nerves, with vasodilatation, hypersecretion, contraction of the longitudinal coat, widening and shortening of the digestive tube, sluggish peristalsis but rapid movement of food through the sphincters, incomplete diges- tion and undernourishment. Inhibition of the splanchnic nerves will produce a like result. The opposite condition would come about as a result of inhibition of the impulses over the vagus to the myenteric nerves, or of overstimulation of the splanchnic nerves. Inhibition of the splanchnic nerves may be secured by extreme flex- ion of the spinal column. This raises the cord in the spinal canal, length- ens it, stretches or draws on the nerve roots and vessels, squeezes the fluid out of the cord, and inhibits the splanchnics in two ways, first by a partial anemia or ischemia of the cord, and secondly by direct traction of the visceral afferent fibers in the posterior and anterior roots. Conversely, stimulation of the splanchnic nerves may be secured by complete extension of the spinal column. This lowers the cord in the spinal canal, shortens it, releases the strain on the nerve roots and ves- sels, flushes the cord with blood, and tones up the sympathetic impulses in two ways, first by increasing their relative and absolute nutrition, through richer supply of richer blood, and secondly by releasing the nerve roots from. strain, permitting free entry of afferent impulses over the posterior roots, and free exit of visceral-efferent impulses over the anterior roots. Any lesion, inasmuch as it limits or alters the normal motion in a joint, produces an exaggeration or diminution of the normal spinal curves, and more or less lateral curvature. The altered equihbrium thus pro- duced affects the viscera in three ways: 1. Mechanically, by pressure, gravity, altered position of ribs, vertebrae, diaphragm, etc. ; 2. Reflexly, influence on nerves to and from affected segment; 3. Directly, by inter- ference with nutrition of nerve-cells by hyperemia or ischemia. The Practice of Osteopathy 497 There is always a functional kyphosis in visceroptosis or splanch- noptosis. The nerves in the cord are inhibited. The skeletal muscles are hypotonic, allowing the functional kyphosis to occur, and the viscero- motor nerves are inhibited, allowing the abdominal viscera to become hypotonic and sag out of place within the abdominal cavity. The ribs are held up by the cervical fascia, and the abdominal muscles are held up by the ribs. The hypotonic condition extends to intercostals and ab- dominal muscles, with the result that the abdominal muscles are unable to play their part in maintaining the viscera in their proper places. The contraction or tonus of the abdominal muscles, the external and internal oblique, transversahs, rectus abdominis, diaphragm and levator ani, maintain the viscera firmly in position. It is only when the muscles of the abdominal wall have lost their tone that any strain or weight is thrown on the peritoneal and vascular supports. The inhibition of the restrain- ing sympathetic impulses via the splanchnic nerves, allows hypersecre- tion and hypermotility of the ahmentary tubes and further compHca- cates the clinical picture by a coKcky diarrhea or spastic constipation. There are eight sphincters of circular unstriped muscle in the ali- mentary tract. Inhibition of sympathetic supply or increased auto- nomic supply causes sphincter insufficiency, overstimulation by sympa- thetic impulses or an insufficient supply of balancing autonomic im- pulses causes sphincter spasm, stasis, vomiting, fermentation, putrefac- tion, auto-intoxication. At each of these sphincters food is held back and controlled tiU the proper time has elapsed and the proper chemical environment is prepared for it in the next portion of the tract. Normal function of these sphincters is absolutely essential to normal metab- oKsm and nutrition. The upper esophageal sphincter controls the en- trance to the esophagus; the cardia controls the entrance to the stomach, the pylorus controls the entrance to the duodenum, the X-Ray shows a duodenal sphincter that controls the entrance of food into the jejunum. Here the food enters the long tract of the jejunum and ileum which measures twenty-five feet when the longitudinal muscles are relaxed and the circular muscles tonic, and which a short time later may measure only fifteen feet when the longitudinal muscles are contracted and the circular are relaxed. This section ends at the ileo-cecal valve, which controls the entrance of food into the cecum. There is the mid-colic sphincter about the junction of the proximal third with the distal two-thirds of the transverse colon, and the. recto-colic sphincter which controls the passage from the sigmoid to the rectum. The rectum ends in the in- ternal sphincter ani. There is some evidence of a ninth sphincter, the. 498 The Practice of Osteopathy mid-gastric at the point where the peristaltic waves of the stomach be- gin. Absorption takes place mostly from the ilemn and jejunum and it is worthy of note that four of these sphincters hold the food up on its way into this part of the tract, and four of them hold it back on its way out. Any lesion m.Siy affect one or other of these sphincters. It is be- lieved that antiperistalsis from the mid-colic sphincter to the cecum dur- ing digestion is normal permitting more complete absorption of nour- ishment. Yet here, after absorption is complete, and at all times else- where in the ahmentary tract, peristalsis is normally forward because the point of liighest irritabihty is at the upper esophageal sphincter and the irritabihty decreases as the tract is further from the esophagus. When the splanchnics are inhibited and the vagus autonomic im- pulses are normal or increased, the intestinal sphincters from the py- lorus down may all be incompetent, so that food passes along too rapidly to be properly digested and absorbed. This results in undernourish- ment. Any lesion anywhere in the body will affect peristalsis. It be- gins at the lower third of the stomach where it joins the pyloric portion and goes forward to the internal sphincter ani, being modified in its course by local conditions. Compensation may be estabhshed. Many cases of diarrhea and constipation are thus to be accounted for. Diarrhea is a symptom due to vasodilatation, hypersecretion and relaxation of the circular muscles especially at the sphincters. When these three factors are cleared up by correction of the lesions and hyper-extension of the spine, the diarrhea stops unless some other factor is at work to irritate the myenteric nerves or to excite the autonomics or inhibit the splanchnics. Lesions from the sixth dorsal down are usually accom- panied at first by some diarrhea, which afterwards becomes constipa- tion, through loss of tone in the longitudinal muscles especially in the distal part of the colon. In these cases, correction of lesions, and ex- treme flexion of the lower dorsal and lumbar spine will give relief while the body is returning to normal. When gastric digestion begins, simultaneous action is set up in the ileum. When disease of the cecum, appendix or ascending colon is present, there is contraction of the ileo-cecal valve causing stasis of the lower ileum and disturbed or retarded action of stomach and duodenum. These reactions are brought about by impulses to and from the myen- teric plexus. The sympathetic and autonomic nerves affect the motor system of the alimentary tract not directly but through the myenteric or Auerbach's plexus. The Peactice or Osteopathy 499 The external sphincter ani muscle is supplied by the pudendal nerve from the third and fourth sacral segments. It is in a state of tonic contraction, and having no opposing muscles keeps the anal orifice closed. The autonomic supply to the longitudinal muscles in the descending colon and rectum is from the second and fourth sacral. Inhibition here will, therefore relax the longitudinal muscles and external sphincter and per- mit free peristalsis in the descending colon and rectum. Pelvic disturb- ances may afi^ect these nerves, or pressure due to visceroptosis, etc. The circular muscles of this section are supplied from the lumbar cord. They may be affected in any lumbar lesion, with the end result of spastic con- stipation by reason of a shortened markedly distended descending colon, sigmoid and rectum, and little peristalsis because of inhibition of the cir- cular fibers, and contraction of the external sphincter ani. The fundus of the stomach, lying in the left dome of the diaphragm, always contains a cushion of air which supports the left dome of the dia- phragm, as the convexity of the liver supports the right. Normally the air is regulated and causes no symptoms. A lesion, usually of the mid- dorsal or lower dorsal segments may inhibit the circular fibers and permit distension, which becomes enormous when the pylorus is obstructed. The shortness of breath, palpitation of the heart, etc., accompanying this distension are probably due to pressure on the heart and lungs from which the stomach is separated only by the diaphragm. Eighth, ninth and tenth dorsal lesions play a large part in peptic ul- cers by permitting hyperemia, hypersecretion, and lowered vitahty of the mucosa, and pyloric incompetence or spasm, because the pylorus, pyloric end of the stomach and first part of the duodenum get their chief sympathetic supply from the ninth and tenth dorsal segments of the cord. The tenth vertebra is more freely movable than the higher dorsal joints and is therefore more frequently in lesion, which helps to account for the greater frequency of duodenal ulcer. The main sympathetic supply to the appendix seems to be derived from the eleventh dorsal segment. The appendix has the same motor and secretory mechanism as the rest of the ahmentary tract but is richly supplied with lymphoid follicles. One of the twigs from the eleventh dor- sal nerve pierces the rectus muscle to supply the skin at McBurney's point, thus explaining the great frequency of pain and cutaneous hyper- algesia at this situation in appendicitis. Lower dorsal and upper lum- bar lesions are unquestionably causes of many cases of appendicitis and other obscure diseases traceable to appendicitis. Correction of 500 The Practice of Osteopathy these lesions has restored the appendix and related structures to nor- mahty in hundreds of cases. Sensory reflexes are shown in hyperalgesia and pain or tenderness in the abdominal skin and muscles and the parietal layer of the peritoneum from the ensiform cartilage to the pubes in an area extending about two inches on each side of the mid-hne, corresponding to the distribution of the twigs of the lower six thoracic nerves which supply sensation to this region. Esophageal disturbance at the cardia causes pain in the re- gion supplied with sensation by the fifth and sixth dorsal, near the ensi- form. Gastric derangement causes pain midway between the ensi- form and umbilicus, which radiates to the left, in the area supphed by the eighth dorsal. Hepatic disturbance causes pain on the right of the median line, radiating to the right in the sensory distribution of the ninth dorsal. Intestinal pain is located in the sensorj^ distribution of the tenth dorsal nerve in an oval area around the umbihcus. Pain due to duodenal ulcer is sharply localized at a point about an inch or two above and to the right of the umbihcus where twigs of the tenth dofsal nerve come to the surface. This point corresponds closely to the normal position of the underlying duodenum, thougli the duodenum may be displaced, and the sensitive spot remain at the same point. The pain from fundal gastric ulcer or carcinoma is usually locaHzed sharply about an inch or two to the right of the median line mid-way between the ensiform and umbilicus, at the spot where the twigs from the eighth dorsal nerve pierce the rectus and come to the surface. In the disease of the pylorus, reflex pain is lower; of the cardiac end, higher. The reflex pain at McBurney's point in appendicitis has been referred to, but it must be borne in mind that pain from disturbance in the colon also shows in the sensory distribution of the eleventh dorsal nerves midway between the umbilicus and pubes. Pain may also be referred to areas supphed in the back by the corresponding segments. These reflex pains can usually be stopped by inhibiting along the spine corresponding to the sensory area affected. This reduces the impulses entering the pos- terior roots and lowers the irritabihty of the segment. The motor reflexes from gastro-intestinal disturbances result in muscular contractures of spinal, abdominal and other muscles supplied by motor nerves arising in the anterior horn of the segment which inner- vates the part of the viscus that is affected. Stomach, liver, gall-gladder pyloric and duodenal disturbances cause increased tone, contraction, contracture and rigiditj^ of the rectus muscles above the umbihcus, for instance, and the other viscera contract it in lower portions. More The Practice or Osteopathy 501 important are the extreme contractures of the musculatm-e of the back which is suppHed by the segments which supply the affected part of the viscus. These contractures produce some distortion and loss of motion in spinal joints and thereby produce the same effects as primary lesions, causing widespread disturbance which persists until the spinal muscu- lature is normalized. In colic, the lumbar segments being involved, there is marked contraction of the ilio-psoas which causes the char- acteristic drawing up of the thighs on the abdomen, while the extreme contraction of the rectus abdominis draws the thorax down. Most persistent vomiting may arise reflexly from other organs as in so-called biliousness, jaundice, pregnane}^, brain affections, appendi- citis, onset of acute infectious diseases, alcohoHsm, sea-sickness, cohc, hernia, intestinal obstruction, migraine, shock, and anesthesia. Irrita- tion of any sensory branch of the vagus or of nerves which connect with it in the medulla, or reflexly from consciousness via the cerebral cortex, as in the case of nauseating sights, smells, tastes, as well as irritation from any viscera innervated from the sixth dorsal down, may over- stimulate the corresponding efferent nerves going to parts of the ah- rnentary tract supphed by that segment, increase its irritability and start antiperistalsis. Similarly disturbances in almost any viscus may reflex- ly disturb the normal balance between sympathetic and vagal autonomic stimuU resulting in hypersahvation, hyperchlorhydria, pylorospasm, distension, gastric atony, gastrosulcorrhea, enterocolitis, spastic con- stipation, achyha, or coKcky diarrhea. In these cases, the derange- ment of the viscus reflexly disturbs the aHmentary tract through central nerve connections. Correction of the primary trouble is followed by re- moval of the reflex symptoms. In this connection it is important to note that the visceral reflex symptoms may arise from irritation of the ahmentary tract by improper diet, poor cooking, or wrong combinations. Carbohydrates digest quicker than proteins, and these more rapidly than fats. Food is handled by the fundus in the order in which it was swallowed. If the fats are swallowed first, the starches may be held up for five or six hours, subjected to the acid stomach secretions and al- lowed to ferment causing distension, which reflexly produces a variety of symptoms. Mental exertion, strong emotions, heavy physical exertion, inter- fere with the function of the alimentary tract and set up disturbances in the balance of sympathetic and vagal autonomic impulses, through the nervous reflexes via the cortex, and through the demand for blood, 502 The Practice of Osteopathy which impoverishes the abdominal circulation at a time when it needs all the blood it can get. The ischemia produced in this way has about the same effect as ischemia produced by a spinal lesion. Conversely, disturbances of the alimentary tract produce profound changes in char- acter and personaUty, by reflexes to the cerebral cortex causing dullness of perception, in all the senses, poor memory, sluggish thought, erratic judgment, irritable disposition, fear, worry, lack of ambition, indecision, lack of energy, vacillation, and finally a psychosis in which manic-de- pressive symptoms are balanced by paranoiac sjTxiptoms. The alimentary tract is so intimately bound up with the whole stream of vital activity, whether vegetative, sensorimotor, or psychic, that any disturbance of body or mind is Ukely to affect it in some part, and conversely any disturbance of the alimentary tract is bound to affect all the rest of the body and the mind. A satisfactory classification of its diseases is therefore difficult to make, but the one here adopted is prob- ably the best for the purpose. The early stages of gastro-intestinal dis- eases are often so similar that it is nearly impossible to differentiate them with certainty; the classification is therefore based on the clinical picture and pathology of advanced stages. Fortunately, with the ex- ception of cancer, diseases treated in the early stages usually clear up when the lesions are corrected, and the necessary attention given to the other causative factors present. Acute Gastritis Acute dyspepsia is one of the frequent disorders of the stomach. It may occur as an early symptom of an infectious disease, but very often it is due to some non-specific irritation. The usual exciting causes are errors of diet, over-indulgence in improperly cooked and highly seasoned food, or food that has been spoiled, such as meat, fish and milk, or over or under ripe fruit. Food that is either too hot or too cold may develop an attack. Alcohol is a common cause in those not accustomed to its use. Overuse of tobacco may bring on an attack. Many acute "bil- ious" attacks are brought about by some mental shock or excitement at the time of taking food, for it has been shown by the researches of Pawlow that both gastric motion and secretion are altered by mental irritation during digestion. Unquestionably osteopathic lesions of the splanchnics and vagi are important predisposing factors. These lesions produce a lowered re- sistance of the tissues, which will frequently explain whj^ certain excit- The Practice of Osteopathy 503 ing factors that will initiate an attack in one individual will not do so in another. A healthy mucosa will not be so readily irritated by either indigestible or partly decomposed food. Osteopathic experimental work reveals that the vertebral and rib lesions readily affect both the spinal nerves and the sympathetic ganglia, which is followed by vasomotor and trophic disorder to the mucous and submucous coats of the stomach, as shown by eccymosis and hemorrhage of the submucosa and beginning parenchymatous degeneration of the free ends of the glands of the mucosa. Upon the other hand irritation of the muscles from dietetic errors always causes more or less contrac- tion of the muscles in the upper and middle dorsal, which, in turn, may produce through imbalance of tension and fibrositic changes, constant interosseous lesions and thus be the cause of the catarrh becoming chron- ic. This vicious cycle phenomenon should not be overlooked. Viscero- motor, viscerosensory and viscerotrophic reflexes may be factors in the pathogenesis of the osteopathic lesion. Pathologically, the mucous membrane is more or less covered with mucus. Upon removal of the mucus the membrane is found red and swollen, and the epithelial cells of the glands are granular. This is especially noted in the pyloric area. There are minute extravasations of blood and hemorrhages of the mucous coat, and infiltration of the sub- mucous layer. Symptoms. — Acute gastritis occurs at all ages, so particularly in children care has to be taken that the attack is not the beginning of some infectious disease. A careful inquiry into the history, and examination of thevomitus will usually make the diagnosis clear. The sudden onset of nausea, vomiting, pain in the epigastric region referred to the back and head, vertigo in some cases, if the infections can be ruled out should leave no doubt as to the nature of the disorder. Other symptoms are weakness, and chilhness which later if the attack is severe, is followed by fever. The tongue is coated, the hps dry, and there may be herpes. Belching of gas, constipation in some and diarrhea in others, and dark colored urine are noticeable. There is ten- derness on palpation over both the stomach and splanchnic areas. Ex- amination of the stomach contents show deficient hydrochloric acid, the presence of organic acids, bile and undigested food, and consideral^le mucus. Diagnosis. — In young children acute gastric indigestion is common, though a casual gastritis is rare. In the former prostration, vomiting, 504 The Practice of Osteopathy and undigested, greenish stools are noted. In some cases there is no fever, while in others it may range from 102 to 105 degrees. In all cases care should be taken, as has been stated, that the attack is not the be- ginning of some infectious disease. Appendicitis, acute bowel constric- tion, pregnancy, uremia, meningitis, gall-stone colic, and gastric crises of tabes dorsahs should be differentiated. Most attacks of acute dys- pepsia are over in twenty-four hours. The prognosis depends upon eliminating the cause. The X-ray may be of value in protracted cases. Treatment. — If the case is seen early, emptying the stomach by induced vomiting or the stomach tube is the first indication. If several hours have elapsed and much of the stomach contents have passed into the intestine, emptying the colon with an enema will commonly give quick relief. Withhold all food for from twelve to twenty-four hours, or longer if necessary. In some cases the sipping of hot water will be bene- ficial, while in others pellets of ice in the mouth will give some relief. Whether or not there existed previous spinal lesions there will al- ways be found muscular tension and spinal rigidness during an attack of acute gastritis. These should be corrected for immediate rehef, but what is of greater importance, if these acute lesions are not corrected the patient's recuperative forces are interfered with and recovery is delayed. Then, also, these lesions tend to chronicity and predispose to future attacks. Treatment should be given daily, or oftener if special indica- tions arise. Though the most common area that demands attention is from the fourth to tenth dorsals, still the vagi nerves, especially the right, should not be neglected. Lesions of the upper three cervicalsare the most frequent distm-bances of the vagi. Vomiting is a common and distressing symptom. Pathologically, it is due to an antiperistatic contraction of the stomach and a spasmodic contraction of the diaphragm and the abdominal muscles. It is caused, usually, by irritation of the vagus in the stomach, or in the pharynx by irritation along the spine (particularly in the cervical and upper dor- sal regions), or to the sympathetic nerves or to various parts of the body, or by direct influence of the brain. Rehef can usually be given by inhi- bition of the vagus in the occipital region or by inhibition at the fourth or fifth dorsal vertebra on the right side. In a few instances, placing the patient in the knee-chest position and gently raising the abdominal or- gans gives relief. If this does not suffice the stomach and colon should be emptied, providing the vomiting is protracted. A frequently ef- fective measure for nausea and vomiting that can be carried out by the attendant, is the application of hot fomentations to the dorsal spine. The Practice of Osteopathy 505 Flatulency may be very distressing. The spinal treatment may be sufficient to control this condition, or careful direct pressure for a few minutes over the pit of the stomach. Adjustment of the lower ribs, especially of the left side, may be effective. Occasionally the gas can be passed into the intestines by careful inhibitory treatment in the re- gion of the eighth and ninth dorsals. The inhibitory treatment causes relaxation of the pyloric orifice; also, inhibition of the left vagus relaxes the pylorus. Inhibition at the sixth and seventh dorsals relaxes the cardiac orifice, thus favoring the passing of the gas from the stomach out through the esophagus. In all cases subject to gastritis the dorsal spine should receive con- siderable attention in order that recovery may be complete. The hab- its of the patient should be thoroughly regulated and over-fatigue guard- ed against. And, also of special importance in recurring attacks, is the fact that a number of cases present some derangement of the biliary tract, or duodenum, or the appendix region. Diet. — After twenty-four or forty-eight hours, if the attack has been severe, albumin water may be given in small quantities; also whey, milk, bouillon, and chicken or lamb broth. If there is no return of gas- tric distress, add junket, custard, cornstarch pudding, gelatine, dropped eggs, scraped beef, and white meat of chicken; vegetables purees made with cream or meat stock are usually well borne at this time. Foods con- taining much cellulose, fats and sweets should be withheld until all symp- toms have subsided. Chronic Gastritis It is unnecessary here to repeat the causes of acute gastritis, any one of which continued over a long period of time will cause chronic catarrh of the stomach, as it is sometimes called. Spinal and rib lesions anywhere from the occiput to the coccyx, but more particularly from the fourth to the tenth dorsal, wiU predis- pose to chronic gastritis, the particular type and degree of local path- ology depending upon the exciting factor. A commonly found en hloc lesion is a flattening of the normal convexity in this region, with more or less immobihzation, shown by at- tempting to reestablish the normal convexity through flexion. In addition there may be single spinal or rib lesion in the same area, or cervical lesions affecting the pneumogastric, which is the secretory nerve to the stomach. (See chapter on the "Lesion and Its Applied Anatomy. ") 506 The Practice of Osteopaths Pathology. — Chronic gastritis probably never develops as such without going through several preliminary stages beginning with .ah- mentary hypersecretion, or hypersecretion occurring only during the active period of digestion. These are the cases usually classified as hy- perchlorhydria. At this time no actual pathology can be demonstrated in the glandularis. If the condition is not treated intelhgently at this time the next step will be periodic attacks of what is known as "hypersecretion periodica chronica" followed by "hypersecretion continua chronica." The stom- ach contains abnormal amounts of gastric juice even after a night's rest. At this stage there is a transition from the functional to the or- ganic condition. All stages are characterized by an abundant secretion of mucus. If allowed to go on there will finally result a destruction of the se- creting cells known as Atrophic Gastritis or Achyha Gastrica in which the stomach presents a smooth functionless appearance. Secondary Chronic Gastritis. — Portal obstruction from any cause predisposes to chronic gastritis. The most common of these is faihng compensation in heart lesions, which through back pressiu-e causes portal stasis; the same thing may follow obstruction in the liver itself. Chronic gastritis is also a late accompaniment of the nephritic trinity, kidneys, heart and arteries. It maj^ also be associated with diabetes, gout, anemia and other constitutional disorders. Tuberculosis is commonly ushered in by symptoms of chronic gas- tritis. We should be constantly on the alert to avoid the mistake so com- monly made of treating the stomach as an entity and overlooking the real trouble in some other part of the anatomy. It is probably safe to say that there are only two primary diseases of the stomach, ulcer and cancer. All others are suspiciously associated with diseased processes elsewhere, and when the spinal lesion is given its full significance even these will be found to be directly traceable to anatomical perversions somewhere within the mechanism of local nu- trition. Symptoms. — These are governed by the stage of progress in which the patient is seen. During the stage of hypersecretion of acid gastric juice there will be vague feehngs of distress, fullness and burning in the stomach, and "heartburn" during digestion. When the stomach is empty all symptoms will subside. Later there will be periods of a few days or weeks when there will be more or less continuous distress with some vomiting of highly acid gastric juice containing mucus. The Practice of Osteopathy 507 When the condition has progressed to the stage of continuous hyper" secretion there will be continuous symptoms as above, but with nausea? vomiting becoming more frequent especially late at night or in the morn- ing, always accompanied by sticky mucus. Appetite is variable, there is often a disagreeable taste in the mouth (the "dark brown" taste of the chronic alcohohc). Heart palpitation and vertigo and other vagus symptoms are common. Diagnosis. — On physical examination the stomach is found dis- tended, and in some cases displaced (gastroptosis) . There will be dif- fused tenderness on pressure over the whole organ which should help to distinguish it from gastric ulcer or cancer in which the tenderness is quite locaHzed. Chronic gastritis cannot be positively diagnosed without making a gastric analysis. Many cases are wrongly diagnosed through neg- lect of this very important procedure. The cases in which gastric analysis should be made are so well stated by Lockwood that we will take the Kberty of quoting them in their en- tirety. "(1) Gastric analysis should always be made in every case of dyspepsia, no matter whether these symptoms be apparently gastric or in- testinal, unless passage of the tube is contraindicated. "(2) Gastric analysis should be made in every case of chronic diarrhea that is not due to evident disease of the colon or rectum. " (3) Gastric analysis should always be made in all cases of in- testinal toxemia, or recurring headache of toxic origin, and in patients who complain of the symptom-complex which is spoken of by the laity as 'biliousness'. '' (4) Gastric analysis should be made in all cases of anemia and general physical wretchedness without known cause and which are re- belHous to treatment. " The finding of excessive gastric mucus intimately mixed with food remnants is the chief differential point in the diagnosis of chronic gastritis. Differential Diagnosis. — A complete statement of differential diagnosis Ijy Kciup cannot be well improved upon. "Chronic Gastritis. — No severe pain, no circumscribed spot, painful to pressure; no hematemesis; no cachexia; no marked emacia- tion, except in severe cases of long duration; free hydrochloric dimin- ished or absent; gastric mucus present; slow course. 508 The Practice of Osteopathy "Ulcer of the Stomach. — Hyperchlohydria present, but not in- variably so; severe pain in the epigastrium with intervals free from pain vhen stomach is empty; local tenderness which is circumscribed; dorsal pain; hematemesis, or occult blood in the stool or gastric contents; mi- croscopic pus; no mucus; patient has appearance of suffering; no true cachexia. "Cancer of the Stomach. — Age usually over forty-five; rapid course; free hydrochloric acid usually markedly diminished or absent; lactic acid present; pain generally continuous, but not so acute as in ul- cer; Boas-Oppler bacillus; cachexia; tumor on physical examination; small amount of visible or occult blood; hematemesis much less than ulcer; foul odor to vomitus at times present. "Achylia Gastrica. — Slow course; scarcely any gastric juice; acidity very low or entirely absent; absence of pepsin and rennin; usually no mucus or lactic acid. "These differential considerations apply to typic cases, and the ob- server must be on the qui vive for various gradations and modifications of these chnical pictures." Prognosis. — The outcome of chronic gastritis depends upon our abihty to locate and remove eveiy factor in the etiology, the willingness of the patient to cooperate and the patience and resourcefulness of the physician. At best the progress is slow and one must expect temporary setbacks usually due to failure of the patient to carry out instructions. Treatment. — The most successful treatment is prophylactic, but until the public has been educated up to this form of economy we must begin with conditions as we find them. First get the patient's confidence by making an intellegent examina- tion, a scientific diagnosis, and a reliable prognosis based upon your findings. All lesions, bony, ligamentous, muscular and psychic must be intelUgently and carefully removed. Specific lesions which would directly or reflexly interfere with the nerve and blood to the stomach must be corrected. The rigidness commonly found in the vertebrae and ribs of the splanchnic area must be overcome first by specific adjustment, and the normal flexibility maintained by teaching the patient proper exercises for the purpose. This should include deep breathing with the spine flexed to the limit, and the ribs fixed, by the patient reaching around as far as possible and grasping the ribs as described by Dr. Harry Forbes. This will tend to overcome the flat dorsal so characteristic in all gastro- intestinal conditions. The Practice of Osteopathy 509 Direct manipulation over the stomach has no particular value and may be even harmful. Inasmuch as nausea and vomiting and excessive gas formation are only the result of hypersecretion we cannot expect to give more than temporary rehef except by methods which remove causes. Much com- fort may be given by inhibition in the splanchnic area. In severe cases it may be necessary at times to wash out the fermenting, irritating mass by gastric lavage. Outdoor Ufe, frequent vacations and change of occu- pation are often of decided benefit. Diet. — Indiscretions of diet must be avoided and this cannot be too positively impressed upon the patient. It is always best to make a Hst of foods to be taken for breakfast, lunch and dinner and insist that no other foods be taken without further instruction. Just what these foods shaU be depends upon the gastric secretions as shown by gastric analysis. They should always be nutritious and giv- en in quantities sufficient to maintain nutrition. The stomach should have rest and yet is expected to do its part in the process of digestion. All foods must be given in a finely divided form and well masticated to spare the stomach the mechanical effort of grinding. In hyperacid gastritis all foods of an irritating nature must be posi- tively prohibited. The classical breakfast of grapefruit, oatmeal, ham and eggs and coffee will not do. Starchy foods must be reduced owing to their tendency to ferment in the presence of highly acid juice and the delay in the stomach due to the high acidity. In subacid gastritis advantage must be taken of the fact that carbo- hydrates digest well and proteins do not. Diet for Hyperacid Gastritis. — Before breakfast: Wash the stomach with warm water and an ounce of Phillips Milk of Magnesia, allowing the water to remain in the stomach 20 minutes or a half hour, lying down and turning from side to side on the face in order that the water and magnesia may be brought in contact with all parts of the stom- ach. For breakfast: Prunes, allowed to simmer for four hours, without boiling, and put through a colander, to remove the skins. Soft cereals, such as farina, cream of wheat, or wheatlet, thoroughly cooked, and served with middle heavy cream, no sugar. Two eggs, soft boiled, or poached. Zweibach, thoroughly masticated, with a hberal quantity of butter. Cocoa (Phillips). Luncheon: Puree of peas, beans or lentils, made with cream. As- paragus, green peas, boiled rice, spinach chopped very fine, creamed car- 510 The Practice of Osteopathy rots, boiled onions, baked potato, well done. Chicken, boiled lamb or beef, ground ; oysters in any form but fried ; fresh fish . Desserts : Choice of junket, cornstarch, custard, rice pudding, floating island, gelatine or tapioca. Evening meal: Same as luncheon except substituting eggs for meat. Cup of hot water before luncheon and dinner. If patient requires quick building up give milk between meals and at bedtime. Gastric Neuroses Gastric neuroses include motor, sensory and secretory derange- ments. Though the sensory disturbance is often the most marked, still motor and secretorj^ symptoms are usually present. In other words there is commonly a complex of the different forms. Where gastric neuroses can be positively diagnosed, by a process of elimination, there is no more plausible explanation than that of the spinal lesion. The success of osteopathic physicians in treating so-called " stom- ach trouble" proves conclusively the superioritj'^ of the osteopathic method. A note of warning should be sounded, however, for as diag- nostic methods have become more exact it is found that many cases which were formerly diagnosed as neuroses prove to be referred from some organic change, such as infected gall bladder, appendix, tube or ovary, tonsil, tooth or sinus. It has been proven that many cases of sensory and secretory disturbances have entirely cleared up when these causes have been removed. Though infection may play an important role, still in some instances, especially gall bladder, duodenum and ap- pendix, the gastric neurosis may be simply due to a nervous reflex. Gastroptosis, atony, and in man}^ cases splanchnoptosis, has been found to be the underlying cause of many hitherto vmaccountable gas- tro-intestinal symptoms. Gastric crisis of locomotor ataxia if not properly diagnosed by the finding of the other well known symptoms msLy give us much trouble and discouragement. Ulcer and cancer have quite characteristic symptoms, yet it is well known that they are often treated as neuroses in the early stages, much to the detriment of the patient, especially if the' case proves to be cancer. In the sensory disturbances, which are probably the most common, hyperesthesia and neuralgia are the special features. In the former a feehng of weight, fullness and bui-ning are complained of, which are fre- The Practice of Osteopathy 511 quently manifestations of a neurotic temperament. In fact, hysteria and neurasthenia are very often basic conditions. The same is true in gastrodynia, where the pain starts in the pit of the stomach and extends around the lower chest and ribs. There ma}^ be other neurotic symptoms such as excessive hunger and a constant desire for food. Menstrual irregularities, the menopause, worry, constipation, and anemia are im- portant factors. Special care should be taken that there is no organic disorder of the gastro-intestinal tract or of the nervous system. The motor neuroses comprise a variety of derangements. Excita- tion of the motor functions of the stomach, as a direct result of irritated nerves or of reflex stimuli, are not uncommon. Owing to this the food may not remain in the stomach long enough or the stomach activity may be too pronounced. There may be also more or less rapid vomiting of the food, without any particular strain. Other motor neuroses may be spasms of either the cardiac or pyloric sphincters, and in a few instances there may be atony of the stomach walls. Although these conditions may be of a neurotic character, still great care should be taken that some organic disease is not basic. The secretory derangements consist of hyperacidity, supersecre- tion, and lessened amount of acid secretion or achyHa gastrica. Many of these cases are associated with hysteria and neurasthenia, though in achyha gastrica, cancer may be the cause. Hyperacidity may be asso- ciated with ulcer. Pelvic diseases, nervous reflexes from the gastro- intestinal tract, constipation, and anemia are to be considered as pos- sible etiological factors. Diagnosis. — These cases require the most painstaldng inquiry into the history, the most complete physical examination, and all findings carefully checked up by laboratory tests. Inquiry will often show that all sjrmptoms subside when on a vacation with a change of scene and cKmate. Lockwood gives the following rules for arriving at a diagnosis of " nervous indigestion. " " (1) A diagnosis of nervous indigestion should not be made in the presence of more than 30 c. c. of fluid in the fasting stomach, the fluid giving a strong reaction for hydrochloric acid. Hypersecretion is gen- erally an expression of pyloric stenosis, organic or spasmodic, and this is due to an organic cause. " (2) A diagnosis of nervous indigestion should not be made in the presence of persistent hyperacidity accompanied by epigastric pain. Nervous hypcrcliloiiiych'ia may occur, but is not accompanied by either 512 The Practice of Osteopathy pyrosis or pain. The association of either of these latter symptoms should suggest an organic origin for the complaint. "(3) Achylia gastrica may be of nervous origin, but this is not probable when serious motor error is in evidence. Achylia with food- stagnation is strongly suggestive of cancer of the stomach. "(4) AchyUa gastrica, accompanied by pain or vomiting, indi- cates an underlying organic cause. " (5) The diagnosis of nervous indigestion should not be made when recognizable food remains are repeatedly found in the fasting stomach. Under the influence of fear, nervous shock, or vicissitudes of temperament the motor functions may be temporarily interfered with, but this would not be the case permanentlj". " (6) The diagnosis of nervous indigestion should not be made when epigastric distress or pain occurs regularly at a definite time after eating. The very fact of this disturbance coming on at a definite time argues against a neurosis. " (7) The diagnosis of nervous indigestion should not be made when one symptom alone persists, without other evidences of nervous instabiHty. The presence of one definite symptom in itself presupposes an organic cause. " (8) The physician should be on the qui vive for drug addictions, for these habitues can sometimes present a syndrome of s^inptoms that will puzzle the most experienced. " (9) The diagnosis of nervous indigestion should not be made in persons over forty or forty-five, in whom indigestion is a new symp- tom. Such patients are usually developing a serious systemic or malig- nant disorder. "(10) Finally, digestive nervous neuroses and organic disease may be concomitant, and the presence of either need not exclude the other." Treatment. — First get the patient's confidence b}^ making a most complete examination. This desirable beginning is usually hastened by the osteopathic physician, when after a few treatments symptoms are greatly relieved. Correct all lesions wherever found, particularly those anatomically connected with the stomach. When the symptoms are sensory rehef can always be given by inhibition over the splanchnic area. Occasionally the ensiform process and the lower costal cartilages are lesioned. Diet. — When hyperchlorhydria is the chief symptom foods must be selected which bind acidity or those which lessen its secretion, such as milk, eggs, cream cheese, fats such as butter, cream, olive oil, boiled The Practice of Osteopathy 513 or broiled fresh fish, boiled beef or lamb run through a grinder, oysters in any form but fried, white meat of chicken, vegetable puree made with cream or milk (no meat stock), gelatine, custard, junket or sponge cake. Many neurotic patients are under-nourished through fear of food. They must be positively assured that if the food is well chosen and care- fully masticated there need be no fear of discomfort. Care should be taken that the patient is not constipated. Some cases can only be reached by a ''rest cure" of four to six weeks, which together with the treatment outlined above will prove most satis- factory. In all cases guard against worry and overfatigue. Build up the gen- eral health as rapidly as possible. Outdoor life, sufficient sleep, frequent vacations, and change of scene are specially beneficial. Gastric and Duodena! Ulcer Statistics show that peptic ulcer is far more prevalent than is sup- posed by the casual observer. "In the combined statistics of 59,450 autopsies of various series evidence of healed or unhealed ulcer were observed in 4.4 per cent. " (Bassler.) The reason for this is that peptic ulcer may present very definite symptoms which are readily interpreted or they may be so atypical as to make definite diagnosis impossible. Like all gastro-intestinal diseases, many of the symptoms are easily confused with so called indigestion or " stomach trouble. " Etiology. — One characteristic of gastric and duodenal ulcer is that it only occurs where the mucous membrane is subject to the influence of hydrochloric acid and pepsin; lower end of esophagus, stomach and first part of duodenum. Similar ulcers are often found in the sigmoid and rectum where the feces often become acid due to bacterial action, or on account of slow movement, hydrochloric acid and pepsin which may have escaped neu- tralization in the duodenum may attack the mucosa. For the part played by spinal and rib lesions on the glandular layer of the stomach, the reader is referred to a previous discussion of the lesion. Probable secondary causes of gastric ulcer are: (1) EmboHsm of an artery (gastric arteries are terminal). These emboh are supposed to be caused by toxic and infectious agencies which enter the circula- tion, as sometimes occurs in pyemia and large burns of the skin. 514 The Practice of Osteopathy (2) While hydrochloi-ic acid associated with pepsin seems to be an important factor, it is doubtful whether it can attack the mucosa without there being a previous abrasion or other injury. It is said that a normal secretion of mucus is nature's protection against self digestion. The swallowing of substances of a coarse or irritating nature or those chemically corrosive or at extremely high temperature may so injure the nuicous membrane as to permit an attack by HCl and pepsin. Certain occupations seem to predispose to gastric ulcer, such ns cobblers, or others who in their work press vaiious objects against the stomach. Sharp blows oVer the stomach have been followed by acute ulcer. A frequently associated condition is gastroptosis, which seems to be explained on the basis of narrowing of the blood vessels and their more ready occlusion. Probably sagging of the duodenum is an important predisposing factor. Anemia and chlorosis should not be overlooked as predisposing caus- es. And tuberculosis and syphilis are possible associated disorders. Of all the theories advanced, the lowering of vitality, due to lesions of the splanchnics and vagus nerves remains the most logical. Symptoms. — The most characteristic symptom is pain, which in a typical case comes on at a regular time after taking food. It may be a half hour, an hour or two hours, and in the case of duodenal ulcer may be as late as four hours. The distance bej^ond the cardia at which the ulcer is located seems to govern the time; also the time at which the se- cretion of hydrochloric acid reaches its height, which varies in different individuals. The pain is due to free acidity (that which is not combined with the food) irritating the raw surface of the ulcer. Pain is often increased or lessened by posture. If turning on the left side gives relief the ulcer is probablj^ at the pylorus ; if worse when standing than reclining the ulcer is probably on the greater curvature. The pain is usually localized bj^ the patient, and pressure at the given spot increases the pain. In many cases there is referred pain in the region of the 9th, 10th and 11th ribs on the left side. At the height of pain vomiting may occur, due probably to pyloro- spasm resulting from high acidity. Vomiting always gives relief. The taking of protein food or alkali will usually relieve the pain of ulcer, (hunger pain). Ulcer patients are usually well nourished owing to the habit of relieving themselves by eating, or they may be thin due to their fear of food. The Practice of Osteopathy 515 In acute ulcer frank blood may show in the vomit, and may be the first indication of trouble, whereas in the chronic type it may be occult, or occult blood may be found in the feces. The hemorrhage of ulcer, imHke that of cancer, is not constant. Diagnosis. — Diagnosis of duodenal ulcer, as distinguished from gas- tric, is made by finding the tender spot to the right and below the pylorus, the pain coming on three or four hours after taking food, and the finding of blood in the feces (tarry stool) and not in the stomach contents. Re- peated examinations may be necessary owing to the fact that hemor- rhage is not constant. The large percentage of stomach ulcers are near the pylorus, and of the duodenal ulcers the ascending portion is the area almost invariabty involved. Ulcer is differentiated from functional disorders by a history of real pain as distinguished from the vague disturbances of sensation often called pain by neurotic patients. Also its regular appearance in relation to food. The pain of "gastralgia" has no regular habit and is not in- fluenced by food. Referred pain from cholesystitis, chronic appendicitis, etc. has no relation to food and is not relieved by food or alkalies. Ulcer is to be distinguished from cancer by the age of the patient (in cancer usually over 40) with a previously good gastric history, ex- cept in cases where cancer has been grafted on to a chronic ulcer. In these cases a careful inquiry will bring out a characteristic ulcer history up to a certain time, when all symptoms change; pain becomes constant; is not relieved by food or alkaH; vomit becomes dark in color and has a characteristic odor, appetite fails, and signs of cachexia set in. Gastric ulcer should be suspected in all cases of persistent gastric symptoms which are not readily relieved by treatment and regulation of diet, and in which there is found high acidity and continuous hyper- secretion not accompanied by mucus. The X-ray and gastric analysis should never be neglected in suspected cases, keeping in mind the possible injuiy from the tube in case of recent hemorrhage. Treatment. — Osteopathic treatment of gastric ulcer will be almost uniformly successful if we will analyze all of the factors entering into the problem. It is obvious that in order to heal the ulcer we must remove all factors which interfere in any way with nutrition. Then give the stom- ach as near absolute rest as possible while at the same time building up the nutrition by a generous but well chosen diet. 516 The Practice of Osteopathy When acute hemorrhage has recently occurred, complete rest in bed with a trained nurse in attendance is the first indication. Complete rest of the stomach, all nourishment being given by nutrient enema. An ice bag is to be placed over the stomach, and removed every three or four hours to allow surface circulation to react. Warm appHcations should not be used while there is any marked bleeding. During this period no effort on the part of the patient should be permitted, and no manipulative treatment which would tend to increase blood pressure should be given. After all evidence of hemorrhage has ceased for ten days, or at once in case of chronic ulcer, we may carefully correct all spinal or rib lesions in the splanchnic area especially the 6th dorsal, or cervical lesions af- fecting the pneumogastric. Pain and pylorospasm may be I'elieved by steady pressure at the 4th and 5th dorsal on the right side. After spinal lesions have been corrected without unduly irritating the stomach, careful relaxing treatment should be given with the patient on the back, keeping in mind that all exertion will tend to irritate the ulcer. If special care is observed, frequently definite relief may be given by placing patient in knee-chest position and gently raising the lower por- tion of duodenum where it Hes alongside of ascending 3rd and colon, 4th lumbar. During this period a hot water bag or a thermal pad should be kept over the stomach night and day. In certain cases of perforation in a few obstinate conditions, and in a few where mechanical obstruction is marked, surgery may be indicated. The following diet will be found best dimng the first week: 7 A. M. A half glass of cooked milk, with the leathery substance which rises on the top removed, and the yolk of one egg stirred into it and sweetened, if desired; taken luke warm or cool, but never ice cold. This amount to be increased on the second day to three-fourths of a glass, and on the third to a full glass, which is to be continued for a week. If the milk produces diarrhea, add two tablespoonfuls of lime water to each portion. 9 A. M. A saucerful of gelatine (Knox's or Crystal Rock) with 2 tablespoonfuls of cream and a teaspoonful of sugar. 12 M. A half to full glass of milk prepared as above. 3 P. M. A saucerful of gelatine, with cream (medium) and sugar as at 9 A. M. 6 P. M. A half to whole glass of milk, as before, with one egg stir- I The Practice of Osteopathy 517 red in and sweetened. The egg yolks at 7 A. M. and 6. P. M. are to be increased until six are taken daily at the end of the week. 8 P. M. A half to a full glass of milk. The whites of the eggs are to be stirred up in the water in the pro- portion of a white to a glass of water, 4 teaspoonfuls of sugar to be added to every glass, this to be taken by the patient only when thirsty. If the bowels do not move, no laxative can be taken, but an injection of warm water or a Httle soap may be employed. If much discomfort is produced by the food, a hot compress must be laid over the stomach or above the navel. During the second week the diet should remain much the same ex- cept for the addition of one or two pieces of Zweiback three times a day. During the third week, if pain and blood in the feces are lessening, we may add soft, well cooked cereal like cream of wheat, cocoa, puree of split pea made with cream. Fifth week add minced chicken, coddled egg, boiled beef or lamb put through a meat grinder, soft vegetables such as chopped spinach,, squash and mashed or baked potatoes with liberal quantities of butter. Diu-ing and after the sixth week we may add all vegetables which can be served in puree form, fresh fish, oysters, apple sauce, inside of a baked apple, prune whip, custard junket, corn starch pudding. At this time also if all goes well the patient may sit up in bed and gradually move about, being careful to avoid all sudden movements which would put a strain on the epigastric region. If necessary we may also increase our manipulative treatment at this time. The patient must be warned against the use of any article of diet which will be chemically or mechanically irritating to the stomach, for a period of months, and an examination of feces should be made from time to time to make sure of no return of hemorrhage. Dilatation of tlie Stomach A dilated stomach is a stretched stomach having increased capacity, due to nervo-muscular atony or to pyloric obstruction. Every stomach which is not retracted when empty is a dilated stomach. A dilated stomach may occur either as an acute or as a chronic condition, but it is to be distinguished from temporary distention and a normally large stomach. Osteopathic Etiology and Pathology. — The nervo-muscular atony causing dilatation may be due to obstructive lesions in the stom- 518 The Practice of Osteopathy ach splanchnics, or to a general debility of the spine in the dorsal region (usualh^ a kyphosis), or to continued overeating and improper food caus- ing a stasis and fermentation. It may also be due to overdrinking and various diseases, as phthisis, liver and lung diseases, anemia, chlorosis, acute fevers and kidney diseases, causing more or less of a general nervo- muscular atony. Dilatation may result from a mechanical obstruction, or narrowing of the pylorus or the duodenum, by a cicatricial contraction of an ulcer; by hypertrophic thickening due to various diseases, by ad- hesions and tumors. Occasional^ the pyloric obstruction is congenital. A floating kidney may fall upon the horizontal portion of the duodenum and thus mechanically obstruct the passage of food from the stomach, which consequently dilates. Tight lacing might prevent the liver, when congested, from passing in front of the kidney, thus luxating the kidney. Dilatation of the stomach occurs at all ages, although most frequently in middle aged persons. Pathologically, the nuiscular coat is thinner and paler than nor- mal, with more or less atrophy of the glandular tissues and an increase in capacity of the stomach. When obstruction exists at the pylorus, hypertrophy of the muscular coat may occur. Symptoms. — The symptoms are those of the disease causing the dilatation plus those of persistent chronic catarrh. The patient com- plains of a sense of fullness in the epigastric region and there is flatu- lency, eructations and vomiting. The cavitj^ of the stomach being much enlarged, great quantities which are usually considerably decomposed are vomited each day or two. There is often lessened acidity of the vomited mass, though in some cases it is increased. Passage of the food from the stomach to the intestine is delayed and the bowels are consti- pated, the fecal matter being dry and hard. The urine may be scanty and the skin dry. Anemia, debihty and emaciation are always present to a greater or less extent, and on account of the absorption of poisonous matter drowsiness maj^ occur. Physical Signs. — Inspection. — In some cases the outline of the distended stomach can be plainly seen. There is prominence of the epi- gastric region, the tumefaction being at the pyloric end of the stomach. Palpation. — The resistance upon manipulation of a dilated stomach is like that of an air cushion. If the patient is made to drink a half tumbler of water, bimanual palpation will cause a splashing sound to be heard along the circumference of the stomach at its lowest point; and by mov- ing the water about by changing the position of the patient, the outline of the stomach can be made. If the sound is not heard at the first manip- The Practice of Osteopathy 519 ulation, it must not be concluded that the stomach is normal for the stomach may be so dilated and flabby that it falls behind the abdominal wall like an apron. Percussion. — The note is tympanitic over the greater part of the stomach until the lower curvature is reached when the sound is dull (due to the Kquid contents of the stomach) , followed by a tympanic sound again when the intestines are reached. When per- cussion is made the patient should always be in a standing position if possible. When there is pyloric obstruction a tumor usually presents itself, and vomiting is more severe and peristalsis more active than when the dilatation is due to atony of the walls of the stomach from an obstructed innervation. Diagnosis. — This is usually easy if due care is taken in making the examination. Goetz has shown by the use of his spinegraphometer that in cases of visceral prolapse the spine is commonly posterior in the dorso-lumbar region. The X-ray is of value in determining the size and function of the organ. Prognosis. — In a case of nervo-muscular atony the prognosis is favorable. If due to a mahgnant disease recovery is usually impos- sible. In hypertrophy of the pylorus or the duodenum, recovery is probable by means of surgical interference. Treatment. — When the dilatation is due to atony of the mus- cular walls of the stomach from obstructed innervation at the spinal column, treatment is usually successful. Attention should be given to the condition of the spinal column in the splanchnic region (fourth dorsal to twelfth dorsal), the spine being usually posterior. A thorough and persistent course of treatment must be given, not only to restore the normal activity of the nerves to the muscular coat and glands of the stomach, but to build up and restore strength in the weakened spinal column. Lesions in the spinal column, even higher than the fourth dorsal, may affect the innervation of the stomach. There are cases where lesions have been found at the fifth, sixth and seventh cervicals that interfere considerably with the action of the stomach, causing nau- sea, flatulency, eructations, and even vomiting. Such an affection may l)e through the fibers of the splanchnic nerves or through fibers of the vagi nerves. The vagi nerves have an important bearing upon gasti'ic dilatation as paralysis of the gastric branches of the vagi arrests the peristalsis of the stomach and thus tends to favor retention of food within its cavity. The stomach in such cases becomes enlarged, mainly by the weight of 520 The Practice of Osteopathy the food and the presence of gases due to decomposition of the retained food. Thus lesions may be found higher than the lower cervicals and cause obstruction and paralysis of the fibers of the vagi to the stomach. Direct stimulation over the stomach in the form of thorough manipu- lation of the stomach walls causes contraction of the muscular fibers of the stomach, mainly the circular fibers. This treatment, with addi- tional treatment of the splanchnic and the vagi nerves, will tend to build up the weakened plexuses of the stomach. Much time can be saved by putting the patient to bed and treating him every day for several weeks. When the stomach is dilated or dilated and prolapsed, to any extent, it usually requires three to five months treatment at least; this time can be shortened one-half by keeping the patient in bed, treating the spine three times a week, and the abdomen everj^ day. Light food at frequent intervals, upper thoracic breathing, and frequent drawing up and in of the abdomen should be required. The patient may also manipulate his own abdomen twice a day to advantage; teach him to manipulate, draw and pull it upward. There is no danger of too fre- quent treatment as long as there is no bruising of the parts; this, how- ever, does not apply to the spine. It is not an uncommon thing to cor- rect a dilated stomach or a dilated and prolapsed stomach that is an inch and a half or two inches below the umbilicus. Care must be taken in all cases that other viscera are not prolapsed. It is a common ex- perience to find enteroptosis, which can usually be readily functionally corrected, with the stomach ptosis. But where the kidney, or possibly both, is much prolapsed only fair results can be secured until the kid- ney is replaced and kept there, and if necessary by surgical means. Also, note whether the liver is enlarged. (See special article on Prolapsed Organs) . When the disease is due to cancer and various growths of the py- lorus or the duodenum, nothing can be done but palliate. Such cases require surgical attention. In all cases it is necessary that care and preoccupation of the patient should be removed. Baths, changes of air, a carefully regulated diet and caution in the use of liciuids will be of great aid to the general health of the patient, and thus the weakened nervous system will be indirectly but greatly benefited. Too great care cannot be taken of the patient, as there is created in the organism a special aptitude for the tissues to become inflamed and thus weaknesses at various parts of the body may occur. Phthisis, typhoid fever and various diseases are apt to follow dilatation of the stomach, as the nu- tritive and resistive process of the body are impaired. The Practice of Osteopathy 521 The meals should be taken regularly and with great care, the pa- tient not eating too quickly nor too much. SoHds should be used but little; the artificially digested foods, such as peptonized milk and beef peptonoids, probably being the best. Beef juice and scraped beef are excellent foods, as they are easily digested. Fatty and starchy foods should be avoided. Washing out the stomach is useful, but it should not be indiscrim- inately employed. Lavage will not be necessary in all cases of mechan- ical obstruction. It relieves the distention, by removing the weight and the fermenting and decomposing material. In acute dilatation, which may be due to prolonged diseases, gen- eral anesthesia, injuries of the spine, and to narrowing of the duodenum, vomiting, pain and collapse occur. Empty the stomach, and place pa- tient in knee-chest position. Reach beneath the duodenum and raise this part of bowel. Start well down, as low as third or fourth hmibar. If this does not give quick relief stand patient on his head. Gastroptosis and Enteroptosis^ (Glenard's Disease) Definition.^ — A displacement of the stomach and intestines. Osteopathic Etiology and Pathology. — A weakened, debihtated spine is the common cause. A slight posterior curvature is a frequent occurrence. A debihtated spine impairs the innervation to the abdom- inal viscera and to the muscles of the abdomen. Many cases are of congenital origin due to lack of complete development and weakness of the supporting tissues. Other causes are muscular strain, repeated preg- nancies, tight lacing and malnutrition. A downward displacement of the floating ribs, and a consequent prolapse of, and atonj^ of the dia- phragm, is an important cause. Prolapses of the stomach and intestines are of frequent occurrence in both sexes, and very common in women. It is a condition often- times overlooked, and when recognized, httle has been done in the way of a cure. It is the cause of much disturbance, not only to the stomach and intestines, but to the various abdominal viscera and to the pelvic organs, and it is the cause of a large percentage of prolapses of the utei'us, (excluding lacerations from childbirth) for not only is the great suspensory ligament of the uterus (the peritoneum) prolapsed as a consequence, but all of the abdominal viscera and the parietes of the abdomen are also prolapsed and crowded down into the pelvis. The small or large intes- 1. See special article, Prolapsed Organs, Part I. 522 The Practice of Osteopathy tine or the stomach may be prolapsed singly. Tliis is frequently the case with the transverse portion of the colon, which may be elongated and tortuous and prolapsed nearly to the S5anph3'sis pubis. Prolapse of the liver, spleen and kidnej's may occur singly or with a general dis- placement of all the organs. Symptoms. — The abdominal walls are weak, oftentimes flabby. The viscera of the abdomen do not have normal resistance upon manipu- lation. The spinal column presents lesions. There is dypspesia, flatu- lency, constipation, abdominal pains and various neurasthenic symp- toms. Diagnosis. — Is readily made by the lack of tone to the abdominal walls and viscera and the general debility of the patient. Inflation of the stomach with air will determine between gastroptosis and dilatation. The X-ray is of special value in determining position, function, spasms, kinks, etc. of the digestive tube. There are innumerable gradations and phases of this condition. Treatment. — To remove the cause is of primary importance. This is to be followed by treatment of the spinal column, correcting its various derangements and improving the innervation to the atonied viscera and abdominal parietes. Direct treatment over the abdomen helps to give tone to both the viscera and abdominal muscles. In many cases the treatment will have to be a prolonged one in order that the tissues may regain their normal condition. Usually a treatment from two months to a year, or possibly more, is required. Exercises and manipulations that tone the tissues, correct the posture, and raise the chest, diaphragm, abdominal and pelvic viscera, and release spasms, kinks, and adhesions, are indicated. The diet of the patient should be nutritious, and sufiicient in emaciated cases to increase his weight if possible. A supporting bandage will often give some relief. A few cases will require surgery. Particular attention should be given to the colon, duodenum and diaphragm. Relative to the treatment of gastroptosis and enteroptosis, W. E. Harris writes as follows: "I first set to work trying to correct the spinal irregularities; coupled with this I give deep and careful manipulation of the gastric and intestinal walls — treating my patient two or more times per week for a period of one to three years. A lesser period is not long enough to bring the desired result in such cases. I also instruct the pa- tient to knead his own bowels, which I prescribe as a necessary proceed- ing, and to be performed twice daily on retiring and before rising. Of equal importance with the osteopathic treatment, come local, spe- The Practice of Osteopathy 523 cific abdominal exercises. These are to be of the resistive type, and must also be taken for the general musculatm-e. I have my patient retract the abdominal walls and voluntarily draw the abdominal con- tents towards the diaphragm, in regular series. These exercises must be faithfully performed and continued after the treatment has ceased in order to be of real value. I do not find our treatment, without the hearty cooperation of the patient in doing his exercises conscientiously, to be sufficient in itself. Have the patient avoid overloading the digestive tract. Use concentrated foods, in small quantities, i. e., only sufficient to sustain strength, twice daily and without taking fluids at meal times. Of course water, in small quantities and at frequent intervals, may be taken between meals. To summarize — First, corrective treatment. Second, resistive exercises. Third, attention to diet." (See Dilatation of the Stomach.) DISEASES OF THE INTESTINES* Acute Diarrhea Definition. — A diffuse inflammation involving the entire intestinal tract to a greater or less degree. Usually the seat of disease is found in the small intestine and the upper part of the large bowel. Osteopathic Etiology and Pathology. — Acute diarrhea may be caused by overeating, drinking impure water, unripe fruits, and poisons produced in decomposed and fermented milk and other articles of food. This sometimes takes place in perfectly harmless substances in an in- explicable manner. Milk and ice cream may produce intestinal ca- tarrh. Dr. Still often referred to the harm resulting from iced drinks. Changes in the weather, tending to weaken the system, often cause diar- rhea; hot weather favors this, although a chilhng of the system by a sudden fall in the temperature may produce the disorder. Dr. Still was of the opinion that sitting on the cold ground (a common habit of children) is a frequent source of intestinal derangements. Changes in the quantity and quality of the secretions also induce the disorder; thus the bile, if in too great a quantity, increases the peristalsis to such a degree that diarrhea is produced; if diminished, it favors the fermenta- tion and decomposition of the food. Pancreatic diseases may be a cause of diarrhea. Infectious diseases, through their specific poisons, such as *The student will receive many helpful suggestions by reading Macleod, Physi- ology and Biochemistry in Modern Medicine; Cannon, The Mechanical Factors of Digestion; Carlson, The Control of Hunger in Health and Disease; Gaskell, The Involuntary Nervous System; Pottenger, Symptoms of Nervous Disease. 524 The Practice of Osteopathy cholera, dysentery and typhoid fever; inflammation, extending into the bowels from adjacent parts; inflammation caused by peritonitis and in- testinal obstructions, as invagination and hernia; hyperemia, secondarj^ to diseases of the liver, heart and lungs; cachectic states met with in Addison's disease; the last stages of Bright 's disease; cancer and marked anemia are all among the causes of diarrhea. As in constipation, diarrhea is oftentimes simply a sjTuptom of var- ious disorders; still, it may be the only symptom manifested. Lesions are found in various regions of the body, but chiefly in the lower dorsal and lumbar vertebrae and the lower ribs at either side. Also lesions may be found to the vagi, thus increasing the peristalsis or affecting the blood suppl}^ of the intestines. The lesions to the splanchnics may involve the motor, vasomotor or secretory fibers to the intestines. Oftentimes the innervation to the liver is disturbed, affecting the secretion of the bile. The left side of the spinal column is involved more often that the right side, by vertebral, rib and muscular lesions. Nervous Diarrhea frequently follows fright and other causes of nervous excitement, and is often found in hysterical women. There is simply an increase in the peristalsis and secretion of the bowel, due to a vasomotor paresis of the intestinal vessels, producing an outflow of the serum. The intestinal condition is one of hyperemia. The secretory glands are frequently inflamed. In decided cases the mucous membrane may be red and injected, but more often it is pale and covered with a layer of mucus. Sometimes the solitary follicles are considerably enlarged. These enlargements may become filled with pus, forming abscesses which rupture, leaving an ulcer. Peyer's patches may also be involved. Symptoms. — The diarrhea is the important, and often the only, symptom of enteritis; the stools are frequent, varying from two or three to fifteen or more a day; they are thin and watery, varying in color ac- cording to the amount of bile they contain. They are usually of a yel- lowish or greenish color. They contain undigested food, mucus, colum- nar epithelium and mucous cells, micro-organisms and triple phosphate. The reaction of the discharge is either acid or neutral. There are coUcky pains in the abdomen, rumbling noises or borborygmi, intense thirst, dry and coated tongue, with loss of appetite, and, rarely, a fever. When fever is pronounced care should be taken that some infectious disease is not the cause. Chronic catarrhal diarrhea may follow the acute form. If the stools contain much undigested food the inflammation is in the upper bowel; if thin, watery and containing mucus, the lower The Peactice of Osteopathy 525 bowel is involved. In prolonged cases the general health is affected. Definite tender areas along the spine and deep muscular contractions are invariably important etiologic and diagnostic clues. Diagnosis. — This is ordinarily made easy by giving attention to the above, symptoms. In distinguishing as to whether the large or small intestines are involved the following is important: In catarrh of the small intestines, diarrhea is not so well marked; there is much undi- gested food, but very little mucus; and there is usually pain of a colicky nature in the middle or inferior part of the abdomen. When the large intestine is involved there may be no pain; when present, it is intense and usually in the upper and lateral parts of the abdomen; there are borborygmi and thin, soupy stools, mixed with much mucus. If the lower portion of the bowel is involved there may be marked tenesmus, with marked contraction of the muscles over the sacral foramina. Duodenitis is often associated with acute gastritis. Placing the patient in the knee-chest position one may be able to palpate the duo- denum. If the inflammation involves the bile duct, there is jaundice; in these cases the urine may be bile-stained. Prognosis. — Commonly favorable if early and prompt treatment is employed; though it should be remembered that some infections, or constitutional disease, or intestinal ulcer may be an underlying cause. Treatment. — Many cases of acute diarrhea will recover by re- stricting the diet, with rest. Where improper food and water are the causes, an entire change of diet should be considered. Withdrawal of all food and the substitution of boiled milk will be of great aid. The bowels should never be confined if there is reason to suspect that all ir- ritating matters have not been removed; and when fermentation and ir- ritation exist in the lower bowel, an enema will often be beneficial. The spinal column should be examined, especially on the left side, from the fifth dorsal down to the cocyx. The vertebrae may become displaced and cause diarrhea, by derangement of the vasomotor nerves. Either an increased blood supply through the intestines, or an affec- tion of the motor nerves will produce an increased peristalsis. An ac- tive condition of Meissner's plexuses may be produced sympathetically, resulting in increased secretion of intestinal juice and thus in diarrhea. The ribs may become displaced and be a source of irritation to the nerves of the intestines. The muscles of the spine are apt to become contracted by colds, injuries, strains, etc., and stimulate or inhibit the action of certain centers in the cord and produce disordered intestines. Conversely the muscles of the back may be thrown into a contracted condition by 526 The Practice of Osteopathy irritating substances in the bowels acting as a stimulus to the centers in the cord, and thus reflexly to the muscles. Trouble may arise in the colon and rectum bj' lumbar lesions, the shpping of an innominate, a dislocated coccyx, or contracted muscles over the sacrum. In a word, thorough inhibition, relaxing contracted muscles and correcting abnormal verte- brae and ribs are the osteopathic essentials of treatment for diarrhea. Inhibition of the lower dorsal and lumbar is very effective; it dilates the mesenteric vessels by way of vasomotor fibers, and thus controls secre- tions and lessens peristalsis. This has been clearly proven in the osteo- pathic experimental work of Burns and Pearce. Hot fomentations over the dorsal and lumbar spine will frequently'', through the nervous reciprocal relationship, be of decided value. Direct treatment over the mesenteric circulation, i. e., through the abdomen anteriorly, will be helpful in some cases. It relaxes tissues, removes irritations and frees the circulation generally about the mesen- teric vessels and intestines. When giving this treatment one should be certain of the underlying pathology. The hver should be kept active. Treatment of the vagus nei'ves is important, as they help to control the blood supply and the motor nerve force through the intestines. Daily hot baths and increased activity of the skin and kidneys are beneficial. Chronic Diarrhea, and Mucous Colitis Definition. — A chronic inflammation of the mucous membrane of more or less of the large intestines. There may be ulceration. Osteopathic Etiology and Pathology. — Chronic diarrhea may be the result of repeated attacks of the acute form or may be caused by cancer, tuberculosis, Bright's disease, typhus fever, disease of the hver, organic disease of the heart and lungs, obstructions to portal circulation or impactions of any nature that occasion passive congestion. Fre- quently cases of long standing are due to chronic lesions of the lower ribs or lower dorsal or lumbar vertebrae. The lesions of the lower ribs usually consist of downward displacement of the ribs, affecting the in- nervation to the intestines directly, or possibly dragging the diaphragm downward to such an extent as to interfere with the blood and lymph vessels as they pass through it, thus causing congestion of the intestines by obstruction to the lumen of the vessels. In many cases the pathological changes are simply those of the acute form. In more pronounced cases the mucous membrane becomes a brownish red, Hvid gray or slate color; this discoloration being due to hyperemia and blood extravasation. The mucous coat is also swollen. The Practice of Osteopathy 527 and thickened. Atrophy of the mucous membrane, and in some cases of all the coats, with destruction of the glands, may be a result of the chronic form. Ulcerative changes occur chiefij^ in the lower part of the ileum and colon; these msiy be follicular or there may be large ulcers and considerable areas of ulceration. Symptoms. — Constipation and diarrhea frequently alternate; the stools are thin, mixed with a large amount of slinw mucus ; the small intestine is most frequently involved, and the patient complains of pain in the umbilical region; there is distention of the bowels with gas; the health gradually declines; there is great pallor, and the patient becomes emaciated, gloomy and irritable. Mucous Colitis is a chronic form of colitis, characterized by par- oxj^sms of severe pain and the discharge of large masses of mucus, forming gray translucent casts, which are not fibrinous but mucoid in character. This disease occurs usually in women of nervous type, but is occasionally seen in men and children. When there is no underlying organic disease, it is probably largely a secretion neurosis. Mental emotions and worry, sometimes errors in diet, or dyspepsia bring on the attack. Over-fatigue is often an exciting factor. The nurtition is generally well maintained, but in other cases there may be a gradual emaciation and ultimate death. This is undoubtedly one of the most persistent and troublesome diseases that one will meet; still the osteopath can do much for these cases and not infrequently bring about a cure. But the treatment must be consistent and persistent. Mucous coHtis is not hard to diagnose, although many cases are treated for simple indigestion. It is needless to say that a correct diag- nosis is paramount. In these cases there is almost invariably some vis- ceral prolapse, which undoubtedly is the underlying cause, by favoring venous congestion of the bowels. The liver is usually congested; this alone may cause the venous stagnation, but more often it is simply due to the common cause. Back of the visceral prolapse and congestion will almost invariably be found a posterior dorso-lumbar curvature; still there may be a scoliosis or single lesions only, and a downward displace- ment and constriction of the floating ribs. The treatment requires most persistent and careful work for at least three months, and probably six to nine months. Correction of the spine and floating ribs should be of first consideration; then intelligent treatment over the abdomen, by raising and toning the bowels, not only the bowels as a whole, but especially in the ilco-cecal, hepatic flexure, transverse colon, splenic flexure, sigmoid flexure, and rectal regions. 528 The Practice of Osteopathy The direct treatment should be cautiously given when there are indica- tions of ulceration. Have the patient help himself b}^ manipulating his bowels night and morning, drawing the abdomen up and in, and by thoracic breathing. Prescribe plenty of drinking water and reduce starchy and saccharine food to a minimum. Again emphasis is placed upon the necessity of per- sistent treatment, two and three times per week, for several months. The mucus is hard to remove. It is tenacious and frequently causes cohcky pains. To the student Von Noorden's^ monograph on this subject is espec- ially instructive. He notes that almost without exception the patients suffer for some weeks or months prior to the development of colica mucosa from obstinate constipation. For acute attacks, among other things, he advises rest in bed, hot apphcations, and high water injections. He beheves in massage of the large intestine (particularly of the sigmoid flexure), in cases of atonic constipation and also in spastic constipation, provided the patient has a diet that leaves a large residue. "A coarse, laxative diet of Graham bread, leguminous plants, including the husks, vegetables containing much cellulose; fruit with small seeds and thick skins, Uke currants, gooseberries, grapes; besides, large quantities of fat, particularly butter and bacon. " Diagnosis. — Diagnosis is always easy. The presence of blood, pus, or fragments of tissue in the stool point to ulceration. Ulcers in the rectum, and as high as the sigmoid flexure, will be recognized by ex- amination with the speculum. Prognosis. — Osteopathy has undoubtedly changed the prognosis of other treatment. Many cases can be cured and most other cases greatly benefited. The deep seated ulcerations may cause circumscribed peritonitis, or even abscess, and the prognosis becomes grave as these complications arise. Treatment. — As diarrhea may be caused by lesions anywhere from the sixth dorsal to the coccyx, a most thorough examination is necessary. On the one hand, diarrhea may be due to a marked lateral or posterior spinal curvature, which is plainly seen upon inspection, but on the other hand, it may be due to a sHght twist or deviation from normal of a ver- tebra which would require considerable osteopathic ability to exactly locate. Diarrhea may result from subluxation in the lower costal region, one or more of the three lower ribs on either side being involved. Record of one case, in particular, of chronic diarrhea is of interest as it was due 1. Von Noorden, Colitis, 1904. The Practice of Osteopathy 529 to a rib dislocation. It was the case of a man fifty years of age, who had suffered from chronic diarrhea, several stools a day, for over thirty years. He was completely cured in one treatment by correcting the dislocation of the vertebral end of the tenth rib on the left side. This case is cited to impress upon the student the necessity of precise diagnosis and treat- ment. Rarely will diseases be cured by a single treatment, but when such happens it exemphfies the potency of the osteopathic lesion. Treat- ment on the left side is usually more effective in diarrhea than treat- ment on the right side. When diarrhea is a symptom of some constitu- tional disturbance, correction of dorsal, lumbar and rib lesions, with thorough inhibition, careful dieting and rest, will commonly suffice pro- vided the primary disease is intelligently looked after. Chronic lesions of the vagi nerves may exist and produce chronic diarrhea in the same manner as in acute diarrhea. Rest and a hquid diet, preferably boiled milk and albumin water, will be a helpful treatment; the diet requirement is to have a minimum amount of waste, so that the residue will cause the least possible irritation. Beef peptonoids with the milk will be a nutritious addition to the diet, and change of air and surroundings may be an aid to a more speedy cure. The skin and kid- neys should be kept in a healthy condition and, if necessary, the bowels thoroughly emptied by injections. Diarrhea of Children Three forms of diarrhea are recognized in children : Acute dyspep- tic diarrhea, cholera infantum, acute enterocoHtis. Acute Dyspeptic Diarrhea This disease is most frequently due to errors in diet; the mother's milk may be d,ltered in quantity or quahty from taking improper food; the child may be over-nursed, or the foods given in place of the mother's milk are at fault. Too often a filthy bottle is the cause. The predis- posing causes are dentition and extreme heat; and these, combined with constitutional Aveakness, bad hygiene and a weak spine, diminish the re- sisting power of the infant. Hence, in artificially fed children of the poorer classes, this disease is very prevalent. Pathologically, there is catarrhal swelling of the mucosa of both the small and large intestines. The amount of mucus is increased, and there is more or less involvement of all the lymphoid tissue. The sub- mucous membrane is often infiltrated. If there is much inflammation ulcers mav occur. 530 The Practice of Osteopathy Symptoms. — The child may seem to be in its usual health, with slight restlessness at night and an increased number of stools. This restlessness may be due to nausea and cohcky pain. The stools are copious and offensive, containing undigested food and curds. In chil- dren over two years old these attacks maj^ follow the eating of unripe food or drinking tainted milk. In other cases the onset may be sudden with vomiting, purging, and griping pains. The fever may rise rapidly to 103 or 104 degrees or more, sometimes followed by convulsions. The stools become more numerous — there may be twenty in the twenty-four hours — gray or green in color, and sometimes containing much mucus, rarely blood. Diagnosis. — The sudden onset and the character of the stools, which never have a watery, serous character, distinguish this from cholera in- fantum. And the small amount of mucus which the stools contain distinguishes them from those of ileo-colitis. This form often precedes the onset of specific fevers. Prognosis. — Among the better classes this is generally favorable, but among the weak, half-starved children of the poor it is often unfav- orable, especiall}' in hot weather. Treatment. — The child should be clad warmly, kept absolutely clean and given a change of diet and air if possible, with frequent baths. Sterihzed milk should be given at regular intervals ; or if the diarrhea con- tinues, beef juice and egg albumin instead. The bowels should be thor- oughly cleansed by injections. The spine should be thoroughly treated through the lower dorsal and lumbar regions, and if the abdomen is not sensitive, a Kght treatment to the bowels directly will aid recovery. Fre- quently it will be found that the muscles of the neck and upper dorsals are considerably contracted, especially where the child has fever and is very restless. For acute intestinal indigestion Ruhrah gives the following di- etetic treatment: "Withhold all food for the first twenty-four hours, except a httle albumin-water. This is best given in small doses at not too great intervals. Plain boiled water may be used instead. Very weak tea to which a httle red wine has been added may be given if the child is weak. On the second day the albumin or barley-water may be given with the addition of weak strained broth, and on the third day malted milk may be added to the list. After four or five days cow's milk diluted and boiled or peptonized may be tried. It is best mixed with a farinaceous gruel or with malted milk to start with. It may be given The Practice of Osteopathy 531 every other feeding for a day or two if it agrees, and the former feeding gradually resumed. "In nursing infants withhold the breast twenty-four hours and feed as above. After that the breast may be given once for a few min- utes and the feeding pieced out with albumin- or barley-water. If it agrees the breast maj^ be given for three or four feedings, every other feeding followed by albmnin- or barley-water. On the following day the breast may be given at each feeding. The time of nursing should be increased gradually until the child is back on its old schedule." Cholera Infantum Definition. — An acute, catarrhal inflammation of the mucous mem- brane of the stomach and intestines, with some disturbance of the sym- pathetic ganglia. This is a disease of childhood during the first dentition. Etiology and Pathology. — Probably due to the poisonous products of decomposing and fermenting foods acting upon the system. The pre- disposing causes are hot weather, dentition, bad hygiene, the previous presence of some sHght dyspeptic derangement, dyspeptic diarrhea, and enterocolitis. The pathological changes are similar to the morbid anatomy of catarrhal gastritis and enteritis. The serous discharges and rapid col- lapse are due to the intense irritation of the sympathetic system. The kidneys and liver may become involved, and bronchopneumonia is a possible compHcation. Symptoms- — The disease is of sudden onset, setting in with severe vomiting, which is increased by giving food or drink. The stools are copious and frequent, at first containing some offensive fecal matter, and later becoming watery, and odorless. There is decided fever, reaching as high as 105 degrees. The pulse is rapid and feeble, ranging from 130 to 160. Prostration, pinched features, hollow eyes, depressed fonta- nelles and loss of weight are characteristic symptoms. The tongue is coated at first, but soon becomes dry and red, and thirst is intense. Even at this time a reaction may set in, but more commonly death results with sj^mptoms of collapse and high temperature. In other cases there are restlessness, convulsions and coma. As there is no cerebral lesion, this condition is prol^ably due to toxic agents absorbed from the intes- tines. Diagnosis. — This is not difficult, as the toxic symptoms, the se- vere vomit ing, the profuse watery discharge, rapid emaciation and pros- tration, and the hyperpyrexia arc significant. 532 The Practice of Osteopathy Prognosis. — Grave, even with the most favorable surroundings, although in numerous instances osteopaths have successfully treated this disorder. Much depends upon the promptness of treatment. Treatment. — A change of air, complete rest, removal of all foods for a short time, and absolute cleanliness are of great importance. Thorough treatment should be given along the entire spine, particularly to the splanchnics of the stomach and the intestines, and to the vagi nerves in the cervical region. Frequent bathing with cool water, or better still, wrapping the child in cold, wet sheets, will reduce the hyper- P3rrexia. Thorough cleansing of the stomach and intestines with warm water occasionally gives excellent results. In collapse the use of a hot bath is indicated, followed by wrapping the child warmly in blankets and plac- ing him in a horizontal position. The food of the cliild should consist of peptonized milk, raw beef juice, diluted egg albumin, barley water and chicken broth. Nourishment should be given gradual^, and only after the intense symptoms have subsided. Acute Enterocolitis In enterocolitis the ileum and colon are chiefly affected, especially the lymphatic glands or lymph folhcles. Osteopathic Etiology and Pathology. — Warm weather, the artificial feeding of children, dentition and bad hygiene are predisposing causes. The disease usually occurs between the ages of six and eighteen months, but it is not infrequent in the tliird or fourth year. This dis- ease is not confined to the warm weather, but may set in at any season of the year. Previous hght attacks of diarrhea are often a predisposing fac- tor. Lesions in the spine occur from the eleventh dorsal to the fourth lumbar. The mucous membrane is congested and swollen, and the sohtary follicles and Peyer's patches are swollen and often ulcerated. The changes may end here or the ulcers enlarge and extend into the muscular coat with the separation of a slough. There may be infiltration and thicking into the submucous and muscular coats, followed by induration of the tissue, producing abnormal rigidity. Symptoms. — The disease may be a sequel of dyspeptic diarrhea or cholera infantum. The temperature increases and the stools change in character, being at first yellow, and later green. They contain traces of blood and mucus. Vomiting may be present, but is not a constant symptom. The abdomen is distended and tender along the course of the The Practice of Osteopathy 533 colon. The disease may abate here, recovery from the condition being slow; or the symptoms may increase in severity with persistent, small, painful stools, mainly of blood and mucus, tenesmus, and with scanty urine. The child grows pale and emaciated, and assumes a senile ap- pearance. These cases last five or six weeks, death being preceded by coma and convulsions; though a few recover. Relapses are not un- common and should be guarded against. Ulcerative and membranous forms may occur. Pneumonia and nephritis are possible complications. Diagnosis. — Enterocolitis is distinguished from dyspeptic diar- rhea by the greater severity, more fever, greater prostration, the stools containing more mucus and even blood, and by the greater pain and suffering. Cholera infant sins may be recognized by the abrupt onset, very high fever, constant vomiting, and early collapse. If typhoid fever seems a possibility, the Widal test should be used. Prognosis. — Grave; recovery follows prompt treatment with fav- orable surroundings. Treatment. — Attention should be given to the condition of the spine from the eleventh dorsal to the fifth lumbar. An inhibitory re- laxing treatment over the sacral foramina will lessen the tenesmus. When the ileum and colon are involved, disorder is usually present at the third and fourth lumbar vertebrae, although the lesion may be higher. Relax- ation of all muscles in this region and correction of the vertebral lesions are essential. Irrigation of the bowels once a day with a pint of cold water is very beneficial and even pieces of ice may be introduced into the rectum. Fresh, pure air, rest and cleanliness, with a restricted diet and daily warm baths are important. In a word, hygienic and dietetic treatment similar to that for acute diarrhea should be employed. In all forms of diarrheal diseases in children much depends upon previous osteopathic attention, diet, hygiene, and environment. Cholera Morbus Dehnition. — An acute, gastro-intestinal catarrh of sudden onset, characterized by violent abdominal pains, incessant vomiting and purg- ing. Etiology and Pathology. — This disease greatly resembles Asiatic cholera; so much so that one seems justified in suspecting that cholera morbus, hke true cholera, is due to a specific organism. No single bacillus has yet been designated as the specific germ, although one has been rec- ognized resembhng verj^ much the common bacillus of true cholera. 534 The Practice of Osteopathy Until this has been fully decided, cholera morbus must be regarded as severe inflammation of the mucous membrane of the stomach and intes- tines, due to some poison generated from the improper food, which seems to be the cause of the disease, such as indigestible fruits, cabbage and cucumbers. It is most prevalent in hot weather, but is also caused by exposure to cold and damp. The condition of the mucous lining of the intestines is the same as in acute diarrhea. In fatal cases of cholera morbus there is the same shrunken, ashy appearance of the skin that characterizes cholera. Sympfoms. — The onset is sudden, with intense cramps in the epi- gastrium and frequently in the lower hmbs; nausea; vomiting, and purg- ing of bilious material, which later becomes alm'i^'^t like water, and in se- vere cases the discharge becomes serous, finally resembhng the rice water discharges of true cholera. There are also inteiise thirst, moderate fever, rapid emaciation and loss of strength ; the surface becomes cold and cov- ered with clammy sweat; the pulse is frequent and feeble. The patient becomes restless and anxio\is. Diagnosis. — Asiatic Cholera. — There is no way of distinguishing between Asiatic cholera and cholera morbus, except by examination of the discharges for the bacillus. Similar attacks are produced in poison- ing by arsenic, corrosive subhmate and certain fungi, and are only dis- criminated from it by chnical history and cause. Prognosis. — In the majority of cases the prognosis is favorable, death rarely occurring. The duration is from twenty-four to forty- eight hours. Treatment. — A strong inhibitory treatment to the gastro-intestinal nerves is at once demanded. This relaxes the muscles of stomach and intestines, dilates the blood-vessels and lessens peristalsis. The treat- ment should be kept up until rehef is given. In some cases, gentle treat- ment over the stomach and intestines quiets the distress. Inhibition at the occiput gives reUef, especially to the nausea and vomiting. Hot ap- phcations should be apphed to dorsal and lumbar spine. The vomiting is reheved principally at the fourth and fifth dorsal vertebrae on the right side near the angle of the ribs. Cold carbonated water and pieces of ice swallowed are useful. The diet must be regulated, the further after treatment being symptomatic. Clear the bowel by warm enema if any irritating matter is stiU present. Inasmuch as food passes through the small intestine in 4 to 6 hours, and requires 20 hours to pass through the colon, the colon should be emptied by high irrigation in all acute intestinal disorders. The Practice of Osteopathy 535 Intestinal Colic This is a painful spasmodic contraction of the muscular layer of the intestines. Osteopathic Etiology. — Lesions of the splanchnics derange the in- testinal nervous mechanism, with a consequent upsetting of circulatory equalization and chemical function of the intestines. Thus irritations and obstructions of the reflex arc predispose to lowered resistance, con- gestions, and disturbed chemism. Indigestible food, flatulency and im- paction of feces oftentimes produce intestinal colic. Exposure to cold and emotional upsets may be factors. Foreign bodies, intestinal worms, abnormal amounts of bile discharged into the intestines, and reflex causes from diseases, as from the ovaries, uterus, liver, kidneys, etc., will pro- duce the disorder; also lead poisoning, syphilis, rheumatism, locomotor ataxia, chronic malaria and hysteria. Kerley says: "Children who take too much milk, too strong milk, or who take milk too frequently are the usual subjects of colic. Prob- ably the most frequent cause of colic is indigestion of the proteid of the milk; either the proteid is in excess or the child has poor proteid capacity. Not a few cases of colic are due secondarily to defective bowel action." Symptoms. — Severe paroxysms of pain, centering around the navel and diffused throughout the entire abdomen. The pain is of a piercing, cutting and twisting nature, reheved upon pressure. The abdomen is distended and the patient restless and continually changing his position. The attacks alternate with periods of complete quietude. In severe at- tacks the features may be pinched and the surface cold, with feeble pulse, vomiting and tense abdominal walls, all indicating incipient collapse. The duration of the attack is from a few minutes to several hours, eased at intervals and usually ending by a discharge of flatus. Differential Diagnosis.— In lead colic the history, the slate-colored skin, blue line on the gums, sweetish metalhc taste, constipation, slow pulse, retracted abdominal walls, and lead in the urine will designate this disease. Biliary colic presents pain in the hepatic region, radiating to the back and right shoulder; also jaundice, calculi in the stools and bile in the urine. Tenderness over the gall bladder is important. Nephritic colic is accompanied by pain radiating down one or both ureters to the inner side of the thigh, with retraction of testicle of side affected, oi- the labia, and blood, mucus, pus or calcuH in the urine. In uterine colic there is dysmenorrhea and pain in the pelvis. In ovarian colic there is extreme pain upon i)ressure over the ovaries, and hysteria. Ab- 536 The Practice of Osteopathy dominal aneurism presents tumor, pulsation, bruit. In inflammatory and ulcerative disorders of the abdomen there is tenderness upon pres- sure, and fever. The pain of acute appendicitis is at first general, cen- tering in the right ihac fossa in about 24 hours. The X-ray may be of definite aid in renal and biliary conditions and various disorders, such as intestinal adhesions, angulations, etc. Treatment. — Relief of pain is the first indication and is best ac- complished by strong inhibition in the splanchnic region, which relaxes the spasm of the intestinal muscles, by normahzing the reflex arc. If disorders of the spinal column are located, it is of primary importance that they be corrected. In cases of irritation of the intestinal mucous mem- brane, a contraction of muscles of the spine will be found according to the area of the intestines involved, e. g., irritation of the mucous coat of the jejunum causes contraction of the muscles at the tenth and eleventh dorsals. It is a visceromotor, viscerosensory or viscerotrophic reflex sign. On the other hand, a lesion at the tenth and eleventh dorsals may produce colic or other disorders of the jejunum. The portion of the bowel affected, therefore, can be often told by noticing the places of mus- cular contraction along the spinal column. Generally the jejunum and ileum are the portions of the bowel affected in intestinal colic. The pain can frequently be controlled if in the jejunum, at the tenth and eleventh dorsals; if in the ileum, at the twelfth dorsal; if in the ileo-cecal region, including the vermiform appendix, at first to third lumbar; if in the colon, at the third to the fifth lumbar; and if in the rectum, over the sacral and coccygeal nerves. Occasionally the duodenum and jeju- num are reached bj^ nerves as high as the fifth dorsal (usually vasomotor nerves, not sensory), and the other portions of the bowel lower, ac- cording to their respective positions. The reHef is given by way of the splanchnics and sympathetics to the mucous (sensorjO coat of the in- testines, although inhibition relaxes intestinal muscles (motor nerves) and dilates blood-vessels (vasomotor nerves). Though precisely local- ized inliibition is of decided value, still if normal ahgnment, through adjustment, can be secured results are usually quicker and more satis- factory. Anterior treatment to the abdomen helps to reUeve the contracted fascia of the mesentery, with a consequent freeing of the circulation. It aids peristalsis of the intestines and expulsion of the irritating material. This probably produces considerable effect by way of the axone reflex. Direct treatment to the abdomen for the peristalsis reHeves also con- stipation, impactions and the enteralgia, the latter principally by firm The Practice of Osteopathy 537 pressure. Peristalsis is also increased by stimulation of the vagi and in- hibition of the splanchnics. The latter treatment^ of course, is not given to relieve pain directly, but to facihtate the removal of irritating sub- stances if such are the source of trouble. If this does not produce a move- ment of the l^owels promptly, a warm enema will assist greatly. The cecum and sigmoid should not be overlooked. Flatulency can be reheved by direct pressure upon the solar plexus, which apparently removes obstructions to the abdominal nervous system (particularly the nerves of the digestive glands, as fermentation and flatulency are due to a disproportionate secretion of digestive juices) and thus the gaseous formations are absorbed. Additional treatment to the lower dorsal vertebrae and lower ribs to relieve nerve lesions and increasing both thoracic and abdominal circulation may be indicated. As stated in the etiology of intestinal coHc, the splanchnic nerves •contain not only sensitive fibers, but motor and vasomotor fibers as well. The same is true of the vagi nerves; they exert upon the intestines not alone a motor influence, but also a blood control; consequently, our work in a certain region can be for more than one purpose. Hot appHcations to the abdomen may be of benefit. And hot fomentations to the spine for 20 or 30 minutes (affecting reciprocal inneravtion) is often of great benefit. The diet should always be regulated for a few days at least. Constipation is an unnatural retention of feces from any cause. The following causes are frequently met with: A deficiency of the bile or other secretions that aid peristalsis; many acute and chronic diseases which lessen the secretions and impair peristalsis, such as anemia, hyster- ia, chronic affections of the hver, stomach and intestines and acute fevers ; •certain drugs and strong purgatives; strictures; concentrated food ; sed- entary habits, over-fatigue and neglect of the calls of nature. Atony -of the colon maj^ be caused by chronic disease of the mucosa and by gen- eral disease causing debihty. There may be weakness of the abdominal muscles, due to obesity and the distention of frequent pregnancies, or obstructions, such as displaced uterus, pregnancy, prolapsed cecum, sigmoid or rectum, and displaced coccyx. Constipation is really a symp- tom, in most cases, of some disease; many times it is about the only symp- tom observed. One has to take into consideration the many causes that would produce constipation when the treatment of a case is undertaken. 1. See Philosophy and Mechanical Principles of Osteopathy, p. 190. 538 The Practice of Osteopathy A disordered structure may be found in almost any region of a body, which would bear directly or indirectly in the causation of constipation. Irregular habits often bring on the most obstinate cases of consti- pation in later life. There may also be local causes, such as disturbances of the normal secretions, impairment of intestinal walls, due to inflam- mation, and mechanical obstructions caused by tumors, intussusception, twists, etc. Constipation in infants is usually caused bj^ errors in diet, but may be congenital. In all obstinate cases the X-ray should be employed in diagnosis. In the majority of cases lesions will be found in the vertebrae of the lower dorsal and lumbar regions, or in the lower ribs of either side. The lesions may affect the vascular supply and innervation of the intestines directly, or the lesion may cause the constipation by affecting some other digestive organ first. Lesions to the vagi affecting the peristalsis of the intestines are common. The usual symptoms are frequent stools, debility, lassitude, head- ache, loss of appetite, anemia, furred tongue and fetid breath. Serious symptoms may result in long continued cases, such as piles, ulceration of the colon, perforation, enteritis and occlusion. The fecal mass may become channeled and diarrhea may occur from the irritation. In long^ standing cases of constipation, if the patient suddenly develops diarrhea the rectum should be well examined to see if there are impacted feces present. Neuralgia of the sacral nerves may also be caused by impacted feces in the sigmoid flexure. Treatment. — Naturally, owing to the numerous etiological factors, each case is a special study and the treatment is necessarily varied. Many cases will present slight impaction of the bowels, a sluggish liver, spinal lesions and so on, which simply require a specific treatment and all the symptoms will be removed. On the other hand, constipation may be due to prolonged ill health and thus require a careful, systematic treatment, not only of the bowels, but of the entire system. Of primary importance in these cases is regulation of the diet, plenty of exercise, sufficient sleep, and regularity in going to stool at a fixed hour each day. The effect of attention to the latter point, in some instances, will be sufficient to pei-form a cure. Too much cannot be said in regard to the beneficial effect of systematic habits. Lesions may be found in the spinal column producing constipation from about the fifth dorsal to the coccyx, although principally the lower three dorsal and upper two lumbar vertebrae are at fault. Constipation may be caused by defects at any point in the intestines, and consequently The Practice of Osteopathy 539 the sections of the spinal column sending nerves through the interverte- bral foraixdna to the several sections of the bowels should be examined. At any point from the fifth dorsal to the coccyx, certain vasomotor, motor and secretory nerves of the intestines may be affected by var- ious lesions. The vasomotor nerves keep up the vascular tone of the bowels, the motor nerves the peristaltic action and the secertory nerves attend to the intestinal juices. In constipation,, disorders of the spinal column are generalty found on the right side. There is no good reason offered as to why this is so.* In those cases where the liver is impaired, the answer might be because most of the nerves to the liver are on the right side, but the right side is just as often affected when the lesions are in the lumbar region and the nerve supply to the hepatic region intact. Dr. Still considered the fifth dorsal of importance. The vagi nerves have important bearing upon the motor apparatus of the intestines. Lesions in the upper cervical, involving intestinal fibers of the vagi, occur occasionally. Stimulation of these fibers increases the peristalsis of the intestines. Mechanical stimulation of the mid and lower dorsal region, as shown by osteopathic experiments, increases per- istaltic action and vasoconstriction in the stomach and intestines. The value of direct treatment over the intestines from the duo- denum to the rectum in most cases of constipation cannot be overesti- mated. It aids peristaltic action, removes impactions, stretches adhe- sions, strengthens weakened muscles of the intestines and abdomen, and in general gives tone to all of the abdominal organs. The treatment should not be given in a hap-hazard manner, but each effort should be for a definite purpose. Care should be taken not to bruise the intes- tines or other organs, as by gouging or severe punching; the flat surface and the palms of the hands should be used. This means that the part of the bowel involved should be treated intelligently, the osteopath reach- ing underneath the section and the patient drawing the bowels up and in. Obstructions and impactions of the gut, especially at the ileo-cecal and sigmoid i-egions, should be carefully corrected. At all angles of the gut, impactions and prolapses may occur. *There are several possible suggestions. (1) Developmental (See Mayo, Rela- tion of the Deve]opment of the Gastro-intestinal Tract to Abdominal Surgery. Jour. A. M. A. Feb. 7, 1920. (2) Owing to the appendix, cecum, ascending colon, duodenum, and biliary tract being frequently disordered. (3) Imbalance of muscular tension, owing to the muscles of the right side being often the -better developed. Muscular lesions and lymphatic involvement of the cervical region seem to occur oftener on the right side than on the left. 540 The Practice of Osteopathy J. H. Sullivan^ makes the following observation concerning severe^ deep abdominal treatment: "I have noted that this often resulted in the reverse of good effects. In constipation, naturally then, I am chary about treating abdominalh^, confining my work principally to the biliary regions, the ileo-cecal and left iliac regions and have attained good re- sults when a promiscuous working of the abdomen had not so resulted." This emphasizes the point that specific treatment is as much indicated for the abdomen as it is for the spine. Frequently there will be found a spastic condition of the pelvic co- lon, often associated with congestion and adhesions. This probably sets up a reversed peristalsis. Treatment by inhibitory relaxation, with patient in knee-chest position, and adjustment of lumbar and innomi- nate lesions, is indicated. Direct treatment to the liver and biliary ducts is necessary in many cases, as the bile secretion is often defective ; thus a slowness or inactivity of the liver and bile ducts might cause costiveness. Some cases result from anesthesia of the rectum, due to pressure of the fecal matter collecting in the rectum. Simple dilatation of the rectal sphincters and a stimulating treatment through the sacral nerves will bring about a healthy activity of these parts. Occasionally the coccyx becomes displaced and produces paresis of the rectal nerves; or a displaced uterus or a tumor may produce the same result. The use of proper food is essential. Coarse food leaves a great amount of residue, and on the other hand, dainty food leaves but little residue, both causing costiveness. As a rule increase the amount of fruit and vegetables. The patient should drink considerable water, and the time is of importance. Have a glass of cool, not iced, water taken on arising and if breakfast is delayed suflficiently, another in half an hour. Most people do not drink enough water. Unless contraindicated eight or ten glasses daily should be insisted upon. An enema^ occasionally is indicated and is a great aid Avhen used, particularly in cases of paralysis of the intestines and in impactions. Correct breathing and out door life are beneficial. Treatment of the Constipation of Infants. — Repeated small enemata at a fixed hour each day will often be satisfactory but be cer- tain that the tissue is not irritated. Two ounces of tepid water at a time should be injected. Careful spinal treatment and massage to the abdo- men will be useful, as will slight dilation of the anus, which is usually done 1. Journal of Osteopathy, May, 1900. 2. For points on enema, see treatment imder Intestinal Obstruction. The Practice of Osteopathy 541 with the Httle finger, but in obstinate cases a soap stick may be used. When there has been continued straining at the stool, the sigmoid and rectum will often be found prolapsed, causing a mechanical obstruction. With the finger well lubricated this can be corrected and often is all that is needed. These directions, with care in the foods, are usually sufiicient in any case not congenital. In chronic constipation Ruhrah outlines dietetic treatment as follows: "In infants see that they get sufficient fat and protein; well-cooked and sweetened oatmeal gruel is useful. Orange juice, baked apple, or prune juice taken on an empty stomach is of service. Olive oil, the malted foods, or malt extracts are useful. In older children fresh fruits, vegetables, and oatmeal porridge are of val- ue. Graham bread, dates, figs, and prunes may be used." Intestinal Obstruction (Ileus) This is due to a sudden or gradual closure of the intestinal canal at any point. Closure of the gut may be caused by strangulation, intussus- ception, twists and knots, abnormal contents, strictures, tumors, Idnks, spastic states, adhesions, etc. Strangulation. — This is the most frequent cause of acute obstruc- tion of the bowels. There may be stricture of the bowels due to inflam- matory processes producing bands or adhesions, or due to the adhesion of a bowel to an abdominal wound; a vitelline remnant, as a blood ves- sel, may remain and act as a strangulating cord, or in Meckel's diver- ticulum one end may be attached to a mesentery or abdominal wall and thus form a ring through which the gut may pass and become strangu- lated. Strangulation may take place through the foramen of Winslow or the foramen ovale, or between the pedicle of a tumor and the abdominal wall. Peritoneal pouches, mesenteric and omental sHts, adherent appen- dix or Fallopian tubes and diaphragmatic hernia may be other causes. An internal strangulation (hernia) may take place in the crural or inguin- al canal, in the umbilicus, in the sacro-sciatic notch or in the opening through which the infra-pubic vessels pass. In strangulation there is a constriction of a portion of the bowel causing an arrest of the circulation of blood at that point, and more or less stoppage of fecal matter of the intestine. In ninety per cent of cases the strangulated part is in the lower abdomen and sixty-seven per cent occur in the right iliac fossa, according to Fitz. 542 The Practice of Osteopath"^ Intussusception or Invagination. — Intussusception is a slip- ping of a part of the intestine into another part immediately below it, as the slipping of a part of a finger of a glove or a coat sleeve into an- other part. The portion involved may be anywhere from half an inch to a foot or more in length. This produces compression and inflammation of the intestine, and obstruction to the intestinal contents. It occurs principally in children and is more common in males. Spasms of the intestinal muscles and perverted peristalsis are prob- ably the most common causes. One part of the bowel may be dilated and an adjacent portion contracted, thus allowing an invagination. Diar- rhea, habitual constipation and intestinal polypi are important exciting causes. Invaginations oftentimes occur just before death, probably due to irregular peristalsis. Following engorgement and inflammation of the invaginated portion, a tumor is usually present, and lymph is exuded which may cause the lay- ers of gut to adhere, so that the invaginated portion is firmly held. Ne- crosis and sloughing are then hkely to take place. Intussusception varies according to location and is named according to the part of the bowel involved. There are commonly recognized (1) Ileo-colic, when the ileo-cecal valve enters the colon. (2) Enteric, of the small intestines. (3) CoHc, of the large intestine. (4) CoHco-rectal, of the colon and rectum. (5) Rectal, of the rectum. Twists and Knots. — These occur more frequently in males, usually between the ages of thirty and forty. In nearly all cases the twist is ax- ial, accompanied by relaxed and lengthened mesentery. One portion of the bowel may be twisted about another, or a loop of bowel twisted upon its long axis. A bowel being impacted or overdistended by feces and gas, is quite likely to roll on its axis or knot and become dislocated, its weight and inactivity thus producing compression and obstruction of the bowels. The volvulus commonly occurs in the large intestine, at the sigmoid flexure and in the ileo-cecal and cecal regions. It occasion- allj' occurs in the small intestine. Abnormal Contents. — Obstructions may be caused by gallstones, enterohths, lumbricoid worms, certain medicines (such as magnesia and bismuth), fruit stones, coins, needles, pins, buttons, etc., and fecal mat- ter. Foreign bodies usually lodge in the ileo-cecal region and in the small intestine, while fecal impactions occur in the large intestine, more frequently in the lower part. Females are more subject to it than males. Its causes are many and are similar to those of constipation. Spinal 1 esions are very frequent, probabl}- causing paresis or paralysis of a seg- The Practice of Osteopathy 543 ment of the bowel; or all the foi'ces that maintain a normal activity of the intestines may become impaired. Hemmeter^ says it is "more frequent- ly the result of defective innervation of the intestine." Impactions are frequently met with and are easily overlooked under any diagnosis which does not include thorough palpation of the abdominal viscera. The impaction may be so large as to produce dila- tion of the bow^el. The obstructive mass becomes very hard and dry and perhaps channeled, allowing some material to pass until, finally a large piece of fecal matter will obstruct the passage completely. In diagnosis it must not be confused with neoplasms, tumors, etc. Impactions may occur at any point of the colon and the weight so drags the bowel out of position as to be misleading. The principal points are the ileo-cecal region, sigmoid flexure, and rectum. Tenderness is usualty present, as may be diarrhea which must not be taken as evidence that the bowel is clear. Impaction gives rise to many reflex symptoms and is often the real cause of many mistaken conditions. Too much cannot be said on the importance of a thorough examina- tion of colon and its connections, which should be routine of every examin- ation as the large bowel is impacted much more often than suspected and may be the seat of many reflex and direct disturbances. The heart may be affected by weight upon the vessels, gastric disturbances and signs oj autointoxication from absorption may appear. Dilatation of the sigmoid flexure, especially when it is congenitally long, may even be so great as to crowd up and interfere with the liver and diaphragm ; in these cases the coats of the intestines are usually hy- pertrophied. Strictures and Tumors. — These usually occur in adults, more frequently in women and generally involve the large intestine and lower part of the abdomen, most of them occurring in the left iliac fossa. They frequently result in chronic obstruction. Occasionally, a stricture may l^e spastic, due to vertebral lesions, that is severe enough to cause com- plete Vjlockage of intestinal contents. These are usually of the pelvic colon. There are cases where the opposite condition, paralysis of a section, generally of the small intestine, occurs. This may be due to injuries to the bowel, or to damage of the blood-supply, or to derangement of the innervation . Scar tissue, following ulceration of the bowel; tumors of various kinds; and congenital defects, are possible sources of intestinal obstruc- tion. 1. Diseases of the Intestines, Vol. I, p. 240. 544 The Practice of Osteopaths Symptoms. — Acute Obstruction. — There is constipation, nausea vomiting, and pain. The pain is of a colicky nature and may come on abruptly. After the contents of the stomach have been vomited, the material becomes colored with bile, and finally stercoraceous vomiting occurs. Observing the contents vomited (gastric, bile-stained, and fecal) will greatly aid in the diagnosis. The contents of the bowel, below the obstruction, may be emptied or complete constipation may remain. All the symptoms, as a rule, rapidly grow more pronounced. The pain is more severe; tenderness occurs over the abdomen in hmited areas; there is slight tympany; the eyes are sunken; the skin is cold and clammy; the pulse is quickened and feeble; there is rapid increase of leucocytes; the urine highly-colored; the tongue is dry and there is incessant thirst; tenesmus and tumor may be marked, and fever occasionally occurs. The' above condition may continue from three daj^s to a week, when collapse and death may occur, if rehef is not obtained. Chronic Obstruction. — In fecal impactions constipation of long standing is commonly observed. In some cases the fecal mass has be- come channeled, allowing the bowels to remain open; the patient possibly not knowing that there is any trouble. In fact, diarrhea may be present, due to irritation above the impaction. Finally, however, obstruction occurs; the breath is offensive, the appetite is poor, the abdomen swells, and there is fullness and weight within the abdomen, accompanied by pain and vomiting. Upon examination before complete closure, the fecal impactions can easily be felt through the abdomen externally. The tumor is a yielding mass. It has been mistaken for an enlarged liver or gall-bladder, a kidney, or a tumor of the stomach or duodenum. Other symptoms may be present as hiccough, jaundice, tenesmus, tumultuous peristalsis, local peristalsis, local peritonitis and collapse. In stricture caused by cicatrices that may have been formed years before, complete obstruction takes place. Transient attacks often occur. Usually the general health is greatly impaired long before complete occlusion. Diagnosis. — A diagnosis can usually be made by careful, thor- ough examination through the abdominal wall, in connection with the symptoms, and the physical signs. The region of intestinal trouble is manifested by contracted muscles at certain points along the spinal col- umn, corresponding with the particular portion of the bowel involved, as indicated under intestinal colic. Examining the patient in the knee- chest position will often give a better opportunity to locate and out- line the obstruction. Rectal and vaginal examinations should not be neglected. Intestinal obstruction may be confounded with tumors, The Practice of Osteopathy 545 hernia, intestinal colic, enteritis, peritonitis, hepatic colic and renal colic. Peritonitis may be differentiated by the history, the early fever, diffused tenderness and absence of fecal vomiting. When invagination occurs, besides the symptoms of obstruction, the age, tenesmus, bloody discharges and the sausage-shaped tumor in the hne of the colon, will be diagnostic. In stricture, the history, gradual onset, and ribbon-like and bloody stools will distinguish that disorder. In tumors the gradual onset, age, bloody discharges, and cachexia will be important s.ymptoms. X-ray diagnosis may be of value in certain cases. Treatment. — Treatment of the bowels directly is required, and each case must depend for its rehef upon the ingenuity of the osteopath. Rules to be followed cannot be given, as cases vary in manner of involve- ment and in location, consequently the correction of the disorder depends as much upon the ability of the osteopath as does the determination of the diagnosis. Taxis is the method commonly used in relieving intestinal obstructions, though other methods may be employed. In invagination, raising the buttocks and lowering the chest, with thorough injection of oil or tepid soapsuds, or an inflation of the colon with air, may give relief. In addition to thorough but cautious manipulation of the bowels as in impaction, irrigation of the lower bowel with warm water, soapsuds, or glycerine and water, will usually be of material aid. In strangulation, high injections of warm water, and assuming the knee-elbow or lateral position, may straighten out the acute obstruction. Twists and knots are best relieved by direct treatment, although injections may be of aid. Kinks of the pelivc colon, ileum, and duodenum are best treated with the patient in the knee-chest position. Tumors and strictures will require, sooner or later, surgical inter- ference in most cases, but to treat as in impaction will be effective for a short time at least. If there is no indication of immediate relief witliin three days, surgical interference should be instituted. Besides the ordinary treatment for the nausea and vomiting, washing out the stomach will help allay such disorder, quiet the peristalsis and relieve the abdominal distention and pressure above the seat of obstruction. Strong thorough treatment of the spinal nerves to the stomach and intestines will be of great help in lessening pain, estabhshing normal peristaltic ac- tion and in suppressing inflammation. The vagi also should be treated for perverted peristalsis. Hot fomentations will be of service. The nutrition of the patient is best retained by rectal injections of food. Spastic states, particularly of the pelvic colon, frequently cause constipation of various degrees of chronicity. Reaching beneath the 546 The Practice of Osteopathy spastic area and inhibiting and raising (knee-chest position) the part^ will often give marked relief. Adhesions can often be stretched sufficient]}' to resore normal func- tion of the bowels. Treatment of impactions and abnorntal contents requires an additional word. The first step is to free the colon of tiie fecal mass. The enema is of great assistance in this, for cases of long standing present a hard, drj^ mass, often adherent, and the mucous membrane is sensitive from inflammation. Much abdominal treatment must not be given un- til the mass is softened by water. When in the sigmoid or rectum it may, if not dislodged by repeated enemata, have to be removed by a colon spoon, perhaps under anesthesia. Impaction of the small intestine is rare and out of reach of the enema, although if taken as hot as can be borne, it will exert considerable influence high up. In these tendencies and in constipation, when the bowel must be kept open before treatment has produced much effect, there should be an effort made to break up any cathartic habit which may be formed. The enema is a most valuable aid, but it must be given correctly. The patient should be instructed that a fountain syringe is preferable, and that it must never be taken standing. This merely fills and distends the rectum, or lower sigmoid at the best, and is passed without any or with very little effect. Lying on the right side is a very good position, as is also on the back with hips elevated, but the knee and chest is best in most cases. The water should be a Httle above body temperature and can be saponified or used clear. The effect will be about the same. The tube should be perfectly smooth and well lubricated and introduction must be made with care so as not to bruise or irritate. The water, having been allowed to run to expel the air, may be now started and will separate the mucous folds and allow easy penetration. The rubber tube should be held between the thumb and finger, so the flow can be stopped as soon as it meets an obstruction. When this is passed the flow can begin again and continue until the re- quired amount (from one to two quarts for an adult), has been taken, or until the feeling of distention becomes too great. By following this method, much of the distress and cohcky pains which sometimes ac- company an enema, ma}^ be avoided. Water should be held for some minutes, to allow softening of the fecal mass. In many impactions it is important to get the water into the ascending colon. For that pur- pose nothing is better than a Coles sigmoid irrigator. This is shaped somewhat like the letter S and is about a foot long from tip to tip. Its introduction is not diflScult, but care must be used. Place the patient The Practice of Osteopathy 547 on the right side and stand in front, having the bag suspended near. Introduce the tube and with slow, gentle pressure let it follow the course of the bowel. When the splenic flexure is reached, it will stop, but by letting a Httle water flow, the bowel will distend and it will pass. When in the full length, the end will be near the median hne and in the trans- verse colon. Now let the water flow slowly, stopping frequently, and with one hand gently hft and work the abdomen. This will both soften the contents and aid the water in reaching the farthest point. It is not well to give more than a quart the first time, as there is apt to be some pros- tration. The tube also has the mechanical effect of raising and replacing the sigmoid, descending colon and splenic flexure. When there is lack of tone to the bowel or when very_ little stimulus is needed, a half pint of cold water taken in the morning, will often act quickly. Appliances which force the water into the bowel when the patient is sitting, are not recommended, as they tend to stretch the muscular coat by pressure from lifting a column of water. Hernia. — There are several methods of replacing a hernia. The first endeavor, in every instance, must be to reduce it, whether it be strangulated, incarcerated or simply protruded. One of the easiest and commonest methods is to place the patient on his back, the buttocks ele- vated, the legs flexed upon the thighs, the thighs flexed upon the abdomen, and the limb on the affected side slightly rotated inward, so that the col- umns of the ring about the hernia may be relaxed. After the hernia is protruded a little more, so that its contents may be emptied readily, a gentle pressure with the thumb and finger is made upon the upper part of the tumor, when the rest will follow. A gurgling noise is heard upon reduction. Cases that cannot be reduced and are causing acute ob- struction of the intestines, should be treated surgically. Incomplete hernia, which does not show externally, may be present and cause severe reflex symptoms. Considerable attention has been given to this by some investigators. The patient is placed in the Trendelenburg position and the bowel lifted out of the fossa. If any signs of hernia are present a well fitting truss will often cause it to heal. Exercises,in a few instances, will be beneficial. Appendicitis Appendicitis is an inflammation of the appendix vermiformis. In a few cases the cecum and surrounding tissues are involved (typhlitis, p(n'ityphlitis) . The vasomotor nerve supply comes from the lower three dorsals and upper two lumbars. The sensory nerves make their exit from 548 The Practice of Osteopathy the three lower dorsals. Appendicitis is nearly always predisposed by in- jury to the innervation of the vermiform appendix and immediate region, vertebral derangements or sub-dislocations from the tenth dorsal to the third lumbar. The vermiform appendix is a peculiarly constructed or- gan, and its function has not been determined with positiveness. It undoubtedly has a function and possibly a very useful one. Sir William Macewen^ does not share in the general belief that the appendix is with- out function, but protests against its indiscriminate removal, believing it has a powerful influence over the function of the colon. "Yet thous- ands have been operated and show no ill effect. " Tliis is in keeping with the ideas of Dr. Still, who always maintained that the appendix is of importance to the human economy. Although the organ has been found in various localities of the abdomen, this fact and others do not necessar- ily indicate that it is a functionless relic. It is richly supplied with lym- phatic and blood-vessels and has a peristaltic action pecuHar to itself. When the organ is in perfect condition, foreign material probably would not find a lodging point in it, on account of its peristalsis. Dr. Still^ suggests that the appendix has a sphincter, also the power to contract, dilate or shorten, should any foreign substance enter, and he worked with this idea in view with uniform success. The truth of this theory has been proved by Abrams'^ who has demonstrated by the aid of the fluoroscope that peristalsis of the appendix can be stimulated by purcus- sion at the 10th dorsal and it made to empty and fill itself. Abrams makes use of this fact in the treatment of catarrhal appendicitis. Appendi- citis may also be caused by fecal impactions and foreign bodies in the bowel contiguous to the appendix. In these cases there is usually an impaired innervation from the spine, due to vertebral and lower rib lesions, resulting in a weakened muscular coat and catarrhal congestion of the mucosa. In a word, prolapse of the bowel at this point is a predisposing conmion cause. In various instances abrasions of the coats of the tube occur, or the innervation or vascular supplj'- is impaired, and pathogenic bacteria, as bacilli coli communis, streptococci pyogenes, staphylococci pyogenes aureus, typhoid baccilh, tubercle bacilli and others, find a favor- able lodging point and determine the nature of the disease. Injuries to the spinal column and displacements of the vertebrae in the lower dor- sal and lumbar regions, straining and lifting, tight lacing, torsion of the appendix, traumatism, impaction of feces, concretions and foreign bodies, 1. The Lancet, (London,) Oct., 1904. 2. Philosophy of Osteopathy, p. 226. 3. Medical Record. The Practice of Osteopathy 549 acute indigestion, indigestible food, overeating, exposure to wet and cold, and infectious diseases (as typhoid fever, tuberculosis and influenza), are all in the Kst of causes of appendicitis. Pathologically, in most cases the inflammation is catarrhal. This includes many of the mild attacks. The mucosa is inflamed similarly to catarrhal processes elsewhere, although the inflammation may rapidly spread to the deeper structures unless immediately cared for. The inflammation may be so severe that the lumen becomes closed. This is termed obliterating appendicitis. When this occurs the attack may cease and danger from subsequent attacks are at an end, but in- flammation may go on to purulent involvement and even to ulceration, gangrene and perforation or peritonitis. An abscess may be within or without the appendix. Adhesions are likely to form about the mass. Symptoms. — A sudden, violent pain in the abdomen, usually locaHzed in the right iHac region, although at first this pain may be gen- eral. The point of greatest tenderness is detected over McBurney's point — a point at the intersection of a line between the umbilicus and the anterior iliac spine, with a second drawn along the outer edge of the right rectus muscle. The patient usually lies on the back with the right leg drawn up. The severity of pain is not indicative of the seriousness. If the pain ceases suddenly, it is commonly a serious indication. There is usually fever at the onset, the temperature being from 100 to 102 or even 104 degrees F., and ver}^ rarely preceded bj^ a chill. In favorable cases the temperature gradually falls, reaching normal in from five to seven days. If recovery has not begun by this time an abscess is prob- ably forming. If suppuration takes place the temperature continues with but shght fall, although in some cases there is a rise, or it may be- come almost normal. Pain in the right iHac fossa, without fever, rarely points to an acute attack of appendicitis. Vomiting and nausea are more or less frequent, and more commonly present in the event of perforation or rupture of an abscess. In favorable cases vomiting rarely lasts be- yond the second day. In the majority of cases constipation is present from the beginning of the attack, due to paralysis of the bowels. There may be diarrhea, particularly in children. "Urine is febrile in character with large quantities of indican. The blood shows leucocytosis. A leucocyte count of 20,000 is high and indicates an acute appendicitis, with pus, gangrene or peritonitis." On Inspection of the abdomen at the onset of the attack, the sides look ahke, but on palpation there is rigidity of the rectus abdominis muscle and the other muscles overlying the seat of inflammation. The 550 The Practice of Osteopathy whole abdomen may be slightly distended. In the majority of cases there is a progressive development of a hard swelling or tumor in the right iliac fossa. These tumors vary in size, but are usually oval and the size of a hen's egg, and generally situated a little above Poupart's lig- ament. Fluctuation of the tumor is indicative of suppuration. There is often great irritability of the bladder and frequent micturition. A sudden fall in the temperature often indicates that a perforation has taken place, or that a small abscess has ruptured into the intestines. In favorable cases the temperature falls at the end of the third or fourth day, the pain lessens, the tongue becomes clearer and the bowels are moved. If the tumor persists, the patient is veiy liable to have a re- currence of the condition. Rapid growth of the tumor and aggravation of the several symp- toms point to suppuration, especially extreme tenderness over the point of inflammation. If the appendicitis goes on to suppuration, there is dan- ger of rupture into the peritoneum. In a few cases the abscess may rupture into the bowel, in which case the patient recovers. Other ter- minations are lumbar abscess, hepatic abscess and perinephritic abscess. Death may be caused by septicemia or pylephlebitis. These events may be delayed a variable length of time, depending upon the extent and strength of the adhesions that form about the abscess. "The gravity of the appendix disease Hes in the fact that from the very outset the peri- toneum may be infected; the initial symptoms of pain, with nausea and vomiting, fever, and local tenderness, present in all cases, may in- dicate a wide-spread infection of this membrane." (Osier). He also says local signs are not so trustworthy as the general symptoms. There is Habihty to relapse in appendicitis. The attacks may recur for years at different intervals. In some cases these intervals are very short. In some cases perfect recovery may take place after re- peated attacks. Diagnosis. — In many cases the diagnosis is easy, but other cases require careful study and close observation. Sudden pain becoming localized, tenderness and rigidity in the right iliac region are three symp- toms that together almost positively indicate appendicitis. The leu- coc3^te count is of particular value. A pseudo-appendicitis, with all symptoms of true appendicitis in the initial stage, may be caused by the downward dislocation of the twelfth rib on the right side, and occasion- ally the eleventh rib on the same side. The rib lies obliquely downward toward the crest of the ilium. In a few cases the obhquity of the lower rib is so great as to very nearly touch the ilium. The dislocated rib may The Practice of Osteopathy 551 produce severe irritation, pain, tenderness, rigidity, and even inflam- mation, of the abdominal muscles. The patient nearly always complains of the pain being deeply seated, thus possibly confusing one. In typhoid there is a gradual development of the fever, characteristic temperature curve, enlargement of the spleen, epistaxis and diarrhea. The Widal test should be made. The absence of fever and intermittent pain in the abdomen, with complete constipation, fecal vomiting, general disten- tion of the abdomen, bloody stools and marked tenesmus would determine intestinal obstruction. In tubal disease a gradual onset, a more dull and constant pain, the history, and pelvic examination will usually differ- entiate this disorder from appendicitis. Kelly^ gives these points in differential diagnosis, between acute salpingitis and appendicitis: "In the former it will usually be found that there has been a yellowish vaginal discharge for some period before the attack. The local pain and tender- ness, usuallylocated deeper in the pelvis, is most intense on palpation in the region of Poupart's ligament. On vaginal examination exquisite tenderness is felt on either side of the uterus." In biliary colic the pain is higher along the biliary ducts and gallbladder, extending even as high as the shoulder, and jaundice is generally present. In renal colic the pain extends along the ureters down to the inner side of thigh and testicle, and back into lumbar region. There is absence of fever and rigidity. The pain in perineplsritic abscess is downward into groin, as in nephritic colic, and there is tenderness of the lumbar region. Ex- ploratory incision may be necessar3^ Prognosis. — Naturally, the prognosis depends upon the character of the appendicitis, but on the whole the prognosis is favorable. A large proportion of cases revover. Surgical operations are many times deferred until too late; undoubtedly on account of the uncertainty of the condition. Still, on the other hand, many serious cases recover under the proper treatment when an operation seemed almost absolutely neces- sary; all going to prove the fact that very much depends upon diagnosis of the true condition. The statement that there is " no medical treatment for appendicitis, " seems rather broad in view of the report of the medical inspector" of the French Army in Algeria. Out of 668 patients suffering from appendicitis, 188 were operated upon and 23 died, while 408 were treated medically and only three died. He concluded that a meat diet tended to increase the number of cases. "It is exceedingly common and the prognosis is, on the whole favorable. Tafft, of Copenhagen, 1. The Vermiform Appendix and Its Diseases, p. 711. 2. Dr. Chauvel, 1902. 552 The Practice of Osteopathy found adhesions in the neighborhood of the appendix in 35 percent, of all bodies subjected to post mortem examinations^. Treatment. — Confine the patient in bed at once. Cases have undoubtedl}' been lost by not enforcing this point. Attempts should be made to correct the disordered condition of the dorsal and lumbar regions. Thorough and careful treatment should be given at this point, and in most instances the pain can be relieved by correction of the dis- ordered vertebrae. If the case is seen at the beginning of the attack, careful manipulation that especially lifts the cecum and surrounding structures and local application of ice are indicated. However, great care should be exercised here, for some of the most severe cases show no induration. Temperature, pulse, and blood picture are invaluable as guides. When the case is advanced, extreme care should be used in manipulating over the swollen and inflamed region. Hot applications will be helpful in such instances. When due to fecal impaction and foreign bodies, thorough, direct, elevating treatment over the involved region, and high rectal injections are indicated. This applies to the onset, for if the disease has progressed to the point where pus may ])e present, the bowel must be absolutely at rest. Do not give or allow to be given purgatives at any stage of the disease. When sure that there is no pus, direct, careful work over the cecum and appendix is allowed and is of value. It should be a hfting of the colon and relaxing of nearby tissues, to promote the circulation. Treatment of the spine is necessary in all cases, to relieve pain, to cor- rect the nerve and vascular supply, and to increase peristalsis so as to remove irritating bodies- from the vermiform appendix. "Colitis follows appendectomy more frequently than any other abdominal operation. The explanation for this is that the appendicitis is seldom localized in the appendix but is complicated by coHtis, or rather the colitis is complicated by the appendicitis. In such cases, removal of the appendix aggravates rather than alleviates. A conclusion to be drawn is, to carefully palpate the colon in all appendicitis cases and reserve diagnosis, prognosis and advising of an operation until it can be definitely determined as to the location, extent and degree of the disease. The formation of pus is an indication requiring immediate evacuation. "If good surgical advantages are available and the case begins with considerable virulence and a surgeon can be had within the first twenty four hours, it is in all probability best to operate ; but if the case begins slowly or no good hospital advantages are available, or if the case 1 . Rose and Carless. The Practice of Osteopathy 553 is not seen until some forty eight hours have elapsed after the onset, in all probabihty it is strictly an osteopathic case and should not be touched by surgery. Some advocate in all instances to wait until pus is formed before operative procedure is resorted to. This is a rather dangerous attitude to take, for I have seen hundreds of cases operated and have operated upon a great many myself and I have never seen a case die unless it was a pus case." — S. L. Taylor.^ The case should be most carefulty watched, and a surgeon should be promptly called for consultation if the occasion demands it in the least; and if thought advisable, operation should be resorted to before too late. Do not assume too much responsibility in these cases. The patient should be nourished on a restricted diet of milk and animal broths. A.sa Willard^ strongly recommends no food by mouth, as it is bound to set up peristalsis and cause increased irritation. He sustains the strength by rectal feeding. This view is held by other authorities, even to with- holding water when the inflammation is at its height. Tasker confirms the advisability of restricted feeding and advises resting the bowel even to the point of discontinuance of food. The course of the attack is usu- ally so short that there is no danger of starvation and little loss of strength results. This point is a highly important one in cases of any degree of severity. In chronic cases of a fibrotic character, no pus, carefully lifting the parts and loosening adhesions in addition to spinal adjustment will often restore normal circulation. These conditions aside from the local disorder frequently cause hyperchloridia and other digestive disturbances. Diseases of the Liver and Bile Duct Primary diseases of the liver will invariably present osteopathic lesions from the fourth or fifth dorsals to the eleventh or twelfth. The ribs on the right side are commonly involved. These lesions probably disturb the Hver by way of the vasomotor fibers. Displacements of the duodenum, of the hepatic flexure and transverse section of the colon and displacements of the right kidney are frequent sources of Hver dis- orders. Care should be taken in differentiating primary from secondary diseases, for naturally the relative importance of the various factors in treatment will vary. In many secondary diseases there will be found predisposing osteopathic lesions, and these secondary disorders and de- generations can at least be palliated and occasionally the degeneration 1. Clinical Osteopathy. 2. Journal of the American Osteopathic Association, Dec, 1902. 554 The Practice of Osteopathy retarded or stopped by persistent osteopathic treatment, diet, and hy- gienic measures. Hyperemia of the Liver This is an abnormal fulhiess of the blood-vessels of the hver, followed by an enlargement of that organ. It is active when there is abnormal pressm'e in the portal veins (afferent vessels); passive when there is excessive pressure in the sublobular veins (efferent vessels) . Osteopathic Etiology and Pathology. — Active hyperemia is usually due to indiscretions in diet. After each meal a physiological hyperemia of the hver occurs, which is greatly increased by habitually overeating and overdrinking. This condition may lead to fimctional disturbance and possibly to organic change. Traumatism and lesions of the vertebrae and ribs, irritating vasomotor nerves, are important. Habitual constipation, malaria, heat, and arrested menstrual epoch, and infectious fevers are also causes of the active form. Enteroptosis is not a rare cause. Passive hyperemia is due to obstructions of the efferent circulation. Valvular heart disease is the most common cause. Lung diseases, as em- physema or cirrhosis; obstruction to the vena cava or interference with the flow of blood through the liver; and diseases of the pleura, are among the causes. Most cases of congestion of the liver present lesions to the vasomotor nerves of the liver, fifth to ninth dorsal. Especially are the ribs over the liver apt to become displaced and affect the organ. Pathologically, the hver is enlarged and engorged with blood. The appearance of the organ depends upon the duration of the hyperemia. In passive hyperemia the central portion of the lobule and the area of the hepatic vein are deeplv colored. The periphery and the area of the por- tal vein are pale. This alternation of the dark and hght color gives rise to the nutmeg liver, which is so noticeable upon section. In cases of long standing, atrophy of the liver cells and overgrowth of connective tissue result. Symptoms. — Active Hyperemia. — Dull aching and a sense of fullness in the right hypochondrium, aching of the hmbs, coated tongue, nausea, vomiting, constipation, highly colored urine, and slight jaundice. In passive hyperemia the symptoms are the same, but less marked. The onset is gradual and the liver may attain considerable size. In severe cases following tricuspid regurgitation the liver may pulsate. In severe cases dropsy takes place. The Practice of Osteopathy 555 Diagnosis. — Active hyperemia is occasionally confounded with vjatarrhal jaundice. Usually congestion of the liver is easily diagnosed. Prognosis. — In active hyperemia the prognosis is good, unless repeated attacks lead to atrophic degeneration. In passive hyperemia the prognosis depends entirely upon the cause. Treatment. — Active hyperemia. — The treatment consists of measures which tend to diminish the congestion, principally a thorough, direct manipulation over the liver by raising and spreading the ribs. Careful and thorough treatment to the dorsal splanchnics of the Hver is also indicated. The substitution of a scanty for a heavy diet is essential. The foods given should be such as are easily digested, as milk and broths; fats and sugars are to be avoided. In passive hyperemia the treatment consists of correcting the disorder causing it. Often heart diseases are the cause. A thorough depletion of the bowels will aid largely in relieving ascites that may fol- low passive congestion (See ascites). In liver congestions it is well to pay attention to the intestinal con- dition in order that the circulatory mechanism here may be thoroughly coordinated with the hepatic. Simple Catarrhal Jaundice Definition. — Jaundice due to inflammation of the terminal portion of the common duct, not the result of impacted gallstone. The disease probably starts as a catarrhal inflammation of the stomach and upper portion of the small intestine. The bile is retained and absorbed. Osteopathic Etiology and Pathology. — A frequent predisposing cause is the subdislocation of the tenth rib on the right side, thus inter- ferring with the innervation to the bile ducts, and causing congestion of the mucous membrane of the common duct; although lesions above and below this point may occur. Extension of gastro-duodenitis into the common duct is a common source of the inflammation. Sagging of the duodenum will disturb the bile-duct through its being a portion of the duo- deno-hcpatic ligament. Duodenal catarrh usually follows errors in diet, exposure, malaria, Bright's disease, portal obstruction and chronic heart disease. Infectious fevers, as pneumonia and typhoid fever, and emo- tional disturbances are among the causes. Catarrhal jaundice may occur in epidemic form. Pathologically, the duodenal end of the duct is most commonly involved. The mucous membrane is swollen and the orifice fills with mucus. The inflammation may involve the common and cystic ducts 556 The Practice of Osteopathy and even the hepatic. The liver is enlarged and the gall-bladder dis- tended. Symptoms. — The only symptom present may be simply the jaun- dice. There is always tenderness upon pressure over the ducts. The patient many times complains of a stabbing pain when pressure is exerted over the duodenal opening. Usually the course of the bile duct can read- ily be felt upon deep pressure, owing to the tumefaction. Accompany- ing this condition may be general malaise, loss of appetite, nausea, vomit- ing, constipation or irregular action of the bowels, pains in the back and limbs and a slight fever. Diagnosis. — Where jaundice is present witliout pain, it generally indicates catarrhal jaundice. The absence of emaciation or of evidences of cancer or cirrhosis usually makes the diagnosis easy. Good general nutrition and a negative physical examination favor simple jaundice as to the diagnosis. Prognosis.— The prognosis of catarrhal jaundice is favorable, un- less accompanied with infectious diseases or hypertrophic cirrhosis. When diseases are associated with jaundice the danger is usually from the disease. The duration of the disease is generally given as from two to eight weeks, but osteopathic treatment generally lessens that time at least one-half. Treatment. — The treatment is directed toward relieving the in- flammation of the bile ducts and increasing the flow of the bile into the intestines. Great relief to the patient will be experienced from thorough treatment over the bile ducts, especially at the duodenal end. Press slowly but firmly over the region of the ducts, then execute a downward motion with firm pressure over the course. This performance should be repeated several times, until the tenderness in this region is almost or entireh^ relieved. The idea of this treatment is, first, to slowly but firmly bear down upon the abdominal muscles over the congested tissues, so as to relax the tissues and get as close to the ducts as possible, and second, with the downward movements to reduce the congestion of the ducts and at the same time to remove any mucus or other material from the or- ifice, thus allowing a freer flow of bile. It will be recalled that the nor- mal flow of bile is under very low pressure. Care should be taken not to gouge or dig into the tissues with the ends of the fingers, but to use the flat surface of the fingers. Any gouging or severe treatment will not allow one to accompHsh his purpose, owing to the stimulus or irritation it would give the abdominal muscles and thus cause them to contract; and furthermore, it would more or less bruise the parts. An inhibitory The Practice of Osteopathy 557 treatment should be given along the spine on the side affected to help relax the abdominal muscles before this treatment is administered. In all circulatory disturbances of the bile-duct and other hepatic tissues lift the duodenum at about the second lumbar where it lies beside the ascending colon. This tends to release portal vein, hepatic artery and bile-duct, the duodeno-hepatic ligament. Direct treatment is given to the liver by more or less kneading or working the organ and also by raising and spreading the ribs. This treatment is to stimulate the activity of the liver. Reaching under the cartilages of the eighth and ninth ribs on the right side and bearing in- ward and downward will empty the gall-bladder and thus be of aid in relieving the tension in the biliary passages. It is probably a stimulus to these cutaneous fibers that causes a relaxation of the sphincter muscles of the gall-bladder and thus allows it to empty. Stimulation of the tenth nerve contracts the gall-bladder. Then it should also be noted that work over the duodenal end of the bile-duct relaxes the orifice while through reciprocal relationship the fibers of the gall-bladder contract. When all of the muscles of the hepatic region have been carefully relaxed and softened, a thorough examination can then be made of the vertebrae and ribs that might embarrass the innervation or vascular supply of the liver. Lesions of the vertebrae and ribs affecting the liver may occur from the sixth to the eleventh dorsal. Lesions to the vagus and phrenic nerves may occasionally involve the organ. Irrigation of the large bowel with cold water ma}^ be employed. The cold excites peristalsis of the gall-bladder and ducts. Drinking freely of water will be helpful. A non-stimulating diet should be given. The stomach ma}^ not be in a condition to bear solid food; and further- more, food on entering the duodenum will increase the local inflammation of the common bile duct. Give diluted milk, buttermilk, light meat- broths, clam-broth, egg albumin and pressed beef juice. After the pain, vomiting and fever subside, the diet can be gradually increased. Cholecystitis Cholecystitis is an inflammation of the gall-bladder caused by in- fection. Stagnation of bile due to obstruction (especially gall-stones) of the bile-ducts, or a slowing of the bile flow owing to deranged innervation from osteopathic lesions or sagging bowel, are predisposing factors. Fibrotic changes in the appendix are fairly common sources that derange the nervous reflexes of the biliary function. The disorder may be associ- ated with specific fevers. 558 The Practice of Osteopathy Exciting factors are the colon bacilli, streptococci, staphylococci, tjqDhoid bacilli, and pneumococci. Symptoms. — The gall-bladder feels hard and full. There is in- flammation and thickening of the mucous membrane, with considerable increase of mucus. Owing to the infection there may be ulceration and suppuration, with possible perforation and peritonitis. When the in- flammation extends outside of the bladder there are usually adhesions. The onset is commonly sudden, with pain and tenderness in the right hypochondrium. Great care should be taken in deciding the loca- tion of the inflammation, for the pain and tenderness may be over the stomach, or along the duodenum or ascending colon as low as the cecum. Nausea, fever, constipation, and possibly jaundice, are other symptoms. Treatment. — Exercise special care in treating these cases. Al- though in many instances the inflammation will rapidly subside, still owing to suppuration there is danger of aggravating the condition. It is better, in doubtful cases, to confine the treatment to spinal work, and to influence drainage by placing the patient in knee-chest position and carefully raise cecum, ascending colon and duodenum. Rest, restricted diet, plenty of water, and hot fomentations will be beneficial. In severe cases surgical interference is indicated. Jaundice (Icterus) Jaundice is a symptom and not a disease. It consists of the dis- coloration of the skin and other tissues by material derived from the bile. The discoloration may vary from a mere paleness to a yellow or brown olive hue. Toxic jaundice occurs in acute yellow atrophy, pernicious anemia, P3^emia, specific fevers, and the action of poisons. Obstruction by foreign bodies as gall-stones and parasites are im- portant causes. Inflammation and swelling of the biliary ducts and duo- denum are common causes as well as stricture of the duct by tumors and various growths, either internal or external, to the biliarj^ ducts. In some instances pressure from without by the pancreas, stomach, kid- neys, enlarged glands, fecal matter, a pregnant uterus, etc., has been the cause. Irritations and obstructions of the splanchnic nerves, due to lesions in the lower dorsal vertebrae and the ribs from the sixth to the eleventh, will often markedly affect the liver. Also lesions at these points may predispose to inflammation and tumefaction of the bile ducts. The Practice of Osteopathy 559 Symptoms. — Besides the discoloration of the skin, there is itching of the skin, on account of bile pigment deposits; even eruptions may occur. The mucous membranes are often colored and a constant symptom is the bright yellow discoloration of the sclerotic coat of the eye. The secretions are colored. It may be first noticed in the urine. The per- spiration is colored, rarely the saliva and tears. There is frequent sweat- ing. As very Kttle bile passes into the intestine, the feces are pale and gray, and sticky. The bowels are generally constipated, but diarrhea may occur, owing to decomposition resulting from absence of the nor- mal ingredients. Other symptoms may be associated with the gastro- intestinal derangements, as nausea, fetid breath and loss of appetite. A slow pulse may occur, due probably to some stimulating effect on the inhibitory action of the vagus nerve. Lesions are often found at the atlas and axis, affecting the vagus. Pain back of the right scapula is a symptom of Uver trouble; it has been suggested that it is due to a stim- ulus passing up the vagus to the spinal accessory, and thence to the trapezius muscle. Various cerebral symptoms may be present, as great depression, irritabihty, headache and vertigo. In severe cases there may be dehrium and coma. In hemolytic and toxic Jaundice the destruction of blood is due to some toxic agent. The feces are not clay colored and the urine is less stained with bile. The general sjaiiptoms may be very severe depending upon the underlying cause. Diagnosis. — To mistake for jaundice the dirty yellowish discolor- ation of the skin . commonly termed sallowness is an error often made. This condition indicates malaria, uterine disease or general ill health. Very likely it is an anemia and is readily diagnosed from the jaundice as the secretions and conjunctiva are not stained. Addison's disease somewhat resembles jaundice, but the feces are normal, the urine and sclerotic coat are not colored, but exposed portions of the body and flex- ures of the joints are deeply stained. Prognosis. — Depends entirely on the cause producing it. Ordi- nary cases run from two to six weeks, while others may not recover for several months. Jaundice from impaction of the bile ducts may be man- ifest for only a few days. Toxic form may terminate fatally, owing to the disease causing it. The extent of resorbtion of bile and destruction of red- blood cells in the liver varies to a considerable degree. Treatment. — The treatment for the different forms resulting sec- 560 The Practice of Osteopathy ondarily will be found under the diseases causing them. A simple icter- us, caused by disturbance through the innervation of the liver and bile ducts directly, can be i-elieved readily by thorough treatment of the liver and bile ducts as described under catarrhal jaundice. Carefully raise the intestines if they are prolapsed, especially the colon and duodeniun. Cirrhosis of the Liver This is a chronic disease of the liver, characterized bj^ hyperplasia of the connective tissue with destruction of the Hver cells, resulting in the organ becoming hard and usually small. Etiology. — The disease usualty occm'S in the male sex and in middle life. When occurring in children, it is commonly of the syphilitic form, though it may be due to other infections. The abuse of spirituous liquors is a common cause. It follows chronic diseases, such as syphilis, long continued malarial intoxication, gout and tuberculosis. Passive con- gestion, due to chronic heart and lung disease, causes some cases. A few cases are caused by inflammation of the bile ducts, due to infection and obstructing calculi; others to a stimulating diet, while some cases are inexplicable. Pathologically, the first stage is hj^perplasia of the connective tis- sue and consequent enlargement of the organ. As this increases the con- nective tissue destroys immense numbers of the hepatic cells, owing to the pressure. Often the enlargement is accompanied by tenderness. In the later stage the overgrowth of imperfectly developed tissue seems to contract the hepatic cells that still remain, causing atrophy and de- generation of most of them, and thus reducing the size of the organ, which is followed by sclerosis. The portal and hepatic circulations are greatly obstructed. An occasional form is termed hypertrophic sclerosis in which sclerosis is found while the organ continues enlarged. There are two common and well defined varieties, atrophic cirrhosis and hypertrophic cirrhosis; other forms (rare) are met with. Atrophic cirrhosis is the common form, and is usually due to alcoholic excess. The surface of the Hver is rough and uneven in ad- dition to its hardness and reduction in size. It may also be greatly de- formed and covered with granulations ("hob-nails"). The normal weight is four or five pounds, but it may ])e so reduced as to weigh no more than one pound or a pound and one-half. Sometimes there is fatty in- filtration, which enlarges the liver to such an extent that the contraction is not noticed. There is an overgrowth of the connective tissue, which contracts and constricts the branches of the portal vein, causes atrophj^ The Practice of Osteopathy 561 and degeneration of the hepatic cells, and even sometimes obliterates the bile ducts. The new connective tissue is well supplied with blood- vessels from the hepatic artery, thus aiding greatly in the growth. In the hypertrophic form, as well as in the atrophic cirrhosis, there is an overgrowth of connective tissue, but in the hypertrophic form the new form of tissue exhibits no disposition to contract. The enlargement of the organ is largely due to hyperemia. As the tissue does not contract there is no pressure on the portal vein and atrophj^ is prevented. There is early jaundice (which is a characteristic symptom) owing to obstruction of the biliary channels. The surface is smooth and its color is greenish yellow. Symptoms. — Atrophic Form. — There may be practically no symp- toms. As there is obstruction of the portal circulation, there may be con- gestion^ of the stomach and intestines, resulting in chronic gastric or intestinal catarrh having the following symptoms — anorexia, distress after eating, distention, constipation and coated tongue. Owing to the anastomotic communication between the portal and caval circulations, as the portal circulation becomes more obstructed, the superficial abdom- inal veins become greatly distended. Hemorrhoids occur, owing to the communication of the superior hemorrhoidal, which is a branch of the portal vein through the inferior middle hemorrhoids, with the hypogas- tric vein and the vena cava; hence hemorrhoids are a characteristic symp- tom. There is enlargement of the spleen and hemorrhage from the stom- ach or bowels. Edema of the legs and ascites are due to engorgement of the portal system. Ascites is much more common than edema of the legs. There may be sKght jaundice, although this is a rare symptom in atrophic cirrhosis. There is always decided emaciation. On examin- ation there is a diminished area of hepatic dullness, while the splenic dullness is enlarged. It is often impossible to outline these organs, as the abdominal distention prevents it. The urine is scanty, high-colored and often loaded with urates, but seldom bile-stained. In the hypertrophic form shght jaundice appears at the onset, which gradually deepens until it is intense and persistent. Occasion- ally there is fever. The disease as a rule is decidedly chronic, though acute symptoms may develop at any period. The urine is often bile- stained, but of normal quantity. On examination the liver is large, smooth and round and can be felt below the ribs. The spleen is greatly enlarged. Diagnosis. — In atropic cirrhosis. — With ascites without dropsy 562 THi^ Practice of Osteopathy elsewhere, history of alcoholism, hemorrhage from stomach or bowels and reduction in size of liver, the diagnosis is absolute. Hypertrophic cirrhosis. — In cancer of the liver the patient is ad- vanced in years, has no splenic enlargement, and more commonlj^ ascites is present ; while in hj^pertropliic cirrhosis there is chronic biliarj^ obstruc- tion, the liver is only moderatel}'^ enlarged and hard, marked jaundice, with causes leading to or evidence of hepatic obstruction. This form of cirrhosis is also to be differentiated from amyloid liver and echinoccc- cus cyst. Prognosis. — Unfavorable, although in some cases the disease can be arrested during the early stage, provided the habits are regulated and treatment is continuous and persistent. Death usually occurs from one to two years after appearance of dropsy. Ascites is difficult to contend with. Treatment. — If the disease is recognized at the beginning and persistent treatment given to the liver, the chances are that atrophy of the cells and connective tissue formation will not take place. But or- dinarily cases of cirrhosis are incurable. The most that can be done is to reestabhsh a compensatory circulation in the liver. Otherwise it would be no more unreasonable to say that one could cure a chronic valvular lesion of the heart. The patient should live a quiet out-door life. Al- cohoHc drinking should be stopped. The diet should be Hght and nu- tritious, preferably a milk diet. The bowels should be kept open, the skin active and the kidneys closely watched. Fatty Liver In fatty infiltration there is no loss of function. The fat infiltrates the cell, crowding aside the protoplasm. This is largely a normal process, though fatty degeneration may be associated. In fatty degeneration the cell loses its structure and is changed into fatty tissue. Chronic intoxication from infectious diseases, such as phthisis puerperal fever, typhoid fever, pneumonia and syphilis are the principal causes. Alcoholism and phosphorous poisoning are other causes. Amyloid Liver There is infiltration into the tissues of the liver, of the socalled amy- loid substance. The infiltration begins in the blood-vessels, the hepatic artery first, then the central zone or periphery, and finall}^ all structures of the liver. This disorder should be viewed as a disturbance of meta- bolism. The Practice of Osteopathy 563 Etiology and Pathology. — This condition is usually found in cases of prolonged suppuration, especially associated with tubercular disease of the bones as in hip-disease, syphihs, rickets, malaria, cancer and leukemia. It is beheved by some to be the result of microbic invasion, especially the tubercle bacillus and staphylococcus. Lesions are frequent- ly found from the fifth to the tenth dorsal vertebrae, which probably act as predisposing factors. The liver is considerably enlarged and rounded. It is pale or waxy in appearance and is doughy in consistency. On section it is anemic and whitish, partly due to infiltration into the walls of the blood-vessels narrowing the lumen. The amyloid changes may be circumscribed and in some cases fatty infiltration is present. Symptoms. — There are no characteristic symptoms except the enlargement of the liver, although the complexion may be waxy and there may be some gastro-intestinal disturbances. Pain is absent, although occasionally there is a dragging sensation, due to the weight of the organ. Jaundice is not present, but the stools may become Hght colored, owing to a diminished secretion of bile. The urine may be increased in amount and contain some albumin if amyloid occur in the kidneys. Emaciation and anemia are present and ascites seldom occurs. Amyloid changes involve the spleen, kidneys, intestines and other organs. Diagnosis. — The organ being large, hard and smooth, with absence of jaundice and ascites, the presence of albuminuria and an enlarged spleen and with the history of the case, mistakes are not hkely to be made. Prognosis. — Depends upon the cause. The progress may be rapid or slow. Treatment. — Careful attention to the primary disturbing factor and direct treatment to the Hver will, in some instances, reduce the size of the organ. Nitrogenous food and hygienic measures should be iij- stituted. The vasomotor nerves of the portal system (fifth to last dorsal) should be treated thoroughly. Gall-stones Gail-stones are concretions that originate in the gall-bladder and occasionally in the hepatic ducts. "The primary formation of gall- stones is itself largely dependent upon stagnation of bile, such as may aiise in the gall-bladder if an intermittent or incomplete closure of the cystic duct be brought about by such things as tight lacing, pregnancy, or even unequal sagging of the abdominal viscera. " — MacCallum. The stone is lai-gely composed of cholesterin, and may form without any 364 The Practice of Osteopathy inflammation of the gall-bladder, owing probably to the stagnation affecting the bile salts so that the cholesterin is precipitated instead of being held in solution. More often there is inflammation of the wall of the gall-bladder due to microorganisms. This causes an exudate from which is derived the calcium. The calcium with bilirubin is deposited in layers on the stone which give it the various colors of yellow, brown or green. A rare type is one formed in the hepatic ducts, which is soft, green, and composed of calcium bilirubin concretions. The stones ''contain a great deal of organic material derived from desquamated epithelial cells and coagulated albuminous matter, as well as pigment." The colon bacilli, staphylococci, steptococci, typhoid bacilli, and pneumococci are the bacteria most frequently found. A cholecystitis may be a predisposing factor or it may be secondary to the concretion. Osteopathic Etiology and Pathology. — This is a disease of middle life and is more frequently found in women. Sedentary habits and constipation combined with overeating, are other important factors. It is found in stout subjects who are particularly fond of starchy and saccahrine food. Catarrhal jaundice is a predisposing factor. Depress- ing mental influences may predispose. The thicker the bile the more Hkely it is to deposit. Dr. Still's theory is that lesions of the ribs on the left side from the sixth to the tenth dorsal are factors in the formation of the stones as they interfere with pancreatic secretions. No matter how it comes about, the fact is that in all cases of gall-stones the osteo- path finds lesions to the eighth, ninth and tenth ribs on the left side, as well as lesions from the fifth or sixth to the tenth dorsal, deranging inner- vation to the liver and bile ducts. It is possible that lesions over the spleen probably interfere with the activities of the spleen and thus in some manner this organ does not properly elaborate the blood before it passes to the liver. Sagging of the duodenum may, through tension on the duodeno-hepatic ligament, interfere with the flow of bile. This would cause derangement of the nervous recipi'ocal relationship between opening at duodenal orifice and gall-bladder. In carcinoma of the liver and stomach, gall-stones are said to be frequent. The stone itself is a brownish object, nearly spherical, faceted and in some instances polygonal in shape, varying in size from a pea to a hen's egg. The stones are found anywhere in the biliary tract from the duo- denal orifice to the ramification of the bile vessels. Usually there is more The Practice of Osteopathy 565 or less of an accumulation in tke gall-bladder At any point the stone may produce ulceration and suppuration. Perforation may occur into the peritoneal cavity or adjacent organs. Symptoms. — Gall-stones may be in the gall-bladder for years without giving rise to any symptoms. Their presence is made known onty by their expulsion from the gall-bladder. If they lodge in the duct in transit from the gall-bladder to the duodenum biliary colic is pro- duced, which is the characteristic symptom of an impacted gall-stone. Small stones may pass into the intestine without jDroducing symptoms. The pain is very sudden, piercing and excruciating in the region of the gall- bladder, when a stone attempts to pass. The pain radiates through the abdomen, right chest and shoulder, and the patient writhes in agony and occasionally faints. Downing^ emphasizes the point that when a patient comes in with a history of repeated attacks of biliary cohc and no stone found in the stools one should at once suspect that one of con- siderable size obstructs the common duct. There is always tenderness in the biliary region with more or less contraction of the abdominal muscles. Nausea, vomiting and sweating are usualty present, followed by a weak pulse, cool skin and pale and anxious face. Fever is soon present and a chill is common. The parox- .ysms continue as long as the stone remains lodged, which may be from an hour to several days. There are remissions of pain, entire relief being given as soon as the stone reaches the duodenum. Jaundice usually fol- lows a prolonged attack. The liver is sometimes enlarged. The spleen is enlarged. Should the stone become impacted, ulcerative perforation, with consequent peritonitis and shock, follows. Diagnosis. — The diagnosis is conclusive when the gall-stones are found in the stools or when they can be felt in the gall-bladder. All the above symptoms are characteristic. If a patient complains of severe pain radiating from the hepatic region, and nausea and vomiting are present, subsiding suddenly with a slight jaundice, the disease should hardly be mistaken. Tenderness over the gall-bladder frequently indicates infection or gall-stones or both. Radiographic examination may be of aid. Nephritic colic should never be confounded with hepatic colic as in the former the pains start in the lumbar region and radiate down- ward into the groin, the testicle and the inside of the thigh. In appen- dicitis, jaundice and bile-stained urine are not found. A pseudo- 1. Journal of American Osteopathic Association, March, 1905. 566 The Practice of Osteopathy biliary colic is occasionally found in nervous individuals especially when the eleventh and twelfth ribs (or ribs as high as the seventh) on the right side are displaced downward. Prognosis. — Is usually favorable. Ulceration, perforation, and suppuration may prove fatal, although much depends upon surgical interference. Treatment. — During the attack of biliary colic, the osteopath should usually be able to readily locate the position of the gall-stone in its transit from the gall-bladder. He should usualty proceed at once to aid the stone in its downward passage by careful manipulation over the duct. Still this treatment should be given with great caution, for if there is suppuration or ulceration, perforation and resultant periton- itis may occur. Usually one will not have much difficulty in dislodging the stone and relieving the sufferer in a few minutes. The recumbent position, with the thighs flexed on the abdomen, is the position assumed for treat- ment, and if the muscles in the hepatic region are very tense and rigid, interfering with locating the gall-stone, an inhibitory treatment to the posterior spinal nerves supplying the contracted muscles will aid one materially. An inhibitory treatment of the nerves of the biliary tract (the ninth and tenth dorsals), may be a helpful measure in dilating the duct. Also, hot appMcation over the affected area and to the dorso- lumbar region will aid. During remissions two or three treatments per week should be given to correct the lesions at the eighth, ninth, tenth and eleventh segments. Give particular attention to any enteroptosis that may be found. Av- erage cases should not require more than two or three months' treat- ment. Hildreth, who has had many cases, is much opposed to opera- tion as his experience has been that where there is not complete obstruc- tion the correction of lesions will prevent further formation of stones. While he finds the trouble ranges from the third to the eighth dorsal, still, as a rule," it is between the fifth and sixth that best results are ob- tained. Probably if the treatment is a rightly directed one the stones already formed may be disintegrated. Willard^ reports 393 cases. Permanently impacted gall-stones require surgical treatment. Pro- phylactic treatment, as a regulated diet, daily exercise and a discontin- uance of excesses, should be stronglj'^ urged. The patient should not be allowed any fatty or saccharine food. Water freely taken will be of aid. 1. Journal of American Osteopathic Association, March, 1905. The Practice of Osteopathy 567 Diseases of the Spleen Diseases of the spleen are usually secondary to other disorders. The following osteopathic treatment under Splenitis will, in addition to the probably primary disturbance, be appKcable to active and passive splenic hyperemia and amj^loid degeneration of the spleen. Surgical and other measures are to be employed when indicated. Owing to the role that the spleen plays in infections, the osteopath pays considerable attention to stimulating the organ through its spinal innervation in these cases. Splenitis In acute splenitis there is generally a blocking up of the smaller splenic arteries b}^ fibrous coagula (hemorrhagic infarct), which have formed in the left ventricle of the heart in consequence of endocarditis. Malarial infections, septicemia, typhus and acute exanthematous fevers may cause coagula formation in the splenic veins. Injuries to the ver- tebrae or ribs on the left side over the spleen (ninth to eleventh ribs inclu- sive) are occasionally the predisposing cause of primary inflammation of the spleen. Following the formation of abscesses the entire organ may suppurate; it may produce pyemia, or it may burst and the pus be dis- charged into the peritoneal sac, causing peritonitis, or into the pleura, stomach or colon. Chronic splenitis is induced by passive congestion, leukocythemia and splenic anemia. Symptoms. — Tenderness and enlargement of the spleen are the principal symptoms. The organ may be twice its normal size, but in a few cases the tumefaction is so insignificant that it can hardly be found on percussion. Dull pain generally exists if the enveloping membrane or adjacent organs are involved, the pain being increased upon percus- sion and deep inspiration. In a few cases the pain radiates to the left shoulder and if the peritoneal covering is involved, a sharp pain will be present. Fever and rigor follow if suppuration has taken place, and peritonitis follows in case of rupture or perforation. Marked hypertro- phy and chronic inflammation may cause cough, nausea, vomiting and dyspnea. Treatment. — In the treatment of both the disease producing splenitis, and of primary splenitis, a- thorough treatment of the spine, eighth to the eleventh dorsal, is necessar3^ The nerves (vasomotor) to the spleen are from the left splanchnics, consequently treatment of the left side is more effectual. Particular attention should be given the ribs over the spleen — the ninth, tenth and eleventh — as disorders of 563 The Practice of Osteopathy these ribs are a common cause of splenic disturbances. Careful and fairly firm treatment is always indicated, care being taken not to add irritation to an already inflamed organ, and especially beware that force is not used where there is danger of rupture. Stimulation of the tenth nerve contracts the spleen. In cases of suppurative splenitis the direct treatment should not be given. Stimulating treatment over the spleen, as over the liver and kidneys, gives tone to the strong elastic capsule surrounding it, so that direct man- ipulation over these organs, coupled with the power of the strong elastic capsule and highly elastic tissue of the inner organ, will greatly aid in lessening the engorgement and hyperemia. In a few cases where the spleen is involved, lesions are found in the upper cervical which affect the right pneumoeastric nerve and thus imoair the normal activity- of the gland. The Practice of Osteopathy 56P DISEASES OF THE RESPIRATORY SYSTEM DISEASES OF THE LARYNX^ Acute Catarrhal Laryngitis Definition. — An acute, catarrhal inflammation of the mucous membrane of the larynx. This may be ushered in as an independent disease or it may be associated with inflammation of the upper respira- tory passages. Osteopathic Etiology and Pathology. — One of the principal causes of acute catarrhal laryngitis is exposure to cold and dampness, which contracts the muscles of the neck region, especially about the larynx. Lesions in the upper and middle cervical vertebrae are important predis- posing causes. Occasionally the first rib becomes luxated, causing a greater or less congestion of the laryngeal mucous membrane by con- tracting the lower anterolateral muscles of the neck, and affecting Ij^m- phatic drainage. Improper placing of tone, as well as too constant use of the voice in speaking and singing, are common causes. Inhalation of irritating gases or dust, and mechanical injuries to the larynx are oc- casional causes. The disease may be associated with certain infectious diseases, as measles, diphtheria, influenza and whooping cough. Pathologically, the mucous membrane is intensely reddened and inflamed; this inflammation involves both the true and false vocal cords and may extend into the trachea and about the epiglottis. The mem- brane is covered slightly with mucous secretion. In rare instances edema of the glottis may occur. The muscular contraction about the larynx impedes blood and lymphatic drainage and thus induces congestion. The contraction may be so severe as to slightly prolapse the organ. The vertebral lesions impinge upon or affect vasomotor fibers and thus bring about congestion. Symptoms. — There is hoarseness and cough with a sensation of tickling in the larynx; these are the most constant symptoms. The cough is dry and the voice altered. At first the voice is husky, but some attempts at speaking are attended with more or less pain and finally the voice may be entirely lost. Deglutition is painful. At first the ex- pectoration is scanty, but later it becomes mucopurulent. There is rarely much fever. When there is considerable edema, dyspnea and asphyxia are prominent features. ■ 1. I'or diseases of I hf nose see Deason, I'aii I, Pago 2r)7. 570 The Practice of Osteopathy Prognosis. — Simple catarrhal laiyngitis never terminates fatally. When there is dyspnea or asphjocia indicating edema of the larynx, the prognosis is grave. The attack usually lasts from one week to ten days, but this can be materially shortened by careful osteopathic treatment In severe infections it may be two or three weeks before the larynx re- turns to its former condition. Treatment. — In a few cases confinement of the patient to his rooni^ and possibly the bed, will be necessary; especially should the larynx have rest from phonation, and the taking of food of an irritating char- acter should be avoided. Smoking is to be prohibited. The room should be at an even temperature, from 70 to 75 degrees F., and the atmosphere saturated with moisture by the generation of steam. The tissues in the cervical region about the cervical sympathetic and vagi nerves should be carefully adjusted. The deep posterior mus- cles of the cervical spine are to be relaxed and direct treatment given over and about the larynx. Relaxing tissues and raising the larynx will be very effectual in relieving the huskiness of the voice and in control- ling the congestion and inflammation of the laryngeal mucosa. Besides the treatment of the vagi nerves at the atlas and their course down the lateral and anterior portion of the neck, the superior laryngeal may be treated at the upper portion of the great cornu of the hyoid bone and the inferior laryngeal at the inner side of the cleido muscle near its sternal attachment. Adjust the tissues along the course of the external car- otid and subclavian arteries, chiefly the first rib ior the latter. Give careful treatment to the internal jugular and innominate veins. Cor- rect anj' tissues that may impinge upon the lymphatics of the mucous and submucous coats of the larynx where they are drained into the deep cervical glands. Release any immobility of the upper chest, relax the pectoral, auxiliary and upper dorsal muscles, and adjust the first four or five dorsal vertebrae. Prompt action of the skin, freedom of the bowels, placing the feet in a hot bath and continued local hot packs, or even an icebag in severe cases, will be of special value at the onset; but due attention should be given these throughout the entire course. The fever is easily aborted by the cervical treatment and proper attention to the bowels and sweat glands. Chronic Catarrhal Laryngitis Dehnition. — A chronic, catarrhal inflammation of the mucous membrane of the larvnx. The Practice of Osteopathy 571 Osteopathic Etiology and Pathology. — The causes of chronic laryngitis may be numerous, but lesions of the cervical vertebrae are the most common. The contractured cervical muscles, especially the deep vertebral ones, are usualty the result of corresponding osseous de- viations. Other causes given under the acute form, as overuse and abuse of the voice, inhalation of irritating substances, excessive use of tobacco and alcoholic drinks, tumors, etc., are important etiological factors. Thus irritations inducing acute attacks, if repeated, will result in chronic catarrh. The pathological changes as revealed by the laryngoscope are swelKng of the mucous membrane, osccaional superficial erosions, and rarely ulceration. Symptoms. — The voice is usually hoarse and rough, being due to a thickening of the vocal organs. In severe cases the voice may be lost. There is fatigue and pain after slight use of the voice, a sense of tickling in the larynx which produces a desire to cough, and expector- ations of viscid mucus and mucopus. Prognosis. — The prognosis is sometimes unfavorable, although many cases are cured. Treatmient. — The patient must learn to ta.ke care of himself prop- erly. He should avoid overheated rooms and the use of tobacco and alcohol, and the throat should not be protected too much. It is a good plan to bathe the neck every morning and night with cold water. He should avoid loud speaking; the sound should be expelled by the abdom- inal muscles and diaphragm and not by the muscles of the throat. Ex- amine the upper air passages carefully for any obstructions and infections that might exist which are a source of irritation to the larynx. Special attention should be given to the atlas, axis and third cer- vical. Lesions lower down the spine may be found, for other laryngeal nerve fibers, other than those from the superior cervical ganglion, may be at fault. Palpate the hyold to see if it is tilted by contracted muscles, as will often be the case. Aphonia is commonly caused by a dislocated atlas. The aphonia may als(j Ijo caused by swelling of the vocal cords and tissues about them and by serous effusions of the laryngeal muscles. The larjmx may be prolapsed slightly and if raised quickly relieved. Difficult breathing and hoarseness are occasionally very troublesome symptoms. The former is due to an inabihty of the glottis to dilate, on account of swelUng of the mucous membrane of the diseased parts ;iimI from drying of the secretions 572 The Practice of Osteopathy on them, thus increasing the obstruction (this is sometimes termed pseu- docroup) but expiration is easy, the stridor is from the inspiration; the latter is due to a collection of mucus on the vocal cords or the cords ma}^ become relaxed, swollen or roughened. Another annoying symptom sometimes presented is pain on de- glutition, which is due to swelhng of the mucous membrane of the upper larjmgeal passages and the epiglottis. In all of these annoying symp- toms, persistent, thorough, direct treatment of the larynx is of value. On the whole, careful, continued treament of the cervical innervation and vascular supply of the larynx, as in the acute form, is indicated. In all laryngeal disorders, if condition permits, hyperextend the neck while the patient is lying supine and thoroughly relax the soft tissues about the organ and then carefully raise it. Laryngismus Stridulus (Spasm of the Glottis) Definition. — A spasm of the muscles of the larynx that are sup- plied b}^ the inferior or recurrent laryngeal nerves. This is commonh' not excited by an inflammatory condition, but it is usually a purely ner- vous condition. Osteopathic Etiology and Pathology. — Spasm of the glottis is usually found in children with enlarged tonsils and adenoids. It has been observed that rickets and syphilis are probably frequent under- lying causes. The spasm is occasionally associated with tetany. The nervous factor is the immediate and important consideration. Cervical lesions, both vertebral and muscular, are invariably found. Then naso- pharyngeal and tracheal disorders and reflex digestive disturbance are exciting causes. An elongated u\n.ila or a deranged hyoid bone will oc- casionally be exciting factors. Subluxation of the upper two or three ribs and of the clavicle may also be exciting factors. The affection is usually found in children under five years of age. All cases are not of a distinct nervous type, for slight acute catarrhal laryngitis may be present. Symptoms. — There is a sudden onset and the spasm may occur on waking from sleep, but it may come on either in the night or day. The disease starts with a sudden arrest of breathing, the child sti'uggles for breath ; there are tonic muscular spasms and the face becomes congest- ed in a few seconds. This is followed by sudden relaxation of the spasm and the air is drawn through the glottis with a shrill, crowing sound. The Practice of Osteopathy 573 Several spasms may occur in a day or they may be weeks apart. Death rarely occm^s. Diagnosis. — The absence of fever, cough and hoarseness and its distinctly intermittent nature will differentiate it from croup. Should there be any question of diagnosis a bacteriological examination is ad- visable. Prognosis. — The prognosis is almost always favorable. In very young children death from suffocation may occur, but rarely. Treatment. — The treatment should be applied either centrally or peripheral^, depending altogether upon the location of the irritation. If the irritation is of central origin, that is, through the innervation from the brain and spine, a correction of the superior and inferior laryngeal nerves is necessarj^; if the stridor is due to peripherial irritations, a cor- rection of the end-plates (muscles) over and about the larynx is required in order that the spasms be relieved. Thorough treatment should be applied to the upper part of the chest and diaphragm, chiefly the phrenic nerves at the third, fourth and fifth cervicals and over the eighth, ninth and tenth ribs anteriorly, in order that the spasms may be prevented from extending to the intercostal mus- cles and the diaphragm. Placing the patient in a hot bath will be of service in some cases when the spasms are severe. Alternating hot and cold packs about the throat are of service. The air of the room should always be kept moist. Care should be taken that the trouble is not due to gastro-intestinal dis- orders or to dentition. Keep the child upon a fluid diet of milk, meat broths and egg albumin. In the more severe cases the well known osteopathic method of re- laxing and inhibiting the soft palate and contiguous tissues will stop the spasm. Spasmodic Laryngitis (False Croup) Debnition. — A catarrhal inflammation of the mucous membrane of the laiynx with spasm of the glottis. Osteopathic Etiology and Pathology. — This affection is practic- ally the same as laryngismus stridulus associated with catarrhal inflam- mation of the mucous membrane. It is a disease of young children. Derangements of the innervation and blood supply to the laryngeal mu- cous membrane and muscles of the larynx are foimd in the same locality as noted under acute catarrhal laryngitis and laryngismus stridulus. 574 The Practice of Osteopathy There is acute catarrh causing a croupy cough, and difficult breathing due to spasm of the glottis. Symptoms. — These attacks generally occur during the night, the child being suddenly awakened by severe paroxysms of suffocating and a dry, hard cough, associated with evidences of dyspnea. In half an hour or an hour or two the coughing ceases, perspiration follows and the child falls asleep. If proper treatment is not given, these attacks may occur for several successive nights, the child appearing almost or quite well during the day. Diagnosis. — The symptoms are so characteristic that the diagno- sis is easy. In all instances the prognosis is favorable. Treatment. — The catarrhal inflammation of the mucous mem- brane of the larynx should be treated in the same manner as simple in- flammation of the laryngeal mucosa, i. e., thorough treatment of the cer- vical spine and direct treatment over the larynx. During the paroxysm, if the patient cannot be relieved very shortly by the cervical treatment, he should be placed in a hot bath of a tempera- ture from 98 to 110 degrees F. This will, in the majority of cases, relieve the attack. In addition a hot compress may be placed about the throat. Producing emesis by irritating the fauces with the finger is necessary in a number of cases in order that the secretions in the laryngeal region may be ejected, thus relieving suffocation and labored breathing. Also, an overloaded stomach which is causing an irritation, should be emptied at once by vomiting. The bowels should be kept well open in all cases. Occasionally the epiglottis becomes wedged in the chink of the glottis. Such a condition requires an introduction of a finger into the fauces to release the disorder. Care should be taken, especially following an attack, that the child is not exposed to cold or rapid changes of temperature, so as to avoid repetition of the spasms. Coughing. — Coughing, not only in spasmodic laryngitis, but also in various diseases where coughing is a prominent symptom, is a most ir- ritating and annoying feature. The osteopath is many times called upon to relieve the cough, whether it is due to slight irritation of a nerve fiber alone or is a symptom of a serious chronic disease. The coughing center is located in the medulla oblongata; the afferent nerves are sensory branch- es of the vagus; the efferent nerve fibers are found in the nerves of expi- ration and in those that close the glottis. Consequently, coughing may be caused by stimuli to various sensory nerves, various cutaneous areas (chiefly the upper part of the body), mucous membrane of the respira- The Practice of Osteopathy 575 tory and digestive tracts, the mammae, liver, spleen, ovaries, uterus, kid- neys, etc. Perhaps the most common cause of cough is contraction of some of the muscles of the neck, irritating sensory fibers. Contraction of the omo-hyoid muscle may produce an irritating cough by causing trac- tion on the hj'^oid bone. In a few cases the larynx may prolapse to some extent and thus be a source of irritation. Lesions of the spinal cord be- tween the seventh and eighth dorsal, also at various points above in the dorsal vertebrae and in the ribs (especially at the second and third ribs) , are very apt to produce a cough. Impaction of the sigmoid flexure is oftentimes accompanied by coughing. Enlargement of the heart may cause pressure upon the respiratory tract directly and cause a deep, dull cough. Foreign bodies in the external meatus of the ear are occasion- ally a source of irritation which is accompanied by coughing. Thus there are innumerable sources of stimuh that may produce coughing. In all cases it is nccessarj^ to make a careful diagnosis as to whether it is an irritation to some fiber that can be corrected at once or whether it is a symptom of a disease that, can only be relieved by the cure of the disease. In local congestions the cold pack will often be of service. Tuberculous Laryngitis Definition. — An inflammation of the larjmgeal tissues of tuber- culous origin. Osteopathic Etiology and Pathology. — Tuberculosis of the larynx is commonly secondary to pulmonary tuberculosis. In a few cases the laryngeal invasion may be of primary origin. In either in- stance there will be found a disturbed innervation or altered blood sup- ply of the larynx that predisposes to the multiplication and gi-owth of the bacilU. The osteopathic lesions are similar to those found in other involvements of the larynx. Pathologically, the mucous membrane is inflamed and swollen, and exhibits scattered tubercles, which are usually about the blood- vessels. The tubercles cluster, caseate and leave shallow, irregular ul- cers. There is thickening of the mucosa about the ulcer, and the ulcer is generally covered by a grayish exudate. The}^ may erode the true vo- cal cords, often destroying them completely. The ulcers slowly involve the tissues in all directions, causing perichondritis with necrosis of the cartilages. The mucous membrane of the pharynx, esophagus, fauces, and tonsils may be involved, and the epiglottis may be completely destroy- ed. 576 The Practice of Osteopathy This disorder, strictly, should be discussed under pulmonary tuber- culosis for, as heretofore stated, it is generally a secondary affection; the larj^nx being invaded by the tubercular bacilli in the sputum arising from the bronchial tubes and lungs. The bacilli in inspired air may pri- marily invade the laryngeal mucosa. However, in either case the circu- lation of the mucosa is not normal and osteopathic correction of the same is effective. Symptoms. — Huskiness of the voice, followed by hoarseness, and in advanced stages aphonia, are prominent symptoms. A hacking cough is usually present and the patient complains of pain in the throat, particularly on coughing, swallowing or speaking. The loss of voice, painful speaking or whispering are quite characteristic. When the ul- ceration of the tissues of the larynx has progressed to a later stage, dys- phagia, suffocation and distressing paroxysms of cough occur. Diagnosis. — Is not difficult, as pulmonary phthisis is usually as- sociated with it. Examination of the sputum for the specific bacilli will he conclusive. Prognosis. — The prognosis is not of the best at any time. On the whole, it is unfavorable. Treatment. — In this disease osteopathic treatment has been quite effectual. Cases of primary origin are more successfully treated than when of secondary cause, although one will be surprised many times at the results obtained when the disorder is not primary. The treatment must necessarily be both constitutional and local. Care of the general health as to hygiene and diet is absolutely necessary. The food must be nutritious and non-irritating. Scraped beef, raw oysters, raw eggs, soups and gruel are required. In cases where difficult}^ of deglutition occurs, it ma}'^ be largely overcome if the patient hangs his head over the side of the bed and sucks through a tube liquid nourishment placed n a dish upon the floor. The local treatment required is careful, persistent work over the lar- ynx and adjacent tissues. The treatment is given to increase the blood supply to the diseased tissues so that healing may take place, and that the bacteria may be deprived of the conditions favorable to their activity. Treatment along the cervical spine and upper dorsal will aid in cor- recting the vasomotor disorders that exist. Local apphcation of hot wa- ter will assist in relieving the pain. When pulmonary phthisis exists, attention and correction of it is important; in fact, is of primary consid- eration in laryngeal affection. The Practice of Osteopathy 577 Syphilitic Laryngitis Etiology. — This disease is of frequent occurrence, due to inherited syphiKs, or to the secondary or tertiary stages of the acquired form. Symptoms. — There is a hoarseness of the voice, a hacking cough, difficulty in swallowing and the various symptoms of catarrhal laryngitis. The secondary form may present superficial, whitish ulcers on the cords or ventricular bands, while in a tertiary stage the lesions are extensive and serious. Deep ulcers with raised edges are present, gummata devel- op on the submucous coat of the epiglottis and there may be necrosis and exfoliation of the cartilages. Deformity is produced by the cica- trices following the heaHng of the ulcers and sclerosis of the gummata. Edema of the larynx may suddenly prove fatal. Diagnosis. — The history of the case, the presence of other symptoms of the disease, the deep, symmetrical ulcers, the absence of tuberculosis elsewhere and the absence of marked pain, will usually make a diag- nosis easy. Prognosis. — Is somewhat favorable, more so at least than the tubercular form of laryngitis. There is great danger of deformity and permanent impairment of the voice. Treatment. — The treatment should be both constitutional and lo- cal. Active measures must be taken to rid the system of the virus of syphiHs, and thorough, direct treatment should be applied to the larynx and to its innervation. If the cicatricial stenosis has progressed so far that there is Httle hope from manipulative treatment, tracheotomy or gradual dilatation should be performed. The ulcerated portion is always to be kept clean. Edematous Laryngitis Definition. — An acute inflammation of the mucous membrane of the larynx with infiltration of serous fluid into the submucous tissue. Etiology.— This is a verj^ serious affection. It may occur in con- nection with acute laryngitis, though rarely, and occasionallj^ with chron- ic diseases of the larynx, as tuberculosis and syphihs. It may be a com- plication of some acute infectious disease like diphtheria, scarlet fever, or erysipelas of the face. It sometimes occurs suddenly in the course of Blight's disease. Lesions as in acute laryngitis are predisposing factors. Pathologically, there is marked sweUing of the epiglottis. The swelling can very easily be felt with the fingers. The mucous membrane is tense and changed in color. There is infiltration of a serous or sero- 578 The Practice of Osteopathy purulent fluid into the loose connective tissue of the larynx. The ary- tenoepiglottic folds are greatly involved, and they may be swollen to such a degree that they almost meet. Symptoms. — Extreme dyspnea and stridulous respiration. Hoarse- ness of the voice and later aphonia. There is a feehng of intense oppres- sion or suffocation. Evidence of dyspnea, anxious face, blue hps, pro- truding eyes and retraction of the base of the chest occvn\ The sterno- cleido-mastoid muscle is very prominent. Diagnosis. — This is not difficult. The history of the case, laryn- goscopic examination, and the swollen epiglottis which can be easily felt with the fingers make diagnosis easy. Prognosis. — Generally unfavorable. At any time it is extremely grave, but with prompt and vigorous treatment recovery is possible. The duration varies from a few hours to several days. Treatment. — One must attend strictly and carefully to the lar}^- geal innervation, as in acute catarrhal laryngitis. Obstruction to the superior or inferior thyroid, facial, internal jugular or innominata will cause tumefaction and edema of the larynx and adjacent tissues. Also, enlargement of the lymphatics about the larynx and salivary glands may produce edema of the laryngeal region; consequently, particular care should be taken of the various tissues about these vessels and of the in- nervation from the cervical spine, so the veins are not obstructed or the Ijmiphatic channels disordered, so that infiltration of the tissues may be further prevented. The most prominent symptom is laryngeal dyspnea and this de- pends altogether upon the swelHng of the soft parts. If the swelling is great and the disorder cannot be removed, suffocation will follow. In such cases, besides giving direct treatment over the larynx, introduc- ing a finger into the mouth, and reaching clear back under the roof of the soft palate, with a firm, downward, outward and sweeping movement on either side, relax the soft tissues. The persistent use of small pellets of ice, held far back in the mouth, will be found very beneficial; also, ap- plication of the ice-bag, provided the edema is of inflammatory origin. If one is not able to control the rapid infiltration of the larynx and glottis when such cases arise, tracheotomy or intubation should be per- formed at once. When edematous laryngitis is due to diseases of the heart, lungs and kidneys, treatment of the primary disease should be given in addition to the local treatment. The Practice of Osteopathy 579 DISEASES OF THE BRONCHI Acute Bronchitis Definition. — A catarrhal inflammation of part or whole of the mucous membrane of the larynx, trachea and bronchial tubes, or it may extend into the capillary tubes. This is bilateral, affecting more or less the bronchial tree in both lungs. Osteopathic Etiology and Pathology. — The most common cause of acute bronchitis is ''catching cold." It is more prevalent in the winter, and it often succeeds an ordinary cold in the head, coryza or laryn- gitis, the inflammation extending downward from the upper air passages. A case of acute bronchitis always presents a contracted condition of the muscles on either side of the spine in the upper dorsal region. The contracted muscles may extend as far down as the middle dorsal or as high as the entire cervical. Occasionally, the ribs posteriorly are drawn downward by the extreme contraction of the muscles, and the upper an- terior part of the chest may be somewhat constricted and hmited in its movements by the tensed muscles. Thus, in a few cases the ribs and up- per dorsal vertebrae are actually sub-dislocated by the extreme con- traction of the muscles. The principal points affected are the second, third, fourth and fifth dorsal regions. In a few instances cervical lesions disturbing the vagus and resulting in motor weakness of the tubes, will be noted. The osteopathic control of the bronchial vasomotor nerves is in this region (dorsal). The disease is also associated with measles and it is usually a symp- tom of influenza. One attack predisposes to another. It affects either sex and especially children and the old, in whom it most frequently in- volves the smaller bronchi. In adult life it involves the larger bronchi. Micro-organisms, particularly the pneumococcus, influenza bacillus, and micrococcus catarrhalis, act as exciting causes. Pathologically, the mucous membrane of the portion of the tra- chea and bronchi tha.t are impHcated become reddened, congested and more or less covered with a tough mucus mingled with epithelial cells. The hyperemia is most marked about the mucous glands. Some of the smaller bronchial tubes are dilated. In severe cases there is desqua- mation of the ciliated epithelium, swelling and edema of the sub-mucosa, and infiltration of the tissues with leucocytes. The affection involves cliiefly the vasomotor nerves. In cases on the verge of chronicity, look well to the diet; especially lessen in amount the starchy and saccharine foods. 580 The Practice of Osteopathy Symptoms.— The onset of acute bi'onchitis is accompanied by the symptoms of a common "cold." In the beginning the cough is hard and dry without expectoration; but later it is looser, the secretion becom- ing mucopurulent and abundant and finally purulent. The scanty sputum is at first glairy and mucoid, while later it becomes more abund- ant and mucopurulent and contains pus-cells and desquamated epi- thelium. When the bronchial inflammation becomes fully estabhshed, there is a feeling of tightness and rawness beneath the sternum and a sen- sation of oppression in the chest, due to swelhng of the mucous mem- brane and the presence of secretions which cause stenosis of the bronchial lumina. There is a sHght fever, rarely exceeding 101 degrees F. The disease lasts from four or five days to three weeks. There is either a com- plete recoveiy or chronic bronchitis is developed. Physical Signs. — There may be no physical signs in shght attacks of acute lironchitis of the larger tubes. In severer cases the physical signs are well marked. Inspection maj^ recognize increased frequency of breathing, and M^hen the smaller tubes are involved there is dyspnea. Palpation. — The bronchial fremitus may often be felt, providing there is sufficient narrowing of the breathing tubes. Percussion. — Sounds are normal as long as the bronchitis is uncomplicated. Auscultation. — In the early stage piping, sibilant rales ma}^ be heard on both sides. These rales are inconstant and appear and disappear with coughing. There may be harshness of breathing added to these. When resolution sets in, the rales change and become mucous and bubbling in quahty. Vo- cal resonance in bronchitis is normal, unless complications occur. Diagnosis. — This is generally easy. The absence of dullness and blowing breathing and the bronchial character of the cough and expec- toration are usually sufficient to distinguish it from pneumonia and pleurisy. If the physical signs are noticed carefulty, the diagnosis is rendered easy and positive in all cases. Prognosis. — In the very young and the very old, the prognosis is unfavorable, but in a previously healthy adult the most that can hap- pen to a case of acute bronchitis is to become chronic. Recovery is the rule; even in the aged and feeble death is rare. If osteopathic treatment can be instituted from the inception, the disease will probabl}" be aborted. The treatment almost invariably lessens the severity and duration of an attack. For capillary bronchitis see Bronchopneumonia. Treatment. — Complete rest in a warm bed, and a hot foot bath would cure a large majority of cases in a day or two if the patient would only submit to such treatment. Most of them wish to be around and The Practice of Osteopathy 581 out doors and very likely attending to their usual work, so that a cure in some cases is hard to perform. They are very liable to take more "cold" and in a few cases it will take great effort to prevent the bronchitis from becoming chronic. One thorough treatment per day will usually be sufficient. The hj^peremic condition of the bronchial tubes is due to a vaso- motor disturbance, generally caused by a severe contraction of the mus- cles of the back in the region of the first to fom^th dorsal; although the vasomotor nerves to the mucous membrane of the bronchial tubes may be affected anywhere from the first to the seventh dorsal inclusive. Con- traction of the muscles over the anterior part of the chest corresponding to these regions and caused by the same influences (chiefly atmospherical changes) is of quite common occurrence. In the majority of cases the contraction of the chest and back muscles is so severe that the ribs are partly displaced by the tension and thus is added a complication to the disorder, and from this complication chronic bronchitis is liable to occur. The ribs or even vertebrae to the corresponding region oftentimes remain partly dislocated and are a source of continued and permanent irritation to the innervation of the bronchial tubes. So it is always necessarj^ in treating any form of bronchitis to see at each treatment that the ribs and vertebrae from the first dorsal to the seventh dorsal, inclusive, are anatomically correct. As has been stated, the disordered muscles or ribs may be affected anteriorly as well as posteriorly; consequently, the treatment applied is a thorough relaxation of the chest and back muscles and the correction of the ribs and vertebrae in order that the vasomotor disturbance of the bronchial mucosa may be corrected and the inflammation relieved. An excellent method to release the immobifized anterior upper chest is to place patient flat upon his back with pillow beneath upper dorsal. This hyperextends spine, enlarges spinal foramina, and tends to elevate ribs. Then by use of arms as levers, moderate inspiration, and em- ployment of one hand over anterior end of ribs they may be easily re- leased and raised. This treatment effects circulation, innervation, lymph tissue, and rib bone marrow. In addition to the dorsal spinal nerves, and the sympathetic, the vagi are to be considered in the treatment of bronchitis, as all of these nerves, s^Tnpathetic, spinal, and vagi, go to make up the anterior and posterior pulmonarj^ plexuses from which the bronchial mucosa receives its innervation. The veins particularly involved in passive hyperemia of the bronchial tubes are the superior intercostal and azygos major; 582 The Practice of Osteopathy so raise and spread the ribs to give greater freedom to these bloodvessels. "The blood flow may be diverted from the bronchi to the abdomen by a slow, deep, inhibitive treatment over it, including pressure over the solar and hypogastric plexuses. " (Hazzard). The excretory organs and the diet of the patient should be attended to. Especially in children, the diet had best be a fluid one, as milk, egg albumin, meat broths and meat juice. For those who are subject to the disease an outdoor life is best. Chronic Bronchitis Definition. — A chronic inflammation of the mucous membrane of the large and middle sized bronchial tubes. Osteopathic Etiology and Pathology. — Chronic bronchitis may be either primary or secondary. The primary form is the result of expos- sure to wet and cold or to the daily inhalation of irritating vapors or dust. This form is rare, the affection being almost always a secondarj^ one, and is most commonly met with in chronic lung affections, heart disease, gout or renal disease. It ma}^ be caused by any disease which favors congestion of the air tubes by obstruction of the circulation; especially mitral diseases and Bright's disease. It is also caused by chronic al- coholism and may be the result of repeated attacks of the acute form. Chronic vertebral and rib lesions are found from the first to the seventh dorsal, inclusive. Elderly people are often subject to the disorder. Pathologically, the lesions of chronic bronchitis present great variation, as to both their nature and extent. In some cases the mucous membrane is atrophied, so that some of the elastic fibers are noticeable. The epithelial layer is in great part missing. The muscular coat and mu- cous glands are atrophied. In certain cases the mucous membrane of the bronchi is thickened, and there may be ulceration. In long standing bronchitis, there is frequently dilation of the tubes (bronchiectasis) and emphysema. Symptoms. — Pain is rarely present; there is merely a feeling of constriction lieneath the sternum. The cough varies with the weather and season and there is often an absence of the cough during the summer. It is apt to be worse at night than in the morning, and is frequently par- oxysmal. There is rarely any fever. As a rule, there is free expector- ation of mucopurulent or distinctly purulent matter. Sometimes it is abundant, seromucous in character, and again there are severe cases of dry cough in which there is almost no expectoration. Unless asso- The Practice of Osteopathy 583 ciated with other diseases, the general health suffers but httle, if at all. The appetite, as a rule, is good and the body weight is well maintained. Physical Signs — Inspection.— There is considerable immobihty of the chest and if emphysema is present there is distension. Percussion is clear, and hyperresonant in emphysema. Auscultation. — The ex- piration is prolonged and forcible. This is associated with sonorous and sibilant rales and moist rales of all sizes. Special Varieties. — Bronchorrhea, dry catarrh, putrid bronchi- tis or fetid bronchitis. Bronchorrhea. — In this form there may be an excessive bron- chial secretion. This may be liquid and watery, but more frequently it is purulent, thin and containing greenish masses; or again it may be thick. Dilation of the tubes and fetid bronchitis may be developed. Fetid Bronchitis. — Fetid expectoration is associated with gan- grene of the lungs, abscesses, bronchiestasis, decomposition of matter within phthisical cavities, or empyema with perforation of the lungs; or it may occur independently. There is considerable expectoration that is thin and offensive. When putrefactive changes take place dur- ing the course of chronic bronchitis, as a rule, the following symptoms immediately appear: fever, which may be septic; increase of cough; pain in the side, and sometimes a chill. There is increased prostration. The symptoms may abate followed by the usual course of bronchitis. Dry Catarrh. — The cough is distressing and paroxysmal. It is usually associated with emphysema and is a very troublesome form. Diagnosis. — This is not usually difficult. Phthisis — the absence of fever, of hemorrhage, of tubercle bacillus and the signs of locaUzed consolidation (usually at one or other apex) will serve to distinguish be- tween the two. Prognosis. — Recovery is not always accompHshed. The diseases being generally a secondary affection, the prognosis must depend upon the primary condition. The danger from development of emphysema, bronchiectasis and dilatation of the right ventricle must be thought of. Frequently cures will be obtained, even in old persons. Care must be taken that there are no serious organic lesions. Deep treatment to re- adjust the upper and middle dorsals is most essential. Treatment. — In the first place there must be a careful regulation of the hygiene of the patient. The diet should be a nutritious one, care iK'ing taken to give food that is easily digested. A liberal diet can easily he selected from the various meats, vegetables, cereals, fruits, soups, l)roths, eggs and milk. The clothing should be carefully selected. Flan- 584 The Practice of Osteopathy nel should be worn next the skin the year around, care being taken that the sufferer is not too warmly clad. Due attention should be given to bathing, exercising, etc. The patient should be out in the open air a great deal, but be careful that it is not too stormy. The air of the room should be kept at an even temperature and not subject to abrupt changes. Two or three treatments per week will be required, and when the condi- tion is considerably aggravated, do not hesitate to treat oftener, but be careful not to unduly irritate the lesions. Lesions will be found to the ribs and vertebrae from the first to the seventh dorsal inclusive. Many cases present lesions in the verte- brae from the second to fourth, usually of a lateral nature. Other lesions of frequent occurrence are displacements of both vertebrae and ribs. Correcting these deviations reheves the chronic inflammation of the tubes. Also in those cases where dilatation of the bronchial tubes occurs, the obstruction to the motor fibers is to be removed by the correction of the vertebrae and by removing obstruction to fibers of the pneumogastric ; the fibers of the latter supplying the transverse muscles of the bronchial tubes. It generally requires a considerable course of treatment for the cure of chronic bronchitis, and one of the hardest things to contend with in the treatment is the hkehhood of the patient " catching cold. " When a fresh cold gets thoroughly started, it is almost impossible to prevent the disease from extending down the bronchial tubes, as the innervation is less rich in the smaller tubes. Hazzard says: "The obese should be taught the habit of deep res- piration, as should all persons subject to the attacks of the disease. This measure, together with the daily cold sponge or shower bath, is a great aid in overcoming the chronic tendency. " Those cases that are due to cardiac or nephritic diseases require the treatment of the primary disease in addition to a light bronchial treat- ment. A lesion between the gladiolus and manubrium of the sternum may be found, but it is of rare occurrence in these cases. The upper portion of the sternum may be held verj^ rigidly and slightly underneath the middle portion of the sternum; or at the point of articulation of the two portions a distinct ridge may be found, caused by the articular ends be- ing pushed antei'iorly. Probably such lesions affect the innervation to the bronchial tubes and lung tissues. Associated with this condition the upper chest is considerably immobilized, affecting the lymph and rib bone marrow function. Examine the first ribs and clavicles carefully. Changes of climate are often beneficial. The Practice of Osteopathy 585 Fibrinous Broncliitis Definition. — A rare, acute or chronic inflammatory disease of the bronchi, in which a fibrinous mould of the bronchus and its branches is formed. These are expelled in paroxysms of cough and dyspnea. The casts block the bronchial tubes. When these moulds are large or medi- um sized, they are generally hollow, while those of the smaller bronchi are solid. Etiology and Pathology. — The causes are unknown. Young men, between the twentieth and fortieth years, are the usual subjects; but the disease may occur at any period of life. Lesions occur as in other forms of bronchitis. The attack occurs most frequently in the spring months. In some cases there seems to be some hereditary influence. Chronic pulmonary diseases, like phthisis, emphysema and pleurisy, are occasionally predisposing causes. It is sometimes associated with skin diseases, such as herpes, impetigo and pemphigus. The pathology is not known. The masses that are expelled are usu- ally round and mixed with blood and mucus. The casts are more dense, but the membrane is identical with that of croupous exudates. This affection, however, is limited to certain bronchial tubes and recurs at stated or irregular intervals, sometimes for a period of several years. There is loss of epithelium in the affected bronchi and the submucous tissue is often swollen and infiltrated with serum. Symptoms. — Acute cases are rare. The attacks may set in with rigor, high fever, pain in the side, soreness, severe paroxysms of cough and sometimes a sHght hemoptysis. The symptoms are those of an or- dinary acute bronchitis, but of severer character; aggravated cough and dyspnea and fatal termination are not uncommon. Death occassional- ly results from suffocation. There may be but one attack without any recm-rence, but in the chronic form the paroxysms recur at irregular in- tervals, though they are less severe than in the acute form. The disease may last for ten or even twenty years, the attacks re- curring weekl}^, or a period of a year or more may intervene. The on- set is marked by bronchial symptoms with or without fever. The cough soon becomes distressing and paroxysmal in character. The sputum may be blood-stained and occasionally there is profuse hemorrhage. The expectoration is in the form of ball-like masses which, when unraveled arc found to be moulds of the bronchi. They may be hollow and laminat- ed or quite solid. When examined under the microscope they are seen to consist of a fibrillatod membrane in which are imbedded leucocytes, 586 The Practice of Osteopathy mucus, corpuscles, fat drops and epithelial cells. Leyden's crystals and Curschmann's spirals are occasional!}^ found. Physical signs are usually those of broncliitis. The weakened or suppressed breath sounds in the affected territory may occasionally be determined. There is sometimes a diminished expansion or even retrac- tion of the chest wall over the affected area. There is no dullness on per- cussion, unless the portions of the lung suppHed by the affected tubes collapse. After dislodgement of the casts, the normal respiratory murmur returns. Diagnosis. — The fibrinous casts alone are sufficient for a positive diagnosis. Prognosis. — Generally favorable. In uncomplicated cases there is rarely any danger, even though there may be severe paroxysms of cough and dyspnea. In fatal cases the lesions of associated or preceding affec- tions have been found, such as chronic pleurisy, pneumonia and phthisis. Although this is a rare disease, cases have been treated with success by osteopathic means. If uncompUcated there should be a fair chance for a cure, depending, of course, upon the constitutional condition and the permanency of the lesions. Treatment. — The treatment is largely that of acute bronchitis. The disorder is more extensive than in acute broncliitis, consequently severe subluxations of the ribs and vertebrae of the upper and middle dorsals occur, besides extensive muscular contractions of the chest and neck. The fibrinous casts are somewhat of the same nature of mem- branous exudates elsewhere, therefore the treatment shguld be directed to a correction of the hyperemia of the mucous membrane of the bron- chial tubes, thus loosening and disorganizing the exudate. The vagi nerves supply a part of the innervation to the bronchial tubes and lungs. Any disorder to them should be corrected when diseases of the bronchial tubes and lungs exist. They contain motor fibers to these organs, and to the bronchial tubes they supply, principally the transverse fibers. In bronchitis of various forms, marked effect can be secured by close attention and treatment to the inferior laryngeal nerve. This is best treated at the inner side of the lower portion of the sterno-cleido muscle. The different forms of bronchitis illustrate the point so often noted in osteopathic etiology and pathology, that the various affections of the same region should not be studied so much as types of several diseases or disease entities as different degrees of involvement, depending on the severity of the causative lesion, the function of the nerves disturbed, and the character of the tissues. It is straining a point to diagnose and The Practice of Osteopathy 587 classify many diseases according to signs and symptoms instead of study- ing the process from central causes, for, at best, peripheral manifesta- tions, micro-organisms, etc., are really incidental to the importance of the primary source of disturbed nutrition. Consequently, the same treatment, if scientific, is frequently indicated for all of the disorders that may affect a given locality. After all has been said and done, the therapy as well as the pathology, must hinge upon the fundamental — uninterrupted blood channels and nerve courses are essential to health. Whether a disease is of primary or secondary origin, or whether or not it presents different symptoms in various types, the above basic princi- ple is invariably appHcable. This simplifies etiology, pathology and treatment and furnishes a backbone to theory and practice, and some day rational medicine will adopt it. Bronchiectasis. Bronchiectasis is a dilatation of a part or the whole of the bron- chial tube. As a rule this affection is a secondary one, the most common cause being chronic bronchitis. The inflammation weakens the broncliial walls so that they are unable to resist the strain that is put upon them during violent paroxysms of coughing. After dilatation has once com- menced, the weight of the secretion which accumulates tends to further distend the weakened walls and the elasticity, becoming impaired, is finally lost. Dilatation of the bronchi is also associated with emphysema, compression of a bronchus, aneurism or mediastinal tumor, broncho- pneumonia, measles and whooping cough in children, and also traction associated with fibroid induration. Hence the bronchial dilatation is especially associated with bronchitis, interstitial pneumonia, and some- times chronic pleurisy. It is rarely a congenital effect in such cases. It is commonly unilateral. The lesions presented to the osteopath are largel}^ Hke those found in chronic bronchitis, i. e., derangement of the upper four or five dorsal vertebrae and ribs, and lesions of the cervical vertebrae involving the vagi. These lesions obstruct the nerve force to the bronchial tubes and thus cause the dilatation. Pathologically, the dilatation is usually either cylindrical or sac- cular, which may occur in the same lung. The entire bronchial tree may be converted into a series of sacs opening into each other. These have smooth, shining walls in the most dependent parts which are some- times ulcerated. In extreme conditions the dilatations may form large cysts immediately beneath the pleura; as a rule, the lung tissue lying between the sacculi becomes cirrhotic. Partial dilatation is more 588 The Practice of Osteopathy common. The bronchial mucous membrane is involved with an oc- casional narrowing of the lumen. The narrowings are most commonlj^ cyhndrical, sometimes saccular. In all forms there is decided change in the bronchial wall. In the large dilatations, the epithelium is changed. The elastic and muscular la3^ers are thin and atrophied. These dilatations frequently contain fetid secretions and when these secretions are retained, the hning mem- brane becomes ulcerated. Symptoms. — There is always cough, which occurs in severe par- oxysms. In some cases a change of position will cause a paroxysm of coughing — very likely due to the emptying of the contents of a dilated tube into a normal one. The sputum is mucopurulent and is greenish brown in color, is fluid, and has a sour, or more frequently, a fetid odor. On standing, it separates into three layers; the upper is frothy and thin, the middle mucoid, and the lower is a thick sediment of cells and granu- lar debris. Microscopically, the sediment consists of pus corpuscles, fatty acid crystals which are arranged in the form of bundles, and some- times red blood discs and hematoidin crystals. Elastic fibers may be found if ulcers are present. Physical Signs. — When distinctly present, thej^ are those of a cavity in the lungs. When chronic pleurisy and interstitial pneumonia are associated, there may be retraction of the chest wall. The percus- sion resonance is impaired. On auscultation, bronchial, or even am- phoric, breathing is heard occasionally with metallic rales. Diagnosis. — In a number of cases this was formerly impossible, where the X-ra}^ is now proving of great assistance. History, paroxysmal cough, characteristic copious sputum and an absence of tubercle bacilli with little impairment of the general health will serve to distinguish bronchiectasis from pulmonary tuberculosis. Circumscribed empyema which has ruptured into the lung may simulate bronchiectasis. This is of a much more sudden onset, has a history of previous pleurisy, the health is gradually impaired, and there is thoracic oppression and dysp- nea on the slightest exertion. Prognosis. — Is generally unfavorable. However this largely de- pends upon the cause. Treatment. — Largely the same as in chronic bronchitis. Severe lesions are found in the dorsal vertebrae about the region of the third, fourth and fifth, and many times lesions of the . pneumogastric at the upper cervical vertebrce are also found. The lesions are much of the same nature as those of bronchitis, but, as a rule, there is a much deeper The Practice of Osteopathy 589 or more extensive lesion. These lesions weaken the motor innervation to the muscular coats of the bronchial tubes, and in many instances the extensive lesions involve the vasomotor nerves controlUng the blood supply to the bronchial tubes. In most cases marked lesions of the ribs on either side will be found, usually in the region corresponding to the affected vertebrae. The position of the patient is important; the head should be low in sleeping. In certain fetid cases surgery should be considered. Care should be taken as to the hygienic surroundings of the patient. The diet should be carefully regulated and nutritious, as in chronic bron- chitis. Bronchial Asthma Bronchial or spasmodic asthma is a chronic affection, charac- terized by a paroxysmal dyspnea due to a spasmodic contraction of the muscles of the bronchial tubes or to swelUng of their mucous membrane. Osteopathic Etiology and Pathology. — The majority of lesions causing bronchial asthma are from the second to the seventh dorsal region, inclusive, either in the ribs posteriorly or anteriorly, or in the vertebrae. These lesions involve vasomotor nerves to the bronchioles which produce the narrowing of the tubes and thus cause the dyspnea. Usually the lesion is at the third, fourth or fifth rib on the right side, although, as stated, a lesion may be found above or below this point at the anterior or posterior ends of the ribs or in the vertebrae corresponding to the same region. Probably lesions are found more on the right side, because most people are right handed; these muscles being better devel- oped would tend, when contracted, to draw the ribs from their articula- tion. The third, fourth and fifth ribs are usually found involved because it is the region of greatest vasomotor innervation to the bronchial tubes In a number of cases there will be found a posteiior curvature of the dorso-lumbar region; and accompanying this condition will be ca- tarrh and dilatation of the stomach, congestion of the liver, and, perhaps, intestinal indigestion and constipation. Careful attention should be given to the digestive organs. Lesions involving the pneumogastric at the atlas and axis are fairly frequent. These irritate fibers of the pneumogastric to the muscles of the bronchioles and thus produce narrowing of the tubes and conse- quently the paroxysms. Other points to note are the costal cartilages and hyoid bone, and prolmbly, in a few instances, lesions to the phrenic. Attacks may be induced reflexly by various excitants, as dust, dis- eases of th(^ upper rcspiratorj' tract, etc., l)ut the lesions to the vasomotor 590 The Peactice of Osteopathy and motor nerves are the predisposing causes. Laughlin^ says: "It is questionable whether reflex causes alone are sufficient to produce genuine asthma without the existence of specific lesions affecting the di- rect nerve connections of the part involved." No doubt a neurotic tendency is often a predisposing factor. Overeating, and particularly certain foods will frequently excite an attack. Pathologically, true asthma is a pure neurosis. There is more or less chronic inflammation of the bronchial tubes, shown by injection and thickening of the bronchial mucosa in the majority of cases. There may be found the morbid states peculiar to chronic bronchitis and em- physema. Whether the constriction of the tubes is due to spasms of the bronchial muscles or to swelHng of the mucosa, or to both, the pri- mary, predisposing and irritating influences are common to both. These are vertebral and rib lesions affecting the spinal nerves at their exit and the sjanpathetic chain along the head of the ribs; irritating lesions to the vagi, constricting pulmonary' vessels, and to the cervical sympathetics, causing disturbance of the same, would be factors in the pathological chain. Reflex irritations may be found in various regions, but the prin- cipal osseous lesions, according to Dr. Still, are on the right side from the second to the sixth dorsal. Symptoms. — The attack may come on at any time, but usuallj^ it comes on in the night during sleep. The onset may be sudden or the attack may be preceded by premonitory sensations, such as tightness in the chest, flatulence, sneezing, chilhness and a copious discharge of pale urine. Nervous symptoms, headache, vertigo, neuralgia, and an anxious, nervous, restless feeling may precede the attack. There is a sense of oppression and anxiety, followed by dyspnea. Soon the respiratory efforts become violent, the patient is obliged to sit up or runs to the window for air. The shoulders are raised, the hands are placed upon something firm to keep the shoulders fixed so that the accessory muscles of respiration can be brought into play. The contracted tubes resist the entrance of air. Expiration is prolonged and wheezy. In severe cases the face becomes pale, the skin is covered with perspiration, the extremities are cold, the Hps, finger-tips and eyeUds are livid, owing to defective oxygenation of the blood. The pulse is small and quick and the temperature is normal or subnormal. The attack msLV terminate suddenly, sometimes with a spell of coughing; this is especially so of severe cases, as the cough is generally absent in brief paroxysms. 1. Laughlin — Asthma — Journal of the American Osteopathic Association, Oct., 1914. The Practice of Osteopathy 591 The cough is at j&rst very tight and dry and accompanied by a tough, scanty expectoration which is expelled with great difficulty. The sputum contains rounded masses of matter, the socalled "pearls" of Lsennec. Microscopically, they are found to be of a spiral structure, containing cells derived from the bronchial mucous membrane and fatty degenerated pus cells. A second form is contained in the inside of the coiled spiral of mucin, a filament of great clearness and translucency, that is most probably composed of transformed mucin. Curschmann's spirals are found in the early stages of the attack and for a time these were supposed, by their irritation, to excite the paroxysms. Their spiral form is unexplained. Curschmann beheves that these spirals are found in the finer bronchioles and to be a product of bronchioHtis. Physical Signs. — Inspection shows enlargement of the chest which is fixed and barrel-shaped. The breathing is labored and the chest moves but shghtly. The diaphragm is lowered and fixed. Per- cussion yields hj^per-resonance, especially in cases which have had re- peated attacks or when the asthma is associated with emphysema. Aus- cultation. — With inspiration and expiration are heard sonorous sibi- lant rales which are more marked on expiration. As the secretion in- creases, which is later in the attack, the rale becomes moist. The at- tack lasts for a variable period, rarely less than an hour. In severe attacks the paroxysms recur for three or four nights or more with spon- taneous remissions during the day. In some cases the relief seems to be absolute, but in the majority of cases there is more or less oppression and cough for a day or two, sometimes for many days. Diagnosis. — The physical signs, examination of the sputum and the history of the case makes the diagnosis easy. Prognosis. — It is not a fatal disease and only dangerous when complications arise. Under osteopathic treatment the prognosis is usually favorable, unless there are serious complications, as this is a disease that osteopathy has treated with signal success. In long stand- ing cases emphysema invariably develops. Treatment. — Asthma, unless complicated with bronchial and lung diseases, is usually readily reheved during the paroxysms. Cases of many years' standing have been cured in a few treatments. It should be borne in mind that asthma is a respiratory neurosis. To relieve an attack the osteopath should locate the lesion and, if possible, correct it. Oium^, in the acute attack, standing at the head of his patient inserts the tips of both thumbs well under the angles of the 1. Journal A. O. A. 1918. 592 The Practice of Osteopathy jaw and then brings direct pressure on both vagi as they pass over the transverse processes of the axis. Pressure must be brief and let up to be appHed again. Immediate relief is given in many cases. Adjust upper three cervicals if found deranged. If the muscles are so severely contracted that it is impossible to make out the nature of the lesion, then strong inhibition, with an up- ward, outward movement over the angles of the ribs involved, will be sufficient. The object to be gained in every ease is to reheve pressure or irritation to the vasomotor or motor nerves, so that the narrowed tubes may be relaxed. Strong inhibition, such as placing the knee in the patient's back, at the same time pulling on the shoulders, will have temporary effect, but it is always best to reduce the lesion if possible. In severe cases dilatation of the rectum may relieve the paroxysm, and in a few instances it will be necessary to treat the uterus locally. During the interval between the attacks is the time to remedy the disease. Then one is able to locate exactly the position of the disturbed tissues that are causing the paroxysms and apply treatment in the re- gions given under etiology. Many cases of asthma are cured in from one to three months' treatment. One treatment a week is sufficient, provided one is able each time to accomphsh something toward a cor- rection of the lesion and that the patient does not suffer during the mean- time. Too frequent treatments may simply act as an irritant to the nervous lesions. Attention should always be given to the diet and hygiene. Gas- tric digestion should be complete before retiring or it may induce an attack. Complications are treated according to the disease. Examine the upper respiratory tract, the digestive tract, and the pehdc organs when there is reason to believe the paroxysm may be induced reflexly. Laughlin sums up the treatment as follows: (1) Removal of specific lesion; (2) removal of exciting causes; (3) removal of reflex causes; and, (4) treatment of the patient to improve the condition of the general ner- vous system. DISEASES OF THE LUNGS Emphysema Used in a general way, emphysema is a term which implies the presence of air in the interstitial tissue, but when applied to the lungs there are two applications of the term, having widely different significa- tions, viz: Interlobular or interstitial emphysema and vesicular em- physema. The Practice of Osteopathy 593 Interlobular Emphysema.— This is caused by rupture of air vesicles, deep in the king structure, the air escaping into the interlobular connective tissue. It is not a very serious condition, rarely produces symptoms and affords no physical signs. It usually results from vio- lent acts of coughing in which the expiratory strain is very great, as in whooping cough and in bronchial asthma: also, from wounds of the lung. The air bubbles escape into the interlobular septa and are sometimes seen hke little rows of beads outhning the lobules. The pleura may become detached and larger vesicles may form. In rare cases the rup- ture may take place at the root of the lung and the air passes along the trachea into the subcutaneous tissue of the neck and chest wall, which gives rise to a very peculiar and distinctive crepitation upon palpation. Rarely there is rupture of the superficial vesicles, producing pneumo- thorax. Vesicular Emphysema. — Dilatation of the infundibular passages and alveoli or an increase in their size either symmetrical, involving both lungs, or localized. Vesicular emphysema is divided into compensatory, hypertrophic and atrophic forms. Compensatory. — This occurs when a region of the lung has been disabled from an}^ cause and does not expand fully during inspiration; the healthy portion of the lung must then distend and do vicarious work or the chest wall will sink in to occupy the space. This happens with por- tions of healthy lungs in the neighborhood of tubercular areas and ci- catrices, areas of collapsed lung or parts prevented from expansion by pleuritic adhesions (in this case the compensatory emphysema is chiefly at the anterior margins of the lungs) . As a rule this distention is physio- logic and beneficial, the alveolar walls being simply stretched. Later they may, atrophy, the air cells becoming fused. Hypertrophic Emphysema. — This is enlargement of the lung, due to dilatation of the air vesicles and atrophy of the walls. Osteopathic Etiology and Pathology. — An important predis- posing cause of emphysema is often found to be due to derangements of the tissues, usually vertebra? and ribs, which affect the innervation to the lung tissues. Such lesions are found in the vagi and spinal dorsal nerves. The atlas may be involved, but it is generally the ribs and dor- sal vertebra. Distinction should be made between cause and effect in the skeletal changes. No doubt in many instances a vicious circle is thus established. Congenital weakness of the lung tissues, probably due to non-development of the elastic tissue, is a predisposing factor. This disease has a m;u•k(■(ll^■ licicditai'v character and frequently starts 594 The Practice of Osteopathy early in life. The heightened pressure within the air cells upon an already weakened lung tissue produces emphysema. Hence, the obstinate cough of chronic bronchitis and expiratory straining of asthma are sometimes the immediate cause. In all attacks of severe coughing or straining efforts, the glottis is closed and the air is forced into the upper part of the lungs, forcibly expanding them, and here is where emphysema is found to be most advanced. This disease is also found in players of wind instruments, in glass blowers and in those whose occupation neces- sitates heavy lifting or straining. Pathologically, the thorax is barrel-shaped. The lungs are en- larged and do not collapse when the thorax is opened, as they have lost their elasticity. The organs are pale, soft and downy to the feeling and pit on pressure. Enlarged air vesicles may readily be seen beneath the pleura. Microscopically, there are seen atrophy of the vesicular walls and a diminished amount of elastic tissue. There is more or less oblit- eration of the capillaries, and the epithelium of the air cells undergoes a fatty change. There is usually chronic inflammation of the bronchial tubes, which may be roughened and thickened. The diaphragm is lowered and the subjacent viscera are displaced. The most important morbid changes are found in the heart, the right chamber being dilated and hypertrophied. This is caused by the increased tension in the pul- monary artery, which is enlarged and the seat of atheromatous degener- ation. In long standing cases the hypertrophy is general. Changes in the hver, kidneys and other viscera are those associated with prolonged venous engorgement. Symptoms. — The onset of the disease is usually gradual. The first symptom to be noticed is the shortness of breath. In rare cases it may exhibit a more acute development, as after whooping cough, and then the first symptom will be dyspnea. In some cases this persists all the time, while in moderate emphysema the dyspnea is noticed only on slight exertion, such as going up-stairs, running or walking rapidly. The lungs are always filled with air which is charged with carbon dioxid and does not change, as the patient is constantly making ineffectual efforts to draw in air. The inspiration is shortened and the expiration is greatly prolonged and is often harsh and wheezy. The. pulse-rate is accelerated; the temperature is usually normal. Cyanosis is a characteristic symptom in well estabhshed cases and is of an extreme gradq not seen in any other affection. Bronchitis is frequently found in combination, especially in winter. In this case there will be the symptoms of the associated bron- chitis, cough, expectoration and sometimes oppression. As the patient The Practice of Osteopathy 595 advances in age and there are successive attacks of bronchitis, the con- dition gets worse. In advanced cases, the result of cardiac failures, there may be venous engorgement, dropsj^ and effusions into the serous sacs. Physical Signs. — Inspection. — There is a marked change in the shape of the thorax. The chest is rounded with increased circumfer- ence, giving the characteristic barrel-shaped chest. The sternum bulges, as do also the costal cartilages. The intercostal spaces are wide, especiallj^ in the hypochondriac region, and narrow above. The clav- icles and muscles of the neck stand out with great prominence and the neck itself seems to be shortened on account of the elevation of the thorax and sternum. The curve of the spine is increased and there is a winged condition of the scapulae. These changes give the patient a stooping posture. The chest does not expand, but is raised up by the scaleni and sternocleidomastoid muscles which stand out prominently and are hj^pertrophied. The heart's apex beat is invisible and there is usual]\ marked epigastric pulsation. On palpation, vocal fremitus is found diminished, but not absent; the apex beat is rarely felt. There is dis- tinct shock over the ensiform cartilage. This is due to the displacement of the heart and engorgement of the right ventricle. There is marked pulsation in the epigastrium. On percussion there is sometimes in- creased resonance, almost amounting to tympany. The upper level of hepatic dullness is depressed. The heart dullness may be obhterated and the upper Hmit of splenic dullness may also be lowered. The per- cussion note is greatly extended. Auscultation reveals that the in- spiration is short and feeble while there is prolonged expiration, the normal ratio being reversed. In associated bronchitis rales are frequently heard. Diagnosis. — Unless complicated the diagnosis is generally easily made. The enlargement of the thorax, with dyspnea and hyper-reso- nance and a prolonged expiration will differentiate emphysema from- chronic bronchitis. Pneumothorax is of sudden development while emphysema is of slow development. Pneumothorax is usually unilat- (u-al, and it gives a tympanitic percussion note. In auscultation there is amphoric breathing and metallic tinkhng and absence of any vesicular murmur. Prognosis. — The disease is rarely fatal, although death may result I'lotu heart failure, dropsy or pneumonia. Thorough and persistent treatment will generally relieve the primary condition. The disease, as a rule, runs a long course but does not necessarily shorten hfe. Atrophic emphysema is a senile change. 596 The Practice of Osteopathy Treatment. — In cases of recent occurrence one maj' be able to build up the altered lung tissue by treatment of the innervation to the lung structure, viz. : the vasomotor nerves from the second to the sev- enth dorsal, the vagi, and the cervical and dorsal sjanpathetics. When a number of air vesicles have been converted into one sac, it is impossible to restore the altered lung structure and a treatment to reheve the symp- toms and to prevent the further progress of the disease is indicated. In all cases treatment should be applied to correct any vertebrae or ribs of the upper dorsal region that may be displaced, and to raise and spread the ribs so that the lung structure may be better nourished and strength- ened and that the aeration of the blood will be more perfect. Treatment of the vagi nerves is important, as their physiological action on the lungs is to increase their movement. The general health of the patient is an important consideration and everything should be done to promote as healthy a condition as possible. The digestion should be carefully looked after and everything done to restore a normal state of the blood. A change of climate may prove beneficial. Strengthening the cardiac action will be of service in relieving any dropsical tendency that might occur on account of obstruction to the pulmonary circulation. If bronchitis or asthma occurs, their respective treatments are indicated. A general treatment of the splanchnic and lung vascular areas should be given to prevent any disturbance in the circulation which might cause congestion of the liver, congestion of the hemorrhoidal veins, or catarrh of the stomach and bowels. "Free evacuation of the bowels and measures to reUeve any flatulent distention are very needful in cases of emphysema to take off from the diaphragm any pressure from below, and to allow it to descend as freely as possible. With this view also the food should be concentrated, nour- ishing, and not bulkJ^"^ It is a good plan to instruct the nurse or attendant to aid inspira- tion by raising the arms strongly above the head during inspiration and to compress the chest during expiration so as to coincide with natural breathing, which will render the aeration of the blood greater and in- crease the elasticity of the vesicles. 1. Yeo — A Manual of Medical Treatment or Clinical Therapeutics, Vol. 1, p. 597. The Practice of Osteopathy 597 Acute Lobar Pneumonia (Croupous Pneumonia) This is an acute, infectious disease wherein various vertebral, rib and muscular lesions predispose to a lowered nutritive state of the paren- chyma of the lung, permitting the invasion of the diplococcus pneumoniae, with consequent local inflammation and pronounced constitutional dis- turbances, chill, extreme prostration and fever, which terminates abrupt- ly by crisis. Secondary infective processes are frequent. In describing a typical case of pneumonia it is considered as a self- hmiting disease. By osteopathic treatment it is often aborted or, at least, its course much shortened. In such a case it is not typical pneu- monia and could not be described as such. Osteopathic Etiology and Patliology. — Pneumonia occurs more often in the young up to the sixth year and in the aged. It is more fre- quent during the winter and spring months. "Colds," exposure and wetting are predisposing influences that lower resistance. Climate exerts Httle predisposing influence. Males are, on the whole, more fre- quently attacked. Pneumonia may follow injuries of the chest. Var- ious derangements of the ribs and vertebrae are always found in pneu- monia; such derangements correspond with the regions of vasomotor, motor and trophic fibers of the lungs, viz., second to seventh dorsal, in- clusive, and the upper cervical vertebrae, the latter region affecting the vagi. The muscles of the chest region are always severely contracted. These various disorders produce a lowered vitality of the bronchial and lung tissues, thus favoring the existence of the micrococcus lanceolatus. Unhj^gienic surroundings, alcohohsm, any or all habits that tend to de- press the nervous system, or lowered vitality from some pre-existent dis- ease, Hke diabetes, Bright's disease, organic heart affection or one of the infectious fevers, favor its development. One attack undoubtedly^ predisposes to another and repeated attacks may occur in the same in- dividual. The exciting cause is the invasion of the lung by pathogenic bacteria, especially by diploccocus pneumoniae. Pneumococci are fre- quently found in the throat and mouth of the healthy. Pathologically, the lung in croupous pneumonia exhibits three distinct stages — congestion, red hepatization and gray hepatization. In th(> stage of engorgement the tissue is red in color, firm and solid and less crepitant than the healthy lung. The cut surface is bathed in blood and stained scrum. Microscopic examination shows the capillaries to 1)0 dilated and tortuous. The alveolai- c'liitholiuni is swollen and the 598 The Practice of Osteopathy air cells filled with a variable number of red corpuscles, detached alveolar cells and a few leucocytes. During the stage of red hepatization the tissue is solid. It is reddish brown in color and of a dry, mottled ap- pearance. It is very friable and does not crepitate, as the affected por- tion is airless. Its weight and specific gravity are increased so that it sinks in water. The torn surface presents a granular appearance, there being fibrinous plugs in the air cells. On microscopic examination the air spaces are found filled with coagulated fibrin. The tissue contains red blood corpuscles and pus cells and the walls of the air cells are infil- trated. In sections properly treated the diplococcus is detected, and in some cases also the streptococcus and staphylococcus. In the stage of gray hepatization, the lung is still dense and heavy, but the surface is moister and softer, while the lung tissue is even more friable and the red color gives place to a mottled gray. The exudate loses its granular character and a yellowish white purulent liquid flows from a cut sur- face. Microscopically, the air cells are filled with leucocytes, while the red corpuscles and fibrin filaments have disappeared. The stage of gray hepatization is the stage of beginning resolution. The exudate is softened. The cell elements are disintegrated and absorbed by the lymphatics and largely eliminated through the kidneys. In unfavor- able cases the consolidated lung may become infiltrated with pus, and abscesses occur. In some instances the tissue is gangrenous, or it may become the seat of fibroid induration. These, however, are rare. Symptoms. — The disease begins abruptly, usually with a severe chill, lasting from half an hour to an hour, the fever rising rapidly. There is a sharp pain in the side, the skin becomes harsh and dry, the face is flushed, the eyes are bright and the expression anxious. A short, dry, painful cough soon develops. The expectoration presents a character- istic, rusty or blood tinged appearance and is extremely tenacious. The temperature rises rapidly, frequently to 104 or 105 degrees F., and con- tinues high for from five to ten days and generally terminates by crisis. The pulse is full, but the pulse-respiration ratio is not maintained. There is marked dyspnea, the respirations ranging from forty to fifty per min- ute. There are many fine rales. Headache, gastro-intestinal disturb- ances, sleeplessness, epistaxis, rarely dehrium except in drunkards, may also be present. The symptoms given are those of a typical case of pneumonia, but all are subject to modification. The onset may be gradual and the chill absent. In all cases, and especially drunkards, the temperature may not be high, while the pulse is often feeble and rapid instead of full and The Practice of Osteopathy 599 strong, and the physical signs may not make their appearance until the second or third day. Special Symptoms. — The fever rises abruptly in the initial chill, the temperature reaching 104 or 105 degrees F., and is continuous with a variation of a degree or two. The fever terminates by crisis after hav- ing continued from five to nine days. The temperature commonly falls during the night and is accompanied by a profuse perspiration. The temperature may fall from five to eight degrees in eight to twelve hours. There is a wide range here depending upon promptness and skillfulness of treatment, the reaction of the tissues, and previous health. Early treatment is invaluable in modifying the course of the disease. The sputum at first is mucoid and frothy. About the second day it becomes of a characteristic color, quite copious and consisting of a frothy, fluid mucus, containing small viscid masses. It is very viscid and glutinous, in some cases almost from the onset. In old and prev- iously weak persons, there may be no expectoration. Under the micro- scope the sputum is seen to contain red blood-corpuscles, leucocytes, alveolar epithehum, the micrococcus lanceolatus as well as other micro- organisms, pus corpuscles and small fibrinous casts. A stabbing pain is a common early symptom, as well as a dry, short cougli. The urine is febrile, scanty and high-colored. Urea and uric acid are increased. A trace of albumin is often present, and there may be symptoms of acute nephritis. Herpes is common. The naso-labial herpes appear from the second to the fifth day, and they may occur upon the cheek, genitals and also upon mucosa of the tongue. It is supposed to indicate a fav- orable prognosis. There is redness of the cheek, usually on the affected side. The mucous membrane of the mouth is dry. The tongue is white and furred. Anorexia and thirst are present. The patient is usually constipated, but diarrhea may occur. Vomiting is common. The spleen is usually enlarged, but the liver is not perceptibly increased in size, unless there is extreme engorgement of the right heart. The pulse is bounding. The average pulse-rate is from 100 to 108 per minute. In consohdation the left ventricle receives a lessened amount of blood and the pulse may become small. In the aged and debihtated, a small, weak and rapid pulse may be present. The lieart sounds are loud and clear, and in favorable cases the pulmonary second sound is accentu- ated, owing to the increased tension in the pulmonary vessels. Upon distension of the right side of the heart and partial failure of the right ventricle, the second sound becomes less distinct which is a very unfav- orable symptom, for very much depends upon the strength of the I'ight GOO The Practice of Osteopathy ventricle in pneumonia. The blood usually exhibits leucocytosis which disappears with the crisis. In malignant pneumonia this is absent and its continued absence is an unfavorable sign. The proportion of fibrin is also greatly increased. The diplococci can rarely be seen. Head- ache is common as an initial symptom and may be persistent. The disease is often ushered in by convulsions, especially in children; con- sciousness is usually retained throughout the whole attack, even in se- vere cases, though in some cases there is delirium. In drunkards delir- ium tremens may be present from the onset. In these cases the pa- tient often wanders about until the prehminary excitement gives way to coma. Physical Signs. — Stage of Congestion.— Diminished expansion, the movements of the affected side are defective, the face is flushed and the patient lies on the affected side. Tactile fremitus is slightly in- creased. There may be tympany over the involved area from dimin- ished intrapulmonary tension. In the latter part of this stage there is impairment of resonance. Fine crepitant rales are heard at the end of forced inspiration. Great care has to be taken in examination when there is deep seated consolidation. Stage of Red Hepatization. — The breathing is markedly ab- normal. Very Httle or no expansive motion of the chest over the affected region. Vocal fremitus is markedly exaggerated. The skin is hot and dry and the pulse frequent. Dullness over the affected parts with an increased sense of resistance is present. There is high-pitched, pro- longed, bronchial breathing when the lung becomes solidified. When the larger bronchi are completely filled with exudate, tubular breathing is absent. Crepitant rales may also be heard. Stage of Gray Hepatization. — Largely the same physical signs are repeated in this stage as in the second. The normal manner of breath- ing returns, as does also the normal expansive movement of the affected side. Crepitant rales reappear. The temperature of the skin is lessened, breathing changes from bronchial to vesicular and bronchial resonance continues for some time. Complications. — Pleurisy is the most frequent complication. Pneumonia on one side and pleurisy on the other is possible. The pain is more acute and localized. The respiration is greatly affected and the usual signs of effusion are present. Empyema may be a complication. Pericarditis is more common in the pneumonia of children. Though usually plastic it may be sero-fibrinous, but rarely the fluid is purulent. There is increased dyspnea, the pulse becomes weaker, and the heart The Practice of Osteopathy 601 sounds are gradually suppressed. Endocarditis is a comparatively frequent complication. It is more liable to attack patients with old valvular disease and to affect the left heart. The physical signs are sometimes absent and even when present are liable to be very deceptive. It may, however, be suspected in cases where the fever is protracted; when septic manifestations, such as chills, sweats or irregular tempera- ture, develop ; when emboHc symptoms appear, or when a rough, diastohc murmur develops. Meningitis is a compHcation that comes on at the height of the fever. This comphcation is rarely recognized unless the basilar meninges are involved. It is frequently associated with ulcer- ated endocarditis. Cerebral emboHsm causing hemiplegia has been ob- served. Other possible compHcations are neuritis, arthritis, nephritis, parotitis and various digestive disorders. Diagnosis. — A typical case of pneumonia is easily recognized. The abrupt onset with rigor, the rapidly developed fever, the sputum, physical signs and abnormal pulse-respiration ratio, as a rule make the diagnosis easy. Frequent examination of the lungs should be made in Bright's disease, diabetes, organic affections of the heart, cancer and al- coholism, as all these affections are hable to become compHcated with acute pneumonia. Pleurisy is often confounded with pneumonia. The resemblance between friction sounds and crepitant rales is often very close. In pleurisy vocal resonance and vocal fremitus are diminished; there is no "rusty" sputum; the percussion dullness may change with the posture of the patient, and the breathing is distant and weak. A typhoid state may be mistaken for typhoid fever. Hypostasis occurs late in typhoid fever while dullness sets in early in pneumonia. The history of the onset will be of aid, as pneumonia as a compHcation sets in late in the disease. The Widal test will be of value. Acute phthisis may begin with a chill and may resemble pneumonia very closely, es- pecially the physical signs. Examination of the sputum will show the bacilli of tuberculosis. The X-ray will often be of aid as a diagnostic measure. Prognosis. — This largely depends upon the previous health of the patient. At the extremes of life the prognosis is much more unfavorable. It is especiall}^ fatal in drunkards. By competent osteopathic treat- ment the mortality rate may be materially lessened and this disease, dreaded by both physician and patient, need not seem so fearful. The death rate from pneumonia during the past few years has been appalling. In New York and Chicago nearly one-eighth of the deaths the year around are due to pneumonia, and during certain months of the year twenty-sev- 602 The Practice of Osteopathy en or eight per cent, of all deaths are due to this disease. Drug medica tion is notoriously unreliable, the most competent physicians freel}" ad- mitting that they are practically powerless to stay the ravages. Given a patient with a fair constitution, osteopathic treatment will offer reason- able hope to the sufferer. There is no question that osteopathy merits much commendation in the treatment of pneumonia. Many severe cases have been cured and many more have undoubtedly been aborted. The treatment is directly applicable and specifically indicated, and coup- led with good nursing and hygiene, the mortaUty rate of the old schools is being markedly lessened. Treatment. — -The treatment of pneumonia must be both consti- tutional and local. By this is meant that the systemic strength and vigor must be maintained in addition to treatment of the chief lesion of the disease, which is located in the lungs. During the various stages of the disease, the treatment should be directed to the nerves of direct innervation that control the capillaries, and to the vasomotor nerves of the pulmonary circulation, in order that the hyperemic and inflamed state of the pulmonarj^ capillaries and ad- jacent tissues may be lessened and the circulatory system equalized. The disordered tissues that should be corrected in order that the centers of the spinal cord and the nerves that influence the function and structure of the lungs may be relieved, are: contraction of the thoracic and dorsal muscles, subluxations of the ribs and dorsal vertebra? from the second to the seventh, inclusive, and the upper cervical vertebra that may be- come disordered and impinge upon the vagi nerves. However, owing to the fact that the vasomotors are not especially abundant here, all increased chest mobility and deep breathing and abdominal aid will materially assist the circulation. Also, carefully treat the middle and inferior cervical regions for the lymphatics of the lungs. Each of these regions should be carefully examined and thoroughly treated whenever found involved. The specific micro-organisms that influence the course of pneumonia are naturally very important factors; but observing and improving the general health, and establishing an unobstructed circula- tion through the diseased lung tissues will hasten the crisis by favoring a rapid formation of antidotal substances to neutralize the poisonous sub- stance produced by the micrococcus lanceolatus. Healthy tissues, which occur only where there is uninterrupted freedom of vascular supply and nerve force, are obtained by correction of any and all anatomical disor- ders. This will rapidly decrease any lethal tendency'' in the patient and often abort the disorder so that all that is needed is sufficient time for The Practice of Osteopathy 603 nature to heal the diseased tissues. The principal predisposing cause of many specific diseases, is some disorder of the anatomical tissues that interferes with normal physiological functions; and the determining of the different types of disease is often due to the location of the lesion and the character of the micro-organism involved in each disease. What is necessary in many cases is a correction of the mechanical predisposing condition and the exciting and determining influences will be rendered inactive. The importance of close attention to both vagi can not be overesti- mated. Any obstruction above or below the origin of the superior laryn- geal nerve is followed by loss of motor power of the lungs, thus causing difiicult and labored breathing. The lungs become surcharged with blood, because the air pressure in the lungs is low and the thorax is dis- tended. This condition is followed by serous exudation. Thus ob- struction of the vagi may be one factor in the cause of pneumonia. Ob- struction of the vagi below the origin of the recurrent laryngeal nerves affects the lower and middle lobes of the lungs, and produces also a ca- tarrhal inflammation of the upper lobes. The recurrent laryngeal nerves may be obstructed by dilatation of the aorta or subclavian artery as they wind about them; also b}^ dislocations of the first and second ribs, which may affect the nerves not only directly, but by causing an obstruction to the subclavian vessels with a consequent disturbance of the aorta and the heart. The recurrent laryngeal nerves may be treated directly at the inner lower part of the sternomastoid. One of the chief objects of the treatment should be to prevent heart failure and to lessen the pulse-respiration ratio. The average pulse-rate in typical cases is from 100 to 110 per minute and when it exceeds this to any extent, say 120, there is cause for alarm. At first the pulse is full and bounding, later it is small on account of a lessened amount of blood reaching the left ventricle and systemic circulation, owing to the ex- tensive consoHdation. In treating heart failure particular attention should be paid to the condition of the ribs on the left side over the region of the heart, the second to the fifth, inclusive. A correction of any dis- turbance to the inhibitory nerves of the heart, (the vagi) and the accel- erator fibers of the heart (the cervical sympathetic) should be made. This means close attention to probable derangements of the vertebrae from atlas to first dorsal. General treatment of the entire system will reheve the heart of some work and favor an equahzation of the vascular system. Also by the use of hydrotherapy the maintenance of the heart's action may be accomplished. Cold compresses, and not warm ones, 604 The Practice of Osteopathy should be used, as the latter relax the vessel walls, producing more or less paresis of the vessels, while the former stimulate the vaso-dilators, producing dilatation and tone of the vessels, thereby causing a vigorous increase in the flow of blood. This reheves the heart bj^ increasing the cutaneous circulation, besides increasing arterial tension. The right heart is indirectl}^ aided by the increase of the tension in the general vascular system, and the vessels of the pulmonary circulation have more force expended upon them and a greater contraction of their vessels occurs on account of the dilatation of the cutaneous vessels. The tem- perature of the water used should be 60 degrees F., and the compress applied for thirty minutes or as long as necessary. Attention to the abdominal area and diaphragm will have a definite effect upon the circulation and ehmination. It is beneficial in its in- fluence upon lungs and heart and in combatting toxemia. Carefully graduated deep breathing is of distinct benefit. In addition to the fever treatment in the cervical and dorsal re- gions, the gradually cooled tub-bath will be of aid. The temperature at first should be ninety degrees F. and then gradually cooled to eighty degrees F. The duration should not be over ten or fifteen minutes. Care should be taken that the patienl does not exert himself. He should be lifted in and out of the baths. These baths also have a marked effect upon the respiratory and nervous centers. The ice-bag over the chest and spine has a beneficial influence; still, with feeble children be exceed- ingly careful when applying or using cold methods. During all stages of the disease, the best possible care should be taken of the patient. See the patient frequently, probably twice a day or oftener. Each time thoroughly relax the dorsal muscles and re-adjust the ribs, for as every osteopath of experience will note (and Dr. Still particularly emphasizes) the contracted muscles frequently and con- tinually displace the ribs. The treatment should not be prolonged to a point of overfatigue, but a definite reaction of tissues should be secured but no further. Carefully raise all the ribs and moderately hyperextend the spine. Release the cervical, pectoral and axillary lymphatics, and stimulate spleen and fiver. Experience has shown that the first treatment is of the greatest im- portance and if the osteopath will control the predominant symptoms at that time the result will be much simplified. For that reason it is best not to leave the patient until the chest pain, fever, high pulse or what- ever may be present, are well in hand, although it may mean a long visit The Practice op Osteopathy 605 with fairly frequent treatments. Treat the conditions existing and wait; then treat again and the result will more than repay. There is always more than a chance of aborting the disease, but the first treat- ment is often the crucial test. F. E. Moore and many others report numerous cases treated without a fatahty and the average duration of the disease not exceeding five days. The apartment should be well aired and a temperature of 65 degrees F. maintained. In the very young the temperature should be higher. The diet is exceedingly important. Give a liquid, light and nutritious one, a milk diet being preferable. Otherwise give meat juice, broths, egg albumin and whey. Avoid starchy and saccharine foods, and give plenty of water. Good nursing and com- plete rest of body and mind, with careful attention to the activity of the bowels, kidneys and skin, will indirectly aid the clogged up lung fascia to perform its function and hasten an early recovery from the disease. In epidemic forms be particularly vigilant in the employment of anti- septics. Bronchopneumonia (Catarrhal Pneumonia) Definition. — An inflammation of the minute bronchi and air ves- icles. The affection begins with an inflammation of the capillary bron- chi, which extends to the air vesicles. The micrococcus lanceolatus, streptococcus pyogenes, influenza bacillus, and staphylococcus aureus et albus are the principal exciting microorganisms. Osteopathic Etiology and Pathology. — The disease is most prevalent among the very young and the old, and may be either pri- mary or secondary. It may occur as a sequence or in association with measles, diphtheria, whooping cough and scarlet fever. Exposure to cold, impure air, rickets and diarrhea are marked predisposing causes in children. In the old, debilitating affections and chronic diseases are predisposing causes. Bronchopneumonia occurs sometimes as a com- plication in smallpox, erysipelas, typhoid fever and influenza. The principal lesions found upon examination are subdislocated ribs affecting the pulmonary vasomotor nerves. The third, fourth and fifth ribs are especially apt to be subdislocated. The muscles throughout the tho- racic region are generally severely contracted. Another group of cases, the so-called aspiration or deglutition pneumonia, are caused by the inhalation of food particles or other substances. A lessened sensitiveness of the larynx (as in comatose states) may allow small particles of food to reach the smaller bronchi 60G The Peactice of Osteopathy and produce inflammation, which may even cause suppm-ation and some- times gangrene. Cases are Hable to occur after operations about the nose and mouth. It is often secondary to carcinoma of the larynx and esophagus and after tracheotomy and glosso-pharyngeal palsy. A ser- ious form of bronchopneumonia is caused by the tubercle bacillus. Pathologically, both lungs are usuall}^ involved and become heavy. On the pleural surfaces, especially at the base, sunken purphsh or slaty patches are noticed, representing collapsed lung tissue. On section small, projecting portions of consolidation are seen, separated from each other by uninflamed and collapsed tissue. The section of lung tissue is of a dark reddish color. The terminal bronclii are filled with tenacious, puru- lent matei'ial. Microscopically, the terminal bronchi and air cells are filled with a plug of exudation composed of leucocjrtes and desquamated epithelium. The walls of the bronchi are swollen and contain many leucoc}^es. Symptoms. — The symptoms are frequently marked by those of the primary affection. The onset may be either abrupt or gradual. The child becomes feverish; there is increased frequency in respiration and there is an aggravated cough. The temperature rises to 102 or 104 de- grees F.; respiration may rise as high as 60 or 80. The cough is hard, distressing, frequently painful and accompanied by a mucopurulent ex- pectoration. The pulse is greatl}^ accelerated — 120 to 180 per minute. As the disease advances, signs of deficient aeration of the blood are no- ticed. At first there is a pale and anxious expression of the face, the lips are blue and the child makes strenuous efforts to breathe. The blood soon becomes highly charged with carbon dioxide and, by its be- numbing influence upon the nerve centers, sensibiHty is reduced and the cough and suffering subside. The face becomes Uvid and death may occur within twenty-four hours from paralysis of the heart. At the beginning of the attack dullness is absent and subcrepitant and sibilant rales are present. Areas of consolidation soon become manifested. There is shght impairment of resonance and the breath- ing is harsh. Upon inspection there is, in grave cases, retraction of the sternum due to defective expansion. Diagnosis. — This is usually eas}', developing as it generally does in the course or at the conclusion of another disease, with a gradual onset as a rule, and irregular fever and a long duration, besides usually occur- ring in children under five. If the areas of consohdation are large, in- volving the greater part of a lobe, it is sometimes very difficult to distin- guish bronchial pneumonia from lobar pneumonia. Lobar pneumonia. The Practice of Osteopathy 607 when occurring in children, is usually between the ages of five and fif- teen. The onset is abrupt in a child of good health; it resolves rapidly; there is rusty colored sputum and continued fever falHng by crisis. Tu- berculous bronchopneumonia is very hard to differentiate from simple bronchopneumonia. A great many cases can be correctly diag- nosed only after the lapse of considerable time. The presence of signs of softening, considerable disease of the apices, and examination of the sputum, or in the case of a child, of the vomited matter, would diagnose this form. If elastic fibers and tubercle bacilli are found in the sputum or vomited matter, the diagnosis is at once decided in favor of tuber- culous bronchopneumonia. X-ray diagnosis should be considered. Prognosis. — The prognosis depends on the cause. In children that are previously weak and debilitated the disease is very fatal. When the disease follows measles and whooping cough, the fatality is not so great. In adults the prognosis is about the same as in the croupous form. The deglutition variety is apt to be fatal. Treatment. — A great deal can be done to prevent the disease, by careful attention to debihtated children in keeping them warm and pro- tected at all times. There is usually a preexisting bronchitis. In meas- les and whooping cough and during convalescence, the child should be well taken care of. A thorough, persistent treatment, but not to a point of overfatigue, of the dorsal vasomotor nerves posteriorly should be given. Gentle work over the cervical and ^axillary lymphatics to free the edematous barrier, correction of the tensed scaleni and deranged first ribs and clav- icles, and stimulation of spleen and liver, with sufficient general treat- ment to start reaction, will be effective. Derangements to the third, fourth and fifth dorsal nerves are most likely to be found; the principal vasomotor innervation to the bronchials and air vesicles is from this region. Treatment over the chest anteriorly is of great aid, especially an upward and outward manipulation to release the ribs should be given. Attention should be given the vagi nerves to increase the activity of the lungs as well as for the effect gained upon the circular fibers of the bron- chi. Care should be taken, that the first rib is not impinging upon the first thoracic ganglion, or interfering with lymphatic drainage. Ice-bags over the chest are helpful. The chest should be protected from changes in temperature by a jacket of cotton batting. The diet should consist of milk, egg albumin and broths. Keep the temperature at about 70 degrees F. and the air of the room moist and free from draughts. When the fever is high, sponging or the wet pack is helpful. 608 The Practice of Osteopathy The bowels from the beginning of the attack should be carefully watched. There is danger of a failing heart: this is generally associated with mucous rales and cyanosis. Douching alternately with hot and cold water will usually excite coughing and overcome the difficulty. The gradually cooled bath will have a marked effect in reducing the tempera- ture, quieting the nervous symptoms, increasing the respiratory power and promoting sleep. Raise and carefully stimulate the abdominal viscera, and elevate the diaphragm. This is effective in both cyanosis and toxemia. In the first stage of pneumonia, Hazzard^ says, "There is better opportunity to correct the specific lesion, as the patient's strength will allow of such treatment. The work is also aided by the fact that the alveoli are still open, and lung action, stimulated b}- treatment, may become a valuable aid in dispelung the engorgement." This is a most valuable suggestion, but be exceedingly careful in subsequent treatments not to treat too hard and thus lame and bruise the patient. Series I, II, III, and V of the American Osteopathic Association Case Reports present several interesting cases of pneumonia which typ- if}^ the importance of immediate and direct correction of the osteopathic lesions. Herman" cites an interesting case of delayed resolution, due to a de- pressed condition of all the ribs on the affected side with marked luxation of the eighth. The lesion at the eighth was the cause of a prolonged at- tack of hiccoughs which prevented resolution. It is pointed out that there is an abundant intercostal nerve supply to the diaphragm from the eighth and ninth intercostals. C. E. Achorn instances an autopsy of patient dying of pneumonia, where a bony ankylosis was found at the second dorsal; this lesion was probably an important predisposing factor. Broadly speaking, one should keep in mind the following: First, early treatment will frequently abort what would ultimately be pneu- monia — still, in the preceding it is not these cases that are especially re- ferred to, but those following the course of a typical pneumonic process; second, both specific and general treatment prior to the crisis will mater- ially lessen the severity of the disease; third, the crisis corresponds to beginning resolution (during resolution expectoration and Uquefaction and absorption of the exudate are paramount features) and must be met promptly and vigorously, special attention being paid to the heart ; and, 1. Hazzard^Practice of Osteopathy p. 91. 2. Herman — An Unusual Feature in a Case of Pneumonia — Journal of the American Osteopathic Association, July 1906. (This refers to lobar pneumonia.) The Practice of Osteopathy 609 fourth, during convalescence, good, general attention and care of patient as to treatment, hygiene, diet, and climate, are important. Chronic Interstitial Pneumonia (Fibroid Induration) Definition. — A chronic, inflammatory disease of the lungs, char- acterized by an overgrowth of fibrous or connective tissue. Etiology. — With few exceptions chronic affections of the lungs cause more or less fibroid overgrowth. Tliis is especially frequent after bronchial pneumonia and pulmonary tuberculosis. It is also excited by abscesses, hydatids, sj^phihs, emphysema, sarcoma and old fibrinous pleurisy. It may also be caused by compression, by aneurism or neo- plasms. It may arise as a primary affection, due to the inhalation of irritating dusts (stone dust, coal dust and metal dust). There will be found deeply seated osseous lesions of the upper and middle dorsal region and corresponding ribs, and frequently of the cervical vertebrae. Pathologically, as it involves limited or extensive areas, it is recog- nized as local or diffuse. It is a unilateral affection. The involved por- tion is shrunken and on section it is found to be tough, firm, of a green- ish color and containing an overgrowth of fibrous tissue. If it affects the left side the heart may be displaced. The unaffected lung is usually enlarged (compensatory emphysema). There is hypertrophy of the right ventricle of the heart. Symptoms. — There is a chronic cough, which varies greatly in its severity; moderate dyspnea, and a variable expectoration. There is no fever and the general health of the patient vasiy be preserved for a number of years. The expectoration is generally copious, muco- or sero- purulent, rarely fetid. There is retraction of the affected side, displace- ment of the apex beat and lateral curvature of the spinal column. The unaffected side is enlarged. The intercostal spaces disappear, the ribs sometimes even overlapping. The tactile fremitus is generally increased, but if the pleural membrane is thickened the fremitus may be decreased. There is generally impairment of resonance. A tympanitic or amphoric note may be heard over a dilated bronchus. On the sound side the percussion note is generally hj^per-resonant. The breathing sounds may be feeble. They may be bronchial or cavernous, but rather amphoric. Late in the disease cardiac murmurs are not uncommon. Diagnosis. — This is never difficult. It is mainly to be distinguished from fibroid phthisis. In the latter both lungs are involved and there 610 The Practice of Osteopathy is fever and bacilli are found in the sputum. An X-ray examination should be made. Prognosis. — The disease is exceedingly chronic and may last for many years. Death may result from gradual failure of the right heart, hemorrhage or from intercurrent attacks of acute pneumonia involving the other lung. Treatment. — Little can be done for this condition. Intercurrent bronchitis ma}^ be somewhat relieved by the treatment for chronic bron- chitis. The patient should dwell in a mild climate. Hygienic surround- ings and nutritious food are indicated. Something can be done by at- tempting to correct the condition of the ribs and vertebra?, but this measure, from the nature of the disease, is generally palhative at best. Congestion of the Lungs Congestion of the lungs may be active, passive or hypostatic. The two former have particular osteopathic significance, owing to the lesions involved. Active congestion may result from violent physical exertion, ex- cessive alcoholic indulgence, inhalation of hot air or as a symptom in pneumonia and other pulmonary affections. There is dyspnea and cough with rusty expectoration of a frothy nature. There may be ab- sence of fever. But generally a shght chill followed by moderate fever, pain in side, and cough are the principal sjnnptoms. On percussion, the note is dull with increased tactile fremitus and bilateral involvement. Prognosis is good under osteopathic treatment, but it must be promptly met as it is usually a symptom of another disease. Treatment is the same as in the beginning of pneumonia. Passive congestion, when not hj-postatic, is mechanical and due to an impeded return of blood to the left heart from mitral stenosis, or regurgitation, dilatation of the right ventricle and cerebral disease. The lungs are large with distended puknonary vessels with venous blood in the air spaces. There is dj^spnea and cough, with blood-streaked, frothj^ expectorations. The treatment is primarily of the condition causing the conges- tion, but in addition the upper ribs should be raised and thorough treat- ment of the abdomen and elevating the diaphragm are beneficial. Hypostatic congestion results from a weakened heart in exhaus- tion, infection or old age; also from continued dorsal decubitus. Rheu- matic fever, tuberculosis and other constitutional diseases, as well as or- ganic growths, may predispose. The condition gives rise to a mild form The Practice of Osteopathy 611 of lobar pneumonia. Symptoms are not well defined and often are not recognized. There may be slight dullness, increased fremitus, moist rales and other signs of a venous engorgement. In treatment the first move is to change position of the patient and then look after any underl3dng cause. Osteopathically, follow treat- ment of pneumonia. In all cases of circulatory involvement of the lungs, treatment to relax muscles or to adjust vertebrae and rib lesions to the vasomotor nerves of the lungs is very efficacious. Landois (1904) says: "Irritation of sensory nerves, particularly if intense and long continued, causes a dilatation of the vessels in the areas innervated by them." Edema of the Lungs There are two forms of edema, collateral and general, which follow an intense congestion with transudation of serum into the air vesicles and interstitial tissue. The collateral form is locaHzed and usually appears in connection with pneumonia, pulmonary infarction or abscess. In general edema the base of the lung is involved to a greater extent, but the whole structure is affected and hydrothorax is generally present. The cause of edema is not well understood, but may result from a long Hne of constitutional diseases. The symptoms are dyspnea, cough with copious, blood-streaked sputum which is expelled with difficulty. There may be fever in the inflammatory type with weak, increased pulse. Dull- ness over the affected area, bronchovesicular breathing and small liquid rales are audible. The diagnosis must largely be made upon the bi- lateral dullness at the base of each lung and physical signs noted above. X-ray examination will usually be of value. Prognosis depends on the condition causing the edema and treatment should be directed to cor- recting it. Frequently edema is a terminal affection. This should be followed by osteopathic treatment to free the lungs of the effusion as out- lined under pneumonia, especially relaxation of the upper dorsal and cer- vical muscles, separation of the upper ribs and stimulation of the heart. DISEASES OF THE PLEURA Pleurisy Definition. — An inflammation of one or both pleural membranes. Varieties. — Etiologically, it may be divided into primary and secondary pleurisy; also, into acute and chronic pleurisy. Anatom- ically, the cases may be divided into dry pleurisy and pleurisy with ef- fusion (sero-fibrinous, purulent, hemorrhagic) . 612 The Practice of Osteopathy Acute Pleurisy (Fibrinous or Plastic Pleurisy) The affection may be primary or secondary. As an independent affection it is rare. It may follow exposure to wet and cold or it may be due to mechanical injury. The disease may set in with pain in the side, slight fever and the friction sound of pleurisy may be present. These symptoms last a few days and then disappear and no exudation occurs. The pleural surfaces become more or less united. As a secondary process, dry plastic pleurisy arises from extension of the inflammation in acute or chronic diseases of the lung, especially pneumonia. Abscesses, gangrene and cancers are also causes. It some- times occurs in acute articular rheumatism, and in a large number of cases is associated with tuberculosis. This condition may be a com- phcation in chronic Bright's disease and in chronic alcohohsm. In the fibrinous form of pleurisy the serum is scant and the mem- brane is covered with a sheathing of Ijmiph, which finally organizes and adhesion takes place between the opposing surfaces. Serofibrinous Pleurisy This form is known as pleurisy with effusion. There is httle lymph, the exudate being mainly composed of serum. Osteopathic Etiology and Pathology. — Many cases rapidly fol- low exposure to cold, wet or an injury to the thorax. Exposure to cold is considered a mere predisposing agent, permitting the action of vario\is micro-organisms. The large majority of cases are due to tuberculous infection of the pleura. The osteopath finds that important predisposing causes of pleurisy are injury to the chest wall, ribs and vertebrse, and exposure to cold, causing contraction of the thoracic muscles. These injuries and strains throughout the chest result in an interference with the intercostal and phrenic nerves, and also with the intercostal and internal mammary arteries; consequently, there is produced a lowered vitality of the pleural tissues, which permits the attack of the micro-organisms. It may be secondary to rheumatism, Bright's disease, cancer and cirrhosis of the liver. Pathologically, there is an abundant exudation of serum. Fibrin is found on the pleura, and is rarely abundant in the serous fluid in the form of fioccuh. The fluid is straw colored as a rule. It varies greatly in quantity from one-half to four litres. Microscopically, there are The Practice of Osteopathy 613 found leucocytes, red blood-corpuscles, shreds of fibrin and occasionally cholesterin, uric acid and sugar. The composition of the fluid resembles blood serum, and is rich in albmiiin. Various displacements of the adjacent organs are caused by the effusion. The lung is more or less compressed into the back part of the pleural sac. The heart is displaced. The diaphragm may be crowded downward. On the right side this lowers the liver; on the left it dis- places the stomach, transverse colon and sometimes the spleen. Symptoms. — The onset maj^ be abrupt with a chill, severe pain in the side and fever. With few exceptions the disease comes on insid- iously, pain in the side being the first symptom. The pain is sharp and cutting and is aggravated by breathing or coughing. There is moderate fever, the temperature ranging from 102 to 103 degrees F. Dyspnea may be present at the onset. This is due to the fever and pleuritic pain. When the fluid is effused slowly, dyspnea may be absent except on ex- ertion. It is most marked when the effusion has developed rapidly. As the effusion accumulates and the inflamed surfaces separate, the pain diminishes and, as a rule, soon disappears. Physical Signs. — Immobihty and bulging of the affected side, de- pending on the amount of exudation. The intercostal spaces are obht- erated. The apex beat of the heart is displaced. Upon palpation the limited movement of the chest is more accurately determined. Tactile fremitus is largely diminished. The position of the heart's impulse can be readily located by palpation. Displacements of the liver and spleen can be felt through the abdominal walls. At first the percussion notes are impaired and later there is dullness which gradually rises as the fluid increases. The upper line of dullness is not horizontal when the patient is in the erect posture, but is higher behind than in front. Above the effusion in the sub-clavicular region, percussion gives a tympanitic note, the so-called Skoda's resonance. In moderate effusions the level of dullness often changes with the position of the patient. Early in the disease a friction rub can usually be heard. As the fluid accumulates, the breath sounds become weak, distant and may have a tubular or bron- chial quahty. Vocal resonance is usually lessened. There may be bronchophony, or it may manifest a nasal or metallic quality, resembling somewhat the bleating of a goat (Lsennec's egophony). X-ray examina- tion should be made. Duration. — The course is extremely variable. The fever is due to inflammation and may last for two or three weeks, when it may subside. The cough and pain disappear and the effusion, which is usually slight in 614 The Practice of Osteopathy these cases, may be absorbed quickly. In cases where the effusion is poured out rapidly it may be absorbed just as quickly. In cases where the effusion is poured out slowly or where the effusion reaches as high as the fourth rib, recovery is usually slower. Large effusions may per- sist without change for months and finally the case may become subacute or chronic. This is particularly true of tuberculous cases. Prognosis. — This depends largely upon the cause; on the whole, prognosis is favorable. Death is a rare termination of serofibrinous effusion; death may, however, occur suddenly without sufficient lesions to explain the cause. The exudate may become purulent. Treatment of Acute Pleurisy An early treatment and rest in bed with a liquid diet are the measures to be employed at the beginning of the attack. Pay particular atten- tion to any primary disease and to the general health. Rarely is there any difficulty in locating certain predisposing causes of the disturbance. Then often a rib or corresponding vertebra is badly subdislocated over the seat of the disease. The sympathetic and phrenic nerves are in- volved through the intercostal and phrenic nerves. A careful examina- tion of the side of the affected chest should be made, as there may be more or less obstruction of the intercostals and the internal mammary arteries from their branching of the aorta and subclavian vessels. A dislocation of the first or second rib may affect the subclavian vessels and their branches markedly ; although all the upper ribs and the thoracic muscles should be examined carefully for derangements which would affect these blood-vessels and produce an exudation. Ice-bags upon the chest, as in pneumonia, may be used. Limiting the movements of the chest with a bandage or adhesive strips will give considerable rehef . When the effusion has taken place, carefully raising and spreading the ribs with attention to special points of involvement, will at times cause absorption of the fluid. The daily amount of liquid food should be greatly lessened with a view of depleting the blood serum from var- ious tissues; thus the serum collecting in the pleura, which is a lymph space, will also be absorbed. Treatment of the bowels, kidneys and skin, so that they may be rendered active, will aid in the depletion of the blood serum. It may be necessary in some cases to aspirate, especially if other methods fail and if the effusion is large. The points of operation are in the mid-axillary line at the sixth interspace or at the angle of the scapula at the eighth interspace. In puncturing, the needle should be held close The Practice of Osteopathy 615 to the margin of the upper rib so as to avoid the intercostal artery. With- draw the fluid slowly and if faintness is produced, desist. Empyema should be treated surgically. Simply tapping is rarely sufiicient. A free incision, as in abscess, and thorough drainage should be made. Care must be taken that the drainage tube is large enough. " In cases of pleurisy the axilla and the inner arm may be tender and painful; this is due to the pleuritic inflammation being carried by the way of the 'nerve of Wrisburg.' ''The pleuritic pain in the costal muscles compels restricted move- ment of the ribs and also limits the respiratory function of the dia- phragm. These painful cramps and stitches are independent of the pain arising alone from the inflamed pleural surface, and the diminution of the respiratory movements is due to a particularly contractured state of the muscles of the chest as is demonstrated by the fact that the pa- tient can not draw a long breath; hence one may reasonably conclude that natm*e has so distributed nerves to the pleura as to enable that serous membrane to control the muscles which create movements of the adjacent costal surfaces and thus insure its quietude during the stages of inflammation or repair. " (Ranney) . Chronic Pleurisy Definition. — Chronic inflammation of the pleural layers. There are two forms, exudative and dry or plastic pleurisies. Chronic Pleurisy with Effusion. — This may follow an acute sero- fibrinous type. Some cases develop very slowly. In most cases in children, the fluid changes to pus early in the disease. The fluid may re- main for months without changing to a purulent character. In such cases the character and physical signs do not differ from those in acute serofibrinous pleurisy. Chronic Dry Pleurisy. — These cases originate in two ways : First, this may succeed pleural effusion when the fluid portion of the exudate is absorbed and the pleural layers are opposed. They are separated only by fibrinous elements that become organized into firm con- nective tissue. This process goes on at the base, principal^, which, if it follows the acute form, produces but shght flattening, but if it suc- ceeds the chronic form or empyema, the extent of retraction and flat- tening ^vill be marked. Calcification may occur in these firm, fibrous membranes and occasionally little pouches of fluid are found between the false bands. 616 The Practice of Osteopathy Second, a large number of cases are dry from the onset. This con- dition msiy follow directly acute plastic pleurisy. It may be of tu- berculous origin or it may set in without any acute symptoms. No matter how shght the plastic exudate may be, it invariably tends to be- come organized, thus producing adhesion of the laj^ers. This is un- doubtedly the result when the pleurisy is primary or secondary. The adhesions are generally circumscribed. When the adhesions are of tuberculous origin they may be locally confined to one pleura or they may be bilateral. In these cases both the parietal and costal layers are thick- ened, and embodied in the thickened pleura are found firm fibrin masses and small tubercles. Occasionally, vasomotor sjTuptoms arise in chronic pleurisy, es- pecially in cases of tuberculous origin, and are probably due to the in- volvement of the first thoracic ganglion. These almost invariably mean that there is a displacement of the first, second, or third rib. Unilateral flushing or sweating of the face or dilatation of the pupil are frequentlj' noticeable. Symptoms. — Definite s3Tnptoms are rarely present. In some cases the physical signs are quite pronounced, while, on the other hand, they may be entirely negative. In mild cases there may be slight im- mobility of the affected side with feeble breath sounds. In other cases there may be very full chest expansion while the breath sounds are feeble. In a large number of instances the phj^sical signs are quite distinct. There is displacement of the viscera, retraction of the chest walls, curvature of the spinal column and dropping of the shoulders. There are feeble breathing and creaking, leathery friction sounds. Dullness is found at the base. Treatment. — The treatment of chronic pleurisy is largely that of acute pleuris.y. Gymnastic and methodical breathing exercises should be emploj-ed in helping to correct the thoracic walls. Care must be taken not to injure the chest and pleura if adhesions have formed. Sur- gical work maj^ be necessary in some cases. The vasomotor symptoms that are sometimes manifested in chronic pleurisj^ and are claimed to be due to involvement of the first thoracic ganghon, are an interesting feature to the osteopath. Such cases would probabl}^ present to the osteopath a marked lesion of the upper dorsal vertebrae or the second or third rib. These vasomotor symptoms are also found in pleurisj^ associated with tuberculosis of the apex of the lung. The Practice of Osteopathy 617 The osteopath frequently treats these cases and he should be cau- tious about over treating or straining the chest wall. The adhesions are persistent and often there is more or less pain, so care must be exercised when attempting to structurally readjust. Do not expect to completely relieve every case, but nevertheless there are few cases but that can be benefited. Occasionally the pain alone is due simply to pleurodynia. DISEASES OF THE URINARY SYSTEM Diseases ©f the Kidneys (Renal Hyperemia) Definition. — An increase in the amount of blood to the vessels of the kidney. It is active hyperemia when there is arterial congestion, passive hyperemia when there is venous congestion. Osteopathic Etiology and Pathology. — Active hyperemia may be caused by injuries to the renal splanchnics, especially the tenth to twelfth dorsal segments; injuries over and to the kidneys; exposure to cold when the body is very warm; poison given, as diuretics; eruptive fevers and pregnancy, or follow genito-urinary operations. Passive hyperemia may be caused by obstructive diseases of the general circu- lation, as chronic heart, lung and liver diseases, or by pressure on the renal veins by tumors, growths and the pregnant uterus. Thrombosis of the renal veins may produce passive hyperemia, but rarely. Pathologically, in active hyperemia the kidney is swollen and shghtly enlarged. Upon removal of the capsule, the kidney is found to be brown and mottled. On section the parts bleed freely, the Malpigh- ian bodies are distended, and microscopical examination shows a cloudy swelling of the renal epithelium. In passive hyperemia the kidney is swollen, hard, firm and of a bluish red color. Later there is an over- growth of connective tissue and some infiltration between the tubules. The Malpighian bodies occasionally become shriveled and the renal epithehum fatty. Symptoms. — In active hyperemia the urine is scanty, of high specific gravity and of high color, containing some albumin and casts. Pain is experienced over the loins, following the course of the ureters, and the bladder is irritable. There are headache, nausea and vomiting. When from infection, fever may be present. In passive hyperemia the symptoms are primarily those caused by the disease producing the disorder. There is weight over the loins and dropsy. The urine is diminished, of high specific gravity, highly col- ored, albuminous and occasionally shows a few hyaline casts. 618 The Practice of Osteopathy Prognosis. — Active hyperemia. — Usually favorable if it can be treated in time. If prolonged, acute nephritis may develop. Passive hyperemia. — Depends on the cause. If the disease is prolonged, it terminates in interstitial nephritis. Treatment. — Active hyperemia. — Absolute rest and thorough treatment to the renal splanchnics and treatment over the abdomen to the kidneys directly by carefully raising them. Adjust the lower ribs if found lesioned. Water should be drunk Uberally and the patient en- couraged to use vapor baths. Favorable hygienic surroundings, warmth and good food are indispensable. Warm applications over the loins are helpful. Passive hyperemia. — The treatment largely depends upon the cause, but too much importance cannot be given to the treating of the vasomotor fibers of the kidneys from the eighth dorsal to the first lum- bar. Textbooks state that the vasomotor fibers to the kidneys are from the ninth to the twelfth dorsal vertebrae, inclusive, but osteopathic ex- perience shows we can affect vasomotor fibers slightly higher. Treat- ment here has a distinct effect on the blood pressure within the glom- eruli. The renal epithelium is extremely sensitive to circulatory changes. Even the compression of a renal artery for only a few minutes causes marked disturbances. Hence any irritation or obstruction to the vaso- motor innervation of the renal blood-vessels may result in serious con- ditions. The superior cervical ganglion of the sympathetic and the sciatic center have important bearing on the secretions of the kidney, through vasomotor fibers. Due attention should be paid to the bowels, and the patient required to take plenty of rest and a light diet. Acute Parenchymatous Nephritis (Acute Bright's Disease) Dehnition. — An acute, inflammatory process affecting the epi- thelium of the uriniferous tubules and due to the action of cold or toxic agents upon the kidneys, as well as to injuries to the renal splanchnics; is characterized by certain nervous symptoms with fever, dropsy, and scanty and highly colored urine. This inflammation involves more or less the whole kidney. Osteopathic Etiology and Pathology. — This disease is caused by exposure to cold and wet while the body is warm and perspiring. Excessive use of alcohol may be a factor. May be caused also by in- fectious diseases, such as scarlet fever, diphtheria, measles, smallpox, acute tuberculosis and others; also by certain specific poisons which are The Pkactice of Osteopathy 619 eliminated by the kidneys, as turpentine, chlorate of potash, carbolic acid, phosphorus, ginger, cantharides and oil of mustard; also by preg- nancy, as this is supposed to compress the renal veins, or through toxic agents. Syphilis may be an underlying cause. Blows and injuries to the back at the tenth, eleventh and twelfth dorsals are frequently the cause. Lesions are found from the sixth dorsal to the fourth lumbar. The lower three ribs may be at fault, while the innominate and muscu- lar contractions have been found to be pathological factors. Lordosis may be a contributing cause. Loudon places considerable importance on cervical lesions and McConnell beheves vasomotor disturbance plays an important causative role in the disease. Pathologically, at times the kidney alteration may be so sUght as not to be recognizable by the naked eye, the appearance varying ac- cording to the stage and severity of the disease. The kidneys become enlarged, engorged and of a bright red color, and later have a mottled appearance; and when the capsule, which is non-adherent, is stripped off, the kidne}^ is found to be soft and inelastic. In most of the cases in which the disease is due to toxic agents brought to the kidney through the blood-vessels, the glomeruU suffer first. The epithelium of the glomeruH and tubules is the seat of cloudy swelUng and, in the later stages, of fatty change and hyaline degeneration. The tubules are clogged by altered cells, leucocytes and blood-corpuscles. In mild cases the interstitial tissue is simply inflamed, but in all cases it becomes more or less mixed with leucocytes and red blood-corpuscles. Osteopathic lesions produced upon animals in the region of the ninth to the twelfth dorsal, resulted in acute nephritis. The autopsy findings were distinctly typical. Symptoms. — The onset is usually sudden, with moderate fever, pain in the back in the lumbar region and over the kidneys and follow- ing the ureters. Nausea and vomiting may be present. Dropsy soon appears, beginning with slight swelling or puffiness in the face below the eyes, later showing itself in edema of the abdominal walls and extremities. Uremic symptoms may develop. The urine is characteristic; is dimin- ished in quantity and of high specific gravity; at first the sediment is copious and reddish brown in color, becoming less in amount and of high color. This sediment contains casts of the uriniferous tubules, free l)lood, epithelial cells, uric acid and urates. There are large quantities of albumin in the urine. The presence of albuminous matter in the urine, even in large quan- tities, is not sufficient evidence to warrant a diagnosis of Bi-ight's disease 620 The Practice of Osteopathy nor is the amount a guide as to the severity of the case, for grave condi- tions often show a slight amount (Loudon).^ Diagnosis. — The general symptoms may be very sUght, for the most severe cases may manifest shght edema of the feet, or there may be only the puffiness under the eyes and of the eyelids. In such cases the diag- nosis must depend upon examination of the urine. With previous his- tory, suddenness of the attack and character of the urine, ordinarily the diagnosis will be quite easy. Prognosis. — Although this disease is generally grave, the prognosis is favorable and the majority of cases recover under judicious treatment. Treatment. — Cases of acute nephritis require rest, quiet and warmth. Many cases recover under these conditions alone. It is abso- lutely necessary, however, that these conditions exist no matter what other treatment is used. A thorough treatment to the renal splanch- nics cannot be overestimated for it is here (tenth to twelfth dorsal, in- clusive) that a majority of the lesions producing acute nephritis occur. Besides correcting the vertebral and rib displacements in tliis region, a very effective treatment is to have the patient lie fiat upon the back and then the osteopath, reaching around the patient with the fingers of one hand on either side near the spines of the lower dorsal vertebree, raise the patient so that the entire body, except the shoulders and the feet, are hfted clear of the bed. Thus the treatment springs the spine anter- iorly and produces a m.arked effect upon the Iddneys through the renal vasomotor nerves. Occasionally lesions in the upper cervical region in- terfere with the normal activit}^ of the renal nerve fibers passing to the kidneys by way of the superior cervical ganghon of the sjrmpathetics. Another very effectual treatment for the kidneys is treating them through the abdomen by a careful pressure upon the kidneys through the abdomen on either side of the umbiUcus, thus lightly working each kid- ney outward and upward. Tliis treatment relaxes any tissues about the blood-vessels, nerves and lymphatics to and from the Iddneys that may be contracted and thus aids in establishing a normal activity of the in- volved organs. It also helps in i*elaxing tissues about the ureters and prevents the clogging up of the latter with debris. Bandel and Stearns report cases in which an impacted colon was an important factor in this particular. The above means have for their object the direct reUef of the con- gestion of the kidney. This is further aided by keeping the bowels active, which supplements the action of the kidneys, and by increasing 1. Journal of the American Osteopathic Association, Jul3% 1904. The Practice of Osteopathy 621 the activity of the skin. This also aids in reheving dropsical effusions. The hot pack, in which the patient is wrapped in a wet sheet and then covered by a number of blankets, is an exceedingly good method to re- lieve the kidneys of some of the work and lessen their congestion, be- sides arresting uremic intoxication. This can be repeated daily if neces- sary. Where there is dropsy and scanty urine, the indications are to in- crease the secreting action of the kidney; besides treatment through the renal splanchnics, which contain the vasomotor nerves of the kidneys, stimulating treatment to the vagi will help to increase the urinary se- cretion. Hot fomentations, placed directlj^ over the region of the renal splanchnics, is a valuable aid in cases which do not respond quickly to osteopathic stimulation. Treatment of the liver is important. Injec- tions of cold water into the intestines will tend to stimulate the secretion of the kidneys, but this should be used with the greatest caution ; in some cases tepid water would be better (see uremia). The diet of the patient with acute nephritis is important. Give food that is easy of digestion and which contains a minimum amount of nitrogen. The stomach is quite likely to be irritable, consequently food that is adapted to it should be selected. Milk and weak animal broths are undoubtedly the best foods. The return to a solid diet, especially of meat, should be very slow. Suitable adjuvants to the milk diet are rice and farinaceous preparations. Loudon^ recommends complete withdrawal of all foods for twenty-four to fortj^-eight hours and the re- ducing of nitrogenous foods to a minimum; a diet of milk and cream after the fast, followed by cereals and broths, then eggs and fish until albumin disappears from the urine. Alkahne mineral waters are useful to help maintain an alkaline urine, thus tending to withdraw exudates. The patient should be treated daily at first and later on every other day, for case reports show frequent treatments hasten recovery. For treatment of acute uremia in Bright's disease, see uremia. Complications should be treated as affections independent of the renal disorder. Chronic Parenchymatous Nephritis Dehnition. — A chronic inflammation of the Iddney, involving the epithelium, glomeruli and interstitial tissue, characterized by dropsy, increasing anemia, albuminous urine and acute uremia. Osteopathic Etiology and Pathology. — It may be the result of acute nephritis. It follows the same diseases as already mentioned in 1. .Journal of the American Osteopathic Association, Dec, 1904. 622 The Practice of Osteopathy acute nephritis. More often it follows the same diseases as already men- tioned in the acute form, syphilis, tuberculosis, purulent conditions, focal infections (streptococcus), alcohol, scarlatina and pregnancy con- tributing the greater number. It is more common in the male sex and in early adult life. Habitual exposure to cold and dampness; chronic lesions of the spine, chiefly in the lower dorsal region, are causative fac- tors. Pathologically, the large white or a yellowish white kidney is the most common kidney lesion. In this form the kidney is enlarged, often to twice its normal size, is smooth, and the capsule very thin. The tubes, on microscopic examination, are found to be choked with broken- down granulated epithehum and fibrinous casts. The capillaries show hyaline changes. The interstitial tissue is increased everywhere, but not to an extreme degree. Catarrhal swelling and hyperemia (to a slight degree) are found in the pelvis of the kidne^^ In the second stage — that of the small white kidney — there is a reduction in the size of the organ, due to the destruction of the renal epithelium and the contraction of the overgrown connective tissue. Some hold that this may be a primary, independent form and not always preceded by the large white kidney. The organ is pale in color, rough and granular, the capsule being thickened and somewhat adherent. There is an accumulation of fatty epithelium in the convoluted tubules, con- stituting marked areas of fatty degeneration and giving the organ a white or whitish yeUow appearance. It is this which gives the name of small granular fatty kidney to this form. There are extensive inter- stitial changes, degeneration of tubules and destruction of great numbers of the glomeruli. Chronic hemorrhagic nephritis is a variety associated with this stage. The organ is enlarged, and scattered throughout the cortex are found brown hemorrhagic foci due to hemorrhages into and about the tubes. Otherwise the changes are similar with those found in the first form. Symptoms. — It usually begins as a chronic affection and the symp- toms slowly become apparent. FaiHng health and loss of strength, dys- pepsia and anemia, waxy appearance with puffiness of the face, dropsy and increased arterial tension with hypertrophy of the left ventricle, gradually make their appearance. Uremic symptoms are common, while dropsy is marked and persistent. Vomiting and sometimes pro- fuse diarrhea occur; in fatal cases there is sometimes found to be ulcera- tion of the colon. The urine, as a rule, is diminished in quantity, is The Peactice of Osteopathy 623 often veiy scanty, although it is frequently normal in color and appear- ance. There is an abundance of albumin, heavy sediment, hyahne and granular tube casts, epithelium from the kidneys and pelvis, leuko- cytes and often red blood-corpuscles. If fatty degeneration takes place, there will be fatty casts and oil globules. In the later stages the urine is abundant, low specific gravity, considerable albumin, and manj^ casts. Diagnosis. — In the inflammatory stage, where there is enlargement of the kidney, extreme pallor, scanty urine, albumin, and tube casts, history of infections, pregnancy, or exposure to cold and wet, and lesions in the lower dorsal region, the diagnosis is clear. Prognosis. — Always give a guarded prognosis; relapses are frequent, but cases have been cured. There is alwaj^s a tendency for the sub- chronic forms to become chronic. Treatment. — The treatment requires persistent work, especially over the renal splanchnics, and strict attention on the part of the pa- tient to hygienic principles. The lower dorsal lesions are very apt to be refractory owing to extensive fibrotic changes of the deep muscles and capsular ligaments. But repeated effort will usuallj^ secure results. Care should be taken as to exposure to cold and overexertion. The qual- ity of the blood should be improved, as it is anemic and contains various toxic products. Strict attention should be paid to the diet. Iron is largely used for anemic conditions, but this principle we hold to be wrong. It is not more iron that is wanted, but an abihty of the system to assimi- late the iron which it has. Relative to diuretics von Noorden says: "It would be the greatest paradox to economize the renal work to the utmost in one direction (diet, sweating, etc.) and on the other hand ex- cite them to increased activity by means of the strongest stimulants we possess, (drugs). I regard such prescribing as radically wrong." The diet should be carefully selected and of minimum amount. The pure milk diet is undoubtedly the best. The use of meat seems to favor uremic convulsions. The digestive organs should be kept in as good condition as pos- sible, particular attention being paid to the liver and bowels. The use of suitable clothing is important; wool should be worn next to the body. The skin is a powerful adjuvant to kidney chmination, and the sup- pression of the action of the skin throws extra work on the kidneys. Possibl}'- stimulation of the lung function would aid in the elimination. Rest, '\\itli a |)roper amount of fr(>sl) air nnd out-door exercise, is essen- tial. 624 The Practice of Osteopathy In conditions calling for attention to the skin and bowels the treat- ment will be the same as in acute parenchjTQatous nephritis. There is a ganghon on each side of the umbilicus within a radius of an inch that sends fibers to the kidneys (Dr. Still). Just what is the function of these gangha is unknown. The treatment of the compHcations is independent of that for the renal trouble. For direct treatment to the kidneys see acute Bright's disease. Interstitial Nephritis Definition. — A chronic inflammation of the kidney in which there is reduction in its size due to an extensive destruction of the tubular sub- stance, with an overgrowth, and later a contraction, of the connective tissue elements. Cardio-vascular changes, arteriosclerosis and cardiac hypertrophy are usualh' associated. Osteopatliic Etiology and Patliology. — Osteopathic lesions to the renal splanchnics are important predisposing causes. The disease may follow parenchymatous nephritis; or it may be caused by a con- tinued passive congestion due to valvular heart disease. Gout; cystitis (often following gonorrhea), the inflammation extending up the ureters to the kidney; heredity; old age; long continued worry, anxiety or grief; chronic alcoholism, overeating; syphiHs; tuberculosis; focal infections, especially of streptococci; chronic mineral poisoning (as from lead), and al- terations in the renal ganghonic centers are causes. It chiefly occurs in males during middle hfe. Pathologically, both kidneys are involved (although one may be more affected than the other), and reduced in size, often to less than half their normal size. After removing the capsule, which is thickened and adherent, the surface is found to be uneven, or granular and containing small cysts. The kidney is hard, tough and resistant, the color varying from a darkish brown to a 3"ellowish gray. The cortical portion is es- pecially reduced in size. On microscopic examination, the connective tissue appears greatly increased; this contracts, compressing the tubules and blood-vessels, causing their destruction. There is general arterial sclerosis, and the left side of the heart is hypertrophied. There are frequent nasal and retinal hemorrhages, due to the brittleness of the arterial walls which predispose them to rupture; hence, apoplexy is a frequent termination. The ganglionic centers, being interfered with, undergo fatty degeneration and atrophy. There are marked retinal changes— retinitis, fatty degeneration of the retinal tissues and sclerosis of the nerve fiber lavers. The Peactice of Osteopathy 625 Symptoms. — The onset is insidious. In most cases the symptoms are latent. The general health is disturbed; there are frequent mic- turition, gastric disturbances, tense and bounding pulse, hypertrophy of the left ventricle, high blood pressure, disorders of vision, sleeplessness, headache, furred tongue, slight swelhng of the feet, dry skin, scurvy and shortness of breath. The urine is increased in quantity, of acid reaction, Hght in color, low specific gravity, with a small amount of albumin, a few hyahne casts, and some epithelial cells. There is increased thirst and the patient m.ay have to urinate two or three times during the night. There is well marked mucous cloud, shght sediment, and as the disease advances the urine may be diminished, the albumin increased and the casts become more numerous, while occasionally blood-cells will be found. Much importance should be attached to the blood pressure condi- tion. Diagnosis. — The early stages are not always recognizable. Later, while there is high arterial tension, thickening of the arterial walls and marked hypertrophy of the heart, the urine should be examined very carefully both night and morning, as the diagnosis will greatly depend upon the condition of the urine, which is increased in quantity, of low specific gravity, with a trace of albumin, narrow hyahne and pale gran- ular casts, making the diagnosis usually easy. Prognosis. — It is generally incurable, but favorable so far as the power to prolong hfe is concerned, provided the diagnosis be made early in the case, and the patient lives a quiet hfe. The case usually termi- nates with convulsions, coma and death. Apoplexy is frequently asso- ciated with chronic nephritis. In all forms of chronic nephritis some intercurrent infectious disease is quite possible, which is apt to be serious owing to the cachectic state. Treatment. — The dietetic and hygienic treatment is the same as in chronic parenchymatous nephritis. The nerve and vascular supply to the kidneys should be treated as in acute parenchymatous nephritis. Freedom from worry and overwork, and if possible change of chmate, should be prescribed. Frequent bathing, with friction of the skin, should be insisted upon and the bowels kept regular by a treatment of alkahne water. In all kidney cases special attention should be given the Uver. The alkaline water is a good diuretic; besides it flushes the kidneys and lu'lps to remove the debris. These cases invariably present a rigid spine which should be care- fully but thoroughly treated, traction being one of the methods that give 626 The Practice of Osteopathy comparatively quick and excellent results. Overcoming spinal immo- bility, correction of the dorsal area, attention to the chest rigidness, and frequently raising the abdominal organs will often considerably reduce the blood pressure. The accidents and compUcations which so often endanger the pa- tient, must be treated as they arise. Amyloid Kidney Definition. — A pathological state of the kidney in which there is a peculiar infiltration into the kidney structure of an albuminoid material of a waxy appearance. Etiology and Pathology. — This is associated with Bright's dis- ease and other wasting diseases. It is most frequently caused by pro- fuse and long continued suppuration, especially of the bones, by syphilis, tuberculosis, cancer, lead poisoning and gout. Pathologically, the kidney is large and pale, but it may be normal in size or even small, pale and granular. The capsule is not adherent, the surface of the kidney, after removing the capsule, is pale and anemic. On section the cortex is seen to be enlarged. It is homogenous, anemic, pale, waxy and resisting. On microscopic examination there is found to be an infiltration of a homogeneous or wax-hke material. This pro- gresses until all parts of the organ are infiltrated. As the result of this pressure the structures of the kidney undergo an atrophic degeneration, the kidney becoming contracted, smaller, rough and even distorted in shape. The cortex becomes narrowed and the capsule adherent. If a section of an amyloid kidney be stained with a solution of iodine, num- erous mahogany red points appear. Symptoms. — There are similar changes in the liver, spleen and often the intestinal canal. There is a profuse, watery diarrhea, due to amyloid changes in the intestinal canal, with loss of flesh and strength, edema of the lower extremities, and ascites. There is an increased flow of pale, watery mine, of low specific gravity; albumin is abundant and usually hyaline, often fatty or finallj^ granular tube casts occur. Prognosis. — As a rule the prognosis is decidedly unfavorable and it must be controlled by the disease with which it is associated. Treatment. — The primary disease demands attention, otherwise the measures of treatment indicated are those of chronic parenchymatous nephritis, with special attention to the general health and surroundings of the patient. Give a generous diet and be persistent with the treat- ment. The Practice of Osteopathy 627 Pyelitis Pyelitis is inflammation of the pelvis of the kidney. When a suppu- rative inflammation extends into the interstitial tissue of the organ, it produces a condition called pyelonephritis. The inflammation usually starts in the pelvis of the kidney, the infection being carried there either by the circulation or the urinary tract, but it soon involves the rest of the kidney. PyeUtis is usually secondary to some other conditions such as urethritis, cystitis, or ureteritis. "Infection of the kidney rarely takes place through the blood and only when the vital membrane of the kidney is impaired." It may start from within the organ in the interstitial tissue, caused by infectious embohsm or traumatism, or the tubules may become obstructed by concretions. Osteopathic Etiology and Pathology. — Retained decomposed urine due to pressure upon the ureters by tumors or bladder disease; calculus concretion, kinked ureter, displaced kidney, traumatic agencies, as falls, blows, strains, kicks or penetrating wounds; nephritis, pregnancy, cold and wet, are causes. Pyehtis may follow cystitis, the inflammation extending up the ureters to the pelvis of the kidney and thence to the substance of the organ, inducing pyelonephritis. Tuberculosis, focal infections, and intestinal disorders (colon bacillus), are other causes. Lesions from the ninth dorsal to second lumbar or lower, and malnutri- tion are predisposing factors. Pathologically, the mucous membrane of the pelvis is usually the first affected, the inflammation generally extending from below upward. It is swollen and sometimes visibly congested and of a gray color. The pelvis and calyces are more or less dilated, while the papillae are flattened. There is a gradual dilatation of the calyces and atrophy of the kidney substance, until the whole organ may be converted into a pus sac. If complete obstruction occurs, the fluid portion maj^ be absorbed and the pus become inspissated and cheesy. The ureter is often dilated. In tuberculous pyelitis the apices of the pyramids are also invaded, the kid- ney substance is broken down and the result is the same. In the pyehtis caused by cystitis, the infection passes up the tubules or is carried by the lymphatics. The abscesses extend along the pyramids, burst through the papillse and calyx into the pelvis of the kidney, and thus also the kidney becomes a purulent sac. Symptoms. — Pain and tenderness over the region of the kidney first appear. In a few cases cystitis will be the only symptom. The sup- purative stage is marked by high fever and a chill or a succession of 628 The Practice of Osteopathy chills. The general condition of the patient denotes prolonged suppura- tion. There is failure of health and more or less wasting and anemia. The urine is characteristic, contains pus, which varies in quantity greatly, and where only one kidney is affected, may be suppressed for a time and there will be a sudden outflow of the pus, due to the breaking of the sac. Blood is also very constant, but hardly ever of suflacient quantity to be seen by the naked eye. The urine is usually diminished in quantity and the color pale; the specific gravity is low on account of the small amount of urea present. The reaction of the urine is acid. Pus and blood render the urine slighth^ albuminous. Casts from the kidney, and even por- tions of the kidney, may be present. Diagnosis. — From nephritis by the absence of much albumin, tube casts and dropsy. From cystitis, by the history, lumbar pains and acid urine, in cystitis the urine is always alkaline. From perl- nephritic abscess, by the absence of edema over the lumbar region. The urine may be normal and there are lumbar pains and hectic fever. In tuberculous pyelitis there is a history of tuberculosis in other or- gans and there arc tubercles in the urine. Malaria or typhoid may be suspected. The X-ray and cystoscope should be employed. An ex- ploratory^ incision may be necessary. Prognosis. — Depends altogether on the cause and extent of kidney involvement. In simple cases and some tubercular, recovery may occur, although there is a tendency in all cases for the disease to become chronic. Treatment. — Depends upon the cause, but thorough treatment along the lower dorsal, the lumbar and sacral regions will be of consider- able benefit in controlling the catarrhal process in the kidney, its pelvis, the ureter and the bladder. If pathology permits, gently raising the kidneys, ureters and neighboring organs, knee-chest position, will ma- terially assist circulation and drainage. Fresh spring waters for dihients and restricting the diet to light food, preferably milk, are indicated. Rest is important and warm applications locally are sometimes helpful. The general health must be carefully watched as there is always consid- erable drain upon the system. A timely operation may materially lengthen the life in many cases. Attention to the bladder, urethra and prostate is necessary. Uremia The name applied to a series of manifestations resulting from the retention of poisonous materials in the blood, which should have been removed by the kidneys. Uremic symptoms may occur any time dur- The Practice of Osteopathy 629 ing an attack of nephritis. In chronic cases it seems likely that extensive destruction of renal tissue is the principal factor that leads to the toxemia. They may also occur when the circulation of the blood in the kidneys is interfered with or the ureters are obstructed. They are not due alone to the urea (which is found to be increased in the blood), but more prob- ably several poisons that are retained in the blood. Traube's theory is that acute cerebral edema with anemia accounts for the symptoms. Hal- bert says: "A more recent and more plausible claim is to the effect that a poison is developed in the body as the result of nephritis, " for retention of effete matter or ligation of renal arteries and ureters or impaired renal activity does not fully explain the cause of the stupor, coma, convul- sions, sometimes paralysis, and gastro-intestinal disorders. Symptoms. — Loss of appetite, nausea, vomiting, headache and drowsiness are the initial symptoms. Headache is usually at the back of the head and may extend down the neck. The next symptom is coma, alternating with convulsions which may range from only a slight twitch- ing to Adolent epileptiform spasms. These spasms may occur without the slightest warning and are often followed by blindness which may last for several days. These attacks of coma and convulsions are some- times ascribed to localized edema of the brain. Transient paralysis is also due to congestion or edema of the brain and it may be of the cord. There may be mania which comes on ab- ruptly, although the delirium is not at all violent, while profound melan- cholia may be found. There may be nervous symptoms develop, such as numbness in the hands and fingers, itching of the skin and cramps in the muscles — especially those of calves of the legs. Pulmonary symptoms are sometimes continuous — dyspnea, paroxysmal dyspnea and Cheyne- Stokes' breathing. These attacks of dyspnea may be as distressing as true asthma. Cheyne-Stokes' breathing may be present without coma. Uncontrollable vomiting may set in with great abruptness, followed by hiccough and purging. There may be a catarrhal or diphtheritic in- flammation of the colon with diarrhea. The breath has a urinous odor and the tongue is often very foul. The pulse is slow and full, with a tem- perature below the normal, although during convulsions the pulse may become rapid and the temperature rise. Occasionally there are atypical forms of uremia which may be very confusing and obscure. Diagnosis. — The history, subnormal temperature, the urinous odor of the breath, high arterial tension and increased second sound of the heart will distinguish the condition. Feeling of numbness, palpi- tation, headache, restlessness, mental wandering are not infrequently 630 The Practice of Osteopathy early symptoms. The phenolsulphonephthalein test for the secreting power of the kidne}^, and the examination of the urea in the blood are of great aid in diagnosis. Prognosis. — Extremely grave, but one should always be very careful in his prognosis, for there is a possibility of recovery, even after the most serious symptoms have been manifested. Treatment. — As impermeability of the kidneys prod\ices uremia, by not allowing the various poisons to be eliminated by the renal path as they should be, the treatment must be applied directly to the kidneys. Elimination is demanded and if treatment through the abdomen to the kidneys directly and to the i-enal splanchnics does not bring about prompt and thorough elimination of the intoxicating properties, the bowels and skin must be made active. The vapor or hot-air bath or hot pack should at once be used. An ice-bag to the head will be beneficial. An increase in the quantity of urine may be brought about by the displacement of a part of the mass of blood, which is in relative stagnation in certain parts of the vascular system. Forcing it into the main circulation in order to increase the pressure within the vessels of the kidney, is the treatment indicated. This great stagnant mass of blood is found in the arterial capillaries of the portal system in the fiver and splenic tissues and should be manipulated into the general circulation in order to increase the ar- terial tension of the kidneys and thus favor efimination. The treat- ment should mainly be applied to the vasomotor nerves of the portal system, from the fifth to the ninth dorsal, and directly over the abdomen, liver and spleen. The introduction of water, from 110 degrees to 120 degrees, or even 150 degrees, into the colon by means of injections, is useful; warm irri- gations increase renal secretion, bowel action and sweating with a de- crease of tension. Cold drinks will stimulate the abdominal vessels and induce absorption of a certain quantity of water to still further increase diuresis. Cold irrigation increases blood pressure temporarily, but later it lessens the pressure; it should be used only with great caution. Milk is one of the best drinks to be used. Secretions of the liver must not accumulate. The bile must be expelled so that its toxicity will not be added to the other poisons. The food of the patient is an important matter. A milk diet is best ; avoid meat and nitrogenous foods and any food that leaves much resi- due. In this way the nutrition of the patient is kept up with a minimum of urea formation and, besides, there will be very little intestinal putre- faction. Emergency measures not mentioned above are repeated high The Practice of Osteopathy 631 normal salt enemata (two to three pints), the alcohol sweat and vene- section (about one pint). When the attack is broken the condition re- solves itself into the renal disorder, generally acute Bright's disease. This disease illustrates one phase of the uselessness of drugs; for when the impermeabihty of the kidney has become such that it ceases to have the power of eliminating toxic substances formed by the organism, there is then retained the medicinal substances. The kidney is as im- permeable for therapeutic poisons as for the natural poisons and the em- ployment of toxic medicines in such cases has often no other effect than to bring an association of medicinal intoxication with an uremic. Renal Calculus Renal calculi are concretions formed by precipitation of sohds de- rived from the urine, and are found in the kidney or its pelvis. If large, they are called stones; the smaller masses are known as gravel or sand, according to their size. When the stones attempt to pass through the ureters, it brings on an attack of renal colic ; rairely are they voided with- out this symptom. Osteopathic Etiology and Pathology. — The affection occurs at all ages, more commonly, however, in children and in old people. The male sex is more liable than the female. Sedentary habits,' gout and excessive meat eating are predisposing causes. Heredity seems to be a predisposing cause in some famihes. Inflammation of the pelvis of the kidney, caused by derangement of the ribs and vertebra of the tenth, eleventh and twelfth dorsals or first lumbar, is an important etiological factor. Pathologically, the chemical varieties are : (1) Uric acid and urates are the most common. The stones are usually smooth or lobulated; are hard and of a reddish color. Usually in these stones, both uric acid and urates are to be found. This mater- ial may be passed in the form of sand or large stones. The sediment in the urine may be the nuclei of the stones; as may foreign matters, such as the mucus or desquamated epithelium caused by the inflammation of the pelvis of the kidney, blood clots, or, in fact, any foreign matter that may reach the urinary passages. Individuals passing a small amount of urine, and old people are the principal subjects. "As a consequence of concentration and high acidity of the urine, the uric acid and urates are readily separated in solid form and held together by the albuminous matrix." (2) Phosphatic Calculi -aw wliilc in color, soft and mortarlike. 632 The Practice of Osteopathy They are composed of phosphate of lime, ammonia and magnesium phos- phate. These are found more often in the bladder than the kidnej'. Disease of the bladder is the cause. (3) Oxalate of Lime are a mixture of oxalate of lime and uric acid. They are dark in color, very hard and uneven, with hard, pointed projections. On account of their uneven shape they have been named mulberry calculi. These stones produce great pain as they pass through the ureters. There are other concretions of rare occurrence. Symptoms. — There is pain in the back in the region of the kidneys with more or less tenderness. The pain may be severe and paroxysmal. There may be bleeding, which is seldom profuse; this will give the urine a smoky hue, but may be present to such a small degree as to be only ap- parent b}^ the use of the microscope. The stone may obstruct the ureter and cause pyonephrosis or hydronephrosis. Pyehtis of a catarrhal character is common. In pyelitis there may be intermittent fever of several degrees, then sweating. There may or may not be pus in the urine. Renal Colic is caused when the calculus attempts to pass through the ureter so that ureteral spasms result. The stone, however, may be- come lodged at the entrance to the ureter. There is a sudden onset and great pain which starts in the back, radiating downward into the groin, down the side of the thigh and into the testicle and glans penis. The tes- ticle is often retracted, the face pale, the features pinched, and there is frequently vomiting. There are cold sweats and the pulse is weak. The paroxysm may last only a few minutes or extend over several hours. If uric acid is found, it points to uric acid or oxalate of lime calculi and the urine is acid in reaction. If alkaline phosphatic stones may be suspected, examination of the urine directly after the attack aids greatly in diag- nosis, for at other times the urine is usually negative. Diagnosis. — Biliary Colic. — The jaundice in bihary coHc comes on vevy soon after the obstruction begins. The stools are without bile and the pain extends from the right hypochondriac region to the upper ab- domen and the right shoulder. The urine is negative and a stone may be passed in the stools. Renal colic is often simulated when the ureter is obstructed from any cause whatever. It max be compressed from a floating kidney or tumor, or obstructed by a clot of blood, fragments of hj^datid cysts or plugs of mucus. Lumbo-abdominal neuralgia, intestinal colic, and renal tuberculosis may simulate renal coUc. The X-ray plate is of decided value. The Practice of Osteopathy 633 Prognosis. — As complications may arise, it is best to give a guarded prognosis, but the prognosis is generally favorable. It is a disease that is very apt to recur when strains or falls affect the innervation to the kidney, but many cases have been permanently cured. If the stone is large, its passage along the ureter may prove fatal unless surgical inter- ference is instituted at once, but if it is renal sand it may be easily voided in the urine and thus the prognosis will be favorable. Treatment. — Treatment should be given toward overcoming the cause producing the calculi, which will often be found at the tenth rib. Treat the kidneys thoroughly, both through the renal splanch- nics and directly through the abdomen, anteriorly. But direct ab- dominal treatment should be given very cautiously. Treatment here corrects disorders and seems to release some solvent that acts upon the various forms of calculi and disintegrates the ones already formed and prevents the formation of others. Possibly this solvent is an internal secretion of some gland; possibly Hke the splenic secretion is to the bil- iary calcuh (Dr. Still.). Dr. Still held that one of the functions of the suprarenal capsule was to prevent the formation of these concretions. In the uric acid tendency, the free use of alkaline mineral waters for the solution of uric acid may be helpful. Much may be done by dieting. The amount of nitrogenous food should be limited, eating a- minimum amount of meat and using plenty of milk and vegetables. In the phosphatic tendency, diluted drinks freely used are helpful. Meats are indicated. Milk and vegetables should not be used freely as they tend to make the urine alkaHne. In all instances care of the gen- eral health and avoidance of beer drinking and excessive meat eating are demanded. During an attack of renal colic, when a stone had lodged in a ureter, one may be able, by very careful manipulation, to aid the stone in its progress downward, (somewhat after the manner of manipulating gall- stones), but do not delay surgical measures too long. By inhibiting the nerve force of the spinal nerves along the lumbar and sacral regions (chiefly tenth dorsal and first lumbar), relief may be given. The nerves of the ureters are derived from the inferior mesenteric, spermatic and pelvic plexuses. Emploj^ the hot bath; this may relax the spastic condi- tion. Cloths wrung out of hot water and appKed locally are of aid. Occasionally a change of posture will give relief. Even inversion of the patient is sometimes followed by immediate cessation of the pain. The patient may drink freely of hot lemonade or water. An anesthetic may bo of aid in the manipulation of a renal calculus in the ureter, as the 634 The Practice of Osteopathy anesthetic will relax the tissues over the abdomen, making it much easier for one to get near the impacted calculus, but be cautious. Morphine may be necessary. During the intervals the patient should lead a quiet life and avoid sudden exertions of any kind. It is important to keep the urine abundant, consequently have the patient drink a large quantity of distilled water. "Renal calculus is brought about by lesions af- fecting the suprarenal capsule of the kidne}^, or spinal lesions from the tenth dorsal to the first lumbar, affecting the lower ribs." Movable Kidney This means a distinctly mobile condition of the kidney (ahnost always acquired, but may be congenital), due to the lax condition of the tissues which support it and to the elongation of the renal vessels which allow the kidney to move in certain directions. Rapid loss of tissue that absorbs the fat surrounding the kidney is a cause. There are al- most invariably lesions in the dorso-lumbar region that predispose to an abnormal mobility of the kidney. These lesions undoubtedly weaken the innervation to the surrounding and supporting kidney structures. A posterior spine, with consequent downward and constricting displace- ment of the floating ribs, is common, although lateral and anterior spines (dorso-lumbar region) may be found. Strains, heavy hfting, and var- ious violent exertions are important exciting factors. Tight lacing, pregnancies, an enlarged liver and gastro- and enteroptosis are also im- portant factors. This condition is found more commonly in women, and undoubtedly is a frequent cause of direct, gastro-intestinal, reflex, and obscure disturbances. There are very different degrees of mobihty in different cases. It may be so slight as hardly to be recognized or so great that it can easily be felt by the hand through the abdominal walls, resembling a movable tumor in the abdomen. Symptoms. — Often there are no noticeable sj^mptoms. Sometimes when the displacement and mobihty of the kidney are most marked, the reflex symptoms are not noticeable. The right Iddney is the one usually affected, on account of its relation to the Hvcr which moves during the respiratory act. Usuall}^ there is pain in the lumbar region and the pa- tient experiences a heavy, dragging pain in the abdomen, which especially manifests itself while standing and walking. There may be intercostal neuralgia. Various colicky and other gastro-intestinal pains, and ner- vous symptoms as neuresthenia, melancholia, hysteria and headache are common. There may be obstinate indigestion, palpitation of the heart, flatulence and cardialgia; also, an irritable bladder, due to pressure. The Practice of Osteopathy 635 At times the kidney becomes tender and swollen as a result of twisting of the renal vessels or of the ureter (Dietl's crises), causing engorgement of the organ; this may be associated with agonizing pain and symptoms of collapse. Hydronephrosis msiy be manifested. Diagnosis. — The shape of the tumor, marked mobility, and lessen- ed resistance on percussion of the renal region will make the diagnosis. The disorder very rarely proves fatal. In doubtful cases utiHze the X-ray. Treatment. — Many cases rarely give trouble directly, but may be a source of reflex and obscure symptoms. Attention to the general health of the patient and persistent treatment of the dorso-lumbar region greatly strengthen the relaxed tissues about the kidney and cure a num- ber of cases. Having the patient attempt to replace the organ after he goes to bed will be of value. Treatment of the abdomen to strengthen the walls and lessen any hver congestion and to keep the bowels active is very beneficial. Teach the patient how to stand and walk correctly, especially holding the abdomen in and up. A liberal diet to the point of increasing the weight is worthy of trial. The use of supports is not always satisfactory. Surgical treatment for fixing the kidney is of per- manent value, but do not advise operation unless absolutely indicated. (See Prolapsed Organs, Part I). To determine the presence of a movable kidney, it is best to have the patient in the dorsal position, the head shghtly lowered and the abdominal walls relaxed by flexing the thighs moderately upon the ab- domen. Then with the left hand in the lumbar region behind the elev- enth and twelfth ribs, and the right hand in the hypochondriac region, the kidney can usually be detected after full inspiration followed by com- plete expiration; or, have the patient in a standing posture with the bodj^ bent shghtly forward and the hands placed upon a table, then perform bimanual palpation; or, perform the manipulation in the knee-elbow l^osition. When in this position (knee-elbow),, if the kidney has become dislodged, a resonant note will be obtained by percussion over the nor- mal location of the kidney. DISEASES OF THE BLADDER Cystitis Cystitis is an inflammation of the mucous membrane of the blad- dci-. Retention of the urine; foreign bodies, such as stones, in the blad- der; the use of dirty catheters; exposure to wet and ookl; injuries to the 636 The Practice of Osteopathy bladder and over the pubes; irritations to the sacral nerves; spinal lesions in the dorsal enlargement of the cord; innominate lesions; irritating drugs; enlarged prostate and urethral strictures are the principal causes of cys- titis. The disease may be secondary to fevers, infectious diseases and inflaimnation of adjacent organs. A displaced uterus may produce a chronic irritation of the bladder. . Pathologically, there is hyperemia of the mucous membrane of part or of the whole of the bladder, with redness, congestion and edema. The secretion of mucus that covers the mucous membrane is of a dirty gray color. If the congestion is very extensive, a bursting of the capil- laries may take place. In a few cases the neck of the bladder and the urethra, where it passes through the prostate, is involved. In chronic cases the mucous membrane becomes thickened and covered with patches of false membrane. The muscular coat of the bladder becomes hyper- trophied and the veins tortuous. Symptoms. — The onset may be sudden with rigors and fever, but in many cases a frequent desire to micturate wiU be the first symptom. This is followed by tenderness and pain over the bladder and contigu- ous parts, loss of appetite, depression and sleeplessness. Tenesmus of the bladder, caused by a spastic condition of its muscles, and a burning along the urethra are usually present. The urine is alkaline in reaction and contains pus, epithehum and blood. Diagnosis.— The diagnosis is usually easy. Pyelitis causes pains in the lumbar region and along the ureters and there is a frequent desire to urinate. The bladder is not subject to spasms and the urine is of an acid or neutral I'eaction. Prognosis. — In many cases the prognosis is favorable, but in cases of long standing and in hypertrophy' of the bladder, prognosis must be guarded. Treatment. — Rest in bed with strict attention to diet is necessar3\ Milk is the best food and avoid highly seasoned articles and acid foods. The use of plenty of pure water is helpful to dilute the urine, and if neces- sary the bladder should be washed out carefully. If the case is severe, emptying the bladder several times a day with a catheter wiU be neces- sary. Always be careful about the cleansing of the instruments. Warm applications over the pelvic region will be comforting to the patient. Lifting the abdominal viscera from the bladder is of assistance. The patient maj^ be placed in the knee and chest position for this or the usual method employed. The Pkactice of Osteopathy 637 Treatment to the second, third and fourth sacral nerves controls the neck of the bladder, and strong inhibition will generally control the spasms of the sphincter. The fundus of the organ is supplied by sympa- thetic fibers from the pelvic plexus. Direct treatment over the bladder, if applied carefully, will act on the terminal fibers of the sympathetic. Lesions to the nerves of the sphincter of the bladder oftentimes occur between the fifth lumbar and sacrum, also from a displaced innominate. Such lesions are apt to be found in cases of incontinence of urine. The lesion to the vertebra is usually a lateral one. Thorough treatment to the genito-urinary center (lower dorsal and upper lumbar) will also be of aid. In males direct treatment of the pros- tate gland is occasionally important as is also the plexus of nerves at the trigone of the bladder. In treating the prostate gland introduce a finger into the rectum and work about the base of the gland to relax the tissues, and thus remove obstructions of the vascular, lymphatic and nervous structures to the gland. Do not work too much upon the gland itself (commonly once a week or ten days), as it may irritate, but release surrounding edema. Also treat the innervation at the eleventh and twelfth dorsals, fifth lumbar, and first, second and third sacrals. Spread- ing the ischii will occasionally be beneficial; this tends to release the an- terior commissure where it is attached to the symphysis. Follow the above with a "general treatment" in order to secure a general systemic reaction. This is of value in all infectious disorders. It is important in young boys to examine the condition of the penis in bladder diseases. The prepuce may become adherent or other irritations may be found that are a source of disturbance to the bladder, or even to the kidneys, on account of the intimate connection of the sympathetic system in this region and the relation of one organ to an- other. An irritable bladder is usually due to disorders of near-by tissues, especially the urethra, vagina, uterus and rectum. Enuresis, exclusive of paralysis, is frequently due to some local mechanical disturbance. Nocturnal enuresis or bed wetting is caused by lower dorsal and lumbar lesions (especially the fifth lumbar), dis- placements of the innominate, or phimosis, hooded clitoris, contracted meatus, highly acid urine, worms, lack of discipHne, etc. The patient is usually neurotic, which demands attention to the neuromuscular sys- tem of the entire body. Care of the general health and habits is impor- tant. Constipation may be present. 638 The Practice of Osteopathy DISEASES OF THE CIRCULATORY SYSTEM DISEASES OF THE PERICARDIUM Pericarditis Pericarditis is an inflammation of the serous membrane covering the heart and its reflection in front over the chest. Primary inflamma- tion of the pericardium is rare. Such cases usually result from cold and exposure or injury or tuberculosis, and are most commonly met with in children. The exciting causes of secondary pericarditis are rheumatism, Bright's disease, tuberculosis, gout, diabetes, eruptive fevers, various septic conditions and dyscrasia. Pericarditis may result by extension of inflammation from contiguous organs, as the disease may occur in pneumonia, pleuropneumonia, chronic valvular diseases, and ulcer- ative diseases of the esophagus, bronchi, vertebrae, ribs, stomach, etc. Displacement of the ribs over the heart and involvement of the cor- responding vertebrae predispose to pericarditis, by weakening the inner- vation of the pericardium and thus disturbing the circulation. Lesions of the cervical region affecting the left phrenic are to be considered. Upper rib lesions may disturb the internal mammary artery and the Ijmiphatics, which have important relationship with the pericardium. The disease may occur at any age. Males are more frequently attacked than females. The morbid conditions vary with the stage. The stages are (1) acute, plastic, or dry pericarditis; (2) pericarditis with effusion, sero- fibrinous, hemorrhagic or purulent; (3) absorption or adhesive pericarditis. These different stages or varieties commonly succeed one another, al- though medical writers place so much importance in them that each is described separately. Acute pericarditis is by far the most common and often the inflammation subsides at this point instead of going on to more serious involvement. There is a possibility that in some cases the forms are independent of each other. The changes are the same as in various serous membranes. Hyper- emia and alteration of the epithelium is most marked on the visceral layer. This is followed by an exudation from the hyperemic vessels. There is roughening and loosening of the epithehum and the fibrin is pre- cipitated upon the walls of the pericardium. More or less lymph is exuded and sometimes injected capillaries burst and cause a bloody ex- udation. From this stage the morbid appearances vary according to the progress of the disease. The disease may undergo resolution and The Practice of Osteopathy 639 fatty degeneration and absorption of the products in point take, place. As the stage of effusion occurs, the parietal and visceral layers of the pericardium are separated by ^ serofibrinous exudate. This condi- tion may increase until the quantity of the exudation is considerable, or the effusion may become absorbed. Rarely does the exudate become purulent. Adhesions may be formed between the layers of the pericardium, during the last stage, by bands of various lengths or the layers are more or less separable. Symptoms. — Simple cases may not present any symptoms. Usual- ly a chill or cold feeling at the heart, followed by pains in the cardiac region, ushers in the attack. Fever is com.monly present, rarely exceed- ing 103 degrees F. Tenderness over the heart is noticeable. There is dyspnea and the patient is restless. In the effusive stage the symptoms depend largely upon the amount of diffusion. The pain is sharp and stitch-like. Nausea, vomiting and hiccough sometimes occur. The pulse is irregular and feeble. Insom- nia, headache and even delirium may occur. Distention of the veins of the neck may cause dysphagia and a cough maj^ be present, owing to the irritation of the trachea. The recurrent laryngeal nerve may be compressed as it winds about the aorta and thus cause aphonia. The friction sound is a characteristic physical sign of the first stage. In the effusive stage there may be precordial bulging. The area of dull- ness is enlarged, the diaphragm and liver may be crowded downward, causing an epigastric bulging. As the effusion increases, the heart sounds become less distinct; the friction is not heard. In the fhird stage there is usually a return to normal, although adhesions may form and cause precordial retraction and permanently embarrass the heart's movements. The young are more subject to permanent disabiKt3^ Extension of heart impulse, which is undulatory; diastoHc shock to hand placed over heart; increased area of dullness; prominent precordia; position of pa- tient does not change apex beat; and when pericardium is adherent to diaphragm a systolic tug is noted over points of attachment, are essen- tial signs and symptoms. Diagnosis.' — Pericarditis is frequently overlooked. It is a serious disease and one should be especially careful. In cases of rheumatism the osteopath must always be on his guard. Tonsillitis may be the ori- gin of the infection. Care has to be taken in distinguishing between dilatation and cardiac hypertrophy and pericardial effusion. Hydro- pericardium may be mistaken for pericardial effusion. 640 The Practice of Osteopathy To distinguish between endocarditis and pericarditis should not be a difficult task if one understands thoroughly the nature of each dis- ease. A large pericardial effusion may be confounded with a pleural effusion. In doubtful cases utiHze the X-ray. Prognosis. — In mild cases of pericarditis the large majority rapidly recover in two to three weeks. In cachectic subjects and where ad- hesions have formed, the duration is longer. Relapses may occur. The purulent effusions are alwaj'S serious. Treatment. — Demands prompt and effective measures. Absolute rest mentally and physically, is necessary. Too much stress cannot be laid upon this point, as death has occurred from neglect of this. To quiet the heart's action is the first necessary requisite, and then give treatment to hmit the inflammation. In the early stage relaxing the upper dorsal musculature to control innervation, and raising and freeing all the upper ribs and clavicles to promote lymphatic drainage is effective. In the second stage prevention of cardiac failure and promotion of ab- sorption are the indications to be met. Too much importance cannot be placed upon the point that general strength, good nursing, dieting and free elimination are essential, not only in securing a rapid subsidence of the inflammation, but to prevent further complications. Raising and separating the ribs over the heart will be of great aid in lessening the inflammation and promoting absorption. In many cases lesions to the ribs on the left side and subdislocations of the vertebrae affecting the vasomotor nerves, the lymphatics and nerves to the heart will be found. The first five ribs and corresponding vertebrae is the re- gion where one may expect to find the lesions. In addition to absolute rest, an inhibiting treatment in the dorsal region between the scapulae will aid in slowing the heart's action. Correcting any lesion that may be found to the vagi nerves will also be a help in controlhng the heart's action; besides, most of the vasomotor fibers to the heart are in the vagi. These lesions are usually found at the atlas. One should also examine carefully all the cervical vertebrae for derangements that might affect the cervical sympathetic, especially the superior and middle cervical gangha. These gangha are primaril}^ affected from the fifth cervical to the first dorsal. Inhibition for a few minutes between the transverse process of the atlas and the occipital bone to the posterior occipital nerves will be of great aid in controlhng the tumultuous action of the heart; also, inhibit in the upper dorsal. The warm bath wiU quiet the heart, but care should be taken not to weaken the patient. The general treat- ment has the effect of lessening nervousness and quieting the heart. The Practice of Osteopathy 641 The function of the phrenic nerve must be borne in mind when re- garding the pericardium. The phrenic is usually primarily affected at the third, fourth and fifth cervicals, and occasionally there are connect- ing fibers as low as the fourth and fifth dorsals. Ice-bags may be found of value in retarding the progress of the effusion and in lessening the heart's action. Liquid food, as milk and broths, should be given through- out the disease. If the effusion is very large the services of a surgeon should be secured and tapping performed. If the effusion is of a purulent nature, a free incision should be made with antiseptic precautions. In chronic cases carefully graduated breathing exercises and mod- erate stretching of the adherent regions, if pathology permits, should be considered. Endocarditis Endocarditis is an inflammation of the lining membrane of the heart. The process is usually confined to the valves; the fining of the cavity of the heart may also be affected, especially in severe cases. Three forms are recognized : simple acute endocarditis, ulcerative endocarditis, and chronic endocarditis. Simple Acute Endocarditis. — This form usually results from acute articular rheumatism. Tonsillitis may be associated with endo- carditis. It may also be caused by other infectious diseases, especially scarlet fever, but rarely, b}^ typhoid fever, measles, chicken-pox, diph- theria, small-pox and erysipelas. Acute endocarditis is frequently found in chorea. It is also met with in diseases attended with emaciation and general weakness, as cancer, gout, Bright's disease and diabetes. It is not uncommon in phthisis. Micro-organisms play an exciting part, but back of this the osteopath finds lesions of the heart innervation im- portant predisposing features. Prophylactic osteopathic treatment is a potent factor in preventing endocardial changes in the above diseases. Keeping the muscles relaxed and the osseous tissues intact is of great value. Pathologically, the left side of the heart is most commonly in- volved. The disease is characterized by the presence of small vegeta- tions on the segments or on the lining membrane of the chambers, al- though in mild cases there is simply sweUing of the valves. The mitral valves are more often affected than the aortic. The vegetations appear, usually, on the auricular surface of the mitral and the ventricular sur- face of the aortic valves, a little back of the valve edge. Their seat cor- responds to the point of maximum contact (Sibson). These growths 642 The Practice of Osteopathy are liable to be broken off at any time and carried as emboli by the blood current to distant organs, particularly the brain, spleen and kidneys. This is not uncommon in acute endocarditis or chronic valvulitis. In favorable cases the vegetation is ultimately absorbed and the valve is but sUghtly altered beyond a simple sclerotic thickening. This is often the starting point of sclerotic valvulitis. Osteopathic measures un- doubtedly lessen the liability of cardiac involvement, prevent extensive changes and promote absorption of disease products, by lowering heart tension and improving the cardiac nutrition, as well as increasing free ehmination of the toxins in the blood. During the fetal life, the right side of the heart is most commonly involved. The chorda tending are sometimes affected, but rarely alone. The vegetations are composed of proliferated connective tissue cells. The superficial elements undergo a coagulation-necrosis and fibrin is deposited from the blood. Micro-organisms are found and are the specific agent in causing acute endocarditis. Symptoms. — A large number of cases are latent, the autopsy first disclosing the lesion. In many cases there are shght fever, a frequent, sometimes irregular, pulse, palpitation and dyspnea. There is seldom any pain. Physical signs are very uncertain. They may not be present in mild cases and in those in which the valves are not affected. Usually auscultation furnishes the only indication of endocarditis — a soft, blow- ing, systolic murmur which is heard most frequently at the apex, as the mitral valves are the ones generally involved. When the aortic valves are affected, the murmur is heard at the second interspace at the right edge of the sternum. Diagnosis. — This depends entirely upon the etiology and physical signs. The greatest danger is in the disease becoming chronic. Treatment. — The patient should be kept as quiet as possible, so that the work required of the heart may be reduced to a minimum. The disturbed circulation can be controlled by careful attention to the vaso- motor nerves at the various centers along the spine. Attention should be given the disease that is causing the endocarditis. Keep the patient w^ell protected by flannels and beware of damp rooms and sudden changes of temperature. Treatment should be given to correct anj^ lesion found in the upper five dorsal vertebra? or ribs and to raise and spread all of these ribs so that the heart's action will not be unduly disturbed by interferences with its innervation. The vasomotor nerves to the heart's vessels are found The Practice of Osteopathy 643 in the vagi nerves, consequently care should be taken that lesions to these nerves do not exist. An inhibitory treatment to the sub-occipital nerves acts refiexly on the vasomotor nerves and tends to equahze the general vascular system. This treatment qviiets the heart's action. Ice appHed locally is advocated by many practitioners. Flannels should be placed next to the skin and the ice-bag placed over the flannel. This reduces the fever, lessens the pulse-rate and quiets the heart action. The same points are obtained by the inhibitory treatment at the sub- occipital region. The ice-bag also relieves pain and oppression. Be very careful in the use of ice when there is much cardiac dilatation. Treat- ment of the middle and inferior cervical regions may have some effect in controlHng the heart's action. A general treatment to quiet the patient is effective. Do not allow any overexertion. The patient should have nourishing Hquid food. Emery^ says: "Many of us have been in the habit of saying, just because we hear a decided murmur in the heart region, that the patient has valvular heart trouble; that the patient has organic heart trouble. This is a common error . . . When there is an anemic condition of the body, apparently the cusps of the valve will be so weakened, and the attachment will be so weakened that the blood will force its way between the valves and back into the heart, causing regurgitation mur- mur, when as an actual fact there is no deformity and no real disease of the valves, and as soon as the general condition of the anemia is im- proved, the valve will do its work fully and the murmur entirely cease. So if you have the murmur without the hypertrophied condition, which at once follows such a valvular lesion, you must be guarded in your statements, for if an actual valvular lesion existed, compensation would take place, and it would be the means of corroborating such a valvular condition; if no hypertrophy is found, then we are not justified in defi- nitely stating that a valvular or organic lesion exists, for such a weakened condition as has been mentioned might be the only pathology present, and be the cause of the murmur. " Ulcerative or malignant endocarditis. — This is an acute, in- fectious or septic disease, characterized locally by necrosis or ulceration of the valve. It is generally a secondary affection to septicemia, pneu- monia, erysipelas, scarlet fever and acute rheumatism. Acute endo- carditis often precedes the ulcerative variety, the latter being simply an increase in severity of the former. Etiology and Pathology. — It is doubtful if there can be a primary 1. Journal of the American Osteopathic Association, April, 1906. 644 The Practice of Osteopathy form of ulcerative endocarditis. Chronic valvular defects are the most important predisposing causes. Pneumonia is most frequently, of all the acute diseases, associated with severe endocarditis. It is rare in tuberculosis, diphtheria, typhoid fever and chorea. It occurs in asso- ciation with erysipelas, gonorrhea and rheumatism. Septicemia, pleur- isy, meningitis and puerperal fever are other possible causes of ulcer- ative endocarditis. Deep seated lesions, which means firmh' anchored lateral flexions and rotations due to fibrotic changes, are important predisposing local factors, while other lesions that disturb blood elaboration and resist- ance and lessen elimination, are predisposing systemic causes. Pathologically, the lesions are cither vegetative, ulcerative or suppurative. The vegetations are composed of granulation tissue, granular and fibrillated fibrin, and colonies of micro-organisms. They become necrotic and break down into ulcers. The ulcerative changes ma}^ lead to perforations or produce valvular aneurisms. Of the valves the mitral is the most frequentty ajffected; then the aortic; then the mitral and the aortic together; then the heart walls; then the tricuspid; then the pulmonary. In a few cases the right heart alone is involved. The lesion is not always confined to the valves, but may involve the mural endocardium. The most common organisms found are the pneu- mococcus, streptococci and staphylococci. The bacillus diphtherise, ba- cillus coli, gonococcus, bacillus anthracis and other organisms have been found. Associated pathological changes include the lesions of the pri- mary disease and the changes due to embolism. The spleen, kidneys, brain, intestines and skin may be the seat of embohsm. When found in the lungs, they originate in the right heart. Symptoms. — If in the course of any of the diseases previously named under etiology, chills followed by fever and sweats occur, ulcer- ative endocarditis should at once be suspected and a thorough examina- tion be made. The general sjTiiptoms are high, irregular fever, dehr- ium, sweating, great prostration, rapid pulse, hurried breathing and sometimes jaundice and diarrhea occur. The occurrence of dehrium, coma or hemiplegia points to involve- ment of the brain; pain in the region of the spleen, with increased dull- ness on percussion, point to trouble in that organ; hematuria may occur from involvement of the kidne3's. More rarely there will be impaired vision from retinal hemorrhage; and there may be suppuration and sometimes gangrene in various locations, depending upon the position of the embolism. The Practice of Osteopathy 645 The septic type is secondary to suppurating external wounds, puerperal sepsis or acute necrosis. Occasionally gonorrhea is the cause. The sjanptoms presented are rigors, irregular fever, sweats and exha\is- tion— the signs of septic infection. The sjrmptoms may resemble a quotidian or a tertian ague. The typhoid type is the most common. The characteristic symptoms are irregular temperature, sweating, pros- tration, delirium, drowsiness, diarrhea, petechial and other rashes, dis- tention of the abdomen and pain in the right iliac region. The heart symptoms may be overlooked, as in the septic type. The cardiac type are cases of chronic valvular diseases in which fever, rigors and sweats, and the symptoms of embohsm may develop. In the cerebral cases the sjanptoms may simulate meningitis. Acute delirium may be the distinctive symptom. Heart symptoms may be overlooked. Physical Signs. — The heart symptoms may be latent. Even after a careful examination, there may be no murmur present. When mur- murs are present it is often difficult to locate them. Diagnosis. — The previous history should be considered and this, together with the symptoms, makes a correct diagnosis possible, even though physical signs are absent. The duration is from a few days to several weeks. Treatment. — The treatment of this form of endocarditis is likely to be of little avail, although in a few cases where the source of infec- tion can be eradicated the condition may be considerably improved and life prolonged. About the same treatment as in simple endocarditis should be followed. Absolute rest is essential and this, coupled with the local treatment of simple endocarditis and a nourishing liquid diet, con- stitutes the principal treatment. Chronic Endocarditis This condition may begin as a chronic inflammation or follow the acute form, which is more often the case. There is a sclerosis of the valves which causes deformity, owing to the contractions. The onset is usually insidious. It is well known that the larger percentage of valvular lesions are the result of either acute or chronic endocarditis. Thus rheumatism stands foremost as a cuase of valvular defects. Alcoholism and over- eating (through introducing irritating influences into the blood, or by causing rheumatism, gout and allied diseases) are important etiological considerations. Nephritis and syphilis arc considered among the causa- tive factors. Infections and senility, when associated with high blood 646 The Practice of Osteopathy pressure, is a phase not to be overlooked. Chronic endarteritis extend- ing from the aorta to the valves, resulting in thickening and degenera- tion of the tissue, may be an insidious source of valve disease. This is probably often of syphilitic origin. A potent cause of special interest to the osteopath (for the reason that his treatment is so effective), is continued muscular strain as seen in athletes and laborers. The heart muscle itself may be strained, particularly the valve leaflets and the tissues about the valve, which effect often terminates in valvular leakage. In addition, the orifice of the valve openings may become stretched and distorted through strain superinduced by prolonged exertion, by flabbiness of heart tissue, and by dilatation of the ventricles. In these latter cases it is seen that the leaflets of the valves may remain intact, but still they are unable to stretch completely across the opening. With the above condition it is readily noted that thickening, curling and adhesions will take place when inflammation attacks the valves and contiguous tissues, and following these, limy infiltration and fatty de- generation may be a consequence. Predisposing osteopathic lesions as noted in acute endocarditis, are not to be neglected. Thickening and liyperplasia are immediate consequents of con- nective tissue overgrowth; and especiall}^ is chronic endarteritis accom- panied with atheromatous and calcareous degeneration. Thickening, at times, is only slight and the function of valves is not impaired. In curling or retraction, there occurs a shrinkage of the hyper- trophic or hyperplastic tissues. This condition is very apt to become permanent. Adhesions of the valve leaflets is a self-evident condition. It is well to note here that in acute and chronic endocarditis some part of the fibrous valve ruptures or is lacerated or eroded from strong and rapid heart action; the laceration or rupture or erosion always occurs at the point of maximum contact. Thus the eroded surface allows an oppor- tunity for the rhemnatic or septic micro-organisms to lodge, multiply and grow, and adhesions result. Carefully applied osteopathic methods are very efficacious in impending acute heart disturbances, and this without doubt is the reason why so many of our rheumatic cases get well without any heart affections. Keeping the heart quieted and slowed prevents the strong and rapid action and thus lessens the probability of lacera- tions, ruptures and erosions of the valve tissues. General resistance- i? The Practice of Osteopathy 647 increased and eKmination improved, which have a decided effect in pre- venting comphcations. Calcification and atheroma, as has been mentioned, may follow the above diseased processes. The calcification is sometimes so marked as to be of the character of a bony ring. The question arises here, What effect have osteopathic lesions as direct causative factors in valvuHtis? It appears reasonable that the heart is not exempt from the influences of the vertebral and rib mal- adjustments. Furthermore, clinical experience has abundantly proven that the heart tissues are affected by these lesions in the same manner as any tissue or organ is affected. Again, osteopathic dissection reveals direct nervous connection from the upper dorsal spinal ganglia to the heart ganglia. No one will question that the integrity of heart function and life are dependent upon normal coronary artery supply, upon vasomotor equihbrium, and upon motor control. All of these functions are influ- enced by the status of cervical vertebrae, upper dorsal vertebrae, and rib relations. Just what the pathological affection is when these anatom- ical parts are disturbed is beyond us until more careful dissection and ex- perimentation have taken place. How cervical and dorsal sympathet- ics, vasomotor and motor nerves with their spinal connections, vagi and phrenic, are so disturbed as to involve valvular parts and induce inflam- mation, is a problem for us to investigate. Through analagous reason- ing from other organic ailments and through the fact that osteopathic therapeutics corrects heart lesions, we know in a general way that the correction of osteopathic lesions decidedly influences the heart. Two well known physiological facts relative to the heart are: first, the heart increases in size up to adult life, and, second, the heart muscle can actually be increased in size. This latter fact occurs in phys- ical development and training. A heart that is weak and flabby can be increased in strength, tone and size. This helps us to understand how certain strains and distortions of the heart, with consequent valvular lesions, may be corrected through rest, exercise and treatment; some- what analagous to the correction of an atonic, prolapsed and dilated stomach. Then it also seems probal)le that disturbed innervation and blood supply to heart areas or to the heart as a whole would predispose to congestions, inflammations and degenerations whereby rheumatism, septic states, etc., and muscular strains would act only as exciting causes, not true causes. No one is going to expect that thickened, retracted, adhered, or 648 The Practice of Osteopathy ruptured valves are to be made anatomically correct ; but the right treat- ment will certainly reduce the morbid state to the minimum. Then there are cases where osteopaths have ehminated all murmurs when specialists stated the disease was incurable; showing that it is impossible by signs and symptoms to always diagnose the morbid tissue state. Only the resulting effects of size and of leakage are definitely revealed by aus- cultation and percussion. Hence there is a class of valvular diseases that can be successfully treated by osteopathic measures, which, if left to terminate under drug medication, will reveal (at post-mortem) the pathological signs of valvular heart disease. Downward displacement of the first rib may interfere directly with the subclavian artery and thus cause constriction of that vessel and a consequent regurgitation; also, cardiac fibers of the recurrent laryngeal nerves may be impinged by a dislocation of this rib. Many lesions which interfere with the right side of the heart occur at the second and third ribs and lesions of the third, fourth and fifth ribs maj^ interfere with the valves. Lesions of the corresponding vertebrae produce the same results as the ribs. These lesions are probably to the sympathetic nerves along the dorsal region. Lesions may be found anywhere along the cer- vical vertebrae which may involve inhibitory (vagi) fibers or accellerator (sympathetic) fibers to the heart. Also, in some cases the floating ribs are dislocated downward and cause a prolapse of the diaphragm, and thus a constriction of the aorta, which may result in regurgitation and valvu- lar disorder. Mitral Regurgitation. — Mitral regurgitation is a leakage of blood from the left ventricle, through the mitral valves, into the left auricle. The opening of the valve may be distorted, or the valve leaflets thick- ened, rigid, or retracted, thus allowing an escape or reflux of blood from ventricle into auricle. The tendinous cords may also be thickened and adhered, with consequent prevention of free action. By a forcing back of a portion of the blood from ventricle to auricle at the same time the pulmonic veins are emptying into the auricle, an overdistention of the auricle takes place. The auricle, then, from the extra amount of work required, becomes hypertrophied and dilated. There may be no noticeable symptoms at first. Later on shortness of breath, cough, irregularity of heart's action, indigestion, liver conges- tion, and so on, occur. The apex beat is forcible and downward to the left. Of course the area of dullness is to the right and left. There is a systolic murmur in the mitral area, which is transmitted to the left nxilla. The Practice of Osteopathy 649 Every osteopath should understand the mechanism of this most frequent valvular lesion. Following hypertrophy and dilatation of the left auricle, the reflux may be so excessive that a residue remains. The auricle not being able to handle all the blood, stasis of the pulmonary vessels takes place, and pulmonary edema and hydrothorax are sequelae. Then comes dilatation of the right ventricle and back pressure on tri- cuspid valves and right auricle. The veins throughout the body become turgescent, and the liver is apt to be indurated. It should be emphasized, however, that "back pressure" is only an effect commonly due to myo- cardial degeneration, caused by some infection, of which auricular fibrilla- tion is an important part of the pathology. Before the breaking down of the left heart compensation, osteopathic methods, as all know, are effective in maintaining balance. Even after the lungs begin to be affected, careful and thorough treatment will result in good, and in cases of general venous sluggishness treatment, particu- larly to liver, diaphragm, bowels and limbs, will generally materially help in slowing the downward course of the disease. Mitral Stenosis. — In stenosis there is narrowing or constriction of the valve opening. Thus in mitral stenosis the free flow of the blood from left auricle to ventricle is hindered. The cusps are usually thickened, rigid and adhered. The valve opening may be so stenosed as to be but a narrow slit. In all cases ste- nosis is a structural defect. It can occur by strains, as regurgitative effects sometimes result. The symptoms of mitral stenosis are practically the same as those of mitral regurgitation, owing to similar effects upon the circulation. Under physical signs we find the apex-beat is only slightly dis- placed. Palpation will reveal, near the apex, a rough presystolic thrill. The increased area of dullness is to the right. There is an abruptly ter- minating, rough, presystoHc murmur. Aortic Regurgitation. — Aortic regurgitation is a reflux of blood from aorta to left ventricle, following ventricular systole. This is con- sidered the most serious of the valvular diseases. The valve opening is either too large, so the valve leaflets do not fit tightly, or the segments themselves arc thickened and retracted. Structural defects of the aortic valves are lai-gcly of the same character as in diseases of the mitral valves. The regurgitation first causes dilatation of the left ventricle. This is followed by hypertrophy. If the mitral valve holds intact, no further effects result. But if the mitral valve is diseased or becomes incompe- 650 The Practice of Osteopathy tent from the dilated ventricle, the same morbid states follow as was noted under mitral regurgitation. There is a forcible apex-beat, displaced downward to the left. The increased dullness is to the left. There is a long, loud diastolic mur- mur. The well known "water-hammer" pulse is felt. Aortic Stenosis. — Aortic stenosis indicates a narrowing of the aortic orifice. It is a structural defect. The free flow of blood is ob- structed from the left ventricle into the aorta. Aortic stenosis is much less frequent than regurgitation. Aortic stenosis and regurgitation are very apt to be associated. The beat is commonly forcible, and the increased area of dullness is to the left. There is a systolic murmur, heard best at the right second interspace, which is conducted into both carotid arteries. Tricuspid Regurgitation. — Tricuspid regurgitation is the most common valvular lesion affecting the right heart. It is rare as a primary lesion. The affection may be of a structural character, or functional. Hypertrophy of the right ventricle occurs after the manner of left ventricle hypertrophy in mitral regurgitation. The sequelae of venous turgescence follow, also, in the same way as was given under the mitral lesions. Tricuspid regurgitation rarely exists independent of some other cardiac or pulmonar}^ ailments. The apex-beat is diffused toward the epigastrium. Increased cardiac dullness is toward the right. There is a systolic murmur, which is heard best just above the xiphoid cartilage. The jugular vein pulsates; in severe cases there is pulsation of the liver. Osteopathic treatment is usually effective in reheving the engorge- ment of the veins, and particularly in reducing liver congestion. Tricuspid Stenosis. — This affection is said to be the most rare of valvular lesions. Thickening, obstruction and adhesions from endo- carditis cause the stenosis. As in other lesions of the heart, there is a congenital form. There is pre-systolic murmur, heard best at the xi- phoid cartilage. The pulse is small and weak. Pulmonary Regurgitation. — This is another rare lesion, and is seldom met with in a simple form. There is forcible pulsation in the epigastrium. Increased cardiac dullness is downward. There is a diastohc murmur, heard most dis- tinctly at the left second intercostal space. Pulmonary Stenosis. — Another rare lesion. The effect of this lesion on the right ventricle is the same as that of aortic stenosis on the The Practice of Osteopathy 651 ieft. The congenital lesion is apt to occur with a patulous foramen ovale. There is a systohc murmur, heard best at the second intercostal space on the left. Many systolic murmurs heard over the pulmonary opening are functional. Combined Valvular Lesions. — When two or more lesions occur at the same time the ternis, combined or associated, are employed. This is a very common occurrence. Two, three or all of the valves may be affected at the same time. Stenosis and regurgitation at the sajne orifice is the most common association of any two valvular lesions. When there is a joint affection of two or more valves, the aortic and mitral are most commonly associated; then mitral and tricuspid; then aortic, mitral and tricuspid . Prognosis and Treatment of Valvular Diseases. — It is impos- sible to outline with exactness either prognosis or treatment of heart lesions. All will agree that the character of the lesion is the first con- sideration, and before records of these cases can be of any scientific bene- fit, we must look well to the nature of the valvular leakage or obstruc- tion and note precisely what effect our therapeutics has. Perhaps of greatest consideration in the matter of prognosis is, to what extent com- pensation has been maintained. We know that compensation may be perfect; that hypertrophy and dilatation may balance the valvular de- fect so thoroughly that even the patient is not aware of a heart lesion. As soon as compensation begins to fail, when palpitation, irregularity of pulse, dyspnea, edema, etc., appear, we know that our treatment should pass from the realm of the defensive to that of the offensive. Then when compensation fails still more, prognosis and treatment must necessarily be changed according to the increasing gravity. In our osteopathic work we should never forget that the condition of the lesion may be greatly influenced by environment. Habits, occu- pation and general daily fife may affect the heart ailment for good or bad. Thus in prognosis we have three features in particular to note : char- acter of heart lesion, extent of systemic involvement, and environment. In the immediate prognosis, the extent of general venous stasis, if any, is of great importance. In other words, the gravity of the complications is of first consideration. Aortic regurgitation is ranked by heart specialists as the most ser- ious lesion. Aortic stenosis is a grave lesion, but not so serious as aortic regurgitation. It is often stated that the character of the lesion is not of so much consequence as the extent of involvement the lesion has en- 652 The Practice of Osteopathy gendered. Mitral stenosis is more grave than mitral regurgitation. Right side heart lesions are usually relative, and, naturallj^, when the right heart is diseased from extension of the ailment from the left side, the situation is serious. It should be remembered that a heart normal in size and beating regularly is usually in a fairly healthy condition even if a murmur is present. In our treatment the first point indicated is to improve, if pos- sible, the integrity of lieart muscle and lessen the valvular defects, if such can be done. Owing to a dearth of statistics, it is impossible to state to what extent improvement in organic lesions has been accom- plished. Very Kkely if we had statistics and no post-mortem findings, we would still be in the dark as to much of our work. This much is positive: osteopaths have time and again apparently cured grave val- vular lesions; cases that eminent speciahsts diagnosed as absolutely or- ganic lesions. Our practitioners have ehminated the murmurs, reduced the size of the heart, and removed any and all systemic symptoms. These patients are well, have been well for years, and are leading active fives. But were these cases suffering from organic lesions? No doubt there was valvular leakage, hypertrophy and dilatation, but was the valve defect a functional one? In other words, was it due to strain and dis- tortion? In ah probabifity the patients' days were numbered and post- mortems would have shown grave lesions and quite likely more or less organic changes. Does it not seem likely that some functional lesions may terminate in organic lesions? Through continued stretching of the valves and their immediate tissues, fatty degeneration may take place; the same as fatty degeneration of the heart muscle, occurring in dilatation of the cham- bers. If we can remedy functional lesions through specific work upon nerve centers and fibers, why cannot we influence organic lesions and at least reduce the gravity to a minimum? We know functional diseases of the heart, as palpitation, rapid heart, slow heart, etc., can be corrected, and from all indications, functional valvular leakages are generally easily and quickly remedied; it is only a step farther to affect truly organic lesions. The same valves, the same nerves, and the same osteopathic lesions are noted. Then it is only a continuation of the same process from functional disease to organic disease. Indeed, no one is able to draw a line between the two. Probably, as was intimated before, careful osteopathic treatment in rheumatism and other diseases that are apt to predispose to heart affections, will keep the heart so strong functionally The Practice of Osteopathy 653 and organically that resulting valvular lesions are not nearly so likely to develop. The heart can be treated and controlled as can any tissue or organ. It certainly stands to reason that osteopathic therapeutics is rational in both preventing and curing valvular lesions. The M. D. gives liis drugs with the hope of maintaining heart muscle integrity, of lessen- ing a too forceful beat, of increasing waning power, of promoting general circulation, of preventing and lessening complications. We can do the same thing with our methods, even more effectuallj^, and with no prob- abihty of harmful effects. It would appear there are at least two ways in which organic lesions may develop. First, as stated above, through functional distortion, the normal heart muscle being strained from severe exercise, or a weak, flabby, or disused heart muscle being overtaxed by ordinary exercise. Here it will be seen that in the first instance immediate rest will prob- ably correct the weakness; in the second, rest and general building up of the body if the atonic heart muscle resulted from some debilitating disease. If from local causes correction of the specific osteopathic lesion should be effective. Secondly, through strong and rapid heart action the valves are ruptured or lacerated, always at the point of maximum contact, and thus present a favorable surface to micro-organisms. Owing to the valves being a reduplication of the endocardium, they have no muscles or blood-vessels, so that in functional leakages, in- flammation does not play a part, hence, a possibihty of degeneration occurring from excessive stretching. The large majority of osteopathic lesions are unquestionably found in the upper five dorsal vertebrae and the first five or six ribs on the left side, although cervical lesions, in many instances, play an important secondary, if not the primary, role. These mal-adjustments affect vasomotor nerves to the heart, that is, to coronary vessels, the dorsal and cervical sympathetics, the vagi, and the phrenic. We are unable to state just how these lesions disturb nerve conductivity; what present anatomy and physiology teach us does not fully explain. Osteopathic dissection must be the means to the end of the explanation. We have many clinical results, but not the physiological knowledge, as yet, to support it. The dropping down of the first rib, as well as the clavicle, inter- fores with the large blood-vessels, especially the subclavian, and causes increased resistance of the heart's action and probably a certain regurgi- tative effect. This regurgitative effect would also occur in cases of ob- 654 The Practice of Osteopathy struction to the aorta by constriction of the diaphragm from dropping of the floating ribs. To what extent this latter feature has been demonstrated is not known. In valvular diseases it is practical to divide them for treatment into, ftrst, where the lesion is compensated; second, where compensation is incomplete; third, where compensation is lost. With all cases we should give consideration to environment, tempera- ment, habits, food, clothing, exercise, etc. Often these secondary mat- ters are of vital importance, especially when compensation is failing. The Schott method of treatment may be of some avail; this treatment, which is composed of a series of resistant exercises, tends to lessen per- ipheral resistance, develop heart muscle, and remove heart stasis. Speaking in general, hypertrophy and dilatation follow valvular leakage, as a secondary effect. It is a compensatory condition, and whenever compensation is failing, there is natiu'ally a breaking down of the structural tissues of the heart; that is, the muscular hypertrophy is losing in integrity. Our primary aim, then, should be to keep up the compensation, which is represented in the hypertrophy, although there are cases that fail rapidly, especially in emphysema and cirrhosis of the lungs. Generally, in hypertrophy and dilatation, there is a dispropor- tion between the amount of work the heart has to do and its ability to do it. One of two things has occurred ; there is an increase in peripheral resistance or the volume of blood through the heart is abnormal in quan- tity\ Loudon^ says: "The treatment of chronic disease of the heart requires a longer time, as a rule, than the same disorder in the acute stage. Some cases cannot be materially helped; a vast majority may be greatly benefited after a thorough trial; while more than we might at first sup- pose, can be entirely cured. We desire to quote at length from Hare relating to this point. He says: 'A chronic structural change in the heart resulting from an acute process is not always synonymous with chronic heart disease. Thus, acute endocarditis occasions a variety of changes of the mitral and aortic valves which long may indicate their presence by their characteristic murmurs, and yet in time these may wholly disappear. That many such cases outgrow the valvular trouble, especially mitral lesions, there can now be no doubt. The majority, even of those in whom valvular murmurs permanently continue, do not have their health unfavorably affected for years, and in many of these, the duration of life is not appreciably shortened.'" This statement, from such an author, gives the osteopath great encouragement; for add 1. Valvular Heart Diseases, A. O. A. Journal, March, 1905. 2. Journal of Osteopathy, February, 1904. The Practice of Osteopathy 655 to those above referred to, which recover in time from all valvular trouble, the many cases of valvular insufficiency, due to dilatation, owing to os- teopathic lesions to the trophic nerves, and which may be cured by re- moving such lesions, we find that quite a percentage of cases are thus disposed of. ''It is doubtless true, also, that the cases above mentioned having valvular thickening and vegetations, could have been cured in quicker time and greater number had osteopathic treatment been given to tone the heart, upbuild the general circulation and increase the activities of the excretory organs. The importance of the lungs is often overlooked in the treatment of cardiac diseases. The osteopath's abihty to expand the chest and increase the capacity of the thorax should be demonstrated in both cardiac and pulmonary troubles. It is said to be a universal law throughout the animal kingdom 'that muscular power is directly proportional to the amount of oxygen consumed.' Hence give the power, and have your patient live as much out of doors as practicable. Exer- cise should be moderate and always stopped short of fatigue." Treatment of the abdominal organs should not be neglected, for improved circulation here and thorough removal of effete products will influence the heart. Freedom from worry, strains, etc. are essential. Tepid baths are best. A person may have a valvular leakage and not be aware of it. Prob- ably it is best to inform them, except in certain neurotic individuals. For then they can take special care of themselves, as to overwork, strains and intercurrent infections, and their life and usefulness be greatly prolonged. When compensation begins to break, certain symptoms are noticed, as heart irregularitj^, difficult breathing, particularly at night, shortness of breath, and more or less anemia. Later there is disturbance of rhythm, cyanosis, dilatation of heart and dropsy. Frequently, considerable can be accomplished through the upper dorsal treatment, attention to the chest mobility, manipulation of the abdominal organs and diaphragm, and special attention to the diet, rest and some exercise. A light gen- eral treatment will assist the labored circulation and improve assimila- tion, and a change of climate may be of benefit. Hypertrophy of the Heart Hypertrophy of the heart is an enlargement of the heart, due to an increase in the muscular tissue. It is usually associated with dilatation. The ventricles are more often involved than the auricles, and the left ventricle is more likely to be affected. 656 The Practice of Osteopathy Etiology. — Valvular disease of the heart causing an obstruction to the outflow of blood, as mitral insufficiency, diseases of the aortic valve; increased intra-vascular pressure, caused by sclerotic changes in the walls of the vessels; contraction of smaller arteries, due to irrita- tion of toxic substances in the blood, as in Bright's disease. Overeating or drinking and excessive physical exercise would also induce hyper- trophy of the left ventricle. Hypertrophy of the right ventricle is caused by valvular lesions on the right side. Lesions of the mitral valve caus- ing an increased resistance in the pulmonary vessels are etiologic factors; also diseases of the pulmonary vessels in the lungs, as in cirrhosis and emphysema. There are conditions affecting the heart, as the use of tea, alcohol and tobacco. Disturbed innervation, as in exophthalmic goiter; derangements of the vertebrae, and ribs corresponding to the upper five dorsals; downward displacements of the floating ribs, causing a prolapse of the diaphragm and a consequent retardation of blood through it to and from the heart, will affect the heart's action. Simple hypertroph}^ never occurs in the auricles; it is always accompanied with dilatation. The condition develops in the left auricle in mitral lesions; in the right auricle when there are disturbances of the pulmonary circu- lation. The tiicuspid is rarely affected primarily. Pathologically, the left side of the heart is more commonly en- larged than the right; the ventricles than the auricles. The shape of the heart varies when the left ventricle is hypertrophied, the conical shape being more or less lost; it lies more horizontally and is elongated. When both ventricles are enlarged the heart is round. When the right ventricle is ajffected, it occupies the largest part of the apex. The in- crease in the size of the heart is probably due to a numerical increase in the muscle cells. The muscle is firm, of deep red color and cuts with considerable resistance. Normally, the heart weighs from eight to nine ounces. In general hypertrophy it may weigh from fifteen to thirty ounces. Symptoms. — Hypertrophy, being a conservative process or an act of compenatlon, does not necessarily present any symptoms at first. At the beginning there is rarely any pain, but a sense of fullness and discomfort is present. As the hypertrophy increases, the arteries become fuller, the veins less full and the circulation accelerated. In hyper- trophy associated with arteriosclerosis the blood pressure is increased, and the pulse full and firm. Epistaxis may be of frequent occurrence and the face congested. Pains occur in the precordial region. There are nervousness, headache, hot flushes, palpitation, cough and vertigo. The Practice of Osteopathy 657 In hypertrophy of the left ventricle, the apex is lower and to the left. The carotids pulsate visibly and the radial pulse is strong and tense. Percussion reveals enlargement to the left and downward. The first sound is louder and prolonged. The aortic second sound is intensified. In hypertrophy of the right ventricle the enlargement is to the right edge of the sternum. The second sound in the pulmonary area is in- creased. The apex-beat is displaced outward. The pulse at the wrist is usually small. Hypertrophy of the auricles always occurs with dila- tation, which is most common in the left auricle. The physical signs are characteristic. They are caused by diseases of the mitral and tri- cuspid valves and diseases of the lungs, as emphysema and cirrhosis. Diagnosis. — If a careful examination is made, hypertrophy can hardly be mistaken for any other condition. There may be a resem- blance to pericardial effusion, pleuritic effusion, aneurism or mediastinal tumor, when near the heart. The X-ray v/ill be of assistance. Prognosis. — Depends largely upon the cause producing the hyper- trophy. Remember that hypertrophy is a compensatory act. The prognosis is more or less unfavorable if resulting from emphysema, Bright's disease or in old age ; also in degeneration of the vessels. In most cases of functional overaction, persistent treatment can usually ac- complish considerable. Treatment. — The treatment must be according to the cause of the hypertrophy. There are many etiological factors, consequently the treatment depends upon the influence of these factors. The principal treatment will be found under endocarditis, as valvular diseases are usually caused by endocarditis, and hypertrophy of the heart is a con- servative process of nature — an act of compensation secondary to valvu- lar and arterial lesions. The indications are to lessen the force and number of pulsations of the heart and remove the cause if possible. Dilatation of the Heart There may be dilatation with thickening of the walls, and dilata- tion with thinning of the walls, or they may be normal. It may be produc- ed by impaired nutrition of the cardiac muscle or increased endocardial tension. More frequently the two conditions act jointly, although they may act singlj^ Impaired nutrition of the cardiac muscle ma}^ diminish the resisting power and thus cause dilatation. Weakening of the cardiac walls may occur in scarlatina, typhoid, typhus, rheumatic fever, etc. It is met with in chlorosis, anemia and leukemia. Increased endo- cardial tension occurs in sudden, extreme exertions and in valvular dis- 658 The Practice of Osteopathy eases. A normal heart through excessive exertion is rarely if ever di- lated. The important causes are considered under hypertrophy. Both impaired nutrition and increased endocardial tension are influenced di- rectly by the extent and severity of the osteopathic lesion. This point has been considered under chronic endocarditis. Pathologically, the right side is more commonly affected than the left. In advanced aortic incompetency, all the divisions may be dilated. When one ventricle alone is dilated the septum may be seen to bulge. In extensive dilatation, the auriculo-ventricular rings are often dilated. Other orifices may also be dilated. The condition is often associated with hypertrophy and fatty degeneration. The muscle may be nor- mal in appearance. The endocardium is often opaque, and roughened in patches. There is degeneration of the ganglia of the heart. Symptoms. — Dilatation causes weakness of the walls of the heart, but as long as the hypertrophied walls can compensate, no symptoms re- sult. When the hypertrophy weakens, greater dilatation occurs and symptoms of venous stasis appear, as dropsy, feeble irregular pulse, dyspnea, cough and scanty urine. In some instances there may be brief precordial distress, faintness or palpitation. Physical Signs. — On inspection the apex-beat is diffuse and feeble, or it may not exist. As observed by Walsh, the impulse may be visible and yet not palpable. Palpation — the impulse is diffuse, feeble and fluttering. The pulse is small, rapid and irregular, rarely is it slow. Percussion — the area of lateral dullness is increased to the right. There is increase in the dullness downward to the sixth interspace and upward to the second rib in many cases. Auscultation — the sounds are weak and sharp. The first sound is shorter, lacks its muscular element and becomes more like the second. The sounds are obscured, the cardiac murmurs are present. In many cases the characteristic gallop rhythm is present. When the right heart is chiefly dilated, the true apex-l^eat cannot be felt, while an impulse may be felt below the xiphoid cartilage, and a wavy impulse is seen in the fourth, fifth and sixth interspaces to the left of the sternum. Diagnosis. — When a clear history can be obtained, together with the characteristic features, the diagnosis can be readily made. Prog- nosis depends upon the cause. Treatment. — The treatment of dilatation is that of valvular heart disease. It is important that the patient should have plenty of rest, suitable food and regulated exercises. The Practice of Osteopathy 659 In acute dilatation absolute rest is necessary. Limit the fluid in- take, and open the bowels thoroughly. In serious cases, bleeding, a pint or more, should be considered. Myocarditis Myocarditis is an acute or chronic inflammation of the heart mus- cle. In many cases where the muscle substance of the heart is diseased, there is no doubt that osteopathic lesions are potent underlying fac- tors. The lesions lessen nervous integrity and thus have a direct bear- ing upon the muscular strength and the hkelihood of inflammatory in- vasion. Acute Interstitial Myocarditis. — This affection is met with in fevers, in connection with endocarditis and pericarditis. Of the infec- tions diphtheria and typhoid are the most frequent. Septic emboli may block the coronary arteries in pyemia, septicemia and mahgnant endo- carditis and cause infarcts in the myocardium with abscess formation. It may be a comphcation of gonorrhea. Males are affected more often than females. Pathologically, in acute interstitial myocarditis the changes take place in the intermuscular connective tissue. This becomes swollen and round-cell infiltration takes place. The muscle substance is pale and soft. Acute parenchymatous degeneration is characterized by degeneration of the muscle fibers, which are infiltrated with gran- ules. The carchac muscle throughout is pale and soft. Acute suppu- rative myocarditis is a rare condition. In this form abscesses occur, which vary in size from a pin's head to a pea. They vary greatly in number and are usuafly multiple. They may not cause any disturbance and may not be recognized before death. On the other hand the abscess may rupture into the heart cavities or the pericardium, or it may per- forate the intraventricular septum, thus allowing the venous and ar- terial blood to intermingle. It may cause a cardiac aneurism. Symptoms. — These are very uncertain. If during the course of any of the causal diseases, the pulse suddenly becomes rapid, small and irregular and compressible and palpitation and syncope develop, all of which point to cardiac weakness, myocarditis may be suspected. Signs of venous stasis develop later in the affection. The physical signs are those of dilatation. This is extremely grave. Cases do, however, re- cover. Treatment. — The treatment is the same as that given under endo- carditis and pericarditis. Rest in bed is absolutely necessary. Pay 660 The Practice of Osteopathy particular attention to the nourishment and to the h3'gienic surround- ings of the patient. Especially attention should be given to the upper dorsal area, both to the muscles and the interosseous lesions, for this influences cardiac muscle innervation and nutrition. Then lesions of the upper cervical are important owing to their relationship to the vagi which control muscular impulses of the heart muscle. Chronic Interstitial Myocarditis. — Among the causes of this form of myocarditis are the excessive use of tobacco or alcohol; gout, rheumatism, malaria, diabetes, chronic nephritis, syphilis and lead pois- oning. Acute interstitial myocarditis may lead to the chronic form. This form is "commonly caused by the narrowing of a coronary branch in a process of obliterative endarteritis" (Osier). It may be due to in- juries of the anterior and lateral portions of the chest. Unquestionably osteopathic lesions of the upper dorsal vertebrae and ribs and cervical region affect the integrity of the heart muscle and predispose to conges- tion, inflammation and debility of the tissue. Males of middle life are more predisposed to chronic myocarditis. The pathological changes occur most frequently in the left ven- tricle and the septum, but they may occur in any portion. The patches and streaks that are in the walls are sometimes only seen upon very careful examination. They are of a gray or grayish white color, and when fibers that have undergone fatty degeneration are intermingled, they have a grayish yellow tint. The condition may be associated with hypertrophy and dilatation. A part of one of the heart cavities may be- come dilated, producing what is known as cardiac aneurism. There is destruction of the muscular fasciculi with subsequent development of new fibrous tissue. Fatty degeneration is also seen. Symptoms.— Advanced fibroid myocarditis may be present with- out any s3Tiiiptoms. Slight degrees present no symptoms. The symp- toms when present are: a feeble, irregular, slow pulse; attacks of angina pectoris and sometimes arhythmia. The blood pressure is increased. Upon exercising there is more or less pain, cardiac distress and dyspnea. If fatty degeneration is also present the pulse wifl ])e quickened and ir- regular. Diagnosis. — This is often very difficult and it requires careful and persistent study of a case to be able to make a correct diagnosis. Prognosis. — This is grave, though unquestionably a number of cases have been distinctly improved through osteopathic methods. Sud- den death is liable to occur at any time from complete obstruction to the The Pkactice of Osteopathy 661 coronary arteries, as this condition is associated with sclerosis and nar- rowing of these arteries or their branches. Treatment. — The treatment of chronic myocarditis is largely in- cluded in chronic endocarditis. The cause of the disease should be de- termined, if possible. Careful treatment to the ribs of the left side, from the first to the sixth, and the corresponding vertebrse, will be of great aid in controlMng the disease. The cervical region demands attention, owing to the influence of the vagi on conduction of the heart impulse and to vasomotor effect. Attention should be given to the diet and hygiene of the patient. Outdoor life, bathing of the skin, and careful treatment of the vasomotor nerves will be of great help. Direct attention to the entire splanchnic region as vasomotor con- trol here materially lessens the work of the heart and assists generally in maintaining the digestive and nutritive functions. Degeneration of the Heart Muscle In fatty degeneration, the sarcous substance of the fasciculi is con- verted into fat. In fatty overgrowths there is an excess of fat in and about the heart. Fatty degeneration is ver\^ common and is due to an interference with the nutrition of the cardiac muscles. It is found in the impaired nutrition of old age, of cachectic states, of grave infectious diseases and of wasting diseases. In poisoning by arsenic and phosphorus, intense fatty degeneration is produced. Pericarditis may be associated with changes in the superficial layers of the cardiac muscle. Lesions of the coronary arteries will produce this condition; also impairment of the oxygen-carrying power of the blood. It occurs most frequently in men after forty years of age. The affection may be either general or local. It is most commonly seen in the left ventricle. When the condition is general the heart is dilated, flabby and relaxed. Microscopicafly, the muscular fasciculi exhibit a loss of nuclei, and oil drops and granules ui^pear in the fibers. The affection may be present without any notice- able symptoms. Slight degrees and localized fatty degeneration are unrecognizaljlc. Dilatation must be present to produce symptoms. This is apt to occur early. Dyspnea; asthma; cough; angina pectoris; diopsy; slow, weak pulse; palpitation, and toward the end, Chcyne- Stokes breathing may appear. Mental symptoms, such as maniacal delusions, may come on and last for weeks. Prognosis depends upon th(^ cause and extent of involvement. The treatment is largely that of tlilatation of the hearl. An cf- 662 The Practice of Osteopathy fort must be made to determine the cause, and treatment should be ap- plied accordingly. Considerable can be done in improving the nutri- tion of the tissues of the heart by hygienic and dietetic measures. Light exercises will often be of aid, but care has to be taken that the exercises do not tax the patient too severely. A general treatment of the body will be a helpful measure in invigorating the system as a whole and ton- ing the cardiac tissues. The diet should be nutritious; largely nitro- genous. Raising the ribs over the heart and increasing the chest expansion will be of help in cases where there are attacks of dyspnea and angina. Many cases present deep seated lesions in the upper dorsal region. When there are attacks simulating apoplexy, lay the patient fiat upon the back with the head slightly elevated. Fatty overgrowth is associated with general obesity and sooner or later this infiltration impairs the nutrition of the cardiac muscle and true fatty degeneration results. This form occurs more frequently in men, and between the ages of forty and seventy j^ears. The charac- teristic changes consist of an increase in the normal fat. The heart may be enclosed in a thick covering of fat. The fat may also be deposited between the fasciculi, sometimes reaching the endocardium. Fatty overgrowth is certain to exist in extreme obesity. No symptoms are produced until the muscular fibers weaken so that dilatation occurs. The presence of extreme obesitj^ combined with signs of cardiac weakness, point to fatty overgrowth. The treatment of fatt}^ overgrowth of the heart is largely the same as that of obesity. Oertel's method of lessen- ing the amount of liquids, proteid diet and graduated exercises is effective in cases where heart compensation is intact. Neuroses of the Heart Palpitation is a more or less rapid action of the heart, of which the patient is conscious. There is usually an irregular or forcible action of the heart, as well as a frequency of the heart-beat. There is generally some local irritation to the cardiac nerves; especially are lesions found to the third and fourth ribs, although a lesion may be higher or lower in the dorsals or it may be in the cervical area. Muscular lesions are fre- quent. These lesions predispose to the disturbances of reflex stimuli, still the general health may be so weakened or the reflex irritation so pronounced that palpitation results independently of predisposing os- teopathic lesions. Females are more liable to be affected. The neurotic state is a common source of the disorder. If palpitation is long continued The Practice of OsTEOPATH-i 663 it causes hypertrophy. It often occurs at puberty, during menstruation and at the climacteric period. Anemia, the acute infectious diseases, dyspepsia, disturbances of the ovaries and other pelvic organs are com- mon causes. The abuse of coffee, tea, alcohol, tobacco; diseases of the stomach, overwork, fright, grief, anxiety, and sexual excesses are causa- tive factors. Palpitation may be associated with organic diseases of the heart, but as a rule it is a purely nervous aiffection. The patient's perception of the increased action and force of the heart is the essential element in palpitation. The action of the heart varies greatly and at times it may be a mere fluttering which lasts but a few minutes. In severe cases the heart beats violently and the pulse may be rapidly increased and reach 160 or more. The face is usually pale, but may be flushed. The heart's action is not increased in some cases. The attack generally lasts only a few minutes. The first consideration in treatment is to locate the disturbing factor. Raising the ribs over the heart and lowering the first rib; cor- recting the clavicle in a few instances, or inhibiting along the upper dor- sal region will usually quiet the heart's action. Stimulation of the vagi nerves, as they pass along the side of the neck, may be all that is neces- sary; in some cases inhibition of the superior cervical sympathetic or of the middle cervical region, acting on the depressor nerve of the heart, will lessen the tumultuous action of the heart. It will be recalled that either there is irritation of the accelerator nerves of the heart or the vagus is inhibited. All reflex disturbances, as a displaced uterus, indigestion, etc., must be removed before the palpitation can be permanently stopped. Rest and confidence in the treatment are of great importance. A very few cases will require a hot bath and a general treatment and possibly an ice-bag over the heart to quiet the increased activity. In anemic cases hygienic measures and a proper diet, coupled with the treatment for anemia, are indicated. If the attack is severe, the patient should rest in a recumbent posture and drink something warm, besides re- ceiving the indicated treatment. When the patient is not a decided neu]-asthenic a rapid five or ten minute walk will often normalize the heart's action. Tachycardia is rapid action of the heart and commonly occurs in paroxysms. There are no heart sensations, as in palpitation. Either the sympathetics are stimulated or the vagus inhibited. It is not gener- nll\- I'clatcd to lesions of the heart, but is in reality a disorder of the nervous system. In some instances the condition is physiologic. 664 The Practice of Osteopathy Nervous strain, in the form of osteopathic lesions to the upper dorsal or cervicals irritating the S3mipathetic, is the most common cause. Emo- tion, fright and severe exercise are other causes. It is found in neures- thenia, anemia, hysteria and in those using an excessive amount of to- bacco, tea and coffee. Reflex stimuli from abdominal or pelvic dis- order, especially during the climacteric may induce tachycardia. In exophthalmic goitre the sympathetics are overstimulated, and in some instances the vagus inhibited, leading to "heart hurry." Tumors, hemorrhages, enlarged glands, etc., obstructing the action of the vagus, are a source of rapid heart. Sudden onset with rapid action of the heart, small weak pulse, head- ache, flushed face and faintness are common symptoms. The treatment is somewhat similar to that outHned under palpita- tion. Locating the cause is the first essential. Besides removing local osteopathic lesions, inhibition to the cervical and dorsal sympathetics is effective. Raising the ribs over the heart will lessen the pulse-rate. Rest, diet and general care of the patient may be necessary. Out- door exercise and cold bathing are beneficial. In a few cases springing the dorsal spine forward, raising the floating ribs, and slight traction of the cervical spine are effective in slowing the heart's activity. A few cases are very refractory, especially in neurotics. Brachycardia, or slow action of the heart, is the opposite of tachy- cardia. In a few cases it is physiologic. It usually occurs secondarily, following infectious diseases; accompanying nervous disorders, as hys- teria, melanchoha and neurasthenia, and is associated with diseases of the digestive organs, pulmonary disorders and toxic effects of coffee, tea, tobacco, and drugs and the toxins of jaundice, diabetes, uremia, etc. Obstructions to the cervical sympathetics and irritations of the vagus, from osteopathic lesions, may be either direct causes in themselves or predisposing factors in the above diseases. A slow, iveal< pulse is the characteristic symptom. The heart sounds are feeble. When the pulse beat is below sixty per minute it is diagnostic. In the treatment of slow heart, as in the other neuroses of the heart, the cause should be first determined. A stimulating treatment to the cervical sympathetics and inhibition to the pneumogastric will readily reheve many cases, at least temporarily. The lesion may be directly to these nerves and of course removal of the same is essential. Inhibition of the pneumogastric probably affects the activity of the depressor nerve, and stimulation of the cervical sympathetics, besides acting on the ac- The Practice of Osteopathy 665 celerator fibers of the heart directly, influences the blood supply of the body and thus increases arterial tension. Stimulation to the upper chest anteriorly and posteriorly, over the cardiac region, will increase the rapidity of the slow heart. Rest and care of the general health is necessary. Arhythmia, or an irregularity of the heart's action and pulse beat, often due to lesions in the cervical region interfering with the vagi, sym- is pathetic or vasomotor nerves to the heart. In a number of cases the first, second or third rib on the left side is at fault and a correction of it will relieve the irregularity immediately. It is claimed that there are nerves at the fourth and fifth dorsals that tend to control the rhythm of the heart-beat. Other causes are organic diseases of the heart and nervous system, reflex disturbances, excessive use of tobacco, coffee and tea. "Normally, the contraction of the heart originates at the sinoauricu- lar node, at the mouth of the superior vena cava, is conducted to the auricle, and thence to the ventricle by way of the auriculo-ventricular bundle (bundle of His or Gaskell's ridge). Under conditions of abnor- mal stimulation, contractions may originate in the auriculo-ventricular node in the wall of the right ventricle near the coronary sinus ; or in the auriculo-ventricular bundle on the ventricular side of the node; or in the auricular tissue itself." — Clinical Osteopathy. Fibers from the right vagus pass to the sinoauricular node, and from the vagus to the auriculo-ventricular bundle. Lesions of the upper three cervicals may readily disturb the vagi through circulator}^ and chemical sources as well as through the communicating branch of the second spinal nerve. Thus the rhythmic power of the heart, rate and strength, and conductivity of impulse may be readily influenced, which is borne out by clinical experience. There are several forms of irregular heart action. For a description of same it is probably best to refer the student to special works. ^ The more common forms are Sinus Irregularities, the Extrasystole, Paroxysmal Tachycardia, Auricular Fibrillation, Auricular Flut- ter, and Heart-block. Pulsus Alternans is a rare form, and is of •iiavc significance when the heart muscle is degenerated. A knowledge oF auricular bbrillation is of special value, for it is a common form and often indicates a serious condition. Most of the irregularities are not of special pathological importance, 1. Mackenzie, Diseases of the Heart; Lewis, Mechanism of the Heart Beat; Macleod, Physiology and Chemistry in Modern Medicine. 666 The Practice of Osteopathy providing the heart muscle is healthy. They are best studied through instrumental means and require considerable experience in order to de- termine the exact condition. Frequently, unnecessary worry has been the result in discovering irregulartities in the young as well as in otherwise healthy adults. Only when the cardiac muscle is diseased or degenerated through various infections and toxi-^ properties in the blood should they receive unusual attention. Dorsal and lower cervical lesions that affect the heart by way of the sympathetics no doubt distui'b nutrition of the heart tissues. And lesions of the vagi, particularly of the upper three cervicals, will dis- turb the rhythm, rate, strength, and conductivity of the impulse through auricles and ventricles. In no other organ of the body will the osteo- path be better rewarded for careful and painstaking work than in nor- malizing the stimuli from syinpathetic and vagi that influence the heart. Stimulatory and inhibitory efforts will frequently suffice, but in our judgment it is always better to secure interosseous adjustment if possible. Though a number of individuals with heart irregularities are of a neurotic type, that predisposes to nervous disturbances of various kinds, still it would be an interesting study, especially in cases of children, to note what percentage are the result of upper cervical lesions caused by birth injury. Angina Pectoris Angina pectoris is characterized by pain in the cardiac region which usually extends to the inner side of the upper arm and forearm. "This region corresponds to the peripheral distribution of the lower cervical nerves (6th and 7th in the arm) and the upper three or four dorsal nerves (in the upper arm and the chest). "^ Occasionally similar areas of the right side are affected, and in a few there is pain in the lower jaw and back of the ears. "The starting of the pain is usually across the chest, about the level of the third ribs, or as low as the fifth ribs," al- though the inception may be anywhere in the left chest or the arm. The duration of the pain is from a few seconds to several minutes; some- times it may remain for several hours. Osteopathic lesions are invariably found in the upper dorsal, in- cluding ribs, or lower cervical region, which are predisposing factors that tend to exhaust and weaken the cardiac muscle, and disturb the coro- nary circulation, so that resistance is lowered. Thus toxic agents and 1 . Mackenzie, Oxford Medicine, Vol. II. The Practice of Osteopathy 667 infections may readily involve the cardiac tissues. Many cases present more or less arteriosclerosis, which involves the heart and affects its cir- culation. Inflammation of the root of the aorta from syphilis is a fre- quent cause. Valvular heart disease and chronic nephritis are other underlying factors. Worry, strenuous hving, and continued physical strain are to be considered. There are a group of cases, that are com- paratively mild and frequently found in women, that are of toxic origin, due to intestinal stasis as a result of constipation, adhesions, etc. The ileocecal section is commonly involved in these instances. Focal infec- tions may be an exciting cause. The osteopathic lesions undoubtedly affect the cardiac innerva- tion, particularly vasomotor and trophic, thus leading to consequent disturbances of cardiac circulation and resulting irritation to the ganglia. Sclerosis and spasm of the coronaries, ischemia, cramping, exhaustion, and degeneration of the heart muscle, and cardiac neuralgia, are various results that may take place. The paroxysm usually begins suddenly, often during exertion or intense mental emotion. The pain is agonizing and of a grip-hke char- acter, and there is a feeling of impending death. The intercostal mus- cles are constricted and there may be a feeling of suffocation. The pains radiate up the neck and down the arm, and may be accompanied by numbness or tingUng. There is usually extreme pallor, and the skin is ashen. vSweating is not uncommon, and dyspnea may be present. The attacks occur at intervals, varying from a few days to many years. After the paroxysms there is instant relief. Other cases may present less severe attacks. In the diagnosis the only condition with which true angina pectoris is liable to be confounded is pseudo-angina pectoris. Pseudo-angina or hysterical, angina occurs chiefly in women or in neuresthenic men. These cases are often excited by toxemia. The attack usually occurs at night and is unassociated with organic heart disease. There is a feeling of cardiac distention instead of constriction as in true angina. There is emotional excitement and the attack lasts one or two hours, which is usually longer than that of true angina. The prognosis is unfavorable, although many cases live for a number of years. A few cases have re- covered under a thorough course of treatment. The treatment of angina pectoris consists in correcting the dis- ordered upper dorsal vertebrae, the upper left ribs over the heart, and the lower cervicals. Invariably lesions are found in this region and if the treatment is applied to correct these disorders, the attack can frequently 668 The Practice of Osteopathy be relieved. By following up the treatment during the intervals, a num- l^er of eases can be practically cured. A common lesion found is a slight lateral curvature in the upper dorsal region. This curvature is often- times great enough to cause a sul^dislocation of several of the ribs, wliich certainly complicates the derangement, at least as far as a quick cure is concerned. During the attack raise the ribs over the heart at the point of con- striction so as to relieve the impinged nerve fibers. Hot drinks are of value. The vagi and phrenic nerves may also be at fault in some cases. The sensory nerves to the heart are from the first, second and third dor- sals. Ice-bags or heat applied locally will be a helpful measure. In cases where there is high arterial tension, an inhibitory treatment to the upper and middle cervical regions will be of special aid, as it relieves this ten- sion by affecting the vasomotor nerves. This treatment will at least overcome the vasomotor form of angina pectoris. Hot foot-baths and friction will also be found of value. In many cases under forty or forty- five syphilis is a cause. In cases past middle life there is often organic disease of the circulatory organs. The patient should at all times avoid any excitement and live a very quiet life. He should take frequent vacations. He should take the best of care of himself and his food should be nutritious. In pseudo-angina the treatment is to relieve the irritation to the nerves affected as well as the underlying affection. The Practice of Osteopathy 669 DISEASES OF THE ARTERIES Arteriosclerosis (Atheroma) This is a thickening of the intima of the arteries, due to an inflam- matory increase of the connective tissue, associated with more or less fatty degeneration and calcification. Old age, alcohol, lead, gout, syphilis, rheumatism and other infec- tions, laborious work, overeating, nephritis, and calcareous water tend to produce the condition. Excessive eating and drinking are common causes of both atheroma and chronic renal diseases and should always be regulated. Physical overwork, chronic intoxications, etc., produce hypertension of the vascular system and thus lead to changes of the vessel walls. A rigid spine is invariably found; this may be a causative factor in itself, or an associated condition. All of the above list of causes are important. Pathologically, the arteries are thickened, tortuous and rigid. The intima may be occupied by rough, calcareous plates. In extreme cases the sub-endothehal tissue undergoes degeneration and breaks down in spots, forming "atheromatous abscesses." The disease may be cir- cumscribed or diffuse; in the latter there is a widespread distribution of the affection. Owing to the general effect, the heart, liver and kid- neys receive less blood and tend to atrophy. Microscopically, there is found more or less fatty degeneration of the different coats, and an over- growth of connective tissue in the intima. The arteries most frequently affected are the aorta and coronary. Symptoms. — Circulatory. — There is a high tension pulse and accentuation of the second aortic sound. There is also dyspnea, severe pain in the left side, palpitation, "pallor, and the left ventricle is hyper- trophied. Cerebral. — Such symptoms as headache, tinnitis, aphasia, vertigo, sjmcopal or epileptiform attacks may be present. Renal. — There is an increase in the quantity of urine, which is of a pale color and low specific gravity; at times it is albuminous. The disturbance leads to atrophic nephritis. There may be gastro-intestinal symptoms, as consti- pation, pain, etc., due to hardening of the splanchnic vessels. In some cases the peripheral arteries become obliterated. The veins l^ecome liard(Miod. Sequelae are cardiac dilatation, heart failure, paralysis, apoplexy, fatty heart, aneurism, contracted or senile kidney, angina pectoris, and in extreme cases, gangrene of the extremities. 670 The Practice of Osteopathy Diagnosis. — The characteristic symptoms are hardened arteries, high tension of the pulse, hypertrophy of the left ventricle and accen- tuation of the aortic second sound. The average blood pressure is from 160 to 180 mm. of mercur}^, though it may be considerably higher. Prognosis. — Many cases can be greatly benefited by osteopathic treatment, and at the incipiency the improvement is generally marked. It usually runs a very chronic course. Treatment. — The treatment must necessarily consist, principally, in the removal of such conditions as are producing the degeneration. The rigid spine should be carefully treated by methods (preferably trac- tion) that overcome the contractures and release the intervertebral discs. The dorsal and lumbar areas, and the abdominal organs should receive special attention. Out-door fife and plenty of rest are important. Al- cohohsm, gout, rheumatism, syphihs, etc., must be remedied before there can be much change in the arteries. Freeliving and all excitement must be stopped. The patient's cooperation is invaluable. A milk diet is often beneficial. Besides treatment of the primary disease, a general treatment will be of much avail in equahzing and reducing arteria tension. Brunton^ speaks of cases of atheroma being cured by exercise and manual treatment to the rheumatic joints themselves. One, appar- rently suffering from senile dementia, was much improved after two years of this treatment apphed to the joints, and showed benefit to the cerebral circulation. The bowels and kidnej^s should be kept active, and the general health of the patient carefully watched. Keeping the skin active by daily baths is an essential factor in the treatment. Very frequently the disease is not only retarded, but improved. In high blood pressure venesection may be of benefit. 1. Lectures on the Action of Medicine, p. 343. The Pkactice of Osteopathy 671 DISEASES OF THE BLOOD By Earl R. Hoskins General Considerations: — It has been said that each individual is a part of all the generations which have preceded him. In the same way it might be said that every drop of our blood is a part of every other cell in our bodies. The other tissues are able to maintain their existence only through the ministrations of the blood and in turn the blood derives its own substance from tissues which it suppUes. We are accustomed to speak of certain organs as being those of blood formation, yet it is true that every tissue furnishes its quota of blood composition, making up the mass which we call blood. It is in one way an algebraic sum of good and baneful substances, without which there can be no normal function, and sometimes being of itseh a menace as well as an aid to other tissues, as in sepsis. There can be no perverted function of any tissue without there being a direct effect upon the blood. We may not always be able to measure this effect with our present laboratory methods. We may not be able to detect clinically the result of this alteration of the blood stream because of compensatory influences, dilution, phagocytic action, enzymatic action, oxidation, and the intricate processes of excretion. It must also be re- membered that normal blood is not of a certain definite chemical or phys- ical composition. It miist vary from minute to minute according to the normal metabolic phenomena which make up our succession of events associated with life. But comparatively Httle is known about this most important fluid. We have accumulated data regarding morphology and relative numbers of its formed elements and their behavior when sufficient abnormality is present to upset their wonted balance of arrangement. We have an ever widening field of investigation in the blood plasma in which we are constantly being told of newly discovered complexities. Certainly the field of the unknown is big enough to contain our unexplained blood reactions. It is probable that as our knowledge increases our number of diseases really considered as true blood diseases will decrease and be shown to be the effect of blood passing through certain pathologic tis- sues of the body. We can measure the number and proportion of formed elements, and the relative efficiency of the erythrocytes by the amount of hemoglobin which they carry. The genesis of the formed elements 672 The Practice of Osteopathy is to be kept in mind in considering therapy. The erythrocytes and gran- ular cells developing in adult life, principally from the red marrow, leads our attention in decrease or increase of these particular cells to the great- est aggregation of red bone marrow which happens to be in the ribs. The anatomical relation of the ribs to the spine would seem to render them verj' liable to disturbances of nutrition and nerve control as a result of structural maladjustment and clinically this presumption is verified. Limitation of the motion of the thoracic spine is perforce accompanied by costal inactivity with disuse effects upon the red marrow and eventually upon the i-elative content of the blood stream. We can measure the efficiency of the erythrocytes in carrying oxygen to the tissues by measuring the relative amount of hemoglobin which a given volume of blood contains. The actual changes taking place in blood character are often thus sufficiently indicated for us in terms of our present methods of examination, to at least aid in the arrival at a di- agnosis. We sometimes have to remember that the adaptation to abnor- mality may be efficient enough to keep the apparent significance from tell- ing the " whole truth. " The Anemias The class of diseases which are referred to as the Anemias are those in which there is an actual, or apparent, decrease in the oxygen carrying element or hemoglobin. This may not be due to an actual decrease in amount of hemoglobin, but rather to a decrease in the ability of the red cells to carry it. This decrease in abihty may be due to alteration in the erythrocytes themselves, or to effects of change in the molecular concen- tration of the plasma in which they are suspended. The plasma may also contain certain poisons probably protied, which may make impossible the efficient carrying of hemoglobin by the erythrocytes. The simplest form of anemia is that due to removal of a large per- centage of erythrocytes from the body. This condition is fulfilled in acute hemorrhage. If the amount of blood lost does not exceed the amount necessary to maintain circulation, roughly fifty per cent of the total quantity, the fluid portion lost is quickly replaced from the fluids of the body and from material ingested. The formed elements and proteids are less rapidly replaced by a compensatory increase in function of the hematopoietic tissues so that there is a gradual return to the ori- ginal number and proportion. A blood cell may be considered as passing through a life cycle of infancy, adolescence, maturity, and senility before it is finally destroyed. The Peactice of Osteopathy • 673 If the demand for new cells is not too great it will be met with mature cells. If the call is more urgent, younger and older cells will both be put into the conflict, while in a time of extreme stress all types of cells, from the "school boj^s" to the ''gray-beards", will have to be utilized to main- tain life. So, roughly, we can judge the severity of the anemic process by the reaction which the body makes to it as indicated by the character of the cells in service. The pigment, hemoglobin, is slowly regenerated even as compared to erythrocytes, so that the color index is usually the last finding to re- turn to normal after a hemorrhage. The leucocytes are usually increased after hemorrhage, probably as a protective mechanism, nature having learned by hard experience that she has less resistance to infection, when there is loss of a considerable quantity of blood. To be considered, also, is the fact that constantly blood cells are out- living their usefulness — some must be disposed of. The extra function required of these older cells gives the same results as over work upon an old man — hurries his time of demise so that there is a greater percentage than usual to be sent to the salvage shops. The regeneration of blood af- ter hemorrhage depends upon the severity of the loss, the nutrition, upon the treatment given, and indirectly the abihty of resistance devel- oped by the patient. In the chronic anemias we may have either defective development of erythrocytes, or defective function of them, or a relatively too great destruction of these same agents. A bank account may be depleted either by too small deposits to account for current expense, or by extravagant withdrawals. It is some- times difficult to determine on which side the fault lies. It seems to be nature's plan not to subject to active work an erythrocyte until after the nucleus has disappeared, judged by ordinary methods of staining. A sudden call for an increased number of erythrocytes may force the or- ganism to send in some with nuclei, but the circulation does not receive those which have not been standardized, as to shape and staining reaction, unless the crisis is of grave import. Evidence of increased destruction of these cells is shown by broken forms — shadow forms, and by an increas- ed excretion of the pigments derived from the breaking down of hemo- globin, namely bilirubin and urobilin. A great deal of information can l)e obtained by a study of the other formed elements of the blood. In general the symptomatology of all the anemias will be that of lessened metabohsm because of deficient oxygenation. This is accom- panied by imperfect nutrition and general impairment of function. 674 The Practice of Osteopathy Among the usual results are muscular weakness, malaise, headache, diz- ziness, anorexia, and cutaneous and membranous pallor, with tendency to local hemorrhages. The heart is often rapid, easily disturbed in rhythm, may possess a hemic or functional murmui-, and gives a soft compressible pulse of low pressure. As a compensatory attempt the respiration may be rapid, but is hkely to be shallow, and dyspnea results from dispropor- tionately small exertions. There may be either troublesome constipation, or diarrhea; often there are alternating periods of each. In the severer forms convulsions, coma, delirium, stupor, localized edema of the ankles or eyelids may be seen. In general the treatment of the secondary anemias will concern the removal of the cause followed by measures tending to increase the de- creased element or elements in the blood stream. In the anemia re- sulting from hemorrhage the thirst which follows is the body's method of calling for more fluid with which to maintain pressure in the arteries and capillaries sufficient to develop new formed elements to take the place of those lost. If the loss is severe enough to give rise to shock, em- ergency measures are necessary of introducing into the venous stream an artificial fluid to make up for the fluid part of the blood lost. If the condition can be predicted and a suitable donor obtained, blood trans- fusion is of greatest advantage to the patient. More often the urgency of the condition will require an artificial fluid to be given in haste. Prob- ably the best so far devised solution is Fischer's physiological salt solu- tion. In the anemias due to chronic metal poisoning as from lead and mercury, or from systemic poisoning such as syphilis or malaria, or from the retention of metabolic products as in some of the diseases of the kid- neys or of the liver, the anemia can only be successfully treated by nor- malizing its primarj^ cause — as it occurs in the role of a symptom or re- sult, and hence is only indirectly a blood condition. Costogenic Anemia (Burns' Anemia) Costogenic Anemia is a result of functional disuse-atrophy of the hematopoietic organs, there being an insufficient supply of erythrocytes to meet the demands of the metaboHsm of the body. It results from in- suflBcient opportunity for nutrition and drainage of the red marrow of the ribs, and gives the clinical picture of an anemia due to too slow pro- duction of erythrocytes. Etiology. — The condition is predisposed to by any factor which The Practice of Osteopathy 675 tends to limit the action and nutrition of the ribs. We are too prone to forget that the function of the ribs is to produce erythrocytes; it is really a matter of secondary importance that they make up part of the thoracic wall. The change from the horizontal to the upright position has tended to a drooping of the whole chest from gravity. The human animal seldom develops the free hinge rib motion as often seen in quadru- peds. The passage of both arterial and venous blood, is not normally free and copious, and as a consequence the tissue supplied functions less efficiently. This function of the red marrow is to produce erythrocytes. Any structural lesion of the dorsal vertebral column, or its costal artic- ulations, which interferes with the free motion of the rib thus interferes directly with the,efficient function of these particular ribs. The severity of the condition varies with the number of ribs affected and the im- pedance to nutrition and drainage. Diagnosis. — The condition may be of gradual onset, and may be associated or coincident with some other condition leading to a loss of tone or opportunity for free rib action. The systemic symptoms are due to a deficient oxygenation of all tissues as a result of the above disuse. The thorax is usually rigid — forced respiration requires unusual effort without proportionate thorax expansion. The type of breathing tends toward diaphragmatic. The quantities of tidal and supplemental air are both markedly decreased. The lack of tissue oxidation renders elimination less active, hence constipation. Gas accumulation, weak- ness, insomnia, with slightly increased amount of urine, and low in to- tal solids, is the rule. "The blood itself is rather characteristic. Coagulation time is in- creased ; specific gravity and viscidit}^ diminished ; red cell count normal or only slightly diminished; hemoglobin 6 to 10 grams per 100 c. c. of blood (Meischer); 40% to 80% (Dare). The red cells are small, pale, vacuolated, sometimes nucleated. The white cell count is normal, slightly increased or sHghtly diminished. The hyaHne cells are normal, or slightly relatively increased. (These, being formed in lymph nodes, tonsils, etc., are not affected by rib changes.) The mononuclear neurto- philes are relatively increased. The nuclear average of the polymor- phonuclear neutrophile is low. Vacuolated and atypical neutrophiles are often found. Basophiles, myelocytes and amphophiles. may be found in considerable numbers. Nuclei in all granular forms present evidences of immaturity or degeneration — they may be swollen, vacuol- ated, extruded, ragged, or with variable staining reaction " (Clinical Osteopath v). 676 The Practice of Osteopathy Treatment. — The treatment is to obtain a normal function in the inactive tissues. This is done by getting better rib hygiene. What- ever is interfering with rib function and metabohsm is to be removed. Breathing exercises are given not only to "ventilate the thorax, but to exercise its walls". Carefully selected horizontal bar work is often of great value. The diet should be of such nature as to supply material for manufacture of erj^throcytes and for loading them with hemo- globin as w^ell. Hence the foods with high chloi'ophyl or hemoglobin content should be emphasized. Prognosis. — This depends on patient's desire for improvement of his condition. He can be improved by correction of whatever lesions there may be interfering with his freedom of thoracic motion. He can be benefited by manipulations which adjust the ril)s, but his cooperation is essential. Lack of cooperation on the part of the patient, which would tend to increase the mobihty and metabolism of the ribs, renders him more liable to any of the interciirrent pulmonary infections, as a result of his deficient thoracic ventilation. Encourage free thoracic respiration especially when in school, or when under conditions which ordinarily would tend to slovenly habits of breathing. Chlorosis (Green Sickness) An anemia characterized by great reduction in the amount of hemo- globin. It most frequently occurs in adolescent girls. It seems to be associated with neurotic manifestations and menstrual irregularities. Etiology. — Its cause is not well understood. Poor hygienic con- ditions may be a factor, but it is a condition found in all stations of life. The age and sex have led to investigation as to probability of lack of an ovarian internal secretion. The reports of workers are contradictory. The name of the condition is derived from the color of the skin, which usually ranges from a pale greenish tint to a slight pallor. Occassionally there is locahzed vasodilation of the cheeks giving brilliant color. Con- stipation accompanied by copremia seems to be either a causative factor or result. In many cases it appears to act in the dual role. Fixation of the middle and lower ribs accompanied by osteopathic lesions from the mid to the lower dorsal spine seem to be constant findings. The costal fixation leads to lessened respiratory excursion and resulting diminished oxygenation. The Practice of Osteopathy 677 Diagnosis. — Chlorosis may be suspected from the color of the skin, perverted appetite, wandering nem-algias, heart palpitation, edematous infiltration, and shallow type respiration, but the diagnosis is not to be made without the aid of the blood count. The striking part of the blood picture is the great reduction in amount of hemoglobin carried by each erythrocyte. There is usually some reduction in the erythrocyte per- centage but not in proportion to the decrease in color index. There are usually many pessary-shaped and shadow erythrocytes. These are of all sizes, but seldom is the condition of such gravity as to cause more than an occasional nucleated red cell, and when found are most likely to be normoblasts. The staining reaction is of wide hmits. Cells of all degrees of relative alkalinity are found and often there is a wide v^ariation of staining reaction in the same cell. The number of erythro- cytes is usually shghtly decreased but not in the proportion that the hemo- globin percentage is, so that the color index is therefore strikingly low. Probably, the average color index for a typical case of chlorosis is 50, with an erythrocyte count of 4,000,000 and a hemoglobin of 40 per cent (Dare.) This drop in color index in chlorosis is far out of proportion to the chnical symptoms which would be expected from a similar reduction resulting from the ordinary causes of secondary anemia. The blood plasma is increased and the specific gravity is lowered, sometimes reduced from 1.055 to about 1.030. Treatment. — The treatment of any malady in which the etiology maj'- be apparently of widely different natures will naturally rationally vary with the apparent cause. If there is copremia, which seems to be a definite causative factor, this should be at once corrected. These patients form the cathartic habit readily, so phj^sical and dietary methods of returning the digestive motility to normal should logically be given first trial. If it is a matter of lessened metabolism as a result of insuffi- cient exercise, or blood oxygenation, out-door gymnastics and breathing exercises may incite the. stimulus to normal erythrocyte hemoglobiniza- tion. The diet should be of such nature as to furnish material both for erythrocyte formation and iron in form for ready absorption by them. The organic iron compounds of animal hemoglobin and vegetable chlor- ophyl are our most common and cheapest as well as most effective sources. The medical treatment of chlorosis is based on the empiric use of inorganic iron. "The exact method in which iron exerts a favorable influence upon chlorosis still remains unsettled. It is difficult to under- stand why iron salts in the food which are sufficient for all ordinary needs, are insufficient in chlorosis. It seems most probable that iron cures 678 The Practice of Osteopathy chlorosis by acting as a stimulant to the blood forming organs" (Bei- feld, The Basis of Symptoms.) Clinically, osteopaths are daily obtaining rationally the necessary stimulus to the blood forming organs by removing all impedance from these organs caused by vertebral and costal lesions and by obtaining better digestive and respiratory hygiene. Prognosis. — Recovery is to be expected and its rate will depend upon the thoroughness of the osteopathic work and the patient's ability to respond to the stimulus. The blood may show chlorotic relapses with concomitant symptoms if in later life secondary anemia develops from hemorrhage, hookworm infection, or other causes. Pernicious Anemia This anemia is of obscure etiology, characterized by progressive de- structive hemol3^sis of the erythrocj'tes, usuall}^ with fatal termination. The cells retain their hemoglobin carrying abilit}^ so that while the hemo- globin is decreased in percentage, the proportionately greater decrease in the number of erythrocj'tes leads to a marked increase in the color index. The destructive influence upon the red cells may be sufficient to allow on- \y a small percentage of the erythrocytes to appear normal and show the greater number to be deformed, or in various stages of degeneration. Cells which in times of health would have been sent to the "salvage sta- tion" are retained to carry an over-load for them of hemoglobin to the needy tissues. Immature nucleated cells of all types are drawn into the battle long before they can be efficient carriers to help supply oxygen to the tissues. Seldom will a secondary anemia be severe enough to produce megaloblasts in the blood stream yet they are a rather con- stant finding in pernicious anemia. With these cells of irregular carry- ing capacity and development, anisocytosis and polychromatophilia are expected findings. Symptoms. — The condition must be regarded as a sjinptom com- plex or a result of pathologic process or processes. A type of anemia very similar in symptoms and blood findings to the pernicious anemia is produced by the toxins of advanced malignancy, and by at least two forms of intestinal parasites, the ankylostoma duodenale and the bothri- ocephalus latus. In the true pernicious anemia we have similar results but are not able to locate the primary pathology. There are present syn- chronously, enormously increased destruction of erjiihrocytes and enor- mously increased production of them but we are unable to determine which is primarih' at fault. The belief that the cells are more fragile The Practice of Osteopathy 679 and too easily broken up has led to the removal of the erythrocyte de- stroying spleen in the hope that destruction would be delayed until re- generation of even imperfect cells would balance the need. Occasionally, the algebraic sum of regeneration and destruction may be apparently balanced and not tell the tremendous amount of pathology both produc- tive and destructive, that the body is going through. The first sjanptoms are of easily produced fatigue of all the body, brain, muscles, diminished digestive secretion, and dyspnea. As a result of poor tissue oxygenation, fatty degeneration takes place in the more active organs as the heart, kidneys and liver. There may be ex- tensive degeneration of varying areas of the central nervous system. Some of these areas are due to hemorrhages from the general tendency to breaking down of vessel walls. Often these areas of destruction affect the posterior horns of the spinal cord, and, occasionally, a blood count differentiates between similar symptoms of pernicious anemia and tabes dorsaHs. There is seldom any emaciation; usually the patient appears "puffy" with a "pasty" color. There is variable sub-cutaneous edema. The symptoms being of such wide distribution and character, the patient is usually treated for all sorts of supposed conditions until some one makes a blood count at a time when there is enough disturbance of equi- librium to give the findings of pernicious anemia. Treatment. — The treatment of the form due to intestinal parasites gives striking results on removal of the causative organisms. Some advise treating all cases having these blood findings on the assumption that the presence of these parasites is responsible for the condition. The treatment of the idiopathic form resolves itself into building up the ability of the body to resist disease and the removing of all possible agents for depressing the vitahty of the body. Rest in bed coupled with the digestible and assimilable hmit of nutrition often gives tempor- ary improvement. Removal of questionable teeth also often aids for a time. Correction of troublesome osteopathic lesions is often accompanied by the same result. The symptomatic osteopathic treatment always makes the patient more comfortable, often gives temporary improvement, and, occasionally, has given a return to normal that has persisted for sev- eral years. Prognosis. — It is nearly always possible to obtain transient im- provement, but the pernicious anemia patient is usually dead within two 3^oars from the time the diagnosis is well established. 680 The Practice of Osteopathy The Leucemias As a result of any inflammatory process, there is a physiological reaction or stimulus leading to an increase in the number of neutrophilic leucocytes found in the peripheral circulation. As long as this increase does not crowd out other cells, red and white, sufficiently to interfere with their abiUty to function there is nothing but gain to the body of the character of more efficient bacterial destruction. After the need for these cells has passed, their number is decreased by destruction and the lessening of their production, until an equiHbrium is reached which will be maintained. This same process of making and destrojdng is constantly- going on for all of the different classes of cells found in the blood stream. Over- production of any type will lead to actual increase of that sort of cell in circulation, and, if unaccompanied by over-production of other types, will lead to a relative decrease of the other elements. It is very difficult for the body to furnish normal cells very much in excess, relatively, of the normal number, so that when the stimulus leading to immense over-production is at work immature cells in great numbers are apt to be thrown into the blood stream. As an example, the case of leucocytosis which has a white count of 60,000 is extreme and the patient nearing death, yet it may not show manj^, if any, abnormal types of cells. A case of myelogenous leucemia with a white count of 60,000 would not be proportionately sick, and would be a mild case — yet the greater part of his white blood content would be made up of cells not found in normal blood. The leucocytosis patient is suffering more from the cause of his increase in number of cells, while usually the leuce- mia patient suffers because of the increase of cells. In one, the cause is usually extrinsic, and, in the other, it is intrinsic as far as the blood is concerned. In general, then, the symptoms of a leucemia parallel in intensity the increase in cells. It takes energy to make these cells — other tissues are made to suffer from lack of this energy. Erj^throcytes and white cells cannot occupy the same space at the same time. The increase in white therefore crowds the red cells out of function. Disease in relative and absolute content of erythrocytes decreases the oxygen carrying ca- pacity of the blood stream. Hence, metabolism of the whole body suf- fers. Often, then, the whole apparent symptomatology of a severe leu- cemia is that of a secondary anemia. The primary pathology is of hyperplasia of the particular genetic tissue of the type of cells which are in excess, and is proportionate in amount to the excess developed. The Peactice of Osteopathy 681 Splenomedullary Leucemia (Myeloid Leucemia; Myelemia) M3^elemia is a disease characterized by an enormous increase in the white cell content with proportionate changes in the spleen, liver, and the blood marrow. Etiology. — It is a disease occuring at all ages, but the majority of cases are recognized in adult males. Heredity, trauma to the spleen, malaria, syphiUs, and rapid repeti- tion of pregnancies seem to be at least exciting factors. A few cases have been reported in which tenth, eleventh, and twelfth rib lesions were definite etiologic factors by pressure. DiagnosiSo — The patient goes through a period of vague, indefinite, and wandering s\Tiiptoms. General malaise, weakness often accompan- ied by dyspnea, and emaciation similar in many ways to incipient pul- monary tuberculosis, except that the sKght temperature changes are not typical. At the same time there may be digestive discomfort of var- ious kinds without tj^pical pathology. Of these early symptoms the most persistent is the dyspnea which is a structural result of the in- crease in size of the spleen . As a direct pressure result of this hyperplasia, there may develop dropsical infiltration of the lower extremities and as- citic accumulation in the abdominal cavity. With the changes in the blood itself, the blood vessel walls break down more easily, and subcutaneous hemorrhages, epistaxis and hema- teraesis are common. In an attempt to destroy the excessive amount of white cells, the liver msiy become enlarged. But this occurs later and of much less de- gree than the enormous increase in size of spleen. There may be areas of hemorrhage with resulting softening in the spinal cord. The most likely areas to suffer are the posterior and lateral horns, with resulting paraplegia, spastic or ataxic. Usually, the course is slow, and the condition is truly chronic. But, occasionally, the rapid increase and succession of symptoms, with con- comitant blood changes, change the diagnosis to acute myelogenous leukemia. The total cell count, red plus white, is diminished, for while there is enormous relative increase of the white cells a gi'cater actual decrease takes place in the reds. This decrease in reds is partially relative from crowding out of erythrocytes by leucocytes, but there is also actual de- 682 The Practice of Osteopathy crease in their formation, so that there is an actual anemia present as well as a leukemia. In some respects the red cells behave as in chlorosis, each carrying a diminished percentage of hemoglobin, resulting in a low color index. Atypical staining reactions and morphology, together with many fractur- ed forms, are the rule. Normoblasts are common throughout the course of the disease, but megaloblasts seldom appear until near fatal termina- tion. The changes in the white ceUs are enormous, both as to numbers and character of cells found. The total white count often exceeds 350,000. This, with the accompanying reduction in number of erythrocytes, leads to a reduction of the ratio between reds and whites to as low as 1 to 5 or 3, or occasionally 1 to 1. There is an actual increase in number of all the white cells with the possible exception of the lymphocytes. In the actual increase of polymorphonuclear neutrophiles and eosinophiles is rendered a sharp relative decrease by the enormous production of myelo- cytes. Basophiles are usually both relatively and absolutely increased. In a white count of 350,000 it is not unusual to have present 325,000 myelocytes, with 25,000 as the actual number of ordinary leucocytes. There is, therefore, a mild leucocytosis coupled with a violent leuke- mia. These two are coml^ined with an anemia that varies with the course of the disease. Treatment. — The treatment is largely hygienic, including thorough osteopathic attention to the lower dorsal and costal area. Symptomatic treatment is often followed by temporary improvement both cHnically and in the blood picture, but complete recovery seldom takes place. Occasionally, roentgen therapy has given a "cure" lasting several years. Prognosis is not good. These patients are frequently carried away quickly bj' some oftentimes slight intercurrent infection. Even if carefully guarded from such, the course of the process usually leads to death from exhaustion in two or three j'^ears. Lymphatic Leucemia Clinically, this is a parallel condition to myelogenous leucemia, except that the hj^perplasia of cells occurs in lymphoid tissue, and leads to an enormous over-production of honphocytes rather than myelocytes. It is more readily divided into acute and chronic forms than myelogen- ous leucemia from differences in s3^nptomatology. In the acute form, adolescents are usually affected, the condition beginning with tumefaction of the lymph glands, first noted in the cervical The Practice of Osteopathy 683 region, but usually a general involvement. Dyspnea results from pres- sure upon treachea and bronchi by the enlarged glands of the medias- tinum. There is pyrexia of 103 to 105 degrees, intermittent in character. The pressure upon nerve trunks and plexuses in the thorax leads to variable anginas distributed not only in regions actually imposed upon but over all sorts of possible reflex paths. The blood vessels of the skin are easily broken down so that slight injuries result in great suggillation. The patient rapidly develops anemia, and later goes into a syndrome similar to the cachexia of malignancy. In fact, the rapid termination and cHnical course of acute lymphatic leukemia is parallel to the action of mahgnancy. Probably the condition will eventually be properly clas- sified as a neoplasm of the blood itself. The chronic form occurs in later life, and, instead of being an ab- rupt rapid process, is slow, progressive and painless. It has the lymph gland hyperplasia, but the enlargement is so gradual that compensation 's estabhshed to a remarkable degree. It is usually a generahzed process, first noted in the cervical and axillary glands because of their accessi- bility. Usually both the spleen and liver are enlarged, but this also is a slow and later development. There may be exacerbations of temperature, but they are not con- stant or usually severe. Hemorrhages into the skin are not common, but pruritus may be very troublesome. The patient comes to a physician because of sjTnptoms resulting from his secondary anemia, dyspnea, dyspepsia, and palpitation. The diagnosis cannot be made without the aid of a blood study. The blood picture shows a severe anemia with both the number of erythro- cytes and the hemoglobin percentage very much lowered. Of the two findings, the hemoglobin percentage is relatively more decreased, so that the color index is markedly lowered. In the acute form nucleated reds are common. Just before death these may show various forms and sizes as well as the normoblasts. In the chronic form normoblasts do not appear except as the case grows decidedly worse. As compared to myelogenous leucemia the anemia of lymphatic leukemia is of greater severity. In the leucocyte count there is great increase in numbers, the greater part being composed of the lymphocytes. The lymphocytes may be cither of the large or small variety, and occasionally are found in about equal proportions. In contra-distinction to the myelogenous type, the increased type of cells are of the mononuclear nongranular types. It is not very unusual to find a well advanced case of lymphatic leucemia 684 The Practice of Osteopathy without abnormal cells in the blood count, the expression of pathology being in the shape of disturbance in number and proportion of cells rather than in development of abnormal types. The actual number of leuco- cytes does not go as high in proportion to the gravity of the condition in Ij^mphatic leukemia as it does in the myelogenous. In other words, a pa- tient with lymphoid leucemia showing a count of 90,000 leucocytes with 90% of these lymphocytes is a much sicker man than the myelogenous case showdng a 350,000 leucocj'te count. Usually there is an actual as well as relative decrease of all the granu- lar types of leucocytes with the polymorphonuclear neutrophiles especial- ly decreased. The treatment is sj'stemic and sjaiiptomatic. Recovery is not to be expected, but these unfortunates can be made relatively comfortable and given occasional respite by judicious osteopathic care. Hodgkin's Disease (Lymphadenoma; pseudo -leucemia) In a general way, the several conditions which are cHnicall}^ leucemia, yet do not possess leukemic blood, can be classified as pseudo-leukemias. We do not definitely know the cause of leucemia as yet and can but ht- tle more than speculate on the various etiologic factors of the pseudo- leucemias. Syphihs, malaria, tuberculosis, and malignancy are all considered as factors, and probably certain cases can be definitely associated with these conditions. All of this group of pseudo-leucemias are characterized by early swelHng of cervical hTuph glands, followed b}^ general gland enlarge- ment, and b}^ great destruction of the erythrocytes. There may be metastatic-Hke growths of lymphoid tissue in other organs. The en- largement of cervical glands usually begins on one side near the angle of the jaw, and most commonly in young male adults. These glands pro- gressively increase in size, first are soft, then later become hard through fibrous proliferation. Each gland tends to increase in size by itself, not to coalesce with its neighbors, so that each separate gland can be pal- pated. This is more readil.y done as there is Httle tendenc}'- to fibrous adhesion formation to the overlying skin. These glands are painless throughout the course of the disease, and tend neither to caseate nor to suppurate. The excised glands show a combined hyperplasia and connective tis- sue proliferation. In the soft stage of the tumefaction, the lymphoid The Peactice of Osteopathy 685 hyperplasia is in preponderance, while, at the stage of hardening, the fibrous tissue derived from the trabeculae and capsule of the gland is in prominence. There is increase in the size of the spleen, and occasionally of the liver, but these are never as marked as those resulting from leucemia. The symptoms are, first, those due to the glandular enlargement in the order of: dyspnea, hydrothorax, dysphagia, ascites, swelling of the extremities, and jaundice. The destruction of red cells gives a resulting anemia which goes with and exaggerates the pressure symptoms. A process of this kind to induce such grave changes over as well protected organs as make up the Ij^mph system, must be virulent enough to set up other symptoms, to be associated with those due to pressure or to anemia. These are usually emaciation (giving greater prominence to glandular tumefaction), cachexia, and the implantation of masses of lymphatic tissue in organs where normally only traces of this tissue ex- ist. Fever is dependent upon the disturbed thermic metaboHsm and may be practically absent or subject to wide variations. The erythrocyte count shows a progressive decrease with a greater proportion of broken down cells and abnormal types as the condition advances. The actual count is usually between 2,000,000 and 3,500,000 per cubic milHmeter. The hemoglobin usually reduces in proportion to the erythrocytes, so that there is Uttle change in color index. The leucocytes are not markedly changed in number (seldom over 10,000), and this is often the diagnostic finding between leukemia and the pseudo-leukemias. Hodgkin's disease usually has a high percentage of lymphocytes, so that there is an actual as well as relative decrease of the granular leucocytes. The treatment is unsatisfactory, and is in the main symptomatic. Roentgen therapy has given temporary improvement, in some cases lasting several years. In general the prognosis is hopeless, the end oc- curing within four years of the time the condition is recognized. 686 The Practice of Osteopathy DISEASES OF THE THYROID GLAND Congestion Physiological congestions of the thyroid gland are not uncommon during puberty, painful menstruations, pregnancy, and the menopause. The premenstrual congestion may persist after the menstrual function has been established, but this is comparatively rare. When the en- largement remains there is more or less hypertrophy, and it should receive appropriate treatment. Upper dorsal and cervical lesions are common. The congestion during pregnancy occurs in the majority of cases and seems to be a physiological process, wherein there is more or less hyper- trophy and hyperplasia, which probably counteracts the waste products especially caused bj^ this state, \>y due to the inactivity of the ovary. During delivery the gland may rapidly enlarge and remain so for an in- definite time. It seems probable that the straining due to labor may cause lesions of the upper dorsal and neck that will derange the function of the organ. When the enlargement occurs during the menopause special care should be taken that the goiter is not malignant. Other possible causes of congestion are overfatigue, particularly when associated with heavy lifting; tight clothing about the neck; over- use of the voice; and in a few cases it may be discovered in boys at puberty. The symptoms are congestion, the gland being very vascular, either soft or tense, somewhat painful owing to the tension of the capsule, and in persistent cases there may be hypertrophy and hyperplasia. The treat- ment is the same as given under simple goiter. Inflammation of the Thyroid Inflammation of the thyroid is not of frequent occurrence. In the several cases that the authors have seen there was some previous en- largement of the organ, which probably caused a lowered resistance of the local tissues. There is almost invariably some infection elsewhere in the body. The exciting causes are usually streptococcus, staphylococ- cus, or bacillus coli. The inflammation may follow pneumonia, tonsilhtis, rheumatism, typhoid, puerpal infections, enteritis, diphtheria, influenza, mumps, etc. Trauma, carrying weights on the head, and cold, may be etiological factors. Commonly, one lobe is involved, though the entire gland may be affected. There is swelling, the capsule is distended and painful, and small hemorrhages occur which in the case of suppuration form the site of The Practice of Osteopathy 687 the abscess. The sweUing involves the parenchyma and interstitial tissue. The onset is usually sudden with chills, fever, and pain over the glands. The patient keeps the head flexed to release the muscular ten- sion, swallowing is painful, and there is a sense of constriction. A rapid heart may be a prominent symptom. Much depends at this period on the treaiment given. If the drainage can be freed, by lowering the first ribs and raising the clavicles with attention to the dorsal and cervical innervation, prompt subsidence of the condition commonly takes place. This should be carefully accomplished in order not to bruise the parts. Diagnosis is not difficult as a rule. The symptoms and historj^ of infection will generally suffice. Hemorrhage may occur in a goiter and somewhat simulate inflammation. A possibility of malignancy is to be considered. If the condition does not yield to treatment, surgical interference may be necessary. Tuberculosis and syphilis of the thyroid are rare conditions. Woody thyroiditis may be mistaken for mahgnancy. The gland is very fibrous, and when cut has a dry surface. The connective tissue is hardened and crowds upon the parenchyma. This condition is usually found in young men. It develops rapidly, with more or less pain and dys- pnea. Adenocarcinoma, carcinoma, and sarcoma are rare diseases^ still one should be on his guard as to their possibihty. They are most apt to occur after forty. A rapid enlargement should be regarded with suspicion. Simple Goiter We employ the term simple goiter to designate chronic enlarge- ment of the thyroid gland not due to inflammation, exophthalmic goiter, or mahgnancy, although the latter conditions are frequently associated with or follow the former. There is usually an enlargement of the gland in cretinism, and occasionally in myxedema, but the functional grade of the gland is far different from that in other diseases of the thyroid. The disease is very prevalent in certain regions of Europe and Asia, although in the United States it is not so common, except in the environs of the Great Lakes, the District of Columbia, and the Northwest states. The second decade of fife, probably owing to adolescent changes, es- pecially in girls, develop the greater number of goiters. It is infrequent- ly congenital, and occasionally a case will develop as early as four or five years of age. 1. Ewing, Neoplastic Diseases; Grotti, Thyroid and Thymus. 688 The Ppuctice of Osteopathy Etiology. — Distiirljed innervation of the gland unquestionably seems to be the predisposing cause of the deranged secretion and vascular changes, which if continued finally lead to hypertrophy and hyperplasia of the tissues. These lesions are found from the fifth dorsal to the occi- put and to the corresponding ribs. They probably involve secretory fibers of the sympathetic that emerge from the upper dorsals, first to fifth inclusive, maximum effect second, third and fourth. "Evidence is pre- sented that the impulses pass to outlying neurones whose cell bodies are located close below the superior cervical ganghon and also in the infer- ior cervical ganglion. "\ In both these ganglia impulses to the thyroid pass from preganglionic fibers to the outlying neurones. This also in- cludes the area of vasomotor^ innervation of the head and neck. In a number of cases cervical lesions alone will disturb the thyroid innervation, especially from the second to fourth segments. These may involve the superior cervical sympathetic, owing to its relationship to the rectus capitis anticus major muscle. Then there are afferent asso- ciation fibers that pass down through the lateral horns and whose con- necting fibers emerge via the upper dorsal. The lymphatic drainage of the thyroid should not be neglected. Lesions of the upper ribs and clavicles are very prone to impede its cir- culation, and thus predispose to secondary infections. Infection from septic foci are important secondary factors. This is particularly true of focal infections of the upper respiratory tract and buccal cavity, although infections and toxins from various regions may be exciting factors. Toxemia due to intestinal stasis is not rarely an important consideration. McCarrison insists that infection from certain waters is the cause of goitei-. He finds that boiling the water renders it harmless. Pathologically, the first effect upon the gland is to lessen its iodine content. The circulation is increased, with hyperplasia of the epithelial tissue, and a lessened amount of colloid material. If the condition con- tinues, the alveoli will again become distended with the colloid material so that the epithelial tissue cells are almost flattened. This represents the so-termed colloid goiter. The gland, commonly the whole organ, though one side may be involved, is fairly uniform in size. In rare in- stances, the gland may surround the trachea — the so-termed circular goiter. Hemorrhages may occur, and there may be various alterations 1. Cannon and Cattell, The Secretory ennervation of the ThsToid Gland, Am. Journal of Physiology, July, 1916. 2. Gaskell, Involuntary Nervous System. The Practice of Osteopathy . 689 and degenerations. When the vessels are much dilated, it is often called a vascular goiter, though the colloid changes are present. The nodular goiter is another form characterized by new forma- tion of gland tissue that is not diffuse but circumscribed. These cases are apt to follow persistent involvement of the gland at puberty. The two forms may occur together, and there may be various combinations and changes. In the nodular goiter there is comparatively Kttle colloid. There are many blood-vessels, and small hemorrhages are frequent. This latter point should be remembered by those who treat over the gland, which at best is a doubtful procedure. Various changes may take place, as local points of necrosis, cystic formation, and calcification, are not uncommon. Symptoms. — The essential feature in goiter is distension of the alveoh and formation of new ones, associated with dilated vessels, and usually degeneration of the colloid. Often the function of the gland is not noticeably disturbed. Usually, it is for the pressure symptoms or the unsightliness, due to the distension, that the patient seeks relief. Pressure upon the windpipe, gullet, or blood-vessels is not rare, and may cause more or less difficulty in breathing or swallowing. Coughing and huskiness may be troublesome. The recurrent nerves and vagus raa.j be compressed. Disturbance of the heart, such as palpitation, tachy- cardia, and hypertrophy may be caused by the effect of pressure upon the blood-vessels, or to changes in the secretory function of the gland. Treatment. — Adjustment of the upper dorsal and cervical lesions will be followed by recovery in the majority of cases. Dr. Still empha- sized the point that the vertebral ends of the first ribs are frequently displaced upward and outward. This lesion is often found in cases fol- lowing confinement. The effect of the change here is probably to the stellate ganghon, or to the lymphatic drainage of the gland. Treatment over the gland should be cautiously given, if at all. Definite correction of the lesioned vertebrae and ribs will be sufficient, but muscular manip- ulation and halfway measures are practically useless. Lesions of the lower spine may be the primary source of a compensa- tory lesion of the upper dorsal, or they may derange the pelvic organs, or be the predisposing factor of intestinal stasis. Attention to possible focal infections, and thorough ehmination, are to be considered. In goitrous regions boiling the water is of value. In obstinate cases the X-ray may be of service, and as a final resort surgery may be employed. ''Marine observed that the amount of iodine is inversely proportion- al to the degree of hyperplasia of the gland, and when the hyperplastic coiidil ion ])ecomcs fully developed, scaix-ely a trace of iodine is contained 690 The Practice of Osteopathy in the gland. Later, when the hyperplasia gives place to colloid goiter, the iodine increases again, both absolutely and relatively. Moreover, it has been found that if iodine be administered to an animal suffering from hyperplasia, the hyperplastic condition very quickly disappears and the animal becomes normal. "\ His viewpoint of the hyperplasia is that an effort is being made to compensate for an "insufficiency due to inabihty to absorb or assimilate sufficient iodine", and thus the effect of the administered iodine is to normalize the gland by stimulation. No one can question that this may be effective under certain condi- tions, particularly where there is deficient iodide in the water, but it is an essential element of the body. But it does not necessarily follow that because in thyroid disturbance the relationship between thyroid functioning and the substance containing iodine is upset that recovery depends upon furnishing more iodine to the body economy. It may be somewhat parallel to giving iron in anemia, when often the real difficulty is one of assimilation, and not insufficient iron in the alimentary canal. Moreover, case after case of goiter has recovered through osteopathic measures following a most thorough trial of the iodine treatment. It is very obvious that the cause of the goiter rested elsewhere. Dogs are susceptible to thyroid enlargement. Lesioning of the cervical region has resulted in goiter formation, and recovery has followed adjustment of the lesion. And dogs having goiter without experimental lesions have frequently been normalized by adjusting an abnormal cervical spine. Exophthalmic Goiter In exophthalmic goiter there is an excess of the thyroid secretion or thyroid autacoid which passes into the circulation, due to hypertrophy or hyperplasia of the secreting cells. The disease is characterized clini- ally by nervousness and irritability, rapid pulse, flushed and moist skin, tremor, and increased nitrogenous metabolism. A goiter is usually pres- ent, but not always noticeable. There is apt to be protrusion of the eyes, especially after the disorder is established, though it may never appear. A disturbed coordination of the muscles of the eyelid, eyeball, and orbit are frequent characteristic symptoms. Etiology. — The essential factor in the cause of this disease is prob- ably osteopathic lesions that irritate the secretory fibers of the thjToid tissue. These lesions are almost invariably found in the upper dorsal, first to fifth, and most often locafized at the second-third or third-fourth segments. They are definite interosseous changes, combined rotation and lateral flexion, and are generally very sensitive upon palpation. The 1. Macleod, Physiology and Biochemistry'in Modern Medicine. The Practice of Osteopathy 691 constant stimulus thus produced passes through the sj^mpathetic fibers to the cervical ganglia, and thence to thyroid secreting tissue, which through vascular changes and hypertrophy and hyperplasia increases the output of the thyroid hormone. The sensitiveness of the lesions is probably of more than passing in- terest. For this actual tenderness is not to be confused with a neuras- thenic state, which may be associated with the disease, or even be a source of confusion in the diagnosis. The lesion is of such a distinct character that there is considerable local irritation and congestion. This constant stimulus is a cause of the increased number of impulses carried to the sym- pathetic, and results in not only an excess of thyroid secretion and the concomitant hypertrophic changes, but also in the rapid removal of the colloid into the circulating blood. This seems to be a very important link in the pathologic chain. Other underlying lesions may be present, as outlined under simple goiter, and do not require repetition here. The mechanism of the thyroid gland may be further upset or derang- ed by various exciting causes, such as focal infections, toxic states, in- testinal stasis, and occasionally an enlarged thymus is an important factor. An inherited neuropathic tendency, excessive strain, worry, and mental shocks may have more or less influence in either predisposing or exciting the disorder. The particular points for the practitioner to remember are that ex- ophthalmic goiter is due to a toxic state, of which there are many grada- tions, from the excessive secretion of the thyroid gland; that the normal resistance of the gland is lowered through definite lesions of its innervation or circulatory channels, or occasionally of lesions of the other organs of internal secretion which are closely associated ; that infections and toxins are often important considerations; and that direct manipulation of the organ may increase the disorder. Pathology. — The enlargement of the thyroid gland is commonly an early symptom, occuring before the nervous, cardiac and exophthal- mic manifestations. There are instances where it follows a simple goiter, although Graves' disease does not seem to be any more prevalent in re- gions where simple goiter is endemic than elsewhere. In these particular instances intestinal toxemia is often present. There are cases where the gland is very slightly enlarged, containing only small areas of hyperplasia. There is usually very little colloid, though there may be marked excep- tions. It should be emphasized that there are various degrees of changes found in the gland though fimdamentally of the same order. The l)lood supply is estensive, and the veins expecially are fragile. The alveoli 692 The Practice of Osteopathy are distorted, due to the incresee of epithelial cells. Lymphoid nodules are frequently noted through the glandular tissue. Research work of unusual interest to the osteopathic physician pertaining to the etiology and pathology of exophthalmic goiter has been carried out at the Mayo Clinic. An examination of cervical sympa- thetic ganglia removed at operation from such cases and certain animal experimentation has given definite results. The following is a summary of their principal findings: "Degree of hyperpigmentation, granular degeneration, and reduc- tion in the number of cells was in direct ratio to the continuance of symp- toms of hyperthyroidism. The increased amount of perivascular con- nective tissue generally throughout the gland was similarly in direct ratio to the time during which symptoms of hyperthyroidism had con- tinued. "Increase of connective tissue in the ganglia from the chronic cases may be interpreted as due to the irritation from inflammation, or as merely a replacement following the destruction of the ganglionic nerve cells. "Ganglia were intimately connected by firm adhesions to the sur- rounding tissue. "There were changes in the outer and middle coats of vessels, and in the nerve fibers. There was an increase of connective tissue through- out the gangHon. "It appears that definite histologic changes do occur as (a) hyper- chromatization, (b) hyperpigmentation, (c) chromatolysis, and (d) atrophy, or (e) granular degeneration of the nerve cells. All of these are but successive steps in degeneration which, if uninterrupted, proceed to complete destruction of the ganghon cells affected. Not all of the gan- glion cells in any of the ganglia examined were so completely destroyed as to render improbable their return to normal under favorable condi- tions. There is some evidence that in ganglia from cases cHnically improved some of the cells have partially or wholly recovered. "^ They are inchned to the view that local infection in the cervical sympathetic gangha plays an important part in the etiology. The above pathologic changes of nerve fibers and ganglia support in many ways the findings noted at the A. T. Still Research Institute, not alone in the cervical region but in other regions of the body, that is, they are changes common to interosseous lesion pathology of various areas of the spine, and thus are predisposing factors that establish lowered resistance of tissue and derangement of function. 1 . Collected Papers of the Mayo Clinic, 1916, '17, '18. The Practice of Osteopathy 693 An important feature of the pathology is hyperplasia of the thymus. Simmonds finds it enlarged in three out of four cases. MacCallum^ has found it enlarged in all autopsies that he has seen. The lymphoid struc- tures of the spleen, hver, kidneys, intestines, and bone marrow is in- creased, while the lymphatic glands of various regions of the body may be enlarged, especially the cervical, bronchial, and axillary. This is probably due to a toxic condition. Dilatation and hypertrophy of the heart is common, and in advanced cases myocardial degeneration is apt to take place. Symptoms. — The outstanding feature of hyperthyroidism is the excessive secretion of the gland. The symptoms seem to be largely de- pendent upon the amount thrown into the blood-stream; still there is a possibihty that there may be a certain perversion of the secretion, though if such exists it has not been discovered. It should be kept in view that in certain instances where the secreting activity of the gland has been markedly curtailed, by surgical means, for instance, even to hypo-func- tioning there may still exist some of the symptoms of exophthalmic goi- ter, wliich goes to show that other factors may be of decided importance. The thymus and other related organs, as well as the sympathetic nerves, are not to be neglected. Kendall and Plummer (Mayo CUnic) ''believe that the location of the active constituent of the thyroid, when it functions, is within the cells not of any particular set of organs or portion of the body, but that it is a constituent of cellular hfe and activity. Plummer states that the ac- tive constituent of the thyroid determines the rate at which any partic- ular cell can produce energy, that is, it estabhshes the quantum energy which any cell can produce when it is stimulated, either from within it' self or from without, so that the thyroid is directly related to the produc- tion of energy within the body. He has shown that one-third of one mil- ligram of the active constituent of the thyroid increases the basal meta- bolic rate one per cent in an adult weighing approximately 150 pounds." This shows how important the secretion is not only to all related glands but to every cell of the body, and assists in estabUshing a physiological basis in the correlation of the symptoms of both hyper- and hypo-func- tioning of the organ. As a rule the thyroid is not greatly enlarged. The size, shape, and consistency varies. It may follow a simple goiter. Many of them are soft and jdelding, or cystic; others are hard, of a fibrous resistance, or nodular. Probably in the instances where hypertrophy is not discover- 1. MacCallum, A Text Book of Pathology. 694 The Practice of Osteopathy able there is hyperplastic tissue scattered through the gland. Or it is possible there may be an intrathoracic thyroid, or accessory tissue in other regions, varying from the root of the tongue to the aortic arch, which has become diseased. Generally, both lobes are enlarged, though the derangement may be confined to a portion. Often there is pulsa- tion and a thrill over the gland. Systolic murmurs are frequent. In the earty stage of goiter, tenderness is noticeable due to the distension of the capsule. The eye symptoms are: widened palpebral fissure or Dalrymple's sign; failure of the upper lid to follow the downward movem.ent of the eyeball or V. Graefe's sign; insufficiency of convergence of the two eyes or Moebius' sign; exophthalmos, which maj^ be unilateral (in about seven- tj' five percent of the cases); and rareness of involuntary winking, are the principal eye signs. Rapid heart action is an early and important symptom. This is given by all observers as the most constant of all symptoms. Pal- pitation is often disturbing. The pulse is forcible, especiallj^ in the ves- sels of the neck. There is generally a low blood pressure. The heart is apt to be dilated, and in chronic cases hypertrophy and degeneration are often found. A fine tremor, eight to ten times a second, is an important symp- tom. Tills is usually present and is considered one of the cardinal diag- nostic points. Profuse sweating, emaciation, muscular weakness, especially of the legs, vomiting, diarrhea, a feeling of dyspnea, and poljmria are frequent symptoms. Anxietj^, apprehension, headache, irritabihty, and fatigue are often early symptoms, but care should be taken that they are not entirely dependent upon a neurasthenic state. Pruritus may be a distressing symptom. There may be abnormal pigmentation. Menstrual derangements are common, especially amenor- rhea, owing to the anemia. And there may be various sexual disturb- ances. Exophthalmic goiter occurs oftener in women than in men. The disease is commonty a chronic one lasting several years, unless the morbid cycle can be broken; still there are cases where it appears very suddenly and runs a rapid course. McCarrison^ says: "Our consideration of the morbid changes met with in Graves' disease will have brought into prominence the fact that they are indicative of toxic action. The h'mphocytosis, the lymphatic hyperplasia, the h^mphocytic infiltration of the thyroid, the liver and 1. McCarrison, The Thyroid Gland. The Practice of Osteopathy 695 other organs; the chronic toxic inflammatory changes in the thyroid, liver and pancreas ; the changes in the muscles, in the nervous system and in the adrenals; all these point to a condition of chronic irritation as the underlying factor in their production, and to the gastro-intestinal tract as the most common source of the toxic irritant. " Diagnosis. — The diagnosis as a rule is not difficult. Difficulty may arise where there is incomplete development of the disorder. Irri- tation of the sympathetic nerves is of the greatest significance, for the characteristic symptoms are dependent upon this condition. Neuras- thenia, hysteria, paralysis agitans, and tobacco poisoning and alcohol- ism may mislead one. The enlarged and active gland, with murmur in the majoritj^ of cases, loss of weight, excessive sweating, diarrhea, tremor, and tachycardia, even without the eye symptoms, are specially significant. The tenderness of the osteopathic lesions is very often noticeable. Prognosis. — A great deal depends upon the cooperation of the patient. Rest and diet are such important features of the treatment, that if the patient is not wilUng to follow instructions, great difficulty will be encountered in securing satisfactory results. Adjustment of the lesions and elimination of toxins are highly essential, but only in a certain number of cases will this suffice. This, however, will usually lessen the severity of the condition, and the patient gets along fairly well, but this may be far from securing the possible maximum results. The duration of the disease is often from five to twenty years, or even longer. And the patient frequently dies from some intercurrent disease, particularly pneumonia and tuberculosis. Weakness of the heart is the most im- portant cause of death. Severe vomiting and diarrhea may so exhaust the patient that a fatal termination takes place. Surgical interference should not be too long delayed if there is no indication of improvement by other means. Treatment. — Every case requires individual study, owing to the many possible exciting causes, especially those where infections and tox- ins play so important a role. The four cardinal features of treatment are: adjustment of the osteopathic lesions, rest, diet, and elimination of infectious and metabolic poisons. Specific adjustment of the upper dorsal spine is primarily essential. The work should be definitely and quickly accomplished. Soft tissue manipulations amount to but little except as a preparation for the in- terosseous adjustment. Do not tire the patient. Often, following ex- act adjustment a definite lessening of the severe s3''mptoms will be notic- ed. The activity of the thyroid will be appreciably decreased; the heart's 696 The Practice of Osteopathy action slowed; the eye s\aiiptoms less noticeable; the tremor lessened; and the strength of the patient improved. Do not treat too often. Once a week is far better than every day. But usually twice a week in the ma- jority of cases will secure the best results. Then later once in two weeks will be the best course to pursue. The tissues are irritable, and require time to estabhsh a physiological balance, that if kept constantly excited by too frequent or too severe manipulation will increase rather than les- len the condition. This, however, does not apply to those cases where a certain amount of general treatment is demanded to improve systemic tone and overcome intestinal stasis, but even here do not undulj^ tire the patient, and keep away from the th3'roid innervation except at stated intervals. There is nothing more important in osteopathic therapy, ex- cept definite adjustment, than not over-treating. The cervical region should be normalized, and the upper ribs and clavicles carefully adjusted. But leave the gland alone, for manipulation over it further stimulates its function and there is a possibility of rup- turing its fragile vessels. Normalization of the entire spine is important, owing to its bearing upon interdependent relationship, mechanically and physiologicalh^, and the necessity of correcting all metabolic irregular- ities. Both physical and mental rest are essential. This tends to les- sen the excitability of the nerves, conserves the strength, increases the metabolism, improves muscle tone, and rests the heart. At least several extra hours in bed is always best. Lying down two or three hours during the middle of the day will accomplish considerable. In severe cases absolute rest in bed until the disorder is under control is impera- tive. In mild and moderate cases all excessive fatigue should be avoided. Unless such measures are followed the treatment otherwise may not ac- complish anything. Stopping short of fatigue is the rule that must be followed. The diet is important in order that the strength may be increased and harmful foods eliminated. If the carbohydrates in the small intes- tine are not sufficient, they may decompose into toxic substances that are harmful when absorbed into the circulation. An abundance of green vegetables and fresh fruit is best. Milk, fermented milk, butter milk, butter and cream are allowable. The patient should drink freely of wa- ter. Meat should be used sparingly, and avoid tea, coffee, and condi- ments. Free elimination and fresh air are also important. It is the aggre- gate of details that counts so much, particularly in such a toxic and ex- The Practice of Osteopathy 697 citable disease as exophthalmic goiter. The neutral bath (95 to 96 de- grees) is better than either hot or cold baths. In such a nervous disease as this, suggestion is unquestionably a valuable measure in quieting the nerves and improving the mental viewpoint. All focal infections, such as often found in the throat, nose, and buccal cavity, in the appendix region, gall-bladder, etc., should be erad- icated. If under carefully controlled treatment the patient does not defi- nitely respond within from two weeks to a month, surgical measures should be seriously considered. Myxedema Myxedema is a chronic disease due to loss of thyroid function, and characterized by markedly decreased metabohsm, trophic disturbances of the skin and subcutaneous tissues, and a cessation of mental develop- ment corresponding to the time of the injury of the thj^roid. McCarrison restricts the term " cretinism" to those cases where there is congenital thyroid deficiency. "After the first year of life, when ossification has proceeded to the extent of closure of the fontanelles, the case is only distinguishable from one of cretinism by this fact." In the child, all the functions are depressed, there is a low temperature, the bones do not develop, and the child may become stout. The mental development is retarded, and also the sex organs. In the adult cases there is the same depressed metabolism. The skin is sallow, dry, and increased in thickness. The tongue is enlarged, the lips thick, and the feet and hands considerably changed in size. The nails may be thickened, and the hair falls out. The abdomen is apt to be pendulous. Heavy pads occur below the clavicles and on the chest, neck, abdomen, and sexual organs. Usually the thyroid cannot be pal- pated. In a few, the gland may be goitrous. The mental faculties are sluggish. The speech is slow, and the voice more or less changed. Physical exertion is an effort, and the pa- tient may have some difficulty in walking. And there is anemia, loss of appetite, and poor digestion. The number and character of symptoms are innumerable, depending upon the extent of thyroid insufficiency, and often upon predisposing and associated disorders. But the essen- tial symptoms are those pertaining to the skin, and the mental apathy. In children the retarded physical and mental growth is the outstanding coiKhtion. Development of the disorder is slow. Etiology,— Leoions of the thvroid innervation may cause a lessened 69S The Practice of Osteopathy function of the gland, for correction of the lesions has been followed by markedly definite improvement in a number of cases. The disorder has followed operation on the gland. In other cases some form of infection^ primary or secondary, is probably the cause of the injury and subsequent atrophy. In some instances there is evidently a family- tendency. It occurs more frequently in women, and in cold than in hot climates. The menopause seems to be a predisposing factor. Overwork, anxiety, poor nutrition, and conditions that lower tissue resistance, are among the etiological considerations. In well marked cases the diagnosis is easy. In others the disease may be mistaken for nephritis or jaundice. X-ray examination of the ossification centers is of decided value. The prognosis, in untreated cases, is considered hopeless, the duration being from four to seven years. The treatnidnt with thyroid extract, or alpha-iodine, has resulted in mark- ed improvement, though in severe cases it must be kept up continuously in order to supply the deficiency. Treatment. — There have been several well marked cases that have responded to the osteopathic treatment. Adjustment of the lesions af- fecting the gland, and attention to the general health have been the meth- ods administered. The response in a number of children has been most notable. In fact, to such an extent that all faculties and functions were completely recovered. Even in cases where thyroid extract had been administered with comparatively little results, the adjustment of the up- per dorsal and cervical lesions, with attention to the diet, elimination, and general hygiene, was followed by normalization. That the thyi'oid function when deranged, hyperthyi'oidism, hy- pothyi'oidism, or otherwise, can often be recovered through osteopathic treatment, adds a very important therapeutic measure in the treatment of this gland. But in view of the brilhant results secured in hypothy- roidism, through the administration of the thyroid extract, one should not hesitate to use it if improvement is not otherwise forthcoming. Never- theless, the very important point remains that thyroid extract is only suppljdng a necessary substance, however essential, to the bodily meta- bolism, and does not strike at the essential etiology of the disorder. Cretinism It should be kept in mind that there are many gradations and alter- ations in both hyperthyroidism and hypothyroidism, and that a ''goiter"" may present either picture, partly or wholly, or on the other hand may be normally functioning. The Practice of Osteopathy 699 MacCallum says: "Unlike the myxedema cases which occur any- where and everywhere, regardless of environment or hereditary tainb, these people, known as cretins, are found in regions where the condition seems to be endemic or inherent in the environment, and we can usually trace in their parents or ancestors some similar thyroid defect. " This disease is found in various countries, particularly in certain parts of Switzerland, Austria, and Italy. McCarrison presents an inter- esting study of 203 cases of Endemic Cretinism found in Himalayan In- dia. He thinks it is due to infection. There are a few cases in North America, probably mostly due to immigration. It is frequently confus- ed with myxedema. Cretins are of short stature, flat-chested and pot-bellied. The face is broad, low forehead, broad nose, prominent cheeks, thick lips, and large nose. The development of the bones is retarded; the skin is thickened and edematous; the hair is thin, and the nails brittle; the sexual organs as a rule do not develop; and in most cases a goiter, sometimes of huge size, is present. Most of them are stupid and apathetic; others are dis- tinct idiots. Deafness is common. There are sporadic and endemic cases, but the same underlying cause is probably present. It is claimed that most cases of the former should be classed as congenital myxedema. Early diagnosis is essential. Removal of the patient from the goiter region, and thyroid substance is the treatment given, though results are not so marked as in myxedema. DISEASES OF THE PARATHYROID GLANDS Tetany The chnical manifestations of the insufficiency of function of the parathjrroid glands is well understood. This came about through the study of endemic tetany, and, especially, noting that tetany followed operations when the entire thyroid gland was removed. Considerable experimental work on animals was next in order, until the discovery was made that the thyroid gland and parathyroids are anatomically indepen- dent, and that tetany is entirely dependent upon the loss of function of the parathyroid glands. Operative tetany is now comparatively rare, since the surgeon is parti culai'ly careful not to injure the parathyroids in his operations on goiters, though mild forms may occur through damage of the tissues or ex-tension of inflammatory processes. There are other forms of tetany aside from operative, that occur in both adults and children, but instability and insufficiency of the func- 700 The Practice of Osteopathy tion of the glands are basic to all cases. This is the common factor, which may be modified by tissue resistance and various hygienic factors. In tetany there are paroxysmal, and often painful, contractions of the muscles of the extremities. Both sides are affected, and occasionally the spasms may extend to other muscles of the body. This is due to an abnormal excitability of the nervous system. Probably the secretion of the parath\Toids have normally a restraining effect upon the nervous impulses, which when removed, or insufficient, or possil^ly perverted, re- sults in the tonic spasms. Thus the predisposing condition of tetany may be either acquired or congenital. Children may be born with defective parathja-oids. In such instances there is probably a hypoplasia of tissue, which may markedly vary in a series of cases, and give rise to different degrees of tetany. Other factors, nutritional and toxic, would, very likely, be im- portant exciting causes. Hemorrhages and fibrosis have been noted in some cases, that add to the injury of the tissues. The blood and nerve tissues in tetany show a decreased amount of calcium. It is claimed by some that the abnormal excitability of the nervous system is due to the lack of calcium. Noel Paton^ believes that, though this maj^ bear some relationship, the parathyi-oids control the metabolism of guanidine, and that guanidine intoxication is the cause of the symptoms. Guanidine seems to regulate the tone of the skeletal muscles, and is closely related to urea. Tetany may occur under many conditions: during pregnancy and nursing, the infectious and nutritional diseases, the diseases of the thyroid and very often gastro-intestinal disorders. There are various exciting causes, such as cold, worry, overfatigue, etc. Alcohol, ergot, morphine, chloroform, and other poisoning may precipitate an attack. But in all these cases the parathyroids are previously damaged. The blood supply to the glands is from branches supplying the thyroid organ. This intimacy implies that the same sympathetic nerves to the thyroid vessels are in control. Probably there are distinct secre- tory nerves, as well as vasomotors, that are connected with the upper dorsal and cervical sympathetics. Lesions related to the corresponding spinal areas probably affect the integrity of the parathyroid function. Schafer says: "The parathyroids are amongst the most vascular organs in the body. They are supplied each by a special branch of the inferior thyroid artery. The sinus-like capillaries come into close rela- tionship with the epithelial cells of the gland. The nerves of the parathy- 1. Paton and Finlay, Jour. Exp. Phys., 1917. The Practice of Osteopathy 701 roids, like those of the thyroids, pass both to the vessels and to the se- creting cells. Some evidence has been adduced which seems to show that the cell-activity is controlled by the nervous system." Hence it would seem that in many cases of tetany, aside from those cases due to operative injury and possibly certain congenital instances, osteopathic lesions affecting the nerve and vascular supply of the organs may so lessen, or pervert, the secreting cells that tetanic states may supervene, especially where lowered nutrition, toxins, and infections are inciting factors. Symptoms. — The tonic contraction of the muscles may last a few minutes or may persist for several hours, and are usually confined to the hands and feet. The fingers and toes are first affected by the spasm, which extends upward toward elbows and knees. This is commonly preceded by numbness and more or less pain in the parts. Occasionally there is a general ill-feeling, depression, and headache. There may be rise of temperature, and some edema of the affected parts. There are no mental symptoms. The fingers are partly flexed at the metacarpo-phalangeal joints and rigidly extended at the inter-phalangeal joints, the thumb is markedly adducted and the fingers drawn close together. The wrist may be flexed, and in severe cases the elbows flexed and adducted. When the feet are contracted the toes are drawn together, flexed, and may overlap, and the feet are arched. Trousseau's phenomenon. — The spasm is increased by pressure over the median or ulnar nerves, or blood-vessels supplying the parts. This may also excite an attack. Chvostek's phenomenon. — Percussion over the facial nerve will cause quick contraction of the muscles innervat- ed. Erb's phenomenon. — The electrical excitabihty of the motor nerves is markedly increased. Diagnosis. — The characteristic attitude, and the irritability of the motor and sensory nerves, make diagnosis easy. It may be confused with meningitis, but in tetany there are no brain symptoms, while in meningitis there are no characteristic signs of tetany. Generally, there is little probability of confusing the disease with tetanus, or hysteria. Treatment. — Most cases are of a mild type, and recovery is the rule. A great deal depends upon the underlying cause. Malnutrition, if long continued, is a very important factor that may readily predispose to the disorder. Rickets in children is often a basic consideration. Rest, warm baths, and careful inhibitory relaxation of the tissues 702 The Practice of Osteopathy materially assist in controlling the spasms. Attention to the thyroid innervation should not be neglected. In indicated cases th>Toid feeding ma}^ be of assistance. The diet is of special importance, for many cases present some disorder of the gastro-intestinal tract. Meat should not be given. Milk is of great value, owing to its calcium content. The administration of calcium is highly recommended, for reasons stated under etiology. Diseases of the Thymus There is little known relative to the functions of the thymus. It is most active during the growth of the body, attaining its greatest weight from the eleventh to fifteenth j^ears, after which it gradually atrophies, though a certain amount of the tissue remains throughout life. There is usually a gradual atrophy of the organ after puberty, associated with increase of connective and adipose tissues. In cases where it does not atrophy, there is often hyperplasia of the entire lymphatic system in the body. There is some relationship between the thjaiius and sexual organs, and in experiments where the organ has been removed, ossification is delayed, muscular weakness and tremor occur, there is hyperplasia of the thyroid, parathyroids, and adrenals, and general cachexia, acidosis, and mental deterioration take place. The inferior thyroid and internal mammary arteries from above, and the pericardiophrenic from below, comprise its arterial supply. The nerve supply is from the sympathetic, vagus, and possibly the phrenic. In cases of exophthalmic goiter there is frequently an associated en- largement of the thymus, which may be shown by the X-ray, due to fail- ure of normal involution or a renewal of growth, that msiy be definitely influenced by adjustment of the osteopathic lesions. In some of the acute infections as pneumonia the thymus may atro- phy with some fatty degeneration and increase of connective tissue. This also occurs in starvation. If the condition is not of long standing recovery will take place. In status lymphatieus there is hyperplasia of the thymus and enlargement of the lymphoid tissue of the body, and hypoplasia of the cardiovascular system. This is a constitutional defect, so that slight injuries or infections may prove fatal. It is found in some cases that there is hypoplasia of the chromaffin system. Whether this latter condi- tion is primary or secondary has not been settled. In males the secondary sexual characteristics are not fully developed. The Practice of Osteopathy 70S The figure resembles the feminine type. The skin is pasty, and the beard is lacking or but httle developed. In females the distribution of the hair may be somewhat similar to the male sex, slender limbs and chest, and disturbances of the menstrual function are noticeable. The thyroid, thymus and lymphatic tissues are usually enlarged,, while there is hypoplasia of the adrenals and chromaffin system. The condition is met with in children who have a weak muscular system, increased adipose tissue, pasty complexion, enlarged tonsils and adenoids, and frequently are anemic. In children where the thymus is ' enlarged there may be excessive lymphocytosis. The enlarged thymus may compress the trachea, interfering with breathing so that cyanosis and temporary loss of consciousness occur. Young children may die in the attack, probably due to compression of the trachea or to heart shock. Death in adults has ocurred from trifling injuries, shocks, infections, and anesthesia. The underlying cause is probably a constitutional weakness. Diagnosis is made from the cKnical signs, percussion of the thy- mus and the X-ray picture, although these may not be positive. An excessive lymphocytosis is suggestive. Treatment should consist of good general care of the patient, avoidance of injuries and shocks as far as possible, and careful atten-. tion to all lesions, especially of the upper chest and neck. By following this plan the child may overcome the condition. X-ray treatment is being employed with success in some cases. Operations have been successful in thymic hyperplasia where it has complicated exophthalmic goiter, and also in serious mechanical pressure in children. Diseases of the Adrenal Glands Experimental work supports the view that the cortex and the medulla have separate functions. The medulla of the adrenals is part of the chromaffin system, which includes tissue of the same character in the ganglia of the sympathetic, the carotid gland, and the accessory gland called Zuckerkand's organ. This system is derived from the same cells as the s>Tnpathetic nerves. The medulla receives a richer blood supply than any tissue in the body. The secretion of the chiomaffin tissue is called adrenalin or epinephrin. The blood receives a continuous supply of the secretion, which acts upon the small blood-vessels and as- sists' in maintaining blood-pressure. It also stimulates glandular tis- sue, and has some effect upon voluntary muscle which tends to counter- act fatigue. 704 The Practice of Osteopathy The cortex of the adi-enal glands is of epitheUal origin, and is part of the so-called interrenal system, which comprises very small masses of tissue in the s>anpathetic ganglia. These are located in the hilus of the kidney, broad ligament, inguinal canal, prostate, epididymis, and along the spermatic veins (Baker). The cortex is the chief glandular tissue of the interrenal system. The amount of tissue is not so great after pu- bert}' as before. The blood supply of the cortex is not so rich as that of the medulla. Abnormal activity is claimed to be the cause of certain • sexual derangements, particularly sexual precocity. Schafer states that the adrenals are very richly supplied with nerves. Each receives no less than thirty-three nervous filaments (KolUker), derived in part directly from the splanchnic, in part from the suprarenal plexus, which is itself constituted by branches from the cehac, phrenic, and renal plexuses. We have noted that in lesions (experimental) of the splanchnics a few cases presented acute pathological changes, congestion with some degeneration of cells, in the adrenals. Macleod states that of the many functions of the adrenals that which is most dii-ectly associated with epinephrin is the production of glucose from glycogen. "When the nervous system is stimulated in such a way as to excite the glycogenolytic process, two effects both operating in the same dii'ection with regard to the glycogenic function are develop- ed : the one, a hypersecretion of epinephrin, which activates the sympa- thetic ner^-e endings, the other, the transmission of the nerve impulse to the hver cell. " Addison's Disease This is a rare, chronic disease, more often occurring in men, that is chara cterized by muscular and vascular weakness, digestive disturbances, and pigmentation. Tuberculosis of the adrenals has been the most constant lesion found. In others, syphilis and atrophy have been noted, while in a few the condition seemed to be functional. It should be re- membered that it is possible that lesions elsewhere in the chromaffin system may be the cause in some cases, for all the chromaffin tissues secrete adrenalin. It is quite likely that in most cases there is some constitutional de- fect of the chromaffin system which underlies a certain tendency to the disorder. Infections, injuries, physical and mcental strains may lower resistance and predispose to the condition. Osteopathic lesions of the splanchnics may congest the organs, or The Practice of Osteopathy 705 derange the secretions, or be of such a character that hemorrhages result, or fibrous changes follow, that would definitely incapacitate the cells and lower resistance. Pathologically, the most common change is tuberculosis. Next in importance aie atrophy and interstitial inflammation. Cancer of the organs has been noted in a few. The adrenal ganglia, the semilunar gan- gha, and the solar plexus are often involved. The thyroid gland may be altered, which, when affected, is usually decreased in size. Brown atrophy of the heart is common. Symptoms. — An insidious onset with muscular weakness, lan- guor, and weak action of the heart are generally the first symptoms. Digestive derangements, such as nausea, hyperacidity, loss of appetite, may occur at the same time, or shortly succeed the general debility. Headache, insomnia, and depression frequently take place. Pigmenta- tion, usually, shortly follows, though there are cases where it is only sHghtly noted. The disease is very chronic, of several years duration, with periods of intermission. Occasionally, a case runs a very rapid course. The general weakness is most noticeable. There is low blood-pres- sure. The derangement of the stomach and intestines is characteristic. And the pigmentation, which at first is light yellow later assumes a dark brown color. The pigmentation may be more or less general, but the axillae, nipples, genitals, the palms of the hands, and the neck, waist or wherever the clothing presses upon the skin, are most pigmented. And pigmentation of the mucous membrane may be noted. Diagnosis. — In typical cases, where there is esthenia, pigmentation, and gastro-intestinal disturbances, the diagnosis is not difficult. Where the chnical picture is incomplete, the diagnosis may be very difficult. Pigmentation may occur in several other disorders, notably: in bronzed diabetes, abdominal mahgnancy, tuberculosis of the peritoneum, exophthahnic goiter, pellagra, marked intestinal stasis, stomach ulcer, pernicious anemia, certain skin diseases, etc., so great care has to be taken in atypical cases. Treatment. — General treatment, with special attention to the adrenal innervation, diet, rest, and fresh air will accomphsh something. In functional derangements, which are very few, recovery may follow. But owing to the often constitutional defect, the probability of tubercu- lar, syphilitic, and other serious lesions, the prognosis is unfavorable. 706 The Practice of Osteopathy DISEASES OF THE NERVOUS SYSTEM DISEASES OF THE NERVES Neuritis Neuritis is an inflammation of the nerve fibers. It may be con- fined to a single nerve, localized; or general, involving a large nmnber of nerves, when it is known as multiple neuritis. Osteopathically, there are invariably lesions of the osseous or muscular tissues, that corre- spond to the nerve fibers involved. The lesion either irritates the nerve directly or disturbs the circulation to the nerve. In those cases where the osteopathic lesion is not the immediate exciting cause, there will be found anatomical irregularities that predispose to the affection. Localized neuritis maj^ be due to: Local osteopathic lesions; Exposure to cold; septic foci; traumatism; and inflammation of contig- uous tissues. Multiple Neuritis may be due to: Osteopathic lesions, which are associated with infectious diseases, as in diphtheria, typhoid, scarlet fever, etc.; prolonged strain or exposure; metabolic poisons, as in dia- betes, anemia, tuberculosis, cancer, etc.; alcohol, lead, mercury and ar- senic poisoning; and beri-beri, which is probably due to lack of vitam- ins, or possibly microorganisms, or carbonic gas poisoning. The inflammation may chiefly involve the connective tissue surround- ing the nerve — peri-neuritis — or it may involve the deeper structure — in- terstitial neuritis. Parenchymatous neuritis is really a degenera- tion, due to excessive or prolonged irritation or pressure which cuts the nerves off from their centers. This is found in deeply seated osteopathic lesions. In experimental osteopathic lesions the first effect is degenera- tion of the medullary sheath. This is followed by degeneration of the axis cyhnder. The local circulation is notably impaired. An acutely inflamed nerve is red and swollen. In peri-neuritis there is an infiltra- tion of the nerve sheath with leucocytes. In the interstitial form, lymphoid cells are found between the nerve bundles. In the parenchy- matous form, inflammatory signs are wanting. The muscles atrophy. Associated in all these forms the osteopathic lesion plays either an ex- citing or predisposing role, by disturbing nutrition to the tissue and thus setting up inflammation, which may lead to-Wallerian degeneration^ Symptoms. — Localized Neuritis. — In the case of a sensory nerve, 1. See Osteopathic Lesion — ^ Journal of American Osteopathic Association. May, 1906, and Deason's Physiology. The PRA.CTICE of Osteopathy 707 there is severe pain following the course of the affected nerve, with tender- ness upon pressure. This may be followed by loss of sensibility. Troph- ic symptoms, such as glossiness of the skin and brittle nails, arise in more chronic cases, while in advanced cases, there is wasting of the muscles. Sweating, herpes, and occasionally effusion into the joints, occur. When a motor nerve is principally affected, muscular power is impaired, motion painful and muscular twitchings will occur. Finally contractions, wast- ing of the muscles, and even reactions of degeneration, may take place. A rare form is the so-called ascending neuritis, in which the inflamma- tion extends upward from the peripheral nerves to the larger nerve trunks, or even the spinal cord, resulting in myelitis. This occurs most common- ly in traumatic neuritis. The duration is variable. Many acute cases get well in a few days. Other cases may persist for months and even years. Multiple Neuritis. — Inflammation involving several nerves which are affected simultaneously or in rapid succession. Acute form. — The attack usually follows overexertion or exposure to cold and wet, with probably some infection. This form is characterized by a chill, followed b}^ a rapid rise in temperature which may reach 103 or 104 degrees F.; headache; pains in the back and limbs. There is weakness of the legs or arms, depending upon region involved, which may be so severe that the muscles atrophy. Sensory symptoms are variable. Most cases re- cover, though there are instances where the vagi, the nerves to the blad- der, rectum, or heart, may be involved. Alcoholic Neuritis results from a moderate amount of alcohohc drinking, continued over a long time. The first symptoms are usually numbness and tingUng in the fingers and toes. Loss of power soon be- comes marked, first in the lower, and then in the upper, extremities. The extensor muscles are most affected, causing wrist and foot drop. Occasionally there is paraplegia. There are hyperesthesia, tenderness and pain, especially in the legs. The cutaneous reflexes are commonly intact, and the deep reflexes, as a rule, are lost. DeHrium is common, and hallucinations or iflusions occur. Neuritis from lead poisoning usually present the "wrist drop" and "foot drop", with colic, and "blue line" on gums. Infectious Diseases neuritis is due to an attack of some infectious disease, and may be local or multiple. It is due to toxic materials absorb- ed into the blood. It is most common after diphtheria. The sj^mptoms presented are those of neuritis due to any other cause. Senile neuritis is pro})ably due to arteriosclerosis. 708 ' The Practice of Osteopathy Diagnosis. — As a rule, the diagnosis is not difficult. In the alco- holic form in some instances, there may be difficulty, and in cases with paralysis, care should be taken. The prognosis of neuritis is generally favorable. Treatment. — It is very evident that the successful treatment of neuritis depends upon being able to ascertain the cause. Rest is im- portant in all cases. Rarely has one any difficulty in locating the derang- ed structures that are predisposing to the attack; and usually correction of these disturbances, which are in the region involve^, will give consider- able relief. If the parts are too sensitive to handle insist on absolute rest and hot fomentations. The affected area should be kept warm and protected. Attention to the diet, and free elimination, are important. Metabolic disorders should be corrected, if possible. Give particular attention to any septic foci. A change of occupation may be necessary in some cases. In alcohoHc cases, the alcohol should be stopped as soon as possible. Passive movements and massage are helpful, but of course bear no com- parison to specific osteopathic treatment. Relaxation of muscles along the spinal column and along the course of the nerve will at least give temporary relief. If contractures and other changes remain after the acute attack, per- sistent treatment will generally result in recovery. (See also Painful Shoulders, Part I.) Sciatica is usually a neuritis of the sciatic nerve, although all pain- ful affections of the nerve are termed sciatica. In some cases it is a neuralgia when the nerve is swollen and presents an interstitial neu- ritis. Osteopatliic Etiology. — This affection occurs more frequently in males than in females. The usual period for sciatica is from the twen- tieth to the fiftieth year and the principal causes are vertebral lesions of the lower dorsal and lumbar vertebrae, especially lesions to the fourth and fifth lumbar. Occasionally the lesion is a subdislocated innomina- tum, a downward displacement of a floating rib or a partial dislocation of the femur. Other causes are exposure to cold, contraction of muscles, gout, rheumatism and syphihs. Contraction of the pyriformis muscle may bring direct pressure on the nerve. Focal infections, arthritis of the articular processes of the lower spine, and sacro-iliac and hip-joint disease should not be overlooked. In a few cases there are intraplevic causes, such as uterine and ovarian tumors, rectal accumulations and the fetal head dui'ing labor. Enlarged prostate may be a factor. It The Practice of Osteopathy 709 is possible for the roughened edges of the sacro-iliac joint, internally, to irritate the sacral plexus as it passes over and thus keep up the pain. This may explain the occasional failure of treatment. Symptoms. — Pain in the nerve along its course is the most con- stant s^-mptom. The pain is most intense back of the thigh and above the hip-joint. The pain radiates downward through the entire nerve; it is of an annoying character and walking is especially painful. In rare cases there is wasting of the muscles, cramps, herpes and edema. In a few cases the neuritis may extend to the spinal cord. Diagnosis. — The diagnosis of sciatica is usually easy. Care has to be taken in the examination to determine whether the affection is primary or secondary. It is difficult, in some cases, to locate the or- igin of the disturbance, especially if it is in the lumbar vertebrae, as fre- quently a very slight deviation of a vertebra will cause the disease; or some focal infection may be difficult to locate; or malformation of the fifth lumbar may be present; or asymmetrj^ of the legs or the body be a factor. Careful palpation, measurements, and the X-ray are of diag- nostic importance. HIp-|oInt disease and sacro-iliac disease can generally be easily distinguished from this affection. The lightning pains of tabes may simulate sciatica, but then there are other well de- fined s3Tiiptoms of the disease. Treatment. — Sciatica rarely runs a very long course, though there are cases that last for years. The treatment ahnost wholly depends upon the cause. If the cause can be determined at once, the probabiHties are that severe cases may be relieved by a few treatments. Correction of the vertebrae, to relieve impingements to the nerve fibers as they pass through the intervertebral foramina, usually constitutes the primary treat- ment. Carefully examine the pelvic organs for disturbances. Occas- ionallj'- deep treatment over the iliac vessels will be of great help. The innominatum, if deranged, should be corrected and all troubles of the hip-joint that are found must be corrected. Cases of rheumatism and gout should receive their separate treat- ments, besides careful manipulations of the affected leg. Rest in bed should be insisted upon; this will usually markedly lessen the duration of the inflammation. Adjustment of the special points found deranged and a thorough treatment, if conditions permit, of the entire leg will be beneficial. Hot fomentations applied along the course of the nerve, and an inhibitory treatment back of the trochanter will at least give temporary relief. Extension of the leg is effective. Placing a patient upon his back and flexing the leg and thigh upon the abdomen, at the 710 The Practice of Osteopathy same time keeping the leg straight and the foot flexed, is an effectual stretching method. As a rule, sciatica readily responds to osteopathy. Neuralgia Neuralgia means simply "nerve pain. " The term neuralgia should be restricted to such nerve pains as are not caused by structural changes in the nerves. In cases where the pain is due to organic changes in the nerves, the disease should not be classed as a neuralgia, although it is practically impossible to draw an absolute line between functional and organic disturbances for the one may gradually progress (pathologically) into the other. In neuralgia there is always disturbance of the blood supply to nervous tissue, which may be of the character of congestive irritation, ischemia or altered states of the blood wherein it contains toxic substances or is below normal quality. It is well known that osteopath- ic lesions are ver}- common etiological factors. Osteopathic Etiology. — Neuralgia is essentially a disease of adults. It rarely occurs before puberty or late in life. Women are more prone to neuralgia than men and the tendency may sometimes be hereditary. Sufferers from neuralgia often present a pecuUar ''nervous temperament. " The exciting causes of neuralgia are impairment of general health; irritations of the nerve fiber or trunk by a displaced bone, hgament or muscle, which may affect the nervous tissue directly by mechanical ir- ritation, or indirectly, by the disturbance of its blood supply, or toxic agents; exposure to cold or damp; overwork and worry; toxic influences of various diseases, as malaria, lead poisoning and alcoholism; irritation from carious teeth, and various septic foci. Symptoms. — Pain, which is spontaneous and paroxysmal, is the most prominent symptom. It may be described as " darting, " " shooting," "burning," "stabbing," "boring," etc. The pain is usually unilateral, following the course of the sensory nerves, and there are generally tender points along the course of the nerve. Especially are there points of tenderness near the central end of the nerve, where the displaced struc- tures are irritating it. After the pain has continued for some time the skin becomes tender, reddened and swollen. The redness and edema are supposed to be due to vasomotor changes. Muscular spasms, trophic disturbances, skin eruptions, herpes and grayness of the hair are of rare occurrence. The duration of an attack varies from a number of min- utes to a few hours. Neuralgia of the Fifth Nerve. — This is by far the most frequent variety of neuralgia, and it is generally due to a displaced atlas or infer- The Practice of Osteopathy 711 ior maxilla. The teeth sinuses, and other possible regions of focal in- fections should be thoroughly investigated. Anemia and products of metabohsm may be underlying factors. All the branches of the fifth nerve are rarely involved. The ophthalmic division is most often affect- ed; pain and tenderness being present about the supraorbital notch or foramen, the palpebral branch at the outer part of the eyelid, the nasal branch, and occasionally an ocular pain will be felt within the eye- ball. When the infraorbital hranch is involved, pain and tenderness are principally present at the infraorbital, nasal and malar points. When the third division is affected, the chief tender places are the inferior dental, temporal and parietal points. In nearly all cases of neuralgia of the fifth nerve, there is extreme tenderness in the region of the artic- ulation of the atlas and the occipital, particularly the side on which the fifth nerve is involved. This tenderness in a few cases may be found as low as the second or third cervical vertebra. The pain may be so severe as to cause edema along the course of the affected nerve fibers, grayness of the eyebrows and locks of hair chiefly in the temporal region, and con- vulsive twitching of muscles. Tic Douloureux is a. vastly exaggerated neuralgia of the fifth nerve and is supposed to be a primary affection of the Gasserian ganghon. Starting in middle Hfe from no apparent cause it increases in severity until it becomes unbearable and suicide is not an infrequent result. Many methods to relieve have been tried including destruction of the ganglion but with various results. Treatment should be the same as in the milder form of neuralgia but it will require critical examination to determine the causes which are liable to be obscure. Cervico-Occipital Neuralgia. — This varietj'' involves the poster- ior branches of the first four cervical nerves, affecting the region of the posterior part of the neck and head. The pain may extend as far forward as the parietal eminence and the ear. The chief tender points are about midway between the mastoid process and the spine, between the sternomastoid and trapezius (branches of the cervical plexus), and a point just above the parietal eminence. This form of neuralgia is chief- ly due to subluxation of the upper four or live cervical vertebrae irritating the posterior branches of the spinal nerves. A draught of air or exposure to cold are common exciting causes. The pain is of a sharp lancinating nature or else it is heavy and tense. Tuberculosis of the cer- vical spine may be an underlying cause. Cervico-Brachlal and Brachial Neuralgia. — In these forms of 712 The Practice of Osteopathy neuralgia the pain is referred to the area suppHed by the four lower cer- vical and the first dorsal nerves. The tender points are in the axilla along the course of the ulnar, the circumflex at the posterior part of the deltoid and points at the lower and posterior part of the neck. The lesions exciting this form of neuralgia are usually found in the upper dorsal and upper cervical spines, but they may be as low as the sixth dorsal or as high as the atlas. As far as neuralgia of the ulnar nerve alone is concerned, it can be traced to the seventh and eighth cervical and first dorsal, and the lesion may be found occasionally at the fifth dorsal verte- bra or rib. How a lesion as low as the fifth dorsal affects the ulnar nerve, it is hard to say definitely. There may be fibers directly to the ulnar nerve as low as this region, the nerve may be reflexly affected, the vaso- motor supply to the ulnar nerve may be disturbed, or possibly the lesion interferes with fibers of the deep layers of the back muscles and thus con- traction of muscles for some distance above the lesion would affect the ulnar and other nerves. The scaleni may be affected and involve the plexus. A bursitis may be present (See Painful Shoulders Part I). Fo- cal infections are sometimes factors. Trunk Neuralgia. — This includes dorso-intercostal and Imnbo- abdominal neuralgia. The former, dorso-intercostal neuralgia, affects the intercostal nerves from the third to ninth dorsal, and is character- ized by pain along the intercostal spaces, or in a few of them. The pain may be bilateral and sjTiimetrical, which usually shows a vertebral lesion. Three points of tenderness are usually noted, viz., near the median line in front, and midway between these two points in the mid- axillary fine. The pain is usually dull with acute exacerbations. Les- ions of the vertebrae and ribs in the locality affected are by far the principal causes. Cold, exposure, strains, etc., are exciting causes of every-day occurrence. When the pain is bilateral and s\aiimetrical the lesion is usually in the vertebra; when unilateral the rib alone may be involved. The most common lesion is a crowding together of the ribs anteriorly at the fifth and sixth interspaces. Carefully exclude a pos- sible tuberculosis of the spine or ribs, aneurism, etc. The pain of herpes zoster is not neuralgic, but neuritic, involving the posterior spinal ganglion. Pleurodynia, strictly speaking, is neural- gia of the pleural nerves, and not of the intercostals, but a deranged rib over the region of the pain is commonly the cause of the pleurodynia. Lumbo-abdominal neuralgia involves the posterior branches of the lumbar nerves. Tender points are found near the vertebrae, middle of the iliac crest, lower part of the rectus, and in the male occas- The Practice of Osteopathy 713 sionally in the scrotum, in the female in the labia. These are often bi- lateral and are usually of a constricting nature. The ihoscrotal branch is the one most commonly affected. Subluxation of the vertebrae, and other lesions, as contracted muscles, are found along the lumbar vertebrae, and even as high as the lower dorsal vertebrae. Also lesions are found at the lumbo-sacral ar- ticulation. Pelvic disease is also a cause. A downward displacement of the lower ribs, eleventh and twelfth, is a common disorder and may be the cause of severe neuralgic pains in the region of the ihac fossae. It may simulate ovarian inflammation, renal colic, or even appendicitis if on the right side. And septic kidney has been wrongly diagnosed from these lesions. In fact it may be a cause of inflammation of the deeper structures, such as the ovary and Fallopian tube. A subluxation of the vertebrae at the fourth and fifth dorsals may cause severe neuralgic pains in the epigastrium. Neuralgia of the Spinal Column. — According to medical writers this is especially found in weakly women and after concussion of the spine ; that it is a troublesome symptom in hysteria, and in many cases it is due to a reflex stimulus from diseased viscera. Most of this is undoubtedly true, but they have not found out the real significance of these neuralgic pains. The various tender points along the spinal column are of para- mount importance to the osteopath as a guide to his diagnosis; not only in certain cases, but in nearly every case. The tender points are not due, in nearly everj^ instance, to reflex stimuli from diseased organs, but these tender points are often the result of a local lesion, and are many times the cause of the disorder to the diseased viscus. The neuralgic pains are simply a symptom that a lesion exists in the immediate locaUty. Neuralgia of the Sacral Region and Coccygodynia. — This form involves the nerves in the sacral and coccygeal regions. The nerves between the bone and the skin are affected. The cause of the pain is generally due to derangement of the articulation of the lumbar and sacrum, and to severely contracted muscles over the sacral foramina; also to lower lumbar lesions. It may be a reflex from various possible disorders of the organs and tissues of the pelvis. In coccygeal neuralgia, the coccyx is commonlj^ displaced in any one of the various displacements that are liable to occur. Special attention should be given to the fibro- articulation of the coccyx, and to the status of the lumbo-sacral and in- nominata. In adjusting the coccyx, place forefinger in rectum up to proximal end of coccyx, and with thumb externally over the section, exert traction until articulation is released; then adjust. 714 The Practice of Osteopathy Neuralgia of the Legs and Feet. — This includes the crural form, in which the front of the thigh is the seat of the pain ; also the form in which tender points are found along the course of the sciatic nerve. The latter form is quite a common one, although sciatica is rarely a neuralgia. It is a neuritis and will be found classed under that heading. The tender points presented are the lumbar, sacro-iliac, gluteal, peroneal, maleolar and external plantar. The various neuralgic pains of the legs and feet are generally due to lesions of the lumbar, pelvic and thigh regions, and to weak arches. Metatarsalgia occurs when the fourth metatarso- phalangeal articulation is partially dislocated. Neuralgia in the heel, ball of the foot and toes may be due to local causes or to lesions higher up. Aside from the above care should be taken that there are no toxic factors that may be exciting causes. Visceral Neuralgia. — This is a term apphed to neuralgia of the gas- tro-intestinal tract, the kidneys, and the various pelvic organs. Diagnosis and Prognosis of Neuralgia. — Neuralgia is to be diag- nosed chiefly from nem-itis, rheumatism, and the effects of severe pres- sure upon the nerves. In neuritis there is oftentimes a symmetrical affection, while in neuralgia there is a unilateral distribution and there are many remissions and intermissions and a varying of the pain from one place to another. In severe forms of neuritis, anesthesia succeeds the hyperesthesia of the sensory nerves. In cases of severe pressure upon nerves, the pain is continuous and neuritis will soon be manifested. In rheumatism the pain is locahzed in muscles or groups of muscles and does not follow the course of the nerve. The pain is increased by motion. The prognosis is generally favorable, no matter how severe the attack. The prognosis is influenced onh^ by the age of the patient and the cause. Treatment of Neuralgia. — Consists, first, in the control of the paroxysm and, second, in the removal of its cause. In controlUng the paroxysm, frequently one will be able to remove the cause. In a large majority of neuralgias the cause is directly due to a displaced tissue, generally a bone or muscle in the locality affected; often all that is neces- sary in order to perform a cure is to adjust the disordered tissue and the pain will cease. This usually can be done immediately, although there are cases which require several treatments before an adjustment of the parts can be accomplished; besides, in acute cases the involved region will be so tender that an attempt to correct the tissues sufficiently to re- lieve the paroxysm will be unbearable to the patient. In such instances when the cause cannot be removed at once, firm pressure or inhibition ■ii*i«^': The Peactice of Osteopathy 715 over the involved nerves for a few minutes and local application of hot packs generally disperse the pain for the time being. The rules of hygiene should be observed in all cases. The best time to remove the cause of neuralgia is between the attacks when the tissues are not as tender or contracted to such an ex- tent as during the paroxysm. A diagnosis can then be made much more easily, and the tissues adjusted with less pain to the patient. The details (as to the locality treated) for each form of neuralgia will be found under the discussion of each variety. The general health and diet should be considered. Peterson^ says: "Morphine is, among the alkaloids, the most frequent cause of insanity. It is a sad commen- tary on the heedlessness of some medical men, but the family physician is responsible, in almost every case, for the development of the mor- phine habit and its far reaching consequences.. It should be looked upon as a sin to give a dose of morphine for insomnia or for any pain (such as neuralgia, dysmenorrhea, rheumatism) which is other than extremely severe and transient. " Diseases of the Cranial Nerves Olfactory Nerves. — This nerve may be affected at various points from its origin to distribution. The disturbances may produce hyper- osmia, or anosmia. The lesions may be tumors, injuries to the head and various diseases of the brain, or diseases of the nasal mucous membrane. The treatment of the nerve (beside treating the disease causing the disturbance) is to the cervical region with a view to controlling the blood supply. Optic Nerve and Tract.^ — The retina, optic nerve, chiasma and optic tract may be affected by various lesions. The affections of the retina are organic or functional. Under or- ganic there is hemorrhage and retinitis. Retinitis may be due to several diseases, as syphilis, Bright's disease, anemia, etc.. Functional includes toxic and hysterical amaurosis, tobacco amblyopia, nyctalopia, hemeral- opia and retinal hyperesthesia. Included in the lesions of the optic nerve, are optic neuritis and op- tic atrophy. Under lesions of the chiasma and tract are diseases of the chiasma and unilateral regions of the tract. Lesions of the tract and centers may be found in the tract itself,'^in the optic thalamus and the tubercula quad- 1. Nervous and Mental Diseases, p. 622. 2. See Diseases of the Eye, Part I. 716 The Practice of Osteopathy rigemina, in the fibers of the optic radiation, in the cuneus, and in the an- gular gja-us. A brief summary, oiAy, has been given of the lesions found, it being the idea not to dwell upon symptoms, morbid conditions, etc., but to bring out essential osteopathic features in regard to the cranial nerves. For the various effects of these lesions and points of diagnosis, the reader is referred to the various works on nervous diseases. Lesions peculiar to osteopathic practice, that affect the optic nerve and tract, are found chiefly in the upper and middle cervical verte- brae. The disorders to these vertebrae may involve fibers of the optic nerve directly — those that are supposed to originate in the cervical spine; they involve the retina and optic nerve by way of the fifth, as claimed by some; and the above lesions especially affect the blood supply to the op- tic nerve and tract, either interfering mechanically with the blood-ves- sels or obstructing and irritating vasomotor nerves. The most common lesions are sub-dislocations of one or all of the three upper cervical verte- brae. Still, lesions may be located as low as the third or fourth dorsal vertebra, which may influence vasomotor and s>aiipathetic nerves, or the lymphatics. The three or four upper ribs should also receive due con- sideration. Motor Oculi. — Lesions of the third nerve may affect its center or the course of the nerve. These lesions produce spasms or paralysis. The onlj^ waj^ that we can control the motor oculi is by way of the superior cervical s^nnpathetic ; also, it has a connection with the fom'th, fifth and sixth nerves, and w^e can influence it to some extent by direct treatment to the ej^eball and orbital muscles. It should be remembered by the osteopath that many of the lesions affecting the cranial nerves, are found upon post mortem examination, to be the effect of lesions in the spinal region; that many predisposing lesions are the disordered ana- tomical spinal tissues; as for instance in the third nerve, derangements of the atlas or axis may affect the nerve s,>Tiipathetically (reflexly), or pos- sibly by direct fibers, and produce the secondary effect — the so-called primary lesions of other schools — at the center or in the course of the nerve. Patheticus. — This nerve may be involved by tumors at its nucleus, or as it passes around the outer surface of the crus into the orbit. Aneur- isms or the exudation of meningitis miaj^ also compress its fibers. This nerve is purely motor, although it receives a few recurrent sensory fibers from the fifth nerve. This nerve is controlled osteopathically, principally at the superior The Practice of Osteopathy 717 cervical sympathetic. It has connections with the sympathetic by way of the cavernous plexus. Trigeminus. — Lesions of this nerve are found in its nucleus and in the pons, and include sclerosis, hemorrhage, disease and injury at the base of the skull, tumors, aneurisms, inflammation of the nerve, and sub- dislocations of the upper three cervical vertebrae, or the inferior max- illary. This nerve is an extremely important one from an osteopathic point of view, as it has a vasomotor influence over various vessels of the head and face, and secretory fibers to the lachrymal, parotid and submaxillary glands; also, it controls mastication, and to some extent deglutition, and influences hearing (tensor tympanum muscle). Diseases of the na- sal mucous membrane and disease of the anterior portion of the eyeballs are largely due to the vertebral sub-dislocations and to derangements to the inferior maxifla. Our principal work upon this nerve is at the upper cervical vertebrae, the inferior maxilla, and the deeply contracted muscles in the upper cervical region. For the facial points of treatment see neuralgia of the hfth nerve. This nerve is closely related to the sixth, seventh, eighth, ninth, tenth, eleventh and twelfth nerves. Par- ticular emphasis is given to the importance of treating this nerve in na- sal catarrh and in eye diseases of the anterior portion of the eyeball. It contains trophic fibers to the eye, sensory fibers to the sclerotic coat and iris, and vasomotor fibers to the choroid plexus. Abducens. — This nerve is especially liable to be affected by tumors and meningitis. It is controlled osteopathicalty at the superior cervical sympathetic, being connected with the sympathetic at the cavernous, plexus. Facial. — Lesions may occur in the cortical centers of the nerve, the nucleus and the nerve trunk. Paralysis of the facial nerve occasion- ally occurs (Bell's paralysis) ; also facial spasm may occur. This nerve is controlled at the stylomastoid foramen. Lesions to the atlas, anter- iorly or laterally, are commonly found. In the region of the stylomas- toid foramen, the nerve communicates with the great auricular of the cer- vical plexus, the trifacial, the vagi, the glosso-pharyngeal and the car- otid plexus of the sympathetic. The facial nerve may be affected directly as it passes above the angle of the jaw. Nearly every case of Bell's paralysis can be cured by osteopathic treatment. There are usually lesions to the upper two or three cervicals. Correction of the cervical vertebrae and massage of the paralyzed nmscles, with care of the general health, will suffice, provided there is not an ex- 718 The Practice of Osteopathy tensive central lesion. Although the disease may be due to syphihs, meningitis, tumors, etc., the most frequent causes are lesions of the atlas, axis, and third cervical and exposure to cold. The cold produces a neuritis in the Fallopian canal, and deep treatment beneath the angle of the jaw is effective. The prognosis of BeU's paralysis is favorable. Auditory. — Lesions^ affecting this nerve may occur anywhere from its cortical center to its distribution in the cochlea and vestibule. Dis- orders resulting from lesions to this nerve are nervous deafness, auditory hyperesthesia, tinnitis aurium, and Meniere's^ disease. The control of the nerve and the treatment of lesions affecting it, are effected principally at the first and second cervical vertebrae. The atlas is especially apt to be subdislocated anteriorly or in a rotary man- ner. The condition of the upper dorsal region should also be carefully examined, as vasomotor nerves to the ear may be impinged at this point. The auditory connects with the fifth, sixth and seventh nerves. Glosso-Pharyngeal. — This nerve may be affected by tumors, degenerations, meningitis and various lesions. It is often very hard to determine exactly the pathology, on account of its various connections with other nerves, the vagi, facial, spinal accessory, olfactory and optic nerves. This nerve is chiefly controlled at its exit at the jugular foramen. Osteopathically, lesions of the cervical vertebrae and upper dorsal vertebrae affect it. The deep muscles of the anterior and lateral regions of the neck and subdislocations of the atlas especially affect the nerve. Pneumogastric. — On account of its extensive distribution, and the importance of its functions this is one of the most important nerves in the body. It distributes fibers to five vital organs — heart, lungs, stomach, liver and intestines — and to other organs of secondary importance. This nerve is associated with deglutition, phonation, respiration, circulation and digestion. Hemorrhages, softening, etc., may involve the nucleus of the nerve, while the trunk may be impinged by tumors, thickened meninges, aneur- ism of the vertebral artery and subdislocation of the upper five or six cervical vertebrae, chieflj^ the atlas. The nerve is most easily controlled at its exit from the foramen. Inhibition of the suboccipital region, between the mastoid process and transverse process of the atlas, will influence the nerve markedly, proba- 1. See Ear Section, Part I. 2. R. D. Emery reports a case of Meniere's disease as cured. A. O. A. Case Reports, Series IV. The Practice of Osteopathy 719 bly reflexly; also direct treatment may. be given the nerve as it passes along the anterior part of the neck near the trachea. The superior laryn- geal branch may be treated below the great cornu of the hyoid bone and attention is particularly called to this in all affections of the throat where coughing is a feature; the inferior laryngeal, at the inner side of the low- er part of the sternocleidomastoid muscle. The inferior laryngeal nerve may be affected by dislocation of the first and second ribs, produc- ing pressure upon the nerve as it winds about the subclavian vessel. Fibers of the nerve have been traced to the spinal accessory nerve, as low as the sixth and seventh cervical vertebrae; consequently, lesions to the vagi nerves may occur anywhere in the cervical region. Spinal Accessory. — Lesions of this nerve may cause paralysis or spasms to the structures to which it is distributed. The lesions consist of subdislocations of cervical vertebrae, chiefly the upper three or four. The nucleus may be involved by wounds, abscesses, caries of the verte- brae, tumors and meningitis. These lesions may also involve fibers of the trunk. The special points of control of the nerve are at the jugular foramen, the sixth and seventh cervicals and the second, third and fourth cervicals. Torticollis or Wry-neck is spasm of the muscles of the neck sup- plied principally by this nerve. There will be found either derangements of the middle or lower cervical vertebrae or the muscles are swollen from exposure to cold or from a blow. Sometimes the lesion is in the up- per dorsal. The disorder is mainly a neurosis and, unless it has become chronic, the prognosis is favorable, and even in chronic cases, often con- siderable benefit can be obtained. Hypoglossal. — This nerve may be affected by cortical, nuclear and infra-nuclear diseases, as well as by subdislocations of the upper cervical vertebrae. It communicates with the superior cervical ganglion, the vagi, the upper cervical nerves and the gustatory branch of the fifth nerve. We control the nerve at the anterior condyloid foramen and at the superior cervical ganglion. Diseases of the Spinal Nerves Cervical Nerves.^The great occipital nerve may be controlled at a point on the occiput between the mastoid process and the first cer- vical vertebra. The small occipital and the great auricular nerves may be controlled at a point just behind the mastoid process. The great auricular nerve and the frontal branch of the trigeminus nerve meet over the parietal protuberance. The preceding points are the 720 The Practice of Osteopathy places where one may inhibit the nerves and control certain headaches or neuralgic attacks, although subdislocations of the upper cervical ver- tebrae, or contracted muscles between the atlas and occiput are usually the cause of such disturbances. Adjustment of the lesion will usually correct the disturbance. Carefully exclude possible caries or tumors. Treatment of the upper cer^ncal region, by relaxing muscles and correcting deranged vertebrae, constitutes the principal treatment of an ordinary headache. It is best to have the patient flat upon his back and the osteopath stand at the head of the patient, and, first, thoroughly relax these contracted muscles or correct the derangement of the verte- brae; then after the foregoing has been accomplished, give an inhibitory treatment of the sub-occipital region. In inhibiting, place the fingers over the contracted and tender tissue; hold tightly for several minutes, or at least until the tissues have thoroughly relaxed. Many times one will be able to detect a slight twitching underneath the fingers, and when such is felt, he knows at once that the headadche is reheved. In inhib- iting at any point along the spine, seek the contracted fibers and tender points and inhibit exactly over the area. Headaches that are due to a disturbed circulation of the brain, may be relieved by this inhibitory treat- ment in the suboccipital region. The treatment tends to reestablish a normal circulation to the brain. Although the large vascular areas such as the splanchnic, should, if possible, be normahzed. Headaches may also be due to lesions at various points along the spine and ribs, and a correction of such points is necessary in order to cure the affection. A place often found involved is the upper dorsal region. Reflex headaches can be cured only by relieving the irritation. The treatment to the head would only be temporary. In headaches of the chronic type it is well to examine the scalp and if not freely movable over occipital region it may be adherent to the skuU and cause pressure on the occipital nerves. Lesions to the phrenic nerve usually occur in the region of the third, fourth and fifth cervical vertebrae. The lesion may be due to a deranged vertebra, or to disease of the membrane of the cord, or of the anterior horn of the gray matter (See Hiccoughs). Paralysis of diaphragm from the phrenic may be single or double. When single it is not very noticeable. When double, respiration must be carried on by the intercostals and accessory muscles. When quiet, the patient may not notice it but on exertion there may be temporary dyspnea. Bronchitis with its constant coughing is a bad complication. Various disorders of the phrenic nerve are principally treated in the area of the origin of the phrenic nerve. Tumors, aneurism, caries, and neuritis are possible complications. The Practice of Osteopathy 721 Lesions to the brachial plexus are usually derangements of the cervical or upper dorsal vertebrae. Focal infections should not be over- looked. Direct injuries, contraction of muscles, a deranged clavicle, a cervical rib, or a dislocated shoulder are to be thought of. (See, also. Painful Shoulders, Part I) The X-ray as a diagnostic aid may be invalu- able. In obstructions to the musciilo-cutaneous nerve, the power to flex the fore-arm upon the arm is greatly impaired. The lesion is most likely to be found between the fifth and sixth cervical vertebrae. Clinicalty, the median nerve is of special interest from the fact that atrophy of the muscles of the ball of the thumb, which is pathognomonic of progressive muscular atrophy, may be caused by an affection of this nerve. The lesion is usually from the third to the seventh cervical verte- brae. Lesions of the silnar nerve may arise between the sixth and seventh cervical vertebrae, but are oftentimes found as low as the fifth dorsal, especially at the fifth rib on the side affected. Lesions of the clrcnniflex nerve may be found in the lower cervical vertebrae, but are commonly caused by dislocations of the humerus and clavicle. Lesions of the suprarscapular nerve occur most frequently from the fifth to sixth cervical vertebrae. The posterior thoracic may be lesioned at the fifth or sixth seg- ments, or by pressure injuries to the serratus magnus. Dorsal Nerves. — The essential osteopathic points of the dorsal nerves have been considered under intercostal neuralgia. It might be stated that the posterior fibers of the sixth and seventh dorsal nerves sup- ply the skin of the pit of the stomach. This is of value, clinically, as severe pains in the epigastric region which may result from impingement of these nerves, are supposed by the patient to be due to stomach dis- order. Diseases of the liver may be manifested by pains in the region of the right scapula. It has been suggested that the stimulus passes from the liver up the pneumogastric to the spinal accessory and down the spinal accessory to the trapezius muscle and thus causes the "liver pain." Intercostal neuralgia is more common on the left side of the body. The intercostal veins of the left side empty into the left superior inter- costal vein or the left azygos. Thus the blood, to reach the vena cava, is obliged to take a circuitous route and stagnation is more likely to oc- cur than on the other side. 722 The Practice of Osteopathy The glandular structure of the mammary glands is supplied by in- tercostal nerves from the third to the sixth interspace. Lesions here will cause various diseases of the breasts and adjustment will cure many of them. Lumbar Nerves. — The lumbar nerves may not only be deranged by various growths, inflammatory processes and abscesses in the abdomen, but by lesions, infections, parturition, and developmental defects of the lumbar vertebrae. Tuberculosis of spine, sacro-iliac and hip joints, is not rare. In doubtful cases utilize the X-ray plate. Lesions in the region of the first lumbar may affect the iliohypo- gastric and ilio-inguinal nerves and causes various irritations of the penis, scrotum, labimii and thigh. Also, the perineal region may be in- volved, as well as connecting branches of these nerves to various visceral nerves underneath. The genital organs may be affected by lesions to the genitocrural and external cutaneous nerves, caused by vertebral lesions of the sec- ond and third lumbar vertebrae. The latter nerve may be irritated by pressure underneath Poupart's hgament. Lesions at the thhd and fourth lumbar vertebrae and sacroiliac articulation may affect the obturator nerve. Sacral Nerves. — Lesions to the sacral nerves are especially liable to occur when an innominatum is subdislocated, as that changes the relative position of the femur with the body and causes impingement to the sacral nerves. Contraction of the pelvic and thigh muscles also affect sacral nerves. Other lesions to the sacral nerves may be located at the fifth lumbar and sacrum. It should be remembered that the centers of the sacral nerves are in the lower dorsal and upper lumbar re- gion. Various lesions to the sacral nerves may be caused by pelvic in- flammation, compressions b}^ growths, and injuries and contractions of muscles within the pelvis. }Sciatica has been described under neuritis. The Practice of Osteopathy 723 GENERAL AND FUNCTIONAL DISEASES Paralysis Agitans (Shaking Palsy) Definition. — A chronic, nervous disease, characterized by tremors, muscular weakness, muscular rigidity and alterations in the gait. Etiology. — The disease usually commences after forty years of age, but occasionally it occurs from the thirtieth to fortieth years. It is more frequent in males than in females. Heredity seems to have but Httle influence in the cause of the disease. Among the principal causes are phj-sical injuries, exposure to cold and wet, emotion, worry, alco- holism, sexual excesses and acute diseases. Physical injury, in conjunc- tion with exposure to cold is the best determined cause. Disorder of the vertebrae of the cervical or dorsal regions, or of the upper and middle ribs, can generally be found. Traumatic influences probably affect the nerve centers, causing a disturbed innervation, either by the direct effect of the deranged structures upon the nervous tissues or obstructing nutri- tive channels to the nervous tissues. In most cases no changes have been observed in the central nervous system or in the sympathetic ganglia. Some observers have noted in- duration of the pons, meduUa and cord, but these changes may be due to seniHty or to the indirect consequences of the long disturbance of function. In a few cases, interstitial sclerosis of the peripheral nerves is observed; these are probably secondary changes. Osteopathic exper- ience regards paralysis agitans as an affection of the central nervous system, due to a disordered structure in the locality affected. Symptoms. — The onset is usually gradual, but may come on quite suddenly after exertion. The initial symptoms are usually tremor, stiffness or weakness in one hand. In rare cases, at first there maj^ be neuralgic pains, dizziness and symptoms of a rheumatoid nature. The tremor can be controlled by the will at the onset of the disease. The affection gradually extends until an entire side or the upper or lower limbs are involved. At this advanced stage of the disease, a peculiar muscular rigidity of the involved region takes place. Muscular weak- ness comes on at about the same time as the rigidity, and the loss of power varies much in degree. The condition is most marked in the fingers and hands, whence it extends to the arms and legs. It commonly passes from the right arm to the right leg, then to the left arm, and then to the left leg. At this stage the movement between the thumb and fingers is 724 The Practice of Osteopathy like that of crumbling bread. The writing is greatl}^ affected and in time it is impossible to write. The trembhng may be so violent as to prevent sleeping. There is occasionally an intermission of days in the tremor. On account of the rigidity of the muscles, the patient assumes a characteristic attitude and gait. The position of the body is that of a tendency to go forward, the head is bent forward, the back ciu'ved out- ward, the arm bent at the elbow and held away from the body, and the kness so close together that they rub in walking. The gait is a "pro- pulsive" one, and when once started in a forward walk, the patient's gait becomes more and more rapid and he cannot stop until he comes against some object. The expression of the face is stiff and mask-like, the speech slow and monotonous and the voice shiill. The patient is generally restless and troubled with insomnia. The general health is in fairly good condition. Reflexes are usually normal. The intellect is generally retained, although the physical ailment may cause mental de- pression. Diagnosis. — Is usually easy and can oftentimes be made at a glance. Disseminated sclerosis has a tremor, but is shown particularly in vol- untary movements. The speech is scanning and the gait ataxic. The disease begins in the lower extremities, the attitude is different from that of paralysis agitans, and there is nystagmus. In chorea the movements are general, irregular and more intermittent, and it particularly involves muscles of the face. Also chorea is a disease of children and young adults. The tremors of old age, hj^steria, and certain toxic conditions due to tobacco, alcohol, etc. are generally easily diagnosed. Prognosis. — The disease does not necessarily shorten life; the pa- tient oftentimes dies with some intercurrent disease. Improvement usually results from careful, prolonged treatment. Early treatment, of course, will give the most satisfactory results, and occasionally, if taken very early, the case can be cured. Treatment. — A most careful examination of the physical struc- tures of the patient should be made, particular attention being paid to the cervical and dorsal vertebrae, the upper and middle ribs and the muscles along the spinal column. All irregularities found should be corrected if possible, and strong, thorough treatment given to the region of innervation of the affected parts. Traction of the rigid areas is of some value. Treatment of the arms and legs will also be of aid. All mental strain and physical exhaustion should be prevented if possible. The Practice of Osteopathy 725 General hygienic measures are to be employed. The life of the pa- tient should be quiet and regular. Bathing, fresh air, massage and out-door hfe will aid in improving the general health. Persistent treatment will retard the progress and frequently improve the general condition. Simple and hysterical tremor must not be confounded with that of paralysis agitans. E. Ashmore^ reports an interesting case which shows about what may be expected under treatment. Acute Chorea (St. Vitus Dance) Detanition. — A functional disorder of the nervous system, chiefly affecting children, more than twice as frequent in females as males; characterized by irregular involuntary muscular contractions, often slight mental disturbance, and KabiHty to endocarditis. Osteopathic Etiology. — The disease affects children of all stations, but is more common among the lower classes. The greater number of cases occur before the age of twenty. It sometimes develops during the early months of pregnancy, when it often assumes the maniacal type. Chorea is frequently associated with endocarditis and rheumatism and delayed menstruation. It occasionally follows infectious diseases of childhood, especially scarlet fever. Fright, mental worry, sudden grief and overstudy may bring on an attack. Children of neurotic stock are more susceptible. Heredity plays some part as a predisposing cause. Reflex irritation from worms or from genital irritation has a slight in- fluence upon the disease. Overwork in school is an important factor. Derangement of the anatomical structures, involving the nervous system along the spinal column, is the most common predisposing cause. Most of the anatomical displacements are found in the cervical verte- brae, although the upper dorsal may be involved. Pathologically, as yet, no constant anatomical lesions have been found. Emboh occur in some cases, but this might be expected, as endo- carditis so frequently occurs as an effect and not the cause of chorea. "In cases not rheumatic, the most probable explanation of the symptoms is to be found in vascular changes, having their origin in disturbed nu- trition. " (Holt) According to osteopathic theories and investigations, the disease is due to various irritations to the spinal centers and nerves of the affected region. The disordered nerve cells may be the result of direct pressm-c, hyperemia, anemia, etc., and the action upon the brain 1. A. O. A. Case Reports, Series IV. 726 The Pra^ctice of Osteopathy centers is possibly a reflex act. Of late acute chorea is regarded by some as an infectious disease. Symptoms. — In the majority of cases the muscular movement is not severe. They are purposeless and the cliild appears awkward. Rest- lessness, disturbed rest at night, crying spells, pain in the Kmbs, head- ache and irritability, are some of the premonitory sjanptoms. In mild cases one hand, or the hand and face, are involved. Occasionally there is some difficulty in talking. The irregular, jerky movements are char- acteristic of this disease. The child is anemic, and the muscles are weak. In severe cases the movements are general, the power of speech is lost, and the patient is unable to get about. The condition usually occurs after one or more mild attacks, although it may occur primarily. Dur- ing an attack of chorea, the child's disposition changes, he becomes ir- ritable, cannot concentrate his mind, memory is affected and halluci- nations may occur. The reflexes do not usually differ from the normal. Maniacal chorea is most serious, and often proves fatal, although re- cover}^ may occur. This form occurs most frequently in pregnant women. Speech is greatly affected and insomnia, fever and maniacal delirium de- velop. The duration is from six to ten weeks, in the average case. Mild cases may recover in a month or less, others last six or more months. There is a tendency of chorea to recur; rheumatism seems to favor this tendenc3% In children lecovery is the rule. Diagnosis. — In the majority of cases chorea is easily diagnosed. The symptoms are generally very characteristic. In a few cases of hys- teria there may be difficulty of diagnosis, but history and rhythmical movements wiU usually differentiate. In hereditary ataxia the slow, irregular movements, the scolioses, scanning speech, talipes and the ex- istence of other cases in the family, will differentiate this from chorea. Cerebral sclerosis usually occurs in infancy; impaired mentality, ex- aggerated reflexes, rigidity and chronic course of the disease, are points which render the diagnosis easy. Treatment. — Nearly all cases can be cured.^ The predisposing causes of chorea, osteopathically, are usually found to be subluxations of the vertebrae or ribs at any point, but particularly in the cervical verte- brae. Chorea is one of the diseases of the nervous system, in which con- stant morbid changes are not found upon the post-mortem examina- tion. Possibly the reason is because the lesions causing the diseased state are not deeply seated enough to primarily affect motor centers: but are lesions of the spinal column and ribs, affecting simply the nerve 1. See A. O. A. Case Reports, Series II., III., IV., V. The Practice of Osteopathy 727 fibers reflexly, as they pass through the intervertebral foramina. There will be found well marked lesions, and upon their correction the osteopath finds complete recovery largely depends. The muscle, or group of muscles, involved, will give a direct clue as to where the lesion will probably be found. In nearly all cases, it is in the spinal region of innervation to the affected muscles. Other cases may be due to cerebral lesions, as well as to intestinal and uterine dis- turbances. Search should be made for possible reflex irritation, such as intestinal parasites, adherent prepuce, eye strain, nasal abnormalities, etc. All cases should be taken from school, carefully guarded from ex- citement, and placed under the most favorable hygienic conditions, with a certain amount of discipline as to self control. The more serious cases should be placed in bed, so that rest will be secured as well as di- minished liability to heart complications. The diet must be carefully watched and the bowels attended to regularly. A milk diet during the earlj^ stage is highlj^ recommended. Do everything possible to restore the general health. Mild gymnas- tics, in most cases, will be found of service. Amusement should be given the child, in the open air if possible. In severe cases where the skin is harsh and dry, the hot air bath, providing the strength is good, will give considerable relief from the intensity of the disease. A few cases of acute chorea run into a chronic form, but the latter, as a rule, yields to osteopathic treatment. Choreiform Affections Myoclonia is a sudden contraction of a few muscle fibers, a single muscle or of a group of muscles. A neurotic tendency, infections and toxic conditions are factors. Occasionally epilepsy may be associated with it. Osteopathically there can be but little doubt that the innerva- tion to the muscles involved is interfered with. The lower extremities are usually first affected and it may be sudden or gradual in appearance. It is progressive and slowly involves the arms and, rarely, the face. Usually the spasms cease during sleep. Prognosis is rather favorable. Examination should show the cause of the nerve interference and its correction bring relief. Dubini's disease is probably associated with certain diseases of the c(jrd and bi'uin and is characterized by sudden, sharp pains in the head, neck and lumbar muscles, extending to the lower extremities in the form of a short, sharp spasm, usually at regular intervals. Later 728 The Practice of Osteopathy there may be symptoms of hemiplegia. The disease is apt to progress and death maj^ occur during a convulsion. Habit spasm usually results from overstudy and nerve exhaustion with impairment of general health, and is incident to early life. The child is usually a neurotic. The symptoms are twitching of the mouth and eyelids, grimaces and jerking of the shoulders. Treatment for the general condition, with correction of any spinal lesions, will generally give relief. General tic resembles habit spasms closely. In some casas the pa- tient is apparentlj^ healthy, while in others there is some brain disorder. There are coordinate spasmodic movements of the head, face and upper trunk, swallowing and abnormal vocal sounds. The movements are ^■apid and frequently repeated. Prognosis is uncertain and will depend largely on general conditions. In convulsive tic there is usually a repetition of certain words or sounds with a convulsive twitching or movement of certain muscles. Infantile Convulsions (ECLAMPSU) Infantile convulsions may be due to various causes. A neurotic inheritance is an important predisposing factor. They may precede the development of many diseases of the nervous system, and also occur as the result of peripheral irritation. Dentition in association with rickets, and intestinal parasites are common causes. They may be the early symptoms of acute, infectious diseases. Scarlet fever, measles, pneu- monia and smallpox are very frequently preceded by convulsions. They may be due to debility, resulting from gastro-intestinal disorders. Mal- nutrition is a predisposing cause. Disease of the bones, especially rick- ets, may be associated with convulsions. Lesions of the brain are other causes. A protracted instrumental delivery may cause a hemorrhage of the meninges. Symptoms.— In severe cases the fit may be identical with epilepsy. It is more often not so complete as true epilepsy. Convulsions vary considerably, but there will be no difficulty in diagnosis. It may come on suddenly, or be preced3d by restlessness, twitching, sometimes grind- ing of the teeth and fever. The spasms may be either of a tonic or clonic type preceded by a cry and loss of consciousness. The attack may be single, but the fits may follow each other with great rapidity and termi- nate fatally. It is rare for the child to die during a convulsion. Ex- haustion and asphyxiation may cause a fatal termination. As in epi- The Practice of Osteopathy 729 lepsy the temperature often rises during the fit. A transient paresis sometimes follows, if the convulsions have been chiefly limited to one side. Diagnosis. — The diagnosis is generally easy. The attack is usually due to the ingestion of some indigestible food or to some peripheral irrita- tion, or an acute disease. Convulsions, appearing immediately after birth or injury, are probably due to meningeal hemorrhages or serious injuries to the cortex; although a few of these cases will present grave lesions of the cervical vertebrae, probably often due to protracted instru- mental delivery. Infantile convulsions usually occur between the fifth and twentieth months. Convulsions occurring after the second year are more likely to be true epilepsy. The prognosis depends almost wholly upon the cause, severity and duration. Treatment. — The first step in the treatment is to determine the cause if possible. Treatment in the region of the sixth and seventh dor- sals will often give relief; thorough work along the lumbar region and the sacrum will many times be sufficient, if the convulsion is due to intestinal disorder. C. M. Proctor reports that in male infants he has relieved convulsions quickly, in several cases, by pushing back the foreskin and has always found, in such cases, either a phimosis or an adherent pre- puce. In female infants it might be well to examine the clitoris. Dila- tation of the rectal sphincter may be of aid. It may be necessary to vomit the patient, when it is due to undigested food in the stomach; and in some cases an enema should be used, when the irritation is in the intestines. In a few cases, when the convulsions are due to dentition, a lancet applied to the gums will be all that is required. A thorough treat- ment to the cervical region, to control the circulation, should always be given; at the same time apply ice to the head. The patient should be put in a bath of 95 to 98 degrees F., should the preceding treatment not have the desired effect, or, better still, use the bath at once and treat at the same time. Owing to the neurotic tendency and the ofttimes trivial causes that precipitate an attack everything possible should be done to build up the general condition — adjustment of all lesions, regulated diet and dis- ciplined haljits. Epilepsy Definition. — A chronic affection of the nervous system, charac- terized by attacks of unconsciousness, which are usually accompanied by general convulsions. When there is merely a momentary loss of 730 The Practice of Osteopathy consciousness it is called petit mal. Loss of consciousness with convul- sions is called grand mal. When the convulsion is localized, with or without loss of consciousness, it is called Jacksonian epilepsy. Cer- tain cases of temporary loss of consciousness are termed psycliic epilepsy. Etiology. — Epilepsy usually begins before puberty, and compara- tively seldom after the twenty-fifth year. Males suffer somewhat more frequently than females. Heredity predisposes to the disease to some extent, but probably not so greatly as many writers would claim. Neu- roses, as insanity and hysteria, and intermarriage of relatives, are im- portant elements to consider. When epilepsy is inherited, it is almost always due to some morbid state of the nervous system. Other predis- positions to the disease may be caused from defective general develop- ment of the brain, from impairment of the general health, and from an exhausted nervous system. Many exciting causes may l^e found: mental emotion, fright, excitement and anxiety; blows and injuries to the head; infectious dis- eases; syphiHs; alcoholism; masturbation; ocular and aural irritation; disturbed and delayed menstruation. Epilepsy may be excited by re- flex convulsions from intestinal worms, gastric irritation, etc. Also thickening of the membranes of the brain, pressure from a tumor at the periphery, uterine diseases and many other sources of irritation may be found, that are the exciting causes of epilepsy. Important exciting causes of epilepsy are, undoubtedly in many cases, due to lesions of the vertebrae and ribs especially the vertebrae of the cervical region, although in some cases the lesion is in the lower splanchnic region or in the ribs (chiefly from the fourth to the eighth) . These lesions to the spinal tissues disturb the nutrition to the vasomotor nerves. If the real seat of the disease is in the cerebral cortex and the medulla, the cervical lesion, and in fact other lesions, could readily affect the nerve force and circulation to and from these regions. The verte- bral artery circulation, where a cervical lesion exists, may be involved and affect the brain. In cases where lesions of the vertebrae and ribs exist in the upper and middle dorsal region, the vasomotor innervation to the brain may be involved, for in this region the vasomotor nerves to the cranium, etc., pass from the cord into the sympathetics. Birth injuries may affect the brain tissue, through cervical lesions, hemorrhages and asphyxiation. ConkHn attaches considerable importance to stasis of the sigmoid and ascending colon. Lesions involving this region may result in toxins entering the blood and affecting nervous tissue. The PRA.CTICE of Osteopathy 731 To illuairate a specific exciting lesion, the following is interesting. The case was one of epilepsy that was evidently caused by a dislocated right fifth rib. By producing an irritation in the region of this rib, so that the lesion was increased, the patient could be made to immediately suffer from an attack of epilepsy. By resetting the rib, at once the sufferer would be entirely relieved. The case was cured after three months' treatment, the chief work being to keep the rib in place. Rarely a subdislocated innominate bone, or some lesion remote from the brain, is located and found to be causing epilepsy. Important lesions in most cases will be readily located in the cervical region. Booth reports: "I have records of seven fairly defined cases of epilepsy — such as have been so pronounced by M. D.'s. I find in all of them marked lesions in the upper cervical and in most of the cases the occiput is posterior upon the atlas or twisted. In all cases there was a thickening of the soft tissues, especially in the upper cervical. The lower cervical was also much involved but not so noticeably. All of the cases also presented marked disturbances in the upper dorsal; most were decidedly anterior, and one very posterior. One was almost a confirmed drunkard; not- withstanding the fact, he recovered to such an extent that he went to work, and I understand has been holding his position for more than three years. He had had to give up his work entirely. One was a hopeless case in every particular and did not seem to receive any benefit from the treatment. I think it was entirel}^ beyond help from any source. The others responded very well and the results were definite and decided. The length of treatment in successful cases ranges from about Rve weeks to a little over a year. But those that were treated the greater length of time were not treated continuously." After one convulsion has occurred, >' chers readily occur, owing to the proneness to changes in the nerve centers. Very little is known as to the pathology of this disease. Convulsions may be caused from irrita- tion of both the cortex cerebri and the medulla oblongata. From a study of the character of the aurse, one is led to believe that there is a disturbance, in most cases, in the centers of the cerebral cortex; and that the lesions so generally found along the spinal cohnnn are the true ex- citing causes of the disease. Perhaps in a few cases the irritation may be to the medulla reflexly. The lesions found on osteopathic examina- tion may act reflexly, as has been stated, upon the centers in the brain and excite them; or the circulation is deranged, and consequently the nutrition to the brain and meninges, by vasomotor control and the ver- tebral vessels, is impaired. 732 The Practice of Osteopathy The splanchnic area and the cervical region should always receive special attention. This in conjunction with all possible reflex sources, and, not least, the general health, restoring a stable nervous sj^stem if possible, are of greatest importance. As a rule, pathological lesions are not found. To the naked eye the appearance of the nerve centers is largely that of healthy organs. The changes revealed by the microscope are most probably those of sec- ondary origin. Recent experiments seem to show that the motor zone of the cortex is affected. Symptoms. — These will be considered under the three varieties, known as grand mal, petit mal and Jacksonian. Grand maS. — In most cases the seizure is preceded by a pronounced sensation known as the aura. This differs greatly in various individuals. It may begin in a finger or toe and rise until it involves the head, when the patient screams and falls to the floor unconscious. In other cases the sensation may start from other parts of the body, as the epigastric region, where it maj^ simply be a sHght discomfort; or other sensations may be felt, as that of a ball rising from the stomach. The aura may start from any part of the body as a numbness, tingling, chilliness, etc., and may, also, be manifested through the optic, olfactory, auditory and gustatory nerves, l)y flashes, smells, sounds and tastes. ''Intellectual aurae" may also be manifested. Some form of aura is met with in nearly one-half the cases of epilepsy. Others lose consciousness so early that the patient is not aware of the onset. In cases not attacked suddenly and not pre- ceded by an aura, a prolonged prodrome may be present for several hours or a day. The patient may feel irritable, dizzj' or dispirited. Or he may be quiet and calmly await the attack. In a few cases certain move- ments may precede an attack, as running rapidly forward in a circle, or standing on the toes and rotating rapidly. The attack proper is sud- den. The patient falls with a peculiar cry. The convulsion or fit may be divided into three stages, that of tonic spasm, of clonic spasm and of coma. The tonic spasm succeeds the epileptic cry; there are loss of con- sciousness, pallor of the face and the contraction of pupils. The body assumes a position of tetanic rigidity, the head is retracted and rotated, and the spine curved, owing to an unequal affection of the muscles of the two sides. The jaws are fixed, the arms are flexed at the elbow, the hands at the wrist, and the fingers are clinched. The legs and feet are extended. The muscles of the chest are involved and respiration is suspended. This stage lasts a few seconds. The clonic spasm follows the tonic The Practice of Osteopathy 733 spasm. The muscular contractions become intermittent. From slight vibratory motions, the intermittent muscular contraction becomes gen- eral. The arms and legs are thrown about violently, the muscles of the face are distorted, the eyes rolled, and the lips open and close. The muscles of the jaw contract violently and the tongue is apt to be bitten. The pupils are dilated, the face cyanosed (though at first the face is pale and pupils contracted) and blood streaked, frothy saliva pours from the mouth. The feces and urine may be discharged involuntarily. The temperatm-e rises about one degree F. This stage lasts about one or two minutes. The period of coma may last from a few minutes to several hours. Usually if left alone, the patient will awaken after a few hours. In a few cases mental confusion foll,ows the waking. During the stage of coma, the face is congested but not cyanotic. The muscles are relaxed and the breathing is noisy. Epileptic attacks during sleep, nocturnal epilepsy, are not rare. This may continue for some time without the patient being aware of it. Petit Mal.^ — In this variety of epilepsy, convulsions are absent. The seizure consists of momentary unconsciousness with fixed, staring eyes, dilated pupils and rarely any twitching of the muscles. After the attack the patient resumes his work. There may be attacks of vertigo, without unconsciousness, and the patient may fall. In a few instance there may be aurse of various kinds. Petit mal may be a forerunner of grand mal or the two may alternate. Between grand and petit mal there are many gi'ades of epilepsy varjdng in severity. Jacksonian Epilepsy. — The affection is always s^miptomatic of lesion in the motor area of the cortex. The lesion is quite apt to be a tumor, though various injuries, inflammation, sclerosis, softening, hemor- rhage or an abscess may be the cause. Consciousness is retained and the convulsions are limited in extent. Tonic and clonic spasms of the same character as in general epilepsy occur. A slight numbness, ting- ling, or twitching may precede the attack. The severity of epilepsy varies extremely. The seizure may occur but once a year or it may occur several times in a day. In many cases a marked periodicity is observed. The mental functions are not, as a rule, injured, but when the seizures are frequent, the health fails and the mental capacity is reduced. Many sufferers from epilepsy are subjects of chronic gastric catarrh, and have at the same time an inordinate appe- tite. Quite frequently a fit may follow inordinate eating. When there is a series of convulsions, which follow one another in rapid succession and which arc associated with high fever, the term 734 The Practice of Osteopathy "status epilepticus" is applied. The most common form of epi- lepsy is the major form. About two-thirds of all attacks occur be- tween eight a. m. and eight p. m. Diagnosis. — Uremic convulsion closely resembles an epileptic convulsion. When the history of the case, analysis of the urine, in- creased temperature and the general health of the patient are all closely observed, error should be avoided. In reflex convulsions of cliildren, a careful search, and if necessary waiting a short time, will readily de- termine the source of the attack. When nocturnal convulsions take place without the knowledge of the patient the attack is epileptic. In hysterical convulsions the patient rarely loses consciousness. They rareh^ hurt themselves, never bite the tongue, the temperature is normal, opisthotonos does not occur, and the duration is usually longer. In Jacksonian epilepsy, the attack is hmited to some portion of the body, or it may gradually extend into a general convulsion. Care should be taken to recognize petit mal. Prognosis.^ — Records show that many cases have been cured and a much larger number have been benefited. Treatment. — Osteopathic treatment has been especially success- ful in epilepsy, as compared with other treatment. Although the os- teopaths do not claim a cure in every case, by any means, still about four out of every ten have been cured, while one-half of the remaining have been greatly helped in regard to the lessening of the severity of the attack, and in rendering the attacks less frequent. Conklin through his special treatment of fasting, dieting, enemata, spinal adjustment, and particular attention to the large bowel, especially cecum and colon, has increased this percentage. This is based on several hundred cases. Important lesions are usually found in the cervical region, from the third to the seventh vertebra, though they may be as high as the atlas. These lesions may affect the l^rain in various waj^s; probably in the man- ner described under the etiology. Lesions are also found in the dorsal vertebrae and when occurring below the cervical region, the lesions are generally found in the upper and middle dorsal regions, though they may be located at any point along the spinal column. The treatment is according to the rule that applies to all osteo- pathic work: an individual correction of the lesions presented in the case at hand. If any general movement or treatment might be given, it would be strong traction of the head to stretch the cervical vertebrae, or rather to separate them, so that the circulation to the brain may be 1. See A. O. A. Case Reports, Series I., III., V. The Practice of Osteopathy 735 equalized. Another general measure is to hyperextend the neck with fulcrum at juncture of atlas and occiput, thus releasing the upper anterior tissues that may impede cerebral cii'culation. If the lesions in such cases are in the cervical vertebra, probably they affect the cervical sympathetics. A careful search for a source of excitation must be made throughout the entii'e body. An irritation of the intestinal tract may be the exciting cause; or some irritation of the genito-urinary tract may be found, as phimosis, masturbation, etc., so that it is very necessary that gi'eat care be taken in the examination. Subjects of masturbation usually present lesions along the genito-urinary center in the spine. All possible reflex irritations should be eradicated. Proper hygienic measures should be added. Pay particular at- tention to the bowels. Place the patient in the knee-chest position and thoroughly raise the cecum and ascending colon in order to improve circulation and promote elimination. Baths are important, and plenty of fresh air and out-door exercise are of much significance. The paT tient's mind should be occupied. The question of food is an important one; general diet — carefully regulated as to the amount given- — should be prescribed. A vegetable diet is usually best. Reduction of salt seems to have a good effect. The patient must not be allowed to eat too much at a time, nor too often. If the bromides are being used, they should be withdrawn gradually. In most cases of true epilepsy a continued treatment of several months is necessary. Unless the patient can follow out ths treatment for several months, or even years, in a number of cases it will be entirely useless to take the treatment; although if the lesion present is very ap- parent, and the patient is enjoying fair health otherwise, and has not been affected long, a treatment for a few months, or even, weeks, might be all that is necessary. Surgical interference may be indicated in Jacksonian epilepsy. Trephining has been practiced successfully in a number of cases and the risk from operation with modern surgery is so reduced that one is fre(|Uontly justified in advising an operation. During an attack, a special treatment cannot be given to lessen the severity of the fit in all cases; in fact, most patients prefer not to have the seizure shortened as the after effects are more disagreeable. In some cases, at the beginning of the seizure, exerting a firm pressure upon the sub-occipital will quiet the patient. This treatment probably controls the circulation of the brain, by way of the superior cervical ganglion. In cases where the exciting factor seems to be in the intestines, and the 736 The Practice of Osteopathy peristaltic action of the bowels is reversed, causing a reversion of the nerv5 current of the vagi, a rapid, firm kneading over the abdomen, so as to establish normal peristalsis, will suffice to prevent an attack, if one is notified of its approach. In some cases a rapid, thorough stimu- lation of the solar plexus will lessen an attack. Possiblj^ it reduces the blood pressure in the brain, by bringing blood to the splanchnic region. In all cases during the convulsion the patient should be carefully protected from injuring himself. A towel should be twisted and placed in the mouth, so that the tongue cannot be bitten. Do not place small articles as corks, etc., between the teeth, as they are liable to enter the pharynx and cause suffocation. The patient should be watched to pro- tect him from any injury; otherwise the attack should usually be allowed to spend itself. Migraine (Sick Headache) Migraine or sick headache is a neurosis, characterized by a par- oxysmal pain in the head, usuallj^ unilateral and periodical, with nausea, frequentlj^ vomiting, and disorders of vision. Osteopatliic Etiology. — The disease usually begins in the first half of life, rarely earher than puberty and is slightly more frequent in females. Some weakened or depressed condition of the nervous sys- tem, due to lesions of the upper cervical vertebrae, lesions of the inferior maxilla, anxiety, overfatigue, anemia, digestive derangements, eye- strain and menstrual disorders, is generally the cause. The hereditary factor is very important. This is frequently associated with derange- ment of the large bowel, especialty cecum and ascending colon, result- ing in toxemia. It is supposed bj' some to be a vasomotor disturbance, because there are symptoms, as pallor and flushing of the skin, which show an involvement of the sympathetic system. It is possible a spasm of cere- bral arteries, followed by vascular dilatation, takes place. The seat of the pain is beheved to be in the meninges of the brain. Possibly in many cases where the atlas is found involved and causing the affection, some meningeal fiber of the fifth nerve is impinged by the lesion. Caries of the teeth and nasal troubles are causes of the disease in children. Symptoms. — A paroxysmal headache is the principal feature of migraine. The attack may occur without warning, although there are usually malaise, restlessness and a disturbed vision preceding the head- ache. The prodromal symptoms vary to a great extent. Other pro- The Pkactice of Osteopathy 737 dromal symptoms besides those given, may be vertigo, spots before the eyes, tinnitus, chilHness, etc. The pain is of a sharp and stabbing nature and is oftentimes hmited to the temporal region of one side. Others describe the pain as of a binding or of a boring nature. It is continuous. It may be in the occiput instead of in the side of the head. Hyperesthesia of the surface is noticed, but the tender points of neuralgia of the fifth nerve are absent. The patient is sensitive to light and noise. Flashes of light occasionally attend the pain in the head. Hemianopia is not infrequent. The temporal artery may be contracted, the face pale and the pupil large. In others the eye is dilated, the face flushed and the pupil small. Nausea and vomiting are frequent, with loss of appetite. In some cases where the stomach is full, vomiting the con- tents win relieve the attack. Should the stomach be empty, vomiting of mucus may occur, and is later followed by vomiting of bile. Tender- ness is commonly found about the region of the occipital and upper cer- vical muscles. Attacks rarely occur oftener than once in ten or fifteen days. During the intervals the patient may be quite well. The dura- tion is anywhere from a few hours to several days. Diagnosis. — The sensory symptoms, the paroxysmal character, the severity and definite course, usually readily distinguish migraine. Growths of the brain may be the cause of symptoms closely simulating migraine. In such cases an ophthalmoscopic examination may reveal a choked disc. Prognosis. — Is usually favorable when the attacks are light and of short duration. Cases of long standing and of great severity are not so easily cured, although in most instances great relief can be given the patient. There are very few cases in which the severity and frequency of attacks cannot at least be lessened. Oftentimes attacks of migraine cease after middle life. Treatment. — The atlas or one of the upper cervical vertebrae is almost invariably subluxated. This is not always the direct cause of migraine, but it is an important factor in the causation. During the attack many cases can be completely, or at least partially relieved, by a careful treatment in the upper cervical region. But there are some cases where treatment of the cervical region is entirely unsuccessful, and, in fact, aggravates the attack. The details of treatment vary in every case. If any defects in general health or any error in the mode of living can be found, these of course must receive first attention. Rest, diet (a vegetable diet is best) and regularity of meals are usually to be spe- cially considered. Anything that is known to induce an attack must be 738 The Peactice of Osteopathy carefully avoided. In some patients the attacks cease so long as they remain free from mental work, but as soon as they return to their studies the paroxysms occur. Every case should be thoroughly examined before a course of treat- ment is laid down. Causal conditions can generally be found, and the correction of such usually results in a cure, or at least in great relief. Errors in diet; digestive disturbances, as a disordered biliary tract; dis- orders of the pelvic organs; eye-strain; nasal disorders; mental and phys- ical fatigue, and affections of the nose may induce attacks. A beneficial treatment for many, aside from adjusting the spinal le- sions, especially the cervical and usually a rigid splanchnic area, is to place the patient in the knee-chest position and thoroughly raise the bowels of the right side beginning in the right iliac, loosening possible adhesions, etc. The earlier the treatment, the more likelihood of a cure. Cases of long standing are generally harder to cure. Preceding a paroxysm, re- lief can usually be given, but after the paroxysm has reached its height it is harder to give relief. The patient should rest in a quiet room which is darkened and well ventilated. Besides the indicated osteopathic treatment (generally a cervical one), hot applications to the nape of the neck and keeping the extremities warm are helpful. The nerves in- volved are the vasomotor, occipital, frontal and temporal. A free evac- uation of the bowels will relieve a few cases, while washing out the stom- ach will help others. Hot fomentations over the splanchnics for thirty minutes may be beneficial. During the intervals, valuable adjuncts will be found in the use of systematic exercises and frequent bathing. Do not fail to have the eyes examined. Occupation Neurosis These are a group of maladies of the nervous system, due to ex- cessive use of certain muscles in some oft repeated act, and character- ized by spasm of the muscles concerned. There are several varieties, as writers' cramp, telegraphers' cramp, piano players' cramp, viohn play- ers' cramp, typewriters' cramp, etc. Professional spasms, that involve muscles of the shoulder girdle, are not rare among osteopathic practitioners, due to prolonged faulty meth- ods of technique. Osteopathic Etiology. — A nervous temperament predisposes to the development of the affection. Previous injuries and strains of the involved parts are important factors. Faulty methods of writing, and in the other disorders, strained or cramped positions of the affected tis- The Practice of Osteopathy 739 sues, predispose to attacks. Slight lesions of the bones, joints, liga- ments and muscles are commonly found, involving the motor and sen- sory nerves of the immediate locahty. The majority of all cases occur between twenty and fifty years of age. Distinctive pathological changes have not been found. Each case has particular lesions of its own. The details of the case are charac- teristic of the one case only. The affection is often primarily a spinal one, due to deranged action of the spinal centers concerned in the var- ious acts; though, no doubt, excessive use of a group of muscles may re- sult in contractions, spasms, contractures and nutritional changes, that in turn will establish definite osteopathic lesions. This is an illustra- tion of a "vicious circle. " Symptoms. — Symptoms of the various varieties of professional neuroses develop slowly and gradually. A cramp or spasm affecting the used member is an early symptom. Tremor, weakness, stiffness, fatigue and heaviness of the affected part are present most of the time. In severe cases neuritis may develop, and a glossiness of the skin be pres- ent. Associated with the inabihty to perform the usual work, may be mental worry and depression. Diagnosis. — The history of the case and the hmitation of the dis- ease to one member, usually make the diagnosis easy: Cerebrospinal diseases, as hemiplegia; early tabes, affecting the arms; and progressive muscular atrophy, have to be carefully excluded. Prognosis. — As a rule is favorable. Osteopathic treatment, in the majority of cases treated, has resulted in recovery. Treatment. — Rest of the part, mental quiet and attention to the nutrition of the patient, are the first essential considerations. A change of occupation may be necessary if excessive use of parts and faulty meth- ods can not be coiTected. The treatment consists of a correction of the parts iiTitating or disturbing the spinal centers or nerves affected. The ulnar, radial and median nerves all innervate muscles employed in writ- ing. Lesions of the cord affecting these nerves may be found from the fifth cervical to the sixth dorsal. In a few cases lesions occur as high as the atlas. When the radial and median nerves are involved the lesions are principally found in the upper dorsal vertebrse. When the ulnar nerve is involved the lesions are usually slightly lower. The lesions may affect the fibers of these nerves directly (mechanically), but more prob- ably the vasomotor nerves are involved, as in this region the vasomotor fibers to the arm pass from the cord to the sympathetic fibers. The brachial plexus originates higher than the upper middle dorsal region, 740 The Pil\ctice of Osteopathy still some of its nerves are frequently affected in the dorsal region by os- teopathic lesions, for removal of the same relieves the disorder. Other lesions affecting the arms are oftentimes found in the ribs on the side involved. Any of the first five ribs may become deranged and affect the innervation of the arm. The clavicle in a few cases may be abnormaUy low. A bursitis may be present. Occasionally shght sub- dislocations of the shoulder joint (especially anterior) and elbow joint are found. Gymnastic exercises of the arm and hand, coupled with a general treatment of the shoulder, arm and hand, are beneficial. Hy- drotherapy, massage and friction of the involved member are useful. In severe cases ''breaking up" fibrotic tissue, and muscle training fre- quently secures good results. Hysteria Oppenheim defines hysteria as ''a psychosis, which does not express itself by disorders of the intellect, but in defects of character and emo- tional disturbances, whose real nature is hidden under an almost unlim- ited and varied number of physical symptoms of disease. " The affection is about equally divided between the two^ sexes. A neurotic tendency, often inherited, is an important underlying factor. This condition, when associated with lack of mental disciphne, is very apt to lead to the mental depression and outbreaks of hysteria. A large number of cases are between the ages of puberty and twenty-five. After forty-five the disorder is infrequent. White, Osier's System of Medicine, says: "The significance ot Freud's theory is the tracing of every case to sexual traumata during childhood. Sexual experiences differ, however, from ordinary experi- ences—the latter have a tendency to fade out, while the idea of the former grows with increasing sexual matm-ity. There results a disproportionate capacity for increased reaction which takes place in the subconscious. This is the cause of the mischief." A distinction is made between the sexual and the sensual. Anders points out that lack of proper mental development, unproper hygienic surroundings and chronic toxemia are causes. The direct causes of hysteria may be many, and include physical and mental influence, or both. Traumatism of various regions of the body, but especially of the spinal column, may excite hysteria. Some slight lesion of the vertebra or rib may be all that is discoverable. A correction of the same is occasionally all that is necessary to remove the direct cause; still there is usually considerable disturbance of the spmal The Practice of Osteopathy 741 tissues, especially slight curvatures and muscular contractions. Pro- longed emotional excitement, overwork, defective education and many moral and mental influences are potent and frequent causes. Mas- turbation or an adherent prepuce occasionally is the cause of the affec- tion in boys, or any excitation that produces exhaustion. Distiu-bances of the sexual system in both sexes are responsible for many cases. The menstrual period and the menopause are frequent periods for the mani- festation of the disease. The disease often affects prostitutes. Dis- turbances of the digestive, nervous and circulatory systems, and general diseases of an exhaustive kind are exciting causes of hysteria. Dr. Still said that occasionally the colon is prolapsed and crowded down upon the pelvic organs. Hazzard^ is of the opinion that "a majority of the cases show a depression of all the ribs, narrowing the thorax and often causing enteroptosis. " Symptoms. — The symptoms may be extremely varied, including any symptom of the many nervous diseases. The sensory symptoms are numerous. The most common is anesthesia, which may be found in certain parts of the body, usually one side (the left) of the body. Geo- metrical areas that bear no relation to the innervation is characteristic. The patient may not know of the sensory derangements until discovered by the physician. When there is anesthesia without other nervous symptoms, the case is commonly hysterical. The most marked symp- tom is analgesia, where the patient is insensible to painful impressions. A pin may be placed deeply into the flesh, and not be felt by the patient. The anesthesia may extend to the mucous surfaces, and even deeply down to the tissues of the joints. Organic and tendon reflexes are not changed. There may be other symptoms of disturbed sensation; as an absence of pressure, temperature and muscular sensation. Hyperesthesia may be present nearly as often as anesthesia. Hy- peresthetic areas may be found in various regions of the body, but es- pecially along the spinal column and in the ovarian region. The ''hys- terical spinal irritability" is of special interest to the osteopath. The spinal column may be affected as a whole, or in segments, or confined to a single vertebra. Especially when a spinal irritability is in segments, or confined to a single vertebra, are local derangements of the spinal column apt to be found. Correction or even pressure upon these areas will often relieve the patient. Severe pain over the heart may simulate angina pectoris. Globous hystericus is of quite common occurrence. Charcot refers to the ovarian hyperesthesia as follows: "It is 1 . Practice of Osteopathy. 742 The Practice of Osteopathy indicated by pain in the lower part of the abdomen, usually felt on one side, especially the left, but sometimes on both, and occupying the ex- treme limits of the hyperesthetic region. It may be extremely acute, the patient not tolerating the slightest touch; but in other cases pressure is necessary to bring it out. The ovary may be felt to be tumefied and enlarged. When the condition is unilateral, it may be accompanied with hemianesthesia, paresis, or contracture on the same side as the ovarialgia; if it is bilateral, these phemomena also become bilateral. Pressure upon the ovary brings out certain sensations which constitute the aura hysteria, but firm and systematic compression has frequently a decisive effect upon the hysterical convulsive attack, the intensity of which it can diminish, and even the cessation of which it may some- times determine, though it has no effect upon the permanent symptoms of hysteria. " The special senses may be disturbed, although these symptoms are usually transient. There may be blindness; narrowing of the field of vision, due to anesthesia of the periphery of the retina; loss of hearing; loss of smell or loss of taste. Motor disorders may be of different forms of paralysis, as hemi- plegia, paraplegia or monoplegia. In fact all forms of parlaysis may be found in hysterical patients. Osier says: "There is no type or form of organic paralysis which may not be simulated in hysteria. " The affected muscles do not atrophy. The paralysis is usually general, and contrac- tures are common. Local paralysis, as of the bladder, vocal cords and other parts of the body, commonly occur. Contractures and spasms may also occur. True epilepsy may even be simulated by hysterical spasms, but on careful observation the characteristic attack of epilepsy is found wanting. Firm pressure may increase the severity of an attack as well as bring it on. The spasms are of various parts of the body, as the diaphragm, bronchi, abdominal mus- cles, bladder, etc. Various disturbances of the viscera may occur. Of the digestive tracts, the appetite may be disturl^ed or depraved. Diarrhea or consti- pation may be present. Flatulency is a common sj^mptom. The re- spiratory tract ma}^ be another point of considerable disturbance in many cases. Dyspnea, aphonia, hiccough, cough, and exaggerated breathing, as when cold water is poured on one, are common manifesta- tions. Various cardiac vascular symptoms may be manifested, es- pecially a rapid heart. Various vasomotor derangements are common. Physical manifestations, as amnesia, lack of will power and an The Practice of Osteopathy 743 excitable nature — easily moved to laughter or tears — are frequent. The moral tone may be lowered. Even delirium, catalepsy, ecstasy and trance, may be mentioned among the psychical phenomena. The hysterogenous zones are of more than passing interest to the osteopath. Tyson writes as follows, in regard to the hysterogenous zones : "These are hyperesthetic areas especially studied by Richet, on which persistent pressure will sometimes excite a hysterical attack. While the ovaries are favorite hysterogenous zones, the zones may be in any part of the body; as for example, the sides of the trunk. Such pressure may also cause an existing attack to subside. Hysterical spasms may also be locahzed or Umited to groups of muscles." Especially when zones along the spine and side of the trunk are located, the attack of hysteria may be completely relieved by correcting the locahzed deranged tissues. Convulsive seizures are not unconmaon and may follow various prodromal sj'mptoms. Some authors divide the symptoms of hysteria into convulsive and non-convulsive forms. These are part of the many manifestations that are presented by various hysterical patients, and it is readily seen that an osteopath has to be continually on his guard. Diagnosis. — The diagnosis is generally quite easy. The charac- teristic emotional symptoms, associated with any of the many other symptoms which have no organic lesion, are characteristic of the dis- ease. Care has to be taken, though, in some cases where symptoms are presented which have organic lesions. The history, the attack and neurotic temperament, will largely decide the nature of the affection. After the "outbreak" the patient often feels decidedly better. Prognosis. — Death may occur from exhaustion, but such a termina- tion is rare. Recovery is the rule, although the duration may be long. Recoveiy usually takes place rapidly, after the exciting cause has been determined and removed. Treatment. — First of all, the osteopath should have due apprecia- tion of the mental characteristics of the disease. Whatever is dominat- ing the patient mentally must be either changed or aboKshed. It is not always necessary to be harsh and severe with the patient; but one should be firm and unyielding. He can do a great deal by having complete ment- al control of the hysterical patient. A most careful examination should be made for an exciting cause, and when found it should be removed. This naturally constitutes a very important part of the treatment. A light general treatment is commonly 744 The Practice of Osteopathy indicated. The general health, especially the bowels, should be care- fully attended to. The hygiene, exercise and amusement of the patient should receive due consideration. One has to gain the confidence of the patient, and then be firm but kind to him. Relative to diet Yeo^ says: "The diet should be simple, abundant, and supplied regularly, and at not too long intervals as is frequently the case in boarding schools. All strong stimulants are best avoided, and the hysterical should not in- dulge in strong tea or coffee, or exciting wines and liquors." The "rest cure" as introduced by Weir IViitchell, is applicable in some cases. This method consists of plenty of food, especially milk, absolute rest of the body and mind, massage and electricity with isola- tion of the patient from friends and sympathetic relatives. Doubtless a general osteopathic treatment would be much better than massage. Yeo says that to the appUcation of hypnotism and suggestion "we look with little sympathy and less confidence. " Dtu'ing the hysterical convulsions, the patient should be watched, but extreme measures should not be practiced. There is little danger of patients hurting themselves. Throwing cold water in the face, or a cold bath may produce the necessary mental shock. Pressure over the ovary as stated in hysterogenous zones, or some other zone of the body, or pressure upon a large blood-vessel, as a carotid, will oftentimes stop an attack. Neurasthenia "Closely aUied to, and in some cases ahnost inseparable from, hys- terical states are those morbid conditions to which, in modern times, has been applied the term neurasthenia. " (Yeo). Neurasthenia is a fatigue neurosis that is characterized by mental and physical irritability and inefficiency. Headache, backache, insomnia, and debility of the gastro- intestinal tract are common symptoms. The affection is often found in that class of people who are predis- posed to hysteria. The disease is more common among men than women, usually occurring after the twentieth year. The predisposition may be inherited or acquired. Church states that "debilitating conditions in the antecedents of neurasthenics," and "defective education that omits discipline and the cultivation of self control" are important predisposing causes. Many of the exciting causes that produce hysteria will cause neurasthenia. Various lesions along the spinal column, chiefly in the cervical and upper dorsal regions, include the predisposing causes of a 1. Manual of Medical Treatment. The Practice of Osteopathy 745 large majority of cases. This spinal irritation, taken in conjunction with overstrain of niind and body, or probably in many cases the spinal irrita- tion as the predisposing cause of the over strain, results in nervous ex- haustion. Particularly overwork, associated with care and anxiety, is an exciting cause of great significance. The neurasthenic patient is generally of a neurotic temperament. The affection may, also, result from various chronic diseases, toxic con- ditions, sexual excesses, alcohol and tobacco. Thompson^ believes that improper sexual hygiene and perversion or abuse of the marital relation are most important factors in the development of neiu^asthenia in both sexes, and a regulation of this is imperative for a cure. The symptoms are due, to a greater or less extent, upon spinal, cerebral, cardiac and gastric disturbances, but all of these conditions are usually dependent upon vertebral and rib lesions of the upper dorsal and cervical regions. Care should be taken whether the condition is secondary to organic lesions. The lesions in the vertebrae are generally shght lateral devia- tions, in the ribs upward displacements of the vertebral ends, followed by contraction of the deep muscles in the neighborhood of the lesions. A posterior condition of the atlas and a lateral lesion between the third and fourth dorsal are especially apt to be found. As to spinal areas most affected Stearns" says the predisposing irritations are located particularly in the first two cervical, the first two dorsal and the last two Imnbar vertebrse. These various lesions probably cause an impairment of nutrition in the nerve-centers of the cord and brain, or both. Definite morbid anatomical changes have not been found resulting from nervous de- bility or irritabihty. Still, it seems probable that certain changes in the nerve-cells may result from excessive functional activity. Traumatism is a prominent causative factor in both neurasthenia and hysteria. Railway and other injuries frequently produce osteopathic lesions that result in nervous disorders. That there is a demonstrable pathological basis resting in sympathetics and spinal nerves, there can be no doubt. Symptoms. — To enumerate the many symptoms of neurasthenia in detail is hardly necessary. The nervous debility may affect any or- gan of the body, owing to the exhaustion of the nervous energy, thus lessening the functional activity of that organ. ^riic most noticealjle symptoms are various sensory disturbances and muscular weakness, dependent in part upon the spinal lesions. 1. Cosmopolitan Osteopath, October, 1903. 2. Journal of Osteopathy, January, 1904. 746 The Practice of Osteopathy The patient generally feels weak and tii-ed. Headache, pains in the back and sacrum, tender points along the spine, and various sensations of numbness, tingling, etc., are felt. The mental faculties are oftentimes irritable and weak. An in- ability to concentrate the thoughts with depression, fear, vertigo, insom- nia, and many other mental symptoms, may be manifested. Palpitation, irregular action of the heart and pain over the pre- cordia may be present. Ocular distm-bances, particularly blurring of letters and narrowing of the visual field, visceral symptoms of many kinds, and vasomotor phenomena, as chilUness, flashes of heat and sweat- ing, are among the many symptoms of which the patient complains. Genito-urinary disorders in the male, and ovarian and uterine irritation and painful menstruation in the female, are occasionally symp- toms dreaded ])y the sufferer. Pohmria is frequent. The symptoms or signs of great importance to the osteopath in neurasthenia, as in manj^ other diseases, are the tender points along the spinal column. They give direct clues as to where the lesion may be found. Diagnosis. — Error in diagnosis can usually be prevented by a study of the history of the case and symptoms. Care must be taken in deter- mining between symptoms of organic diseases and the symptoms of a true nervous exhaustion. Prognosis. — Is abnost invariably good. Only in cases where there is a tendency to mental disorder should the prognosis be guarded. Much depends upon the thorough cooperation of the patient. It usually takes some time to perform a cure among the poorer class, as the require- ments demanded for a cure are oftentimes expensive. Treatment. — Naturally the treatment, exclusive of the manipula- tion to correct the various lesions found, is extremely varied, owing to the many exciting causes and sjnnptoms to contend with. As has been stated, the lesions are usually found in the upper spinal region; still lesions are occasionally located in the lower spinal region, especially in female sufferers, when the pelvic organs are disturbed. The many mental symptoms, as inabihty to concentrate the mind, in- somnia, vertigo, headache, etc., are best treated through the cervical region, with attention to the heart's action and the excretory organs. Careful attention should be paid to the deep posterior muscles between the atlas and occipital bones. Rest is very necessary. Changes of scene and occupation, atten- tion to the surroundings, careful dieting, hydrotherapeutic measures, The Practice of Osteopathy 747 pleasant companions, relief from responsibility, bathing, etc., should receive careful attention and consideration by the osteopath. Set rules cannot be given. The details of treatment that should be adopted are dependent upon the individual case. Every well trained osteopath will be familiar with such measures. Careful attention must be given to the secretions, excretory organs and the circulation. A study of each case will bring out the various irregularities that may exist. When the nervous involvement is extensive, a "general treatment" may be given. Such a treatment would affect the entire nervous and muscular system, and tend to equalize disturbed nerve force. Bringing the muscular system into play and relaxing contracted muscles calls for more blood and nerve force, and consequently a nutritious diet. The "rest cure," as introduced by Weir Mitchell, may be employed to considerable advantage in many cases. Yeo says: "It is in certain cases of this disease that the 'rest cure,' devised by Weir Mitchell, has proved so remarkably successful. But there can be no sort of doubt that it has been apphed far too indiscriminately, and that for this, as indeed for any special method of treatment, a careful selection of suitable cases is needful. " The diet should consist principally of milk at first, followed in a few days by soft boiled eggs, boiled rice, lamb chops, graham bread, steAved fruits and butter, and a little later by roast beef, vegetables and light puddings. Porter's system of milk diet has proved effective in many cases. Tea, coffee and alcohol should be avoided. During the entire course of the treatment, care should be taken to correct any lesion that may bear directly upon the cervical sympathetic, the solar plexus and the hypogastric plexus, as they are the great reflex centers of the body. 748 The Practice of Osteopathy DISEASES OF THE SPINAL CORD Acute Myelitis Acute myelitis is an acute inflammation, with softening of the substance of the cord, gi\dng rise to marked disturbances of motion, sen- sation and nutrition. When the whole thickness of a section of the cord is involved, the condition is termed transverse myelitis. When an extensive area is involved, it is termed diffuse myelitis. When the gray matter around the central canal is especially affected, it is termed cen- tral myelitis. Etiology. — There can be no doubt that osteopathic lesions are very potent predisposing factors. Osteopathic lesions of the spine, even of a muscular nature, readily disturb the cord circulation. It may follow repeated exposure to wet, cold or exertion; or be a sequel to the infectious diseases, as smallpox, typhoid fever, typhus, puerperal fever or measles. It may be due to traumatism or disease of the vertebrae, as caries or cancer. Syphilis is a frequent cause. Pathology. — To the untrained, naked eye, the cord may present little or no change. The nervous tissues are in various stages of degen- eration. On section the substance of the cord is red and soft, the Une of demarcation between the gray and white matter is lost or extremely indistinct, and minute hemorrhages are sometimes seen. In very acute cases, affecting the white and gray matter, after injury, when the mem- branes are cut, the substance of the cord may flow out as a reddish creamy fluid. The nerve fibers are much swollen and the axis cjdinders broken up. Blood discs, leucocytes, and numerous granular fatty cells may also be present. The blood-vessels are distended and dilated. There may be tliickening and hyaline degeneration of the vessel walls and hemorrhagic extravasation. Symptoms. — Acute Transverse Myelitis. — This is the type most frequently met with. The symptoms differ with the situation of the lesion, which is generalh^ in the dorsal cord. At the onset there may be pain; numbness and tingUng in the back, radiating into the Hmbs. There is usually moderate fever, malaise, chills, muscular pains, a coated tongue and constipation. Sjanptoms of motor paralysis soon develop, which may become more or less complete. Both motor and sensory symptoms vary to a marked degree, depending upon the pathologic involvement. The reflexes are lost at first. They may soon return and are exaggerated The Practice of Osteopathy 749 below the lesion. Following this the muscles often become rigid and contracted. Unless the lesion is in the lumbar or cervical cord, reaction of degeneration or much wasting of the muscles, as a rule, does not occur. A girdle sensation frequently occurs at the level of the disease. At first there is retention of the urine and feces, later incontinence. Bed- sores soon develop; also drpng and hardening of the skin. The nails become thick and brittle. Death may occur from exhaustion, or heart or respiratory failure, but it is rare; segments of the cord may be com- pletely and permanently destroyed, causing persistent paraplegia. H. A. Greene'^ reports a case, due to injury, which was greatly benefited by treatment. Acute Diffuse Myelitis. — In the acute forms the course of the disease is rapid. The trophic disturbances are more marked than in the former type. This form is Kkely to follow exposure to cold, injuries, tumors, syphilis or one of the infectious diseases. There may be chills, fever, malaise, pain in the back and limbs, and occasionally convulsions. The reflexes are generally lost. The motor functions are rapidly lost. There is incontinence of urine and feces, rapid wasting of the muscles and bed-sores develop. The disease may prove fatal in from six to ten days. Diagnosis. — Landry's Disease. — In this the bladder and rectum are not affected. Trophic disturbances are absent. There is but shght loss of sensation, no reactions of degeneration and no girdle pains. Multiple Neuritis. — Both arms and legs involved, and slow onset. The bladder and rectum are rarely involved; the girdle pain is absent. Acute Poliomyelitis. — There are no sensory symptoms and the rec- tum and bladder are not affected. Prognosis. — In very acute cases death occurs in from three to ten days. Milder cases generally recover with some loss of motor power, although in a few cases treated by osteopathy recovery was complete, due probably to the case being seen early and thus degeneration pre- vented. Treatment. — Lesions of the vertebrae are usually readily found in cases of myelitis. Generally, deranged vertebrae are found in the upper dorsal region, and occasionally lesions are located in the lumlmr and cervical vertebrae. The treatment of myelitis is chiefly to correct these lesions, so that the normal circulation of the cord may be recstabhshed. One has to he very careful when treating the lesions not to cause ad- ditional injury to the cord. An inhibitory treatment to the muscles 1. A. O. A. Case Reports, Series V. 750 The Practice of Osteopathy about the lesion may be all the treatment that can be given at first; never- theless, it aids natm'e just so much in overcoming the excessive irrita- tion of the cord tissues. Natm-e has the curative means, provided they may operate unobstructedly. In a few cases the ribs in the region of the spinal lesion will be found deranged and interfering with trophic fibers, blood-vessels and l>Tnph vessels of the cord. The patient should be kept in the prone posture at first. Warm baths and massage will be found of additional value. The bowels and bladder should receive special attention. An ice-bag to the spine may be beneficial. If there is anj^ danger of bed-sores, use alcohol to stimulate and harden the skin. Rest, hquid diet and good nursing are necessary. Later on careful exercising of the limbs will be beneficial. Chronic Myelitis. — This defines the conditions when the in- flammation is subacute with the paraplegia and other sjinptoms which then naturally appear, present, and also with the signs of both degenera- tion and repair. The sj^nptoms develop slowly as compared with the acute form. It should not be confused with atrophy, pach;>Tiieningitis or tumors of the cord. Treatment is practically the same as in acute form. Surgical measm^es may be indicated. Loudon^ reports a case due to injury which was greatly benefited. Poliomyelitis (Infantile Paralysis) Definition. — An acute infectious disease occurring most commonly in young children, characterized by paralysis, rapid wasting of certain muscles, and fever. It is an acute mj'ehtis that affects the anterior horns of the cord. There are no sensory symptoms. Etiology. — It usually occurs in children under ten years of age, and the majority of cases occur before the fourth year. It is more com- mon in summer than in winter. The infection seems to gain entrance through the nasal mucous membrane. Traumatism, exposure to cold and overexertion, are probably predisposing causes. It has occurred in severe epidemic form. Morbid Anatomy. — The disease is most frequently seen in either the limibar or cervical enlargement and is usually unilateral, though there is considerable variation in the extent of the lesions. In very early cases, the condition of acute hemorrhagic myelitis, with degenera- tion and rapid destruction of the large ganglion cells, has been found. In older lesions the anterior cornu in the affected region is atrophied and 1. A. O. A. Case Reports, Series II. The Practice of Osteopathy 751 there is destruction of the multipolar ganghon cells. The anterior nerve roots are atrophied, the muscles are wasted and undergo a fattj'" and sclerotic change. Symptoms. — The child may have a slight fever, malaise, muscu- lar twitching, headache, some rigidity of the neck, and sometimes vom- iting. This may last a day or several days or only a few hours, when paralysis sets in abruptly. The paralysis is rarely complete and groups of muscles onlj^ may be affected. As a rule, the paralysis comes on abruptly, but it may come on slowly, taking several days to develop. In a few weeks, atrophy sets in and the Hmb becomes flaccid, soft and wasted. The paralysis remains stationary for a time when improvement takes place, but complete recoverj^ is rare. Sometimes the growth of the bone of the affected hmb is impaired. Usually there are no sensory dis- turbances and the bladder and rectum are not affected. The condition of the reflexes is dependent upon the extent of involvement of the cor- nual cells. Occasionally the bulbar muscles are affected. Diagnosis. — This is not difficult except in the early stages. Care- ful study of the case is commonly all that is necessary. Landry's paraly- sis and peripheral neuritis are to be differentiated. Prognosis. — Complete recovery is rare. Improvement is the rule. Ivie^ tabulates sixteen cases, all showing good results. W. B. Davis reports a case cured by six months treatment and still well after three years. T. M. King" one case cured and one greatly benefited and A. S. Craig^ one much helped. Florence Gair, F. P. Millard, A. G. Walms- ley and others report gratifying results in many cases. Treatment. — In the treatment of chronic cases, F. P. Millard^ says "Five minutes' time is sufficiently long in treating a patient, and some- times too long. * * * Start in and move every spinal joint. That takes about two minutes. Spring the sacro-ihac articulations just enough to get motion. Then give a specific cervical treatment. Do not stop to relax muscles in a child. Adjust as rapidly as possible. Make every spinal joint yield to motion. Spend only one minute, or possibly two, on the cervical vertebrae. So far we have consumed four minutes. The last minute we loosen up the wrist or ankle, according to the extremities that are involved." This outHne has been followed with gratifying success by Gair, Green, Bush and others in many chronic cases. The pro- cedure in acute cases is condensed from A. G. Walmsley^: "Isolate, 1. A. O. A. Case Reports, Series V. 2. A. O. O. Case Reports, Scries I. 3. Millard, Poliomyelitis. 752 The Practice of Osteopathy keep cool and absolutely quiet. Stop all food until the temperature drops to 100° F. or lower and until the pain subsides when fruit juices may be given followed by heavier foods. Give patient all the water he will drink. Where the spine is sensitive, and it will be in many, use hot fomentations until a specific treatment can be given. If the fever is running high cool compresses will be grateful and help reduce tempera- ture. Irrigate the colon twice daily with saline water. Do this first thing when called. Later once daily will do and then discontinue. Look carefully to the nose and throat and wash with sahne or boracic solution. Keep feet warm as they may be cold even with high fever. Treat the case over a long period. See that he does not overdo and observe all dietetic and hygienic measures. " Both these men lay great stress on the importance of specific adjustments and massage of muscle tissue has little place in their treatment. This, with drill at home can be attended to by the mother. Ivie\ among other good ideas on treatment, gives the following: "May I suggest that when such severe results (the acute stage) follow a slight infection, that we may expect to find a lesion located at such a point as will interfere with one or more of the anterior root arteries which join and supply the anterior spinal plexuses. As there are only five or ten of the anterior root arteries (Dana), the lesions affecting them can be located throughout a wide range of the spine. In a great many cases we find that the correction of lesions well up in the dorsal and even in the cervical region have increased the amount of the improvement well beyond that received in the correction of the lumbar lesions alone. To promote resolution, correct the lesions, both muscular and bony, and relax the muscles of the spine daily; move every vertebra to the limit of all its possible motions; use flexion, extension, rotation, and lat- eral flexion at least once every day for at least a week; and help to over- come stasis by keeping the child off its back, turning it from side to side, and letting it lie on its stomach as much as possible. The limb, to be kept in its l)est condition, should be kept warm; treated gently; held in a natural position by the use of sand bags and clothes cradle, thus begin- ning early the prevention of deformity; the paralyzed muscles should not be kept on a stretch, as that will retard any possible improvement; stimulating rubs and baths should be given frequently. " In the chron- ic stage he advocates: "Now that the nerve cells have been given a chance to regenerate (removal of lesions), the best thing to do is to force them to work if possible. To do this, the so-called resistance exercises 1. Journal of the American Osteopathic Association, February 1906. The Practice of Osteopathy 753 or educational movements are to be strongly recommended; the idea being to place the limb in a given position and then ask the child to fix all its attention on the hmb and to earnestly attempt to hold it there while you move it, or to keep making the attempt while you move the limb through its whole range of motion in that direction. These movements should be so calculated that the resistance of the child will exercise the group of muscles affected. The mother or nurse can give these exercises every night on going to bed." Acute Ascending Paralysis (Landry's Paralysis) Definition. — An acute disease, characterized by an advancing paralysis, beginning in the legs, passing upward to the trunk and the arms and finally it may involve the centers in the medulla. Toxic and infectious influences that congest the nerve courses and ultimately destroy the cells seem to be the important factor. The anterior gray matter of the cord is involved, and it is probable that many cases are a form of acute poHomyelitis. The spleen is congested and in some instances the lymphatics. Etiology. — A definite cause has not been found, although osteo- pathic lesions are important predisposing factors. A toxic cause seems probable. The disease is most common in males between twenty and forty years of age. It may follow traumatism, exposure, cold or the in- fectious fevers. Symptoms. — Weakness of the lower extremities is generally the first symptom, though the arms may be involved first. This is shortly followed by paralysis. The paralysis then extends to the trunk and within a few days the arms are also affected. The muscles of the neck are next involved and finahy those of respiration, deglutition and articu- lation. The reflexes are aboHshed. The muscles are relaxed, but gen- erally do not waste or show electrical modification. Sensation is usually not affected, but there may be tingling, numbness, hyperesthesia and muscular tenderness. The sphincters are not involved as a rule. The spleen is usually enlarged. The course is variable. Death often occurs in from two days to a few weeks. When the improvement takes place, th(; part last affected recovers first. Diagnosis. — This is not always easy. It is sometimes impossible to differentiate between this disease and multiple neuritis. The his- tory, the motor paralysis, the absence of wasting and of electrical modi- 754 The Practice of Osteopathy fication, as well as the absence of involvement of the spliincters, will definitely aid in the diagnosis. Prognosis. — The prognosis is unfavorable. A large majority of cases prove fatal. In a few cases treated osteopathically, results were favorable if the patient was seen earl}'. The muscles of the spinal col- umn were markedly contracted. Treatment. — The treatment of Landry's disease consists princi- pally of thorough treatment of the spine, especially of the lower dorsal and lumbar regions, and attention to the underlying toxic condition. The treatment should be most thorough; the vertebrae and ribs found disordered should be corrected and each vertebra should be care- fully separated (if conditions permit) from its neighbor. When the paralysis has extended to the trunk and neck, a thorough treatment all along the spinal column should be given with a view to relaxing the con- tracted muscles and to render flexible the entire spinal column, so that the cord may be properly nourished and the progress of the disease check- ed. Careful relaxation of the contracted spinal muscles unquestionably has a potent effect upon the cord circulation, which tends to check and retard degenerative processes. Treatment of the hmbs directly will be found a help, as well as direct treatment of all tissues paralyzed. If swallowing is impossible, the patient should be fed through the rectum, or by the stomach or nasal tube. See that the patient is carefully nursed. Massage is beneficial. Locomotor Ataxia (Tabes Dorsalis) Locomotor Ataxia is frequently met with. It is a disease of the spinal cord wherein the ultimate effect is a sclerosis of a progressive char- acter of the nerve courses of the posterior column. It is claimed that the origin is in the protoplasmic processes of the posterior spinal ganghon. The characteristic symptoms are incoordination, Ai'gyll Robertson pupil, Hghtning pains and loss of knee-jerk. Osteopatliic Etiology and Pathology. — Most cases develop be- tween the ages of thirty and forty, although it is occasionally seen in young men, and rarely in children from hereditary syphihs. Malefe are much more frequently affected than females (10 to 1, Osier), and the disease is much more frequent in cities. Predisposing causes are given as syphihs, prolonged exposure to wet and cold, and sexual excesses, although there is a disposition on the part of neurologists to confine The Peactice of Osteopathy 755 the cause of true tabes to syphilis, some records showing as high as 90 per cent, of the cases from that cause. Tabetic symptoms develop in from five to fifteen years after syphiHtic infection. There are no data to show the probable proportion of syphiKtic cases which later develop tabes, but it is undoubtedly small. As all cases of tabes examined by osteopaths show spinal lesions, it is reasonable to suppose that by inter- fering with the nutrition to the spinal cord, they allow consequent de- generation. It is also quite probable that osteopathic treatment for syph- ihs would, for the same reason, prevent sclerosis and resultant tabes. That syphilis is not the only cause, is also held by some authorities. Starr cites a true case from a severe blow in the dorsal region. Osteopathic observation would lead to a differentiation of tabes, according to the cause. Cases have been recorded, which simulated true tabes in most symptoms, which did not have a history of syphiHs. J. Knowles makes the point that probably certain cases simulating tabes have reached what might be called an irritation stage (pathologically) of the nerves and their centers, sclerotic changes not having taken place; and he be- lieves these cases would naturally yield to osteopathic treatment. Teall confirms tliis view by being of the opinion that these cases are the ones largely due to tramnatism, exhaustion or exposure, and the probabilities are t^at in time sclerotic changes would take place, resulting in true tabes. In such cases there can be no question as to the osteopathic lesion, which would be sufficient to materially interfere with the peripheral sensory nerves and disturb the protoplasmic processes to the spinal gangHa and sensor}^ tract. As a rule they are in the lower dorsal and lumbar regions. Cases are reported which had marked sacral and coccygeal lesions. Pathologically, Dana speaks of locomotor ataxia, "as a post- infective degeneration, which first attacks the posterior spinal ganglia or corresponding cells of the special senses, due to a prolonged poisoning of these parts by the toxins of the infection. " The first change is in the posterior roots. Without doubt osteopathic lesions can readily affect the nutrition of these roots. This is shown upon examination in cases where the vertebral lesions impinge the tissues surrounding the spinal nerve at its exit, (or otherwise damage nervous stimuli and cir- culation) and also where the displaced head of the rib crowds upwards against the spinal nerve and again where the rib impinges the correspond- ing sympathetic gangHon which lies anterior to the head of the rib. Very likely in many cases the syphilitic infection is an exciting factor, but it seems plausible that osteopathic lesions, traumatism, cold, exposure and excesses predispose by disturbing the circulation to involved areas. The 756 The Practice of Osteopathy changes are at first inflammatory, followed by degenerative changes in the nerve com-ses wliich cause connective and neuroglia overgrowths to take the place of fibers in the sensory tract, and finally in the motor tract. Thus from the posterior ganglia, a section between the columns of Goll and Burdach is involved, and the progress of the sclerotic change is upward in the cord. The pia mater and coats of the vessels are thick- ened. The principal changes in the cord are in the lower dorsal and upper lumbar segments and the cord may be changed in shape. In long- standing cases there is degeneration of the ascending antero-lateral tract, of the direct cerebellar tract, and of the pyramidal tract. The cerebral changes in some cases consist of sclerosis in the restiform bodies in the inferior peduncles of the cerebellum, and of certain cranial nerves, especially the third, optic, vagus and auditory nerves, and also cortical changes may occur. Symptoms. — Authorities divide the sj^nptoms into three stages — the pre-ataxic, ataxic and paralytic. This division is largely an arbitrary one. Motor symptoms are usually the most prominent. There is inabihtj^ to coordinate the muscles. The patient first notices that he cannot walk steadily when in the dark or when he has his eyes closed. Later he finds that he cannot maintain his equilibrium even in daylight ; this is ascertained when the patient places his feet together and the eyes are closed (sign of Romberg). As a rule this is unaccom- panied by muscular wasting, so there is no loss of motor power. Soon the gait becomes characteristic ; in walking the feet are lifted high and are brought down heavily on the heel; the ball of the foot comes down last, producing what is called the "double step;" the walk is straddling; the limbs are thrown about, and there is staggering, due to incoordina- tion. Incoordination also develops in the hands, but usually later in the disease. Suddden involuntary movements and palsies are other motor sjTiiptoms. The latter occur in about twenty per cent of cases and as a rule are of short duration. Paralysis and muscular atrophy do not develop until after a few years. Pain is an early symptom and always present; it is of a darting, shoot- ing or stabbing character and appears in paroxysms. It is most common in the legs, lasting but a second or two, and often accompanied by a hot, burning feeling. Herpes may appear along the course of the nerve. Anesthesia and hyperesthesia of certain areas may occur. A girdle sensation may be a noticeable symptom. The muscular sense is more or less impaired; there is a feehng as if there were cotton between the patient's feet and the floor. Retardation of tactile sensation is a The Practice of Osteopathy 757 common symptom. The power of localizing pain is often lost. The knee-jerk is lost early in the disease. Occasionally, however, cases are met where it is retained. The skin reflexes are also impaired; in some cases they may be increased at first, but later are sure to be in- volved with the deep reflexes. The piapi! does not respond to the light, but still accommodates for distance, constituting the Argyll Robertson pupil. Ptosis may develop with or without strabismus. Optic atrophy, which may lead to blindness, paresis of the ocular muscle, and contracted pupils, may occur. The ocular symptoms may appear early in the dis- ease. The visceral pains or crises are chiefly gastric and are sometimes accompanied by obstinate vomiting. Laryngeal, rectal, urethral and nephritic crises may occur, and at times are exceedingly severe. Laryn- geal crises may be manifested by intense dyspnea and noisy breathing. Constipation is common. There may be retention of the urine resulting m cystitis. Sexual power is generally lost early. Trophic changes occur later in the disease. The so-called arth- ropathies, or joint lesions, msLj occur at any period of the disease. It con- sists of an enlargement of the joints, associated with serous exudations, which rarely become purulent; atrophy of the heads of the bones; de- struction of the bones and cartilages; or spontaneous fracture or disloca- tion may occur, owing to the brittleness of the bones. There is no pain and the large joints are most frequently affected; these may be excited by an injury. Herpes, skin ecchjmioses, edema, local sweating, altera- tions in the nails, perforating ulcer of the foot, onychia, decay of the teeth and 'atrophy of the muscles may occur. The auditory nerve is rarely affected, but in some cases there may be deafness. There may be attacks of vertigo. Olfactory sjinptoms are rarely met with. Cere- bral symptoms are rare. Paralysis may develop and the patient be- comes bed-ridden. The disease itself does not prove fatal; the patient may live for years until some intercurrent disease causes death. Diagnosis. — This is usuall}^ easy when the characteristic symptoms are developed. The presence of hghtning pains, absence of the knee- jerk, early ocular palsies, a squint, ptosis and Argyll Robertson pupil make the diagnosis conclusive. Care has to be taken in making diag- nosis from peripheral neuritis, paresis, ataxic paraplegia, cerebral disease and some diseases in which the posterior columns are disturbed. Prognosis will depend largely on the exciting cause, as it is least hopeful from syphilis, but the earlier the case is treated the better the 758 The Practice of Osteopathy chance. The progress of the disease can sometimes be arrested and occasionally cases presenting symptoms of the first and second stage are entirely relieved with persistent treatment. Treatment. — Experience in the treatment of locomotor ataxia has been that often the disease can be checked and the symptoms re- Heved; but curing a case of locomotor ataxia, except in the early stages, is seldom possible. When there is degeneration of nerve centers, there is no hope for a cure. Those with a syphilitic history are by far the hardest to relieve. Antisyphihtic treatment should be considered. Cases with a syphiUtic history presenting preataxic symptoms, Argyll Robertson pupil, lightning pains and loss of patellar reflex have been cured; unfortunately these cases are not always diagnosed. The treatment consists of thorough correction of the spinal derange- ments found, especially through the lumbar and lower dorsal regions. If the disease has involved the arms or brain, thorough treatment should be given the entire length of the spine with a view to increasing the cir- culation in the spinal cord and brain, and thus checking or prevent- ing the tissue degeneration. "In the early stage, deep massage to the muscles of the back promotes the flow of venous blood through the spinal vessels and their anastomotic branches, and is the best means of reheving the congestion which is supposed to exist. " (Starr) The lower spine will be found to be rigid and should be well sprung to get mobiHty. Careful treatment of the limbs should be given, but be exceed- ingly cautious in the treatment of the limbs of advanced cases, as there is considerable danger of producing fractures. Stretching the thigh muscles and internal and external rotation treatment of the legs should be given. See that the bowels are moved daily and be positive that there is no retention of the urine in the bladder. A catheter has to be used in some cases. The patient should be careful about taking too much food, and especially beware of indigestible food, as it irritates or excites gastric crises. Dming painful attacks the patient should rest in bed, and with careful treatment the attack can generally be reheved. Hot applications are of considerable aid. At all times excesses should be avoided. Occupation of some char- acter should be given the sufferer. Do not promise to cure the patient, and make it plain at the start that it will probably require a long time to show much improvement. Sj^stematic exercises to reestablish coordina- tion should not be neglected. The Practice of Osteopathy 759 Hereditary Ataxia (Friedreich's Ataxia) This is a rare hereditary disease, due to sclerosis of the cohimns of GoU and Burdach and the pyramidal tracts. There are ataxia, mus- cular weakness, nystagmus, speech disorders and loss of knee flex. Al- most invariably there will be found a neuropathic history. Alcoholism, syphihs and insanity in the parents are predisposing causes. Tubercu- losis may be a factor. Acute diseases, especially infectious fevers, den- tition and injuries to the spine may be exciting causes. It occurs most frequently in males about the seventh or eighth year and very seldom after puberty. Several members of the same family are apt to be affected. The disorder is transmitted by the female. "The degeneration of the posterior and pyramidal columns seems to occur at the time of cord de- velopment, when malnutrition or hereditary dyscrasia would disturb it most. " Pathologically, "the spinal cord is smaller throughout than nor- mal; we have also a combined disease of the posterior and lateral tracts (Schultze), a degeneration of GoU's tract in toto, of Burdach's almost entirely, and of the direct cerebellar, the crossed pyramidal (?), and of Clarke's columns, in which we find not only atrophy of fibers, but also a degeneration of the gangHon cells. Gower's tract msiy Hkewise be in- volved." (Oppenheim). Symptoms. — Impaired coordination, beginning in the legs and later extending to the arms, is the first marked symptom. The gait is pecuUar; it is swaying and irregular and it lacks the pronounced stamping gait of locomotor ataxia. There is a loss of reflexes, while no sensory symptoms are present as a rule. The spliincters are normal. Nystagmus is present and is a characteristic s3Tiiptom. The speech is scanning. Tahpes and lateral curvature of the spine are common. The mind be- comes sluggish in later stages. The course is always very slow. Diagnosis. — This is not difficult as a rule, owing to the usual family histor}^ presented. The spinal curvature, nystagmus, incoordination, scanning speech, irregular gait, and deformity of the feet are symptomatic. In locomotor ataxia the gait, sharp pains, anesthesia and Ai-gyll Robert- son pupil will differentiate between the two. Differentiation will also have to b(> made from chorea, ataxic paraplegia and multiple sclerosis. Treatment. — The same treatment as in locomotor ataxia is fol- lowed. Lesions presented have been found at the tenth and eleventh dorsals, and at the second and third cervicals, although, as a rule, the en- 760 The Practice of Osteopathy tire spinal column is quite debilitated. Some improvement will be noted in these cases, but not much can be expected from treatment; contrac- tures may be prevented. Spastic Paraplegia Spastic paraplegia begins as a stiffness in the legs, with no sensory- symptoms, but finally the muscles become rigid and slowly paralyzed. The reflexes are exaggerated. It may occur, in a few instances, as a primary disease, "being a de- generation of the motor neurone, whose body lies in the brain cortex and whose axone lies in the lateral pyramidal tract. " Usually it is secondary to tumors, inflammation and softening of the brain. Multiple sclerosis, hemorrhage, transverse myelitis, syringomyelia and other diseases of the cord, injur}^, exposure and overexertion are exciting causes. Syphihs may be a cause. It generally develops between the ages of twenty and forty. Pathologically, the degeneration involves the lateral pyramidal columns of the cord. It begins at the periphery and extends upward until finally the axones atrophy and neuroglia overgrowth takes place and sclerosis of the motor tracts results. Symptoms. — Muscular stiffness in one leg is usually the first symp- tom, which gradually disturbs both sides. The muscular stiffness in- creases to a rigidity, and even cramps, so that it is with considerable diffi- culty that the patient moves about. The reflexes are exaggerated. The joints, as well as the muscles are stiff, so that the toes are dragged upon the ground and the legs are kept close together, abduction of the limbs being difficult. On the whole, there is much tiredness, stiffness, rigidity and hardness of the leg muscles, so that all motions with them are per- formed with great effort. Sensory and trophic symptoms are lacking; control of the bladder and rectum is usually normal. The progress of the disease is slow. The upper extremities may be involved in after years, but the common extensive disturbance is with the legs, so that they may be entirely useless and the muscles atrophy from disuse, although rigidity and contractures remain. Treatment. — The prognosis is usually unfavorable, though fre- quently the patient may be considerably benefited. A few cases that have been caused by traumatism, cold or exposure have yielded to osteopathic treatment and all symptoms disappeared. The treatment is largely that of locomotor ataxia. The lesions are readil}' located in the spinal column. In a few cases a slight posterior curvature of the dorso- The Practice of Osteopathy 761 lumbar region is found, but the majority of the lesions are in the lower dorsal region. Special care should be given to the bladder and bowels. Prolonged warm baths are beneficial. Treatment of the legs is always secondary to that of the spine. The diet should be nutritious and one easily digested. Give the patient plenty of fresh air and sunhght with cheerful surroundings. E. C. Link reports two cases, one of over one year's standing, completely recovered, and another much improved. Ataxic Paraplegia In ataxic paraplegia there are ataxic and spastic symptoms, due to both posterior and lateral sclerosis. Traumatism, cold and exposure are etiologic factors. It is found in diffuse myelitis, general paresis, lepto- meningitis and in toxic conditions as in pernicious anemia. The pos- terior and lateral columns are degenerated, so that in the former there is an ascending degeneration and in the latter a descending. Symptoms. — These comprise those of tabes and spastic para- plegia. Incoordination, ataxia, Hghtning pains, anesthesia, rigidness of muscles and exaggerated reflexes are the principal symptoms. The muscles easily fatigue; sensory symptoms are not so troublesome as in tabes; there may be \isceral crises, sometimes Argyll Robertson pupil;' and possibly spasms of the upper extremities and jaw. The course of the disease is slow. Diagnosis. — This is not difficult as a rule. First, there is ataxia; then increased reflexes, fatigue of the muscles and paraplegia. Tumor of the cerebellum maj^ confuse the diagnosis. Treatment. — There is frequently a chance to greatly benefit these cases, and even in some instances a cure may be performed, provided the case is seen early. Thorough treatment of the spine to relax the mus- cles and to adjust the ribs and vertebrae is the indication. Stretching the spine, if carefully done, is beneficial. Muscular manipulation improves the spinal cord circulation, and osseous correction removes probable impingements to nutrient channels and nervous influences induced by cold, exposure, traumatism and secondarj^ disturbances. Care of the general health, hygiene, diet, etc., are important. Syringomyelia Definition. — A chronic affection of the spinal cord in which there is an cnihryonal neurogliar overgrowth about the central canal, with cavity formation. It is characterized, clinically, by progressive mus- 1. Journal of Osteopathy, Oct. 1904. 762 The Practice of Osteopathy cular atrophy, peculiar disturbances of sensation and various trophic and vasomotor disorders. The onset generally takes place before the thirtieth year. Males are much more commonly affected than females. It is claimed by some that the disease is infectious. It frequently fol- lows trauma. Pathologically, the condition begins with an overgrowth of em- bryonal neurogUar tissue. This is followed by degeneration of the gliomatous tissue with a formation of cavities, or this cavity formation may be the result of hemorrhage. The disease, in most cases, involves only the cervical or dorsal regions, and is usually in the posterior or postero-lateral tracts. The cavity may prevail throughout the entire cord, but usually only the cervical and dorsal regions are involved. The cavities lie in the gray matter outside of the canal. Symptoms. — The onset is slow. The symptoms depend upon the situation and extent of the cavity. As the disease most frequently in- volves the cervical region, the neck and arms are usually affected. At first neuralgic pains may develop in the muscles. Later there is progress- ive muscular atrophy and loss of painful and thermic sensations. Tac- tile and muscular senses are usually intact. The reflexes are increased and a spastic condition is present. The lower limbs usually escape, but when they are involved the cHnical picture may be that of amyotrophic lateral sclerosis. A lateral curvature is present. When the disease extends into the medulla, there will be various bulbar symptoms. Tro- phic changes and vasomotor disorders are common. A form of syringomyelia, known as Morvan's disease, is charac- terized by neuralgic pains, cutaneous anesthesia and painless felons. Diagnosis. — The progressive muscular atrophy, the retention of muscular and tactile senses, and the loss of thermic and painful sensations are typical symptoms. The diseases with which it may be confounded are: Cervical Pachymeningitis. The pain is usually greater, the tactile sense is lost and it runs a more rapid course. Anesthetic Leprosy. The trophic changes are more marked, tactile sensation is lost and the phalanges often drop off. Progressive Muscular Atrophy and Amyo- trophic Lateral Sclerosis. Sensory symptoms are wanting. Prognosis. — The prognosis is unfavorable. Duration is from five to twenty years. Treatment. — Little can be done except attending to the diet and hygiene of the patient and meeting urgent symptoms. Probably, con- tinued treatment along the spinal column would influence to some ex- tent the circulation of the cord in the region of the involvement. Hot The Peactice of Osteopathy /63 applications are of value in relieving pain and cramps. The X-ray has proven of some benefit in checking the progress of the disease. Amyotrophic Lateral Sclerosis "This is a chronic, progressive form of spinal paralysis, character- ized by the symptoms of progressive muscular atrophy in the arms and by lateral sclerosis or spastic paraplegia in the legs. " (Starr). It is sim- ilar to progressive muscular atrophy, except, in addition, there is sclerosis of the pyramidal tract. (See Progressive Muscular Atrophy.) Osier classes progressive muscular atrophy of spinal origin, amyotrophic lateral sclerosis and progressive bulbar paralysis as diseases of the whole efferent or motor tract, wherein these disorders may simply be various stages in the same case. He says, "A slow, atrophic change in the motor neurones is the anatomical basis, and the disease is one of the whole motor path, involving, in many cases, the cortical, bulbar, and spinal centers. " There can be no question that for the student, a classification of spinal cord diseases according to the whole motor tract, the upper motor segment, the lower motor segment, etc., is a scientific classification from our present knowledge of the histology and physiology of the neu- rone, but for clinical purposes the usual classification is given. Osteo- pathically, we are greatly in need of a new nosology, either according to the cause of the disorder or to the physiological disturbance. Amyotrophic lateral sclerosis does not occur so frequently as pro- gressive muscular atrophy. Heredity plays a part, and it affects older people. Injury to the spinal column is undoubtedly an important factor. Exposure and cold may be exciting causes. Infectious diseases and syphilis are probably important causes. Pathologically, there are atrophy in the anterior cornu and scle- rosis of the crossed and direct pyramidal tracts. There is sclerosis of cen- ters in the medulla. Symptoms. — Atonic atrophy, muscular weakness and fibrillar}'- contractions, of varying degrees, are characteristic. The reflexes are ex- aggerated; the arm and leg muscles become weak and finally rigid and atrophied. This results in deformity. Disturbances of sensation are not pronounced. The sphincters may be slightly affected. Diagnosis. — The disease is not so prolonged as progressive muscu- lar atrophy. Differentiation has to be made from multiple arthritis and transverse myelitis and s^aingomyelia. Treatment. — The same treatment as outlined for progressive mus- cular atrophy is indicated. The disease may bo retarded and life pro- longed. "64 The Practice of Osteopathy Progressive Muscular Atrophy A disease characterized by a slow, but progressive, loss of power and by muscular atrophy. Anatomically, it is characterized by de- generation of the gangHon cells of the gray matter in the cord. This atropliic affection develops just opposite to that of chronic anterior pol- iomj-ehtis. It is commonly a disease of males in middle life. Syphihs, rheumatism and lead poisoning predispose. It sometimes foUows cold, wet, exposure, traumatism, mental worries, overuse of certain muscles,, or prolonged emotional excitement. Hereditary influences are present in some cases. In all cases lesions are detected in the vertebrae and ribs, corresponding to the innervation of the diseased areas. Very likelj' these lesions are the starting point of the disease, by impairing nu- trition to the motor cells of the anterior cornu, and thus resulting in atrophy. Pathologically, the muscles are wasted, the fibers undergo fatty degeneration and there is an overgrowth of connective tissue. The peripheral motor fibers are degenerated. The anterior nerve roots leading to the horns are atrophied. The large gangUon cells of the an- terior horns are atrophied, or even entirely removed. The neuroghar tissue is increased. There is sclerosis of the anterior and lateral pj'ra- midal tracts of the cord in the majorit}- of cases. (See Amyotrophic Lateral Sclerosis). The pyramidal tracts have been found degenerated through the pons and internal capsule, even up to the motor cortex. When bulbar sjonptoms are present, there is degeneration of the motor nuclei of the medulla. The posterior columns are not involved. Symptoms. — IrregTilar pains, numbness or exhaustion are usually felt in the region that is soon to become wasted. The upper extremities are first affected. The muscles of the ball of the thumb waste first, then the interossei. From atrophy of the interossei and lumbricales and contraction of the long extensor and flexor muscles, the deformity known as "claw hand" results. The wasting creeps up from the forearm, arm and shoulder. The muscles of the trunk are gradually affected. The muscles of the lower extremity may escape entirely. The platysma myoides does not waste and is often hypertrophied. The face muscles are attacked late or not at all. The affected muscles often twitch. De- formities and contractm-es develop, notably lordosis. Sensation is not impaired although the patient may complain of numbness and coldness. The bladder and rectum are not affected, but sexual power may be lost. The paralysis is flaccid and the reflexes absent in the so-called atonic The Practice of Osteopathy 765 cases. In atonic atrophj^ there is more or less spasm, the reflexes are greatly increased, there are often contractm'es and the wasting is usually trifling. Diagnosis. — Differential diagnosis has to be made from syringomye- ha, chronic anterior poUomyehtis, lead palsy and muscular dystrophies. Prognosis. — The prognosis of progressive muscular atrophy is not favorable, although a number of cases have been greatly helped by an extended course of treatment. Treatment. — The treatment consists of a thorough, stimulating treatment of the innervation of the affected regions, with manipulation of the muscles and parts diseased. Correction of the lesions to the vertebrae and ribs, which are involving the innervation to the diseased tissues, is of primary importance. A cure cannot be expected when de- generation of the nerve centers has occurred; still, the progress of the disease may be checked in many cases, and the patient occasionally gain considerable strength. When atrophy starts in the muscles of the ball of the thumb, the lesion is to the median nerve, and derangements of the cervical vertebrae, from the fifth to the seventh, may be found. At- tention to the general health is important Outdoor hfe is preferable and gymnastic exercises are of value, but do not overtax the strength. Bulbar Paralysis (Labioglossolaeyngeal Paralysis) A progressive atrophy and paralysis, invading the lips, tongue, pharynx and larynx, due to involvement (sclerosis) of the motor nuclei of the medulla oblongata that supply these tissues. It is rarely pri- mary, more frequently secondary to tabes, amyotrophic lateral scle- rosis and diseases involving the motor nuclei of the medulla. Diph- theria, syphihs and lead poisoning are said to predispose. Osteopathic lesions of the upper cervical are also important factors in many cases. Halbert says: "The nuclei of the hypoglossal, the spinal accessory, the facial and the motor part of the trifacial nerves suffer most decidedly from the sclerotic degeneration. The nerve trunks and the muscles which they supply gradually show the effects of a similar degeneration." The acute form results from hemorrhage, embolism or inflamma- tory softening. The onset is usually sudden. The speech is difficult or entirely lost. There are dribbling of sahva, difficult swallowing, flabbiness and flaccidity of the lips and frequent choking spells occur. These cases may prove rapidly fatal. 766 The Practice of Osteopathy w The chronic form may result from progressive muscular atrophy, insular sclerosis, amyotrophic lateral sclerosis, acute ascending paralysis or chronic poUomyelitis. The paralysis starts in the tongue, the first symptom being a shght defect in the speech. When the Hps become involved, the patient cannot whistle and speech is rendered still more difficult. The hps are prominent and the lower one drops. The saUva is increased in amount and there is drooHng. Mastication of the food becomes difficult. The tongue becomes atrophied and the mucous membrane wrinkled. Fibrillary tremors of the lips and tongue are pres- ent. Sensory symptoms are not present. Taste is normal. Paralj^sis of the larynx is not so pronounced as of the other parts. Diagnosis. — This is generallj^ easy as the symptoms are well mark- ed. The prognosis is unfavorable. Treatment. — Little can be done in the majority of cases. Only in those cases where the paralysis is caused by cervical lesions can much hope be given. Derangements of the cervical vertebrae, especially the atlas and axis, occa.sionally influence the circulation in the medulla to such an extent that the motor nuclei are greatly involved. The sub- luxated vertebrae may interfere with the blood-vessels directly or through the vasomotor and trophic nerves. When the onset is not abrupt, the prognosis is more favorable. When deglutition is impaired, the stom- ach tube should be used in feeding the patient to prevent the food pass- ing into the trachea. The Practice of Osteopathy 767 ORTHOPEDIC SURGERY By H. S. Hain Orthopedic surgery deals with the mechanical or surgical prevention and correction of all deformities, especially those of children. It is not alone justifiable, but imperative, that orthopedic surgery be given a prominent position in any vip-to-date text on the Principles and Prac- tice of Osteopathy. The justification is threefold: though orthopedics was practiced to a limited extent before the Science of Osteopathy was developed, it has always been considered to be outside the realms of true surgery, in that it is practically bloodless, and those engaged in such practice have sought to establish it upon a platform of its own. The basis of the practice of orthopedic surgery and osteopathy is similar, if not identical, in that it deals almost entirely with bony abnor- maHties. It is recognized by the whole osteopathic profession, and unconsciously by some adherents of medical science, that the maintain- ance and restoration of normal function are alike dependent on a force inherent in bioplasm and that function perverted beyond the limits of self-adjustment, is dependent upon a condition of structure perverted beyond those Umits. This, then is the platform upon which the two sci- ences of osteopathy and orthopedic surgery are erected. The technique of osteopathic practice consists of passive manipu- lative measures, designed to render to the organism such aid as will en- able it to overcome or adapt itself to the disturbed structure; and does not seek, in itself, the aid of any instrument, mechanical appliance or plaster of Paris cast. Surely it is but a short step from our osteopathic therapeutics to a system of therapeutics where we find all sorts of mechanical and plaster of paris appliances, etc., to help our passive manipulation in rendering to the human organism such aid as will enable it to overcome or adapt itself to a disturbed structure. This latter, of course, is the modern science of orthopedic surgery, and because of the shortness of this step, I insist that it is one of the most valuable adjuncts of the science of osteopathy, it is frequently necessarj^ for the osteopathic practitioner to take this step as conditions are met with that have progressed beyond the possi- ])ihties of passive manipulations and again other conditions of perverted structure can be much more quickly reduced by the aid of each. It is then indisputable that the therapist who approaches disease from the osteopathic standpoint, above enunciated, is far more competent 768 The Practice of Osteopathy to deal with the mechanical problems of orthopedic surgery than any other known therapist. Secondly, in many conditions originally treated by orthopedic methods, subsequent ordinary osteopathic manipulations obtain a much more satisfactory and more lasting result than if it is withheld. Thirdly, in order to avoid possible error, it is of extreme im- portance that all osteopathic practitioners be particularly famiUar with the conditions hereinafter described, more especially tubercular condi- tions of the spine, bones and joints, primary spinal curvatures and others. It is reasonable and furthermore true that osteopathic physicians are confronted in practice with an unusually large percentage of cases indicated above, and the early recognition of such conditions is of fun- damental importance in order that osteopathic manipulations be with- held and supplemented or replaced by orthopedic methods. Space of course will not permit of the entire discussion of this vast subject but the most important and serious conditions met with in gen- eral practice are fully discussed in the following pages of this chapter. Perhaps the commonest condition coming under this line of thera- peutics, and one in w-hich we, as osteopaths, are most vitally interested is rotary lateral curvature of the spine. From my personal observation and from experiences of some of the most prominent members of our profession, I am led to beUeve that this is one of our most difficult lesions to overcome osteopathically, hence my desire to go further into this condition than most of us might expect. I had opportunity to obtain personally some verj^ valuable information from Dr. Joachim Stahl in the King's Charity Hospital in Berhn, and to him I am deeply grateful for many of the ideas of treatment presented in the following article. I believe that I have an accurate conception of the patho- logical condition that exists in connection with this deformitj^ and I beUeve that my treatment of it has been more successful than any that I have seen under other methods, in that I have gotten most excellent results, in selected cases, in a comparatively short time, entirely be- cause osteopathic manipulations and exercises were used in connection with the modified Abbott method. Scoliosis or Rotary Lateral Curvature Scoliosis or Lateral Curvature of the Spine is a deformity where the spine is deviated in w^hole or in part to one or the other side of the median line, which deviation is accompanied by an element of rotation. Though usually considered as a spinal deformity its effects are obvious outside the spinal area in so much as it will cause deformity of the pel- The Practice of Osteopathy 769 vis, legs, ribs, sternum, scapulae, and in severe cases, of the thoracic and abdominal viscera. Curvatures of the spine are the result of one of two distinct factors: first where there is a primary disease of the bone causing more or less destruction of the bone and spinal articulations, and resulting in per- manent spinal curvature. The most common example of this condition is seen in the angular curvature of Pott's disease. Rickets is usually responsible for a general long posterior curvature of the whole spine, as is osteomalacia with the superimposition of some lateral deviation. Fur- ther, any type of inflammation or trauma is capable of producing curva- tures of various types. Second, where there is no primary disease of the bone, joints, or ligaments, and where the curvature is due to exter- nal forces acting constantly or at frequently recurring intervals on the spine. Scoliosis or lateral curvature belongs to the second class. It is un- fortunately necessary to further subdivide scoliosis into two classes; one where the curvature is a position permanently maintained but cap- able of being reproduced by extreme physiological movement of a nor- mal spine, and secondly, a position which no normal spine can assume and which necessarily implies a change in the normal shape of the bones and intervertebral discs. The first may be described as a functional or postural lateral curvature, and the second as an organic or structural lat- eral cm-vature. Further, I might say that the first type may progress until it becomes the organic type. Pathology. — In scoliosis the spine undergoes not only curvature or lateral deviation but also rotation of the vertebral bodies which you will note always takes place towards the convexity of the curve. Changes in the Individual Vertebrae. — ^The bodies may be cither wedge shaped or lozenge shaped. In wedge shaped vertebrae, the bodies are compressed on the concave side and extended on the convex side, the intervertebral discs being atrophied on the shortened side. In the lozenge shaped type, the change in the bodies is most marked at the junction of the opposite curves, and is thus more commonly observed in compound curvatures. The pedicles are duected more antero-pos- teriorly on the convex side and more transversely on the concave side. The transverse processes on the convex side are more antero-posterior than normal, causing the vertical furrow between them and the spine to be narrower on this side. The spines point towards the concavity in structural curvatures and toward the convexity in the functional type. The vertebral foramen is rounded in the convexitj^ and pointed in the 770 The Practice of Osteopathy concavity. The edge of the anterior common Ugament toward the con- vexity is greatly thinned while it has a well marked edge on the concave border. A fibrous degeneration occurs in the muscles on the convexity owing to stretching, while atrophy from disuse takes place in those on the concave side. Associated changes in tlie Viscera. — The dorso-lumbar curva- vature decrease in the volume of the lower thorax on the dorso-convex side tends to cause pleural adhesions with obliteration of the pleural sac and consequent collapse. Tuberculosis of the lung is common in patients who suffer from scoliosis. The lieart is often overworked but the above lessening of the pulmonary area in turn results in hypertrophy and dilatation of the right ventricle and subsequent general venous stasis. The itidney on the convex side is compressed, and as a result degenerative changes are prone to occur. Thd spleen is frequently dis- placed upward and is liable to pathological changes. Organs such as the stomach, transverse colon, esophagus and trachea are frequently dis- placed owing to the bony deformity and are thereby more prone to patho- logical change. Etiology. — The essential factor in the production of scoliosis is spinal insufficiency, which includes spinal muscles and ligaments as well as the bones. In many instances, however, the following factors have an important augmenting or predisposing effect. 1. Occupational Deformity. — Primarily under this classifica- tion, I have found faulty positions adopted by school children as being the most comfortable, to be perhaps most important. Occupations such as those of nurse-maids, hod carriers, or stone cutters, are apt to induce scoliosis. 2. Diseases of the Central Nervous System. — Unilateral weakness or paralysis of the muscles of the trunk are common causes of scoliosis. Anterior poliomyelitis plays a particularly important part as it may induce deformity by distortion of the lower extremity or by any inequality in the length of the limbs due to retardation of growth, as well as inducing general weakness of the muscles of the trunk. Other nervous disorders that should be considered are spastic pari ay sis, locomotor ataxia, syringomyelia and Friedreich's ataxia. 3. Incidental Deformity.^ — Scoliosis may be caused b}^ direct injury or by fracture, Pott's Disease, or organic affections of the spine. Marked deformity caused by Sciatica or lumbar neuritis, if persistent may finally induce permanent deformity. The Practice of Osteopathy 771 4. Deformities Due to Diseases of tlie Cliest. — In empyema or pleurisy one side of the chest is retracted and it will be noticed that the curvature occurs toward the healthy side. Chronic pulmonary tuberculosis producing fibrosis of the lung gives the same result as em- pyema and pleurisy. 5. Deformiity due to obliquity of tlie pelvis. — This type may be due to any inequality of the limbs, such as equinus of the foot. Con- genital dislocation of the hip may play a part while one naturally lays stress on pelvic and lower lumbar lesions. 6. Deformity due to Distortion of Other Parts. — Unequal visions, unequal hearing, and torticolHs by causing malposition are etio- logical factors especially in school children. The loss of an arm will tend to cause an asymmetrical position of the trunk. 7. Congenital Deformity. — Congenital scoHosis occurs, but is usually associated with other congenital deformities of the spine, such as the reduction or increase of the vertebree, cervical rib, elevation of the scapula, etc. The deformity is usually not apparent until later years, though it may occur at birth. 8. Spinal Lesions. — Any osteopathic lesion predisposes to cur- vature because it interferes with the nerve supply and tonicity of the spinal muscles and could readily cause the faulty position. Functional or Postural Lateral Curvature This is a condition where there is a gradual curve to one side unac- companied by any marked rotation. The maximum deviation may be no more than one inch and a half from the middle line, which point is generally found about the tenth dorsal vertebra. In the vast majority of cases deviation is to the left and in such the following alterations will be noticed: a general convex cm-ve to the left; elevation, and anterior displacement of the left shoulder; posterior displacement of the right shoulder; in extension, the right side of the back will be higher than the left and in addition some torsion to the concave side, which is easily under- stood if one recalls the exact changes that take place during side move- ment of the normal spine. It is important to remember that functional scoliosis disappears when the patient is suspended or assumes the re- cumbent position. Organic or Structural Scoliosis This term is applied to cases where definite change has taken place in the vertebra3. Organic curves may be simple when the deviation is unaccompanied by any compensatory curve, or compound when a com- 772 The Practice of Osteopathy pensatory curve is present. We shall consider the deformities as they present themselves in the various regions of the spine. Cervico-Dorsal Curvature. — This condition is comparatively rare and according to Lovett occurs in only three and six tenths per cent of cases. The head is slightty deviated towards the concave side, the shoulder on the concave side is lowered, while on the opposite side or the side of the convexity it is naturally at a higher level. The angles of the upper ribs are prominent due to the co-existing rotation. The Dorsal Curvature. — The shoulder is raised on the convex side, and the rotation of the vertebrse is very marked, causing a very definite projection of the angles of the ribs on the convexity. This rotation also projects the scapula backwards on the convex side. On the concave side the scapula is flat and sunken, and the inferior angle rotated inwards and at a higher level than the opposite side. Viewed from the front the thorax may not be displaced at all, or it may be dis- placed toward the convex side, and if the latter is the case it is, of course more prominent on the concave side. In severe cases the lower end of the sternum is deviated towards the convexity and you will find that usually the arm hangs further from the convex side than from the op- posite one. The Lumbar Curvature. — Here we find the trunk displaced to- ward the side of the convexity, and the waist retracted on the opposite side. The difference in the level of the hips is the most prominent de- formity in this region, and it will be found that the hips are raised on the concave side. Rotation in this region is much less evident than in the dorsal region, but can be demonstrated by a fullness on the convex side of the curve, due to the projection of the transverse processes. Dorso-Lumbar Curvatures. — This condition is similar to a cer- tain extent, to a severe functional scoliosis. The findings observed in the last two regions above described will naturally be present in this type of curvature. It is not so frequently associated with compensa- tory curves as in the other types described. Compound Structural Curves. — The appearance in this type of scoliosis will, of course, be a combination of those described above according to the types of curvature in combination, that is to say right dorsal and left lumbar, etc. If one type predominates the appearance will be chiefly that found in that particular type of curvature. The relative frequency of the common type, as given by Schaltless, in eleven hundred and thirty seven cases is as follows; functional scoliosis, 15.39%; lumbar, 11.7%; dorsal, 19%; dorso-lumbar, 20%; cervico-dorsal, 3.6%; compound, 30%. The Practice of Osteopathy 773 Diagnosis. — To the osteopathic physician the diagnosis of scol- iosis is not difficult. Let me caution you that true scoliosis must be distinguished from th6 lateral curvatures caused by Pott's disease. Vertebral rotation, the absence of pain, the extreme rigidity, the char- acteristic appearance of the ribs and thorax should, however, make the diagnosis of scoliosis easy. Treatment. — In general the treatment of scoliosis is difficult to present, because every case is considerably different, and the amount of correcting force used in any form is almost entirely a matter of judg- ment, as is also the time when corrective pressure should be discon- tinued. Continual practice in the treatment of these conditions is most essential to your success with them. I have had most gratifying results in a comparativel}^ short time simply because I used osteopathic treat- ment and exercises along with a modified Abbott method. Functional or False Scoliosis The functional or false scoliosis might be regarded as a habitual inability to stand correctly, simply a postural malposition and lack of muscle tone without marked structural change, which is maintained for a considerable length of time or where the position is repeated several times daily. The treatment of selected t3^pes of this deformity is most successful and may well be divided into three procedures: first, the substitution of a correct attitude for the faulty one, that is careful investi- gation should be made to ascertain the condition which might be the cause of the incorrect position such as poor school desks which might cause the child to reach either up or down to write, poorly fitting clothing which causes a pulling on the shoulder, eye strain which would cause tilting or twisting of the neck, congenital shortening of one limb or too rapid growth, should all be looked for and removed ; second, regular osteopathic manip- ulation, at least three times per week to increase the tonicitj'' of the already weakened spinal muscles and aid correction, are highly essential and shortens the time required for a complete cure; third, supervised gymnastic exercises of various kinds are very beneficial to develop and bring the musculature back to normal. Such simple exercises as crawl- ing on the hands and knees in a small circle towards the side of the con- vexity, and the hanging from a horizontal bar by the arm on the side of the concavity will prove to be helpful. Some authors recommend the regular army setting up exercises for some cases or a frame by means of which the hips are fixed, and rotating and side bending exercises of the head and trunk given. These last two exercises are indeed very rea- 774 The Practice of Osteopathy sonable procedures but I have found them unnecessary mainly because I used osteopathic manipulations instead. In advising and supervising exercises it is best to have the patient's back bared so that the effect of each movement can be noticed and the exercises directed accordingly. Care and judgment should be used as to the number and severity of the exercises and would depend of course on the vigor of the child. Treatment should continue until the condi- tion has been overcome, and the patient should be under observation for a couple of months afterwards so that any recurrence of the deformity would be noticed and attended. Organic or Structural Scoliosis The treatment of organic or structural scoliosis is more complicated for it must be remembered there are two elements of the deformity de- manding correction; one, the lateral curve to be corrected by a side force, and the other, the rotation of the vertebrae to be corrected by a twisting force. I find both osteopathic manipulation and gymnastic exercises are of great value in the correction of this deformity as they help to loosen the curve and develop the musculature but used alone good results can rarely he obtained especially in obstinate curvatures. I believe that I have improved nutrition and probably prevented further deformity by treatments and exercises, but I am quite positive that it is not possible to correct an organic scoliosis without the forcible cor- rection used in the Abbott method. As the details of treatment are tedious to follow, we will take for example a case of right dorsal curvature presenting a marked hump de- formity, with a compensatory curve to the left in the lumbar region, as this is the most common type. I might say here that whether or not a compensatory curve is present, makes no difference, as treatment is di- rected entirely to the primary curve on the assumption that overcor- rection of it will cause a secondary curve to disappear by compensation. The patient is prepared by putting on a snug fitting undershirt and sewing pads of saddler's felt over all bony prominences, especially the crest of the ileum and anterior superior spine. Sometimes I take a piece of felt of four or five inches wide and long enough to go around the en- tire pelvis, just high enough to cover the brim, and fasten it in front with adhesive. Next I make a bunch of pads two or three inches in thickness and large enough to fill up the concavity of the left side, and first sew them together, and then with a few stitches fasten them to the undershirt thereby filhng up the space on the concave side. The edges The Practice of Osteopathy 775 of the pads should, of course, be trimmed down to conform with the general contour of the body, the main thickness being in the middle. I then sew a single pad on the right side of the thorax in front and a httle to the right side. The patient is now ready for the Abbott frame and is placed on a canvas hammock about twelve inches wide, which is cut on the bias so the right side is three inches shorter than the left. The hammock can be adjusted to the desired degree of flexion by a ratchet at the foot of the regular Abbott frame. The limbs of the patient should be elevated to increase the flexion as this has a tendency to unlock the articulation and thereby help in overcoming the rotation. Next a canvas bandage four in- patient suspended on canvas hammock in regular Abbott frame ready to apply cast for a right dorsal curvature. Notice manner of applying the correcting canvas straps. ches wide is passed around the patient under the axilla of the concave side and fastened to the frame on the opposite side, and another one is placed around the pelvis and fastened to the same side of the frame, both on a level with the body plane. A third bandage is next placed around the point of greatest convexity and fastened to the opposite side of the frame in such a way that it can be tightened and a direct pull be made on the curve. Before tightening the last bandage the left arm and shoulder should be brought up high beside the face and pulled backward toward 776 The Practice of Osteopathy the floor as it is this twisting force that produces some rotation of the thorax. The correcting bandage is now tightened being careful not to •^ause the patient too much discomfort. I always use ordinary absorbent cotton for padding, which is held in place by the regular gauze bandage. The plaster of Paris bandages should be applied high up under the left shoulder and well down over the sacrum and innominate bones and should be of a uniform thickness of half an inch. Sometimes I carry the plaster over the right shoulder to hold it down and back, though not alwaj^s. I always let the cast set pretty well before removing the pa- tient from the frame and if it has been applied in the morning I find it best to wait until afternoon before trimming and cutting the windows because there is less danger of break- ing it. In trimming I always smooth up the edges, lower the right shoul- der, but keep the left well up, trim off enough at the bottom in front to allow the thighs to be readily flexed without obstruction, and leave it low behind so as to maintain the flexion. Next, two holes or windows are cut in the cast, one over each area where the pads were inserted, and remove them. The hole in the back on the left or concave side permits expan- sion of the chest to the back, while the hole on the right side in front allows the ribs, which are posterior, to move forward under pressure or the pads to be inserted at the pos terior angle or backward prominence of the ribs of the convexity. Tht canvas bandages or straps around both the axilla and pelvis are re- moved, but the one about the convexity of the cm've is left in place so as to assist in the after treatment. The patient usually suffers some discomfort such as difficulty in breathing and the inability to move the body freely, and should remain in bed a day or two after the cast has been applied. Usually they sleep very poorly the first few nights, but the spine soon gives under the pressure and they become comfortable. When the cast has become quite comfortable an assistant pulls on the Cross section sketch of a right dorsal curvature showing deformity in the thorax and rotation of the vertebrae, also windows which are cut in the cast to allow expansion in these two direc- tions and the directing force of the pads. These are placed over the angles of the ribs. Arrows show directions of the various forces. The Practice of Osteopathy 777 canvas bandage which was left around the convexity, while pads are inserted so that the greatest pressure is exerted on the angle of the ribs to further overcome the rotation and decrease the lateral deformity. Also heavy felt pad may be inserted over the bulging ribs in front of the left side to push them back. Care should be taken that too much pres- sure is not brought to bear on the side of the convexity because if more pressure is exerted here than on the angles of the ribs, it will tend to increase rather than decrease. Casts should be worn for different periods, some being changed in a month while others can be worn for three months. It is entirely a mat- ter of judgment. My best results have been secured by only slightly correcting the curvature at the time the cast was applied, and relying more on the proper insertion of the pads. Often at the end of a month or six weeks, in selected cases, I have split the cast down the front and removed it by springing it apart, and administered osteopathic manipu- lations to the spine freely in all dnections, thoroughly loosening up the muscles. Then I replace the cast and hold it together in front with mole- skin adhesive and insert the pads as before. I repeat this procedure thi'ee times per week for another month, together with daily exercises each morning and evening of drawing the left shoulder up and forward while in the cast to develop the muscles of the left shoulder girdle. The treatments and exercises certainly do build up the spinal muscles for it must be realized that they have suffered in nutrition to a great extent as a result of wearing the cast. Next the cast can be worn during the day and removed at night, and gradually it can be left off several hours at a time. If no bad results occur it can be left off for longer periods until finally its use can be discontinued. However, the patient should still be under observation once a week for a couple of months to determine any recurrence of the deformity. The resumption of active corrective treatment, or increasing relaxation in gymnastic work, will, of course, depend upon the progress of the case. In the more obstinate cases, casts should be applied as long as fur- ther correction can be obtained. The procedure is entirely the same, only the time required for correction is longer, sometimes a year or year and a half, and when over-correction has been maintained, it is better to use a removable jacket made of celluloid or light stiffened leather, with large windows cut over the region where pressure is to be avoided, than the removable cast described above. In closing let me say that this method of correcting lateral curvature is best adapted to patients during their growing period and though it 778 The Practice of Osteopathy may be employed in older eases you will usually be disappointed in the final result. The only reason I can see for treating older cases is purely mercenar3^ Congenital Dislocation of the Hip Unilateral Undoubtedly as far back as 1829, the actual recognition of this con- dition was due to the pathological research of a French surgeon Du- puytren, who described this deformity with great accuracy and insisted that there was no possible chance of correction. From then on until 1886 nothing was done bj^ medical science to overcome the deformity, though it is claimed some were made. It was in this year that the famous Bavarian surgeon, Hoffa, gave to the medical profession the results of his successful attempts at reduction by opening the hip joint from be- hind and enlarging the acetabulum to a size sufficient to hold the head of the femur. Orthopedic surgery has to thank the irritating effects on the skin, of antiseptics necessary in preparing his hands for ordinary surgery, as it was due to this triviality that Lorenz, a promising surgeon of Vienna, transferred his energies to the field of bloodless surgery and gave to us the most valuable early work and present day technique in the bloodless reduction of congenital dislocation of the hip. The name, of course, is applied to a congenital deformity which in- volves one or both hip j oints, resulting in lameness, due to a misplacement of the head of the femur from the acetabulum. Of all congenital dislo- cations the hip joint is by far the most common and most important. The misplacement is far more often unilateral than bilateral and far more frequent in females than in males, the cause for the latter probably being the difference which exists in aspect and position of the acetabulum as well as the disproportionate laxity of the capsule in the two sexes. It must be remembered that normally at bii'th, the acetabulum covers only about one-third of the head of the femur, and our most accepted theory as to the cause of this deformity, is a defective development of the aceta- bulum or its posterior margin, which may be primary or secondary to an abnormally prolonged fixation of the limb in a position of flexion or adduction while in utero. At birth it is quite probable that the disloca- tion is a subluxation only, which becomes complete by muscular action and the use of the limb in standing and walking. The pathology of this disease is clearly established, and varies, of course, with the age of the patient in strain and friction to which the The Practice of Osteopathy 779 misplaced parts have been subjected. In children over two and one- half years of age the acetabulum is usually shallow and small, and filled with a deposit of fat and fibrous tissue. It is covered with normal hya- line cartilage and nearly alw^ays the ligamentum teres is present, but is so badly stretched and ribbon-like that ultimately the artery accom- panying it fails to function, resulting in a malformation of the head of the femur. The capsular Hgament is elongated and thickened to ac- commodate the upper displacement of the femur, and the anterior wall of it is stretched tight across the acetabulum like an hour glass. The interior of the capsule is always partly lined with synovial membrane. Usually a secondary acetabulum is found upon the ileum, formed by the direct pressure of the head of the femur through the capsule and the re- sult of irritation of the periosteum of the ileum, but it is as a rule, not deep enough to form a secure support for the head of the bone. The neck of the femur is usually shorter than nor- mal and the upper extremity of the bone is somewhat atrophied. The pelvis is usually sKghtly atrophied on the affected side, and a lateral inclination of the spine may be present. The long muscles of the thigh are shortened; while those attached to the pelvis and tro- chanter are changed in direction and are usu- ally lengthened. Symptoms. — As a rule congenital disloca- tion of the hip is not accompanied by the defective development or deformity elsewhere, and the sjanptoms are so diagnostic that there is little difficulty in recognizing this condition even without the X-ray which is, of course, a positive diagnosis. Rarely does the displacement attract attention until the child be- gins to walk. Often the child does not walk as early as it should. Some- times it may be delayed until the eighteenth month or second year and then it walks with a limp which becomes more pronounced as the child grows older until at the fourth or fifth year it is very decided. The limp is peculiar and its character is explained by its cause; for the shortened hmb, owing to the elasticity of the capsule, becomes still shorter when the weight is borne upon it, thus causing a pecuHar lunge of the body to- wards the short side like the normal motion of walking downstairs. In compensation, of course, the pelvis is tilted towards the short limb and its inclination is thereby increased, so that the anterior superior spine Tjrpical congenital dis- location of the hip, show- ing the "hour glass" con- striction of the capsular ligament. 780 The Practice of Osteopathy Outline of a radiograph following reduction and removal of the first cast in unilateral dislocation of the hip. Notice the head in the socket and the thigh still flexed and abducted. lies at a lower level and in advance of the op- posite side. Usually the affected limb is about an inch shorter than the sound one, and in adult life it is considerably more. The range of abduction is much diminished, but flexion, ex- tension and adduction are quite normal, and the trochanter will be found elevated about an inch above Nelaton's line. If the thigh be flexed and adducted to. its extreme limit, the neck and head of the femur can be easily distinguish- ed moving under the gluteal muscles when the limb is rotated, or the head can usually be readily palpated in front when the limb is ex- tended. Then, too, by fixing the pelvis and using traction and upward pressure on the limb, the abnormal mobility or telescopic motion is easily demonstrated and this, I might add, is a very important test. Rarely do we find a unilateral anterior dislocation, in which the head of the bone lies beneath the anterior superior spine, but when this posi- tion is present, the sjnnptoms are much less marked than in the ordinary form because the relation of the pelvis to the femur is more nearly normal. The limp and the shortening of the limb are less noticeable because the tissues attached to the anterior superior spine form a relatively secure support. The X-ray, of course, makes the diagnosis complete. Even though the clinical diagnosis is certain, a radiograph is indispensible in every case, particularly for the purpose of ascertaining the exact position of the head and condition of the acetabulum and femur. The acetabulum is usually shallow and poorly de- veloped, more particularly the ihac portion of its rim. After the reduction of the dislocation, an X-ray picture should always be taken within the first few weeks, and before the plaster of paris cast has been removed, to ascertain whether the head of the femur is still in place. As to bilateral dislocation of the hip, the pathology, of course, is the same as in the unila- teral type. The shortening of the limbs is as a Outline of the same case following removal of the second cast. The head of the femur is firmly fixed in the acetabulum and the position of the limb is nearlv normal. The Practice of Osteopathy 781 rule equal or nearly so, and when both femurs are displaced backward, the pelvis is tilted forward thus presenting a marked lumbar lordosis and protruding abdomen. The pelvis seems to be abnormally wide, both buttocks are flattened and the thighs are separated by a consider- able space. The characteristic hmp in this condition is an exaggerated waddle, often spoken of as "sailor gait." Again in this condition rarely do we find an anterior dislocation, but when such is the case, the entire body is swayed entirely backward, though the lumbar lordosis is not increased, in fact usually presents a peculiarly flattened appearance. Other symptoms differ only in a slight degree from those of the ordinary posterior displacement. The physical signs are the same as the uni- lateral displacement and are even more readily recognized by the peculiar appearance and distinctive gait of the patient. The swaggering gait of himbar Pott's Disease is somewhat similar, but this is an acquired clin- ical condition of the spine in which the hip joints are normal in appear- ance and nearty so in function. Before taking up the usual procedure for the correction of congenital dislocation of the hip, it might be interesting to touch on several cases of this deformity in young children that I have reduced without an an- esthetic. If future experience proves as successful as these cases it will entirely revolutionize the treatment of this condition especially in chil- dren under twenty months of age. To begin with, these children had just started to walk and it must be remembered that at this stage the aceta- bula are nearly normal and there has been no muscular or ligamentous contraction because very Uttle weight has been borne on the limb. First the pelvis is held fixed by the assistant, and the thighs com- pletely flexed on the abdomen. Next firm pressure is made on the knee to force the head of the femur beneath the acetabulum and as the Hmb is abducted in the flexed position, the head is raised into the acetabulum with the thumb of the operator's other hand. The whole procedure takes but a moment's time and the child should be placed at once upon the floor and allowed to walk. Time will tell if the reduction has been suc- cessful, and if failure of retention develops, the Lorenz method followed by plaster of Paris fixation can still be used. I should always recom- mend the trial of this method in children who have walked not longer than six months, before resorting to the following Lorenz treatment. Treatment by the Lorenz Operation. — This treatment is based on the fact that there is normally present an acetabulum of sufficient size and capacity to retain the head of the femur, providing the limb can be fixed in a favorable attitude, and as soon as possible weight borne 782 The Practice of Osteopathy upon it to deepen the rudimentary acetabulum. The typical operation of today is best divided into fom- distinct steps; first, to overcome the resistance of the tissues surrounding the joint; second, to reduce the dis- location, or rather to force the head of the femur over the posterior bor- der of the acetabulum; third, to inci-ease the security of the articulation by stretching the anterior border of the capsule; fourth, to fix the parts in a plaster of Paris bandage. The child is completely anesthetized, and an assistant firmly fixes the pelvis on the table with his hand. The operator first flexes the thigh to a right angle with the bodj^ and forcibly abducts, at the same time kneading and stretching the tense adductor muscles and if necessary rup- turing the adductor tendons in order to bring the limb down to the plane with the body. Next to overcome the contraction of the posterior tis- sues, the limb fully extended is flexed upon the trunk and gradually forced downward until the toes touch the patient's face. To overcome the resistance of the tissues on the front of the joint, it is best to move the patient to the edge of the table and forcibly extend the thigh down- ward behind the plane of the body. It is also well to apply direct trac- tion in the line of the body. This preliminary stretching is absolutely necessary, because all the tissues about the joint are so shortened, and it will now be noted that with slight traction the trochanter can be drawn down to Nelaton's line. Next reduction is attempted by grasping the limb with one hand at the knee and strongly abducting it while the palm of the other hand is placed on the anterior spine of the ihum with the thumb placed beneath the great trochanter to act as fulcrum. As the limb is gradually forced downward to and behind the body plane, the head of the femur is forced upward until it finally slips over the posterior and inferior border of the acetabulum. In the more resistant cases a padded wedge-shaped block placed behind the trochanter will be an aid in pushing the head for- ward and upward while the patient's knee is forced downward. A suc- cessful reduction is usually accompanied by a distinct jar and audible thud, and it would be observed that the tension upon the ham string muscles causes fixed flexion of the leg. After reduction has been made, the limb should be brought down carefully into a straight position to test the security of the re-position. If dislocation appears during this manipulation, the tissues must be still fm'ther stretched and the dis- placement further reduced. If displacement occurs readily due to a shallowness of the acetabulum the prognosis is not so good as where the stability remains when the limb is brought down into a straight The Practice of Osteopathy 783 Patient in position for the first cast in a left uni- lateral dislocation. The thigh should be a little past a right angle in rela- tion to the trunk, with about 80° abduction. position, and one must be more particular in the fixation of it. I have also observed that the more difficult the reduction the more stable the end results. The easy replacements are usually just as easily displaced. Sometimes the head slips into the socket quietly without the distinct jar or thud but the results in these cases are just as good provided they are pro- perly cast. The application of the plaster spica is by far the most important part of the treatment, as the reduction is usually quite easily accom- pHshed in children under six years of age. If the cast is improperly apphed, the hip will sUp out of the socket and the case is a failure. A pair of soft knitted cotton drawers are put on and the patient is placed upon a pelvic rest with the limb held in the position of greatest stability at a right angle with the trunk, or even slightly more and about eighty degrees abduction. In a case where the socket is very shallow, the position to be cast should be about one hundred de- grees flexion, and in abduction the hmb should lie sHghtly behind the plane of the body to secure the best results. The limb and pelvis are covered with ordinary absorbent cotton which is held in place with a roller gauze bandage. A snug fitting plaster of Paris cast is now applied around the pelvis and well down over the knee. I leave this over the knee for five or six days or until the child ceases to be fretful, then I cut it away just back of the knee joint to per- mit motion there. The ends of the drawers are drawn back smoothly over the cast and are sewed to each other. For about a week following the operation the adductor regi3n is swollen and discolored and more or less painful due to rupturing and stretching of those tendons. After this discomfort has passed away, walking is encour- aged on the theory that the weight bearing and the stimulation of functional activity will in- crease the stability of the joint by deepening the acetabulum. The first cast should remain from three to six months according to the stability of the joint at the time of reduction. If in young children the cast becomes offensive, it must be changed as often as is necessary. When Correct position and proper application of cast for double congenital dis- location of the hips. 784 The Practice of Osteopathy Proper position of the limb in the second cast for unilat- eral dislocation. the first cast is removed, the hmb is pulled down to about thirty degi'ees abduction and the same amount of flexion, without an an- esthetic, and a second cast is applied, which extends only to the knee, to be worn from three to six months longer. After removal of second cast, the child is permitted to get about carefully. The limb will be everted and slightl}^ flexed, which position invariably causes much concern among the relatives of the patient, but this abnormal condition disappears after a few months' time. Some- times for even a year following removal of the second cast there will also be a no- ticeable hitch in the walk of the child, but this, too, disappears and in the course of two years' time one could never tell that such an operation had been performed. Massage of the posterior and lateral mus- cles of the hip always helps considerably towards the relief of any stiffness or lameness. Reduction by Open Incision In the more resistant older cases, where manipulative reduction has failed, reduction by incision can be employed with success, but this procedure requires the exercise of care in order to do as little injury to the muscles as possible. A crucial incision of the capsule is made and the capsular constriction and ilio-psoas tendon divided. With a little traction, the head of the femur slips easily into its socket. The capsule is stretched firmly around the neck and the incision into the capsule is then closed by suture, and the limb fixed in a plaster of Paris spica in the fully abducted position. The operation should of course be done under the strictest asepsis. Talipes or Club Foot The word talipes signifies some deformity of the foot and is quite common in orthopedic practice, being found in nearly ten per cent of the cases coming under this branch of the science. Club foot may be classified into two types — the congenital and the acquu'ed. The congen- ital type is the most common and is due probably to abnormal intrauter- ine pressure or to a perversion of normal intrauterine development. The Practice of Osteopathy 785 The acquired type is due usually to injury or infantile paralysis, but either joint disease or cerebral paralysis may be the cause. The de- formity presents six different forms with most characteristic chnical pictures which, with the exception of talipes planus I have taken up in the order of frequency. Talipes Equino varus is usually congenital and is the most com- mon type. It is characterized by inversion and torsion of the foot with elevation of the heel. The weight is borne on the outer side of the foot and in extreme cases upon the dorsum as well. Calluses are always present which are red and painful upon the point where the greatest Illustrating the more common types of talipes. A combination of any may be present. weight is borne. The most common method of treating this condition is to divide the tendo Achilles at a level with ths malleoli. The oper- ation should be done aseptically and under complete anesthesia. As an assistant raises the end of the foot so as to stretch the tendo Achil- les the surgeon enters the knife parallel to the border of the tendon through the skin and tendon sheath into the tendon itself. Next with a tenotome inserted into the incision and turned at right angles to the tendon, the tendon is divided fii'st on one half then on the other. Care should be tak- en to disturb the tendon sheath as little as possible for it serves an im- portant purpose in repair. When the division is complete as indicated by the separation of the divided ends, the tenotome is withdrawn and tlu! luinuto opoiiinK in the skin, from which 1here is only slight bleeding. 786 The Practice of Osteopathy is covered with aseptic gauze. The foot is forced into dorsal flexion and if in severe cases the deformity is not then corrected, the tendons on the outer side of the foot may be shortened, while those on the inner side may be lengthened in the same manner as the tendo Achilles. A plaster of Paris cast is then apphed well up to the knee with the foot in the over corrected position, care being taken that no undue pressure is brought upon the seat of operation^ as this might interfere with the effusion of plastic material. Personally I believe that functional use of the limb and foot stimulate repair, and I always encourage the patient to stand and walk after the discomfort of the operation has passed. At the end of four weeks the space between the two cut ends will be filled with new material and the cast can be removed, and in another month the splice, which is somewhat larger and thicker than normal, should be strong enough for use. In the course of a year the lengthened tendon is per- fectly normal. Talipes Equinus. — ^In this type the patient walks on his toes with the heel highly elevated, in the same position as the horse, and it will be noticed that the foot has no dorsal flexion whatsoever. Infantile paral- ysis affecting the anterior muscles of the leg is usually the cause of this condition, though sometimes shortening of the leg following knee joint disease, or fracture may lead to an adaptive equinus which serves to make the limb of equal length for walking. This type is by far the easiest to remedy, and the results following operations are perfect. A simple division of the tendo Achilles is made under anesthesia and a cast applied as above, in a position of exaggerated dorsal flexion. Func- tional use of the limb after the cast has been removed overcomes any stiffness that might occur and perfect results are obtained in a short time, compared with the other types. Talipes Caleaneous. — This is a condition in which the foot is held in a position of dorsal flexion. The patient walks on the heel with an inelastic gait because the spring of the foot is absent and the whole weight is borne upon the os calcis. The best procedure in this type is manipulative treatment into a position of plantar flexion to overcome the contraction of the anterior muscles of the foot and leg, and bring about contraction and shortening of the posterior muscles. A tenotomy of the anterior tendons or an anesthetic is rarely indicated, though in severe cases, a series of casts holding the foot in position of plantar flexion may be necessary to secure good results. I have found it a help to have a shoe with a heel prolongated backward, or a steel splint laced to the leg to prevent the foot from upward motion. The Practice of Osteopathy 787 Talipes Valgus. — This is a very uncommon type of deformity, characterized by eversion of the foot. The patient walks on the inside of the foot and, as a rule, experiences very little trouble. I find a ma- nipulative treatment is best for this condition, aided by braces. Talipes Cavus. — This form is sometimes called "hollow foot" and is very uncommon in this country. It is characterized by a marked- 1}^ high arch sometimes as in Chinese women to the extent that the anter- ior part of the foot is approximated to the heel. The plantar fascia is badly contracted and one can distinctly palpate the bands beneath the skin. This condition is practically the same as the ordinary so-called •'contracted foot" except that it is much more exaggerated. The ordinary high arch of today is usually the result of wearing too short a shoe, and if painful, long last shoes, aided by manipulations, will usually correct the trouble. In severe cases of contracted foot the plantar fascia may be divided, under anesthesia and the arch brought down and put in a cast, though this procedure is not very successful. In case it is done the patient should be made to walk in two or three weeks, as this helps materially to overcome the deformity and hasten repair of the fascia. Talipes Planus. — This condition is commonly known as "flat foot" and is taken up in another part of this text. However, it is one of the classifications of "club foot" and is far the most common type. Prognosis. — These conditions never correct themselves and if uncorrected usually get worse and the more severe types certainly become obstinate malformations. In general the tendency to relapse is strong, though if properly treated the results are excellent. In infantile cases the time required for correction is relatively short, but retentive appli- ances are needed for a longer time. The older the cases and larger the foot the more difficult, of course, the correction, but usually there is less danger of relapse. A perfect correction, that is when the gait and attitude are normal, will never relapse. I find it better to leave the fixa- tion appliance on too long than not long enough. Never remove a cast under four weeks except in the cavus type, then apply a brace such as can be obtained from any supply house for any type of case, for from one to three months longer. The tendons involved in these conditions are so apparent that it is almost impossible to make a mistake in the division of them. About the only precaution necessary is to be assured that the tendon itself is completely divided, but that the tendon sheath is only slightly disturbed. 788 The Practice of Osteopathy Tuberculous Disease of the Bones and Joints Perhaps no bony lesion has caused so much difference of opinion in this profession as tubercular conditions of the spine, bones and joints and I wish it understood that in the following discussion, it is not mj' desire to reopen the argument. My observations have been of cases treated both osteopathically and by fixation, in private practice and institutional work. And I have come to the conclusion that the fixa- tion method of treatment is absolutely always indicated. In general the pathology and etiology of all tubercular bone conditions is the same. It begins as a tubercular infection of the spongy tissue of the epiphysis, the first change being a local hyperemia of the portion involved, followed by one of thi'ee courses : the diseased focus being absorbed and a sponta- neous cure resulting; it may extend to the periphery of the bone and break through the periositum and empty itself there by abscess formation; or most commonl}^ it may extend to the joint, which becomes involved through attendant injury-. Repair is brought about by the formation of fibrous tissue probably arising from the layer of non-tuberculus gran- ulation tissue which grows in and replaces the tuberculous tissue. Also the replacing material may become calcified and encapsulated. A fi- brous or bony ankjdosis may result from this process of repair. The vulnerabiUty of growing bone accounts for the frequency of tubercular bone disease in cliildren as compared with adult life. Injury not only causes a local predisposition to the disease, but it favors its pro- gress when it is once estabhshed. About seven-eighths of the cases of this trouble occur under fourteen years of age, more especially when the vertebrae or liip-joint are involved. The knee and anlde joints as well as the elbow and shoulder joints are more often diseased in later fife. While the inherited predisposition is very direct and positive in twenty-five percent of the cases, the acquired predisposition is of most importance since it includes lessened vitality due to poor food and imperfect hygienic surroundings. As to the distribution of the disease the vertebrae are most commonly affected, followed closely by the hip and knee joints, and then in the order of frequency the ankle, elbow, shoulder and wrist joints. Tubercular Disease of the Spine This condition is commonly called Pott's Disease or Caries. It is a chronic destructive process of the bodies of the vertebrae. The spine bends at the weakest point and the compression and collapse of the affected parts cause the characteristic posterior angular projection at the seat of the disease. If one vertebral body is destroj^ed, the projec- The Practice of Osteopathy 789 tion will be sharp; ix several are involved it will be less angular and if one side breaks down before the other, there may be a lateral as well as posterior distortion. The size of the deformity and its effect upon the patient depend upon its situation; that is, if either end of the spine is involved the angular projection is sHght because the area of the spine di- rectly involved in the deformity is small compared with that which is free from the disease. If the middle of the spine is affected, the deformity is great, because the entire spinal column may enter into the angular projection. In the latter area the internal organs are compressed and, of course, the effect upon the vital organisms of the body is disastrous. Pathology. — The first indication of tubercular disease of the spine is usually found in the anterior part of a vertebral body just beneath the fibro-periosteal layer of the anterior longitudinal hgament. From this point the foci may advance along the front of the spine following the course of the blood vessels and invading the adjacent vertebral bodies. The destruction may begin in the interior of the body itself, more often in several minute foci near the upper or lower epiphysis, which coalesce gradually enlarge and form a cavity surrounded, for a time, by unbroken cortical substances which finally collapse under the pressure of the weight above. The intervertebral discs seem to offer some resistance to the extension of the disease from one vertebra to another but once the bone is destroyed on either side, they too quickly disintegrate and disappear. Pedicles and articulations which come into direct contact with the disease may become involved. Originally the disease is confined to one or two adjacent vertebrae and may extend in either direction, and the final area of deformity and rigidity shows that from three to six bodies may be involved before a cure is estabUshed. The infected granulations ad- vance rapidly with the usual retrograde change of shape and structure to a cheesy degeneration and frequently liquifaction and abscess forma- tion may follow. Symptoms of Pott's Disease. — There are three main symptoms of Pott's disease, namely the peculiarity of attitude and gait, limitation of motion or muscular stiffness and the pain and referred pains. In the cervical region, the chin is held somewhat raised and the patient may have somewhat the same appearance as in wry-neck. In the mid- dorsal region one will always find an elevation of the shoulder besides the deformity. In the lumbar region, the patient nearly always leans })ackward and has a sort of sidling gait or waddle due to the contraction of the psoas and iliacus muscles. The patient in walking, stooping, or lying down most carefully guards the spine against any jar or motion, 790 The Practice of Osteopathy and always assumes attitudes which will relieve the strain on the in- volved vertebrae. There is always present an unnatural mode of stand- ing or walking, especially when the dorsal and lumbar regions are in- volved, as the patient walks more on his toes and with the knees slightly bent, because in this posture all possible strain of the step may be brought into play to diminish jarring of the spine. The child becomes tired very easily and hes down or rests on the arms of a chair or seat. The pain rarely occurs in the back, but is usually referred to the peripheral end of the nerves and is thus felt in the chest, abdomen or limbs. The abdominal pain passes sometimes as a stomach ache and often times in the Kmbs, as rheumatism or "growing pains". I have noticed ako a peculiar grunting respiration and sometimes cough especially when the mid-dorsal region is involved. Muscular stiffness is always present, all mobihty being lost. The temperature is not at all diagnostic, though sometines in the afternoon it will be one or two degrees higher than normal and does occur independently of abscesses. About the only com- plication that occurs is paralysis or abscess formations. Paralysis is given as a frequent compUcation, though I have never seen it. It is us- ually flacid and bilateral and may exist from a mere muscular weakness to a complete loss of power. It is certainly uncommon under proper treatment, and the prognosis is favorable. Abscesses, though a very distressing compUcation, are very uncommon in my experience and are certainly an evidence of improper or incomplete treatment. They may subside in any region and be absorbed without detriment to the patient, though if they increase in size there is no tendency towards absorption. It is best to incise them and secure complete drainage. It is hard, of course, to do this on account of the depth. Abscesses occur always in close proximity to the disease. Treatment. — Some authors recommend a brace for the treatment of this condition, while others recommend a frame to which the patient is strapped, and rest in bed. I have found nothing that gets results like a plaster of Paris jacket apphed with the patient suspended by the neck and shoulders. I make no attempt at correction of the de- formity present other than the traction of the weight of the body at the time the cast is applied. The spine is, of course, fully extended by this and any undue pressure on the cord reheved. The cast should extend over the shoulders and well down over the pelvis and sacrum. If the disease is in the neck the cast should include the head as well. A large window is cut in front and one must be cut over the invoved area of the spine behind. Ordinary absorbent cotton is used for pad- The Practice of Osteopathy 791 ding with, of course, extra padding over all bony prominences. From two to five years' time is required for a complete recovery. The X-ray is invaluable in diagnosing this trouble, and each time a cast is removed to see how much progress has been made. The casts should be changed as often as they become soiled. Tuberculosis of the Hip This is a chronic tubercular condition of the head of the femur or of the acetabulum commonly known as hip-Joint disease. Pathology. — Primarily the head of the femur is the seat of the disease, the epiphysis being attacked in seventy-five per cent of the cases and the acetabulum in twenty-five per cent. The irritated pel- vic femoral muscles which are in a state of chronic contraction crowd the head of the femur against the upper and back border of the aceta- bulum. Under this continual pressure, absorption of that portion of the rim takes place with actual enlargement of the acetabulum from below upwards. This is spoken of "migration of the acetabulum" and is one cause for the shortening of the limb. Changes in the head of the femur are the result of inflammation and pressure. Partial de- struction of the head also helps shortening of the hmb and elevation of the trochanter above its proper level the same as the wearing away of the acetabulum. The synovial membrane is found to be reddened and thickened and granulation tissue is present, and usually the cartilage is gone from the head of the femur. Rarely does perforation of the floor of the acetabulum take place, but if such is the case a dense wall of fibrous tissue and thickened periosteum shuts off the head of the femur from the pelvic cavity. A natural cure results in two ways, — by absorption or calcification of the tubercular tissue, or by the evacuation and discharge by an external opening. This latter suppuration seems to be nature's effort to eUminate the disease, and when a cure is estabhshed this way it is usually characterized by mal-positions and shortening of the hmb, and, of course, an ankylosed joint. Early Symptoms. — The most characteristic symptoms of the disease are the 'night cries', stiffness and hmping, shortening of the leg, atrophy of the muscles of the hip, leg, and thigh, and the unconscious protection of the joint. A referred pain is usually present to the inside and front of the thigh near the knee or directly at the knee joint itself, due to the intimate relations and anastamosis of sciatic, obturator, and anterior crural nerves. Diagnosis. — The chief diagnostic sign is muscular spasms or the 792 The Practice of Osteopathy presence of stiffness of the joints and limitations of its proper arc of mo- tion, due to the tonic contraction of the muscles controlhng the joint. If there is no limitation of motion it is almost safe to say there is no hip-joint disease. The lameness may be intermittent. The attitudes or abnormal positions of the diseased limb are caused by the action of muscles holding the hmb stiffly in a distorted position. The pelvis is usually tilted and always one will find the patient assuming attitudes which will favor the diseased limb. Atrophy is very significant and a comparison of the two limbs should be made by measuring at the middle of the thigh and the middle of the calf. Nearly always one will find a deep thickening over the front of the hip joint and behind the trochanter. Physical Examination. — 1. Observe the general condition of the patient. 2. Note the attitude in standing. .3. Note character of the limp. 4. Note shortening of the hmb. 5. Remove the clothing and lay patient on the back. 6. Test the function of the groin. Always begin on the sound side for comparison in order that the patient may become accustomed to the manipulation before the hmb suspected of disease is tested. Tuber- culosis in a joint is always accompanied by muscular spasms that pos- itively Hmit motion in every direction, while in other affections only one or more hmitations are observed, but never in all directions. Com- pare closely the motions of the sound and affected hmbs while the pa- tient is on the back. Turn patient on face and test for extension by hold- ing pelvis flat on table with one hand and gently elevating thigh with the other. The normal range in a child is about twenty degrees backward from the Hne of the body and Hmitation of this range is perhaps the earli- est indication of hip-joint disease. It is due to psoas contraction. If this range of motion is unrestricted hip disease can be practically ex- cluded. The X-ray completes the diagnosis when used with a thorough knowledge of the physical signs. It must be remembered that in early life a larger part of the extremity of the femur is cartilaginous and does not show. well in a radiograph. The X-ray picture shows clearly the destructive effect of the disease on the femur and acetabulum and gives a clear conception of the actual condition of the joint. Treatment. — The object of treatment of this condition is three- fold: first, to reheve the pain that depresses the vitality of the patient; second, to relieve the muscular spasms that induce distortion of the limb The Practice of Osteopathy 793 and which stimulates the destructive process by increasing pressure and friction of the diseased surfaces of the opposing bones; third, to correct and prevent deformity by lessening pressure and by restraining motion, thereby keeping the femur from upward displacement. Rest and protection are the two cardinal features of treatment of this condition. Sunshine, fresh air and good nutritious diet are very im- portant. Complete rest of the joint offers the most favorable opportunity for nature to repair this disease. The recumbent period of the treat- ment necessitates rest in bed for the reduction of the deformity and sub- sidence of acute symptoms. By the aid of traction, which is applied to the length of the legs by means of a Buck's extension. As much weight should be applied as can be borne without discomfort to the patient. As soon as the deformity and acute symptoms have subsided, the ambulatory treatment should be substituted to keep up the general health of the patient. This merely consists of the appHcation of a long plaster of Paris spica of the hip which should reach well up to the thorax and extend down and include the foot. All bony prominences should be well padded, and a moderate amount of traction with about twenty degrees al)duction should be used while applying the plaster bandage. Though various forms of apparatus have been devised for fixation and traction, I believe that the plaster of Paris spica is far the most effective and should always be used, changing the cast as often as it becomes soiled. Locomotion is possible with crutches providing the shoe on the well side is stilted by an iron patten which is high enough to allow the casted Hmb.to clear the floor. The earlier treatment is begun, the better the outlook. Recov- ery with perfect motion occurs in about twenty-five percent of hospital cases; fifty per cent will obtain useful motion and the other twenty-five per cent will obtain practical fixation, but it must be remembered that results will range entirely according to the thoroughness of treatment, the severity of the disease in the individual case, and the natural resist- ance of the child. In general, the hip should be fixed as long as it is sensitive, it should be protected and distracted as long as there is mus- cular spasm, and protected until the congested and inflamed bone of the epiphysis is replaced by firm healthy bone. Tuberculosis of the Knee Joint Tuberculous disease of the knee is next to the hip in frequency. It is a chronic destructive process of the epiphysis of the femur or tibia, or 794 The Practice of Osteopathy it may start in the patella, head of the fibula, or primarily in the synovial membrane of the knee joint. The condition presents two distinct types; one, the adult type beginning as a chronic synovitis, of which the early symptoms are subacute; and the other, the childhood or most common class, in which the symptoms of pain, muscular spasms and deformity seem to indicate clearly a primary disease of the bone. Symptoms. — This disease is commonly known as "white swelling" and the symptoms as a rule are ouite characteristic. The affection be- gins with a limp and limitation of motion, and is usually slow in pro- gress with periods of severe pain. There is usually much swelling and this together with the distortion of the limb by muscular spasm and atrophy of the muscles both above and below the joint, gives a most characteristic knock-kneed appearance. The affected limb is usually longer at first, owing to the congestion of the epiphesis of the knee. Local heat is always present in the more acute stages and the lameness is usually a constant SAmiptom. The differential diagnosis from other joint troubles is easy because of the slow insidious onset. Treatment. — Like other tubercular bone conditions the fixation treatment is best. Rest in bed with a Buck's extension to overcome the deformity and the local application of hot packs until the acute symp- toms have subsided, is the best preliminary treatment of this condition. Five- to ten-second exposures to the X-ray each day for ten days seems to relieve the pain and in most instances causes less marked infiltration of tissues. When the acute stage has subsided, the ambulatory treatment by fixation in a plaster of Paris cast extending from the groin to the ankle^ with about 10 degrees flexion, is most efficient. The patient is allowed to walk about with the aid of crutches, having the shoe on the sound side stilted enough so that the diseased limb clears the floor. The functional results after conservative treatment are in the average case excellent, that is providing proper treatment is begun at an early stage. Useful motion is obtained in fifty per cent of these cases, perfect motion is restored in twenty-five per cent, and complete rigidity results in the other twenty-five per cent of cases. Any chronic, painful inflammation confined to a single joint, in which motion is limited by muscular spasm, and in which there is a ten- dency towards deformity, is almost always tubercular in character. The Practice of Osteopathy 795 The Plaster of Paris Bandage The plaster of Paris bandage was perhaps first applied by Kluge of Berlin in 1829, but to the Dutch physicians Mathysen and Vander Loo belongs the credit of the modern bandage. It is imperative to give, in this chapter, a detailed and complete description of what constitutes a properly made plaster of Paris bandage and the application of it, in order that the general practitioner may be- come familiar with its use. Even though one cares not to treat the conditions heretofore enumerated, I have found that for fractures of almost every bone in the body requiring immobilization, the plaster bandage property applied is far superior and rather to be preferred to any other form of splints. It has been used very Kttle in the past in private practice because the ordinary commercial bandage found in any supply house does not come up to requirements, in that it is usually air slaked or the plaster has been shaken from it by the time it is received. Then too the mesh is too closely woven and the plaster lies on the bandage instead of in the meshes and there is, in consequence, an excess of plaster; also as a rule the bandages are rolled so tightly that the water does not reach the deeper laj^ers. The ordinary plaster of Paris bandage made in your own office can always be successfully applied because the right quantity of plaster can be incorporated in the bandage and it can readily be made into the de- sired widths. The plaster of Paris to be used should be of the superior quality used by dentists and should be of the quick setting kind. It 2. lumbar nerves, lesions affecting, 722. technic, 74. Lumbo-abdominal neuralgia, 713. Lungs affected by stomach p.-ess- ure, 498. complications in typhoid, 332 congestion, 610. crowded by round slioulder.s, 121. diseases, 592. due to ribs, 47. causing hyperemia of liver, 554 edema of 611. relation to digestion, 494. sensory nerves to, 95. stimulated through rectum, 169, 170. vasomotor nerves to 93, Lymphatic leukemia, 682. Lymphadenoma, 684. — M— McBurney's point, 549. why pain in appendicitis, 499. Macula lutea, 195. Maddoxrod, 193. Mai, grand, 730, 732. petit, 730, 733. Malaria associated with typhoid .337. ^L^larial cachexia, 351. fever, 347. pernicious, 350. hematuria, 351. Mammary gland innervation, 722. Manic depressive psychoses, 291. Massage following hip joint dis- ease. 111. intracapsular fracture of hip, 111. of fractures, 116. of sprains, 109. not osteopathy, 19. Mastoiditis, 240. Mayo clinic's goiter findings, 692. Measles, 437. a cause of bronchitis, 579. differentiate German measles, 446. scarlet fever, 432. German, 444. Meatus of ear, atrophic, 237. infection of, 238. Medulla contains vasomotor center, 92. Meibomian cyst, 200. Meissner's plex.us, 494. Melancholia agitata, 297. Mellitus, Diabetes, 470. Meniere's disease, 254, 718. symptom complex, 253. Meningeal tuberculosis, 387. Meningitis, cerebrospinal, 358. complicating pneumonia, 601. tubercular, 360. Menopause, thyroid enlargement during, 686. Mental deficiency, 305. diseases, 282. osteopathic lesions in, 289. Microcephalus, 308. Migraine, 736. Milk leg, 167. Mind, relation to brain, 307. Miner's anemia, 155. Mitral regurgitation, 648. stenosis, 649. Moebius' sign, 694. MorbilU, 437. Mongohan amentia, 309. Morons, 305. Morphine habit, phyr sieians respon.sible, 715. Morton's disease, 112. Morvan's disease, 762. Mosquito carrier of filaria, 158. Motion is function of joint, 489. Motor oeuli nerve, lesions affect- ing, 716. Mouth, diseases of, 487. Mucous colitis, 520. Mumps, 449. whooping cough and acute eruptive fevers, 410. differential diagnosis, 451. Murmurs, Heart, 042, 643. Muscle contractions caused by vis- ceral disturbances, how, 500. relieved by inhibition, 89. Muscular lesions, 27, 41, 45. Also considered in connection with osseous lesions of var- ious parts, rheumatism, 465. Musculacutaneous nerve, lesions affecting, and results, 721. Myalgia, 467. Mydriatic, 194. Myelemia, 681. Myelitis, 707. acute, 748. chronic, 750. diffuse, 749. transverse, 748. Myelogenous leukemia, acute, 681 Myeloid leukemia, 681. Myocarditis, 659. Myoclonia, 727. * :Myxedema, 097. — N— Nasal — See nose Nasopharyngitis, 272. Na.sopharynx, diseases of, 272. Neck — See also cervical. Neck examination, 47. muscle lesions, 46. stiff, 465, 466. technic, 64, 66. dangers of, 66, 86. Nephritis differentiated from pye- litis, 628. hemorrhagic, chronic, 622. interstitial, 624. differentiated from diabetes in.sipidus,477. parenchymatous, acute, 61S. chronic, 621. postoperative, 314. Nerve centers (osteopathic) 88. deafness, 255, 718. degeneration, auditory, 256. The Practice of Osteopathy 805 diseusesof, 706. ci-iinial, diseases of, 715. spinal, diseases of, 719. sensory, 94. • vasomotor, 92. Nervous indigestion, 511. prostration from prolapse, 12S. system, diseases of, 706. Neuralgia, 710. cervico-brachiai and brachial, 711 cervico-occipital, 711. differential diagnosis, 714. intercostal, 721. of eye, 197. of fifth nerve, 710. of foot, some causes, 112. of legs and feet, 714. of sacral nerve from impacted feces, 537. of sacral region, 713. of spinal column, 713. of trunk, 712. relieved by inhibition, 89. Neuresthenia, 744. Neuritis, 706. brachial, 123. differentiated from neuralgia, 714 multiple, differentiated from Lan- drjf's paralysis, 753. from myelitis, 749. optic, 230. postoperative, 313. retrobulbar, 231. Neuroses of heart,' 662. gastric, 510. Neurosis, occupation, 738. " Neurotic spine, " 101. Nocturnal epilep.sy, 733, 734. Nose and throat in eye troubles, 191.196,225,229. antiseptic sprays etc., 2.58, 262. conditions in torticollis, 466. diseases of, 257. intranasal treatment, 260. packing, 267, 268. pharmacodynamics of, 262. syphilis of, 270. throat and ear, diseases, 230. nosebleed, 161,271. differential diagnosis, 161. Nursing necessary to osteopathy, 62 Nutmeg liver, 554. -0-, Obesity, 480 exercises to reduce abdomen, 128,139,480. Obstetric cases, innominate Icosin in, 108. Obstruction, intestinal— see intes- tinal. (Jbturator nerv-e, lesions affecting, 722. Occipito-allantal (•x.'iminiitif)n and lesions, 45. technic, 67. Occupation neurosis, 738. Olfactory nerve, diseases of, 715. Omodynia, 466, 467. Ophthalmia neonatorum, 210. purulent, 209. sympathetic, 227. Ophthalmology, 183. Ophthalmoscope, 193. Optic disc, 195. nerve atrophy, 231. probably connection with third, 234. neuritis, 230. tract, diseases of, 715. Oropharynx, diseases of, 274. Orthopedic Surgery, 767. Osteopathic centers — see centers. diagnosis and prognosis, 38. etiology and pathology, 24. examination of eye 184. inhibition, 89. lesion defined, 24. manipulation in eye diseases, 196, 213. readjustment, 90. stimulation, 88. theory, proof of, 34 scientific demonstration, 89. treatment, general directions, 58. Osteopathy, definitions of, 18. includes many measures, 62. not massage, 19. not passive exercise, 129. not Swedish movements, 19,63,68 Otitis media, acute suppurative, 239 chronic suppurative, 243. differential diagnosis, 244. nonsuppurative, 246. Ovarian examination, 56. Ovary, prolapse of, 144. sensory nerves to, 95. Oxyuris vermicularis, 1.54. Pachymeningitis, cervical, differ- entiated from syringomye- lia, 762. Packing, nasal, 207, 268. Pains, location of reflex, 499. Palpation, educated, 60. practice in, 87. Palpitation, 662. Pannus, 224. Panophthalmitis, 227. Papillae in rectum, 174. Paralysis, acute ascending, 753. Paralysis agitans, 723. differential diagnosis, 724. bulbar, 765. Paralysis, infantile, 750. Paranephritic abscess differentiated from pyelitis, 628. Paranoia, 287. Paraplegia, ataxic, 761. spastic, 760. Parasites, animal, 151. Parathyroid glands^diseasesof, 699. Paratyphoid fever, 344. Paris, plaster of, 795. Parotiditis, epidemic, 449. differential diagnosis of, 451. Parotitis, epidemic, 449. Patheticus nerves, lesions affecting, 716. Pathologies, osteopathy recognizes two distinct, 489. Pathology, osteopathic, 31. Patient's receptivity to treatment, 61. Pearls, Laennec's, 591. Pelvic examination, 52. prolapse caused by abdominal prolapse, 128. technic, 78. Pendulous abdomen, 127. Pericarditis, 638. complicating pneumonia, 600. Pericardium, diseases of, 638. Peristalsis explained, 494. reversed, normal in parts of colon, 497. technic to affect, 495. Peritonsillar abscess, 278. Pernicious anemia, 678. Pertussis, 452. Petit mal, 730, 733. Pharyngitis, 274. Pharynx complications in typhoid, 332. technic, 67. Phenol-glycerine formula, 263. Phlebitis, 167. postoperative, 313. Phlegmasia alba dolens, 167. Phlyctenular keratitis, 224. Phrenic nerve, lesions affecting, 720. Phthisis, see tuberculosis Piles, 171. Pinworm, 154. Plaster of Paris, 795. Pleura, diseases of, 611. Pleurisy, 611. complicating pneumonia, 600. differentiated from pneumonia, 601. postoperative, 314. Pleurodynia, 465, 466, 712. Pneumogastric nerve, lesions af- fecting, 718. Pneumonia, acute lobar, 507. aspiration, 605. alcohol not indicated in, 319. associated with endocarditi.s, 044 bronchial, 605. caused by tubercle bacillus, 606 catarrhal, 605. 806 The Practice of Osteopathy complication of typhoid, 332 chronic interstitial, 009. croupous, 597. tlifferential tliagnosis of, 009. deglutition, 605. differential diagnosis of, 001. postoperative, 314. Pneumonia, strychnine not indi- cated in, 320. Pneumonic phthisis, 388. Poliomj'elitis, 750. causing scoliosis, 770. difierentiated from myelitis, 749. Polj'uria,476. Portal system, vasomotors to, 94. Posterior spine technic, 101. thoracic nerve, lesions affecting, 721. Postoperative treatment, 312. Postural curves of spine, 128. defects, 120. Posture, correct, 127, 128. Pott's disease, 102,788. differentiated from kyphosis, 97. from scoliosis, 773. treatment, 102. Proctitis, 170. Prognosis and diagnosis, osteo- pathic, 38. osteopathic, 50. Progressive muscular atrophy, 764. differentiated from syringo- myelitis, 762. Prolapse — See also ptosis. Prolapsed hepatic flexure, 139. intestines, 139, 170. kidney, 136. liver, 138. organs, 127, 133, 521. ovaries, 144. rectum, 171. sigmoid flexure, 141, 170. stomach, 134. uterus, 143. Prominent hip, 12."). Prostate gland, 175 technic, 637. sensory nerves to, 95. Prostatitis, 175. Prostatorrhea, 176. Pseudo-angina pectoris, 667. appendicitis, 550. croup, 572. leukemia, 684. Psychalgia, 293, 296. Psychosis, involutional, 295. Ptosis — See also prolapse. of abdominal organs, 127. of eyelids, 201. Pulmonary regurgitation, 650. stenosis, 650. Punctumproximum, 192. remotum, 192. Purpura, 483. variolosa, 420. Pyelitis, 627. differential diagnosis, 628, 636. Pyelonephritis, 027. Pyemia, 356. — o— Quinsy, 278. — R— Radial nerve, lesions affecting, 739. Rash, differentiate scarlet fever from drug >.r septic, 431. Receptaculum chyli, vasomotor nerves to, 94. Rectal conditions requiring sur- gery, 174. disorders, brief di.scussion, 141. examination, 55, 56, 169. Rectum, 169. to dilate, 170. technic, 169. Reflex gastric troubles, 509. pains, location of various, 499. Reflexes, somatic, Burns experi- ments, 189. Regions of body should form basis of disease classification, 586. Regurgitation, aortic, 649. mitral, 648. pulmonary, 650. tricuspid, 650. Remittent fever, 350. differentiate from yellow fever, 375. Renal calculus, 631. Re,nal colic — see colic. differentiate fiom appendicitis 551. Respiratory diseases 569' reflex inefficiency, 264. Retina, diseases of, 230, 715. Retinitis, 230. Retrobulbar neuritis, 231. Rheumatic fever, 457. Rheumatism, abdominal, 406, 467 cause of heart valve defects, 645. chronic articular, 460. differential diagnosis, 459. and brachial neuritis, 125. gonorrheal, 459. inflammatory, 457. muscular, 465. subacute, 459. Rheumatoid arthritis, 462. differentiated from rheumatic fever, 459. Rhinitis, acute, 257. atrophic, 261. chronic hypertrophic, 2.39. hyperesthetic, 263. purulent, 259. Ribs, danger in elderly patient.", 87. examination, 47. false, technic, 74. first, examination, 49. technic, 72. floating, 49. technic, 73. lesions cause heart trouble, 648, 653. described, 48. sprains. 111. technic, 69. Rickets, 478. Rose spots, .334. Round shoulders, 121, 130. worm, 151. Rubella, 441. differentiated from measles and scarlet fever, 446. Rubeola, 437. Ruddy nasal third finger, 197. third finger eye instrument, 214, 229. treatment of tonsillitis, 281. .St. Vitus' dance, 725. Saccules in rectum, 174. .Sacial ner\^es, lesions affecting, 722. neuralgia, 713. caused by impacted feces, 538. Sacro-iliac — see innominate. Sacrum examination, 55. technic, 82. Salivary glands, 491. Sallow skin, 559. Scalp, 40. technic, 68. Scapula, technic, 08. Scapulodynia, 466, 467. Scarlatina, 428. differentiate diphtheria, 432. drug rash, 431. German measles, 432, 446. measles, 432. septic rash, 431. types and forms, 432. Scarlet fever — .see scarlatina. Schematic eye, 194. .Sciatica, 708, 714. "Scissors" technic dangerous, 86. Sclerosis, amyotrophic lateral, 762, 763. differentiate from syringomye- lia, 762. cerebral, differentiate from cho- rea, 726. disseminated, differentiate from paralysis agitans, 724. Scoliosis — See curvatures. Scrofula, 384, 396. Scrofulous ophthalmia, 214. Scurvy, 481. Seminal vesicles, 176. Senile delirium, 300. dementia, 297. The Practice of Osteopathy 807 Sensory nerves to various viscera, 94. See also under various viscera. Septic rash, differentiate scarlatina, 431. Septicemia, 35.5. "Setting-up" exercises for pendu- lous abdomen, 128. Shaking palsy, 723. Shoulder, 56, SO. painful, 122. round, 121. sprain of, 114. Sight — see eye. diagnosis, 38. Sigmoid impaclion causing cough, 575. prolapse, 141. Sinuitia, 269. vacuum, 270. Skin diseases, 147. Small occipital norve, point to con- trol, 719. Small-pox, 412. black, 420. differentiate from chicken-pox, .417. Smell, sense of, 491. Snellin's test type, 191. Solar plexus inhibition, .582. Somatic reflexes — -Burns experi- ments, 188. Spasm — see convulsions. habit, 728. Spastic paraplegia, 760. Sphincters, alimentary, 490. ani, external, 49S. Spina! accessory nerve, lesions af- fecting, 719. centers (osteopathic), 88. column, neiiralgia of, 713. postural curvatures of, 128. cord, diseases of, 748. curvature, pathological, 96. technic, 97. examination, importance of, 41. landmarks, 39. lesioas — see lesions, nerves, diseases of, 719. stretching, dangers of, 86. Spine the center of osteopathic interest, 38. hysterical, description and tccii- nic, 101. neurotic, description iind tecli- nic, 101. of the aged, description and tech- nic, 101. posterior, technic, 101. sprains of, 110. straight, 99. technic, 100. tubercular di.sease of, 788, 102. typhoid, description and technic, 100. Splanchnic technic, 495. Spleen complications in typhoid, 332. diseases of, 567. examination, 52. treatment, 78. vasomotor nerves to, 94. Splenitis, 567. Splenomedullary leukemia, 681. Spondylitis deformans, 463. Sprains and fractures, 104. bandaging not always good, 107. heat and cold in treatment, 106. immobilization and rest, 106, 115. massage, 109, 116. of ankle, 112. of elbow, 114. of fingers, 114. of foot, 112. , of hip, 111. of innominate. 111. of knee, 112. of ribs. 111. of shoulder, 114. of spinal column, 110. of wrist and hand, 1 14. passive movement, 107. summary of treatment, lib. Stand erect, how to, 127. Status epilepticus, 734. lymphaticus, 702. Stenosis, aortic, 650. mitral, 649. pulmonary, 050. tricuspid, 650. Sternum examination, 49. technic, 73. Still, early struggles of Dr. A. T., 17 Still-Hildreth Sanitarium 280, 291. Several times in chapter on mental and nervous dis- eases. Stimulation, osteopathic, 88. Stomach, — sec also digestive sys- tem. cardiac relaxation by inhibition, 89. conditions in bronchial asthma, ,5S9. dilatation, 134. differentiate from gastroptosia, 1.34. distention, 498. examination, 52. hemorrhage, 162, 516. pain over pit of, due to cutaneous .scn.sory nerves, 721. prolapse, 134. sen.sory nerves to, 95. technic, 78. ulcer, spinal causes of, 498. Stomatitis, 487. Stones, gall, 563. kidney, 631. "Straight spine, " 99, 130. technic for, 100. Strangulation of intestines, 541. Stretching, indiscriminate, 86. Strychnine not indicated in post- operative pneumonia, 320. poisoning differentiated from tetanus, 378. Stupor, delirium and confusion, 289. Sty, 200. Sunstroke, 180. Supports, arch, 114. in prolapse, 133, 142. Suprarenal capsule. Dr. Still's the- ory, 633. Surgery, relation to osteopathy, 22. in various conditions, taken up in connection with treatment, orthopedic, 767. Swallowing, 492. Swedish movements not oste- opathy, 19, 63, 68. Synechiae in keratitis, 221. Syphilis of nose, 270. of thyroid, 687. Syphilitic laryngitis, 577. Syringomjfelia,701. differential diagnosis, 762. — T— Tabes dorsalis, 754. Tachycardia, 663. Taenia fiavo-punctata, 151. saginata, 151. solium, 151. Talipes, 784. Tape worm, 151. Taste, bad, in mouth, 492. sense of, 491. Technic, see under osteopathic treatment; also under vari- ous regions, and organs. dangerous, 86. osteopathic, 60. Teeth conditions in torticollis, 466. defects should be corrected, 490. Tompero-mandibular — see jaw. Tenesmus treatment, 170. Testes, sensory nerves to 95. Tetanus, 377. differentiated from hydropho- bia, .378. strychnine poisoning, 378. Tetany, 699. Thorax examination, 51. Threadworm, 154. Throat and nose in eye trouble, 191, 196, 225, 229. Throat, diseases of the ear, nose and, 230. 808 The Practice of Osteopathy (Edwards' turbinate adjustor) 197. irritation due to hyoid, 47. (Ruddy's nasal third finger), 197. technic, 67. Thrombosis from typhoid, 332. Thrush, 488. Thyroid gland, direct manipula- tion dangerous, 696. diseases of, 686. Thymus gland enlarged in goiter, 691, 693. diseases of, 702. Tic, convulsive, 728. douloureaux, 711. general, 728. Tongue, 490. furred, 491. vasomotor nerves to, 92. Tonsils. 67. function of, 276. in rheumatism, 457, 400. in torticollis, 466. palpated, 47. (peritonsillar abscess), 278. trouble in eye disease, 196. Tonsillectomy, 278. summary of indications for, 280. Tonsillitis, 276. technic, 68, 279, 280. Torticollis, 129, 465, 466, 719. Touch, educated sense of, 60. Trachoma, 208, 212. differentiated from follicular con- junctiv-itis, 20S. Traction, reasons for, 62. Transillumination in diagnosing sinuitis, 269. Treating (over-treating), 84. in influenza, 404. Treatment — see also technic. after a meal, 83. frequency of, 83, 84. general, 62, 68, 90. should be given when, 63. inhibition to begin, 89. length of, 84. misapplied, 85, 87. position of phy.sician and pa- tient, 63. receptivity of patient to, 61. resulting in some motion, leave lesion for that time, 76. to be avoided, 86. value of vacation from, 85. Tremors, differentiate from paraly- sis agitans, 724. Trichiniasis, 156. Trichiasis, 201. Tricuspid regurgitation, 650. stenosis, 650. Trigeminous nerve, lesions affect- ing, 717. Trigger-finger, 115. Trousseau's phenomenon, 701. Tubal disease, differentiated from appendicitis, 551. Tubercle bacillus may cause bron- chopneumonia, 606. Tuberculo.sis, 380. and joint immobilization, 115. of alimentary tract, 393. acute, 386. begins as chronic gastritis, 506. bones and joints, 788. bronchopneumonic, 388. cerebral, 387. deformities predisposing factors, 389. differentiate from brachial neu- ritis, 125. pneumonia, 601. (fibroid phthisis), 393. differentiate from chronic in- terstitial pneumonia, 609. of genito-urinary tract, 394. of hip, 791. of knee, 793. of lymph glands, 384. of miliary, 386, 394. pneumonic, 386. pulmonary, 387, 389. of spine, 102, 788. orthopedic surgery necessary in, 767. of thyroid, 687. Tuberculous laryngitis, 575. Tumor, brain, differentiate from migraine, 737. Tuning fork tests, 294. Turbinates, to clean around iu rhinitis, 260. Tussis convulsiva, 4.52. Typhoid fever, 329. afebrile, 334. fever associated with malaria, 337 do not manipulate abdomen, 163. differentiated from appendi- citis, 551. spine, 100. Typhus fever. 344. —XT- Ulcer of cornea, 219, 221. gastric and duodenal, 512. location of reflex pain in gastric or duodenal, 499. of stomach, spinal causes of, 498. differential diagnosis, 508, 515. Ulcerative stomatitis, 164. Ulnar nerve, lesions affecting, 726, 739. Uncinariasis, 155. Uremia, 628.- Uremic convulsions, differentiated from epilepsy, 734. Ureter, sensory nerves to, 95. hemorrhage, 164. Urethra hemorrhage, 164. Urinary system, diseases of, 617. Urine, blood in, 163. massage prostate for retention of, 176. Urticaria, 149. Uterine examination, 56. hemorrhage, 164. THerus, prolapsed, 143. sen.sory nerves to, 95. Vaccination, 424. Vaccinia, 424. Valve diseases, heart, 642, 644, 645, 649,651. Varicella, 424, 446. differentiated from variola, 417. Varicocele, 176. Varicose veins, 166. Variola, 412. cornea, 421. differentiated from varicella, 417 hemorrhagica pustulosa, 420. vera, 418. verucosa, 420. Varioloid, 420. Variolosa purpura, 420. sine exanthemate, 420. Vasomotor nerves, 92. Venereal disease and eye trouble, 184. Vertebrae, landmarks for dis- tinguishing, 39. Vision explained, 230. Volvulus, 541. Vomiting, persistent, mostly re- flex, 501. postoperative, 312. technic to relieve, 504. von Graefe's sign, 694. — W— Water, drink plenty, 540. White swelling, 793. Whooping cough, 452. Whooping cough, mumps, and acute eruptive fevers, 411. differentiate enlarged glands, 454. Worms, intestinal, 151. Wrist, 56. sprain, 114. Wr\--neck — see torticollis. — \ — Yellow Fever, 374. differentiate from remittent fin- er, 375. — Z— Zuckerkandl's organ, 703. -^'"'\-o^\'^ ./^ •^o V ax^ . *.'^. T^ 0^ s * , ^ 'i L -«--v,.^ 'c/. \' V 0^ ./' ^ .#'%, O •' , ,V -^ .A ™^;..'; s:^;^-- >>. /." #*<%,. \ :', %> /,i|nS/-- ^".^ / ^o V'- • ' a 4 ^ 4^ •^^ ° / -0' \ ,0 ^ - ^'''^- \0 ■^v. ^'^- =o V i^N^ V '^^. *,,^■'^ A^^ •„ ■ e>* *W„V^ '^ .^ ■^^. '''' r^^ .>"■ o,'?-' A^ %. ^^ '^r, .'.*#^2!%^^ -^ .-b- V' <^^ .S^ '^' 'X\^^'%. "b V